241 59 17MB
English Pages 424 [478] Year 2011
UNIT
3
RECORDING AND REPORTING FOR A TRADING BUSINESS
In Unit 3 of the VCE Accounting course, we will cover the following chapters: 3
CHAPTER 1
THE ROLE OF ACCOUNTING
CHAPTER 2
THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION
CHAPTER 3
THE GENERAL LEDGER
CHAPTER 4
THE GOODS AND SERVICES TAX (GST)
CHAPTER 5
SPECIAL JOURNALS 1: CREDIT JOURNALS
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
CHAPTER 7
THE GENERAL JOURNAL
CHAPTER 8
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
CHAPTER 9
DETERMINING PROFIT OR LOSS
CHAPTER 10
BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS: EXPENSES
217
CHAPTER 11
DEPRECIATION OF NON-CURRENT ASSETS
239
CHAPTER 12
THE CASH FLOW STATEMENT
21
35 59 85 107
143 163 195
263
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s EXPLAIN the role of accounting s IDENTIFY the users of accounting information and THEFINANCIALINFORMATIONTHEY MAYREQUIRE s DISTINGUISH between financial data and financial information s IDENTIFY and EXPLAIN the stages in the accounting process
s DEFINE and APPLY the accounting principles and QUALITATIVECHARACTERISTICS s EXPLAIN the relationships between the accounting PRINCIPLESANDQUALITATIVE characteristics s IDENTIFY and DEFINE the elements of financial statements.
CHAPTER 1
THE ROLE OF ACCOUNTING KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s elements of s accounting principles s financial data financial statements n ENTITY s financial information s transaction
– Going Concern
– assets
s source documents
– Reporting Period
– liabilities
s recording
– Historical Cost
n OWNERSEQUITY
s reporting
– Conservatism
– revenue
s advice
n #ONSISTENCY
– expense
s agreed value
n -ONETARY5NIT
s MATERIALITY
s QUALITATIVECHARACTERISTICS – Relevance n 2ELIABILITY n #OMPARABILITY n 5NDERSTANDABILITY
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
4
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
1.1
UNITS 3&4
THE PURPOSE OF ACCOUNTING
5NFORTUNATELY FOR BUSINESS OWNERS HAVING A GREAT BUSINESS IDEA IS NOT ENOUGH TO GUARANTEESUCCESS9OUDONTHAVETOLOOKVERYFARTOlNDSTORIESOFBUSINESSOWNERS WHOSTARTEDOUTWITHWHATTHEYTHOUGHTWASAFANTASTICPRODUCTORSERVICE BUTENDED UPGOINGBUST!SIDEFROMTHEQUALITYOFWHATBUSINESSOWNERSARESELLING THEREAREA VARIETYOFOTHERFACTORSTHATWILLINmUENCETHEIRCHANCEOFSUCCESS INCLUDING s CONSUMERTASTESANDDEMAND s THELEVELOFCOMPETITION s THEQUALITYOFTHEIRSTAFFEMPLOYEES s THEECONOMICCLIMATE s THEMANAGEMENTSKILLSOFTHEOWNERS 4HISLASTPOINTISPARTICULARLYIMPORTANTBECAUSEINMOSTSMALLBUSINESSESOWNERSHAVEA HANDS ONMANAGERIALROLE ANDTHEIRMANAGEMENTSKILLSCANHAVEADIRECTANDSIGNIlCANT EFFECTONWHATHAPPENSTOTHATBUSINESS7HETHERTHEYAREDETERMININGSELLINGPRICES DECIDING ON ADVERTISING CAMPAIGNS EMPLOYING STAFF OR UNDERTAKING MORE MUNDANE TASKS SUCHASPAYINGBILLS THEOWNERMUSTMAKEIMPORTANTDECISIONSONADAILYBASIS #ERTAINLY SMALLBUSINESSOWNERSMUSTHAVEDETAILEDKNOWLEDGEOFWHATEVERITISTHEY ARETRYINGTOSELL BUTTHEYMUSTALSOHAVEDETAILEDINFORMATIONONAWHOLERANGEOFOTHER ISSUESTHATMAYAFFECTTHEIRCHANCESOFSUCCESS4HISISWHEREACCOUNTINGCOMESINTOTHE PICTUREITISESSENTIALLYANINFORMATIONSERVICE Accounting is the collection and recording of financial data, and the reporting, analysis and interpretation of financial information. purpose of accounting to provide financial information to assist decision-making
The purpose of accountingISTOPROVIDEBUSINESSOWNERSWITHlNANCIALINFORMATION THATWILLASSISTTHEMINMAKINGDECISIONSABOUTTHEACTIVITIESOFTHEIRlRM4HISDOESNOT mean that accounting will ensure owners make the right decisions, but it should help them to make more informedDECISIONS WHICHWILLHOPEFULLYIMPROVETHEPERFORMANCE OFTHElRMANDITSCHANCESOFSUCCESS
The purpose of accounting is to provide business owners with financial information that will assist them in making decisions about the activities of their firm
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 1
5
THE ROLE OF ACCOUNTING
2%6)%715%34)/.3
1 ,ISTlVEFACTORSTHATCANINmUENCETHELIKELIHOODTHATASMALLBUSINESSWILLBE successful. 2 ,IST three important decisions that a business owner would need to make on ADAILYBASIS 3 $ElNE ‘accounting’. 4 %XPLAIN the purpose of accounting.
1.2
USERS OF ACCOUNTING INFORMATION
4HIS COURSE CONCENTRATES SPECIlCALLY ON ACCOUNTING FOR SOLE TRADERS THAT IS TRADING BUSINESSESTHATAREOWNEDBYONLYONEPERSON WHOISUSUALLYRESPONSIBLEFORRUNNING THE lRM &OR THIS REASON WE WILL CONCENTRATE ON THE INFORMATION THAT THE owner will WANTTOSEE(OWEVER ITISIMPORTANTTONOTETHATANUMBEROFDIFFERENTPARTIESMAYBE INTERESTEDINTHElRMSlNANCIALINFORMATION4HESEPARTIESAREKNOWNASTHE@USERSOF THEACCOUNTINGINFORMATION ANDMAYINCLUDE s debtors and other customers WHOMAYWISHTOKNOWABOUTTHElRMSCONTINUING ABILITYTOPROVIDETHEMWITHSTOCK s creditors and other suppliers WHOMAYWISHTOKNOWABOUTTHElRMSABILITYTO REPAYWHATITOWESTHEM s banks and other financial institutions WHOWILLWANTTOKNOWABOUTTHElRMS CURRENTLEVELSOFDEBTBEFOREPROVIDINGITWITHANYADDITIONALlNANCE s employees WHOMAYWISHTOKNOWABOUTTHElRMSLONG TERMVIABILITYnANDTHEIR LONG TERMEMPLOYMENTPROSPECTSnORITSABILITYTOAFFORDIMPROVEMENTSINWAGES and conditions s prospective owners WHOMAYWISHTOKNOWABOUTTHElRMSlNANCIALSTRUCTURE and earnings performance s the Australian Tax Office (ATO) WHICHWILLREQUIRElNANCIALINFORMATIONFORTAXATION purposes. #ONSIDERING THE VARIETY OF USERS OF ACCOUNTING INFORMATION AND THE DIFFERENT INFORMATIONEACHMAYREQUIRE WHATINFORMATIONSHOULDTHEACCOUNTINGSYSTEMPROVIDE 4HISSEEMINGLYDIFlCULTQUESTIONHASASURPRISINGLYSIMPLYANSWERTHEACCOUNTINGSYSTEM SHOULDPROVIDEWHATEVERINFORMATIONTHEUSERDECIDESISNECESSARY4HISMEANSTHATITIS the usernNOTTHEACCOUNTANTORTHEACCOUNTINGSYSTEMnWHODECIDESWHATISNECESSARY
Financial data versus financial information Given that accounting is concerned with providing information, it is worth noting the DIFFERENCEBETWEENlNANCIALdataANDlNANCIALinformation. Financial data refers to the RAWFACTSANDlGURESONWHICHlNANCIALINFORMATIONWILLBEBASED&ORMOSTBUSINESSES THIS DATA IS CONTAINED IN THEIR RECEIPTS CHEQUE BUTTS INVOICES AND OTHER BUSINESS DOCUMENTS&ORINSTANCE AlLEFULLOFBUSINESSDOCUMENTSMAYPROVIDETHEDETAILSDATA RELATINGTOTHElRMSACTIVITIESOVERTHELASTWEEKORMONTH However, in their original form these documents would be of limited use as the data HASNOTBEENPROCESSEDINANYWAY/NLYWHENTHISINFORMATIONISSORTED CLASSIlEDAND summarised into a more useable and understandable form does it become financial informationTHATCANBEUSEDASTHEBASISFORBUSINESSDECISIONS4HISSORTING CLASSIFYING ANDSUMMARISINGISPERFORMEDBYTHEACCOUNTINGSYSTEM
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
financial data raw facts and figures upon which financial information is based
lNANCIALINFORMATION financial data that has been sorted, classified and summarised into a more useable and understandable form
Cambridge University Press
6
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
2%6)%715%34)/.3
1 ,ISTSIXLIKELYUSERSOFACCOUNTINGINFORMATION 2 %XPLAINWHYBANKSANDOTHERlNANCIALINSTITUTIONSWILLBEINTERESTEDINTHE lNANCIALINFORMATIONOFASMALLBUSINESS 3 %XPLAINTHEDIFFERENCEBETWEEN@lNANCIALDATAAND@lNANCIALINFORMATION
1.3
THE ACCOUNTING PROCESS
If we work backwards, then what the owner is looking for is the information the ACCOUNTINGSYSTEMCANPROVIDE$ATAMUSTBECOLLECTED PROCESSEDINTOAUSEABLEFORM and then communicated so that the business owner has meaningful information on which to base a decision. The accountant should then provide some guidance as to appropriate courses of action. These four ‘phases’ or ‘stages’ are the basis of what is known as the accounting process. Figure 1.1 The accounting process
Sources documents
Records
Reports
Provides advice
Stage 1: collecting source documents TRANSACTION an exchange of goods or services with another party SOURCEDOCUMENTS paper or electronic documents that provide both the evidence that a transaction has occurred and the details of the transaction itself
Collecting source documents is sometimes known as the ‘input stage’, where the business collects the source documents relating to its transactions. A transaction is SIMPLYANEXCHANGEOFGOODSORSERVICESWITHANOTHERPARTY Source documents are the paper or electronic documents that provide both the evidence that a transaction has occurred and the details of the transaction itself. Source documents provide the data on which the accounting information will be based. Common source documents include: s receipts WHICHPROVIDEEVIDENCEOFCASHRECEIVEDBYTHEBUSINESS s cheque butts WHICHPROVIDEEVIDENCEOFCASHPAIDBYTHEBUSINESS s invoices, which provide evidence of credit sales and purchases s memos WHICHPROVIDEEVIDENCEOFTRANSACTIONSWITHINTHElRMITSELF These source documents are covered in more detail in Chapter 4. ! BUSINESS WILL ENTER INTO MANY TRANSACTIONS EVERY DAY AND EVERY ONE OF THESE transactions must be detailed on a source document. As far as the accounting process is concerned, if it isn’t written down, it didn’t happen.
Stage 2: recording recording sorting, classifying and summarising the data contained in the source documents so that it is more useable
/NCETHESOURCEDOCUMENTSHAVEBEENCOLLECTED THEDATATHEYCONTAINMUSTBEWRITTEN down or noted in a more useable form, or ‘recorded’. Recording involves sorting, CLASSIFYINGANDSUMMARISINGTHEDATACONTAINEDINTHESOURCEDOCUMENTSSOTHATITIS more useable. This is sometimes known as the ‘processing’ stage, where data becomes information. Common accounting records include: s journals WHICHRECORDDAILYTRANSACTIONSOFACOMMONTYPESUCHASALLCASHPAIDOR ALLSTOCKPURCHASEDONCREDIT s ledgers WHICHRECORDTHEEFFECTOFEACHTRANSACTIONONTHEITEMSINTHElRMS accounting reports s stock cards, which record all the movements of stock in and out of the business.
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 1
7
THE ROLE OF ACCOUNTING
4HESEACCOUNTINGRECORDS ANDHOWTHEYAREUSED WILLBEDISCUSSEDINDETAILTHROUGHOUT this text.
Stage 3: reporting The ‘output’ stage of the accounting process involves taking the information generated BYTHEACCOUNTINGRECORDSINSTAGE ANDREPORTINGTHATlNANCIALINFORMATIONTOTHE owner of the business in an understandable form. Reporting involves the preparation OF lNANCIAL STATEMENTS THAT COMMUNICATE lNANCIAL INFORMATION TO THE OWNER SO THAT decisions can be made. There are three general-purpose reports that all businesses should prepare: s a Cash Flow Statement WHICHREPORTSONTHElRMSCASHINmOWSANDOUTmOWS AND the change in its cash balance over a period s an Income Statement WHICHREPORTSONTHElRMSABILITYTOEARNAPROlTFROMITS trading activities over a period s a Balance Sheet WHICHREPORTSONTHElRMSASSETSANDLIABILITIESATAPARTICULAR point in time.
reporting the preparation of financial statements that communicate financial information to the owner
Stage 4: advice Armed with the information presented in the reports, the owner should be in a much better position to make informed decisions. However, the best course of action is sometimes unclear. Therefore, the accountant should be able to offer advice BYMAKING SOMESUGGESTIONSABOUTANAPPROPRIATECOURSEOFACTIONOR ATTHEVERYLEAST PRESENTING OWNERSWITHARANGEOFOPTIONSFROMWHICHTHEYCANTHENCHOOSE 4HEPROVISIONOFADVICEISTHEACCOUNTANTSKEYFUNCTION BUTTHISADVICERESTSONTHE INFORMATIONGENERATEDBYTHElRSTTHREESTAGESOFTHEACCOUNTINGPROCESS %SSENTIALLY THEACCOUNTINGPROCESSINVOLVESCOLLECTINGDATAFROMSOURCEDOCUMENTS SORTINGIT CLASSIFYINGITANDWRITINGITDOWNCOMMUNICATINGTHElNANCIALINFORMATIONTO the owner; and providing advice about that information. We will refer to this accounting PROCESSTHROUGHOUTTHETEXT SOTHATYOUHAVEACLEARIDEAOFHOWEACHTOPIClTSINTO the overall process.
advice the provision to the owners of a range of options appropriate to their aims/objectives, together with recommendations as to the suitability of those aims/objectives
2%6)%715%34)/.3
1 ,ISTthe four stages in the accounting process. 2 %XPLAINthe role of source documents in the accounting process. 3 3TATETHETYPEOFTRANSACTIONEVIDENCEDBYTHEFOLLOWINGSOURCEDOCUMENTS CUMENTS s receipt s CHEQUEBUTT s invoice s memo. 4 %XPLAINthe difference between the ‘recording’ and ‘reporting’ stages of the accounting process. 5 3TATEthe purpose of the following accounting reports: s Cash Flow Statement s Income Statement s Balance Sheet.
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
8
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
1.4
accounting principles the generally accepted rules that govern the way accounting information is generated
UNITS 3&4
ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES
"YANDLARGE ACCOUNTANTSAPPROACHTHEIRCRAFTFROMACOMMONPERSPECTIVE&ORINSTANCE MOSTWOULDAGREETHATAMOTORVEHICLEOWNEDBYTHElRMSHOULDBEREGARDEDASANASSET However, from time to time certain issues arise where proper accounting procedure is unclear, and a number of alternative approaches are possible. For instance, if a business PURCHASEDABUILDINGINFOR ANDSPENTONRENOVATIONSIN ATWHATVALUESHOULDITBERECORDEDANDREPORTEDTODAY7HATIFTHEBUILDINGWOULD BEWORTHIFSOLDTODAY7HATIFITSPLUMBINGSYSTEMREQUIRESREPLACEMENT )NSHORT HOWMUCHISTHEBUILDINGWORTH 4HESEAREBUTAFEWOFTHEQUESTIONSTHATANACCOUNTANTMUSTANSWER ANDINMANY CASES EACHOFTHESEQUESTIONSCOULDHAVEMORETHANONEANSWER 4O PROVIDE FOR SOME DEGREE OF CERTAINTY THE ACCOUNTING PROFESSION HAS AGREED to a number of accounting principles THAT GOVERN THE WAY ACCOUNTING INFORMATION IS generated. In this course, we will investigate the following accounting principles: s ENTITY s 'OING#ONCERN s 2EPORTING0ERIOD s (ISTORICAL#OST s #ONSERVATISM s #ONSISTENCY s -ONETARY5NIT
Entity Entity the business is assumed to be separate from the owner and other businesses, and its records should be kept on this basis
The Entity principle states that from an accounting perspective, the business is assumed to be separate from the owner and other businesses, and its records should be kept on THISBASIS4HISMAYSEEMASLIGHTLYBIZARREIDEA ESPECIALLYWHENWECONSIDERTHATTHE OWNEROFASOLEPROPRIETORSHIPISFREQUENTLYTHEPERSONBEHINDTHECOUNTER ORTHEONE ACTUALLYPERFORMINGTHESERVICE(OWEVER IFWEARETOASSESSTHEPERFORMANCEOFTHE business itself WEMUSTINCLUDEONLYINFORMATIONRELEVANTTOTHATBUSINESS4HEOWNER MAYHAVEABEACHHOUSEORAFOUR WHEELDRIVE BUTIFTHISITEMISNOTBEINGUSEDBYTHE business, it must not be included as a business asset. Transactions between the business and the owner )NPRACTICALTERMS THE%NTITYPRINCIPLEMEANSTHATTHEBUSINESSMUSTHAVEASEPARATE BANKACCOUNT ANDTHATITSHOULDONLYBEUSEDFORBUSINESSPURPOSES)FTHEOWNERUSES the business’s funds for personal purposes, this must be recorded in the business’s records as drawings. )NTHESAMEWAY IFTHEOWNERCONTRIBUTESPERSONALASSETSTOTHEBUSINESS THENTHIS SHOULD BE RECORDED AS A CAPITAL CONTRIBUTION FROM ONE ENTITY THAT IS THE OWNER TO ANOTHERENTITYTHATIS THEBUSINESS )NTHECASEOFACONTRIBUTIONOFNON CASHASSETS SUCHASAVEHICLE THE%NTITYPRINCIPLE WILLHAVEAFURTHEREFFECTINTERMSOFTHEWAYTHEASSETISVALUED#ONSIDERANASSET SUCH ASAVEHICLE PURCHASEDBYTHEOWNERBUTTHENCONTRIBUTEDTOTHEBUSINESS4HISASSET CANNOTBEVALUEDATTHEORIGINALPRICEPAIDBYTHEowner, as it is the cost to the business, ASASEPARATEENTITY THATISIMPORTANT However, although the business and the owner are assumed to be separate ACCOUNTING ENTITIES THERE WOULD BE NO SOURCE DOCUMENT TO VERIFY THE @SALE BY THE OWNER TO THE BUSINESS AS THEY ARE IN FACT ONE AND THE SAME )N THIS CASE THE ASSET
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 1
9
THE ROLE OF ACCOUNTING
If a business owner contributes a personal asset, such as a vehicle, to the business, this should be recorded as a capital contribution from one Entity (the owner) to another Entity (the business)
would be recorded in the books of the business at an agreed value DETERMINEDATTHE TIMETHEASSETISCONTRIBUTEDTOTHEBUSINESS 4HISAGREEDVALUEWOULDTHENBECOMETHE effective Historical Cost as far as the business is concerned.
Going Concern The Going Concern principle assumes that the life of the business is continuous, and its records are kept on that basis. This principle is important because it allows us to record transactions that have an effect on the future. For instance, where a sale is made on CREDITTERMS THECASHWILLNOTHAVEBEENRECEIVEDFROMTHECUSTOMER"YASSUMINGTHAT THEBUSINESSWILLCONTINUETRADINGINDElNITELY THE'OING#ONCERNPRINCIPLEALLOWSUSTO RECORDDEBTORSAMOUNTSOWEDTOTHEBUSINESSBYCREDITCUSTOMERS ASANASSETBECAUSE ATSOMESTAGEINTHEFUTURETHEBUSINESSISLIKELYTORECEIVECASH4HESAMEAPPLIESTO amounts the business owes to its creditors for its credit purchases, or to amounts the BUSINESSHASPAIDINADVANCEFORBENElTSITISYETTORECEIVE 4HEEFFECTOFTHE'OING#ONCERNPRINCIPLEISALSOSIGNIlCANTINDISTINGUISHINGBETWEEN EXPENSESWHOSEBENElTISCONSUMEDENTIRELY ANDASSETSWHOSEBENElTEXTENDSINTO THEFUTURE /NLYBYASSUMINGTHATTHELIFEOFTHEBUSINESSISONGOINGCANWERECOGNISE THEBENElTTHATwill beDERIVEDSOMETIMEINTHEFUTUREFROMTHEASSETSUNDERTHElRMS CONTROL3EE@4HEELEMENTSOFlNANCIALSTATEMENTSFORADISCUSSIONOFTHEDIFFERENCE BETWEENASSETSANDEXPENSES
agreed value the accepted value of a non-cash asset at the time of its contribution by the owner Going Concern the life of the business is assumed to be continuous, and its records are kept on that basis
Reporting Period The Reporting Period principle states that the life of the business must be divided into PERIODS OF TIME TO ALLOW REPORTS TO BE PREPARED 4HIS PRINCIPLE IS INEXTRICABLY LINKED to the idea that the business is a Going Concern. Because the life of the business is ASSUMEDTOBECONTINUOUS ITISNECESSARYTODIVIDETHATLIFEINTOARBITRARYPERIODSSO THATPROlTCANBEDETERMINED7ECANNOTWAITUNTILTHEENDOFTHElRMSLIFETOCALCULATE PROlTBECAUSEWEAREASSUMINGTHATTHEENDWILLNEVERCOME SOWECALCULATEPROlTFOR THEMONTH ORYEAR!2EPORTING0ERIODCANBEASSHORTASTHEOWNERREQUIRES BUTIN MOSTCASES TOMEETTAXATIONREQUIREMENTS ISNOLONGERTHANAYEAR
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Reporting period the life of the business must be divided into periods of time to allow reports to be prepared; these accounting reports should reflect the Reporting Period in which a transaction occurs
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
accrual accounting calculating profit by comparing revenues earned against expenses incurred in a particular reporting period Historical Cost the recording of a transaction at its original cost or value, as this value is verifiable by reference to the source document
UNITS 3&4
/NEPOSSIBLECONSEQUENCEOFDIVIDINGTHELIFEOFTHEBUSINESSISTHATATTHEENDOFA 2EPORTING0ERIODTHEBUSINESSMAYSTILLBEWAITINGFORSOMECASHFROMDEBTORS ORMAY NOTYETHAVEPAIDFORSOMEEXPENSES4HESEAMOUNTSARESTILLINCLUDEDINTHECALCULATION OF PROlT AS THE REVENUE WAS earned WHEN THE GOODS WERE SOLD AND THE EXPENSE incurredWHENTHEITEMWASCONSUMED INTHECURRENTREPORTINGPERIOD4HISMETHODOF CALCULATINGPROlTASREVENUESearned less expenses incurred in each Reporting Period is known as accrual accounting.
Historical Cost The Historical Cost principle states that a transaction should be recorded at its original COSTORVALUE ASTHISVALUEISVERIlABLEBYREFERENCETOTHESOURCEDOCUMENT4HISPRINCIPLE APPLIESPARTICULARLYTOASSETS WHICHMUSTBERECORDEDATTHEIRORIGINALPURCHASEPRICE !NYOTHERVALUATION SUCHASRESALEVALUEORREPLACEMENTVALUE ISSUBJECTTOACERTAIN amount of guesswork, and therefore Historical Cost is preferred. For instance, if land ISBOUGHTFOR ANDISLATERESTIMATEDTOBEWORTH ITSHOULDREMAIN INTHEACCOUNTINGRECORDSASASTHEOTHERPRICEISONLYANESTIMATE ANDNOT VERIlABLE4HEREARECERTAINSITUATIONSINWHICHITISACCEPTABLETOUSEAVALUATIONOTHER than Historical Cost, but these situations will be covered in later chapters.
Conservatism Conservatism losses should be recorded when probable but gains should only be recorded when certain, so that liabilities and expenses are not understated and assets and revenues are not overstated
The Conservatism principle states that losses should be recorded when probable but GAINS SHOULD BE RECORDED ONLY WHEN CERTAIN SO THAT LIABILITIES AND EXPENSES ARE NOT understated and assets and revenues are not overstated. This principle advocates a worst-case scenario approach to accounting. Where different valuations are possible, or it is impossible to avoid the use of an estimate, accountants should use whichever data gives the most cautious or ‘conservative’ assessment. This does not mean the records SHOULDDELIBERATELYREPRESENTASITUATIONASWORSETHANITACTUALLYIS BUTITDOESMEAN THEY SHOULD NOT REPRESENT THE SITUATION AS BETTER THAN IT MIGHT TURN OUT TO BE &ROM AN ACCOUNTING POINT OF VIEW IT IS BETTER TO BE CAUTIOUS AND CONSERVATIVE THAN OVERLY OPTIMISTICANDTHENGETARUDESHOCKWHENREALITYDOESNOTMATCHEXPECTATIONS
Consistency Consistency accounting methods should be applied in a consistent manner to ensure that reports are comparable between periods
The Consistency principles states that accounting methods should be applied in a consistent manner from one period to the next, so that reports can be compared BETWEENPERIODS7ITHOUTCONSISTENTACCOUNTINGMETHODS ITISDIFlCULTTOTELLWHETHER changes in accounting reports are the result of changes in business performance, or SIMPLY CHANGES IN ACCOUNTING PROCEDURES 4HIS MAKES IT DIFlCULT TO COMPARE REPORTS from one period to the next. The amounts in the reports do not need to be the same, BUTTHEWAYTHEYARECALCULATEDDOES
Monetary Unit Monetary Unit all items must be recorded and reported in a common unit of measurement; that is, Australian dollars
The Monetary Unit principle states that all items must be recorded and reported in a common unit of measurement; that is, Australian dollars. This is one of the more obvious principles. It would make little sense to record the purchase of a motor vehicle as ‘1 Holden Commodore’ without attaching a valuation in dollars. To do so would make it impossible to aggregate total assets or make comparisons between periods ORBUSINESSES3IMILARLY RECORDINGLOANSIN!USTRALIANDOLLARSANDSTOCKIN*APANESEYEN would make the information impossible to use.
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 1
THE ROLE OF ACCOUNTING
The Monetary Unit principle states that all items must be recorded and reported in a common unit of measurement; that is, Australian dollars
2%6)%715%34)/.3
1 $ElNE the following accounting principles: s ENTITY s Going Concern s Reporting Period s Historical Cost s Conservatism s #ONSISTENCY s -ONETARY5NIT 2 %XPLAINONEPRACTICALCONSEQUENCEOFADOPTINGTHEENTITYPRINCIPLE 3 3TATETHELENGTHOFA2EPORTING0ERIOD"EWARETHISISATRICKQUESTION 4 %XPLAINWHYTHEIMPLEMENTATIONOFTHE'OING#ONCERNPRINCIPLEREQUIRESTHE adoption of the Reporting Period principle. 5 3TATEHOWPROlTISCALCULATEDUNDERACCRUALACCOUNTING
1.5
QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICS
In addition to the accounting principles, which guide the recording process, the profession IS GUIDED BY WHAT IS KNOWN AS The International Framework for the Preparation and Presentation of Financial Reports. The Framework, as it has become known, sets out the BROADCONCEPTSTHATUNDERPINTHEPREPARATIONOFlNANCIALREPORTS4HESECONCEPTSARE known as qualitative characteristics4HE&RAMEWORKALSODElNESTHEITEMSTHATWILLBE reported in each report. The Framework also provides the basis for the development of Accounting Standards, WHICH ARE RULES GOVERNING SPECIlC ACCOUNTING PROCEDURES THAT ALL ACCOUNTANTS ARE COMPELLED TO FOLLOW 4HESE STANDARDS UNDERPIN MANY OF THE TECHNIQUES USED IN THIS TEXT BUTSTUDENTSARENOTREQUIREDTOKNOWTHERELEVANT!CCOUNTING3TANDARD If we follow and implement the accounting principles when we are recording, then OUR ACCOUNTING REPORTS SHOULD POSSESS THE QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICS OUTLINED IN THE &RAMEWORK4HEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTICSAREBASICALLYTHEQUALITIESWEWOULDLIKEOUR ACCOUNTING INFORMATION TO POSSESS 4HE FOUR QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICS OF ACCOUNTING reports are: s 2ELEVANCE s 2ELIABILITY s #OMPARABILITY s 5NDERSTANDABILITY © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
qualitative characteristics the qualities of the information in accounting reports
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
STUDY TIP
Accounting principles APPLYMAINLYTORECORDS WHEREASQUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICSAPPLYTO reports. Relevance accounting reports should include all information that is useful for decision-making materiality size or significance
UNITS 3&4
Relevance Relevance states that reports should include all information that is useful for decisionmaking, and exclude information that is not. This information should be up-to-date, ANDAPPROPRIATETOTHEDECISIONATHAND4HEQUALITYOF2ELEVANCEGUIDESUSINWHAT TO INCLUDE IN OUR REPORTS AND WILL BE PRESENT IF WE FOLLOW THE %NTITY AND 2EPORTING Period principles. For example, when preparing a Balance Sheet for a business, it is not relevant to include the personal assets of the owner, as these are not being used BYTHEBUSINESSTOEARNREVENUE ANDTHUSARENOTUSEFULFORMAKINGDECISIONSABOUT FUTUREBUSINESSACTIVITIES3IMILARLY THE)NCOME3TATEMENTSHOULDINCLUDEONLYREVENUES ANDEXPENSESFROMTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIODnLASTYEARSWAGES ORNEXTYEARSSALES lGURESWILLNOTHELPUSTOASSESSTHISYEARSPROlT4HEKEYISWHETHERTHEINFORMATIONIS useful for decision-making. !LTHOUGH2ELEVANCEISDETERMINEDLARGELYBYWHETHERTHEnature of the item makes it useful for decision-making, the size or materiality of the item can also be important. )TEMSTHATARETOOSMALLORINSIGNIlCANTTOAFFECTDECISION MAKINGMAYBECONSIDEREDTO BEIMMATERIAL MEANINGTHEYCANBEREPORTEDINTHEVALUEOFALARGERITEM ORINSOME cases omitted from the reports. For instance, Relevance allows us to omit from the "ALANCE3HEETSPENTONSTATIONERYASITISSUCHASMALLAMOUNT ANDINSTEADREPORT THISASANEXPENSE)TSINCLUSIONOREXCLUSION FORTHATMATTER INTHE"ALANCE3HEETWILL NOTAFFECTDECISION MAKINGINANYMATERIALWAY
Reliability Reliability accounting reports should contain information that is accurate, and free from bias or error
Reliability states that reports should contain information that is free from bias and ERROR ANDTHUSCANBERELIEDUPONFORITSACCURACY4HEQUALITYOFReliability means that in relation to the amounts we show in reports, we should avoid the use of estimates. 2ELIABILITY WILL BE ASSISTED VIA THE (ISTORICAL #OST PRINCIPLE BECAUSE THE BEST WAY TO ENSURE THAT INFORMATION IS FREE FROM BIAS AND ERROR IS TO MAKE SURE IT IS VERIlABLE BY REFERENCETOASOURCEDOCUMENT2ELIABLEINFORMATIONHASPROOFTOSUPPORTITSACCURACY For example, it should be possible to check the level of credit sales reported in the Income Statement against the invoices that documented the sales. This ensures there is NOROOMFORSUBJECTIVITYORGUESSES
Comparability Comparability accounting reports should be able to be compared over time
Understandability accounting reports should be presented in a manner that makes it easy for them to be understood by the user
Comparability states that reports should be comparable over time, and between different companies, through the use of consistent accounting procedures. One of the most basic uses of accounting reports is to compare performances of businesses and BETWEENPERIODS(OWEVER THISWILLONLYBEPOSSIBLEIFCONSISTENTACCOUNTINGMETHODS have been used. Where accounting procedures are changed, this should be stated CLEARLYDISCLOSED INTHEREPORTS SOTHATTHEUSERSCANMAKEMOREINFORMEDASSESSMENTS of what the reports are telling them.
Understandability Understandability states that reports should be presented in a manner that is simple to understand. It is important to remember that the most basic function of accounting reports is to COMMUNICATEINFORMATIONTOTHEUSERTHATIS SOLETRADERSANDOROWNERS-OSTSMALL business owners are not accountants, so it is not sensible to present reports in a form that owners cannot understand. The characteristic of 5NDERSTANDABILITYMEANSITISEASY FORTHEUSERTOCOMPREHENDTHEMEANINGOFREPORTS&ORTHISREASON ITMAYBEMORE EFFECTIVETOPRESENTINFORMATIONINGRAPHS TABLESORCHARTS ORSIMPLYINLANGUAGETHATIS FREEFROMACCOUNTINGJARGON
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 1
THE ROLE OF ACCOUNTING
)NSUMMARY THEACCOUNTINGPROCESSISGUIDEDBY s ACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLES WHICHGOVERNTHEWAYACCOUNTINGINFORMATIONISRECORDED s QUALITATIVECHARACTERISTICS WHICHINFORMTHEWAYACCOUNTINGREPORTSAREPREPARED 2%6)%715%34)/.3
1 $ElNETHEFOLLOWINGQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTICS s 2ELEVANCE s 2ELIABILITY s #OMPARABILITY s 5NDERSTANDABILITY 2 %XPLAINHOWTHE%NTITYAND2EPORTING0ERIODPRINCIPLESENSURE2ELEVANCEIN the accounting reports. 3 2EFERRING TO ONE QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTIC EXPLAIN WHY ACCOUNTANTS MUST follow the Historical Cost principle. 4 %XPLAIN HOW THE RECORDING SYSTEM CAN ENSURE Comparability of accounting reports. 5 3UGGESTTWOWAYSOFIMPROVINGTHE5NDERSTANDABILITY of accounting reports.
1.6
THE ELEMENTS OF FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
7EHAVEDISCUSSEDATLENGTHTHEQUALITIESTHATACCOUNTINGREPORTSSHOULDPOSSESS BUT WHATITEMSSHOULDTHEYINCLUDE4HE&RAMEWORKDElNESTHEELEMENTSOFTHEACCOUNTING reports as: s ASSETS s LIABILITIES s OWNERSEQUITY s REVENUES s EXPENSES
Assets AssetsARERESOURCESCONTROLLEDBYANENTITY ASARESULTOFPASTEVENTS FROMWHICHFUTURE ECONOMICBENElTSAREEXPECTEDTOmOWTOTHEENTITY&ORANITEMTOBERECOGNISEDAS ANASSET ITMUSTMEETEACHPARTOFTHEDElNITION!NITEMTHATFAILSTOMEETANYOFTHESE REQUIREMENTSCANNOTBECONSIDEREDTOBEANASSET ,ETSBREAKTHISDElNITIONDOWNINTOITSMAINCOMPONENTS Resources controlled by the entity
asset a resource controlled by an entity, as a result of past events, from which future economic benefits are expected to flow to the entity
2ESOURCES ARE SIMPLY ITEMS THAT ARE CAPABLE OF GENERATING AN ECONOMIC GAIN FOR A BUSINESS SUCHASBANKTHECASHHELDTHERE NOTTHEBUILDING DEBTORS STOCK VEHICLES and premises. (OWEVER ONLYTHOSEITEMSTHATAREUNDERTHElRMScontrolCANBEDElNEDASASSETS 4HISMEANSTHATTHElRMMUSTBEINAPOSITIONTODETERMINEHOWANDWHENTHEITEMIS used. For instance, it is up to the business to determine how and when the cash in the BANKACCOUNTWILLBESPENT WHENTHEDEBTORSAREEXPECTEDTOPAYANDHOWTHEVEHICLES will be used. "YCONTRAST THEOWNERSHOMECANNOTBECLASSIlEDASAbusiness asset because it is not under business control$ONTFORGETTHE%NTITYPRINCIPLEHERETHEOWNERSHOMEIS UNDERTHECONTROLOFTHEOWNER WHOISCONSIDEREDTOBEASEPARATEACCOUNTINGENTITY from the business.
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
.OTETHATALTHOUGHABUSINESSWILLOWNMANYOFITSASSETS OWNERSHIPITSELFISNOTA NECESSARY CONDITION FOR AN ITEM TO BE CLASSIlED AS A BUSINESS ASSET Control is much broader than ownership SOTHElRMSASSETSWILLOBVIOUSLYINCLUDE BUTNOTBERESTRICTED to, what it owns. Future economic benefits In addition to falling under business control, assets must be capable of generating a futureECONOMICBENElT4HATIS THEYMUSTREPRESENTSOMESORTOFBENElTTHATISYETTO BERECEIVED4HISREmECTSTHE'OING#ONCERNPRINCIPLE&OREXAMPLE CASHINTHEBANK can be spent and stock can be sold at some point in the future; the amount owed to THEBUSINESSBYITSDEBTORSWILLBERECEIVEDASCASHSOMETIMEINTHENEXTMONTHORSO ANDITEMSSUCHASPREMISESANDVEHICLESWILLUSUALLYBEUSEDFORBUSINESSACTIVITIESFORA NUMBEROFYEARSINTOTHEFUTURE On the other hand, cash paid for this month’s wages is not an asset, as there is no FUTUREBENElT)NORDERTOGAINAFURTHERBENElTFROMEMPLOYEES AFURTHERPAYMENTMUST BEMADE)TEMSSUCHASTHISCANNOTBECLASSIlEDASASSETSBECAUSETHEIRBENElTDOES NOTEXTENDBEYONDWHATHASALREADYBEENRECEIVED
Liabilities liability a present obligation of the entity as a result of past events, the settlement of which is expected to result in an outflow from the entity of resources embodying economic benefits
LiabilitiesAREPRESENTOBLIGATIONSOFTHEENTITYASARESULTOFPASTEVENTS THESETTLEMENT OF WHICH IS EXPECTED TO RESULT IN AN OUTmOW FROM THE ENTITY OF RESOURCES EMBODYING ECONOMICBENElTS4HISMAYSEEMLIKEALOTOFJARGON BUTBROKENINTOITSCOMPONENTS it is easier to understand. Present obligations )FTHEBUSINESSHASALEGALRESPONSIBILITYORobligation TOSETTLEADEBT THENTHISDEBTIS LIKELYTOBEALIABILITY)NTHECASEOFABANKOVERDRAFTORMORTGAGE THECONTRACTWITHTHE LENDERMEANSTHEBUSINESSISOBLIGEDTOREPAYTHEAMOUNTOWING #ONTRASTTHESEITEMSWITHTHEAMOUNTTHATTHEBUSINESSEXPECTSTOPAYNEXTYEARFOR ADVERTISING4HISCANNOTBEREPORTEDASALIABILITY ASATPRESENTTHEREISNOOBLIGATION TO PAY 4HE OBLIGATION WILL ONLY OCCUR ONCE THE lRM HAS SIGNED THE CONTRACT OR THE advertising itself has been provided. Expected to result in an outflow of economic benefits 4HEFACTTHATALIABILITYISexpectedTORESULTINANOUTmOWORSACRIlCEOFECONOMICBENElTS MEANSTHATTHEOUTmOWSACRIlCEHASNOTYETOCCURRED)NTHISWAY ALIABILITYCOULDBE SEENASREQUIRINGAfuture economic sacrifice. )NMOSTCASES THEECONOMICBENElTTOBESACRIlCEDWILLBECASH ANDTHEEXPECTED OUTmOWWILLOCCURWHENTHEBUSINESSPAYSITSDEBTS(OWEVER THISISNOTALWAYSTHECASE THERE MAY BE AN ALTERNATIVE ECONOMIC BENElT THAT MUST BE SACRIlCED &OR EXAMPLE A lRM MAY HAVE RECEIVED CASH IN ADVANCE FOR A JOB YET TO BE COMPLETED IT IS NOT A PAYMENTTHATISREQUIREDTOEXTINGUISHTHISLIABILITY BUTTHECOMPLETIONOFTHEWORK
Owner’s equity owner’s equity the residual interest in the assets of the entity after the deduction of its liabilities
Owner’s equityISTHERESIDUALINTERESTINTHEASSETSOFTHEENTITYAFTERTHEDEDUCTIONOF ITSLIABILITIES)NEFFECT OWNERSEQUITYISWHATISLEFTOVERFORTHEOWNERONCEAlRMHAS METALLITSLIABILITIES'IVENTHATTHEOWNERANDTHElRMARECONSIDEREDTOBESEPARATE entities, it can also be described as the amount the business ‘owes the owner’.
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 1
THE ROLE OF ACCOUNTING
Revenue Revenues ARE INmOWS OF ECONOMIC BENElTS OR SAVINGS IN OUTmOWS IN THE FORM OF INCREASES IN ASSETS OR DECREASES IN LIABILITIES THAT INCREASE OWNERS EQUITY EXCEPT FOR CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS BY THE OWNER #APITAL CONTRIBUTIONS ARE EXCLUDED BECAUSE THEY occur not due to the activities of the business, but rather the actions of the owner. Revenue then represents the increasesINOWNERSEQUITYTHATOCCURTHROUGHBUSINESS activities, and in most cases will represent what the business has gained from the goods it has sold or the work it has done. But there are other forms of revenue, and although REVENUE MAY TAKE THE FORM OF CASH THIS IS NOT A REQUIREMENT CREDIT SALES WOULD BE REVENUEINTHEFORMOFANINCREASEINANASSETOTHERTHANCASHNAMELY DEBTORS WHEREAS DISCOUNTREVENUEWOULDTAKETHEFORMOFADECREASEINALIABILITYCREDITORS 4HEKEYIS THATAREVENUEMUSTINCREASEOWNERSEQUITY BUTNOTASACONSEQUENCEOFTHEOWNER making a contribution.
revenue an inflow of economic benefits (or saving in outflows) in the form of an increase in assets (or decrease in liabilities) that increases owner’s equity, except for capital contributions by the owner
Expenses ExpensesAREOUTmOWSORCONSUMPTIONSOFECONOMICBENElTSINTHEFORMOFDECREASES INASSETSORINCREASESINLIABILITIES THATREDUCEOWNERSEQUITY EXCEPTFORDRAWINGSBY THEOWNER$RAWINGSISEXCLUDEDBECAUSEITDOESNTCONTRIBUTETOTHElRMSABILITYTO CARRYOUTITSTRADINGACTIVITIES ANDSODOESNOTAFFECTITSABILITYTOEARNREVENUEORPROlT Expenses then represent the decreasesINOWNERSEQUITYTHATOCCURTHROUGHBUSINESS ACTIVITIESOR PUTSIMPLY WHATABUSINESSHASCONSUMEDORUSEDUP TOEARNITSREVENUE %VENTHOUGHMANYEXPENSESAREPAIDINCASH THISISNOTAREQUIREMENTSTOCKLOSSDUE TOTHEFTWOULDBEANEXPENSEINTHEFORMOFADECREASEINASSETSSTOCK WHEREASWAGES COULDTAKETHEFORMOFANINCREASEINLIABILITIESIFITWEREYETTOBEPAID4HEKEYHEREIS THATANEXPENSEMUSTDECREASEOWNERSEQUITY BUTNOTASACONSEQUENCEOFTHEOWNER making a withdrawal from the business. 2 % 6 ) % 7 1 5 % 3 4 ) / . 3
1 $ElNE the following items: s asset s LIABILITY s OWNERSEQUITY s revenue s expense. 2 3TATEONEREASONWHYWAGESISNOT considered to be an asset. 3 3TATEONEREASONWHYTHEADVERTISINGFORNEXTYEARISNOT considered to be a LIABILITY 4 %XPLAINWHYACAPITALCONTRIBUTIONISNOT considered to be revenue. 5 %XPLAINWHYDRAWINGSISNOT considered to be an expense.
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
expense an outflow or consumption of economic benefits (or reduction in inflows) in the form of a decrease in assets (or increase in liabilities) that reduces owner’s equity, except for drawings by the owner
STUDY TIP
#OMPARETHEDElNITIONS of revenues and expenses. Opposites APPLYHERE
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s s
s
s
s s
EXERCISES
4HE PURPOSE OF ACCOUNTING IS TO PROVIDE lNANCIAL INFORMATION TO ASSIST DECISION making. 4HEACCOUNTINGPROCESSINVOLVESCOLLECTINGSOURCEDOCUMENTS RECORDINGlNANCIAL DATAANDTHENREPORTINGlNANCIALINFORMATION ANDSUBSEQUENTLYADVISINGTHEOWNER on an appropriate course of action. !CCOUNTINGPRINCIPLES THEGENERALLYACCEPTEDRULESGOVERNINGTHEWAYACCOUNTING information is generated, are: n ENTITY – Going Concern – Reporting Period – Historical Cost – Conservatism n #ONSISTENCY n -ONETARY5NIT 1UALITATIVECHARACTERISTICS THEQUALITIESWEWOULDLIKEOURlNANCIALREPORTSTOPOSSESS are: – Relevance – Reliability – Comparability n 5NDERSTANDABILITY 4HE THREE GENERAL PURPOSE lNANCIAL REPORTS ARE THE #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT THE Income Statement and the Balance Sheet. 4HEELEMENTSOFTHElNANCIALREPORTSAREASSETS LIABILITIES OWNERSEQUITY REVENUE and expenses.
EXERCISE 1.1 ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES
W B
page 4
In each of the following situations, STATEand EXPLAINthe accounting principle that has been breached. a 2HONDARECORDEDTHEPAYMENTOFHERDAUGHTERSORTHODONTISTSFEESASABUSINESS expense. b The proprietor of Richmond Spare Parts decided to combine the recording of repair EXPENSESWITHVEHICLEEXPENSESAFTERRECORDINGTHEMSEPARATELYFORSEVERALYEARS a $UETOUNCERTAINTIESWITHTHEEXCHANGERATE $IG&REELYDECIDEDTORECORDFOREIGN EARNINGSINYUANTHE#HINESECURRENCY a $URING*ANUARY *EAN3IMONSRECEIVEDCASHFORGOODSSOLDIN$ECEMBER *EANDECIDEDTORECORDTHECASHASREVENUEFOR e -ILLS3ONHAVEJUSTREVALUEDTHEIRNON CURRENTASSETSUPWARDSBYTOREmECTTHE RATEOFINmATION f Paul Rullett is the proprietor of PR Traders. He has decided to list all the liabilities of THElRMASCURRENTTOGIVEHIMABETTERPICTUREOFWHATHEOWES DESPITEAMORTGAGE THATISDUEINYEARS g +AREN2OBERTSONLYPREPARESlNANCIALREPORTSEVERYTWOYEARS
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 1
EXERCISE 1.2 ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES AND QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICS
THE ROLE OF ACCOUNTING
W B
page 6
$URING$ECEMBER "ON7ILHELMPAIDFORAFAMILYHOLIDAYUSINGABUSINESSCHEQUE 4HISTRANSACTIONWASTREATEDASABUSINESSEXPENSE WITH"ONARGUING @)TSMYBUSINESS ITSMYMONEY Required a
Referring to one accounting principle, EXPLAIN WHY THIS TRANSACTION SHOULD HAVE been recorded as drawings. b %XPLAINHOW7ILHELMSDECISIONWILLUNDERMINETHE2ELEVANCEOFTHElNANCIALREPORTS
EXERCISE 1.3 ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES AND QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICS
W B
page 7
)N/CTOBER -ARK,ARKIN THEOWNEROF,ARKIN,IGHTING DECIDEDTHATTHElRMSSTOCK should be valued at its selling price rather than its cost price because, according to -ARK @4HATSWHATITISACTUALLYWORTH Required a
Referring to one accounting principle, EXPLAINWHYTHESTOCKMUSTBEVALUEDATITS cost price. b %XPLAINHOWVALUINGSTOCKATITSSELLINGPRICEWILLUNDERMINETHE2ELIABILITYOFTHE reports.
EXERCISE 1.4 ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES AND QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICS
W B
page 8
Erica Carr’s business has been sued for false advertising, and her solicitor has indicated THATSHEISLIKELYTOLOSETHEFORTHCOMINGCOURTCASEANDBELIABLETOPAYDAMAGES%RICA has decided to not disclose the damages in the Income Statement. Required a
Referring to one accounting principle, EXPLAIN WHY %RICA SHOULD DISCLOSE THE damages in the Income Statement. b 3TATETHEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTICTHATSUPPORTSYOURANSWERTOPART@A*USTIFYYOUR answer.
EXERCISE 1.5 ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES AND QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICS
W B
page 9
)NANATTEMPTTOSATISFYTHE#ONSISTENCYPRINCIPLE #OOLICK2EFRIGERATORSALWAYSREPORTS THESAMElGUREFORDEPRECIATIONOFEQUIPMENT Required a $ElNE@CONSISTENCYASANACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE b 2EFERRING TO ONE QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTIC EXPLAIN WHY THE ACCOUNTING RECORDS SHOULDBEMAINTAINEDBYFOLLOWINGTHE#ONSISTENCYPRINCIPLE © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 1.6 ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES, QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICS AND ELEMENTS OF THE REPORTS
W B
page 10
)N/CTOBER 2AD-AGAZINESSUCCESSFULLYCOMPLETEDAMARKETINGCAMPAIGNWHERE READERS PAY IN ADVANCE FOR MAGAZINES TO BE DELIVERED IN 4HE OWNER WANTS TO RECORDALLTHECASHRECEIVEDASREVENUEFOR Required a
Referring to one accounting principle, EXPLAINWHYTHECASHRECEIVEDSHOULDNOT be RECORDEDASREVENUEFOR b 3TATETHEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTICTHATWILLBEUNDERMINEDIFTHECASHRECEIVEDIS REPORTEDASREVENUEFOR*USTIFYYOURANSWER c 2EFERRING TO THE DElNITIONS OF THE ELEMENTS OF THE REPORTS EXPLAIN WHY THE CASH received is NOTYETREVENUE
EXERCISE 1.7 ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES AND QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICS
W B
page 11
4HE ACCOUNTING DEPARTMENT OF 0LASTIC #UPS %MPORIUM RECENTLY ISSUED A REPORT TO A MEETING OF THE WORKERS OF THE lRM COMPLETE WITH VARIOUS lNANCIAL STATEMENTS AND lNANCIALRATIOS.ONEOFTHEWORKERSATTHEMEETINGHADANYKNOWLEDGEOFACCOUNTING Required a 2EFERRINGTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC EXPLAINWHYTHEACCOUNTINGREPORTSWILL NOTFULlLTHEIRINTENDEDFUNCTION b 3TATE ONE TECHNIQUE THE ACCOUNTING DEPARTMENT COULD EMPLOY TO IMPROVE THE APPROPRIATENESSOFITSlNANCIALREPORTS
EXERCISE 1.8 ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES AND QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICS
W B
page 12
4HEOWNEROF&ROSTY&RIDGESBELIEVESITSMARKETVALUEISSHOWNINTHE"ALANCE3HEETAS the difference between total assets and total liabilities. Required a
Referring to one accounting principle, EXPLAIN WHY THE MARKET VALUE OF &ROSTY Fridges will NOT be shown as the difference between total assets and total liabilities.
EXERCISE 1.9 ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES, QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICS AND ELEMENTS OF THE REPORTS
W B
page 13
/N!PRIL -AXCONTRIBUTEDSECOND HANDSHELVINGTOHISBUSINESSWITHANAGREED VALUEOF-AXORIGINALLYPAIDFORTHESHELVING/N*UNE THE RESALEVALUEOFTHESHELVINGWAS
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 1
THE ROLE OF ACCOUNTING
Required a 2EFERRINGTOTHEDElNITIONSOFTHEELEMENTSOFTHEREPORTS EXPLAIN how the shelving SHOULDBECLASSIlEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF-AXSBUSINESS b Referring to one accounting principle, EXPLAIN how the shelving should have been VALUEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF-AXS-ARTASAT!PRIL c 2EFERRINGTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC EXPLAINWHYTHESHELVINGSHOULDNOT be VALUEDATITSRESALEVALUEINTHE"ALANCE3HEETASAT*UNE
EXERCISE 1.10 ELEMENTS OF THE REPORTS
W B
page 14
For each of the following items, STATE whether it should be reported in the Income 3TATEMENTORTHE"ALANCE3HEET USINGTHEDElNITIONSOFTHEELEMENTSOFTHEREPORTSTO EXPLAINHOWITSHOULDBECLASSIlED a debtors b loan – principal c interest on loan d stock loss e cash sales f wages incurred g wages owing h discount revenue.
EXERCISE 1.11 ELEMENTS OF THE REPORTS
W B
page 15
(ARD 5TES SPECIALISES IN THE SALE OF UTILITY VEHICLES /N !UGUST THE lRM PURCHASEDANEWVEHICLEWORTHONCREDITFROM(OLDEN Required a %XPLAIN the difference between an asset and an expense. b %XPLAIN one circumstance in which the cost of the vehicle would be reported as a current asset. c %XPLAIN one circumstance in which the cost of the vehicle would be reported as a non-current asset. d %XPLAIN one circumstance in which the cost of the vehicle would be reported as an expense.
EXERCISE 1.12 GOODWILL
W B
page 16
/VERTHELASTCOUPLEOFYEARS %LAINEHASBUILTUPALOYALCLIENTELEFORHERFASHIONBOUTIQUE &INE&ASHIONS4HESECUSTOMERSBUYFROM%LAINEONAREGULARBASISBECAUSETHEYTRUST HERJUDGEMENTANDEXPERTISE Required a
$ISCUSSwhether Elaine should recognise this ‘goodwill’ as an asset.
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s defineANDidentifyASSETS LIABILITIESANDOWNERSEQUITY s explainTHERELATIONSHIP BETWEENTHEELEMENTSOFTHE ACCOUNTINGEQUATION s calculateOWNERSEQUITY USINGTHEACCOUNTING EQUATION s explainTHERELATIONSHIP BETWEENTHEACCOUNTING EQUATIONANDTHE"ALANCE 3HEET
s defineANDidentifyCURRENT ANDNON CURRENTITEMS s prepareAFULLYCLASSIFIED "ALANCE3HEET s applyTHERULESOFDOUBLE ENTRYACCOUNTING s analyseHOWTRANSACTIONS AFFECTTHEACCOUNTING EQUATIONANDTHE"ALANCE 3HEET
CHAPTER 2
THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s EQUITIES s "ALANCE3HEET s CLASSIFICATION s CURRENTASSET s NON CURRENTASSET s CURRENTLIABILITY s NON CURRENTLIABILITY s DOUBLE ENTRYACCOUNTING
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
22
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
2.1
UNITS 3&4
ASSETS, LIABILITIES AND OWNER’S EQUITY
4HEMOSTOBVIOUSPLACETOSTARTANASSESSMENTOFANYBUSINESSISWITHITSCURRENTSITUATION OR IFYOULIKE ITSCURRENTlNANCIALPOSITION!TITSMOSTBASIC THISASSESSMENTWILLCONSIDER THEECONOMICRESOURCESITCONTROLSnITSASSETSnANDTHEOBLIGATIONSITHASnITSLIABILITIES "YPREPARINGA"ALANCE3HEET WHICHDETAILSTHESEASSETSANDLIABILITIES ANOWNERCAN ASSESSTHEOWNERSEQUITYnTHENETWORTHOFTHEOWNERSINVESTMENTINTHEBUSINESS ,ETSSTARTBYREFRESHINGOURUNDERSTANDINGOFASSETS LIABILITIESANDOWNERSEQUITY
Assets !SWASEXPLAINEDIN#HAPTER ASSETSAREDElNEDASRESOURCESCONTROLLEDBYANENTITY ASARESULTOFPASTEVENTS FROMWHICHFUTUREECONOMICBENElTSWILLmOWTOTHEENTITY !COMMONLISTOFASSETSFORATRADINGBUSINESSMIGHTINCLUDETHEFOLLOWINGITEMS s banknCASHKEPTINTHEBUSINESSSBANKACCOUNT s debtorsnTHEAMOUNTOWEDTOTHEBUSINESSBYCUSTOMERSWHOWERESOLDGOODS ONCREDIT s stocknGOODSPURCHASEDANDHELDFORRESALETOCUSTOMERS s fixtures and fittingsnITEMSUSEDINTHEBUSINESSPREMISES SUCHASSHELVINGOR WINDOWCOVERINGS s vehiclesnCARS TRUCKSANDVANSUSEDFORBUSINESSPURPOSES s premisesnTHEBUILDINGS FROMWHICHTHEBUSINESSACTIVITYISCONDUCTED
Liabilities ,IABILITIESAREPRESENTOBLIGATIONSOFTHEENTITYASARESULTOFPASTEVENTS THESETTLEMENT OFWHICHISEXPECTEDTORESULTINANOUTmOWOFRESOURCESEMBODYINGECONOMICBENElTS !COMMONLISTOFLIABILITIESMIGHTINCLUDE s bank overdraftnANAMOUNTOWEDTOTHEBANKWHENABUSINESSSPENDSMORE THANISCURRENTLYINITSBANKACCOUNT s creditorsnTHEAMOUNTOWEDBYTHEBUSINESSFORGOODSITHASBOUGHTONCREDIT s loan nANAMOUNTTHATISBORROWEDFROMABANKOROTHERlNANCIALINSTITUTIONAND MUSTBEREPAIDATSOMETIMEINTHEFUTURE s MORTGAGEnASPECIlCTYPEOFLOANTHATISSECUREDAGAINSTPROPERTY 9OU MIGHT BEGIN BY THINKING OF ASSETS AS @WHAT THE lRM OWNS AND LIABILITIES AS @WHAT THE lRM OWES BUT SUCH SIMPLISTIC DElNITIONS WILL NOT SUFlCE IN MORE COMPLEX ACCOUNTINGSITUATIONS INCLUDINGTHEEXAM4HEMORESOPHISTICATEDDElNITIONSASLISTED ABOVEANDDESCRIBEDINDETAILIN#HAPTER MUSTBEAPPLIEDTODETERMINEACCURATELY ANDCONCLUSIVELYWHETHERANITEMISANASSETORALIABILITY
Owner’s equity /WNERSEQUITYISTHERESIDUALINTERESTINTHEASSETSOFTHEENTITYAFTERTHEDEDUCTIONOFITS LIABILITIES,IABILITIESAREOBLIGATIONSTOEXTERNALENTITIESTHATIS PARTIESOUTSIDETHElRM SUCHASBANKS CREDITORSANDOTHERLENDERS4HISMEANSTHATLIABILITIESAREDEBTSOWEDTO ENTITIESOTHERTHANTHEOWNER4HEAMOUNTOWEDTOTHEOWNERnTHEOWNERSCLAIMONTHE ASSETSOFTHElRMnMUSTBEREPORTEDSEPARATELYASOWNERSEQUITY (OWCANABUSINESSOWEITSOWNER$ONTFORGETTHE%NTITYPRINCIPLEASACCOUNTANTS WE ASSUME THAT THE BUSINESS AND THE OWNER ARE SEPARATE ENTITIES SEPARATE BEINGS 4HEASSETSOFTHEfirmARENOTASSETSOFTHEowner ANDNORARETHELIABILITIESTHEYARE ASSUMEDTOBELONGTOTHEBUSINESSALONE"ECAUSETHEVALUEOFTHElRMSASSETSMUST EXCEEDITSLIABILITIES THEREWILLBEANAMOUNT@LEFTOVER)TISTHISLEFTOVERORRESIDUAL
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 2
23
T H E A C C O U N T I N G E Q U AT I O N
AMOUNTTHATTHElRMOWESNOTTOANYEXTERNALPARTY BUTTOTHEOWNER SOOWNERSEQUITY ISTHERESIDUALINTERESTINTHEASSETSOFTHEENTITYAFTERTHEDEDUCTIONOFITSLIABILITIES
The accounting equation 7HAT LIABILITIES AND OWNERS EQUITY HAVE IN COMMON IS THAT THEY ARE BOTH equities ORCLAIMSONTHEASSETSOFTHEBUSINESS4HATIS LIABILITIESAREWHATTHEBUSINESSOWES TOexternal parties WHILEOWNERSEQUITYISWHATTHEBUSINESSOWESTOTHEowner"OTH TYPESOFCLAIMMUSTBEFUNDEDFROMTHEBUSINESSSASSETS 4HISRELATIONSHIPnBETWEENASSETS LIABILITIESANDOWNERSEQUITYnISDESCRIBEDBYTHE accounting equation
equities claims on the assets of the business, consisting of both liabilities and owner’s equity
accounting equation the rule that states that assets must always equal liabilities plus owner’s equity
The relationship between assets, liabilities and owner’s equity is described by the accounting equation
Accounting equation Assets
=
Liabilities
+
Owner’s equity
4HEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONISASIMPORTANTTOACCOUNTINGAS%INSTEINSTHEORIESARETO PHYSICSANDITISSUBJECTTOONEIMMUTABLELAWITMUSTALWAYSBALANCE4HATIS ASSETS MUSTALWAYSEQUALLIABILITIESPLUSOWNERSEQUITY)TISNOTPOSSIBLEFORTHEEQUATIONTOBE OUTOFBALANCE &ORINSTANCE IFAlRMHASASSETSOFANDLIABILITIESWORTH ITSOWNERS EQUITY MUST BE THE RESIDUAL THAT IS WHAT IS LEFT OVER )T IS NOT POSSIBLE FOR OWNERSEQUITYTOEQUALANAMOUNTgreaterTHANTHIS BECAUSETHEREWOULDBEINSUFlCIENT ASSETSTOFUNDTHECLAIM /NTHEOTHERHAND ITISNOTPOSSIBLEFOROWNERSEQUITYTOEQUALANAMOUNTlessTHAN THIS)FLIABILITIESCLAIMED ANDTHEOWNERCLAIMEDONLY THATWOULDLEAVE ANAMOUNTOFTHATHASNOTBEENCLAIMEDBYLIABILITIES NORBYTHEOWNERAND NO ONEISSUGGESTINGITSHOULDJUSTBEGIVENAWAY )TISNOTPOSSIBLEFORANAMOUNTTO REMAINUNCLAIMED PROVINGTHATTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONMUSTALWAYSBALANCE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
24
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 2.1
1 DefineTHETERM@ASSET 2 ListTHREEASSETSTHATWOULDBEFOUNDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOFATYPICALTRADING lRM 3 DefineTHETERM@LIABILITY 4 List THREE LIABILITIES THAT WOULD BE FOUND IN THE "ALANCE 3HEET OF A TYPICAL TRADINGlRM 5 DefineTHETERM@OWNERSEQUITY 6 2EFERRING TO ONE ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLE explain HOW A BUSINESS CAN @OWE ITS OWNER 7 StateTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION
2.2 Balance Sheet an accounting report that details the business’s assets, liabilities and owner’s equity at a particular point in time
THE BALANCE SHEET
4HE RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN ASSETS LIABILITIES AND OWNERS EQUITY n AS DESCRIBED BY THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION n IS AT THE HEART OF THE Balance Sheet 4HE "ALANCE 3HEET IS AN ACCOUNTINGREPORTTHATDETAILSTHElRMSASSETS LIABILITIESANDOWNERSEQUITYATAPARTICULAR POINTINTIME ANDISAREmECTIONOFTHElRMSACCOUNTINGEQUATION4HISRELATIONSHIPIS SHOWNIN&IGURE
Figure 2.1 The accounting equation and the Balance Sheet Assets
=
Assets
Liabilities + Owner’s equity Liabilities plus Owner’s equity TOTAL EQUITIES
TOTAL ASSETS
!"ALANCE3HEETFORATRADINGlRMMAYLOOKLIKETHEONESHOWNIN&IGURE
Figure 2.2 Balance Sheet MORGAN’S MERCHANDISE Balance Sheet as at 30 June 2015 Assets
$
$
Liabilities
$
Creditors
$
Bank
5 000
Stock
34 000
Loan – MHB Bank
Debtors
12 000
Owner’s Equity
Vehicles
45 000
Capital – Morgan
54 000
Total Assets
96 000
Total Equities
96 000
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
6 000 36 000
42 000
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 2
25
T H E A C C O U N T I N G E Q U AT I O N
4HEASSETSARELISTEDONTHELEFT HANDSIDE WITHTHEEQUITIESLIABILITIESANDOWNERS EQUITY LISTEDONTHERIGHT JUSTLIKETHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION .OTE HOW THE TITLE OF THE REPORT STATES who IT HAS BEEN PREPARED FOR -ORGANS -ERCHANDISE whatKINDOFREPORTITISA"ALANCE3HEET ANDwhenITWASPREPARED *UNE "ECAUSE BUSINESSES ENGAGE IN A NUMBER OF TRANSACTIONS EVERY DAY AND EVERYTRANSACTIONCHANGESTHE"ALANCE3HEET THE"ALANCE3HEETISONLYEVERACCURATE ONTHEDAYITISPREPARED4HUS THETITLESAYS@ASATAPARTICULARDATE .OTE ALSO HOW THE TERM @/WNERS %QUITY IS USED AS A HEADING 4HE ACTUAL ITEM REPRESENTINGTHEOWNERSCLAIMISKNOWNAS@#APITAL WITHTHENAMEOFTHEOWNERLISTED NEXTTOIT!NYPROlTSEARNEDBYTHEBUSINESSnANDTHUS@OWEDTOTHEOWNERnWOULD ALSOBELISTEDUNDERTHEHEADINGOF@OWNERSEQUITY REVIEW QUESTIONS 2.2
1 ExplainWHATISSHOWNINA"ALANCE3HEET 2 Explain THERELATIONSHIPBETWEENTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONANDTHE "ALANCE3HEET 3 State THETHREEPIECESOFINFORMATIONTHATMUSTBEPRESENTINTHETITLEOF EVERYACCOUNTINGREPORT 4 Explain WHYTHE"ALANCE3HEETISTITLED@ASATAPARTICULARDATE
2.3
CLASSIFICATION IN THE BALANCE SHEET
'IVENTHATACCOUNTINGEXISTSTOPROVIDElNANCIALINFORMATIONTOASSISTDECISION MAKING ACCOUNTANTSAREALWAYSSEEKINGWAYSTOIMPROVETHEUSEFULNESSOFTHEINFORMATIONTHEY PROVIDE/NESIMPLEBUTVERYEFFECTIVEWAYOFIMPROVINGTHEUSEFULNESSOFTHE"ALANCE 3HEETISBYCLASSIFYINGTHEINFORMATIONITCONTAINS ClassificationINVOLVESGROUPINGTOGETHERITEMSTHATHAVESOMECOMMONCHARACTERISTIC )NRELATIONTOTHE"ALANCE3HEET THEASSETSANDLIABILITIESHAVEALREADYBEENGROUPED TOGETHER BUTWITHINTHESEGROUPINGSTHEITEMSCANBECLASSIlEDACCORDINGTOWHETHER THEYARECURRENTORNON CURRENT
classification grouping together items that have some common characteristic
Current versus non-current assets !LLASSETSAREDElNEDAS@FUTUREECONOMICBENElTS BUTITISTHEDElNITIONOF@FUTURETHAT DETERMINESWHETHERTHEYAREcurrent assetsORnon-current assets0UTSIMPLY ASSETS ARECLASSIlEDASCURRENTORNON CURRENTACCORDINGTOHOWLONGTHEYAREEXPECTEDTOLAST )FITISEXPECTEDTHATTHEASSETWILLBESOLD USEDUPORTURNEDINTOCASHWITHINAYEAR THATIS IFITISEXPECTEDTOPROVIDEANECONOMICBENElTONLYin the next 12 months THEN ITSHOULDBECLASSIlEDASACURRENTASSET#OMMONCURRENTASSETSINCLUDETHECASHINTHE BUSINESSSBANKACCOUNT THESTOCKITISHOLDINGFORRESALE ANDTHEAMOUNTSOWEDTOIT BYITSDEBTORS !NY ASSETS THAT ARE EXPECTED TO PROVIDE AN ECONOMIC BENElT for more than 12 months SUCH AS BUSINESS PREMISES VEHICLES OR SHOP lTTINGS SHOULD BE CLASSIlED AS NON CURRENTASSETS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
current asset a resource controlled by the entity as a result of past events, from which a future economic benefit is expected to flow to the entity in the next 12 months non-current asset a resource controlled by the entity as a result of past events, from which a future economic benefit is expected to flow to the entity for more than the next 12 months
Cambridge University Press
26
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
If it is expected that an asset will be sold, used up or turned into cash within a year (such as stock held for resale in a warehouse) it should be classified as a current asset
An asset that is expected to provide an economic benefit for more than the next 12 months (such as a business’s premises or truck) should be classified as a non-current asset
current liability a present obligation of the entity arising from past events, the settlement of which is expected to result in an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits in the next 12 months non-current liability a present obligation of the entity arising from past events, the settlement of which is expected to result in an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits in more than 12 months
Current versus non-current liabilities 4HE SAME @ MONTH TEST APPLIES TO LIABILITIES Current liabilities ARE OBLIGATIONS THAT AREEXPECTEDTOBEMETin the next 12 months SUCHASAMOUNTSOWINGTOCREDITORSAND LOANSDUEINTHENEXTYEAR!BANKOVERDRAFTWOULDALSOBECLASSIlEDASACURRENTLIABILITY NOTSOMUCHBECAUSEITwillBEMETINTHENEXTMONTHSASBECAUSEIT can BE4HAT IS ALTHOUGHITISUNLIKELYTOOCCUR ITISPOSSIBLETHATANOVERDRAFTCOULDBECALLEDINFOR REPAYMENT ONVERYSHORTNOTICE MAKINGITACURRENTLIABILITY "YCONTRAST non-current liabilitiesARETHOSEOBLIGATIONSTHATMUSTBEMETSOMETIME in more than 12 months,ONGER TERMLOANS SUCHASMORTGAGES ARETHEMOSTCOMMON NON CURRENTLIABILITIES
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 2
27
T H E A C C O U N T I N G E Q U AT I O N
Loans 7HEN CLASSIFYING LOANS IT IS IMPORTANT TO RECOGNISE THAT SOME OF THE AMOUNT OWING MAYBECURRENTANDSOMENON CURRENT&OREXAMPLE WITHALOANSUCHASAMORTGAGE THELENDERUSUALLYABANK WOULDEXPECTTHEBORROWERTHEBUSINESS TOMAKEGRADUAL REPAYMENTSOFFTHEPRINCIPALRATHERTHANREPAYONEMASSIVEAMOUNTATTHEENDOFTHE LOAN)NTHISCASE THEAMOUNTTHATISDUEFORREPAYMENTINTHENEXTMONTHSWOULD BECLASSIlEDASACURRENTLIABILITY WITHTHEREMAINDERWHICHDOESNOTHAVETOBEREPAID UNTILAFTERMONTHS CLASSIlEDASANON CURRENTLIABILITY!SARESULT THEAMOUNTOWING ONALONG TERMLOANMAYNEEDTOBESPLITBETWEENCURRENTANDNON CURRENTLIABILITIES )FWETAKETHE"ALANCE3HEETSHOWNEARLIERINTHISCHAPTERANDCLASSIFYITSCONTENTS THERESULTWOULDAPPEARASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 2.3 Classified Balance Sheet MORGAN’S MERCHANDISE Balance Sheet as at 30 June 2015 Current Assets
$
Bank
5 000
Stock
34 000
Debtors
12 000
$
Current Liabilities Creditors Loan – MHB Bank
$
$
6 000 12 000
18 000
51 000 Non-Current Liabilities Loan – MHB Bank
Non-Current Assets Vehicles
24 000
45 000 Owner’s Equity
Total Assets
96 000
Capital – Morgan
54 000
Total Equities
96 000
)NTHISEXAMPLE THE,OANn-(""ANKFORHASBEENSPLITBETWEENCURRENT AND NON CURRENT LIABILITIES MUST BE REPAID IN THE NEXT MONTHS WITH THE REMAININGDUEFORREPAYMENTSOMETIMEAFTERTHAT .OTEALSOTHEUSEOFCOLUMNSWHERENECESSARY THELEFT HANDCOLUMNONEACHSIDE OFTHESTATEMENTHASBEENUSEDFORLISTINGINDIVIDUALAMOUNTS LEAVINGONLYTHETOTALOF EACHCLASSIlCATIONINTHERIGHT HANDCOLUMN4HISISASIMPLEMECHANISMFORIMPROVING THELAYOUTOFTHEREPORT ANDMAKINGITMOREUSER FRIENDLY
STUDY TIP
#HECKTHEDATEWHENA LOANHASTOBEREPAID THISISTHEKEYTO WHETHERITISCURRENTOR NON CURRENT
Uses of the classified Balance Sheet 7ITHCURRENTANDNON CURRENTITEMSIDENTIlED THE"ALANCE3HEETNOWHASMORERelevance FORDECISION MAKING&OREXAMPLE ITCANBEUSEDTOIDENTIFYTHEAMOUNTOFDEBTSTHAT MUSTBEMETINTHEFORTHCOMINGYEARTHATIS CURRENTLIABILITIES)FTHEOWNERWANTSTO GOFURTHER THECURRENTLIABILITIESCANBECOMPAREDAGAINSTTHECURRENTASSETSTOASSESS THE lRMS ABILITY TO MEET THOSE SHORT TERM DEBTS 4HIS IS IN EFFECT AN ASSESSMENT OF THElRMSLIQUIDITYBYCALCULATINGITS7ORKING#APITAL2ATIO BUTWEWILLLEAVETHISUNTIL #HAPTER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
28
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 2.3
1 2 3 4 5 6
DistinguishBETWEENACURRENTASSETANDANON CURRENTASSET ListTHREECURRENTASSETSANDTHREENON CURRENTASSETS DistinguishBETWEENACURRENTLIABILITYANDANON CURRENTLIABILITY ListTHREECURRENTLIABILITIES ExplainHOWAMORTGAGESHOULDBECLASSIlEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEET ExplainONEBENElTOFCLASSIFYINGTHE"ALANCE3HEET
2.4
double-entry accounting a system that records two effects on the accounting equation as a result of each transaction
DOUBLE-ENTRY ACCOUNTING
!LTHOUGH THE "ALANCE 3HEET STATES A lRMS lNANCIAL POSITION AT A PARTICULAR POINT IN TIME THISPOSITIONISNOTSTATICITWILLCHANGEAFTEREVERYTRANSACTION3PECIlCALLY WHEN ABUSINESSEXCHANGESGOODSANDORSERVICESWITHANOTHER%NTITY ATLEASTTWOITEMSWILL CHANGEINITSACCOUNTINGEQUATIONAND THEREFORE ITS"ALANCE3HEET4HISISTRUEOFEVERY TRANSACTION THAT A lRM COULD HAVE 4HIS MEANS THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION AND "ALANCE 3HEETWILLNEEDTOBEREWRITTENAFTEREVERYTRANSACTION!TTHESAMETIME THEACCOUNTING EQUATIONMUSTALWAYSBALANCE SOEVENAFTEREACHTRANSACTIONHASBEENRECORDED THE ACCOUNTINGEQUATIONANDTHE"ALANCE3HEETMUSTSTILLBALANCE4HESETWORULESFORMTHE BASISOFWHATISKNOWNASdouble-entry accounting Rules of double-entry accounting 1 Every transaction will affect at least two items in the accounting equation: a double entry. 2 After recording these changes, the accounting equation must still balance.
EXAMPLE
Imelda’s Shoe Shop has presented the following transactions:
)MELDACONTRIBUTEDTOESTABLISHABUSINESSBANKACCOUNT !SARESULTOFTHISTRANSACTION THEBUSINESSNOWHASINITS"ANKACCOUNT ANINCREASEINITSASSETSOF)NADDITION BECAUSETHATCASHCAMEFROMTHE OWNERWHOISASSUMEDTOBEASEPARATEACCOUNTING%NTITY THE/WNERS%QUITYHAS INCREASEDBY4HEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONFOR)MELDAS3HOE3HOPAFTERTHIS TRANSACTIONISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 2.4 Accounting equation 1 Assets Bank
$
$ 20 000
Liabilities
$
$
nil Owner’s Equity
Total Assets
20 000
Capital – Imelda
20 000
Total Equities
20 000
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 2
T H E A C C O U N T I N G E Q U AT I O N
.OTE HOW THE TRANSACTION HAS CHANGED TWO ITEMS n "ANK ASSET AND #APITAL OWNERS EQUITY n BOTH OF WHICH HAVE INCREASED BY !S A RESULT THE ACCOUNTINGEQUATIONSTILLBALANCES 0URCHASEDSTOCKONCREDITFROM-ILANO,EATHER0RODUCTSFOR 4HISTIMEITISNOT"ANKTHATINCREASES BUTADIFFERENTASSET3TOCK/NTHEOTHERSIDE OFTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION ALIABILITYISCREATED CALLED#REDITORS REPRESENTINGTHE AMOUNT OWED TO -ILANO ,EATHER 0RODUCTS 4HE ACCOUNTING EQUATION FOR )MELDAS 3HOE3HOPAFTERTRANSACTIONISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 2.5 Accounting equation 2 Assets
$
$
Liabilities
Bank
20 000
Creditors
Stock
45 000
Owner’s Equity
Total Assets
65 000
$
$ 45 000
Capital – Imelda
20 000
Total Equities
65 000
7HILETHEREISNOCHANGETO"ANK THENEWASSETn3TOCKnINCREASESTHEASSETS TO/NTHEOTHERSIDEOFTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION #REDITORSINCREASESTHE EQUITIESTOTHESAMEAMOUNTAND ONCEAGAIN THEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONBALANCES 0AIDTOPURCHASENEWSHOPlTTINGS 4HISTRANSACTIONCREATESATHIRDASSET3HOP&ITTINGS BUTINTHEPROCESSDECREASES "ANK BY THE SAME AMOUNT 4HUS THE AMOUNTS OF THE INDIVIDUAL ASSETS CHANGE WITHOUTCHANGINGTHETOTALASSETSlGURE4HEREISNOCHANGEONTHEEQUITIESSIDEOF THEEQUATION PROVINGTHATALTHOUGHTWOITEMSMUSTCHANGE THEYCANBOTHBEON THESAMESIDEOFTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION PROVIDEDTHATTHERESULTSTILLBALANCES4HE ACCOUNTINGEQUATIONFOR)MELDAS3HOE3HOPAFTERTRANSACTIONISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 2.6 Accounting equation 3 Assets
$
$
Liabilities Creditors
$
$
Bank
8 000
45 000
Stock
45 000
Owner’s Equity
Shop Fittings
12 000
Capital – Imelda
20 000
Total Assets
65 000
Total Equities
65 000
%ACHANDEVERYTRANSACTIONWILLHAVEATLEASTTWOEFFECTSONTHEACCOUNTING EQUATIONAND AFTERTHESEEFFECTSHAVEBEENRECORDED THEEQUATIONMUSTBALANCE )FITDOESNOTBALANCE THENTHERECORDINGISINCORRECT REVIEW QUESTIONS 2.4
1 Explain WHYTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONMUSTBEREDRAWNAFTEREVERYTRANSACTION 2 State THETWORULESOFDOUBLE ENTRYACCOUNTING
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
29
30
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s s
s s s
s
s
s
EXERCISES
!SSETSARERESOURCESCONTROLLEDBYTHE%NTITYASARESULTOFPASTEVENTS FROMWHICH AFUTUREECONOMICBENElTISEXPECTEDTOmOWTOTHE%NTITY ,IABILITIES ARE PRESENT OBLIGATIONS OF THE %NTITY ARISING FROM PAST EVENTS THE SETTLEMENT OF WHICH IS EXPECTED TO RESULT IN AN OUTmOW OF RESOURCES EMBODYING ECONOMICBENElTS /WNERSEQUITYISTHERESIDUALINTERESTINTHEASSETSOFTHE%NTITYAFTERTHEDEDUCTION OFITSLIABILITIES 4HEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONIS@!SSETS,IABILITIES/WNERS%QUITY ANDITMUSTALWAYS BALANCE 4HE "ALANCE 3HEET IS AN ACCOUNTING REPORT THAT DETAILS THE BUSINESSS ASSETS LIABILITIESANDOWNERSEQUITYATAPARTICULARPOINTINTIME ANDISAREmECTIONOFTHE lRMSACCOUNTINGEQUATION !SSETSARECLASSIlEDASCURRENTIFTHEYAREEXPECTEDTOPROVIDEANECONOMICBENElT INTHENEXTMONTHS!SSETSTHATPROVIDEANECONOMICBENElTFORMORETHAN MONTHSARECLASSIlEDASNON CURRENT ,IABILITIESARECLASSIlEDASCURRENTIFITISEXPECTEDTHEYWILLBESETTLEDINTHENEXT MONTHS,IABILITIESTHATWILLBESETTLEDINLONGERTHANMONTHSARECLASSIlEDAS NON CURRENT $OUBLE ENTRYACCOUNTINGMEANSEACHANDEVERYTRANSACTIONWILLHAVEATLEASTTWO EFFECTSONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION ANDAFTERTHESEEFFECTSHAVEBEENRECORDEDTHE ACCOUNTINGEQUATIONMUSTBALANCE
EXERCISE 2.1 CLASSIFYING ITEMS
W B
page 18
ClassifyEACHOFTHEFOLLOWINGITEMSASASSETSORLIABILITIES ANDASCURRENTOR NON CURRENT s CREDITORS s BANKOVERDRAFT s CASHONHAND s CAPITAL s DEBTORS s EQUIPMENT s MORTGAGEOWINGONPREMISESFORBOTHTHISYEARANDREMAINDER s PREMISES s STOCK s VEHICLES s WAGESOWINGTOEMPLOYEES s RENTPAIDINADVANCE s '34PAYABLE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 2
T H E A C C O U N T I N G E Q U AT I O N
EXERCISE 2.2 BALANCE SHEET
W B
page 19
-ARK&LORENCEISTHEOWNEROF0ONTE*EWELLERS ANDHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGLISTOFTHE lRMSASSETSANDLIABILITIESASAT-AY 3TOCK #REDITORS ,OANn.!"REPAYABLE 3HOP&ITTINGS "ANK $EBTORS /FlCE%QUIPMENT
Required
*
a b c d
ExplainWHATISMEANTBYTHETERM@EQUITIES Calculate#APITALASAT-AY PrepareACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR0ONTE*EWELLERSASAT-AY 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@C explainYOURTREATMENTOF#REDITORS
EXERCISE 2.3 BALANCE SHEET
W B
page 20
'REG-ILLEROWNS'REGS'ARDENING3UPPLIESANDHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATION ASAT*ANUARY Item
$
Item
$
Term Deposit (matures 2020)
8 000
Bank
700
Debtors
2 490
Creditors
Wages Owing Stock
600 50 000
1 400
Motor Vehicle
22 000
Loan from ANZ due 2025 (repayable $2 000 p.a.)
36 000
Required
*
a Calculate#APITALASAT*ANUARY b PrepareACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR'REGS'ARDENING3UPPLIESASAT*ANUARY c 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@B explainYOURTREATMENTOF3TOCK d 4HE MOTOR VEHICLE IS THREE YEARS OLD AND THE OWNER HAS ESTIMATED ITS VALUE AT RATHERTHANASLISTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETDiscuss HOWTHEMOTOR VEHICLESHOULDBEVALUED CITINGATLEASTTWOQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTICSINYOURANSWER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
31
32
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 2.4 BALANCE SHEET
W B
page 21
,AURA$ESTIOOWNS-ALLACOOTA7INESANDHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONASAT *UNE Item
$
Item
Bank Overdraft
2 500
Shelving
43 000
Mortgage
60 000
Debtors
10 500
Stock
12 000
Creditors
5 000
Premises
100 000
$
GST Payable
1 700
Note: 4HEMORTGAGEISREPAYABLEINQUARTERLYINSTALMENTSOF Required
*
a PrepareACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR-ALLACOOTA7INESASAT*UNE b ExplainWHYA"ALANCE3HEETISTITLED@ASAT c ExplainYOURTREATMENTOF s $EBTORS s "ANK/VERDRAFT d StateTWOEXTERNALUSERSWHOMIGHTBEINTERESTEDINTHIS"ALANCE3HEET
EXERCISE 2.5 TRANSACTIONS AND THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION
W B
page 23
State THEEFFECTEACHOFTHEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSHASONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION s ALOANFORWASRECEIVEDFROM!.:"ANK s OFlCEFURNITUREWORTHWASPURCHASEDONCREDITFROM(0%NTERPRISES s ACREDITORWASPAID s THEOWNERCONTRIBUTEDTOTHEBUSINESSAVEHICLEWORTH s WASPAIDOFFTHELOANPRINCIPAL s STOCKWORTHWASPURCHASEDWITHCASH s WASRECEIVEDFROMADEBTOR
EXERCISE 2.6 TRANSACTIONS AND THE BALANCE SHEET
W B
page 24
!SAT-ARCH THEASSETSANDLIABILITIESOF0ETES0AINT%MPORIUMWEREASFOLLOWS Assets
$
Equities
$
Bank
2 300
Creditors
9 000
Debtors
8 000
Wages Owing
2 000
Fixtures and Fittings
18 000
Delivery Van
25 000
Stock
24 000
Capital – Pete
?
Total Assets
77 300
Total Equities
77 300
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 2
T H E A C C O U N T I N G E Q U AT I O N
)NTHElRSTWEEKOF!PRIL THEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSOCCURRED Apr.
1
Paid $3 000 to a creditor.
2
Borrowed $28 000 cash from the NAB, which was used to purchase another van. The loan is to be repaid in monthly instalments of $1 000, commencing in May 2015.
3
Received $2 400 from a debtor.
4
Pete withdrew $1 500 worth of paint for his own purposes.
5
Paid the wages owing.
6
Pete contributed to the business his personal computer. Pete had paid $4 600 but its agreed value on this date was $4 000.
Required
*
a Calculate#APITALASAT-ARCH b ExplainWHYTHECOMPUTERCONTRIBUTEDON!PRILMUSTBEVALUEDAT c Prepare A TABLE TO SHOW THE EFFECT OF EACH TRANSACTION ON THE "ALANCE 3HEET OF 0ETES0AINT%MPORIUM d PrepareACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR0ETES0AINT%MPORIUMASAT!PRIL
EXERCISE 2.7 TRANSACTIONS AND THE BALANCE SHEET
W B
page 26
!SAT3EPTEMBER THEASSETSANDLIABILITIESOF3AM"OOKER,IQUORWEREASFOLLOWS Assets
$
Debtors
3 000
Equities
$
Bank Overdraft
2 500 7 000
Fixtures and Fittings
15 000
Creditors
Stock
25 000
Loan – ANZ (repayable $6 000 p.a)
Fridges
40 000
Capital – Sam
?
Total Assets
83 000
Total Equities
83 000
36 000
)NTHElRSTWEEKOF/CTOBER THEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSOCCURRED Oct.
1
Paid $2 000 to a creditor.
2
Sam contributed $5 000 of his own money to the business.
3
Paid $3 000 off the loan principal.
4
Purchased stock on credit for $10 000.
5
Sam took $2 500 of the fixtures and fittings home for personal use.
6
Paid $1 200 rent in advance for the next 6 months.
Required
*
a PrepareATABLETOSHOWTHEEFFECTOFEACHTRANSACTIONONTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF3AM "OOKER,IQUOR b PrepareACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR3AM"OOKER,IQUORASAT/CTOBER c 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@B explainYOURTREATMENTOF2ENTPAIDINADVANCE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
33
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s explainTHEROLEOFTHE 'ENERAL,EDGER s applyTHERULESOFDOUBLE ENTRYACCOUNTINGTOTHE 'ENERAL,EDGER s recordTRANSACTIONSINTHE 'ENERAL,EDGER s explainTHEROLEOFACROSS REFERENCE s explainTHERELATIONSHIP BETWEENOWNERSEQUITYAND REVENUESANDEXPENSES
s recordOPENINGBALANCESIN THE'ENERAL,EDGER s recordCASHANDCREDITSALES OFSTOCKINTHE'ENERAL ,EDGER s stateTHEEFFECTOFCASHAND CREDITSALESONTHEACCOUNTING EQUATION s footLEDGERACCOUNTS s prepareA4RIAL"ALANCE s balanceLEDGERACCOUNTS
CHAPTER 3
THE GENERAL LEDGER KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s LEDGERACCOUNT s 'ENERAL,EDGER s CROSS REFERENCE s 4RIAL"ALANCE s FOOTING s BALANCING
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
36
3.1
ledger accounts accounting records showing all the transactions that affect a particular item
General Ledger the collective name for the main group of ledger accounts
UNITS 3&4
LEDGER ACCOUNTS
#HAPTERINTRODUCEDTHECONCEPTOFDOUBLE ENTRYACCOUNTINGnTHEPRINCIPLETHATFOR EVERYBUSINESSTRANSACTION THEREWILLBEATLEASTTWOEFFECTSONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION 4HISWASILLUSTRATEDBYANYNUMBEROFTRANSACTIONS EACHOFWHICHREQUIREDAREDRAWING OFTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONTOREmECTHOWITSCOMPONENTSHADCHANGED )T MAY HAVE OCCURRED TO YOU THAT REWRITING THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION AFTER EVERY TRANSACTIONWOULDNOTBEPRACTICALFORAREAL FUNCTIONINGSMALLBUSINESS)NADDITION THE ACCOUNTANTORBOOKKEEPERWOULDPROBABLYlNDITVERYREPETITIVEANDBORING 4HIS IS PARTICULARLY THE CASE WHEN WE CONSIDER THAT ALTHOUGH EVERY TRANSACTION WILL CHANGE TWO ITEMS IN THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION THERE MAY WELL BE A LARGE NUMBER OF ITEMSTHATDOnotCHANGE&ORINSTANCE ACREDITPURCHASEOFSTOCKWILLINCREASE3TOCK ASSET AND #REDITORS LIABILITY BUT WILL HAVE NO EFFECT WHATSOEVER ON "ANK $EBTORS ,OANSOREVEN#APITAL4HEREMAYBEMANYITEMSTHATDONOTNEEDTOBECHANGED BUT THEYWILLSTILLNEEDTOBEREWRITTENINANUPDATEDVERSIONOFTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION 4HECHALLENGETHENISTODEVELOPANACCOUNTINGSYSTEMTHATISCAPABLEOFRECORDING CHANGESINTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION WITHOUTREQUIRINGTHATTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONBE REWRITTENEVERYTIME4HERESPONSETOTHISCHALLENGEISTORECORDTRANSACTIONSINledger accounts
What are ledger accounts? !TITSMOSTBASIC ALEDGERACCOUNTISSIMPLYANACCOUNTINGRECORDLIKEAPAGEINABOOK WHERETRANSACTIONSAREWRITTENDOWN WITHASEPARATELEDGERACCOUNTORPAGE FOREACH ITEMINTHElRMSRECORDS4HATIS THEREWILLBEALEDGERACCOUNTFOR"ANK ANDASEPARATE LEDGERACCOUNTFOREACHOF3TOCK $EBTORS #REDITORS ,OANS #APITAL ETC)FTHEBUSINESS HASITEMSINITSREPORTS ITWILLNEEDLEDGERACCOUNTS#OLLECTIVELY THISGROUPOF LEDGERACCOUNTSISKNOWNASTHEGeneral Ledger %ACHINDIVIDUALACCOUNTWILLRECORDALLINCREASESORDECREASESINTHATPARTICULARITEM &ORINSTANCE THE"ANKLEDGERACCOUNTWILLRECORDALLMOVEMENTSOFCASHINANDOUTOF THElRMSBANKACCOUNTTHE3TOCKLEDGERACCOUNTWILLRECORDALLMOVEMENTSOFSTOCK INANDOUTOFTHEBUSINESSTHE#REDITORS,EDGERACCOUNTWILLRECORDALLINCREASESAND DECREASESINWHATTHElRMOWESTOITSSUPPLIERS %ACHTRANSACTIONCHANGESATLEASTTWOITEMSINTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION SOATLEAST TWOLEDGERACCOUNTSWILLNEEDTOBECHANGED"YRECORDINGEACHTRANSACTIONONLYINTHE LEDGERACCOUNTSOFTHETWOITEMSTHATAREAFFECTED THECHANGESTOTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION CANBERECORDEDWITHOUTHAVINGTOREWRITEEVERYITEMINTHATACCOUNTINGEQUATION
The T-form account !4 FORMACCOUNTISCREATEDBYDIVIDINGTHEPAGEINTOTWOCOLUMNS4HELEFT HANDCOLUMN ISLABELLEDTHEDEBITCOLUMNORDEBITSIDE ANDTHERIGHT HANDCOLUMNISLABELLEDTHE CREDITCOLUMNORCREDITSIDE &IGURESHOWSTHEFORMATOFA4 FORMACCOUNT Figure 3.1 T-form account Name of item/account $EBITCOLUMNSIDE (Dr)
#REDITCOLUMNSIDE (Cr)
4HEWORD@DEBITINTHISCONTEXTSIMPLYMEANSTHELEFTSIDEOFALEDGERACCOUNT AND @CREDITMEANSTHERIGHTSIDEOFALEDGERACCOUNTNEITHERONESHOULDBETHOUGHTOFAS GOODORBAD/NEOFTHESECOLUMNSWILLBEUSEDTORECORDINCREASESINTHEVALUEOFTHE ITEMTHEOTHERWILLBEUSEDTORECORDDECREASES ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 3
THE GENERAL LEDGER
REVIEW QUESTIONS 3.1
1 Explain the role of a ledger account. 2 In reference to ledger accounts, define the following terms: s 'ENERAL,EDGER s DEBITSIDE s CREDITSIDE
3.2
DOUBLE-ENTRY RECORDING IN LEDGER ACCOUNTS
4HEREARESETRULESFORRECORDINGTRANSACTIONSINLEDGERACCOUNTS RULESTHATAPPLYTHE CONCEPTSOFDOUBLE ENTRYRECORDINGANDPRESERVETHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION *UST AS EVERY TRANSACTION WILL AFFECT AT LEAST TWO ITEMS IN THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION EVERY TRANSACTION WILL AFFECT AT LEAST TWO LEDGER ACCOUNTS )N ORDER TO ENSURE THAT THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION REMAINS IN BALANCE THE TRANSACTION MUST BE RECORDED IN ONE OF THOSELEDGERACCOUNTSONTHEDEBITSIDE ANDINTHEOTHERONTHECREDITSIDE4HERULES FORRECORDINGINLEDGERACCOUNTSARESHOWNBELOW Double-entry rules 1 Every transaction must be recorded in at least two ledger accounts. 2 Every transaction must be recorded on the debit side of one ledger account and the credit side of another. 'IVEN THAT EVERY TRANSACTION MUST BE RECORDED ON THE DEBIT SIDE OF ONE LEDGER ACCOUNT AND THE CREDIT SIDE OF ANOTHER THE MOST OBVIOUS QUESTION IS WHEN ARE TRANSACTIONSRECORDEDONTHEDEBITSIDE ANDWHENARETHEYRECORDEDONTHECREDITSIDE 5NFORTUNATELY THEREISNOONEANSWERASITDEPENDSONWHATTYPEOFITEMISINQUESTION &ORTUNATELY JUSTASA4 FORMACCOUNTLOOKSLIKEA"ALANCE3HEET THERULESFORRECORDING INALEDGERACCOUNTFOLLOWASIMILARPATTERN
Assets !SSETITEMSAPPEARONTHEleftSIDEOFTHE"ALANCE3HEET SOTORECORDANINCREASEIN ANASSETRECORDTHETRANSACTIONONTHEdebitSIDEOFTHATLEDGERACCOUNT"YTHELAWOF OPPOSITES DECREASESMUSTBERECORDEDONTHECREDITSIDE Bank (Asset) )NCREASESARERECORDEDONTHE debit side
$ECREASESARERECORDEDONTHE credit side
Liabilities and owner’s equity ,IABILITIESANDOWNERSEQUITYITEMSAPPEARONTHErightSIDEOFTHE"ALANCE3HEET SO TORECORDANINCREASEINALIABILITYOROWNERSEQUITYRECORDTHETRANSACTIONONTHEcredit SIDEOFTHATLEDGERACCOUNT"YTHELAWOFOPPOSITES DECREASESMUSTBERECORDEDON THEDEBITSIDE Creditors (Liability) $ECREASESARERECORDEDONTHE debit side
)NCREASESARERECORDEDONTHE credit side
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
37
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
38
UNITS 3&4
Capital (Owner’s Equity) $ECREASESARERECORDEDONTHE debit side
)NCREASESARERECORDEDONTHE credit side
REVIEW QUESTIONS 3.2
1 State the two rules of recording in ledger accounts. 2 Identify on which side of a ledger account a transaction would be recorded in order to: s INCREASEANASSETACCOUNT s DECREASEANASSETACCOUNT s INCREASEALIABILITYOROWNERSEQUITYACCOUNT s DECREASEALIABILITYOROWNERSEQUITYACCOUNT
3.3
RECORDING LEDGER ENTRIES
,ETSEXAMINEASIMPLETRANSACTIONTOSEEHOWITWOULDBERECORDEDINLEDGERACCOUNTS
EXAMPLE
Jan. 1
Bill Brighton deposited $40 000 of his own funds in a business bank account to commence business operations as Bright Books.
7HATLEDGERENTRIESAREREQUIREDTORECORDTHISTRANSACTION&IRST THEDEPOSITBYTHE OWNER MEANS THAT THE lRMS "ANK IS INCREASING "ECAUSE "ANK IS AN ASSET WHICH WILL APPEARONTHEleftSIDEOFTHE"ALANCE3HEET THEINCREASEMUSTBERECORDED ONTHELEFTSIDEnthe debit sidenOFTHISLEDGERACCOUNT4HISWOULDBEDESCRIBEDAS debitingTHE"ANKACCOUNT Bank (A) Date
Cross-reference
Jan. 1
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
40 000
!TTHESAMETIME THEFACTTHATTHECASHHASCOMEFROMTHEOWNERMEANSTHAT#APITAL ISINCREASING!SANOWNERSEQUITYITEM #APITALWOULDAPPEARONTHErightSIDEOFTHE "ALANCE3HEET SOTHEINCREASEMUSTBERECORDEDONTHERIGHTSIDEnthe credit sidenOF THE#APITALLEDGERACCOUNT4HISWOULDBEDESCRIBEDAScreditingTHE#APITALACCOUNT Capital (OE) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Jan. 1
Amount $ 40 000
/NETRANSACTIONHASPRODUCEDANEFFECTONTWODIFFERENTACCOUNTS WITHONEENTRY ONTHEDEBITSIDEINTHE"ANKACCOUNT ANDONEENTRYONTHECREDITSIDEINTHE#APITAL ACCOUNT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 3
THE GENERAL LEDGER
39
The cross-reference .OTE HOW EACH ENTRY IN THIS EXAMPLE SHOWS BOTH THE DATE OF THE TRANSACTION AND ITS AMOUNT)THASPROBABLYNOTESCAPEDYOURATTENTIONTHATTHEREISAGAPINGHOLEINEACH OF THE LEDGER ACCOUNTS SHOWN n A HOLE THAT SEEMS TO REQUIRE AN ADDITIONAL PIECE OF INFORMATION)FITHADINITIALLYESCAPEDYOURATTENTION ITSHOULDBEOBVIOUSNOWTHATIT HASBEENPOINTEDOUT 4HISSPACEBETWEENTHEDATEANDTHEAMOUNTOFEACHTRANSACTIONISUSEDTORECORD WHAT IS KNOWN AS THE cross-reference "ECAUSE EACH TRANSACTION AFFECTS TWO LEDGER ACCOUNTS AT THE SAME TIME THESE ACCOUNTS ARE LINKED 4HE CROSS REFERENCE SPECIlES THELINKBETWEENTHESETWOACCOUNTSBYIDENTIFYINGTHEotherACCOUNTAFFECTED)NTHE "ANKACCOUNT FOREXAMPLE THECROSS REFERENCEWOULDBE@#APITAL WHILEINTHE#APITAL ACCOUNTTHECROSS REFERENCEWOULDBE@"ANK 4HETWOACCOUNTSnWITHTHEIRCROSS REFERENCESNOWENTEREDnWOULDSHOW
cross-reference the name of the other account affected by a transaction, so that both accounts affected by a particular transaction can be identified
Bank (A) Date Jan. 1
Cross-reference Capital
Amount $ Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
40 000 Capital (OE)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $ Date Jan. 1
Bank
40 000
)T IS THE amount NOT THE CROSS REFERENCE THAT DETERMINES WHETHER AN ACCOUNT HAS BEENDEBITEDORCREDITED)NTHISEXAMPLE THEAPPEARSONTHELEFTSIDEOFTHE "ANKACCOUNT SOITISTHISACCOUNTTHATHASBEENDEBITED4HECROSS REFERENCE@#APITAL APPEARSONLYTOSHOWTHENAMEOFTHEotherACCOUNTAFFECTEDBYTHATPARTICULARTRANSACTION
More examples #ONTINUINGWITHTHELEDGERACCOUNTSUSEDABOVE THEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSWOULDBE RECORDEDINTHELEDGERACCOUNTSASFOLLOWS Jan. 2
Purchased $12 000 worth of stock on credit
4HIS TRANSACTION WILL INCREASE 3TOCK ASSET AND SIMULTANEOUSLY INCREASE #REDITORS LIABILITY "ECAUSE3TOCKISANASSETLEFT HANDSIDEOFTHE"ALANCE3HEET INCREASESMUST BERECORDEDONTHEdebitSIDEOFTHEACCOUNT#REDITORS ONTHEOTHERHAND ISALIABILITY RIGHT HANDSIDEOFTHE"ALANCE3HEET SOINCREASESINTHISACCOUNTMUSTBERECORDED ONTHEcreditSIDE !LTHOUGH IT IS LIKELY THAT THERE WILL BE MORE THAN ONE 3TOCK ITEM ALL TRANSACTIONS AFFECTING 3TOCK WILL BE RECORDED IN THE SAME 'ENERAL ,EDGER ACCOUNT CALLED @3TOCK #ONTROL 4HE SAME WILL APPLY FOR CREDITORS WHICH WILL BE RECORDED IN THE @#REDITORS #ONTROLACCOUNT ANDFORDEBTORSUSINGTHE@$EBTORS#ONTROLACCOUNT Jan. 3
Borrowed $20 000 from Sunbank
4HISTRANSACTIONINCREASES"ANKASSET VIAAdebitTOTHATACCOUNT ANDALSOINCREASES ,OANn3UNBANKLIABILITY VIAACORRESPONDINGcreditTOTHATACCOUNT Jan. 4
Paid $15 000 cash for a van to use for business deliveries
!LTHOUGH"ANKISANASSETANDWOULDNORMALLYAPPEARONTHELEFTSIDEOFTHE"ALANCE 3HEET THIS TRANSACTION ACTUALLY INVOLVES A decrease TO THAT ITEM 4HIS DECREASE MUST THEREFOREBERECORDEDONTHEcreditSIDEOFTHE"ANKACCOUNT4HEINCREASETOASSETSIN THEFORMOFTHE6ANWOULDBERECORDEDONTHEdebitSIDEASUSUAL ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
40
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
4HELEDGERACCOUNTSINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERWOULDTHENAPPEARASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 3.2 General Ledger accounts General Ledger Bank (A) Date
Cross-reference
Jan. 1 3
Amount $
Capital
40 000
Loan – Sunbank
20 000
Date Jan. 4
Cross-reference Van
Amount $ 15 000
Capital (OE) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Jan. 1
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $ 40 000
Stock Control (A) Date Jan. 2
Cross-reference
Amount $
Creditors Control
12 000
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
Creditors Control (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Jan. 2
Stock Control
12 000
Loan – Sunbank (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Jan. 3
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $ 20 000
Van (A) Date
Cross-reference
Jan. 4
Bank
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
15 000
%VERYTRANSACTIONHASBEENRECORDEDASAdebitENTRYINONEACCOUNT ANDAcredit ENTRYINANOTHERACCOUNT ENSURINGTHATTHELEDGERRULESAREUPHELD!SSTATEDBEFORE THESERULESAREASFOLLOWS s s
!TLEASTTWOLEDGERACCOUNTSAREAFFECTED 4HEREISADEBITENTRYANDACREDITENTRYFOREVERYTRANSACTION
3.4
RECORDING RULES FOR REVENUES AND EXPENSES
4HELEDGERRULESFORRECORDINGREVENUESANDEXPENSESCANBEDETERMINEDBYREFERRING TOTHEIRRELATIONSHIPTOOWNERSEQUITY
Revenue 2EVENUEREPRESENTSANincreaseINOWNERSEQUITYITIS INFACT PARTOFTHEDElNITION SOTHERULESFORRECORDINGREVENUEARETHESAMEASTHOSEFORRECORDINGANINCREASEIN OWNERSEQUITY2EMEMBER INCREASESINOWNERSEQUITYARERECORDEDONTHECREDITSIDE SO TO RECORD AN increase IN REVENUE RECORD THE TRANSACTION ON THE credit side OF THE LEDGERACCOUNT"YTHELAWOFOPPOSITES DECREASESMUSTBERECORDEDONTHEDEBITSIDE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 3
THE GENERAL LEDGER
41
Cash Sales (Revenue) $ECREASESARERECORDEDONTHE debit side
)NCREASESARERECORDEDONTHE credit side STUDY TIP
Expenses %XPENSESREPRESENTAdecreaseINOWNERSEQUITYAGAIN ASDICTATEDBYTHEDElNITION SOTHERULESFORRECORDINGEXPENSESARETHESAMEASTHOSEFORRECORDINGADECREASEIN OWNERSEQUITY$ECREASESINOWNERSEQUITYARERECORDEDONTHEDEBITSIDE SOTORECORD ANINCREASEINEXPENSES RECORDTHETRANSACTIONONTHEdebitSIDEOFTHELEDGERACCOUNT /NCEAGAIN THELAWOFOPPOSITESMEANSDECREASESMUSTBERECORDEDONTHECREDITSIDE
2EVENUESANDEXPENSES ARERECORDEDON OPPOSITESIDESOFTHE LEDGERREVENUESONTHE CREDITSIDEEXPENSESON THEDEBITSIDE
Wages (Expense) )NCREASESARERECORDEDONTHE debit side
$ECREASESARERECORDEDONTHE credit side
EXAMPLE
Continuing with the earlier example, the following transactions occurred: Jan. 5 6
Received $600 commission from a publisher Paid wages $1 200
4HESEREVENUEANDEXPENSETRANSACTIONSWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER ASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 3.3 General Ledger: recording revenues and expenses General Ledger Bank(A) Date Jan. 1
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Capital
40 000
Jan. 4
3
Loan – Sunbank
20 000
6
5
Commission Revenue
Cross-reference Van
Amount $ 15 000
Wages
1 200
600 Commission Revenue (R)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Jan. 5
Cross-reference
Amount $
Bank
600
Wages (E) Date Jan. 6
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
1 200
&IGUREONTHENEXTPAGE SUMMARISESHOWTORECORDANINCREASEORDECREASEIN EACHTYPEOFLEDGERACCOUNT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
42
UNITS 3&4
Figure 3.4 Summary of ledger entries Type of account
Increase
Decrease
Asset
Debit side
Credit side
Liability
Credit side
Debit side
/WNERS%QUITY
Credit side
Debit side
Revenue
Credit side
Debit side
Expense
Debit side
Credit side
Recording procedure
Analysing Chart a tool used to identify the steps for recording transactions in the General Ledger
5NTILTHESERECORDINGRULESBECOMESECONDNATUREWHICHTHEYWILLAND INFACT MUST IT MAYBEWORTHWHILETOFOLLOWTHEFOURSIMPLESTEPSOUTLINEDBELOW )DENTIFYTHEITEMSACCOUNTSAFFECTED2EMEMBERTHEREWILLBEATLEASTTWO )DENTIFYWHATTYPEOFACCOUNTSTHEYAREn!,/%2% )DENTIFYWHETHERTHEYAREINCREASINGORDECREASING 5SETHETABLETOIDENTIFYWHETHERTHEACCOUNTSHOULDBEDEBITEDORCREDITED 4HISPROCEDURECANBEFOLLOWEDBYCOMPLETINGWHATISKNOWNASANAnalysing Chart 4HE!NALYSING#HARTFORTHESIXTRANSACTIONSDESCRIBEDEARLIERISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 3.5 Analysing Chart Date Jan. 1
Accounts affected Bank Capital
Jan. 2
Stock Control Creditors Control
Jan. 3
Bank Loan – Sunbank
Jan. 4
Van Bank
Jan. 5
Bank Commission Revenue
Jan. 6
Wages Bank
Type of account
Increase/ Decrease
Debit $
Asset
Increase
40 000
/WNERS%QUITY
Increase
Asset
Increase
Liability
Increase
Asset
Increase
Liability
Increase
Asset
Increase
Asset
Decrease
Asset
Increase
Revenue
Increase
Expense
Increase
Asset
Decrease
Credit $
40 000 12 000 12 000 20 000 20 000 15 000 15 000 600 600 1 200 1 200
"YCONVENTION THEDEBITENTRYISSHOWNlRST ANDTHESECONDENTRYISINDENTEDSLIGHTLY TOEMPHASISETHATITISTHECREDITENTRY 4HE!NALYSING#HARTISNOTANACCOUNTINGRECORDITISSIMPLYATOOLYOUMAYUSEUNTIL YOULEARNTHELEDGERENTRIES LIKETRAININGWHEELSWHENYOULEARNTORIDEABIKE7HEN YOUFEELTHATYOUKNOWTHELEDGERRULESnANDCANBALANCEONYOUROWNTWOWHEELSnYOU CANSTOPUSINGTHE!NALYSING#HARTANDRECORDTHETRANSACTIONSSTRAIGHTINTOTHELEDGER ACCOUNTS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 3
THE GENERAL LEDGER
43
REVIEW QUESTIONS 3.4
1 2EFERRINGTOTHEIRRELATIONSHIPTOOWNERSEQUITY, explain why: s REVENUEACCOUNTSINCREASEONTHECREDITSIDE s EXPENSEACCOUNTSINCREASEONTHEDEBITSIDE 2 Draw a table to summarise the rules for recording in ledger accounts. 3 Explain the role of an Analysing Chart.
3.5
SOME CHALLENGING ENTRIES
Opening balances 7HENLEDGERACCOUNTSARESTARTEDFORABUSINESSTHATHASALREADYBEENTRADINGFORSOME TIME THEREWILLBEPRE EXISTINGBALANCESFORITEMSINITSREPORTS4HESEBALANCESMUST BEENTEREDINTHELEDGERACCOUNTSBEFOREANYNEWTRANSACTIONSCANBERECORDED4HE NORMALRULESFORRECORDINGINLEDGERACCOUNTSSTILLAPPLY SUCHASINCREASEASSETSONTHE DEBITSIDE ANDINCREASELIABILITIESANDOWNERSEQUITYONTHECREDITSIDE(OWEVER THE BALANCESINEACHACCOUNTWILLBETHEPRODUCTOFANUMBEROFDIFFERENTTRANSACTIONS AND THUSWILLNOTBETRACEABLETOONESINGLEACCOUNT4HISMEANSTHATTHECROSS REFERENCECAN BESTATEDASSIMPLY@"ALANCE
EXAMPLE
The assets and equities of Mickelham Frames as at 1 July 2015 were as follows: Bank $ 1 000 Creditors Control $ 2 000 Stock Control 4 000 Capital – Malloy 20 000 Shelving 17 000
%VENWHENENTERINGOPENINGBALANCES APROPERDOUBLEENTRYMUSTSTILLBERECORDED WITHTOTALDEBITSEQUALLINGTOTALCREDITS&IGURESHOWSTHE!NALYSING#HARTTOENTER THESEOPENINGBALANCES Figure 3.6 Analysing Chart: opening balances Date July 1
Accounts affected
Type of account
Increase/ Decrease
Debit $
Credit $
Bank
Asset
Increase
1 000
Stock Control
Asset
Increase
4 000
Shelving
Asset
Increase
17 000
Creditors Control
Liability
Increase
2 000
Capital
/WNERS%QUITY
Increase
20 000
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
44
UNITS 3&4
&IGURE SHOWS HOW THESE OPENING BALANCES WOULD BE ENTERED IN THE LEDGER ACCOUNTS Figure 3.7 General Ledger: opening balances General Ledger Bank (A) Date July 1
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
1 000 Stock Control (A)
Date July 1
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $
Date
4 000 Shelving (A)
Date July 1
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $
Date
17 000 Creditors Control (L)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date July 1
Balance
2 000
Capital – Malloy (OE) STUDY TIP
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date July 1
)FTHECAPITALFIGUREIS NOTGIVEN ITCANALWAYS BECALCULATEDUSINGTHE ACCOUNTINGEQUATION /%!n,
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $ 20 000
Cash sales (of stock) -OSTOFTHEENTRIESTHATHAVEBEENDEALTWITHTODATEHAVEHADONLYTWOEFFECTSONTHE LEDGERACCOUNTSONEDEBITENTRYANDONECREDITENTRY4HESALEOFSTOCKnWHETHERFOR CASHORONCREDITnISMORECOMPLICATEDBECAUSEITREQUIREStwoDOUBLEENTRIES 4HESIMPLEMECHANICSOFACASHSALEINVOLVETHEBUSINESSRECEIVINGTHECASH ANDTHE CUSTOMERRECEIVINGTHEGOODS"UTTHECASHANDTHEGOODSWILLBEVALUEDDIFFERENTLYTHE CASHWILLBEFORTHESELLINGPRICE WHILETHESTOCKWILLBEVALUEDATCOSTPRICE)NFACT ITIS THEDIFFERENCEBETWEENTHESETWOAMOUNTSTHATCREATESA'ROSS0ROlTFROMTHESALE&OR EXAMPLE GOODSPURCHASEDFORMAYBESOLDFOREARNING'ROSS0ROlT "ECAUSETHEREAREtwo pricesTORECORD THEREAREtwo double entriesTORECORD
Figure 3.8 Cash sale of stock Cash Customer
Supplier Goods (stock)
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 3
THE GENERAL LEDGER
45
!CASHSALEWILLINCREASE"ANK WHICHMUSTBERECORDEDASADEBITTOTHISACCOUNT 4HECREDITENTRYCOMESFROMRECOGNISINGTHESOURCEOFTHATINCREASETHATIS THE3ALES REVENUEEARNED4HISTRANSACTIONWILLBERECORDEDATTHESELLINGPRICE )NADDITION ASALEOFSTOCKWILLDECREASE3TOCK#ONTROLBYCREDITINGTHISACCOUNT )NEFFECT THISSTOCKHASBEENCONSUMED SOANEXPENSEMUSTBERECOGNISEDTORECORD THE VALUE OF THE STOCK CONSUMED OR SOLD 4HIS EXPENSE IS CALLED #OST OF 3ALES 4HIS TRANSACTIONWILLBERECORDEDATCOSTPRICE
July 7
EXAMPLE
Sold stock for $590 cash (cost price $320).
&IGURESHOWSHOWTHISSALEWOULDBEENTEREDINTHELEDGERACCOUNTS Figure 3.9 Analysing Chart: cash sale Date
Accounts affected
July 7
Bank
Type of account
Increase/ Decrease
A
Increase
Sales
R
Increase
Cost of Sales
E
Increase
A
Decrease
Stock Control
Debit $
Credit $
590 590 320 320
7HENSTOCKISSOLD THEasset3TOCK#ONTROL BECOMESANexpense#OSTOF3ALES )NOTHERWORDS THESTOCKISNOLONGERAfutureECONOMICBENElT BECAUSEITSVALUEHAS BEENconsumed 4HECASHSALEWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 3.10 General Ledger: cash sale General Ledger Bank (A) Date
Cross-reference
July 1
Balance
Sales
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
1 000 590 Sales (R)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date July 7
Bank
590
Stock Control (A) Date July 1
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $
Date
4 000
July 7
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cost of Sales
320
Cost of Sales (E) Date July 7
Cross-reference Stock Control
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
320
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
46
UNITS 3&4
Effect on the accounting equation !CASHSALETHUSHASTHEFOLLOWINGEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
Increase (increase Bank $590, decrease Stock Control $320)
Liabilities
No effect
Owner’s Equity
Increase (Sales $590 less Cost of Sales $320 = Profit)
270
270
Credit sales ! CREDIT SALE IS ONE WHERE THE CUSTOMER TAKES THE GOODS BUT PROMISES TO PAY AT A LATERDATE!SWITHACASHSALE ACREDITSALEISREVENUEBECAUSEITCREATESANINmOWOF FUTUREECONOMICBENElTSINTHEFORMOFANINCREASEINASSETSTHATLEADSTOANINCREASE INOWNERSEQUITY4HEFACTTHATCASHHASNOTBEENRECEIVEDDOESNOTMEANTHATACREDIT SALEISNOTREVENUE4HEONLYDIFFERENCEISTHATFORACASHSALE THEINCREASEINASSETSISIN THEFORMOFcash ("ANK WHEREASFORACREDITSALE THEASSETISINTHEFORMOFANAMOUNT OWEDBYdebtors ($EBTORS#ONTROL
EXAMPLE
July 12 Sold goods on credit for $720 (cost price $480)
&IGURESHOWSHOWTHISSALEWOULDBEENTEREDINTHELEDGERACCOUNTS Figure 3.11 Date July 12
Analysing Chart: recording a credit sale Accounts affected
Type of account
Debtors Control Sales Cost of Sales Stock Control
Increase/ Decrease
Debit $
A
Increase
720
R
Increase
E
Increase
A
Decrease
Credit $
720 480 480
#REDITSALESSHOULDBERECOGNISEDASREVENUEINTHE2EPORTING0ERIODWHENTHESALE ISMADE BECAUSEITISATTHISPOINTTHATTHEINmOWOFFUTUREECONOMICBENElTSnINTHE FORMOFTHEINCREASEDAMOUNTOWEDBYTHEDEBTORSnOCCURS ANDASACONSEQUENCETHE REVENUEISEARNED&AILINGTOINCLUDECREDITSALESASREVENUEWOULDBEOMITTINGFROMTHE )NCOME3TATEMENTANIMPORTANTANDRelevantPIECEOFINFORMATION Effect on the accounting equation !CREDITSALETHUSHASTHEFOLLOWINGEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
)NCREASEINCREASE$EBTORS#ONTROL DECREASE3TOCK #ONTROL
Liabilities
.OEFFECT
Owner’s Equity
)NCREASE3ALESLESS#OSTOF3ALES0ROFIT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 3
THE GENERAL LEDGER
47
Receipts from debtors 4HE MOST COMMON ERROR IN RECORDING CASH RECEIVED FROM A DEBTOR IS TO TREAT IT AS ADDITIONALREVENUE RATHERTHANASSIMPLYTHESWAPPINGOFONEASSET$EBTORS#ONTROL FOR ANOTHER "ANK 4HE FACT THAT ASSETS DO NOT INCREASE OVERALL MEANS THAT A RECEIPT FROMADEBTORcannotBERECORDEDASREVENUEITDOESNOTlTTHEDElNITION)NADDITION RECORDINGARECEIPTFROMADEBTORASREVENUEWOULDBEDOUBLE COUNTINGTHEREVENUE WASALREADYRECORDEDnASACREDITSALEnWHENITWASEARNEDTHATIS ATTHEPOINTOFSALE WHENTHEGOODSWEREPROVIDEDTOTHECUSTOMER &IGURESHOWSHOWTHISRECEIPTFROMADEBTORWOULDBEENTEREDINTHELEDGER ACCOUNTS
EXAMPLE
July 24 $500 was received from a debtor
Figure 3.12 Analysing Chart: receipt from a debtor Date July 24
Accounts affected
Type of account
Bank Debtors Control
Increase/ Decrease
A
Increase
A
Decrease
Debit $
Credit $
500 500
4HE CREDIT SALE and THE RECEIPT FROM THE DEBTOR WOULD BE POSTED TO THE 'ENERAL ,EDGERASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 3.13 General Ledger: credit sale and receipt from a debtor General Ledger Bank (A) Date
Cross-reference
July 1
Balance
7 24
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
1 000
Sales
590
Debtors Control
500 Debtors Control (A)
Date
Cross-reference
July 1
Balance
12
Sales
Amount $
Date
3 000
July 24
Bank
500
720 Sales (R)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date July 7 12
Cross-reference
Amount $
Bank
590
Debtors Control
720
Cross-reference
Amount $
Stock Control (A) Date July 1
Cross-reference
Amount $
Balance
4 000
Date July 7
Cost of Sales
320
12
Cost of Sales
480
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
48
UNITS 3&4
Figure 3.13 (cont.) General Ledger: credit sale and receipt from a debtor Cost of Sales (E) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
July 7
Stock Control
320
12
Stock Control
480
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Drawings $RAWINGSREPRESENTSTHEVALUEOFTHEASSETSTHEOWNERHASWITHDRAWNFROMTHEBUSINESS !LTHOUGH IT IS CLASSIlED AS AN OWNERS EQUITY ACCOUNT BECAUSE IT RECORDS decreases IN OWNERS EQUITY IT IS IN FACT A negative OWNERS EQUITY ACCOUNT 4HIS ACCOUNT MUST THEREFOREBEdebitedWHENDRAWINGSOCCUR4HEACCOUNTTOBECREDITEDDEPENDSONTHE ASSETTHEOWNERHASWITHDRAWNIFCASHHASBEENWITHDRAWN "ANKWOULDBECREDITEDTO RECORDTHEDECREASEIFSTOCKHASBEENWITHDRAWN THEN3TOCK#ONTROLISCREDITED
EXAMPLE
July 28 Owner withdrew $650 in cash July 31 Owner took home stock worth $1200
&IGURESHOWSHOWTHESEDRAWINGSWOULDBEENTEREDINTHELEDGERACCOUNTS Figure 3.14 Analysing Chart: drawings Date July 28
Accounts affected
Type of account
Drawings
– OE
Increase
A
Decrease
– OE
Increase
A
Decrease
Bank 31
Drawings
Increase/ Decrease
Stock Control
Debit $
Credit $
650 650 1 200 1 200
4HESEENTRIESWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 3.15 General Ledger: drawings General Ledger Bank (A) Date
Cross-reference
July 1
Balance
7 24
Amount $
Date
1 000
July 28
Sales
590
Debtors Control
500
Cross-reference Drawings
Amount $ 650
Stock Control (A) Date
Cross-reference
July 1
Balance
Amount $ 4 000
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
July 7
Cost of Sales
320
12
Cost of Sales
480
31
Drawings
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
1 200
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 3
THE GENERAL LEDGER
49
Drawings (– OE) Date July 28 31
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
650
Stock Control
1 200
4OTALDRAWINGSnINTHISCASECASHANDWORTHOFSTOCK nISTHEN REPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETUNDERTHEHEADING@/WNERSEQUITY BUTASAdeduction FROM#APITAL ASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 3.16 Balance Sheet: owner’s equity Balance Sheet (extract) as at 30 June 2015 Owner’s Equity
$
$
Capital Plus Net Profit
30 000 5 400 35 400 1 850
33 550
Less Drawings
REVIEW QUESTIONS 3.5
1 Show the debit and credit entries necessary to record: s ACASHSALESTOCK s ACREDITSALEOFSTOCK s ARECEIPTFROMADEBTOR s CASHDRAWINGS 2 Explain why a receipt from a debtor does not increase profit.
3.6
THE TRIAL BALANCE
/NCEALLTRANSACTIONSHAVEBEENRECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER ITMUSTBECHECKEDTO SEETHATTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONSTILLBALANCESTHATIS THATTHETOTALDEBITSEQUALTHETOTAL CREDITS4HISCHECKISCARRIEDOUTBYPRESENTINGATrial Balance WHICHISALISTOFALLTHE LEDGERACCOUNTSANDTHEIRBALANCESTHEBALANCEBEINGTHENETAMOUNTLEFTINANACCOUNT
Footing an account Footing IS THE PROCESS OF CALCULATING THE BALANCE OF AN ACCOUNT AND INVOLVES THE FOLLOWINGSTEPS !DDINGUPALLTHEAMOUNTSONTHEdebitSIDE ANDPENCILLINGTHETOTALBELOWTHE LASTDEBITAMOUNT !DDINGUPALLTHEAMOUNTSONTHEcreditSIDE ANDPENCILLINGTHETOTALBELOWTHE LASTCREDITAMOUNT $EDUCTINGTHESMALLERTOTALFROMTHELARGERTOTAL 0ENCILLINGTHISlGUREnTHEBALANCEnONTHEside of the larger total ANDDRAWING ACIRCLEAROUNDIT 4HISBALANCESHOULDNOTBEWRITTENINTHESAMECOLUMNASTHEOTHERAMOUNTS BECAUSE THISRISKSINADVERTENTLYANDINCORRECTLY COUNTINGITASANENTRY4HEBALANCESHOULDBE WRITTEN IN THE CROSS REFERENCE SECTION TO MAKE IT CLEAR THAT IT IS NOT AN entry BUT THE balanceOFTHEACCOUNT&IGURESHOWSHOWTHE"ANKACCOUNTWOULDBEFOOTED
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Trial Balance a list of all the accounts in the General Ledger, and their balances, to determine if total debits EQUALTOTALCREDITS footing an informal process used to determine the balance of a ledger account
Cambridge University Press
50
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Figure 3.17 Footing an account Bank (A) Date March 1
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $
Date
12 500
March 3
Cross-reference
Amount $
Wages
4 000
15
Cash Sales
6 000
12
Rent
9 000
22
Debtors Control
3 400
25
Drawings
6 250
2 650 21 900
19 250
4HEBALANCEOFTHE"ANKACCOUNTISONTHEDEBITSIDE /NCEALLTHEACCOUNTSHAVEBEENFOOTED THEBALANCESARELISTEDINTWOCOLUMNSONE FOR$EBITBALANCES ANDONEFOR#REDITBALANCES4HECOLUMNSARETHENTOTALLEDANDnIF THELEDGERRECORDINGISCORRECTnTHETOTALSSHOULDBETHESAME&IGURESHOWSTHE 4RIAL"ALANCEFOR#LACKS3HOE3HOPASAT-ARCH Figure 3.18 Trial Balance CLACK’S SHOE SHOP (PROP. G. CLACK) Trial Balance as at 31 March 2015 Account
Debit
Bank
2 650
Stock Control Debtors Control Shop Fittings
Credit
24 700 8 900 33 100
Creditors Control
6 500
Loan – KH Bank
40 000
Capital – Clack
19 450
Sales
13 000
Cost of Sales
5 600
Rent
1 500
Wages
2 100 400
Advertising Totals
78 950
78 950
Errors revealed )FTHE4RIAL"ALANCEDOESnotBALANCE THELEDGERENTRIESHAVENOTBEENRECORDEDCORRECTLY PERHAPSBECAUSE s 4WOENTRIESHAVEBEENRECORDEDONTHEsame sideOFTHE'ENERAL,EDGER FOREXAMPLE TWODEBITSORTWOCREDITS INSTEADOFONEDEBITANDONECREDIT s /NLYone entryHASBEENRECORDEDFOREXAMPLE ONEDEBITENTRYWITHOUTA CORRESPONDINGCREDITENTRY ORVICEVERSA s Different amountsHAVEBEENRECORDEDONEACHSIDEFOREXAMPLE ONTHE DEBITSIDE BUTONTHECREDITSIDE )NTHISCASETHEENTRYTHATHASCAUSEDTHEDIFFERENCEBETWEENTHETWOTOTALSMUSTBE FOUND ANDCORRECTED
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 3
THE GENERAL LEDGER
Errors not revealed
51
STUDY TIP
)NSPITEOFITSBENElTS THEUSEFULNESSOFA4RIAL"ALANCEASADIAGNOSTICTOOLINDETECTING ERRORSISLIMITEDITWILLONLYDETECTERRORSIFTOTALDEBITSDONOTEQUALTOTALCREDITS/NE ORMOREOFTHEFOLLOWINGERRORSMAYBEPRESENTINTHELEDGERACCOUNTSEVENWHENTHE 4RIAL"ALANCEBALANCES s !TRANSACTIONHASBEENomittedALTOGETHER s 4HEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESHAVEBEENreversed. &OREXAMPLE INSTEADOF RECORDINGAPAYMENTTOACREDITORBYDEBITING#REDITORS#ONTROLANDCREDITING "ANK THEENTRYISERRONEOUSLYRECORDEDASADEBITTO"ANKANDACREDITTO#REDITORS #ONTROL s 4HETRANSACTIONHASBEENRECORDEDINTHEwrong ledger accounts.&OREXAMPLE INSTEADOFRECORDINGTHEPAYMENTOFWAGESASADEBITTOTHE7AGESACCOUNT THE TRANSACTIONISINCORRECTLYDEBITEDTO2ENT s !Nincorrect amountISRECORDEDONBOTHSIDESOFTHELEDGER .ONEOFTHESEINCORRECT ENTRIESWOULDBEDETECTEDORREVEALEDBYA4RIAL"ALANCE BECAUSEEACHOFTHEMSTILLHASAMATCHINGDEBITANDCREDITENTRY4HATIS EVENTHOUGH THEENTRYWOULDBEWRONG THEREWOULDSTILLBEANAMOUNTRECORDEDONTHEDEBITSIDE ANDANEQUALAMOUNTRECORDEDONTHECREDITSIDE4HE4RIAL"ALANCEISAUSEFULTOOL BUT ITWILLNOTDETECTALLTHEERRORSTHATMAYEXISTINTHELEDGER
)FTHE4RIAL"ALANCEDOES NOTBALANCE LOOKFORA TRANSACTIONINVOLVING THEAMOUNTIDENTIFIED ASTHEDIFFERENCE ORHALF ORTWICETHEDIFFERENCE ANDCHECKTHISENTRY FIRST
REVIEW QUESTIONS 3.6
1 2 3 4
State the purpose of a Trial Balance. Referring to ledger accounts, stateWHATISMEANTBYTHETERM@FOOTING List the steps involved in footing a ledger account. State three errors that will be detected by the preparation of a Trial Balance. 5 State four errors that will not be detected by the preparation of a Trial Balance.
3.7
BALANCING
&OOTINGISANINFORMALPROCESSTHATCANBEDONETOANYACCOUNTATANYTIMETODETERMINE ITSBALANCE"UTATTHEENDOFTHEREPORTINGPERIOD ASSET LIABILITYANDOWNERSEQUITY ACCOUNTSMUSTBEFORMALLYRULEDOFF ANDTHEIRBALANCECARRIEDFORWARDTOTHENEXTPERIOD SOTHATTHEIRBALANCESCANBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEET
Balancing procedure "OTHFOOTINGANDbalancingINVOLVECALCULATINGTHEBALANCEOFANACCOUNT BUTTHEREARE THREEMAINDIFFERENCES s "ALANCINGISDONEONLYATTHEENDOFTHEREPORTINGPERIOD s /NLYASSET LIABILITYANDOWNERSEQUITYACCOUNTSAREBALANCED2EVENUEANDEXPENSE ACCOUNTSAREclosed4HISWILLBECOVEREDINDETAILIN#HAPTER s "ALANCINGISAMOREFORMALPROCESS INVOLVINGAPROPERDOUBLEENTRYTHATIS ADEBIT ANDMATCHINGCREDITENTRY
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
balancing ruling off an asset, liability OROWNERSEQUITYACCOUNT to determine its balance at the end of the reporting period and transferring that balance to the next reporting period
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
52
UNITS 3&4
Steps for balancing "ALANCINGANACCOUNTINVOLVESTHEFOLLOWINGSTEPS 4OTALTHEAMOUNTSONEACHSIDE ANDWRITETHELARGEROFTHESETWOTOTALSONboth sides.)NTHEEXAMPLEBELOW THETRANSACTIONSONTHEDEBITSIDEADDUPTO ANDTHETRANSACTIONSONTHECREDITSIDEADDUPTOONLY SOISWRITTEN ON both sides4HISlGURESHOULDBE@RULEDOFFWITHADOUBLELINETOINDICATETHATIN THATREPORTINGPERIODTHEREARENOMORETRANSACTIONSTHATAFFECTTHEACCOUNT4HISIS NOTTHEbalanceOFTHEACCOUNTITISTHEtotal!TTHISPOINT THEAMOUNTSONONLYONE SIDEnINTHISCASETHEDEBITSIDEnWILLADDUPTOTHISTOTALOF #ALCULATETHEBALANCEBYDEDUCTINGTHETOTALOFTHESMALLERSIDEFROMTHETOTALOFTHE ACCOUNT)NTHEEXAMPLE THISIS TOTAL nSMALLERSIDE BALANCE %NTERTHISBALANCEASAPROPERLEDGERENTRYWITHAMATCHINGDEBITANDCREDITabove THETOTALONTHEsmallerSIDEandbelowTHETOTALONTHElargerSIDE4HISENTRY@CARRIES FORWARDTHEBALANCEFROMTHEENDOFONEREPORTINGPERIODTOTHESTARTOFTHENEXT 4HISISWHYINTHEEXAMPLETHEDATEISGIVENAS-ARCHaboveTHETOTALBUTAS!PRIL below &IGURESHOWSTHE@"ANKACCOUNTAFTERITHASBEENBALANCED Figure 3.19 ‘Balancing’ an account Bank (A) Date March 1 STUDY TIP
#OMPARETHIS@BALANCED ACCOUNTWITHTHE @FOOTEDACCOUNTIN &IGURE4HE BALANCEOFTHEACCOUNT ISTHESAME BUTTHIS ACCOUNTHASBEENMORE FORMALLYCOMPLETED
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $
Date
12 500
March 3
Cross-reference
Amount $
Wages
4 000
15
Cash Sales
6 000
12
Rent
9 000
22
Debtors Control
3 400
25
Drawings
6 250
31
Balance
2 650
21 900 April 1
Balance
21 900
2 650
)NTHISEXAMPLETHEBALANCEOFMUSTBERECORDEDon the credit side above the totalSOTHATTHECREDITSIDEEQUALS)TMUSTTHENBETRANSFERREDTOTHEdebit side, but below the total ASTHEOPENINGBALANCEFORTHENEXTPERIOD!PRIL REVIEW QUESTION 3.7
1 List three differences between footing and balancing a ledger account. 2 List the steps involved in balancing a ledger account. 3 ExplainWHYTHEENTRIESREQUIREDTOBALANCEALEDGERACCOUNTARESHOWNWITH different dates.
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 3
THE GENERAL LEDGER
53
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s s s s s s s s s s s
s
!LEDGERACCOUNTISANACCOUNTINGRECORDSHOWINGALLTHETRANSACTIONSTHATAFFECTAPARTICULARITEM 4HE'ENERAL,EDGERISTHECOLLECTIVENAMEFORTHEMAINGROUPOFLEDGERACCOUNTS 4HELEFT HANDSIDEOFALEDGERACCOUNTISTHEDEBITSIDETHERIGHT HANDSIDEISTHECREDITSIDE %VERYTRANSACTIONMUSTBERECORDEDINATLEASTTWOLEDGERACCOUNTS %VERYTRANSACTIONMUSTHAVEADEBITENTRYANDACREDITENTRY 4ORECORDANINCREASEINASSETSOREXPENSES RECORDTHETRANSACTIONONTHEdebitSIDE 4ORECORDANINCREASEINLIABILITIES OWNERSEQUITYORREVENUES RECORDTHETRANSACTIONONTHEcredit SIDE 4HECROSS REFERENCESPECIlESTHELINKBETWEENTWOACCOUNTSBYIDENTIFYINGTHEOTHERACCOUNTAFFECTED &OOTINGISANINFORMALPROCESSTOCALCULATETHEBALANCEOFANACCOUNT %RRORSA4RIAL"ALANCEwillREVEALTWOENTRIESRECORDEDONTHESAMESIDEONLYONEENTRYRECORDEDOR ADIFFERENTAMOUNTRECORDEDONEACHSIDE %RRORS A 4RIAL "ALANCE will not REVEAL A TRANSACTION OMITTED ALTOGETHER DEBIT AND CREDIT ENTRIES REVERSEDATRANSACTIONRECORDEDINTHEWRONGLEDGERACCOUNTSORANINCORRECTAMOUNTRECORDEDON BOTHSIDESOFTHELEDGER "ALANCINGINVOLVESRULINGOFFANASSET LIABILITYOROWNERSEQUITYACCOUNTTODETERMINEITSBALANCEAT THEENDOFTHECURRENTREPORTINGPERIODANDTRANSFERRINGTHATBALANCETOTHENEXTREPORTINGPERIOD
EXERCISE 3.1 RECORDING IN THE GENERAL LEDGER
W B
page 28
EXERCISES
*ANE'REENISANEXGROUNDS KEEPERWHOHASJUSTGONEINTOBUSINESSFORHERSELFSELLING LAWNSEED OPERATINGUNDERTHENAME2EAPAND3OW(ERTRANSACTIONSFORTHElRSTWEEK OF-AYARESHOWNBELOW -AY
#ONTRIBUTEDCASHTOCOMMENCEBUSINESS 2ENTEDASMALLOFlCE PAYINGRENTFOR-AY 0URCHASEDSTOCKWORTHONCREDITFROM,USH,AWNSEED 0AIDFOROFlCEFURNITURE 0AIDFORADVERTISINGINTHELOCALPAPER *ANECONTRIBUTEDTOTHEBUSINESSHERPERSONALCOMPUTERAGREEDVALUE
Required a PrepareAN!NALYSING#HARTTOSHOWTHEDOUBLEENTRYREQUIREDTORECORDEACHENTRY INTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF2EAPAND3OW b RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFORTHElRSTSIXDAYSOF-AYINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF 2EAPAND3OW c 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainWHYTHETRANSACTIONON-AY MUSTBERECORDEDINTHEACCOUNTSOFTHEBUSINESS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
54
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 3.2 RECORDING IN THE GENERAL LEDGER
W B
page 30
0HIL -EECUP JUST COMMENCED BUSINESS AS 1UICK 0ERK A COMPANY THAT SELLS COFFEE MACHINES4HEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSOCCURREDDURINGTHElRSTWEEKOF.OVEMBER .OV
0HILCONTRIBUTEDCASHTOCOMMENCEBUSINESS 0URCHASEDPREMISESFORUSINGAMORTGAGEFROMTHE"ANKOF2,- 0URCHASEDSTOCKWORTHONCREDITFROM.EW#AFFE3UPPLIES 0AIDWAGESTOOFlCEMANAGER 0HILWITHDREWCASHFORPERSONALUSE 0AIDFORADVERTISINGTHATWILLNOTBEGINUNTIL$ECEMBER 0AID.EW#AFFE3UPPLIES
Required a PrepareAN!NALYSING#HARTTOSHOWTHEDOUBLEENTRYREQUIREDTORECORDEACHENTRY INTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF1UICK0ERK b RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFORTHElRSTWEEKOF.OVEMBERINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER OF1UICK0ERK c 2EFERRINGTOTHEDElNITIONS explainWHYTHEADVERTISINGSHOULDBERECOGNISEDAS ACURRENTASSETASAT.OVEMBER
EXERCISE 3.3 CASH SALES IN THE GENERAL LEDGER
W B
page 32
-ELITA !NOGRA JUST OPENED -ELITA -OWS A SHOP SPECIALISING IN THE SALE OF MOWERS 4HElRMSTRANSACTIONSFORTHElRSTWEEKOF*ANUARYSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING *AN
#ONTRIBUTEDCAPITALTOCOMMENCEBUSINESSnCASHANDONEVEHICLE AGREEDVALUE 0AIDRENTOFFOR*ANUARY 0URCHASEDSTOCKONCREDITFORFROM(AVANNA-OWERS 3OLDONEMOWERFORCASHCOSTPRICE 0AIDWAGESOFASSISTANT 3OLDTWOMOWERSFORCASHEACHCOSTPRICE 0AIDTO(AVANNA-OWERS
Required a ExplainWHYTHEVEHICLECONTRIBUTEDON*ANUARYMUSTBEVALUEDATITSAGREED VALUE b PrepareAN!NALYSING#HARTTOSHOWTHEDOUBLEENTRYREQUIREDTORECORDEACHENTRY INTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF-ELITA-OWS c RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFORTHElRSTWEEKOF*ANUARYINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF -ELITA-OWS d StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOFTHETRANSACTIONON*ANUARY e Calculate'ROSS0ROlTFOR-ELITA-OWSFORTHElRSTWEEKOF*ANUARY
EXERCISE 3.4 CASH AND CREDIT SALES IN THE GENERAL LEDGER
W B
page 35
+IM3WOODJUSTOPENEDHEROWNSPAREPARTSSHOPCALLED-ONARO-OTORS4RANSACTIONS FOR!UGUSTSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 3
!UG
THE GENERAL LEDGER
#APITALCONTRIBUTIONOFSTOCKAGREEDVALUE ANDCASH 0URCHASEDPREMISESWORTHPAYINGACASHDEPOSITWITH THEBALANCEFUNDEDBYAMORTGAGEFROM16"ANK #ASHSALEOFPARTSFORCOSTPRICE 0AIDCASHTO7ILSON&ITTINGSFORSHELVING 0URCHASEDSTOCKONCREDITFROM(OL&ORD0ARTSFOR 3OLDPARTSONCREDITTO,EMON2ENTALSFORCOSTPRICE 0AIDWAGESOFAPPRENTICE +IM3WOODTOOKHOMESTOCKWORTH 2ECEIVEDCASHFROM,EMON2ENTALS
Required
*
a Prepare AN !NALYSING #HART TO SHOW THE DOUBLE ENTRY REQUIRED TO RECORD EACH TRANSACTIONINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF-ONARO-OTORS b RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR!UGUSTINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF-ONARO-OTORS c FootTHEACCOUNTSANDprepareA4RIAL"ALANCEASAT!UGUST d StateONEERRORTHATWOULDCAUSETHE4RIAL"ALANCETOnotBALANCE e 2EFERRINGTOTHEDElNITIONS explainWHYTHERECEIPTOFCASHFROM,EMON2ENTALSON !UGUSTSHOULDnotBEREPORTEDASREVENUE f StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF-ONARO-OTORSIFTHETRANSACTIONON !UGUSTHADnotBEENRECORDED
EXERCISE 3.5 OPENING BALANCES IN THE GENERAL LEDGER
W B
page 39
&INOULA/2ILEYOWNSASMALLSHOPCALLED(OT$OGGIESTHATSELLSDOG GROOMINGPRODUCTS &INOULA HAS BEEN OPERATING FOR THREE YEARS BUT ON *UNE DECIDED TO ADOPT A DOUBLE ENTRY RECORDING SYSTEM (ER OPENING ACCOUNT BALANCES ON *UNE WERE "ANK 3TOCK #ONTROL $EBTORS #ONTROL 3HELVING AND #APITALn/2ILEY 4RANSACTIONSFOR*UNESHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING *UNE
2ECEIVEDCASHFROMADEBTOR,YNX FORSTOCKSOLDIN-AY &INOULACONTRIBUTEDHERLAPTOPTOTHEBUSINESSAGREEDVALUE 3TOCKWASSOLDONCREDITTO!LLENDALE+ENNELSFORCOSTPRICE 0AIDWAGES 0URCHASEDSTOCKWORTHONCREDITFROM,AMINAR0RODUCTS #ASHSALESOFCOSTPRICE 2ECEIVEDFROM!LLENDALE+ENNELS 0URCHASEDEXTRASHELVINGFORCASH #ASHSALESOFCOSTPRICE 0AIDFORREPAIRSTOSOMEOFTHEOLDSHELVING 3TOCKWASSOLDONCREDITTO*OANIES$OG7ASHFORCOSTPRICE 0AIDWAGES
Required
*
a RecordTHEOPENINGBALANCESINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF(OT$OGGIES b RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR*UNEINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF(OT$OGGIES c 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainWHYTHECASHRECEIVEDFROM,YNXON *UNESHOULDnotBEREPORTEDASREVENUEFOR*UNE d StateTHEPURPOSEOFA4RIAL"ALANCE e FootTHEACCOUNTSANDprepareA4RIAL"ALANCEFOR(OT$OGGIESASAT*UNE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
55
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
56
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 3.6 OPENING BALANCES IN THE GENERAL LEDGER
W B
page 43
0AUL-C-ARTINISTHEOWNEROPERATOROF"RIGHT#AMPING ABUSINESSTHATSELLSCAMPING GEAR/N/CTOBER 0AULDECIDEDTOADOPTADOUBLE ENTRYRECORDINGSYSTEM4HE lRMSBALANCESONTHATDATEWEREASFOLLOWS3TOCK#ONTROL $EBTORS#ONTROL 3HOP&ITTINGS 0REMISES ,OANn(IGHLAND"ANK #REDITORS#ONTROLAND"ANK/VERDRAFT 4HETRANSACTIONSFOR/CTOBERWEREASFOLLOWS /CT
3OLDSTOCKONCREDITTO3LEEPY(OLLOW#ARAVAN0ARKFORCOSTPRICE 0URCHASEDNEWSHOPFITTINGSFORnPAIDINCASHWITHTHEREMAINDER FINANCEDBYASHORT TERMLOANFROM0UNKAH#REDIT#O 2ECEIVEDCASHFROMADEBTOR-ILAWA!DVENTURES #ASHSALESOFCOSTPRICE 0AULPAIDFORTHEFIRMSADVERTISINGUSINGAPERSONALCHEQUE 0URCHASEDSTOCKONCREDITFROM(ARDY#AMP'EARFOR 0AIDWAGESOF 2ECEIVEDCASHFROM3LEEPY(OLLOW 3OLDSTOCKONCREDITTO(IGH0EAK!DVENTURESFORCOSTPRICE 0AIDTOACREDITORn*ILLAROOS#HOICE
Required
*
a RecordTHEOPENINGBALANCESINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF"RIGHT#AMPING b RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR/CTOBERINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF"RIGHT#AMPING c ExplainTHEIMPORTANCEOFACROSS REFERENCEWHENRECORDINGTRANSACTIONSINLEDGER ACCOUNTS d FootTHEACCOUNTSANDprepareA4RIAL"ALANCEFOR"RIGHT#AMPINGASAT/CTOBER e StateTWOERRORSINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERTHATWILLnotBEDETECTEDBYA4RIAL"ALANCE
EXERCISE 3.7 IDENTIFYING TRANSACTIONS
W B
page 47
-IRA 6AN 3ANDEN IS A PHOTOGRAPHER WHO OWNS AND OPERATES A SHOP IN -ELBOURNE CALLED0ERFECT0HOTOGRAPHS4HElRMS'ENERAL,EDGERFOR$ECEMBERSHOWEDTHE FOLLOWING Bank (A) Date
Cross-reference
Dec. 1
Balance
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
1 000
$EC
/FFICE%QUIPMENT
$EC
2EPAIRS
3ALES
$EBTORS#ONTROL
Stock Control (A)
Date Dec. 1
Cross-reference Balance #REDITORS#ONTROL
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
5 000
$EC
#OSTOF3ALES
#OSTOF3ALES
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Amount $
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 3
THE GENERAL LEDGER
Debtors Control (A) Date
Cross-reference
Dec. 1
Balance
3ALES
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
1 700
$EC
"ANK
Amount $
Office Equipment (A)
Date
Cross-reference
Dec. 1
Balance
"ANK
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
4 000
$EC
$RAWINGS
Amount $
Creditors Control (L)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Dec. 1
Balance
Amount $ 1 100
3TOCK#ONTROL
Capital (OE) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Dec. 1
Cross-reference
Amount $
Balance
10 600
Sales (R) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
$EC
"ANK
$EBTORS#ONTROL
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
Amount $
Drawings (– OE) Date $EC
Cross-reference
Amount $
/FFICE%QUIPMENT
Date
Cost of Sales (E) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
$EC
3TOCK#ONTROL
3TOCK#ONTROL
Date
Repairs (E) Date
Cross-reference
$EC
"ANK
Amount $
Date
Required
*
a 5SINGTHE'ENERAL,EDGER describeEACHTRANSACTIONINDATEORDER b CalculateTHERATEOFMARK UPTHATISAPPLIEDTOSTOCK c PrepareA4RIAL"ALANCEFOR0ERFECT0HOTOGRAPHSASAT$ECEMBER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
57
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
58
UNITS 3&4
/N $ECEMBER -IRA PAID FOR OFlCE EXPENSES 4HE TRANSACTION WAS POSTEDINTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERASFOLLOWS Ledger account /FFICE%QUIPMENT
Debit $
Credit $
200
Bank
200
d StateWHETHERTHE4RIAL"ALANCEWOULDIDENTIFYTHISERRORJustifyYOURANSWER e StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF0ERFECT0HOTOGRAPHSIFTHISERROR WASnotCORRECTED f ShowTHEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESNECESSARYTOCORRECTTHISERROR
EXERCISE 3.8 TRANSACTIONS TO REPORTS
W B
page 49
4URNING 0OINTS IS A lRM THAT SELLS EXERCISE MACHINERY )TS OWNER 4RACEY .ICOLE HAS DECIDEDTOADOPTADOUBLE ENTRYRECORDINGSYSTEM!T*ULY THElRMSASSETSAND LIABILITIESWEREASFOLLOWS "ANK 3TOCK#ONTROL $EBTORS#ONTROL /FFICE%QUIPMENT 0REMISES #REDITORS#ONTROL -ORTGAGEn*(&INANCE
4HElRMSTRANSACTIONSFOR*ULYSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING *ULY
#ASHSALETO2$ONNEGANCOSTPRICE 0AIDFORELECTRICITY #REDITSALESTO,OWDOWN'YMCOSTPRICE 0URCHASEDSTOCKONCREDITFROM(AVILLAND-ACHINES 0AIDWAGES #REDITSALESTO3T-ARTINS(OSPITALCOSTPRICE 2ECEIVEDCASHFROM7ALKERS7ORLDFORGOODSSOLDIN*UNE 0AIDCASHTO(AVILLAND-ACHINES -ADEMONTHLYPAYMENTONMORTGAGEINCLUDINGINTEREST 4RACEYTOOKHOMEANEXERCISEMACHINEFORHERSON 0AIDWAGES #ASHSALETO*.OTTSCOSTPRICE 2ECEIVEDCASHFROM,OWDOWN'YM 0AIDINADVANCEFORSIXMONTHSADVERTISING WHICHWILLBEGIN IN!UGUST
Required
*
a b c d e f
* *
g h i
Calculate4RACEYSCAPITALASAT*ULY RecordTHEOPENINGBALANCESINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF4URNING0OINTS RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR*ULYINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF4URNING0OINTS BalanceTHEACCOUNTSWHEREAPPROPRIATE ANDprepareA4RIAL"ALANCEASAT*ULY StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF4URNING0OINTSIFTHETRANSACTIONON *ULYWASnotRECORDED 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainWHYTHETRANSACTIONON*ULYIS notCONSIDEREDTOBEREVENUEFOR*ULY PrepareAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR4URNING0OINTSFOR*ULY PrepareACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR4URNING0OINTSASAT*ULY 2EFERRING TO ONE QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTIC explain WHY THE ADVERTISING MUST BE REPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETASAT*ULY
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s explainTHEEFFECTOFTHE 'OODSAND3ERVICES4AX'34 ONTHEACCOUNTINGSYSTEMOFA SMALLBUSINESS s explainTHEROLEOFTHE'34 #LEARINGACCOUNT s explainTHECIRCUMSTANCESIN WHICHA'34REFUNDAND'34 SETTLEMENTWILLOCCUR s explainTHEROLEOFSOURCE DOCUMENTSINTHEACCOUNTING PROCESS INCLUDINGTHEIR RELATIONSHIPTOTHEACCOUNTING PRINCIPLESANDQUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICS s identifyANDrecord TRANSACTIONSVERIlEDBYA
s identifyANDexplainTHEROLE OFASTATEMENTOFACCOUNTAND ANORDERFORM s identifyTHEEFFECTOF'34ON THERECORDINGOFCASHAND CREDITSALESANDPURCHASES ANDONTHEACCOUNTING EQUATION s report'34#LEARINGINTHE "ALANCE3HEET
n CASHRECEIPT n CHEQUEBUTT n SALESINVOICE n PURCHASEINVOICE n MEMO
CHAPTER 4
THE GOODS AND SERVICES TAX (GST) KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s 'OODSAND 3ERVICES4AX'34
s SALESINVOICE
s SOURCEDOCUMENTS
s MEMO
s CASHRECEIPT
s STATEMENTOFACCOUNT
s CHEQUEBUTT
s ORDERFORM
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
s PURCHASEINVOICE
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
60
4.1 Goods and Services Tax (GST) a 10% tax levied by the federal government on most purchases of goods (excluding fresh food) and services
UNITS 3&4
THE GOODS AND SERVICES TAX (GST)
4HEINTRODUCTIONOFTHEGoods and Services Tax (GST)IN*ULYMEANTTHATINADDITION TOBEINGTRADINGOPERATIONS ANUMBEROFSMALLBUSINESSESBECAMETAXCOLLECTORSFORTHE !USTRALIAN4AX/FlCE!4/ 5NDERTHE'34nWHICHAPPLIESTOMOSTGOODSEXCEPTFRESH FOOD ANDSERVICESnTHEFEDERALGOVERNMENTCHARGESCONSUMERSATAXOFOFTHE PRICEOFWHATEVERTHEYHAVEPURCHASED4HISMEANSTHEBUSINESSTHATSELLSTHEGOOD SERVICEMUSTCHARGEANDCOLLECTFROMTHECUSTOMERTHESELLINGPRICEplusANAMOUNTFOR '344HE'34AMOUNTISTHENTRANSFERREDTOTHE!4/BYTHEBUSINESSATALATERDATE 7HENABUSINESSCHARGESITSCUSTOMERS'34 ITDOESSOONBEHALFOFTHEGOVERNMENT !SARESULT ANYGST on salesCREATESALIABILITYnANAMOUNTOF'34OWEDTOTHE!4/ )FTHEBUSINESSHASBEENCHARGEDANY'34BYITSSUPPLIERS ITISALLOWEDTODEDUCTTHIS GST on purchases FROMITS'34LIABILITY4HE'34ONITSPURCHASESWILLBEFORWARDEDTO THE!4/BYTHElRMSSUPPLIERS SOITISTREATEDASIFTHEBUSINESSHADACTUALLYPAIDTHE '34STRAIGHTTOTHEGOVERNMENT !TTHEENDOFTHEPERIOD THEBUSINESSMUSTCALCULATEHOWMUCH'34OVERALLITOWES TO THE !4/ OR WHETHER IT IS OWED A REFUND BY THE !4/ 4HIS MEANS THE ACCOUNTING SYSTEMMUSTBECAPABLEOFIDENTIFYING RECORDINGANDREPORTINGFORTHEEFFECTSOF'34
Recording GST !LL TRANSACTIONS INVOLVING '34 ARE RECORDED IN A NEW LEDGER ACCOUNT CALLED @'34 #LEARING WHICHCANEITHERBEACURRENTLIABILITYORACURRENTASSET GST liability "ECAUSE SELLING PRICES ARE USUALLY HIGHER THAN COST PRICES IN MOST CASES the GST on sales will be greater than the GST on purchases SO THE BUSINESS WILL HAVE A current liabilityINRELATIONTO'344HISMEANSTHAT OVERALL THEBUSINESSWILLOWE'34TOTHE !4/ WHICHITWILLPAYWHENITMAKESA'34SETTLEMENT GST asset )F THE BUSINESS MAKES A BULK ORDER OF STOCK WHICH IT HAS NOT SOLD OR PURCHASES AN EXPENSIVENON CURRENTASSET THENITSGST on purchases could be greater than its GST on sales SOTHEBUSINESSWILLHAVEAcurrent assetINRELATIONTO'344HISMEANSTHE BUSINESSWILLBEOWED'34BYTHE!4/ WHICHITWILLRECEIVEINTHEFORMOFA'34REFUND
REVIEW QUESTIONS 4.1 1 Define THETERM@'OODSAND3ERVICES4AX'34 2 Explain WHY'34ONSALESCREATESA'34LIABILITY 3 Explain WHY'34ONPURCHASESLEADSTOAREDUCTIONINANY'34LIABILITY 4 State THEROLEOFTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNT 5 Explain WHYMOSTSMALLBUSINESSWILLENDUPWITHA'34LIABILITYATTHEEND OFTHEPERIOD 6 State TWOWAYSASMALLBUSINESSCOULDENDUPBEINGOWEDA'34REFUNDBY THE!4/
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 4
4.2
T H E G O O D S A N D S E R V I C E S TA X ( G S T )
61
SOURCE DOCUMENTS
4HEEXERCISESIN#HAPTERINVOLVINGRECORDINGTRANSACTIONSINTHELEDGER WEREGENERALLY PRESENTEDASALIST WITHTHEDATEANDDETAILSOFTHETRANSACTIONSPELTOUTCLEARLY4HIS IS NOT A LUXURY AFFORDED TO BOOKKEEPERS IN REAL BUSINESSES )N A FUNCTIONING BUSINESS THEINFORMATIONWOULDBECONTAINEDONTHEsource documents ANDPARTOFTHEJOBOF THEBOOKKEEPERWOULDBETOSORTTHEDOCUMENTS ANDDECIPHERTHEINFORMATIONTHEY CONTAIN 3OURCEDOCUMENTSCOMEINAVARIETYOFSHAPESANDSIZES BUTHAVEINCOMMONONE ESSENTIALQUALITYTHEYPROVIDETHEEVIDENCE ORPROOF THATATRANSACTIONHASOCCURRED )NFACT SOURCEDOCUMENTSARETHElRSTSTAGEINTHEACCOUNTINGPROCESSSEE&IGURE ANDPROVIDETHEFACTSANDDETAILSONWHICHALLSUBSEQUENTACCOUNTINGINFORMATIONWILL BEBASED
source documents printed or electronic documents that provide evidence that a transaction has occurred, and the details of the transaction itself
Figure 4.1 The accounting process
Source documents
Records
Reports
Advice
"ECAUSESOURCEDOCUMENTSPROVIDETHEEVIDENCEOFTHEDETAILSOFEVERYTRANSACTION THEYAREINTEGRALINENSURINGTHATACCOUNTINGREPORTSCONTAININFORMATIONTHATISreliable ORFREEFROMERRORS BIASANDSUBJECTIVITY
Source documents and the GST "ECAUSEOFTHE'34 SOURCEDOCUMENTSMUSTINCLUDETHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATION s THEWORDS@TAXINVOICESTATEDCLEARLY s THENAMEOFTHESELLER s THE!USTRALIAN"USINESS.UMBER!". OFTHESELLER s THEDATEOFTHETRANSACTION s ADESCRIPTIONOFTHEGOODSERVICEPROVIDED s THEPRICEOFTHETRANSACTION INCLUDINGTHE'34 s THEAMOUNTOFTHE'34 3ALES OF MORE THAN MUST ALSO SHOW THE NAME AND ADDRESS OR !". OF THE BUYER7ITHOUTTHESEDETAILS THESOURCEDOCUMENTSCANNOTBEUSEDTOSUBSTANTIATE'34 TRANSACTIONS ANDTHEBUSINESSMAYENDUPPAYINGTOTHE!4/MORE'34THANISREQUIRED Calculating GST !LTHOUGHATAXINVOICEMUSTSPECIFYTHEAMOUNTOFTHE'34 ITISSTILLUSEFULTOUNDERSTAND THERELATIONSHIPBETWEEN s THESELLINGPRICEOFTHEGOODSERVICEexcluding GST s THE'34ITSELF s THE total price OFTHETRANSACTIONincluding GST )NITSSIMPLESTFORM '34ISCALCULATEDASOFTHESELLINGPRICE ANDADDEDTOTHE SELLINGPRICETODETERMINETHE total price ASSHOWNIN&IGURE STUDY TIP
Figure 4.2 Calculating GST and total price (including GST )
Example
Selling price
+
GST (selling price x 10%)
=
Total price (including GST)
$350
+
$35
=
$385
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
5SETHISMETHODWHEN AQUESTIONSAYS@PLUS '34
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
62
UNITS 3&4
!T OTHER TIMES IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO WORK backwards FROM THE total price TO DETERMINEEITHERTHE'34OFTHEtotal price ORTHESELLINGPRICEOFTHEtotal price &IGURESHOWSTHISRELATIONSHIP STUDY TIP
5SETHISMETHOD WHENAQUESTIONSAYS @INCLUDING'34
Figure 4.3 Calculating GST or selling price from total price
Example
Total price (including GST)
=
Selling price (10/11 of total price)
+
GST (1/11 of total price)
$385
=
$350
+
$35
REVIEW QUESTIONS 4.2
1 2EFERRING TO ONE QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTIC explain THE ROLE OF SOURCE DOCUMENTSINTHEACCOUNTINGPROCESS 2 List THEINFORMATIONTHATMUSTBESHOWNONASOURCEDOCUMENTTHATINCLUDES '34 3 ShowHOWTHE'34WILLAFFECTTHECALCULATIONOF s TOTALPRICEWHENGIVENSELLINGPRICE s SELLINGPRICE'34WHENGIVENTOTALPRICE
4.3
cash receipt a source document used to verify cash received
CASH INFLOWS AND CASH RECEIPTS
7HENCASHISRECEIVED THEBUSINESSWILLISSUEAcash receiptTOTHECUSTOMER ANDKEEP A COPY OF THE RECEIPT FOR ITS OWN RECORDS 4HE CASH RECEIPT CAN BE HAND WRITTEN OR GENERATEDELECTRONICALLYORBYACASHREGISTER3OMESMALLERBUSINESSESWILLNOTISSUEAN INDIVIDUALISEDRECEIPTTOEVERYCUSTOMER PREFERRINGINSTEADTOISSUEONLYACASHREGISTER RECEIPT ANDRELYONTHESUMMARYGENERATEDBYTHEREGISTERTOVERIFYTHECASHRECEIVED IN A SINGLE DAYS TRADING 2EGARDLESS OF THE TYPE OF RECEIPT ISSUED IT SHOULD CONTAIN ALL THE INFORMATION NECESSARY TO ACCOUNT FOR THE '34 PLUS A RECEIPT NUMBER FOR EASY IDENTIlCATIONANDVERIlCATION
Cash sales and the GST !TTHETIMEACASHSALEISMADE THEBUSINESSWILLRECEIVETHECASHFORTHEGOODS PLUS THE'34ONTHESALE ANDTHISMUSTBEDOCUMENTEDONACASHRECEIPT4HE'34DOESNOT AFFECTTHESALESREVENUEEARNED ORTHECOSTOFTHESTOCKSOLDINSTEAD ITISANADDITIONAL AMOUNTCOLLECTEDONBEHALFOF ANDTHEREFOREOWEDTO THE!4/
EXAMPLE
On 7 April 2015, Snaps Photographic Equipment sold a Menolta camera to J. Mortlock for $400 plus $40 GST (Rec. 17). The camera had a cost price of $250.
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 4
T H E G O O D S A N D S E R V I C E S TA X ( G S T )
4HECASHRECEIPTTHATPROVIDESEVIDENCEOFTHISCASHSALEISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 4.4 Cash receipt (hand-written): cash sale
Snaps Photographic Equipment
TAX INVOICE
22 Grace St, Essendon VIC 3041
ABN: 11 049 411 049
Date:
7/4/2015
Received from:
J. Mortlock
The sum of:
Four hundred dollars plus forty dollars GST
Being for:
Cash sale – Menolta camera
Amount:
$440.00
Receipt:
17
J. Buckley
Signed:
3UCHARECEIPTCOULDEASILYBEGENERATEDELECTRONICALLY ASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 4.5 Cash receipt (electronically generated): cash sale
Snaps Photographic Equipment
TAX INVOICE
22 Grace St, Essendon VIC 3041
ABN: 11 049 411 049
Date:
7/4/2015
Receipt:
17
Received from: J. Mortlock For:
Cash sale of 1 Menolta camera
Amount:
$440.00 (incl. $40.00 GST)
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
63
64
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
%XACTLYTHESAMEINFORMATIONISPROVIDEDONBOTHVERSIONS s THEWORDS@TAXINVOICE s THEDATEOFTHETRANSACTION s THERECEIPTNUMBER s THENAMEAND!".OFTHESELLER3NAPS0HOTOGRAPHIC%QUIPMENT s ADESCRIPTIONOFWHATHASBEENSOLDONE-ENOLTACAMERA s THESELLINGPRICEINCLUSIVEOFTHE'34$440 4HISISTHEAMOUNTOFCASHRECEIVED s THEAMOUNTOFTHE'34 4HISMEANSTHESELLINGPRICEOFTHECAMERAIS .OTE THAT THE COST PRICE OF THE SALE IS NOT SHOWN BECAUSE WE DO NOT WANT TO DISCLOSEOURMARK UPTOTHEBUYER Identifying sales revenue "OTHOFTHEPRECEDINGDOCUMENTSIDENTIFYTHETOTALCASHOF$440 THAT 3NAPS0HOTOGRAPHIC %QUIPMENTHASRECEIVEDFROMTHECUSTOMER"ECAUSETHETOTALCASHRECEIVEDINCLUDES '34ONTHESALEWHICHISCOLLECTEDONBEHALFOF ANDTHEREFOREOWEDTO THE!4/ NOTALLOFTHIS$440CANBERECORDEDASSALESREVENUEONLYCANBECOUNTEDASSALES REVENUEEARNEDBY3NAPS0HOTOGRAPHIC%QUIPMENT 4HIS SALES REVENUE lGURE IS IDENTIlED DIFFERENTLY IN THE PRECEDING DOCUMENTS 7HEREAS&IGURESEPARATELYIDENTIlESTHESALESREVENUEOF IN&IGURETHIS AMOUNTMUSTBECALCULATEDBYDEDUCTINGTHE'34 FROMTHETOTALAMOUNTRECEIVED $440
Recording a cash sale with GST (ADWERECORDEDTHECASHSALEOFTHECAMERAwithout'34 THEDEBITSANDCREDITSINTHE LEDGERACCOUNTSWOULDHAVEBEEN $2 #2 $2 #2
"ANK #ASH3ALES #OSTOF3ALES 3TOCK#ONTROL
.OWTHAT'34ISINVOLVED THEPROCESSTORECORDACASHSALEINTHELEDGERMUSTBE AMENDED BUTONLYALITTLE4HECOSTPRICEOFTHESALEISNOTAFFECTEDATALL ANDNEITHERIS THEAMOUNTOFSALESREVENUEEARNED(OWEVER THEAMOUNTDEBITEDTOBankWILLINCREASE BECAUSETHEBUSINESSWILLRECEIVENOTONLYTHEFORTHESALE BUTALSO'34!SA RESULT THEDEBITSANDCREDITSTORECORDACASHSALEWITH'34WOULDBE DR #2 #2 $2 #2
Bank #ASH3ALES '34#LEARING #OSTOF3ALES 3TOCK#ONTROL
$440
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 4
T H E G O O D S A N D S E R V I C E S TA X ( G S T )
4HISENTRYWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 4.6 General Ledger: recording a cash sale with GST General Ledger Bank (A) Date April 1 7
Cross-reference
Amount $
Balance
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
April 7
Bank
1 000
Sales/GST Clearing
440 Sales (R)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
400
GST Clearing (A or L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
April 7
Bank
Amount $ 40
Stock Control (A) Date April 1
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
15 000
April 7
Cost of Sales
Amount $ 250
Cost of Sales (E) Date
Cross-reference
April 7
Stock Control
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
250
4HE CROSS REFERENCE IN THE "ANK ACCOUNT REFERS TO BOTH 3ALES AND '34 #LEARING BECAUSETHECASHRECEIVEDCONSISTSOFPARTSALESANDPART'344HEENTRYONTHECREDIT SIDE OF THE '34 #LEARING ACCOUNT SHOWS THE LIABILITY OWED TO THE !4/ FOR THE TAX COLLECTEDBYTHEBUSINESS WHICHTHEBUSINESSMUSTFORWARDTOTHE!4/ATSOMETIMEIN THEFUTURE Effect on the accounting equation !CASHSALEWITH'34HASTHEFOLLOWINGEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION Increase/Decrease/No effect Assets
Increase (increase Bank $440, decrease Stock Control $250)
Liabilities
Increase (GST Clearing)
Owner’s Equity
Increase (Sales $400 less Cost of Sales $250 = Profit)
Amount $ 190 40 150
Other cash inflows #ASHRECEIPTSSHOULDBEISSUEDEVERYTIMECASHISRECEIVED WHETHERITISFORACASHSALE A RECEIPTFROMADEBTOR ACAPITALCONTRIBUTIONORSOMEOTHERSOURCE4HEONLYEXCEPTIONS AREWHENCASHISDEPOSITEDDIRECTLYINTOTHEBUSINESSSBANKACCOUNT INWHICHCASETHE SOURCEDOCUMENTMIGHTSIMPLYBETHEBANKSTATEMENT
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
65
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
66
UNITS 3&4
&IGURESHOWSTHECASHRECEIPTTOPROVIDEEVIDENCEOFARECEIPTFROMADEBTOR
Snaps Photographic Equipment
22 Grace St, Essendon VIC 3041
TAX INVOICE ABN: 11 049 411 049
Date:
30th April 2015
Received from:
Moondance Club
For:
Settlement of account
Amount:
$2 000.00
Receipt:
99
Figure 4.7 Cash receipt: receipt from a debtor
STUDY TIP
)NTHE6#%!CCOUNTING 3TUDY$ESIGN TRANSACTIONSTHATARE SUBJECTTO'34WILL BEIDENTIlED BUTTHE AMOUNTMAYNOTBE
)NTHISCASE THEREASONFORTHERECEIPTREFERSTO@SETTLEMENTOFACCOUNT INDICATING THATTHECASHHASBEENRECEIVEDFROMADEBTOR-OONDANCE#LUB TOSETTLETHEAMOUNT OUTSTANDING)TISALSOIMPORTANTTOIDENTIFYTHENAMEOFTHEDEBTORFROMWHOMTHECASH ISRECEIVED4HISALLOWSTHETRANSACTIONTOBERECORDEDINTHE$EBTORS,EDGER4HISWILL BEEXPLAINEDIN#HAPTER 4HEREISNO'34TOACCOUNTFORWHENCASHISRECEIVEDFROMADEBTOR BECAUSETHE '34ISRECOGNISEDANDREPORTEDONLYATTHETIMESALESAREMADE)NFACT ARECEIPTFROM ADEBTORISJUSTONEOFTHECASHINmOWSTHATISNOTSUBJECTTO'34 WITHOTHERSINCLUDING s INTERESTREVENUE s CAPITALCONTRIBUTIONS s LOANS
REVIEW QUESTIONS 4.3
1 2 3 4 5
StateTHESOURCEDOCUMENTUSEDTOVERIFYCASHRECEIVED ShowTHEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDACASHSALEWITH'34 ExplainWHYTHE'34RECEIVEDONACASHSALEINCREASESTHE'34LIABILITY ListTHREEDIFFERENTTRANSACTIONSFORWHICHACASHRECEIPTMAYBEISSUED ExplainWHYTHEREISNO'34TOACCOUNTFORWHENCASHISRECEIVEDFROM ADEBTOR
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 4
4.4
T H E G O O D S A N D S E R V I C E S TA X ( G S T )
67
CASH OUTFLOWS AND CHEQUE BUTTS
$ESPITETHERISINGPROMINENCEOFONLINEBANKING THEREARESTILLANUMBEROFSITUATIONSIN WHICHITISNECESSARY ANDPERHAPSEVENDESIRABLE FORABUSINESSTOPAYBYCHEQUE4HE MAINBENElTSOFPAYINGBYCHEQUEINCLUDE s securitynPAYINGBYCHEQUEAVOIDSTHERISKSOFCARRYINGLARGESUMSOFCASH ANDTHE DANGEROFTHEFTTHISENTAILS s traceabilitynCHEQUESMUSTBEDEPOSITEDINTOABANKACCOUNT MEANINGITISPOSSIBLE TOTRACETHEEVENTUALRECIPIENTOFTHEFUNDS s verifiability n ALL PAYMENTS MADE BY CHEQUE ARE RECORDED ON THE CHEQUE BUTT PROVIDINGASOURCEDOCUMENTTOVERIFYTHETRANSACTION !STHECHEQUEITSELFISGIVENASPAYMENT ITISTHE cheque butt THATWILLBERETAINED BYTHEBUSINESSASEVIDENCEOFTHECASHITHASPAID%VENIFACHEQUEISCANCELLED THE CHEQUEBUTTSHOULDSTILLBECOMPLETEDTOVERIFYTHATTHECHEQUEHASNOTBEENSTOLEN
cheque butt a source document used to verify cash payments
Cash payments and the GST !T THE TIME A CASH PAYMENT IS MADE THE BUSINESS WILL PAY CASH FOR WHATEVER IT IS PURCHASING plusTHE'34ONTHEPURCHASE ANDTHISMUSTBEDOCUMENTEDONTHECHEQUE BUTT4HE'34PAIDDOESNOTCHANGETHEVALUEOFWHATISPURCHASEDnITWILLDECREASE THE'34LIABILITY
EXAMPLE
On 14 April 2015, Snaps Photographic Equipment paid $1 320 for 12 months’ insurance: $1 200 plus $120 GST (Ch. 245).
4HECHEQUEBUTTTHATPROVIDESEVIDENCEOFTHISPAYMENTISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 4.8 Cheque butt Pig-e-Bank Australia
ABN 49 100 001 222
14th April 2015 Date .............................................................. AGI Insurance To.................................................................. Yearly insurance For ................................................................ $1 200 (+$120 GST) ..................................................................... Bal c/fwd $ ................................................... Deposits $ ....................................................
$1 320.00 Amount ....................................................... Balance $...................................................... CHQ No. 245
4HISCHEQUEBUTTPROVIDESALLTHEINFORMATIONWENEEDTORECORDTHETRANSACTION BUT TOSATISFYTHE!4/ WEWOULDALSONEEDTOKEEPTHETAXINVOICEISSUEDBYTHESUPPLIER
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
68
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Recording a cash payment with GST (ADWERECORDEDTHECASHPAYMENTFORINSURANCEwithout'34 THEDEBITSANDCREDITSIN THELEDGERACCOUNTSWOULDHAVEBEEN $2 #2
0REPAID)NSURANCE
"ANK
.OTE THAT THE DEBIT ENTRY IS TO AN ASSET ACCOUNT CALLED 0REPAID )NSURANCE 4HE INSURANCEISYETTOBEINCURRED SOITISAfutureECONOMICBENElT 7ITH'34INVOLVED THEAMOUNTOFCASHPAIDWILLINCREASE4HEBUSINESSMUSTPAY FORTHEINSURANCE PLUS'344HISMEANSBankWILLDECREASEBY$1 320IN TOTAL!SARESULT THEDEBITSANDCREDITSTORECORDACASHPAYMENTWITH'34WOULDBE $2 $2 CR
0REPAID)NSURANCE '34#LEARING Bank
1320
4HISENTRYWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 4.9 General Ledger: cash payment with GST General Ledger Bank (A) Date April 1 7
Cross-reference
Amount $
Balance
1 000
Sales/GST Clearing
Date
Cross-reference
April 14
Prepaid Insurance/
440
Amount $ 1 320
GST Clearing
Prepaid Insurance (A) Date April 14
Cross-reference
Amount $
Bank
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Amount $
1 200 GST Clearing (A or L)
Date April 14
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
120
April 7
Bank
Bank
40
/NCEAGAIN THECROSS REFERENCEINTHE"ANKACCOUNTREFERSTOBOTH0REPAID)NSURANCE AND'34#LEARINGASBOTHAMOUNTSHAVEBEENPAID!LTHOUGHTHE'34ISPAIDTOTHE SUPPLIERWHICHINTHISCASEIS!'))NSURANCE THATSUPPLIERISTHENOBLIGEDTOFORWARDTHE '34TOTHE!4/4HISMEANSTHEBUSINESSHASEFFECTIVELYPAIDSOMEOFITS'34LIABILITYTO THE!4/BUTVIATHEINSURANCECOMPANY#ONSEQUENTLY THE'34PAIDISDEBITEDTOTHE '34#LEARINGACCOUNTTOREDUCETHE'34OWEDTOTHE!4/ Effect on the accounting equation 4HIS CASH PAYMENT FOR 0REPAID )NSURANCE WITH '34 HAS THE FOLLOWING EFFECT ON THE ACCOUNTINGEQUATION Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
Decrease (decrease Bank $1320, increase Prepaid Insurance $1200)
120
Liabilities
Decrease (GST Clearing)
120
Owner’s Equity
No effect
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 4
T H E G O O D S A N D S E R V I C E S TA X ( G S T )
69
Other cash outflows #HEQUES SHOULD BE USED TO MAKE PAYMENTS FOR MOST CASH OUTmOWS SUCH AS WAGES INSURANCE RENT ADVERTISING PAYMENTSTOCREDITORS ANDDRAWINGS&IGURESHOWSTHE CHEQUEBUTTTOPROVIDEEVIDENCEOFAPAYMENTTOACREDITOR Figure 4.10 Cheque butt: payment to a creditor Pig-e-Bank Australia
ABN 49 100 001 222
30th April 2015 Date .............................................................. Pentacks Cameras To.................................................................. Settlement of For ................................................................ account ..................................................................... Bal c/fwd $ ................................................... Deposits $ ....................................................
$600.00 Amount ....................................................... Balance $...................................................... CHQ No. 253
/NACHEQUEBUTT SETTLEMENTOFACCOUNTINDICATESTHATTHECASHHASBEENPAIDTO ACREDITORINTHISEXAMPLE 0ENTACKS#AMERAS TOSETTLETHEAMOUNTOUTSTANDING4HE NAMEOFTHECREDITORTOWHOMTHECASHWASPAIDWILLBEIMPORTANTWHENTHETRANSACTION ISRECORDEDINTHE#REDITORS,EDGERSEE#HAPTER )NTHESAMEWAYTHATTHEREISNO'34ONARECEIPTFROMADEBTOR THEREISNO'34ONA PAYMENTTOACREDITOR BECAUSETHE'34ISRECOGNISEDANDREPORTEDONLYATTHETIMETHE PURCHASEISMADE4HELISTOFPAYMENTSTHATARENOTSUBJECTTO'34INCLUDES s PAYMENTSTOCREDITORS s COUNCILRATES s INTERESTEXPENSE s CASHDRAWINGS s WAGES s LOANREPAYMENTS /FCOURSE ITWILLNOTBEPRACTICALTOMAKEALLPAYMENTSBYCHEQUE&ORINSTANCE MOST MILKBARSWOULDBEUNWILLINGTOACCEPTACHEQUEFORFORALITREBOTTLEOFMILK)N CASESLIKETHIS PETTYCASHCANBEUSED BUTEVENTHEESTABLISHMENTOFTHEPETTYCASH FUNDSHOULDBEDONEBYCHEQUE4HEOTHEREXCEPTIONWOULDBEWHERECASHISDEDUCTED DIRECTLYFROMTHEBUSINESSSBANKACCOUNTFORITEMSSUCHASWAGESORLOANREPAYMENTS ANDTRANSFERREDELECTRONICALLY
STUDY TIP
!SWITHCASHRECEIPTS TRANSACTIONSTHATARE SUBJECTTO'34WILL BEIDENTIlED BUTTHE AMOUNTMAYNOTBE
STUDY TIP
0ETTYCASHISNOT ACTUALLYPARTOFTHIS COURSEnYOUDONT HAVETOKNOWHOWTO RECORDIT
REVIEW QUESTIONS 4.4
1 ExplainTHREEREASONSWHYCASHPAYMENTSSHOULDBEMADEBYCHEQUE 2 StateTHESOURCEDOCUMENTUSEDTOVERIFYCASHPAID 3 ShowTHEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDACASHPAYMENTWITH '34 4 ExplainWHY'34PAIDDECREASESTHE'34LIABILITY 5 ListlVEDIFFERENTTRANSACTIONSFORWHICHACHEQUEBUTTMAYBEISSUED 6 ExplainWHYTHEREISNO'34TOACCOUNTFORWHENCASHISPAIDTOACREDITOR
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
70
4.5
sales invoice a source document used to verify a credit sale of stock
UNITS 3&4
CREDIT SALES
#REDIT TRANSACTIONS EFFECTIVELY SEPARATE A SALE OR PURCHASE INTO TWO TRANSACTIONS THE EXCHANGEOFGOODSOCCURSlRST WITHTHEEXCHANGEOFCASHONLYOCCURRINGATSOMELATER DATE7HENSTOCKISSOLDONCREDITANDTHEGOODSAREEXCHANGED THESOURCEDOCUMENT WILL BE A sales invoice 2EMEMBER THE '34 IS RECOGNISED AND REPORTED AT THE TIME OF THE SALE SO THE SALES INVOICE MUST SHOW ALL THE INFORMATION NECESSARY FOR IT TO BE CLASSIlEDASATAXINVOICEPARTICULARLYTHEAMOUNTOFTHE'34 BUTTHE'34WILLNOTAFFECT THEREVENUE EXPENSEORPROlTMADEONTHESALE
Credit sales and the GST 7HENSTOCKISSOLDONCREDIT THECUSTOMERDEBTOR WILLOWEBOTHTHEAMOUNTOFTHESALE FORTHESTOCK plusTHE'34ONTHESALE
EXAMPLE
On 21 April 2015, Snaps Photographic Equipment sold 5 Menolta cameras to A. Windley for $400 (plus $40 GST) each (Inv. 34). Each camera had a cost price of $250.
4HESALESINVOICETHATPROVIDESEVIDENCEOFTHISCREDITSALEISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 4.11 Sales invoice
Snaps Photographic Equipment
TAX INVOICE
22 Grace St, Essendon VIC 3041
ABN: 11 049 411 049 Customer:
A. WINDLEY Lakeside Dve Sth Melb. VIC 3205 ABN: 24 653 817 620
STUDY TIP
/NANINVOICE THE NAMEOFTHEseller ALWAYSAPPEARSAT THETOP
Item Menolta camera
21 April 2015 Invoice: 34 Terms: 5/7, n/30
Quantity
Unit Price
Total
5
400
2 000
GST (10%)
200 TOTAL
$2 200
/NCEAGAIN THECOSTPRICEOFTHESALETHATIS ISNOTSHOWN BUTTHESALES INVOICESHOWSTHATTHEDEBTOROWES$2 200FORlVECAMERAS PLUS'34 4HE CREDIT TERMS OF THE SALE INDICATE HOW LONG THE DEBTOR HAS TO PAY AND IF A SETTLEMENTDISCOUNTAPPLIES WILLSPECIFYTHETERMSOFTHATDISCOUNT)N&IGURE THE TERMSOFTHESALE N INDICATETHATTHEDEBTOR!7INDLEY HASDAYSTOSETTLE THEDEBT BUTIFITISREPAIDWITHINSEVENDAYS ADISCOUNTWILLBEAPPLIEDTOTHETOTAL AMOUNTOWING © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 4
T H E G O O D S A N D S E R V I C E S TA X ( G S T )
Recording a credit sale with GST 2ECORDINGACREDITSALEISVERYSIMILARTORECORDINGACASHSALE THEONLYDIFFERENCEBEING THATACREDITSALETAKESTHEFORMOFANINCREASEIN$EBTORS#ONTROLRATHERTHAN"ANK 4HE '34DOESNOTAFFECTTHECOSTPRICEOFTHESALEORTHESALESREVENUEEARNED SOTHELEDGER ENTRIESTORECORDACREDITSALEWITH'34WOULDBE DR #2 #2 $2 #2
Debtors Control #REDIT3ALES '34#LEARING #OSTOF3ALES 3TOCK#ONTROL
$2 200
4HISENTRYWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 4.12 General Ledger: credit sale with GST General Ledger Debtors Control (A) Date April 1 21
Cross-reference
Amount $
Balance
6 000
Sales/GST Clearing
2 200
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
Sales (R) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date April 7 21
Bank
400
Debtors Control
2 000
Cross-reference
Amount $
GST Clearing (A or L) Date April 14
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $ 120
Date April 7 21
Bank
40
Debtors Control
200
Cross-reference
Amount $
Stock Control (A) Date April 1
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $
Date
15 000
April 7
Cost of Sales
250
21
Cost of Sales
1 250
Cost of Sales (E) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
April 7
Stock Control
250
21
Stock Control
1 250
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
4HE$2 200OWEDBYTHEDEBTORSINCLUDESTHEFORTHESALE PLUS'34 SO THE CROSS REFERENCE IN THE $EBTORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT REFERS TO BOTH 3ALES AND '34 #LEARING (OWEVER THE '34 IS CHARGED TO THE DEBTOR ON BEHALF OF THE !4/ SO IT IS CREDITEDTO'34#LEARINGTOINCREASETHELIABILITYOWEDTOTHE!4/
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
71
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
72
UNITS 3&4
Effect on the accounting equation !CREDITSALEWITH'34HASTHEFOLLOWINGEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
Increase (increase Debtors Control $2 200, decrease Stock Control $1250)
950
Liabilities
Increase (GST Clearing)
200
Owner’s Equity
Increase (Sales $2 000 less Cost of Sales $1 250 = Profit)
750
REVIEW QUESTIONS 4.5
1 2 3 4 5
4.6 purchase invoice a source document used to verify a credit purchase of stock or other items
EXAMPLE
StateTHESOURCEDOCUMENTUSEDTOVERIFYACREDITSALE ExplainWHATISMEANTBYTHETERMS N ShowTHEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDACREDITSALEWITH'34 ExplainWHYTHE'34CHARGEDONACREDITSALEINCREASES$EBTORS#ONTROL ExplainWHYTHE'34CHARGEDONACREDITSALEINCREASESTHE'34LIABILITY
CREDIT PURCHASES
7HENGOODSAREPURCHASEDONCREDIT THESUPPLIERWILLISSUEApurchase invoice WHICH MUSTSATISFYTHEREQUIREMENTSOFTHE!4/TOQUALIFYASA'34DOCUMENT!PURCHASE INVOICEWILLLOOKALMOSTIDENTICALTOASALESINVOICE DETAILINGTHESAMEINFORMATION BUT FROMADIFFERENTPERSPECTIVETHISTIMEITWILLSPECIFYNOTTHENAMEOFTHEDEBTORANDTHE GOODSSOLD BUTRATHERTHENAMEOFTHECREDITORANDTHEGOODSPURCHASED 4HEPURCHASEINVOICETHATWOULDPROVIDEEVIDENCEOFTHISCREDITPURCHASEISSHOWN IN&IGURE
On 28 April 2015, Snaps Photographic Equipment purchased 10 cameras from Pentacks for $270 (plus $27 GST) each (Inv. A16).
Figure 4.13 Purchase invoice 28 April 2015
PENTACKS
41 Kookaburra St, Frankston VIC 3199
ABN: 22 098 822 098 TAX INVOICE A16
STUDY TIP
5SETHENAMEOFTHE SELLERATTHETOPOFTHE INVOICETODETERMINE WHETHERTHEINVOICE VERIlESACREDITSALEOR CREDITPURCHASE
Charge to:
ORIGINAL
TERMS: 30 days
Snaps Photographic Equipment Grace St, Essendon VIC 3041 ABN: 11 049 411 049 Item
Qty
Unit cost
Pentacks 550 Series camera
10
270
GST (10%)
$ 2 700 270
$
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
2 970
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 4
T H E G O O D S A N D S E R V I C E S TA X ( G S T )
73
)NTHERECORDSOF0ENTACKS THISDOCUMENTWOULDBEIDENTIlEDASASALESINVOICEAND RECORDEDASACREDITSALE(OWEVER INTHERECORDSOF3NAPS0HOTOGRAPHIC%QUIPMENT IDENTIlEDWHEREITSAYS@#HARGETO THISISAPURCHASEINVOICE VERIFYINGACREDITPURCHASE OFSTOCK
Recording a credit purchase with GST !SARESULTOFACREDITPURCHASE WEWILLOWETHESUPPLIERFORBOTHTHESTOCKplusTHE '34 BUTTHEITEMSARESEPARATETHE'34DOESNOTAFFECTTHECOSTPRICEOFTHESTOCK PURCHASED4HELEDGERENTRIESTORECORDACREDITPURCHASEWITH'34WOULDTHUSBE $2 $2 CR
3TOCK#ONTROL '34#LEARING Creditors Control
2 970
4HISENTRYWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 4.14 General Ledger: credit purchase with GST General Ledger Stock Control (A) Date April 1 28
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $
Date
15 000
April 7
Cost of Sales
250
2 700
21
Cost of Sales
1 250
Creditors Control
Cross-reference
Amount $
GST Clearing (A or L) Date April 14 28
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference Bank
Bank
120
April 7
Creditors Control
270
21
Amount $ 40
Debtors Control
200
Cross-reference
Amount $
Creditors Control (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date April 1 28
Balance
7 000
Stock Control/
2 970
GST Clearing
4HE $2 970OWEDTOCREDITORSINCLUDESTHEFORTHESTOCK PLUS'34 SO THECROSS REFERENCEINTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNTREFERSTOBOTH3TOCK#ONTROLAND '34 #LEARING BOTH ACCOUNTS ARE LINKED TO #REDITORS #ONTROL BECAUSE THE BUSINESS OWESTHECREDITORSBOTHAMOUNTS4HE'34ONTHEPURCHASE WILLREDUCETHE'34 LIABILITYTOTHE!4/ ANDSOITISDEBITEDTOTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNT
STUDY TIP
Effect on the accounting equation !CREDITPURCHASEOFSTOCKWILLTHUSHAVETHEFOLLOWINGEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
Increase (Stock Control $2 700)
2 700
Liabilities
Increase (increase Creditors Control $2 970, decrease GST Clearing $270)
2 700
Owner’s Equity
No effect
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
!LTHOUGHINVOICES WOULDBEISSUEDFOR CREDITPURCHASESOFALL ITEMSnSTOCKANDNON CURRENTASSETSALIKEn 5NITONLYCOVERSCREDIT PURCHASESOFSTOCK
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
74
STUDY TIP
$ONTPANICIFTHE '34ISNOTYETCLEAR #HAPTERSANDWILL EXPLORE'34INDETAIL USINGARANGEOF EXAMPLES4HISCHAPTER ISONLYDESIGNEDTOBE ANOVERVIEW
UNITS 3&4
GST Clearing: summary 4HE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTSHOWS s '34RECEIVED ONCASHSALES s '34CHARGEDTODEBTORS ONCREDITSALES s '34PAID ONCASHPURCHASES s '34CHARGEDBYCREDITORS ONCREDITPURCHASES )F '34 ON SALES IS GREATER THAN '34 ON PURCHASES THEN '34 #LEARING WILL HAVE A CREDITBALANCE ANDBEREPORTEDASACURRENTLIABILITY4HEBUSINESSWILLBEREQUIREDTO MAKEAPAYMENTTOTHE!4/CALLEDA'34SETTLEMENT/NTHEOTHERHAND IF'34ON PURCHASESISGREATERTHAN'34ONSALES THE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTWILLBEACURRENTASSET WITHADEBITBALANCE ANDTHEBUSINESSWILLBEDUEA'34REFUNDFROMTHE!4/ REVIEW QUESTIONS 4.6
1 StateTHESOURCEDOCUMENTUSEDTOVERIFYACREDITPURCHASE 2 ShowTHEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDACREDITPURCHASEOF STOCKWITH'34 3 ExplainTHEEFFECTON3TOCK#ONTROLOFTHE'34ONACREDITPURCHASE 4 ExplainWHYTHE'34ONACREDITPURCHASEDECREASESTHE'34LIABILITY 5 ExplainWHATMUSTOCCURIFTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTHASACREDITBALANCE ATTHEENDOFTHEPERIOD 6 ExplainWHATMUSTOCCURIFTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTHASADEBITBALANCE ATTHEENDOFTHEPERIOD
4.7
OTHER BUSINESS DOCUMENTS
Memos 3OME TRANSACTIONS WILL NOT BE EVIDENCED BY ANY OF THE PRECEDING DOCUMENTS AS THEY INVOLVE NEITHER A SALE NOR PURCHASE NOR THE RECEIPT OR PAYMENT OF CASH 4HESE TRANSACTIONSMAYINCLUDE s OPENING CLOSING CORRECTINGANDADJUSTINGENTRIES s STOCKLOSSES GAINS WRITE DOWNSANDTRANSFERS s NON CASHTRANSACTIONSWITHTHEOWNER s OTHERNON CASH INFREQUENTTRANSACTIONS
memo a source document used to verify an internal transaction
%ACHOFTHESETRANSACTIONSISCOVEREDINDETAILLATERINTHISTEXT 4HESE TRANSACTIONS MUST STILL BE VERIlED BY A DOCUMENT BUT FOR THE PRECEDING TRANSACTIONSITWILLBEADOCUMENTISSUEDFROMWITHINTHElRM CALLEDAMEMORANDUM ORmemo-EMOSCANBEISSUEDFORANYNUMBEROFTRANSACTIONS ANDSOTHEIRFORMAT ISMUCHMOREmEXIBLETHANTHEOTHERDOCUMENTSDISCUSSEDSOFAR0UTSIMPLY THEYWILL DESCRIBEAPARTICULARENTRY ANDREQUESTTHATITISRECORDED&IGURESHOWSACOMMON LAYOUTFORAMEMO
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 4
T H E G O O D S A N D S E R V I C E S TA X ( G S T )
Figure 4.15 Memo
75
m
e
graphic
Snaps Photo
19 mo
Equipment
ril 2015 Date: 30 Ap Room From: Stock
Department g n ti n u o c c To: A s e of Pentack k ta k c o st l a Physic s 0 series) show cameras (55 and. 20 units on h
M. Hillsington ger Stock Mana
4HEDOCUMENTISDATEDANDNUMBEREDANDINFORMSTHEACCOUNTINGDEPARTMENTTHAT ASTOCKTAKEHASCOUNTEDCAMERAS4HISlGURECANTHENBECOMPAREDWITHTHESTOCK CARDSTOCHECKTHEIRACCURACY ANDDETECTANYSTOCKLOSSORGAIN WHICHCOULDTHENBE RECORDEDINTHELEDGERACCOUNTS
Statements of account 4HElRST ANDMOSTIMPORTANT POINTTONOTEABOUTAstatement of accountISTHATITIS NOTEVIDENCEOFASINGLETRANSACTIONWITHACREDITORORDEBTOR BUTRATHERAsummaryOFA NUMBEROFTRANSACTIONSINVOLVINGTHATDEBTORORCREDITOROVERACERTAINPERIOD"ECAUSE ITISALISTOFTRANSACTIONSTHATHAVEALREADYOCCURREDnANDSHOULDHAVEALREADYBEEN RECORDEDnTHESTATEMENTOFACCOUNTISNOTASOURCEDOCUMENTTHATMUSTBERECORDED &IGURESHOWSTHESTATEMENTOFACCOUNTFROMACREDITORn0ENTACKSnFOR!PRIL
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
statement of account a summary of the transactions a firm has had with a particular debtor/ creditor over a certain period of time (usually a month)
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
76
UNITS 3&4
Figure 4.16 Statement of account
PENTACKS
41 Kookaburra St, Frankston VIC 3199
ABN: 22 098 822 098
STATEMENT OF ACCOUNT
Account of:
Date April 1 April
Snaps Photographic Equipment Grace St, Essendon VIC 3041
For period: April 2015
Details
Payments
Sales
Balance
Balance 200
8
Inv. A09
400
600
Ap
28
Inv. A16
2 970
3 570
Apr
30
Payment received: thank you (Ch. 245)
Balance owing: 30 April 2015
600
2 970
$ 2 970
4HISSTATEMENTOFACCOUNTSUMMARISESTHEVARIOUSCREDITPURCHASESMADEby3NAPS 0HOTOGRAPHIC %QUIPMENT from 0ENTACKS DURING !PRIL AS WELL AS THE PAYMENTS IT MADE %ACH TRANSACTION SHOULD BE CHECKED AGAINST THE SOURCE DOCUMENT THAT WAS ISSUEDATTHETIMETOCHECKITSACCURACYnANDITMAYBEAREMINDERTOPAYTHECREDITOR THEBALANCEOWINGnBUTNOFURTHERRECORDINGISREQUIREDWHENTHISSTATEMENTISRECEIVED
Order forms order form a document requesting the supply of stock or other goods
*UST LIKE STATEMENTS OF ACCOUNT order forms ARE A TYPE OF SOURCE DOCUMENT THAT DO NOTNEEDTOBERECORDED/RDERFORMSARECOMPLETEDWHENABUSINESSREQUESTSSTOCK OROTHERSUPPLIESASSETSFROMASUPPLIER BUTTHETRANSACTIONDOESNOTOCCURUNTILTHE
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 4
T H E G O O D S A N D S E R V I C E S TA X ( G S T )
Figure 4.17 Order form
Snaps Photographic EQUIPMENT
22 Grace St, Essendon VIC 3041
ORDER FORM ABN: 11 049 411 049
Supplier:
Menolta Cameras 55 High St, Armadale VIC 3143
3 May 2015
Please supply the following items:
Item Menolta camera – Model #310
Qty 20
Please inform re. delivery date
GOODSAREEXCHANGED)TISONLYWHENTHEGOODSARERECEIVEDOR INTHECASEOFASALE DELIVERED THATTHEINVOICEWILLBESENT ANDITISTHEinvoice NOTTHEORDERFORM THAT MUSTBERECORDED!NORDERFORMISSIMPLYAREQUESTFORITEMSnTHEITEMSMAYNOTBE AVAILABLE ORMAYNOTBEDELIVEREDFORSOMETIMETOCOMEnSOITCANNOTBERECORDEDAS ATRANSACTION .OTEHOWTHEORDERFORMIN&IGUREDOESNOTSPECIFYANAMOUNTTHEBUSINESS ORDERINGTHESTOCK3NAPS0HOTOGRAPHIC%QUIPMENT ISNOTABLETOSETTHESELLINGPRICE SOITCANNOTSPECIFYANAMOUNTONTHEORDERFORM)TISALSOUNABLETOSPECIFYTHE'34 OR THAT IT IS A TAX INVOICE 4HE AMOUNT WILL BE SPECIlED ON THE PURCHASE INVOICE THAT ACCOMPANIESTHEGOODSWHENTHEYAREDELIVERED ANDITISthenTHATTHETRANSACTIONCAN BERECORDED 4HIS IS NOT AN EXHAUSTIVE LIST OF BUSINESS DOCUMENTS BUT IT ILLUSTRATES THE MAIN DOCUMENTS THAT WILL BE USED IN THE 6#% !CCOUNTING COURSE TO VERIFY TRANSACTIONS ANDENSURETHATREPORTSAREReliableTHATIS FREEFROMBIASANDERROR/THERBUSINESS DOCUMENTSINCLUDINGBANKSTATEMENTS PAYADVICETOEMPLOYEES GROUPCERTIlCATES TAX REMITTANCES DELIVERYDOCKETSANDSTATEMENTSOFSUPERANNUATIONCONTRIBUTIONS WILLBE IMPORTANTINTHENORMALCOURSEOFBUSINESSACTIVITIES ANDEACHANDEVERYONEOFTHESE DOCUMENTSMUSTBECOLLECTED CHECKED RECORDEDWHERENECESSARY ANDlLED
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
77
78
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s 4HE'OODSAND3ERVICES4AX'34 ISATAXLEVIEDBYTHEFEDERALGOVERNMENT ONMOSTGOODSANDSERVICESEXCLUDINGFRESHFOOD s '34 ON SALES IS OWED TO THE GOVERNMENT BUT '34 ON PURCHASES REDUCES THAT LIABILITY s !LL'34TRANSACTIONSARESUMMARISEDINTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNT WHICHCANBEA CURRENTASSETORCURRENTLIABILITY s )F '34 ON SALES IS GREATER THAN '34 ON PURCHASES THE BUSINESS WILL HAVE A '34 LIABILITY ANDBEREQUIREDTOMAKEA'34SETTLEMENT s )F'34ONPURCHASESISGREATERTHAN'34ONSALES THEBUSINESSWILLHAVEA'34ASSET ANDISDUEA'34REFUND s !SSELLINGPRICESAREGENERALLYHIGHERTHANCOSTPRICES MOSTlRMSWILLENDUPWITHA '34LIABILITY s 3OURCEDOCUMENTSPROVIDEBOTHTHEEVIDENCETHATATRANSACTIONHASOCCURRED AND THEDETAILSOFTHETRANSACTIONITSELF4HEYENSURETHEREPORTSAREReliableORFREEFROM ERRORANDBIAS s -OSTCASHPAYMENTSSHOULDBEMADEBYCHEQUEBECAUSETHEYARESECURE TRACEABLE ANDVERIlABLE s 7HENCASHISRECEIVED THESOURCEDOCUMENTWILLBEACASHRECEIPT s 7HENCASHISPAID THESOURCEDOCUMENTWILLBEACHEQUEBUTT s 7HENSTOCKISSOLDONCREDIT THESOURCEDOCUMENTWILLBEASALESINVOICE s 7HEN STOCK IS PURCHASED ON CREDIT THE SOURCE DOCUMENT WILL BE A PURCHASE INVOICE s '34ISRECOGNISEDANDREPORTEDONLYATTHETIMETHEPURCHASEORSALEISMADE s 4HE CREDIT TERMS OF THE SALE INDICATE HOW LONG THE DEBTOR HAS TO PAY AND IF A SETTLEMENTDISCOUNTAPPLIES WILLALSOSPECIFYTHETERMSOFTHATDISCOUNT s !MEMOISASOURCEDOCUMENTUSEDTOVERIFYANINTERNALTRANSACTION s ! STATEMENT OF ACCOUNT IS A SUMMARY OF THE TRANSACTIONS A lRM HAS HAD WITH A PARTICULARDEBTORCREDITOROVERACERTAINPERIODOFTIMEUSUALLYAMONTH s !N ORDER FORM IS SIMPLY A REQUEST FOR STOCK OR OTHER SUPPLIESASSETS FROM A SUPPLIER
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 4
T H E G O O D S A N D S E R V I C E S TA X ( G S T )
EXERCISE 4.1 CASH TRANSACTION
W B
page 56
79
EXERCISES
4HEFOLLOWINGDOCUMENTWASFOUNDINTHEOFlCEOF(ATS/FFTO(ATS4HEOWNER (ARRY APPLIESMARK UPTOALLSTOCK
555 Mickleham Road Tullamarine VIC 3043
Hats Off to Hats!
ABN: 45 983 453 101
Total:
2 November 2015 60 (tax invoice) Cash sales Two hundred and twenty dollars 2 top hats @ $100 each $ 200.00 $ 20.00 $ 220.00
Signed:
Paula Ekland
Date: Receipt no.: Received from: The sum of: Being for: Amount: Plus GST:
Required a IdentifyTHESOURCEDOCUMENTABOVE b DescribeTHETRANSACTIONVERIlEDBYTHISDOCUMENT c Show THE DEBITS AND CREDITS NECESSARY TO RECORD THIS DOCUMENT IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGEROF(ATS/FFTO(ATS d ExplainWHYTHISTRANSACTIONCREATESA'34LIABILITYFOR(ATS/FFTO(ATS e 2EFERRING TO ONE QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTIC explain THE ROLE OF SOURCE DOCUMENTS INTHEACCOUNTINGPROCESS
EXERCISE 4.2 CASH TRANSACTION
W B
page 57
)#2EDD THEOWNEROF"OOK-E$ANNO FOUNDTHEFOLLOWINGDOCUMENTWHENCLEANING HISDESK
Book Me Danno
Rec. #83
Antique and rare books Puckle St, Moonee Ponds VIC 3039
Received from: V. Deo
ABN: 50 505 505 505
Date: 15.8.15
The sum of: Two hundred and seventy dollars Being for: Settlement of account Signed: Alex Micari
Amount:
$270.00
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
80
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Required a 2EFERRINGTOTHEPRECEDINGDOCUMENT identifyTHEENTITYTHATHASRECEIVEDTHECASH b ExplainWHYTHEREISNO'34IDENTIlEDINTHISDOCUMENT c ShowTHEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHISTRANSACTIONINTHE'ENERAL ,EDGEROF"OOK-E$ANNO d Explain THE EFFECT THAT THIS TRANSACTION HAS ON THE PROlT OF "OOK -E $ANNO FOR !UGUST
EXERCISE 4.3 CASH TRANSACTION
W B
page 58
4HEFOLLOWINGSOURCEDOCUMENTWASDISCOVEREDBYTHEMANAGEROF3ALLYS3HOE3HOP
ABN 63 217 846 199
National Australia Bank
1 March 2015 Date .............................................................. Courier Newspaper To.................................................................. Advertising paid in advance For ................................................................ $1 400 plus GST of $140 ..................................................................... Bal c/fwd $ ................................................... Deposits $ ....................................................
$1 540.00 Amount ........................................................ Balance $...................................................... CHQ No. 200
Required a StateWHETHERSOURCEDOCUMENTSTAKEPLACEATTHEINPUT PROCESSINGOROUTPUTSTAGE OFTHEACCOUNTINGPROCESS b IdentifyTHESOURCEDOCUMENTABOVE ANDdescribeTHETRANSACTION c State TWO REASONS WHY PAYMENTS SHOULD NOT BE MADE USING CASH FROM THE CASH REGISTER d ShowTHEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHISTRANSACTIONINTHE'ENERAL ,EDGEROF3ALLYS3HOE3HOP e StateTWOREASONSWHYTHISDOCUMENTWOULDnotSATISFYTHEREQUIREMENTSOFATAX INVOICE
EXERCISE 4.4 CREDIT TRANSACTION
W B
page 59
4HEACCOUNTANTFOR-ENTONE-USIC3HOPCAMEACROSSTHISSOURCEDOCUMENTINADRAWER
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 4
T H E G O O D S A N D S E R V I C E S TA X ( G S T )
MUSICAL MAYHEM
TAX INVOICE
72 City View Rd Balwyn VIC 3930
Invoice: 480 (Original) Net 30 days 8 February 2015
ABN: 61 363 217 404
Customer:
Mentone Music Shop (ABN: 12 945 362 733) 91 Balcombe Rd, Mentone VIC 3194
Attn:
B. Gill
Item 205
Description
Qty
Unit Cost
$
15
500
7 500
Saxophones Plus GST 10%
750
Total
$
8 250
Required a IdentifyTHESOURCEDOCUMENTABOVE ANDdescribeTHETRANSACTION b Show THE DEBITS AND CREDITS NECESSARY TO RECORD THIS TRANSACTION IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGEROF-ENTONE-USIC3HOP c ExplainTHEEFFECTOFTHISTRANSACTIONONTHE'34LIABILITYOF-ENTONE-USIC3HOP d State THE VALUE AT WHICH THIS STOCK WOULD BE REPORTED IN THE "ALANCE 3HEET OF -ENTONE-USIC3HOPJustifyYOURANSWER
EXERCISE 4.5 CREDIT TRANSACTION
page 60
W B
!LEX THEOWNEROF$ECO$ÏCOR FOUNDTHEFOLLOWINGDOCUMENTUNDERTHECASHREGISTER )THASNOTBEENRECORDED
Deco Décor
Invoice:
Block Arcade Melbourne VIC 3000
Duplicate Tax invoice
ABN: 98 564 872 575
6/7, n/30
90
Charge to: Lloyds Country Inn, Ballarat VIC 3350 Date
Details
Qty
May 4
Single bed sheet sets
12
Unit Price $ 60
GST (10%)
Total $ 720 72
Total
$792
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
81
82
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Required a IdentifyTHEPRECEDINGSOURCEDOCUMENT ANDdescribeTHETRANSACTION b ExplainWHATISMEANTBYTHETERMS@ N c 'IVENTHATALLSALESAREMARKEDUPBY showTHEDEBITSANDCREDITSNECESSARY TORECORDTHISTRANSACTIONINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF$ECO$ÏCOR d ExplainWHYTHISTRANSACTIONINCREASESTHE'34LIABILITYOF$ECO$ÏCOR
EXERCISE 4.6 STATEMENT OF ACCOUNT
W B
page 61
4HE OWNER OF #ELTIC 3ENSATIONS HAS RECEIVED THE FOLLOWING SOURCE DOCUMENT IN THE MAIL
Look of the Irish
5 July 2015
ABN: 34 221 768 999 110 Main Rd Greensborough VIC 3085
STATEMENT OF ACCOUNT Statement for:
Celtic Sensations 45 Burke Rd, Camberwell VIC 3350 Particulars
June 1
ACC: 8613
Debit
ABN: 16 422 031 164
Credit
Balance b/fwd
12
Inv. MH 365
24
Thank you – payment
29
Inv. MH 372
Days outstanding Amount outstanding
Balance 3 200
1 200
4 400 2 400
1 500 Current
2 000 3 500
30 – 60
2 700
60+ 800
Please pay any outstanding amounts immediately to ensure continuance of supply
Required a StateTHEROLEOFASTATEMENTOFACCOUNT b Explain HOW ,OOK OF THE )RISH WOULD BE REPORTED IN THE "ALANCE 3HEET OF #ELTIC 3ENSATIONS c ExplainHOW#ELTIC3ENSATIONSWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF,OOKOF THE)RISH d Explain HOW THIS DOCUMENT SHOULD BE USED BY #ELTIC 3ENSATIONS TO IMPROVE THE ReliabilityOFITSREPORTS
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 4
T H E G O O D S A N D S E R V I C E S TA X ( G S T )
EXERCISE 4.7 MEMORANDUM
W B
page 62
4HEACCOUNTANTOF&ERRIS&RAMESRECEIVEDTHEFOLLOWINGSOURCEDOCUMENTINTHEINTERNAL MAILFROMTHEMANAGER
Ferris Frames Shannon Street Sunbury VIC 3429
To:
memo
5
The Accountant
Re: $300 worth of stock has been taken for personal use. Signed:
K. Ferris
Required a IdentifyTHESOURCEDOCUMENTABOVE ANDdescribeTHETRANSACTION b ExplainTHEROLEOFMEMOSINANACCOUNTINGSYSTEM c 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainWHYTHISTRANSACTIONMUSTBERECORDED INTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF&ERRIS&RAMES d Show THE DEBITS AND CREDITS NECESSARY TO RECORD THIS TRANSACTION IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGEROF&ERRIS&RAMES e StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF&ERRIS&RAMESIFTHISDOCUMENTWAS notRECORDED f StateTWOOTHERTYPESOFTRANSACTIONTHATWOULDBEVERIlEDBYAMEMO
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
83
84
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 4.8 ORDER FORM
W B
page 64
4HE-ANAGEROF"EVS0HOTO3HOPSENTTHEFOLLOWINGDOCUMENTTOHERSUPPLIER+OMAK
Bev’s Photo Shop
Purchase Order: 91
Highpoint Centre Maribyrnong VIC 3168
29 April 2015
The Photographer’s Friend Supplier
KOMAK Industrial Lane, Dandenong VIC 3162
Please supply the following: Qty
Photographic supplies
25
Film – Kodak 400
10
Paper – A45 (high gloss) Please deliver within 7 days
Required a ExplainWHYORDERFORMSAREnotPARTOFTHEACCOUNTINGPROCESS b ExplainWHYTHEREARENOPRICESLISTEDONTHISDOCUMENT c 2EFERRING TO THE DElNITIONS explain WHY THIS DOCUMENT DOES not LEAD TO THE RECOGNITIONOFANASSETINTHERECORDSOF"EVS0HOTO3HOP d NameTHEDOCUMENTTHATWILLVERIFYTHEPURCHASEOFTHEPHOTOGRAPHICSUPPLIESWHEN THEYAREDELIVERED
© Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s explainTHEROLEOFSPECIAL JOURNALSANDTHEBENElTS THEYBRINGTOTHEACCOUNTING PROCESS s listTHEFOURSPECIALJOURNALS ANDidentifyTHETRANSACTIONS THEYAREUSEDTORECORD s recordCREDITPURCHASES OFSTOCKWITH'34 INTHE 0URCHASES*OURNAL s postTHE0URCHASES*OURNAL TOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERAND #REDITORS,EDGER s prepareA#REDITORS3CHEDULE s recordCREDITSALESOFSTOCK WITH'34 INTHE3ALES *OURNAL
s postTHE3ALES*OURNALTOTHE 'ENERAL,EDGERAND$EBTORS ,EDGER s prepareA$EBTORS3CHEDULE s explainTHERELATIONSHIP BETWEENCONTROLACCOUNTS ANDTHESUBSIDIARYLEDGER s explainTHEBENElTSOFUSING ASYSTEMOFCONTROLACCOUNTS ANDSUBSIDIARYLEDGERS s identifyTHEEFFECTOF'34 ONTHERECORDINGOFCREDIT PURCHASESANDSALES s report'34#LEARINGINTHE "ALANCE3HEET
CHAPTER 5
SPECIAL JOURNALS 1: CREDIT JOURNALS KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s SPECIALJOURNAL s 0URCHASES*OURNAL s CONTROLACCOUNT s SUBSIDIARYLEDGER s 3ALES*OURNAL s '34SETTLEMENT s '34REFUND ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
86
5.1
UNITS 3&4
SPECIAL JOURNALS
,EDGER ACCOUNTS ARE IDEAL FOR RECORDING THE EFFECT OF TRANSACTIONS ON INDIVIDUAL ITEMS IN BUSINESS REPORTS BUT HAVING COMPLETED THE EXERCISES IN #HAPTER YOU WILL KNOW THATRECORDINGINLEDGERSINVOLVESAFAIRDEALOFREPETITION4RANSACTIONSTHATOCCUREVERY DAYSUCHASCASHSALES CASHPAYMENTSORPURCHASESOFSTOCKONCREDIT WILLNEEDTOBE RECORDEDINTHELEDGERACCOUNTSEACHDAY USINGEXACTLYTHESAMEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIES
EXAMPLE
Linen and McCartney is a shop that sells sheets, towels and bed linen. Its transactions for October were as follows: Oct.
1 6 17 22 25 29
Purchased stock on credit from Marks and Co. – $230 plus $23 GST (Inv. B93) Stock purchased from Walton Traders for $220 including $20 GST (Inv. 13) Purchased $190 worth of stock (plus $19 GST) from Jackson Suppliers (Inv. 142) Bought stock from Highlife Ltd for $320 plus $32 GST (Inv. A17) Purchased stock on credit from Marks and Co. for $410 plus GST (Inv. B99) Stock purchased from Walton Traders for $187 (includes GST) (Inv. 21)
%ACHOFTHETRANSACTIONSABOVEISAcredit purchase of stock ANDWILLREQUIREEXACTLY THESAMEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESEVERYTIMEITISRECORDEDINTHELEDGER4HATIS $2 $2 CR
3TOCK#ONTROL '34#LEARING Creditors Control
!FTERRECORDINGTHESETRANSACTIONSINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER THEACCOUNTSWOULDSHOW General Ledger Stock Control (A) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Oct. 1
Creditors Control
230
6
Creditors Control
200
17
Creditors Control
190
22
Creditors Control
320
25
Creditors Control
410
29
Creditors Control
170
Date
Cross-reference
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Amount $
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 5
SPECIAL JOURNALS 1: CREDIT JOURNALS
87
GST Clearing (A or L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Oct. 1
Creditors Control
23
6
Creditors Control
20
17
Creditors Control
19
22
Creditors Control
32
25
Creditors Control
41
29
Creditors Control
17
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Creditors Control (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Oct. 1
Stock Control/GST Clearing
253
6
Stock Control/GST Clearing
220
17
Stock Control/GST Clearing
209
22
Stock Control/GST Clearing
352
25
Stock Control/GST Clearing
451
29
Stock Control/GST Clearing
187
!LTHOUGHTHESELEDGERACCOUNTSSHOWONLYSIXTRANSACTIONS THEREPETITIONISOBVIOUS )MAGINEWHATTHESEACCOUNTSWOULDLOOKLIKEWITHORCREDITPURCHASESPERMONTH 'IVEN THAT THERE WILL BE A NUMBER OF TRANSACTIONS THAT HAVE THE SAME EFFECT ON THE 'ENERAL,EDGER ITHARDLYMAKESSENSETOREPEATTHESAMELEDGERENTRIESOVERANDOVER AGAIN&ORTHISREASON special journalsAREUSEDTOSUMMARISESIMILARTRANSACTIONSBEFORE POSTINGTHETOTALSTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSATTHEENDOFTHEMONTH
Types of special journals 7HEREAS LEDGER ACCOUNTS RECORD ALL TRANSACTIONS THAT AFFECT A PARTICULAR item SUCH AS "ANK OR#REDITORS#ONTROLOR3ALES SPECIALJOURNALSRECORDALLtransactionsOFAPARTICULAR TYPE4HEFOURMOSTCOMMONSPECIALJOURNALSnANDTHETRANSACTIONSTHATTHEYRECORDn ARESHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 5.1 Types of special journals Journal
Transaction
Purchases Journal (PJ)
Credit purchases of stock (from creditors)
Sales Journal (SJ)
Credit sales of stock (to debtors)
Cash Receipts Journal (CRJ)
Cash received (from all sources)
Cash Payments Journal (CPJ)
Cash paid (for all uses)
4HEMAINPURPOSEOFTHESESPECIALJOURNALSISTOSUMMARISESIMILARTRANSACTIONSSO THATTOTALSCANBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER INTHEPROCESSREDUCINGTHENUMBEROF LEDGERENTRIESREQUIREDANDIMPROVINGTHEEFlCIENCYOFTHERECORDINGSYSTEM 7HILETHESEARETHEMOSTCOMMONSPECIALJOURNALS ITSHOULDBENOTEDTHATITISUPTO EACHlRMTODETERMINEWHICHSPECIALJOURNALSTOUSE DEPENDENTONITSOWNCIRCUMSTANCES ANDNEEDS&ORINSTANCE IFCREDITPURCHASESOFSTOCKOCCURONLYINFREQUENTLY THEREISNO NEEDFORA0URCHASES*OURNAL/NTHEOTHERHAND EVERYlRMWILLHAVECASHTRANSACTIONS SOTHESEJOURNALSAREALMOSTINDISPENSABLE ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
special journal an accounting record that summarises similar transactions
STUDY TIP
4HEREISNONEEDTO SPECIFYcreditINTHE TITLEOFTHE0URCHASES *OURNALOR3ALES*OURNAL ASTHISISTHEONLYTYPE OFTRANSACTIONTHEY CANRECORDALLCASH PURCHASESORSALESWILL BERECORDEDINEITHER THE#ASH0AYMENTS *OURNALOR#ASH 2ECEIPTS*OURNAL
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
88
UNITS 3&4
!NYTRANSACTIONSTHATAREUNABLETOBERECORDEDINASPECIALJOURNALMUSTBERECORDED IN THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL WHICH IS USED TO RECORD ALL INFREQUENT NON CASH TRANSACTIONS 4HISWILLBECOVEREDIN#HAPTER Every transaction must be recorded in a journal before it is posted to the ledger accounts. !SARESULT THEJOURNALSnSPECIALAND GENERALnPLAYANADDITIONALROLEOFPROVIDING ALINKBETWEENTHELEDGERENTRIESANDTHESOURCEDOCUMENTSTHATPROVIDETHEEVIDENCE ANDDETAILSOFTHETRANSACTIONSTHEMSELVES
REVIEW QUESTIONS 5.1
1 2 3 4
5.2
ListTHEFOURSPECIALJOURNALS ANDstateTHETYPESOFTRANSACTIONSTHEYRECORD ExplainTHEFUNCTIONOFASPECIALJOURNAL ExplainTHEFUNCTIONOFTHE'ENERAL*OURNAL ExplainWHYNOTALLBUSINESSESWILLUSETHESAMESPECIALJOURNALS
THE PURCHASES JOURNAL
!SWASSTATEDINTHEPREVIOUSEXAMPLEOF,INENAND-C#ARTNEY ALLTRANSACTIONSINVOLVING THEPURCHASEOFGOODSONCREDITHAVEEXACTLYTHESAMEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIES $2 $2 #2 Purchases Journal an accounting record that summarises all transactions involving the purchase of stock on credit during a month
3TOCK#ONTROL '34#LEARING
#REDITORS#ONTROL
4HESE TRANSACTIONS CAN BE SUMMARISED IN A Purchases Journal TO ALLOW THE total CREDITPURCHASESOFSTOCKTOBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSATTHEENDOF THEMONTH
Recording in the Purchases Journal 4HE CREDIT PURCHASES FOR ,INEN AND -C#ARTNEY FOR /CTOBER ARE SUMMARISED IN THE 0URCHASES*OURNALIN&IGURE Figure 5.2 Purchases Journal
Date1
Creditor2
Invoice number3
Stock Control4
GST5
Creditors Control6
Oct. 1
Marks and Co.
B93
230
23
253
6
Walton Traders
13
200
20
220
17
Jackson Suppliers
142
190
19
209
22
Highlife Ltd
A17
320
32
352
25
Marks and Co.
B99
410
41
451
29
Walton Traders
21
170
17
187
1 520
152
1 672
Totals
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 5
SPECIAL JOURNALS 1: CREDIT JOURNALS
89
Notes for recording in the Purchases Journal 1
Date !LTHOUGH THE TOTALS WILL BE POSTED TO THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER ONLY AT THE END OF THE MONTHTHATIS ON/CTOBER THETRANSACTIONSARERECORDEDINTHEJOURNAL ONTHEDATETHEYOCCUR4HISDATEWILLBEVERYIMPORTANTFORTHEINDIVIDUALCREDITORS RECORDS
2 Creditor !LL THESE TRANSACTIONS WILL BE RECORDED IN ONE #REDITORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT IN THE 'ENERAL,EDGER BUTBECAUSETHEBUSINESSHASMORETHANONECREDITOR THEJOURNAL MUSTSHOWTHENAMEOFEACHINDIVIDUALCREDITOR!SEPARATERECORDWILLBEMAINTAINED ELSEWHEREFOREACHINDIVIDUALCREDITOR 3 Invoice number )NORDERTOENSUREReliability THESOURCEDOCUMENT WHICHFORTHISJOURNALISAPURCHASE INVOICE MUSTBERECORDED)FAQUERYARISESASTOTHEDETAILSOFTHETRANSACTION IT CANBETRACEDBACKEASILYTOTHESOURCEDOCUMENTFORCLARIlCATIONANDVERIlCATION 4HEPURCHASEINVOICESLISTEDINTHE0URCHASES*OURNALOF,INENAND-C#ARTNEYWILL NOTRUNINORDER BECAUSETHEYAREISSUEDNOTBY,INENAND-C#ARTNEY BUTBYTHEIR SUPPLIERS SUCHAS-ARKSAND#OAND7ALTON4RADERS"ETWEENPURCHASESBY,INEN AND-C#ARTNEY THESESUPPLIERSWILLISSUEINVOICESTOALLTHEIROTHERCUSTOMERS 4 Stock Control 3TOCK#ONTROLISTHEVALUECOSTPRICE OFTHESTOCKTHATHASBEENPURCHASED EXCLUDING THE'34 5 GST 4HISISTHE'34CHARGEDBYSUPPLIERSONCREDITPURCHASES CALCULATEDASOFTHE PURCHASEPRICE ASRECORDEDINTHE3TOCK#ONTROLCOLUMN4HE'34CHARGEDBYTHE SUPPLIERSDOESNOTAFFECTTHEVALUATIONOFSTOCKITSIMPLYREDUCESTHE'34LIABILITY OWEDTOTHE!4/ ANDINCREASESTHEDEBTOWEDTOCREDITORS
STUDY TIP
4RANSACTIONSMAYASK YOUTOCALCULATETHE AMOUNTOF'34 BUTWILL ALWAYSIDENTIFYTHAT'34 APPLIES
6 Creditors Control 4HISISTHETOTALAMOUNTOWEDTOCREDITORS CALCULATEDBYADDINGTOGETHERTHEVALUE OFTHESTOCKPURCHASEDANDTHE'347EOWETHECREDITORFORTHESTOCKPURCHASED ANDTHE'34ONTHATSTOCK
Posting the Purchases Journal to the General Ledger !TTHEENDOFTHEMONTH THETOTALOFTHE0URCHASES*OURNALCANBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL ,EDGERACCOUNTSASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 5.3 General Ledger: posting the Purchases Journal General Ledger Stock Control (A) Date Oct. 1 31
Cross-reference Balance Creditors Control
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
10 000 1 520 GST Clearing (A or L)
Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference Creditors Control
Amount $
Date
152
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
90
UNITS 3&4
Figure 5.3 (cont.) General Ledger: posting the Purchases Journal Creditors Control (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference Stock Control/
Amount $ 1 672
GST Clearing
2ECORDING TRANSACTIONS IN THE 0URCHASES *OURNAL BEFORE POSTING TO THE 'ENERAL ,EDGERHASALLOWEDUSTORECORDallCREDITPURCHASESWITHJUSTONEENTRY NOTSIX INEACH ACCOUNT 2EMEMBERTHATTHECROSS REFERENCEINTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNTREFERSTOBOTH 3TOCK #ONTROL and '34 #LEARING BECAUSE BOTH ACCOUNTS ARE LINKED TO THE AMOUNT RECORDEDINCreditors Control )NTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNT THE'34CHARGEDBYTHESUPPLIERISRECORDEDONTHE DEBITSIDE ASITREDUCESANY'34LIABILITYTHEBUSINESSMAYHAVEACCRUED)TISTREATEDAS IFSOME'34HASALREADYBEENPAIDTOTHE!4/)FTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTALREADYHAD ADEBITBALANCE THIS'34CHARGEDBYSUPPLIERSWOULDINCREASETHEVALUEOFTHEASSET The Purchases Journal is posted to the General Ledger using the column totals at the end of the month.
REVIEW QUESTIONS 5.2
1 ExplainTHEROLEOFTHE0URCHASES*OURNAL 2 StateWHICHTYPEOFSOURCEDOCUMENTISUSEDTOVERIFYALLTRANSACTIONSRECORDED INTHE0URCHASES*OURNAL 3 ExplainTHEEFFECTONTHEVALUATIONOFSTOCKOF'34CHARGEDBYSUPPLIERS ON CREDITPURCHASES 4 2EFERRINGTOTHE0URCHASES*OURNAL stateONEREASONWHYTHEAMOUNTRECORDED INTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLCOLUMNISGREATERTHANTHEVALUEOFSTOCKPURCHASED 5 ShowTHEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESNECESSARYTOPOSTTHE0URCHASES*OURNALTO THE'ENERAL,EDGER 6 ExplainTHEEFFECTONTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTOF'34CHARGEDBYSUPPLIERS ONCREDITPURCHASES
5.3
control account an account in the General Ledger summarising the transactions recorded in the subsidiary ledger accounts subsidiary ledger an additional set of ledger accounts kept outside the General Ledger, recording individual transactions for each individual debtor or creditor
THE CREDITORS (SUBSIDIARY) LEDGER
!LTHOUGHWEHAVERECORDEDTHETOTALPURCHASEDFROMCREDITORS THEREISATPRESENTNO RECORDOFTHEAMOUNTSOWEDTOINDIVIDUALCREDITORS4HE0URCHASES*OURNALWASPOSTED TOAcontrol accountINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERCALLED#REDITORS#ONTROL WHICHSUMMARISED THEPURCHASESFROMallCREDITORS 4HE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTISCALLEDCreditors Control MAKINGITCLEARTHATITISA summaryACCOUNT ANDFURTHERDETAILSARERECORDEDELSEWHERE)NTHECASEOFCREDITORS THE DETAILED RECORDS ARE KEPT IN A subsidiary ledger CALLED THE #REDITORS ,EDGER ! SUBSIDIARY LEDGER IS AN ADDITIONAL SET OF LEDGER ACCOUNTS KEPT OUTSIDE THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER7HEREASTHE'ENERAL,EDGERCONTAINSTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNT SHOWINGA SUMMARYOFALLTRANSACTIONSAFFECTINGCREDITORSASAWHOLE THE#REDITORS,EDGERCONTAINS A SEPARATE ACCOUNT FOR EACH INDIVIDUAL CREDITOR SHOWING EACH INDIVIDUAL TRANSACTION AFFECTINGTHATCREDITORSBALANCE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 5
SPECIAL JOURNALS 1: CREDIT JOURNALS
Posting the Purchases Journal to the Creditors Ledger
91
STUDY TIP
!LTHOUGH IT IS STILL A LEDGER THE DOUBLE ENTRY RECORDING RULES ARE MODIlED SOMEWHAT WHENPOSTINGTOTHE#REDITORS,EDGER)TISINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERTHATTHEDOUBLE ENTRY RECORDING RULE n REQUIRING A MATCHING DEBIT AND CREDIT ENTRY n MUST BE MAINTAINED )NTHE#REDITORS,EDGER ALLTHATMUSTBESHOWNARETHEdetailsTHATIS THEINDIVIDUAL TRANSACTIONSTHATTOGETHERMAKEUPTHEONECREDITENTRYINTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNT 4HE 0URCHASES *OURNAL IN &IGURE WOULD BE POSTED TO THE #REDITORS ,EDGER AS SHOWNIN&IGURE
,OOKINGATTHE INDIVIDUALACCOUNTSIN THE#REDITORS,EDGER ISLIKE@ZOOMINGINON THE#REDITORS#ONTROL ACCOUNTnSORTOFLIKE ZOOMINGINON'OOGLE %ARTH
Figure 5.4 Creditors Ledger: posting the Purchases Journal Creditors Ledger Marks and Co. (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Oct. 1
Stock Control/GST Clearing
253
25
Stock Control/GST Clearing
451
704 Walton Traders (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Oct. 6
Stock Control/GST Clearing
220
29
Stock Control/GST Clearing
187
407 Jackson Suppliers (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Oct. 17
Cross-reference Stock Control/GST Clearing
Amount $ 209
STUDY TIP
209 Highlife Ltd (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Oct. 22
Cross-reference Stock Control/GST Clearing
Amount $ 352
352
4HEENTRIESINA CONTROLACCOUNTMUST BEREPLICATEDINTHE SUBSIDIARYLEDGER BUTASINDIVIDUAL TRANSACTIONS
4HEDOUBLEENTRYISMAINTAINEDINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER BUTINTHE#REDITORS,EDGER EACHINDIVIDUALCREDITORSACCOUNTISCREDITEDFORTHEINDIVIDUALTRANSACTIONSTHATMADE UPTHATTOTAL ONTHEDATETHATTHEYOCCURRED The Purchases Journal is posted to the Creditors Ledger using the individual transactions on the date they occur.
The Creditors Schedule )N ORDER TO CHECK THAT THE SAME INFORMATION HAS BEEN RECORDED ALBEIT IN A DIFFERENT FORM INTHE'ENERAL,EDGERAND#REDITORS,EDGER ACreditors ScheduleOR#REDITORS 2ECONCILIATION IS PREPARED 4HIS OCCURS AT THE END OF THE MONTH BEFORE THE "ALANCE 3HEETISPREPARED4HE#REDITORS3CHEDULELISTSTHENAMEANDBALANCEOFEACHINDIVIDUAL ACCOUNTINTHE#REDITORS,EDGER&IGURESHOWSTHE#REDITORS3CHEDULEFOR,INENAND -C#ARTNEYASAT/CTOBER ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Creditors Schedule a list of the name and balance of each individual account in the Creditors Ledger, added together to enable checking against the balance of the Creditors Control account
Cambridge University Press
92
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Figure 5.5 Creditors Schedule LINEN AND McCARTNEY Creditors Schedule as at 31 October 2015 Creditor
Balance $
Marks and Co.
704
Walton Traders
407
Jackson Suppliers
209
Highlife Ltd
352
Balance as per Creditors Control account
1 672
4HETOTALOFTHE#REDITORS3CHEDULEISCALCULATEDBYADDINGTOGETHERTHEBALANCES OFTHEINDIVIDUALCREDITORACCOUNTSINTHE#REDITORS,EDGER ANDTHISSHOULDEQUALTHE BALANCEOFTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER4HE#REDITORS3CHEDULE FULlLSACONTROLFUNCTIONBYACTINGASACHECKINGMECHANISM/NLYTHEBALANCEOFTHE #REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNTOF$1 672WILLBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEET Note:)NTHISEXAMPLE THESUMOFTHEBALANCESOFTHEINDIVIDUALCREDITORSACCOUNTS MATCHESNOTONLYTHEBALANCEOFTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNT BUTALSOTHETOTALOFTHE 0URCHASES*OURNALBECAUSENOCASHPAYMENTSTOCREDITORSHAVEBEENRECORDED)TISNOT NECESSARY NORLIKELY THATTHE#REDITORS3CHEDULEWILLEQUALTHETOTALOFTHE0URCHASES *OURNALITMUSTONLYMATCHTHEBALANCEOFTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNT REVIEW QUESTIONS 5.3
1 Explain THE RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN THE #REDITORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT AND THE #REDITORS,EDGER 2 State TWO DIFFERENCES IN THE WAY THE 0URCHASES *OURNAL IS POSTED TO THE #REDITORS,EDGERASCOMPAREDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER 3 StateTHEFUNCTIONOFA#REDITORS3CHEDULE 4 ExplainHOWTHE#REDITORS3CHEDULEAIDSINTHECONTROLOFCREDITORS
5.4
THE SALES JOURNAL AND THE DEBTORS (SUBSIDIARY) LEDGER
*USTASALLCREDITPURCHASESHAVEEXACTLYTHESAMEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIES SOTOODOALL CREDITSALES DR #2 #2
Debtors Control
3ALES2EVENUE
'34#LEARING
AND $2 #2
#OSTOF3ALES
3TOCK#ONTROL
4HESETRANSACTIONSCANBESUMMARISEDINA Sales JournalTOALLOWTHETOTALCREDITSALESOF Sales Journal an accounting record STOCKTOBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSATTHEENDOFTHEMONTH summarising all transactions involving the sale of stock on credit during a month
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 5
SPECIAL JOURNALS 1: CREDIT JOURNALS
93
Recording in the Sales Journal 4HECREDITSALESFOR/CTOBERFOR,INENAND-C#ARTNEYARESUMMARISEDINTHE3ALES *OURNALIN&IGURE Figure 5.6 Sales Journal
Date1
Debtor2
Invoice
Cost of
number3
Sales4
Sales5
GST6
Debtors Control7
R. Starr
45
290
450
45
495
G. Martin
46
160
300
30
330
14
R. Starr
47
200
380
38
418
20
B. Epstein
48
220
400
40
440
27
G. Martin
49
150
270
27
297
1 020
1 800
180
1 980
Oct. 2 6
Totals
Notes for recording in the Sales Journal 1
Date !S WITH THE 0URCHASES *OURNAL TRANSACTIONS ARE RECORDED IN THE 3ALES *OURNAL ON THEDATETHEYOCCUR ASTHISISTHEDATEONWHICHTHEYWILLBEPOSTEDTOTHE$EBTORS ,EDGER
2 Debtor 7HEREASCREDITPURCHASESWILLINCREASE#REDITORS#ONTROL CREDITSALESWILLINCREASE $EBTORS#ONTROL)NADDITION THE3ALES*OURNALMUSTSHOWTHENAMEOFEACHINDIVIDUAL DEBTORSOTHATTHEINDIVIDUALTRANSACTIONSCANBEPOSTEDTOTHEAPPROPRIATEACCOUNTS INTHE$EBTORS,EDGER 3 Invoice number !LTHOUGHTHEINVOICESWILLNOTRUNINSEQUENCEINTHE0URCHASES*OURNAL THEYWILLIN THE3ALES*OURNAL BECAUSETHEYAREALLISSUEDBYTHEBUSINESSKEEPINGTHEJOURNAL 4 Cost of Sales 4HE AMOUNT LISTED UNDER #OST OF 3ALES WILL BE THE COST PRICE OF THE STOCK SOLD EXCLUDINGANY'344HISISTHEAMOUNTTHATWILLBEPOSTEDTORECORDTHEEXPENSE INCURREDWHENSTOCKISSOLD
$2 #2
#OSTOF3ALES%
3TOCK#ONTROL!
5 Sales 4HISISTHESELLINGPRICEOFTHESALE excludingANY'34THATIS THEAMOUNTOFSALES REVENUEEARNEDFROMTHESALE 6 GST 4HISISTHE'34CHARGEDTODEBTORS ONCREDITSALES CALCULATEDASOFTHEPRICE OFTHESALEASRECORDEDINTHE3ALESCOLUMN 4HE'34CHARGEDDOESNOTAFFECTTHE AMOUNT OF REVENUE EARNED IT INCREASES THE '34 LIABILITY OWED TO THE !4/ AND INCREASESTHEAMOUNTOWEDBYDEBTORS 7 Debtors Control 4HISISTHETOTALAMOUNTOWEDBYDEBTORS CALCULATEDBYADDINGTOGETHERTHESELLING PRICEOFTHESTOCKSOLDandTHE'34CHARGED4HATIS EACHDEBTOROWESUSFORTHE SALEANDTHE'34ONTHATSALE ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
STUDY TIP
!SWITHCREDIT PURCHASES CREDITSALES WILLALWAYSIDENTIFYTHAT '34APPLIES
Cambridge University Press
94
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Posting the Sales Journal to the General Ledger and Debtors Ledger 4HETOTALSOFTHE3ALES*OURNALAREPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSATTHEENDOF THEMONTHINTHISCASE /CTOBER ASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 5.7 General Ledger: posting the Sales Journal General Ledger Debtors Control (A) Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference Sales/GST Clearing
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
1 980 Sales (R)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Oct. 31
Debtors Control
1 800
GST Clearing (A or L) Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference Creditors Control
Amount $
Date
152
Oct. 31
Cross-reference Debtors Control
Amount $ 180
Stock Control (A) Date Oct. 1 31
Cross-reference Balance Creditors Control
Amount $
Date
10 000
Oct. 31
Cross-reference Cost of Sales
Amount $ 1 020
1 520 Cost of Sales (E)
Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference Stock Control
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
1 020
2ECORDINGTRANSACTIONSINTHE3ALES*OURNALHASREDUCEDTHENUMBEROFDEBITAND CREDITENTRIESFROMTWOENTRIESATCOSTPRICEANDTHREEENTRIESATSELLINGPRICE TIMES lVETRANSACTIONS TOJUSTlVEINTOTAL The Sales Journal is posted to the General Ledger using the column totals at the end of the month.
Posting the Sales Journal to the Debtors Ledger )N CONTRAST TO THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER IN WHICH ONLY THE TOTALS ARE POSTED AT THE END OF THEMONTH THE$EBTORS,EDGERMUSTSHOWEACHINDIVIDUALCREDITSALE INTHEACCOUNT OF EACH INDIVIDUAL DEBTOR ON THE DATE THE TRANSACTION ACTUALLY OCCURRED !S WITH THE #REDITORS,EDGER THE$EBTORS,EDGERRECORDSANADDITIONALDEBITTOMIRRORTHEDEBITTO $EBTORS#ONTROLINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER4HISISSHOWNIN&IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 5
SPECIAL JOURNALS 1: CREDIT JOURNALS
95
Figure 5.8 Debtors Ledger: posting the Sales Journal Debtors Ledger R. Starr (A) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Oct. 2
Sales/GST Clearing
495
14
Sales/GST Clearing
418
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
913 G. Martin (A) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Oct. 6
Sales/GST Clearing
330
27
Sales/GST Clearing
297
Date
627 STUDY TIP
B. Epstein (A) Date Oct. 20
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
440
Sales/GST Clearing
The Sales Journal is posted to the Debtors Ledger using the individual transactions on the date they occur.
7HATEVERENTRIES APPEARINACONTROL ACCOUNTMUSTBE REPLICATEDINTHE SUBSIDIARYLEDGER BUTASINDIVIDUAL TRANSACTIONS
The Debtors Schedule !$EBTORS3CHEDULECANBEPREPAREDTOCHECKTHEACCURACYOFTHEPOSTING FOLLOWING THESAMEPROCESSTHATWASUSEDTOPRODUCEA#REDITORS3CHEDULE&IGURESHOWSTHE $EBTORS3CHEDULEFOR,INENAND-C#ARTNEYASAT/CTOBER
Figure 5.9 Debtors Schedule LINEN AND McCARTNEY Debtors Schedule as at 31 October 2015 Debtor
Balance $
R. Starr
913
G. Martin
627
B. Epstein
440
Balance as per Debtors Control account
1 980
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
96
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 5.4
1 ExplainTHEROLEOFTHE3ALES*OURNAL 2 State WHICH TYPE OF SOURCE DOCUMENT IS USED TO VERIFY ALL TRANSACTIONS RECORDEDINTHE3ALES*OURNAL 3 ExplainTHEEFFECTONREVENUEEARNEDOF'34CHARGEDTODEBTORSONCREDIT SALES 4 2EFERRINGTOTHE3ALES*OURNAL stateONEREASONWHYTHEAMOUNTRECORDEDIN THE$EBTORS#ONTROLCOLUMNISGREATERTHANSALESREVENUEEARNED 5 ShowTHEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESNECESSARYTOPOSTTHE3ALES*OURNALTOTHE 'ENERAL,EDGER 6 ExplainTHEEFFECTONTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTOF'34CHARGEDTODEBTORS ONCREDITSALES 7 Explain THE RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN THE $EBTORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT AND THE $EBTORS,EDGER 8 StateTWODIFFERENCESINTHEWAYTHE3ALES*OURNALISPOSTEDTOTHE$EBTORS ,EDGERASCOMPAREDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER 9 StateTHEFUNCTIONOFA$EBTORS3CHEDULE 10 ExplainHOWTHE$EBTORS3CHEDULEAIDSINTHECONTROLOFDEBTORS
5.5
REPORTING GST CLEARING
!TTHEENDOFTHEREPORTINGPERIOD THE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTMUSTBEBALANCED AND REPORTEDASEITHERACURRENTASSETORACURRENTLIABILITY DEPENDINGONWHETHERITHASA DEBITBALANCEORACREDITBALANCE!FTERBALANCINGATTHEENDOF/CTOBER THE'34 #LEARINGACCOUNTFOR,INENAND-C#ARTNEYWOULDSHOW GST Clearing (A or L) Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference Creditors Control Balance
Amount $ 152
Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference Debtors Control
180 Nov. 1
GST refund a cash receipt from the ATO to refund the excess that occurs when GST on sales is less than GST on purchases
180
28 180
GST settlement a cash payment made to the ATO to settle the liability that occurs when GST on sales is greater than GST on purchases
Amount $
Balance
28
4HECREDITBALANCEOFINDICATESTHATTHISACCOUNTISAcurrent liability'34CHARGED TODEBTORSONSALES ISGREATERTHAN'34CHARGEDBYCREDITORSONPURCHASES SO THE BUSINESS OWES TO THE !4/ '34 #LEARING WOULD THUS BE REPORTED IN THE "ALANCE3HEETWITHOTHERCURRENTLIABILITIES SUCHAS"ANKOVERDRAFTAND#REDITORS#ONTROL ASAPRESENTOBLIGATIONTHEBUSINESSMUSTMEETATSOMETIMEWITHINTHENEXTMONTHS WHENITMAKESAPAYMENTTOTHE!4/INTHEFORMOFAGST settlement )F THE '34 ON SALES HAD BEEN less THAN THE '34 ON PURCHASES THE '34 #LEARING ACCOUNT WOULD HAVE HAD A debit BALANCE 4HIS WOULD MEAN '34 #LEARING WOULD BE A current asset A RESOURCE CONTROLLED BY THE BUSINESS FROM WHICH A FUTURE ECONOMIC BENElT IS EXPECTED IN THE NEXT MONTHS '34 #LEARING WOULD BE REPORTED IN THE "ALANCE 3HEET WITH OTHER CURRENT ASSETS SUCH AS "ANK 3TOCK #ONTROL AND $EBTORS #ONTROL ANDTHEBUSINESSWOULDBEDUEAGST refundFROMTHE!4/
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 5
SPECIAL JOURNALS 1: CREDIT JOURNALS
REVIEW QUESTIONS 5.5
1 ExplainHOWTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTMAYENDUPWITHACREDITBALANCE 2 Explain HOW THE '34 #LEARING ACCOUNT SHOULD BE REPORTED IN THE "ALANCE 3HEETIFITHASACREDITBALANCE 3 DefineTHETERM@'34SETTLEMENT 4 ExplainHOWTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTMAYENDUPWITHADEBITBALANCE 5 Explain HOW THE '34 #LEARING ACCOUNT SHOULD BE REPORTED IN THE "ALANCE 3HEETIFITHASADEBITBALANCE 6 DefineTHETERM@'34REFUND
5.6
BENEFITS OF USING CONTROL ACCOUNTS AND SUBSIDIARY LEDGERS
!LTHOUGHITMAYSEEMLIKEMOREWORKTHANSIMPLYUSINGASINGLEACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL ,EDGER USINGASYSTEMOFCONTROLACCOUNTSANDSUBSIDIARYLEDGERSISVITALINENSURING THATALLRELEVANTINFORMATIONISAVAILABLE4HETHREEMAINBENElTSOFUSINGASYSTEMOF CONTROLACCOUNTSANDSUBSIDIARYLEDGERSARE Double-checking that allows detection of recording errors. 4HE PREPARATION OF A $EBTORS OR #REDITORS 3CHEDULE ALLOWS THE BALANCE OF THE CONTROL ACCOUNT TO BE CHECKED AGAINST THE SUM OF THE BALANCES OF THE SUBSIDIARY LEDGER ACCOUNTS 4HIS ALLOWSFORRECORDINGERRORSTOBEDETECTEDANDCORRECTED IMPROVINGTHEReliability OFTHEBALANCEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEET s Ease of reporting. 4HESINGLEBALANCEFORALLDEBTORSORCREDITORSPROVIDEDBYTHE CONTROLACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER ANDTHE3CHEDULE MEANSTHATTHE"ALANCE 3HEET NEED ONLY REPORT THE BALANCE OF THE CONTROL ACCOUNT RATHER THAN LIST EVERY INDIVIDUALDEBTORORCREDITOR ANDTHEIRINDIVIDUALBALANCES/MITTINGTHESEDETAILS GIVES GREATER Relevance AS THESE DETAILS WOULD NOT BE USEFUL FOR THE TYPES OF DECISION MAKINGTHATRELYONTHE"ALANCE3HEETFORINFORMATION s Allocation of responsibility. 3EPARATING THE SUBSIDIARY LEDGER ACCOUNTS FROM THE 'ENERAL,EDGERMEANSTHEMANAGEMENTOFTHESUBSIDIARYLEDGERCANBEALLOCATED TOAPARTICULAREMPLOYEE4HISEMPLOYEECANTHENBERESPONSIBLEFORMANAGINGALL DEALINGSWITHDEBTORSSUCHASTHEASSESSMENTOFCREDITWORTHINESSTHEISSUINGOF SALESINVOICESTHECOLLECTIONOFRECEIPTSFROMDEBTORSANDTHEMANAGEMENTOFBAD DEBTS ORCREDITORSSUCHASTHECOLLECTIONOFPURCHASEINVOICESANDTIMELYPAYMENT OF CREDITORS 'REATER ACCOUNTABILITY WOULD HOPEFULLY IMPROVE EFFECTIVENESS AND WOULDALSOLEAVETHESENIORBOOKKEEPERFREETOMANAGETHE'ENERAL,EDGER 4HUS USINGASYSTEMTHATINCORPORATESBOTHSUBSIDIARYLEDGERSANDCONTROLACCOUNTS HAS BENElTS FOR RECORDING DOUBLE CHECKING REPORTING EASE OF REPORTING AND MANAGEMENTALLOCATIONOFRESPONSIBILITY 4HE ALTERNATIVE WOULD BE TO INCLUDE ALL INDIVIDUAL ACCOUNTS IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER BUT THIS WOULD REMOVE THE DOUBLE CHECKING MECHANISM REQUIRE MANY lGURES TO BE REPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETANDDISALLOWTHEALLOCATIONOFRESPONSIBILITY s
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
97
98
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s 3PECIALJOURNALSSUMMARISESIMILARTRANSACTIONSSOTHATTOTALSCANBEPOSTEDTOTHE 'ENERAL,EDGER WHICHREDUCESTHENUMBEROFLEDGERENTRIESREQUIREDANDIMPROVES THEEFlCIENCYOFTHERECORDINGSYSTEM s 4HE'ENERAL*OURNALISUSEDTORECORDALLINFREQUENT NON CASHTRANSACTIONS s !CONTROLACCOUNTISANACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERSUMMARISINGTHETRANSACTIONS RECORDEDINTHESUBSIDIARYLEDGER*OURNALTOTALSAREPOSTEDATTHEENDOFTHEMONTH s !SUBSIDIARYLEDGERISANADDITIONALSETOFLEDGERACCOUNTSKEPTOUTSIDETHE'ENERAL ,EDGER CONTAININGINDIVIDUALTRANSACTIONSPOSTEDONTHEDAYTHEYOCCUR s !3CHEDULELISTSTHENAMEANDBALANCEOFEACHINDIVIDUALACCOUNTINTHESUBSIDIARY LEDGER ANDSHOULDEQUALTHEBALANCEOFTHECONTROLACCOUNT s 4HE'34ONCREDITPURCHASESDOESNOTAFFECTTHEVALUATIONOFSTOCKITREDUCESTHE '34LIABILITYOWEDTOTHE!4/ANDINCREASESTHEDEBTOWEDTOCREDITORS s 4HETOTALAMOUNTOWEDTOCREDITORSINCLUDESTHEVALUEOFTHESTOCKPURCHASEDAND THE'34 s 4HE'34ONCREDITSALESDOESNOTAFFECTTHEAMOUNTOFREVENUEEARNEDITINCREASES THE'34LIABILITYOWEDTOTHE!4/ANDINCREASESTHEAMOUNTOWEDBYDEBTORS s 4HETOTALAMOUNTOWEDBYDEBTORSINCLUDESTHESELLINGPRICEOFTHESTOCKSOLDAND THE'34 s !TTHEENDOFTHEREPORTINGPERIOD THE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTMUSTBEBALANCED ANDREPORTEDASEITHERACURRENTASSETORACURRENTLIABILITY DEPENDINGONWHETHER ITHASADEBITORACREDITBALANCE s 4HEMAINBENElTSFROMUSINGASYSTEMOFCONTROLACCOUNTSANDSUBSIDIARYLEDGERS AREDETECTIONOFRECORDINGERRORS EASEOFREPORTINGANDALLOCATIONOFRESPONSIBILITY
Transaction
Document
Journal
General Ledger: sTOTALS sENDOFTHEMONTH
Subsidiary ledger: sINDIVIDUALTRANSACTIONS sTRANSACTIONDATE
Credit purchases of stock
Purchase invoice
Purchases Journal
DR Stock Control DR GST Clearing CR Creditors Control
CR Each individual creditor
Credit sales of stock
Sales invoice
Sales Journal
DR Debtors Control CR Sales CR GST Clearing DR Cost of Sales CR Stock Control
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
DR Each individual debtor
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 5
SPECIAL JOURNALS 1: CREDIT JOURNALS
EXERCISE 5.1 PURCHASES JOURNAL
page 66
W B
99
EXERCISES
4HEFOLLOWINGDOCUMENTWASHANDEDTOTHEMANAGEROF0ORCELAIN-AGIC ASHOPTHAT SELLSTEASETSANDPORCELAINSTATUES
Fine Tea China
322–335 Swindle St, Melbourne VIC 3000 ABN: 24 664 237 190
Invoice: S.90
Tax invoice Terms: 5/7, n/30
Charge to:
Porcelain Magic 245 Bulla Rd, Keilor VIC 3043 ABN: 82 100 346 275
Date
Details
Qty
Unit Price $
4 May 2015
Fine China Tea Sets
10
120
Total $ 1200
GST (10%)
120 Total
$1 320
Required a IdentifyTHESOURCEDOCUMENTABOVE ANDdescribeTHETRANSACTIONITVERIlES b RecordTHISTRANSACTIONINTHEAPPROPRIATESPECIALJOURNALOF0ORCELAIN-AGIC c ShowTHEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHISTRANSACTIONINTHE'ENERAL ,EDGEROF0ORCELAIN-AGIC d ExplainWHYTHE'34ONCREDITPURCHASESDOESNOTAFFECTTHEVALUATIONOFSTOCK
EXERCISE 5.2 PURCHASES JOURNAL
W B
page 67
0HILS0IANOSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGLISTOFTRANSACTIONSFOR!UGUST Aug.
3 8 15 24 29
Purchased 5 grand pianos from Yamaha on credit. Each grand piano cost $4 000 plus GST of $400 (Inv. Yh3764) Bought 6 upright pianos from Bernstein at a total cost of $6 600 including $600 GST (Inv. B4801) Purchased 2 standard pianos from Yamaha on credit for $2 000 (plus GST) each (Inv. Yh3784) Received delivery of 4 grand pianos from Rachman, at a total cost of $17 160 including GST (Inv. R132) Purchased 3 upright pianos from Bernstein at a cost of $1 320 (including GST) each (Inv. B4816)
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
100
UNITS 3&4
Required
*
a ExplainTHEROLEOFTHE0URCHASES*OURNAL b RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR!UGUSTINTHE0URCHASES*OURNALOF0HILS0IANOS c PostTHE0URCHASES*OURNALTOTHERELEVANTACCOUNTSINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF0HILS 0IANOS d PostTHE0URCHASES*OURNALTOTHERELEVANTACCOUNTSINTHE#REDITORS,EDGEROF0HILS 0IANOS e ExplainONEDIFFERENCEINTHEWAYTHE0URCHASES*OURNALISPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL ,EDGERCOMPAREDTOTHEWAYITISPOSTEDTOTHE#REDITORS,EDGER f ExplainHOWUSINGASYSTEMOFCONTROLACCOUNTSANDSUBSIDIARYLEDGERSCANIMPROVE THE2ELIABILITYOFTHEREPORTS
EXERCISE 5.3 PURCHASES JOURNAL
W B
page 69
'LOW7ARMISALIGHTINGSTOREOWNEDBY$ONALD$IMM!SAT!PRIL s
s
THE'ENERAL,EDGERSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWINGBALANCES n '34#LEARING n 3TOCK#ONTROL n #REDITORS#ONTROL THE#REDITORS,EDGERSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWINGBALANCES n 3HOCK%LECTRICS n "RIGHT,IGHTS
#2
$ONALD HAS RECORDED THE lRMS CREDIT PURCHASES FOR !PRIL IN THE 0URCHASES *OURNAL Purchases Journal Date April 5
Creditor
Invoice
Stock
number
Control
GST
Creditors Control
Shock Electrics
I. 251
2 500
250
2 750
15
Bright Lights
CX 34
3 500
350
3 850
19
Shock Electrics
I. 268
2 000
200
2 200
26
Bright Lights
CX 40
4 000
400
4 400
12 000
1 200
13 200
Totals
Additional information: /N!PRIL 'LOW7ARMPAIDTO3HOCK%LECTRICS4HISWASTHEONLYPAYMENT TOCREDITORSFORTHEMONTHOF!PRIL Required
* *
a ExplainWHYTHEINVOICESINTHE0URCHASES*OURNALDONOTRUNINSEQUENCE b Post THE0URCHASES*OURNALTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERAND#REDITORS,EDGERFOR'LOW 7ARM c StateTHEEFFECTOF'34ONCREDITPURCHASESONTHEFOLLOWINGITEMS s 3TOCK#ONTROL s #REDITORS#ONTROL s '34#LEARING d Record THEPAYMENTTO3HOCK%LECTRICSINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERAND#REDITORS,EDGER e BalanceTHECREDITORSCONTROLACCOUNT f Foot THE SUBSIDIARY LEDGER ACCOUNTS AND prepare A #REDITORS 3CHEDULE AS AT !PRIL
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 5
SPECIAL JOURNALS 1: CREDIT JOURNALS
EXERCISE 5.4 SALES JOURNAL
page 71
W B
0ICKWICK"OOKSISABOOKSHOPIN3OUTH-ELBOURNE4HEFOLLOWINGSOURCEDOCUMENTWAS HANDEDTOITSACCOUNTANTBYAMEMBEROFTHESALESSTAFF Additional information: 0ICKWICK"OOKSAPPLIESAMARKUPTOALLITSSTOCK
Pickwick Books
TAX INVOICE ABN: 09 990 656 432
1102 Clarendon St South Melbourne VIC 3205
Invoice: 46 Terms: 30 days
12/6/15
Duplicate
Charge to:
Grant Hugh
Item
Description
T01
Children’s Bible
19 Cobbam Drive, Glen Waverley VIC 3150 Qty
Unit Cost
$
5
50
250.00
GST Total
25.00 $
275.00
Required a IdentifyTHESOURCEDOCUMENTABOVE ANDdescribeTHETRANSACTIONITVERIlES b RecordTHISTRANSACTIONINTHEAPPROPRIATESPECIALJOURNALOF0ICKWICK"OOKS c ShowTHEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHISTRANSACTIONINTHE'ENERAL ,EDGEROF0ICKWICK"OOKS d Explain WHY '34 CHARGED ON CREDIT SALES INCREASES THE '34 LIABILITY OF 0ICKWICK "OOKS
EXERCISE 5.5 SALES JOURNAL
W B
page 72
0OLLY*UNIORSELLSCHILDRENSFURNITUREATAMARK UP ANDHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWING LISTOFTRANSACTIONSFOR3EPTEMBER Sept.
5 11 16 23 29
Sold 2 bookcases on credit to Rydell Primary School for $240 (plus $24 GST) each (Inv. 75) Sold 3 children’s beds to Camp Somerset for $660 including $60 GST per bed (Inv. 76) Sold 6 desks on credit to Rydell Primary School, charging $900 plus GST (Inv. 77) Sold 4 children’s beds to Camp Somerset for a total invoice price of $2 640 (including GST) Sold 1 bookcase to 123 Playgroup for $240 plus $24 GST (Inv. 79)
Required
*
a StateTHEINVOICENUMBERFORTHETRANSACTIONON3EPTEMBER b RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR3EPTEMBERINTHE3ALES*OURNALOF0OLLY*UNIOR c PostTHE3ALES*OURNALTOTHERELEVANTACCOUNTSINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF0OLLY*UNIOR ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
101
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
102
UNITS 3&4
d PostTHE3ALES*OURNALTOTHERELEVANTACCOUNTSINTHE$EBTORS,EDGEROF0OLLY*UNIOR e ExplainHOWUSINGASYSTEMOFCONTROLACCOUNTSANDSUBSIDIARYLEDGERSCANIMPROVE THEMANAGEMENTOFDEBTORS
EXERCISE 5.6 SALES JOURNAL
W B
page 74
%RNIE 7ALSH IS THE OWNER OF %* (I&I (E SELLS STEREO EQUIPMENT AND HAS JUST WON A LUCRATIVECONTRACTTOlTOUTACHAINOFHOTELSWITHSTEREOEQUIPMENT!SAT*UNE s
s
THE'ENERAL,EDGERSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWINGBALANCES n '34#LEARING #2 n $EBTORS#ONTROL n 3TOCK#ONTROL THE$EBTORS,EDGERSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWINGBALANCES n $*7AREHOUSE n (OLDEN(OTELS
4HElRMSCREDITSALESFOR*UNEARERECORDEDINTHE3ALES*OURNALBELOW Sales Journal Date
Debtor
Invoice
Cost of
number
Sales
Sales
GST
Debtors Control
June 4
Holden Hotels
86
1 000
1 500
150
1 650
15
Holden Hotels
87
2 000
3 000
300
3 300
21
DJ Warehouse
88
800
1 200
120
1 320
28
Holden Hotels
89
1 400
2 100
210
2 310
5 200
7 800
780
8 580
Totals
Additional information: s /N*UNE %*(I&IRECEIVEDFROM(OLDEN(OTELS s 4ERMSOFDAYSAREOFFEREDTOCREDITCUSTOMERS Required
* *
a State ONE REASON WHY THE INVOICE NUMBERS RECORDED IN THE 3ALES *OURNAL RUN IN SEQUENCE b PostTHE3ALES*OURNALTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERAND$EBTORS,EDGEROF%*(I&I c StateTHEEFFECTOF'34ONCREDITSALESONTHEFOLLOWINGITEMS s 3ALES2EVENUE s $EBTORS#ONTROL s '34#LEARING d RecordTHERECEIPTFROM(OLDEN(OTELSINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERAND$EBTORS,EDGER e BalanceTHE$EBTORS#ONTROLACCOUNT f FootTHESUBSIDIARYLEDGERANDprepareA$EBTORS3CHEDULEASAT*UNE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 5
SPECIAL JOURNALS 1: CREDIT JOURNALS
EXERCISE 5.7 CREDIT JOURNALS
W B
page 76
"EN(EWITTAND,AURA#ARTWRIGHTLEFTTHEIRFORMERCAREERSANDDECIDEDTOSTARTASMALL BUSINESSCALLED(#4ENNIS SELLINGTENNISEQUIPMENTFROMAFACTORYIN"ENTLEIGH4HE FOLLOWINGDOCUMENTSHAVENOTYETBEENRECORDEDINTHEJOURNALSFOR-AY DOCUMENT A
H&C Tennis
Invoice: 92 DUPLICATE Terms: 10/7, n/30 TAX INVOICE
120 Norman St Bentleigh VIC 3204 ABN: 94 863 021 005
Charge to: Elicia Molik 4 White Street, Elwood VIC 3184 C Date May 6
Details Racquets – Spaulding Brand
Qty
Price $
8
66.00
Total
528.00
GST included in total
48.00
DOCUMENT B
Top Quality Racquets
Invoice: A80
UA LI
ET
P
Q
ORIGINAL Terms: 10/7, n/30
U
TO
ABN: 66 090 786 511
S
254 Union Rd, Ascot Vale VIC 3032 Q T Y RAC
Charge to:
H&C Tennis Norman Street Bentleigh VIC 3204
Date
Details
May 9
30 Spaulding tennis racquets: $30 (plus GST) each
Total $990.00
Total invoice amount includes GST of $90
Required a 2EFERRING TO ONE QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTIC explain THE IMPORTANCE OF SOURCE DOCUMENTSINTHEACCOUNTINGPROCESS b 2EFERRINGTOTHEINFORMATIONPROVIDED identifyTHESOURCEDOCUMENTTHATVERIlESA CREDITSALEJustifyYOURANSWER c 'IVENTHATSTOCKISSOLDATMARK UP record$OCUMENTS!AND"INTHESPECIAL JOURNALSOF(#4ENNIS d 2EFERRINGONLYTOTHEINFORMATIONPROVIDED stateWHETHER(#4ENNISWOULDHAVEA '34ASSETOR'34LIABILITYJustifyYOURANSWER ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
103
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
104
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 5.8 CREDIT JOURNALS
page 77
W B
'LEN #OPPELL OPERATES A SPORTS STORE CALLED #OPPELL 3PORTS !T -ARCH HIS ACCOUNTINGRECORDSSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWINGBALANCES Stock Control Debtors Control – Gunter Basketball Club
$ 9 000
GST Clearing
$
200
6 490
Creditors Control
2 750
990
– München Sports
1 100
– AB Sports Gear
1 650
– Ruddersfield FC
2 200
– Central Warriors Soccer Club
3 300
CR
4HEFOLLOWINGOCCURREDDURING-ARCH March
1 4 7 10 12 16 20 23 28
Sold stock to Central Warriors for $770 (including $70 GST). The stock had a cost price of $420 (Inv. 35) Received $2 200 cash from Ruddersfield FC (Rec. 21) Purchased sporting goods on credit from München Sports (Inv. E93) worth $600 plus $60 GST Gunter Basketball Club purchased sporting goods worth $500 plus GST, with a cost price of $310 (Inv. 36) Paid AB Sports Gear $1 000 on account (Ch. 244) Sold stock to Central Warriors – total invoice price $880 (including GST). The stock was originally purchased for $600 plus $60 GST (Inv. 37). Purchased stock for $900 (plus GST) from AB Sports Gear (Inv. 82) Sold sporting goods to Ruddersfield FC for $1 650 (including GST). The stock had a cost price of $1 200 plus GST (Inv. 38). Purchased sporting goods from München Sports (Inv. E113) for $1 320 including GST.
Required
*
* *
a Record THE TRANSACTIONS FOR -ARCH IN THE APPROPRIATE SPECIAL JOURNALS OF #OPPELL3PORTS b PostTHE3ALES*OURNALAND0URCHASES*OURNALTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERANDSUBSIDIARY LEDGERSOF#OPPELL3PORTS c BalanceTHE$EBTORS#ONTROLAND#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNTS d Foot THE SUBSIDIARY LEDGER ACCOUNTS AND prepare A $EBTORS 3CHEDULE AND A #REDITORS3CHEDULEASAT-ARCH e Explain HOW '34 #LEARING WOULD BE REPORTED IN THE "ALANCE 3HEET OF #OPPELL 3PORTSASAT-ARCH f ExplainWHYTHERECORDSOF#OPPELL3PORTSWOULDSHOW'UNTER"ASKETBALL#LUBWITH ADEBITBALANCE WHEREASTHERECORDSOF'UNTER"ASKETBALL#LUBWOULDSHOW#OPPELL 3PORTSWITHACREDITBALANCE
EXERCISE 5.9 CREDIT JOURNALS
page 81
W B
)RVING#REESEOPERATESASTORECALLED3OFT3HIRTS WHICHHADTHEFOLLOWINGBALANCESAS AT!PRIL Stock Control
$ 3 000
GST Clearing
$
200 CR
Debtors Control
4 070
Creditors Control
4 730
– Daniel Jones
2 090
– Jade
3 190
– Mier Stores
1 980
– Country Style
1 540
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 5
SPECIAL JOURNALS 1: CREDIT JOURNALS
4HETRANSACTIONSFOR!PRILHAVEBEENRECORDEDINTHEJOURNALSBELOW Sales Journal Invoice
Cost of
number
Sales
Sales
GST
Debtors
Date
Debtor
April 4
Mier Stores
85
1 000
1 500
150
1 650
Apr. 8
Daniel Jones
86
1 400
2 100
210
2 310
Apr. 15
Big X
87
500
750
75
825
Apr. 21
Daniel Jones
88
800
1 200
120
1 320
Apr. 28
Mier Stores
89
1 200
1 800
180
1 980
4 900
7 350
735
8 085
Totals
Control
Purchases Journal Date
Creditor
Invoice number
Stock
GST
Creditors Control
April 5
Jade
I. 251
2 400
240
2 640
Apr. 12
Country Style
CX 34
1 800
180
1 980
Apr. 19
Country Style
I. 268
2 300
230
2 530
Apr. 26
Jade
CX 40
1 100
110
1 210
7 600
760
8 360
Totals
Additional information: s /N!PRIL 3OFT3HIRTSPAIDTO*ADE s /N!PRIL 3OFT3HIRTSRECEIVEDFROM-IER3TORES Required
* *
a StateWHETHERSPECIALJOURNALSBELONGTOTHEINPUT PROCESSINGOROUTPUTSTAGEOF THEACCOUNTINGPROCESSJustifyYOURRESPONSE b PostTHEJOURNALSTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERANDSUBSIDIARYLEDGERSOF3OFT3HIRTS c BalanceTHE$EBTORS#ONTROLAND#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNTS d Prepare A $EBTORS 3CHEDULE AND #REDITORS 3CHEDULE FOR 3OFT 3HIRTS AS AT !PRIL e ExplainHOW'34#LEARINGWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF3OFT3HIRTSAS AT!PRIL f Explain TWO BENElTS THAT 3OFT 3HIRTS DERIVES BY ADOPTING A SYSTEM OF CONTROL ACCOUNTSANDSUBSIDIARYLEDGERSFORDEBTORSANDCREDITORS Additional information: /N -AY 3OFT 3HIRTS PURCHASED OFlCE FURNITURE ON CREDIT FROM $ESK 7ORLD FOR PLUS'34)NV Required g ExplainWHY)NVSHOULDnotBERECORDEDINTHE0URCHASES*OURNAL
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
105
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s recordCASHPAYMENTSWITH '34ANDDISCOUNTS INTHE #ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL s postTHE#ASH0AYMENTS *OURNALTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER AND#REDITORS,EDGER s recordCASHRECEIPTSWITH '34ANDDISCOUNTS INTHE #ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL s postTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS *OURNALTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER AND$EBTORS,EDGER
s identifyTHECOSTSAND BENElTSOFOFFERINGDISCOUNTS TOCUSTOMERS s calculateDISCOUNTEXPENSE ANDDISCOUNTREVENUE s identifyTHEEFFECTOF DISCOUNTSONTHEACCOUNTING EQUATION s identifyTHEEFFECTOF'34 ONTHERECORDINGOFCASH PAYMENTSANDCASHRECEIPTS s recordA'34REFUNDAND '34SETTLEMENTINTHECASH JOURNALSAND'ENERAL,EDGER
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s #ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL s #ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL s '34SETTLEMENT s '34REFUND s SETTLEMENTDISCOUNT s DISCOUNTREVENUE s DISCOUNTEXPENSE ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
108
6.1
UNITS 3&4
THE CASH PAYMENTS JOURNAL
4HE SPECIAL JOURNALS DESCRIBED IN #HAPTER DEALT SOLELY WITH CREDIT TRANSACTIONS THE 0URCHASES *OURNAL SUMMARISED ALL STOCK PURCHASED ON CREDIT AND THE 3ALES *OURNAL SUMMARISEDALLSTOCKSOLDONCREDIT"YSUMMARISINGTHESETRANSACTIONS ITWASPOSSIBLE TOPOSTTHE0URCHASES*OURNALTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERINONLYTHREEENTRIES ANDTHE3ALES *OURNALINONLYlVE Purchases Journal
DR
Stock Control
DR
GST Clearing
CR Sales Journal
DR
Creditors Control* Debtors Control*
CR
Sales Revenue
CR
GST Clearing and
DR CR
Cost of Sales Stock Control
)NDIVIDUALTRANSACTIONSMUSTALSOBEPOSTEDTOTHEINDIVIDUALACCOUNTSINTHECREDITORS ANDDEBTORSSUBSIDIARYLEDGERS 4HESAMEAPPROACHTHATIS SUMMARISINGSIMILARTRANSACTIONSBEFOREPOSTINGTHEMTO THE'ENERAL,EDGER CANBEAPPLIEDTOCASHRECEIPTSANDCASHPAYMENTS WITHTHE#ASH 0AYMENTS*OURNALUSEDTOSUMMARISEALLCASHPAID ANDTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALUSED TOSUMMARISEALLCASHRECEIVED
EXAMPLE
Consider the following list of transactions for June 2015 for Green Thumb Plants: June 1 5 8 10 13 15 22 24 29
Paid $200 (plus $20 GST) for stock (Cheque 22) Cash paid to creditor, Mills Bros $400 (Cheque 23) Paid $190 wages (Cheque 24) Paid electricity $150, plus GST (Cheque 25) Owner withdrew $100 cash (Cheque 26) Purchased stock for $242, including $22 GST (Cheque 27) Paid $190 wages (Cheque 28) Payment to creditor – Johnson Ltd $350 (Cheque 29) Purchased new vehicle for $13 200 including GST (Cheque 30)
4HIS LIST OF TRANSACTIONS IS FAR MORE DIVERSE THAN A STRAIGHT LIST OF CREDIT SALES OR CREDIT PURCHASES )T INCLUDES CASH PAYMENTS FOR STOCK PAYMENTS TO CREDITORS PAYMENTS FOR WAGES THECASHPURCHASEOFAVEHICLE ANDEVENCASHDRAWINGSBYTHEOWNER(OWCAN THESE TRANSACTIONS BE SUMMARISED IN A SINGLE JOURNAL )N TERMS OF DEBITS AND CREDITS WHATDOESEACHOFTHETRANSACTIONSABOVEHAVEINCOMMON 4HEANSWER OFCOURSE LIESINTHEFACTTHATEACHOFTHETRANSACTIONSABOVEISAcash payment ANDTHEREFOREEACHHASEXACTLYTHESAMEEFFECTONTHELEDGERACCOUNTFOR"ANK Each cash payment requires a credit to the Bank account.
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
7HILEITISTRUETHATTHEdebit PARTOFEACHENTRYISDIFFERENT ANDONLYSOMEINVOLVE '34 EACHTRANSACTIONINVOLVESTHESAMEcredit ENTRY2ATHERTHANRECORDINGlVEORSIX CREDITS TO THE "ANK ACCOUNT OR IN THE CASE OF A REAL BUSINESS MANY MORE THAN THAT THESETRANSACTIONSCANBESUMMARISEDINACash Payments Journal
REVIEW QUESTIONS 6.1
109
Cash Payments Journal an accounting record summarising all cash paid during a month
1 ExplainTHEBENElTOFRECORDINGTRANSACTIONSINSPECIALJOURNALS 2 ListFOURTRANSACTIONSTHATWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL 3 ExplainWHATEACHCASHPAYMENTHASINCOMMONINTERMSOFITSEFFECTONTHE 'ENERAL,EDGER
6.2
RECORDING TRANSACTIONS IN THE CASH PAYMENTS JOURNAL
!TYPICALMULTI COLUMN#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALWOULDLOOKLIKETHEONEFOR'REEN4HUMB 0LANTSSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 6.1 Cash Payments Journal
Date 1
Details 2
Cheque Creditors Stock Bank 4 Wages5 Sundries 6 GST 7 number 3 Control 5 Control 5
June 1 Stock Control
22
220
June5
Mills Bros
23
400
June8
Wages
24
190
June 10
Electricity
25
165
150
June 13
Drawings
26
100
100
June 15
Stock Control
27
242
June 22
Wages
28
190
June 24
Johnson Ltd
29
350
30
13 200
June 29 Vehicle Totals
15 057
200
20
400 190
220
15
22 190
350
750
420
380
12 000
1 200
12 250
1 257
Notes for recording in the Cash Payments Journal 1
Date !SWITHALLJOURNALS TRANSACTIONSARERECORDEDINDATEORDER ONTHEDATETHATTHEY OCCURALTHOUGHONLYTHETOTALSAREPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERATTHEENDOFTHE MONTH
2 Details "ECAUSE EVERY CASH PAYMENT REQUIRES A CREDIT TO THE "ANK LEDGER ACCOUNT THE ONLYPARTOFTHEDOUBLEENTRYTHATMUSTBESPECIlEDFOREACHPAYMENTISTHEother ACCOUNTTHEACCOUNTTOBEdebited.OTEHOWTHENAMEOFEACHINDIVIDUALCREDITOR ISLISTEDWHENPAYMENTSAREMADETOCREDITORS4HETOTALPAIDTOCREDITORS WILL BEPOSTEDTOTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER BUTTHEINDIVIDUAL TRANSACTIONS WILL BE POSTED TO THE INDIVIDUAL CREDITORS ACCOUNTS IN THE #REDITORS ,EDGER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
110
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
3 Cheque number )N ORDER TO SATISFY THE DEMANDS OF Reliability THE SOURCE DOCUMENT IS IDENTIlED !CHEQUENUMBERISIDENTIlABLEFROMTHECHEQUEBUTT ANDBUSINESSESSHOULDBE ENCOURAGED TO MAKE PAYMENTS BY CHEQUE FOR ALL BUT THE SMALLEST AMOUNTS SEE #HAPTER !LLCHEQUENUMBERSSHOULDBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL EVENIFTHECHEQUEISCANCELLED SOTHATALLCHEQUESAREACCOUNTEDFORANDTHEFTIS DISCOURAGEDOR IFITOCCURS DETECTED 4 Bank 4HEamount of the paymentMUSTBERECORDEDlRSTINTHE"ANKCOLUMN TOALLOW CALCULATIONOFTHETOTALCASHPAID7HERE'34ISINVOLVED THEAMOUNTRECORDEDIN THE"ANKCOLUMNincludes the GST amount4HISAMOUNTWILLBEPOSTEDTOTHE"ANK LEDGERACCOUNTASONETOTALATTHEENDOFTHEMONTH 5 Classification columns 4HEAMOUNTOFEACHTRANSACTIONISRECORDEDTWICEONCEINTHE"ANKCOLUMNTORECORD THECASHPAID ANDASECONDTIMEINACLASSIlCATIONCOLUMNTORECORDWHATTHECASH WASPAIDFOR4HESECLASSIlCATIONCOLUMNSALLOWFORFREQUENTCASHPAYMENTSTOBE SUMMARISED ANDTHETOTALPOSTEDTOTHEAPPROPRIATEACCOUNT4HEHEADINGSUSED FOREACHOFTHESECLASSIlCATIONCOLUMNSWILL OFCOURSE VARYBETWEENBUSINESSES AS THEIRTRANSACTIONSVARY)N&IGURE FREQUENTCASHPAYMENTSAREMADETOCREDITORS FOR STOCK AND FOR WAGES AND SO THESE TRANSACTIONS HAVE THEIR OWN CLASSIlCATION COLUMN 6 Sundries !NYCASHPAYMENTSTHATAREINFREQUENTMUSTBERECORDEDINTHESUNDRIESCOLUMN4HE CASHPURCHASEOFTHEVEHICLEISUNLIKELYTOOCCURMORETHANONCE ANDTHEPAYMENTOF ELECTRICITYISINFREQUENT SOTHEYDONOTWARRANTTHEIROWNCOLUMNS 7 GST &OR TRANSACTIONS THAT INCUR '34 THIS COLUMN IS WHERE THE '34 PAID OF THE PURCHASE PRICE IS RECORDED 4HE '34 INCREASES THE AMOUNT PAID OUT OF THE "ANK ACCOUNT BUTDOESNOTAFFECTTHEVALUEOFWHATEVERHASBEENPURCHASEDWHICH IN THISCASE ISSTOCK ELECTRICITYANDAVEHICLE
Double-checking mechanism !TTHEENDOFTHEMONTH EACHCOLUMNINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALSHOULDBETOTALLED !SADOUBLE CHECKINGMECHANISM THETOTALOFTHE"ANKCOLUMNSHOULDEQUALTHESUM OFTHETOTALSOFTHEOTHERCOLUMNS5SINGTHElGURESFROM&IGURE THEDOUBLE CHECK WOULDSHOW
#REDITORS#ONTROL 3TOCK#ONTROL 7AGES 3UNDRIES '34#LEARING Total debits
$15 057
Bank
15 057
Total credits
$15 057
)FTHESEAMOUNTSDONOTMATCH THENATRANSACTIONHASBEENRECORDEDINCORRECTLYINTHE #ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL ANDTHEJOURNALCANNOTBEPOSTEDTOTHELEDGERUNTILTHEERROR ISRECTIlED
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
REVIEW QUESTIONS 6.2
1 State WHY THE #ASH 0AYMENTS *OURNAL ONLY IDENTIlES THE ACCOUNT TO BE DEBITEDINTHE$ETAILSCOLUMN 2 IdentifyTHESOURCEDOCUMENTUSEDTOVERIFYTHETRANSACTIONSRECORDEDINTHE #ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL 3 ExplainHOWTHEHEADINGSFORTHECLASSIlCATIONCOLUMNSINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS *OURNALAREDETERMINED 4 ExplainWHYTHENAMEOFEACHCREDITORISIDENTIlEDINTHE$ETAILSCOLUMN 5 ExplainTHEDOUBLE CHECKINGMECHANISMINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL 6 StateTHEEFFECTOF'34PAIDON s THEAMOUNTOFCASHPAIDFORPURCHASES s THEVALUEOFTHEASSETEXPENSEPURCHASED
6.3
POSTING THE CASH PAYMENTS JOURNAL TO THE GENERAL LEDGER
/NCETHECOLUMNSINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALHAVEBEENTOTALLED THESETOTALSCAN BEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSATTHEENDOFTHEMONTH5SINGTHE#ASH 0AYMENTS*OURNALIN&IGURE THE'ENERAL,EDGERENTRIESWOULDBE DR DR DR DR DR DR DR CR
Creditors Control Stock Control Wages Electricity Drawings Vehicle GST Clearing Bank
$ 750 420 380 150 100 12 000 1 257 15 057
!LTHOUGHTHEREISONLYONECREDITENTRYTOTHE"ANKACCOUNT ANDSEVENDEBITENTRIES THETOTALDEBITSANDCREDITSSTILLMATCH4HESEENTRIESFORMAMATCHINGDOUBLEENTRY 4HESEJOURNALTOTALSWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERONLYATTHEENDOFTHE MONTHINTHISCASE *UNE %VENTHEENTRIESINTHE3UNDRIESCOLUMN WHICHMUST BEPOSTEDTOTHEINDIVIDUALACCOUNTSINTHISCASE %LECTRICITY $RAWINGSAND6EHICLE ARE POSTEDATTHEENDOFTHEMONTH4HISISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 6.2
General Ledger: posting the Cash Payments Journal General Ledger Bank (A)
Date June 1
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
5 000
June 30
Cash payments
15 057
Cross-reference
Amount $
Creditors Control (L) Date June 30
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
750
June 1
Balance
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
900
Cambridge University Press
111
112
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
Figure 6.2 (cont.)
UNITS 3&4
General Ledger: posting the Cash Payments Journal Stock Control (A)
Date June 1 30
Cross-reference Balance
"ANK
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
2 000 420 Wages (E)
Date June 30
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
380 Electricity (E)
Date
Cross-reference
June 30
Bank
Amount $
Date
150 Drawings (– OE)
Date June 30
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
100 Vehicle (A)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
The Cash Payments Journal is posted to the General Ledger using the column totals at the end of the month.
June 30
Bank
12 000 GST Clearing (A or L)
Date June 30
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
1 257
Cross-references in the Bank account )N ALL THE LEDGER ACCOUNTS SHOWN IN THIS TEXT SO FAR THE CROSS REFERENCE HAS BEEN THE NAME OF THE OTHER LEDGER ACCOUNT AFFECTED BY EACH TRANSACTION %VEN WHEN POSTING THE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL THECROSS REFERENCEINTHE#REDITORS#ONTROL 3TOCK#ONTROL 7AGES %LECTRICITY $RAWINGS 6EHICLEAND'34#LEARINGACCOUNTSWAS"ANK (OWEVER THECROSS REFERENCEINTHE"ANKACCOUNTITSELFDOESNOTFOLLOWTHISRULEIT ISNOTTHENAMEOFALEDGERACCOUNT4HISISBECAUSETHEREISNOSINGLEACCOUNTLINKED TOTHE $15 057PAIDOUTOFTHE"ANKACCOUNTITHASBEENPAIDFORANUMBEROFDIFFERENT PURPOSES&ORTHISREASON THECROSS REFERENCEINTHE"ANKACCOUNTMUSTSIMPLYBE#ASH 0AYMENTS TO INDICATE THAT THERE ARE A NUMBER OF OTHER ACCOUNTS LINKED TO THIS TOTAL PAYMENTSlGURE 4HEUSEOFTHISCROSS REFERENCEALSOMEANSANY'34PAID ISINCLUDEDINTHE TOTALCASHPAID ANDTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTDOESNOTNEEDTOBENOTEDINTHECROSS REFERENCE "ECAUSE IT IS THE ONLY ENTRY IN THE '34 #LEARING ACCOUNT THE DEBIT ENTRY MEANSTHATTHISBUSINESSCURRENTLYHASACURRENTASSETINRELATIONTO'34 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
REVIEW QUESTIONS 6.3
1 ExplainHOWTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALISPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER 2 Show THE DEBIT AND CREDIT ENTRIES NECESSARY TO POST THE #ASH 0AYMENTS *OURNALIN&IGURE TOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER 3 Explain WHY THE CROSS REFERENCE USED WHEN THE #ASH 0AYMENTS *OURNAL IS POSTEDTOTHE"ANKACCOUNTISNOTTHENAMEOFALEDGERACCOUNT 4 ExplainTHEEFFECTOF'34PAIDON s "ANK s '34#LEARING
6.4
POSTING THE CASH PAYMENTS JOURNAL TO THE CREDITORS (SUBSIDIARY) LEDGER
4HESAMEAPPROACHTHATWASTAKENTOPOSTINGTHE0URCHASES*OURNALIN#HAPTER MUST BETAKENWHENPOSTINGTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL)NTHE'ENERAL,EDGER THETOTALPAID TOCREDITORSISDEBITEDTOTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNTATTHEENDOFTHEMONTH)NTHE #REDITORS,EDGER HOWEVER THEINDIVIDUALTRANSACTIONSMUSTBEDEBITEDTOTHEACCOUNTOF EACHINDIVIDUALCREDITORONTHEDAYTHATTHEYOCCUR4HISISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 6.3 Creditors Ledger: posting the Cash Payments Journal Creditors Ledger Mills Bros (L) Date
Cross-reference
June 5
Bank
Amount $
Date
400
June 1
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $ 500
Johnson Ltd (L) Date
Cross-reference
June 24
Bank
Amount $
Date
350
June 1
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $ 400
The Cash Payments Journal is posted to the Creditors Ledger using individual transactions on the day they occur.
REVIEW QUESTIONS 6.4
1 IdentifyTWODIFFERENCESINTHEWAYTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALISPOSTEDTO THE#REDITORS,EDGERCOMPAREDTOTHEWAYITISPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER 2 ExplainTHECROSS REFERENCEUSEDINTHEINDIVIDUALCREDITORSACCOUNTS
6.5
THE CASH RECEIPTS JOURNAL
4HETRANSACTIONSINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALHADONELEDGERENTRYINCOMMONnTHEY ALLINVOLVEDACREDITTOTHE"ANKACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER4HESAMEPRINCIPLECAN BEAPPLIEDTOALLCASHRECEIPTS BUTFROMTHEOPPOSITEPERSPECTIVE Each cash receipt requires a debit to the Bank account.
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
113
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
114
Cash Receipts Journal an accounting record that summarises all cash received during a month
UNITS 3&4
7HILETHECREDITPARTOFEACHENTRYWILLVARYACCORDINGTOTHESOURCEOFTHECASHRECEIVED EACHCASHRECEIPTINVOLVESTHESAMEDEBITENTRYTO"ANK4HISISTRUEWHETHERTHECASH ISRECEIVEDFROMCASHSALES ADEBTOR THEOWNERVIAACAPITALCONTRIBUTION OREVENFROM THERECEIPTOFALOAN!SWITHTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL RATHERTHANASEPARATEDEBITTO THE"ANKACCOUNTFOREACHINDIVIDUALTRANSACTIONANDTHESECOULDNUMBERORPER MONTH THESETRANSACTIONSCANBESUMMARISEDINACash Receipts Journal
REVIEW QUESTIONS 6.5
1 ListFOURTRANSACTIONSTHATWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL 2 ExplainWHATEACHCASHRECEIPTHASINCOMMONINTERMSOFITSEFFECTONTHE 'ENERAL,EDGER
6.6
RECORDING TRANSACTIONS IN THE CASH RECEIPTS JOURNAL
! MULTI COLUMN #ASH 2ECEIPTS *OURNAL WOULD TYPICALLY LOOK LIKE THE ONE FOR 'REEN 4HUMB0LANTSSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 6.4 Cash Receipts Journal Details 2
June 1
Cash Sales
11
440
210
400
40
5
Cash Sales
12
550
270
500
50
8
G. Matthews
13
300
11
Cash Sales
14
660
600
60
14
T. May
15
200
19
Capital
16
10 000
22
Cash Sales
17
220
27
G. Matthews
18
100
$ 12 470
Totals
Receipt Bank 4 Debtors 3 number Control 5
Cost of Sales 6
Sales 5 Sundries 7 GST 8
Date 1
330 10 000 120
200
20
Notes for recording in the Cash Receipts Journal 1
Date !SWITHALLJOURNALS TRANSACTIONSARERECORDEDINDATEORDER ONTHEDATETHATTHEY OCCURALTHOUGHTHETOTALSAREPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERATTHEendOFTHEMONTH
2 Details "ECAUSEEVERYCASHRECEIPTREQUIRESADEBITTOTHE"ANKLEDGERACCOUNT THEONLY PARTOFTHEDOUBLEENTRYTHATMUSTBESPECIlEDFOREACHRECEIPTISTHEACCOUNTTO BE CREDITED .OTE HOW THE NAME OF EACH DEBTOR IS LISTED WHEN CASH IS RECEIVED FROMDEBTORS4HETOTALRECEIVEDFROMDEBTORS WILLBEPOSTEDTOTHE$EBTORS #ONTROLACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER BUTTHEINDIVIDUALTRANSACTIONSWILLBEPOSTED TOTHEINDIVIDUALDEBTORSACCOUNTSINTHE$EBTORS,EDGER 3 Receipt number 7ITHCASHRECEIPTS THESOURCEDOCUMENTITSELFSHOULDBEACASHRECEIPT GENERATED EITHERMANUALLYORBYCOMPUTERORCASHREGISTER"ECAUSETHESERECEIPTSAREISSUED BYTHElRMINTHISCASE 'REEN4HUMB0LANTS THERECEIPTNUMBERSSHOULDRUNIN SEQUENCE ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
115
4 Bank 4HEamount receivedMUSTBERECORDEDlRSTINTHE"ANKCOLUMN TOALLOWCALCULATION OFTHETOTALCASHRECEIVED7HERE'34ISINVOLVED THEAMOUNTRECORDEDINTHE"ANK COLUMNincludes the GST amount4HISAMOUNTWILLBEPOSTEDTOTHE"ANKLEDGER ACCOUNTASONETOTAL ATTHEendOFTHEMONTH 5 Classification columns !S WITH THE #ASH 0AYMENTS *OURNAL THE AMOUNT OF EACH TRANSACTION MUST BE RECORDEDTWICEnONCEINTHE"ANKCOLUMNTORECORDTHECASHRECEIVED ANDASECOND TIMEINACLASSIlCATIONCOLUMNTORECORDTHESOURCEOFTHATCASH4HESECLASSIlCATION COLUMNSALLOWFORFREQUENTCASHRECEIPTSTOBESUMMARISED ANDTHETOTALPOSTEDTO THELEDGERACCOUNT)NTHISEXAMPLE THEFREQUENTCASHRECEIPTSTHATHAVETHEIROWN CLASSIlCATIONCOLUMNARE$EBTORS#ONTROLAND3ALES 6 Cost of Sales /NEOFTHECOMPLICATINGFACTORSINRECORDINGCASHSALESISTHEFACTTHATEACHSALEWILL INVOLVETWODOUBLEENTRIESONEATSELLINGPRICEANDONEATCOSTPRICE4HEAMOUNTOF CASHRECEIVEDFROMTHESALERECORDEDATSELLINGPRICE ISRECORDEDINTHE"ANKAND3ALES COLUMNS"UTBECAUSEEACHSALEDECREASESSTOCKANDCREATESANEXPENSE#OSTOF3ALES ITISALSONECESSARYTOSHOWTHECOSTPRICEOFEACHSALEINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL )NTHISCASE THISWILLBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERAS DR CR
Cost of Sales (E)
$ 930
Stock Control (A)
930
7 Sundries 4HISCOLUMNFULlLSEXACTLYTHESAMEFUNCTIONINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALASITDOES IN THE #ASH 0AYMENTS *OURNAL )NFREQUENT CASH RECEIPTS MUST BE RECORDED IN THE 3UNDRIESCOLUMN 8 GST &ORCASHSALES THISISWHERETHE'34RECEIVEDOFTHESELLINGPRICE ISRECORDED 4HE'34INCREASESTHEAMOUNTRECEIVED ASSHOWNINTHE"ANKCOLUMN BUTDOESNOT AFFECTSALESREVENUEEARNED NORTHECOSTOFTHESALE
STUDY TIP
2EMEMBERTHAT'34 DOESNOTAFFECTTHE VALUATIONOFSTOCK NOR THEREVENUEEARNED FROMITSSALE
Double-checking mechanism )NCOMMONWITHTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL THE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALHASACHECKING MECHANISM BUTITISCOMPLICATEDBYONEFACTORTHEUSEOFTHE#OSTOF3ALESCOLUMN!T THEENDOFTHEMONTH EACHCOLUMNINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALSHOULDBETOTALLED!S ADOUBLE CHECKINGMECHANISM THETOTALOFTHE"ANKCOLUMNSHOULDEQUALTHESUMOF THETOTALSOFTHEOTHER#LASSIlCATIONAND3UNDRIES COLUMNS EXCEPT#OSTOF3ALES4HIS ISBECAUSE#OSTOF3ALESDOESNOTRECORDCASHRECEIVEDFROMSALESITONLYRECORDSTHE COSTPRICEOFTHESTOCKTHATHASBEENSOLD)TRECORDSANoutflow of stock RATHERTHANAN inflow of cash 5SINGTHEAMOUNTSFROM&IGURE THEDOUBLE CHECKWOULDSHOW Bank
Total debits
12 470
$12 470
=
Debtors Control
600
+
Sales
+
Sundries
1 700
+
GST Clearing
170
Total credits
$12 470
10 000
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
116
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 6.6
1 StateWHYTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALONLYIDENTIlESTHEACCOUNTTOBECREDITED INTHE$ETAILSCOLUMN 2 IdentifyTHESOURCEDOCUMENTUSEDTOVERIFYTHETRANSACTIONSRECORDED INA #ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL 3 ExplainHOWTHEHEADINGSFORTHECLASSIlCATIONCOLUMNSINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS *OURNALAREDETERMINED 4 ExplainWHYTHENAMEOFEACHDEBTORISIDENTIlEDINTHE$ETAILSCOLUMN 5 ExplainWHYITISNECESSARYTOUSEA#OSTOF3ALESCOLUMNINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS *OURNAL 6 ExplainTHEDOUBLE CHECKINGMECHANISMINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL 7 StateTHEEFFECTOF'34RECEIVEDON s THEAMOUNTOFCASHRECEIVEDFROMCASHSALES s THEREVENUEEARNEDFROMCASHSALES
6.7
POSTING THE CASH RECEIPTS JOURNAL TO THE GENERAL LEDGER
/NCE THE COLUMNS IN THE #ASH 2ECEIPTS *OURNAL HAVE BEEN TOTALLED THESE TOTALS CAN BEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTS/NCEAGAIN THISISDONEONLYATTHEENDOF THEMONTHTHATIS *UNE5SINGTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALIN&IGURE THE'ENERAL ,EDGERENTRIESWOULDBE DR
Bank
$12 470
CR
Debtors Control
CR
Sales
CR
Capital
CR
GST Clearing
600 1 700 10 000 170
4HISISAMATCHINGDOUBLEENTRY BUTITDOESNOTACCOUNTFORALLTHEINFORMATIONINTHE #ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALWEMUSTALSORECORDTHECOSTPRICEOFTHESALESMADE4HISIS DONEBYPOSTINGANADDITIONALDOUBLEENTRY DR
Cost of Sales
CR
$ 930
Stock Control
930
&IGURESHOWSHOWTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARAFTERPOSTINGTHE #ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL Figure 6.5 General Ledger: posting the Cash Receipts Journal General Ledger Bank (A) Date June 1 30
Cross-reference Balance Cash receipts
Amount $ 5 000
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
June 30
Cash payments
15 057
Cross-reference
Amount $
12 470 Debtors Control (A)
Date
Cross-reference
June 1
Balance
Amount $
Date
1 100
June 30
Bank
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
600 Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
Sales (R) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date June 30
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $ 1 700
Capital (OE) Date June 1
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
42 000
June 30
Balance
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $ 10 000
GST Clearing (A or L) Date June 30
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
1 257
June 30
Bank
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $ 170
Stock Control (A) Date June 1 30
Cross-reference
Amount $
Balance
2 000
Bank
Date June 30
Cross-reference Cost of Sales
Amount $ 930
420 Cost of Sales (E)
Date June 30
Cross-reference
Amount $
Stock Control
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
930
The Cash Receipts Journal is posted to the General Ledger using the column totals at the end of the month.
Cross-references in the Bank account !SWITHTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL THEAMOUNTPOSTEDTOTHE"ANKACCOUNT$12 470 ISNOTLINKEDTOONEACCOUNT BUTMANYINTHISCASE FOUR$EBTORS#ONTROL 3ALES #APITAL AND'34#LEARING 4HECROSS REFERENCEINTHE"ANKCANNOT THEREFORE BETHENAMEOF ONELEDGERACCOUNTITMUSTBE#ASH2ECEIPTSTOINDICATETHATTHEREAREANUMBEROF OTHERACCOUNTSLINKEDTOTHISTOTALRECEIPTSlGURE 4HE'34RECEIVED ISSIMPLYINCLUDEDINTHETOTALCASHRECEIVED ANDTHE'34 #LEARING ACCOUNT DOES NOT NEED TO BE NOTED IN THE CROSS REFERENCE "UT IN THE '34 #LEARING $EBTORS #ONTROL 3ALES AND #APITAL ACCOUNTS THE CROSS REFERENCE CAN AND THEREFOREMUST BETHENAMEOFTHEOTHERLEDGERACCOUNTINVOLVED"ANK
REVIEW QUESTIONS 6.7
1 ExplainHOWTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALISPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER 2 ShowTHEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESNECESSARYTOPOSTTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL IN&IGURE TOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER 3 Explain WHY THE CROSS REFERENCE USED WHEN THE #ASH 2ECEIPTS *OURNAL IS POSTEDTOTHE"ANKACCOUNTISNOTTHENAMEOFALEDGERACCOUNT 4 ExplainTHEEFFECTOF'34RECEIVEDON s "ANK s '34#LEARING
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
117
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
118
6.8
UNITS 3&4
POSTING THE CASH RECEIPTS JOURNAL TO THE DEBTORS (SUBSIDIARY) LEDGER
!MONGOTHERFUNCTIONS &IGURERECORDSTHECASHRECEIVEDFROMTWODEBTORS 4-AY AND ' -ATTHEWS 4HE TOTAL RECEIVED FROM DEBTORS IS CREDITED TO THE $EBTORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT AT THE END OF THE MONTH THAT IS *UNE BUT THE INDIVIDUAL TRANSACTIONSnON AND*UNEnMUSTBECREDITEDTOTHEACCOUNTOFEACHINDIVIDUAL DEBTORINTHE$EBTORS,EDGERONTHEDAYTHEYOCCUR4HISISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 6.6 Debtors Ledger: posting the Cash Receipts Journal Debtors Ledger G. Matthews (A) Date
Cross-reference
June 1
Balance
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
800
June 8
Bank
300
27
Bank
100
T. May (A) Date
Cross-reference
June 1
Balance
Amount $
Date
300
June 14
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $ 200
The Cash Receipts Journal is posted to the Debtors Ledger using individual transactions on the day they occur.
REVIEW QUESTIONS 6.8
1 IdentifyTWODIFFERENCESINTHEWAYTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALISPOSTEDTOTHE $EBTORS,EDGERCOMPAREDTOTHEWAYITISPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER 2 Explain HOW THE CROSS REFERENCE USED IN THE INDIVIDUAL DEBTOR ACCOUNTS IS DETERMINED
6.9
GST SETTLEMENT AND GST REFUND
!TTHEENDOFTHEREPORTINGPERIOD EACHBUSINESSWILLBALANCEITS'34#LEARINGACCOUNT TODETERMINEWHETHERITHASA'34LIABILITYORA'34ASSET!FTERTHEENDOFITS"USINESS !CTIVITY3TATEMENT"!3 PERIOD WHENITMUSTCOMPLETEANDSUBMITITS"!3 THEBUSINESS MUSTPAYANY'34OWINGTOTHE!4/ASA'34SETTLEMENT ORWILLRECEIVEA'34REFUND FROMTHE!4/FOREXCESS'34
GST settlement GST settlement a cash payment made to the ATO to settle the liability that occurs when GST on sales is greater than GST on purchases
)F'34ONSALESISGREATERTHAN'34ONPURCHASES THEBUSINESSWILLBEREQUIREDTOMAKE AGST settlementTHATIS SETTLETHE'34OWINGBYMAKINGACASHPAYMENTTOTHE!4/
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
EXAMPLE
Holding Furniture has provided the following information about its GST transactions for September 2015: Opening balance – GST Clearing GST received on cash sales1 GST charged to debtors on credit sales2 GST paid on cash purchases3 GST charged by creditors on credit purchases4
$
600 1 200 2 400 1 700 1 100
119
CR
"ASEDONTHESElGURES THEBUSINESSHASCHARGEDANDRECEIVEDWORTHOF'34 ONITSSALES BUTONLYPAIDANDBEENCHARGEDWORTHOF'34ONITSPURCHASES/N TOPOFTHE$600 CROPENINGBALANCE THISMEANSTHATASAT3EPTEMBERITOWES THE!4/ WHICHWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETASACURRENTLIABILITY3OME TIMEIN/CTOBER A'34SETTLEMENTOFWOULDNEEDTOBEPAIDTOTHE!4/ !SSUMING THIS '34 SETTLEMENT WAS PAID ON /CTOBER #H IT WOULD BE RECORDEDINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 6.7 Cash Payments Journal: recording a GST settlement Cash Payments Journal Date Oct. 4
Details
Cheque number
Bank
31
1400
GST Clearing
Creditors Control
Stock Control
Wages
Sundries
GST
1 400
.OTETHATALTHOUGHTHE'34SETTLEMENTISPAID ITISNOTRECORDEDINTHE'34COLUMN AS THIS COLUMN IS ONLY FOR '34 PAID to suppliers, on purchases "Y CONTRAST A '34 SETTLEMENT IS PAID TO THE !4/ ONLY INFREQUENTLY TO SETTLE A '34 DEBT !S A RESULT IT MUSTBEIDENTIlEDSEPARATELY ANDSOISRECORDEDINTHE3UNDRIESCOLUMN)TWILLALSOBE REPORTEDSEPARATELYINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTASWILLBEEXPLAINEDIN#HAPTER 4HE BALANCE OF THE '34 #LEARING ACCOUNT WOULD NOW BE SETTLED OR CLEARED AS IS SHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 6.8 GST Clearing account with GST settlement GST Clearing (A or L) Date Sept. 30
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Bank3
1 700
Sept. 1
Creditors Control4
1 100
30
Balance
1 400
Cross-reference Balance
Bank
600
Bank1
1 200
Debtors Control2
2 400
4 200 Oct. 31
Amount $
4 200 Oct. 1
Balance
1 400
2EMEMBERTHATALTHOUGHTHE'34SETTLEMENTWILLBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS *OURNAL WHEN IT IS PAID ON /CTOBER THE #ASH 0AYMENTS *OURNAL WILL NOT BE POSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERUNTIL/CTOBER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
120
UNITS 3&4
GST refund )F'34ONPURCHASESISGREATERTHAN'34ONSALES THEBUSINESSWILLBEENTITLEDTOAGST refundFROMTHE!4/
EXAMPLE
Garner Electronics has provided the following information about its GST transactions for June 2015:
GST refund a cash receipt from the ATO to refund the excess that occurs when GST on sales is less than GST on purchases
Opening balance – GST Clearing $ GST received on cash sales1 GST charged to debtors on credit sales2 GST paid on cash purchases3 GST charged by creditors on credit purchases4
200 3 200 1 600 3 900 2 000
CR
"ASED ON THESE lGURES THE BUSINESS HAS WORTH OF '34 ON SALES BUT HAS WORTHOF'34ONPURCHASES%VENCOUNTINGTHE$200#2OPENINGBALANCE ITSTILL MEANSADEBITBALANCE WHICHWOULDBEREPORTEDASACURRENTASSETINTHE"ALANCE 3HEETASAT*UNE4HEN SOMETIMEDURING*ULY THEBUSINESSISDUETO RECEIVEA'34REFUNDFROMTHE!4/OF !SSUMINGTHIS'34REFUNDWASRECEIVEDON*ULY2EC ITWOULDBERECORDED INTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 6.9 Cash Receipts Journal: recording a GST refund Cash Receipts Journal Date
Details
Receipt number
July 8
GST Clearing
40
Bank
Debtors Control
Cost of Sales
Sales
900
Sundries
GST
900
4HE'34COLUMNISONLYFOR'34RECEIVEDFROMCUSTOMERSFORCASHSALES WHEREASTHE '34REFUNDISRECEIVEDFROMTHE!4/ITSELF#ONSEQUENTLY ITISRECORDEDSEPARATELYIN THE3UNDRIESCOLUMN ANDWILLBEREPORTEDSEPARATELYINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTSEE #HAPTER 4HE'34REFUNDWOULDHAVETHESAMEEFFECTASA'34SETTLEMENTINTERMSOFCLEARING THEPREVIOUSBALANCEINTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNT ASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 6.10 GST Clearing account with GST settlement GST Clearing (A or L) Date June 30
Cross-reference Bank
3
Creditors Control4
Amount $
Date
June 1
2 000
30
Cross-reference Balance
3 200
Debtors Control2
1 600
5 900 Balance
900
200
Bank1
Balance
July 1
Amount $
900
July 31
Bank
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
900
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
121
GST cash flows 4HEPAYMENTOFA'34SETTLEMENTORRECEIPTOFA'34REFUNDMEANSTHATTHEREAREFOUR POTENTIALCASHmOWSRELATEDTO'34 s '34paidONCASHPURCHASESFROMTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL s '34receivedONCASHSALESFROMTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL s '34settlementPAIDFROMTHE3UNDRIESCOLUMNOFTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL s '34refundRECEIVEDFROMTHE3UNDRIESCOLUMNOFTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL 4HE'34CHARGEDTODEBTORSONCREDITSALESINCREASESTHE'34LIABILITY BUTITISNOT ACASHmOW4HESAMEAPPLIESTO'34CHARGEDBYCREDITORSONCREDITPURCHASES WHICH DECREASESTHE'34LIABILITY BUTDOESNOTINVOLVEAPAYMENTOFCASH
REVIEW QUESTIONS 6.9
1 ExplainTHECIRCUMSTANCESTHATWOULDLEADTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTTOHAVE ACREDITBALANCE 2 ExplainHOWACREDITBALANCEINTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTWOULDBEREPORTED INTHE"ALANCE3HEET 3 DefineTHETERM@'34SETTLEMENT 4 ExplainWHYA'34SETTLEMENTISNOTRECORDEDINTHE'34COLUMNINTHE#ASH 0AYMENTS*OURNAL 5 ExplainTHECIRCUMSTANCESTHATWOULDLEADTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTTOHAVE ADEBITBALANCE 6 ExplainHOWADEBITBALANCEINTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTWOULDBEREPORTED INTHE"ALANCE3HEET 7 DefineTHETERM@'34REFUND 8 ExplainWHYA'34REFUNDISNOTRECORDEDINTHE'34COLUMNINTHE#ASH 2ECEIPTS*OURNAL 9 IdentifyTHETWOTRANSACTIONSRELATINGTO'34THATINVOLVEACASHINmOW 10 IdentifyTHETWOTRANSACTIONSRELATINGTO'34THATINVOLVEACASHOUTmOW 11 IdentifyTHETWOTRANSACTIONSRELATINGTO'34THATdo notINVOLVEACASHmOW
6.10
DISCOUNTS
&ORABUSINESSTHATSELLSONCREDITTERMS THEISSUEOFHOWTOMAKESUREDEBTORSPAY EITHEREARLYORONTIMECANBEAVEXEDQUESTION/NEOFTHEMOREOBVIOUSOPTIONSIS TOOFFERAsettlement discount WHICHREWARDSDEBTORSWHOPAYEARLYBYREDUCINGTHE AMOUNT THAT THEY ARE REQUIRED TO PAY 4HE TERMS OF A SETTLEMENT DISCOUNT MUST BE STATEDONTHESALESINVOICE ANDAREUSUALLYEXPRESSEDINTHEFORMOF@7 N4HIS ISTRANSLATEDAS s 7DISCOUNTIFTHEINVOICEISPAIDWITHINDAYS s NTHENETAMOUNTMUSTBEPAIDWITHINDAYS )NTHISEXAMPLE THECUSTOMERHASDAYSTOPAYTHENETAMOUNTBALANCEOWING ON THEINVOICE BUTIFTHEFULLAMOUNTISPAIDEARLYnWITHINDAYSnTHECUSTOMERISENTITLED TOADISCOUNTOFOFTHEINVOICEAMOUNT4HISDISCOUNTAMOUNTWILLnotHAVETOBE PAID BUTWILLSTILLBEDEDUCTEDFROMTHEAMOUNTOWING 4HEDISCOUNTRATEANDTHENUMBEROFDAYSALLOWEDTOPAYWILLVARYBETWEENlRMS DEPENDING ON HOW QUICKLY THEY NEED THEIR CASH AND THE RELATIONSHIPS THEY DEVELOP WITHTHEIRCUSTOMERS BUTTHEFORMATFOREXPRESSINGTHECREDITTERMSISGENERALLYFAIRLY CONSISTENT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
settlement discount a reduction in the amount repayable by a credit customer in return for early repayment
STUDY TIP
)NCREDITTERMS THE SECONDANDFOURTH NUMBERSTELLUSHOW MANYDAYSAREAVAILABLE
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
122
UNITS 3&4
For a business that sells on credit terms, the issue of how to make sure debtors pay either early or on time can be a vexed question
Benefits s Cash is received faster from debtors.4HISWILLALLOWTHEBUSINESSTO n PAYITSDEBTSONTIME ALLOWINGITTOTAKEADVANTAGEOFANYDISCOUNTSOFFEREDBY CREDITORS n MAKEOTHERPAYMENTS SUCHASWAGESOROTHEREXPENSES s The possibility of bad debts is reduced.4HELONGERADEBTGOESUNPAID THEMORE LIKELYITISTHEDEBTORWILLNOTACTUALLYPAYATALL s Greater sales may be encouraged.#USTOMERSMAYBEMOREWILLINGTOBUYFROMA lRMTHATOFFERSDISCOUNTSTHANONETHATDOESNOT KNOWINGTHATTHEAMOUNTTHEYEND UPPAYINGWILLBELESS Costs s Less cash is received from debtors. "ECAUSE A DISCOUNT REDUCES THE AMOUNT THE DEBTORHASTOPAY LESSCASHISRECEIVED s Net profit is reduced.4HEAMOUNTOFTHEDISCOUNTISANEXPENSE ANDTHUSREDUCES NETPROlT /FCOURSE IFTHEDISCOUNTISRECEIVEDFROMACREDITORRATHERTHANGIVENTOADEBTOR THENTHESECOSTSBECOMEBENElTS!DISCOUNTMEANSLESSCASHISPAIDTOCREDITORS AND ASTHEDISCOUNTISAREVENUE PROlTINCREASES Note:!SETTLEMENTDISCOUNTDOESnotREDUCETHEAMOUNTOFREVENUEEARNEDFROM THE SALE )NSTEAD IT REDUCES THE CASH RECEIVED FROM THE DEBTOR AND BECAUSE IT IS AN EXPENSETOTHESELLER ALSOREDUCESPROlT
Calculating the discount 4HEDISCOUNTREVENUEOREXPENSEWILLDEPENDONTHECREDITTERMSOFFERED ANDWHENTHE CASHISPAIDRECEIVED
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
EXAMPLE
During December 2015, Lomax Carpets had the following transactions: Dec. 3
Sold carpet on credit to V. Barbarino for $1 000 plus $100 GST (Inv. 43)
6
Received cash from V. Barbarino in full settlement of debt (Rec. 61)
123
Lomax Carpets offers credit terms of 7/10, n/30.
"ECAUSE 6 "ARBARINO HAS PAID WITHIN DAYS HE IS ENTITLED TO A DISCOUNT OF WHICHWOULDBECALCULATEDASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 6.11 Calculating discount expense Discount expense
=
Discount rate x Amount owing
=
7% x $1 100
=
$77
STUDY TIP
4HEDEBTORRECEIVESADISCOUNTONTHEFULLBALANCEOWING)NTHISEXAMPLE ,OMAX WILLINCURADISCOUNTEXPENSEOF$77 ANDTHEREFORERECEIVEONLYINCASHFROMTHE DEBTOR(OWEVER 6"ARBARINOSBALANCEWILLBEREDUCEDBYTHETOTALAMOUNTOF$1 100 !NY'34EFFECTISSIMPLYABSORBEDBYTHEBUSINESSOFFERINGTHEDISCOUNT
'34CANBEADJUSTED SOTHATBUSINESSESDO NOTHAVETOABSORBTHE '34THEYDONOTCOLLECT BUTTHISISBEYONDTHE SCOPEOFTHISCOURSE
REVIEW QUESTIONS 6.10
1 2 3 4
6.11
DefineTHETERM@SETTLEMENTDISCOUNT ExplainWHATISMEANTBYTHENOTATION@ N ListTHEBENElTSOFOFFERINGASETTLEMENTDISCOUNT ListTHECOSTSOFOFFERINGASETTLEMENTDISCOUNT
RECORDING DISCOUNT REVENUE IN THE CASH PAYMENTS JOURNAL
7HEN A CREDITOR IS PAID EARLY AND A DISCOUNT IS received THE AMOUNT PAID TO THAT CREDITORISREDUCED4HEAMOUNTOFTHISREDUCTIONISKNOWNASdiscount revenue ASITIS AREDUCTIONINANOUTmOWOFECONOMICBENElTSLESSCASHISPAIDTOCREDITORS INTHEFORM OF A REDUCTION IN LIABILITIES CREDITORS THAT INCREASES OWNERS EQUITY &IGURE USES THETRANSACTIONSFROM&IGURE BUTWITHTHETWOTRANSACTIONSINVOLVINGPAYMENTSTO CREDITORSnON*UNETO-ILLS"ROS AND*UNETO*OHNSON,TD nADJUSTEDTOREmECT ADISCOUNTREVENUE
June
5 24
Paid Mills Bros $360 (after discount of $40) Paid amount owing to Johnson Ltd ($350 less discount $35)
Ch. 23
discount revenue a revenue (in the form of a decrease in creditors) earned when creditors are paid early
EXAMPLE
Ch. 29
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
124
STUDY TIP
4HECASHPAIDTO CREDITORSISTHE AMOUNTINTHE #REDITORSCOLUMNLESS THE$ISCOUNT2EVENUE
Figure 6.12 Cash Payments Journal (with discount) Cash Payments Journal Date
Cheque number
Details
June 1 Stock Control
Bank
22
220
Discount Creditors Stock Revenue Control Control
Wages Sundries
20
Mills Bros
23
360
8
Wages
24
190
10
Electricity
25
165
150
13
Drawings
26
100
100
15
Stock Control
27
242
22 Wages
28
190
24
29
315
30
13 200
Johnson Ltd
29 Vehicle Totals
GST
200
5
STUDY TIP
$UETOTHEDISCOUNT THEAMOUNTRECORDED INTHE#REDITORS #ONTROLCOLUMNSHOULD BELARGERTHANTHE AMOUNTRECORDEDIN THE"ANKCOLUMN
UNITS 3&4
40
400 190 15
220
22 190
35
350 12 000 1 200
14 982
75
750
420
380
12 250 1 257
/N*UNE ONLYHASBEENPAIDTOTHECREDITOR SOTHISAMOUNTISRECORDEDIN THE"ANKCOLUMN(OWEVER THEAMOUNTOWEDTOTHECREDITORHASALSOBEENREDUCEDBY THERECEIVEDASADISCOUNT4HETOTALREDUCTIONINCREDITORSISACTUALLY PAIDPLUSDISCOUNT ANDITISTHISTOTALTHATMUSTBERECORDEDINTHE#REDITORS#ONTROL COLUMN4HE#REDITORS#ONTROLCOLUMNRECORDSTHETOTALBYWHICH#REDITORS#ONTROLWILL DECREASE WITHTHE"ANKCOLUMNRECORDINGTHEAMOUNTOFACTUALCASHPAID Effect on the accounting equation 4HEEFFECTOFTHEPAYMENTTO-ILLS"ROSON*UNEWHEREADISCOUNTISINVOLVED IS Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
$ECREASE"ANK
Liabilities
$ECREASE#REDITORS#ONTROL
Owner’s Equity
)NCREASE$ISCOUNT2EVENUEINCREASESPROlT
Double-checking mechanism 4HE RECORDING OF A DISCOUNT REVENUE MEANS THAT THE DOUBLE CHECKING MECHANISM IS SLIGHTLYDIFFERENT BUTTHEBASICPRINCIPLEREMAINSTHESAMETHETOTALOFTHE"ANKCOLUMN plus THE DISCOUNT REVENUE COLUMN SHOULD EQUAL THE SUM OF THE TOTALS OF THE OTHER CLASSIlCATION AND SUNDRIES COLUMNS 5SING THE lGURES FROM &IGURE THE DOUBLE CHECKWOULDSHOW Creditors Control
750
+
Stock Control
420
+
Wages
380
+
Sundries
+
GST Clearing Total debits
=
Bank +
14 982
Discount Revenue
75
12 250 1 257 $15 057
Total credits
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
$15 057
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
125
REVIEW QUESTIONS 6.11
1 DefineTHETERM@DISCOUNTREVENUE 2 ExplainWHYDISCOUNTREVENUEISCLASSIlEDASREVENUE 3 7HEREADISCOUNTISRECEIVEDONAPAYMENTTOACREDITOR stateTHEAMOUNTTHAT SHOULDBERECORDEDINTHEFOLLOWINGCOLUMNSOFTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL s "ANK s #REDITORS#ONTROL 4 2EFERRINGTO&IGURE stateTHEEFFECTOFTHETRANSACTIONON*UNE ONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION
6.12
POSTING THE CASH PAYMENTS JOURNAL (WITH DISCOUNT REVENUE)
4AKING INTO ACCOUNT THE DISCOUNT REVENUE THE #ASH 0AYMENTS *OURNAL IN &IGURE WOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERUSINGTHEFOLLOWINGENTRIES DR
Creditors Control
DR
Stock Control
DR
Wages
380
DR
Electricity
150
DR
Drawings
DR
Vehicle
DR
GST Clearing
CR
Bank
CR
Discount Revenue
$
750 420
100 12 000 1 257 14 982 75
4HISTIMEITTAKESTWOCREDITSTO"ANKAND$ISCOUNT2EVENUE ANDSEVENDEBITSTO FORMAMATCHINGDOUBLE ENTRY(OWEVER THISISSTILLFARFEWERTHANITWOULDTAKETOENTER THETRANSACTIONSDIRECTLYINTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER &IGURESHOWSHOWTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARAFTERTHE#ASH 0AYMENTS*OURNALHADBEENPOSTED Figure 6.13 General Ledger: posting the Cash Payments Journal (with discount) General Ledger Bank (A) Date June 1
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
5 000
June 30
Cash Payments
14 982
Balance
Discount Revenue (R) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
June 30
Creditors Control
75
Creditors Control (L) Date
Cross-reference
June 30 Bank/Discount Revenue
Amount $ 750
Date June 1
Cross-reference
Amount $
Balance
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
900
STUDY TIP
4HE#REDITORS#ONTROL ACCOUNTHASTWO ENTRIESWITHADOUBLE CROSS REFERENCE"ANK $ISCOUNT2EVENUEON THEDEBITSIDE AND 3TOCK#ONTROL'34 #LEARINGONTHECREDIT SIDE
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
126
UNITS 3&4
Cross-references .OTE HOW THE CROSS REFERENCE IN THE #REDITORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT NOW REFERS TO two ACCOUNTS "ANK AND $ISCOUNT 2EVENUE 4HIS IS BECAUSE THE AMOUNT DEBITED TO THE #REDITORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT CONSISTS OF SOME CASH AND SOME DISCOUNT REVENUE /NTHEOTHERHAND THECROSS REFERENCEINTHE$ISCOUNT2EVENUEACCOUNTREFERSONLY TO#REDITORS#ONTROL4HEREISNOCONNECTIONBETWEENTHE"ANKAND$ISCOUNT2EVENUE ACCOUNTSAS BYDElNITION THEDISCOUNTISTHEAMOUNTTHATHASnotBEENPAID 4HESAMEPRINCIPLEAPPLIESINTHE#REDITORS,EDGER SHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 6.14 Creditors Ledgers: posting the Cash Payments Journal (with discount) Creditors Ledger Mills Bros (L) Date June 5
Cross-reference Bank/Discount Revenue
Amount $
Date
400
June 1
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $ 500
Johnson Ltd (L) Date
Cross-reference
June 24 Bank/Discount Revenue
Amount $
Date
350
June 1
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $ 400
REVIEW QUESTIONS 6.12
1 Show THE DEBIT AND CREDIT ENTRIES NECESSARY TO POST THE #ASH 0AYMENTS *OURNALTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERWHENDISCOUNTREVENUEISINVOLVED 2 ExplainWHYTHEREARETWOACCOUNTSCROSS REFERENCEDINTHE#REDITORS#ONTROL ACCOUNTWHENADISCOUNTREVENUEISRECEIVEDONAPAYMENTTOACREDITOR
6.13
RECORDING DISCOUNT EXPENSE IN THE CASH RECEIPTS JOURNAL
7HEN CASH IS RECEIVED FROM A DEBTOR WHO PAYS EARLY AND A DISCOUNT IS GRANTED THE AMOUNTRECEIVEDFROMTHEDEBTORISREDUCED4HEAMOUNTOFTHISREDUCTIONISKNOWN discount expense ASdiscount expense ASITISAREDUCTIONINANINmOWOFECONOMICBENElTSLESSCASH an expense, in the form ISRECEIVEDFROMDEBTORS INTHEFORMOFAREDUCTIONINASSETSDEBTORS THATDECREASES of a decrease in debtors, OWNERS EQUITY &IGURE USES THE TRANSACTIONS FROM &IGURE BUT WITH THE THREE incurred when cash is TRANSACTIONSINVOLVINGRECEIPTSFROMDEBTORSnONAND*UNEFROM'-ATTHEWS AND received early from debtors *UNEFROM4-AY nADJUSTEDTOREmECTTHEDISCOUNTTERMSOF N
EXAMPLE
June
8 14 27
Received $270 from G. Matthews (discount $30) T. May paid $180 after $20 discount Receipt of cash from G. Matthews $90 ($10 discount granted)
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Rec. 13 Rec. 15 Rec. 18
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
Figure 6.15 Cash Receipts Journal (with discount)
127
STUDY TIP
Cash Receipts Journal Date
Details
Receipt number
Bank
Discount Expense
Debtors Cost of Control Sales
Sales
Sundries
GST
June 1 Cash Sales
11
440
210
400
40
5 Cash Sales
12
550
270
500
50
8 G. Matthews
13
270
11 Cash Sales
14
660
330
600
60
14 T. May
15
180
19 Capital
16
10 000
22 Cash Sales
17
220
27 G. Matthews
18
90
10
100
12 410
60
600
Totals
30
20
300
$UETOTHEDISCOUNT THEAMOUNTRECORDED INTHE$EBTORS#ONTROL COLUMNSHOULDBE LARGERTHANTHEAMOUNT RECORDEDINTHE"ANK COLUMN
200 10 000 120
200
930
1 700
20
10 000
170
/N*UNE ONLYHASBEENRECEIVEDFROMTHEDEBTORASCASH SOTHISAMOUNT IS RECORDED IN THE "ANK COLUMN (OWEVER THE AMOUNT OWED BY THE DEBTOR HAS ALSO BEENREDUCEDBYTHEGRANTEDASADISCOUNT4HUS THETOTALREDUCTIONINDEBTORS ISRECEIVEDplusDISCOUNT ANDTHISISTHETOTALTHATMUSTBERECORDEDIN THE$EBTORS#ONTROLCOLUMN4HE$EBTORS#ONTROLCOLUMNRECORDSTHETOTALBYWHICH $EBTORS#ONTROLWILLDECREASE WHILETHE"ANKCOLUMNRECORDSTHEAMOUNTOFACTUALCASH RECEIVED
STUDY TIP
4HECASHRECEIVED FROMDEBTORSISTHE AMOUNTINTHE$EBTORS #ONTROLCOLUMNLESSTHE $ISCOUNT%XPENSE
Effect on the accounting equation 4HEEFFECTOFTHERECEIPTFROM'-ATTHEWSON*UNEWHEREADISCOUNTISINVOLVED IS Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
$ECREASEINCREASE"ANK DECREASE$EBTORS#ONTROL
Liabilities
.OEFFECT
Owner’s Equity
$ECREASE$ISCOUNT%XPENSEDECREASESPROlT
30
30
Double-checking mechanism )NAFASHIONSIMILARTOTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL THETOTALOFTHE"ANKCOLUMNplus THE $ISCOUNT%XPENSECOLUMN SHOULDEQUALTHESUMOFTHETOTALSOFTHEOTHER#LASSIlCATION AND3UNDRIES COLUMNSEXCEPTTHE#OSTOF3ALESCOLUMN WHICHRELATESTOASTOCKmOW NOTACASHmOW 5SINGTHElGURESFROM&IGURE THEDOUBLE CHECKWOULDSHOW Bank +
Discount Expense
Total debits
12 410 60
$12 470
=
Debtors Control
600
+
Sales
1 700
+
Sundries
+
GST Clearing
170
Total credits
$12 470
10 000
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
128
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 6.13
1 DefineTHETERM@DISCOUNTEXPENSE 2 ExplainWHYDISCOUNTEXPENSEISCLASSIlEDASANEXPENSE 3 7HEREADISCOUNTISGIVENONARECEIPTFROMADEBTOR stateTHEAMOUNTTHAT SHOULDBERECORDEDINTHEFOLLOWINGCOLUMNSOFTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL s "ANK s $EBTORS#ONTROL 4 2EFERRINGTO&IGURE stateTHEEFFECTOFTHETRANSACTIONON*UNE ONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION
6.14
POSTING THE CASH RECEIPTS JOURNAL (WITH DISCOUNT EXPENSE)
4AKING INTO ACCOUNT THE DISCOUNT EXPENSE THE #ASH 2ECEIPTS *OURNAL IN &IGURE WOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERUSINGTHEFOLLOWINGENTRIES DR DR CR CR CR CR
Bank Discount Expense Debtors Control Sales Capital GST Clearing
$
Cost of Sales Stock Control
$
12 410 60 600 1 700 10 000 170
and DR CR
930 930
4HISTIMEITTAKESTWODEBITSTO"ANKAND$ISCOUNT%XPENSE ANDFOURCREDITSTOFORM AMATCHINGDOUBLE ENTRY&IGURESHOWSHOWTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSWOULD APPEARAFTERTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALHADBEENPOSTED Figure 6.16 General Ledger: posting the Cash Receipts Journal (with discount) General Ledger Bank (A) Date STUDY TIP
June 1 30
,IKE#REDITORS#ONTROL THE$EBTORS#ONTROL ACCOUNTHASTWO ENTRIESWITHADOUBLE CROSS REFERENCE"ANK $ISCOUNTEXPENSEON THECREDITSIDE AND 3ALES'34#LEARINGON THEDEBITSIDE
Cross-reference Balance Cash Receipts
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
5 000
June 30
Cash Payments
14 982
Cross-reference
Amount $
12 410 Discount Expense (E)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
June 30
Debtors Control
60
Date
Debtors Control (A) Date June 1
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $ 1 100
Date June 30
Cross-reference Bank/Discount Expense
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Amount $ 600
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
Cross-references !S WITH CASH PAYMENTS INVOLVING A DISCOUNT REVENUE A CASH RECEIPT FROM A DEBTOR THATALSOINVOLVESADISCOUNTEXPENSEISPOSTEDTOTHE$EBTORS#ONTROLACCOUNTUSING ONE lGURE THE TOTAL OF THE $EBTORS #ONTROL COLUMN FROM THE #ASH 2ECEIPTS *OURNAL "UTTHISlGUREINCLUDESSOMECASHRECEIVEDINTHEPRECEEDINGEXAMPLE PLUSSOMEDISCOUNTEXPENSE SOTHECROSS REFERENCEMUSTREFERTOBOTH"ANKAND $ISCOUNT%XPENSE /NTHEOTHERHAND THECROSS REFERENCEINTHE$ISCOUNT%XPENSEACCOUNTREFERSONLY TO$EBTORS#ONTROL ASTHEDISCOUNTISTHEAMOUNTNOTRECEIVED 4HESAMEPRINCIPLEAPPLIESINTHE$EBTORS,EDGER WHICHISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 6.17 Debtors Ledger: posting the Cash Receipts Journal (with discount) Debtors Ledger G. Matthews (A) Date June 1
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
800
June 8
Bank/Discount Expense
300
27
Bank/Discount Expense
100
Balance
Cross-reference
Amount $
T. May (A) Date June 1
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
300
June 14
Balance
Cross-reference
Amount $
Bank/Discount Expense
200
REVIEW QUESTIONS 6.14
1 ShowTHEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESNECESSARYTOPOSTTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL TOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERWHENADISCOUNTEXPENSEISINVOLVED 2 State ONE REASON WHY THE AMOUNT POSTED TO THE $EBTORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT FROM THE #ASH 2ECEIPTS *OURNAL IS NOT THE SAME AS THE CASH RECEIVED FROM DEBTORS 3 ExplainWHYTWOACCOUNTSARECROSS REFERENCEDINTHE$EBTORS#ONTROLACCOUNT WHENADISCOUNTEXPENSEISINCURREDONARECEIPTFROMADEBTOR
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
129
130
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s 3PECIALJOURNALSSUMMARISESIMILARTRANSACTIONS ALLOWINGTOTALSTOBEPOSTEDTOTHE 'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSUSINGFEWERDEBITANDCREDITENTRIES s !LLCASHPAIDISRECORDEDINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALALLCASHPAYMENTSRESULTIN ACREDITTOTHE"ANKACCOUNT s !LLCASHRECEIVEDISRECORDEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALALLCASHRECEIPTSRESULTIN ADEBITTOTHE"ANKACCOUNT s &REQUENTCASHTRANSACTIONSAREGIVENTHEIROWNCOLUMNINTHECASHJOURNALINFREQUENT CASHTRANSACTIONSARERECORDEDINTHE3UNDRIESCOLUMN s *OURNALS ARE POSTED TO THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER AT THE END OF THE MONTH USING THE COLUMNTOTALS)NDIVIDUALTRANSACTIONSAREPOSTEDTOTHESUBSIDIARYLEDGERACCOUNTS ONTHEDAYTHEYOCCUR s 4HE"ANKACCOUNTISONEOFONLYTWOLEDGERACCOUNTSINWHICHTHECROSS REFERENCES ARENOTTHENAMESOFOTHERLEDGERACCOUNTS/NTHEDEBITSIDECash ReceiptsAND ONTHECREDITSIDECash Payments s 3ETTLEMENT DISCOUNTS ENCOURAGE CREDIT CUSTOMERS TO PAY EARLY BY REDUCING THE AMOUNT PAYABLE $ISCOUNTS OFFERED BY SUPPLIERSCREDITORS ARE KNOWN AS DISCOUNT REVENUESDISCOUNTSOFFEREDTOCUSTOMERSDEBTORSAREKNOWNASDISCOUNTEXPENSES s )NTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL THE#REDITORS#ONTROLCOLUMNSHOWSTHETOTALAMOUNT BY WHICH CREDITORS WILL DECREASE THE CASH PAID TO THE CREDITOR plus THE DISCOUNT REVENUE s )NTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL THE$EBTORS#ONTROLCOLUMNSHOWSTHETOTALAMOUNT BYWHICHDEBTORSWILLDECREASETHECASHRECEIVEDFROMTHEDEBTORplusTHEDISCOUNT EXPENSE
Transaction Document
Journal
#REDIT PURCHASES OFSTOCK
0URCHASES $23TOCK#ONTROL *OURNAL $2'34#LEARING #2#REDITORS#ONTROL
0URCHASE INVOICE
General Ledger
Subsidiary ledger #2)NDIVIDUALCREDITORS ACCOUNTS
$2$EBTORS#ONTROL #23ALES #2'34#LEARING AND $2#OSTOF3ALES#0 #23TOCK#ONTROL#0
$2)NDIVIDUALDEBTORS ACCOUNTS
#ASHPAID
#HEQUEBUTT #ASH $2!LL5SESOF#ASH 0AYMENTS #2"ANK *OURNAL #2$ISCOUNT2EVENUE
$2)NDIVIDUALCREDITORS ACCOUNTS
#ASH RECEIVED
#ASHRECEIPT #ASH 2ECEIPTS *OURNAL
#REDITSALES 3ALESINVOICE 3ALES OFSTOCK *OURNAL
#2)NDIVIDUALDEBTORS $2"ANK $2$ISCOUNT%XPENSE ACCOUNTS #2!LL3OURCESOF#ASH AND $2#OSTOF3ALES#0 #23TOCK#ONTROL#0
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
EXERCISE 6.1 RECORDING IN THE CASH PAYMENTS JOURNAL
W B
page 86
131
EXERCISES
'ABBY IS THE OWNER OF 'ABBYS #OMPUTERS WHICH HAD THE FOLLOWING BALANCES IN ITS LEDGERACCOUNTSASAT-ARCH Bank GST Clearing Stock Control Creditors Control – Mother Boards – Acep Parts
$
1 500 800 1 000 3 630 2 200 1 430
CR
'ABBYPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGLISTOFTRANSACTIONSFOR-ARCH March 1 5 8 12 15 23 29 30
Paid wages of assistant – $750 (Ch. 176) Purchase of stock for $1 650 including $150 GST (Ch. 177) Paid creditor – Mother Boards $2 000 (Ch. 178) Paid $400 for electricity plus GST of $40 (Ch. 179) Paid wages of assistant – $750 (Ch. 180) Purchase of stock for $1 700 plus GST (Ch. 181) Gabby withdrew $700 cash for personal use (Ch. 182) Paid Acep Parts $500 off amount owing (Ch. 183)
Required
*
a ExplainONEBENElTOFRECORDINGTRANSACTIONSINSPECIALJOURNALS b RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR-ARCHINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALOF'ABBYS #OMPUTERSTotalTHEJOURNAL c ShowTHEDEBITSANDCREDITSNECESSARYTOPOSTTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALTOTHE 'ENERAL,EDGEROF'ABBYS#OMPUTERS d PostTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF'ABBYS#OMPUTERS e PostTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALTOTHE#REDITORS,EDGEROF'ABBYS#OMPUTERS f ExplainHOWTHEHEADINGSOFTHECLASSIlCATIONCOLUMNSINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL AREDETERMINED
EXERCISE 6.2 POSTING THE CASH PAYMENTS JOURNAL
W B
page 89
!LEX-C+INNONOWNS-ANCHESTER5NION ABUSINESSSELLINGSHEETSANDOTHERMANCHESTER 4HEBUSINESSHADTHEFOLLOWINGBALANCESINITSLEDGERACCOUNTSASAT*ANUARY Bank GST Clearing Stock Control Creditors Control – Irish Linen – Sherman Sheets Shelving
$ 5 000 650 1 000 3 520 2 420 1 100 29 000
CR
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
132
UNITS 3&4
!LEXHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGJOURNALSFOR*ANUARY Cash Payments Journal Date
Cheque number
Bank
Drawings
501
800
Sherman Sheets
502
1 100
7
Shelving
503
3 960
9
Irish Linen
504
700
Wages
505
500
Jan. 18
Irish Linen
506
600
Jan. 24
Advertising
507
440
Jan. 27
Wages
508
500
Jan. 1 J5
13
Details
Totals
Creditors Control
Wages
Drawings
Sundries
GST
3 600
360
400
40
4 000
400
800 1 100
700 500 600
500
8 600
2 400
1 000
800
Purchases Journal Date Jan. 6
Creditor
Invoice number
Stock Control
GST
Creditors Control
Sherman Sheets
158
2 400
240
2 640
Jan. 12
Irish Linen
A206
2 300
230
2 530
Jan. 23
Sherman Sheets
163
3 000
300
3 300
7 700
770
8 470
Totals
Required
* *
a ExplainWHYTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALHASA3UNDRIESCOLUMN BUTTHE0URCHASES *OURNALDOESNOT b PostTHEJOURNALSTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERAND#REDITORS,EDGEROF-ANCHESTER5NION c ExplainTHEEFFECTOF'34PAIDONTHEBALANCEOFTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNT d BalanceTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNTASAT*ANUARY e FootTHEACCOUNTSINTHE#REDITORS,EDGERANDprepareA#REDITORS3CHEDULEASAT *ANUARY f StateTWOBENElTSOFUSINGASYSTEMOFCONTROLACCOUNTSANDSUBSIDIARYLEDGERS
EXERCISE 6.3 RECORDING IN THE CASH RECEIPTS JOURNAL
W B
page 92
'ARY0ECKSISTHEOWNEROF'ARYS'YM%QUIPMENT WHICHHADTHEFOLLOWINGBALANCESIN ITSLEDGERACCOUNTSASAT-AY Bank GST Clearing Stock Control Debtors Control – Braun Co. – Power Station
$
900 350 4 600 2 990 1 650 1 340
CR CR
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
'ARYPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGLISTOFTRANSACTIONSFOR-AY May
3 5 9 15 24 28
Cash sales of $3 000 (cost price $2 000) plus $300 GST (Rec. 207) Received balance owing from debtor – Braun Co. (Rec. 208) Cash sales $1 980, including $180 GST; cost price $1 200 (Rec. 209) Bank statement indicated $15 interest received (BS) Received $500 owing from Power Station (Rec. 210) Cash sales $2 400 plus GST (Rec. 211)
Required
*
a ExplainWHYTHEINTERESTRECEIVEDON-AYSHOWS@"3INSTEADOFARECEIPT NUMBER b RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR-AYINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALOF'ARYS'YM %QUIPMENT TotalTHEJOURNAL c ShowTHEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESREQUIREDTOPOSTTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALTOTHE 'ENERAL,EDGEROF'ARYS'YM%QUIPMENT d PostTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF'ARYS'YM%QUIPMENT e PostTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALTOTHE$EBTORS,EDGEROF'ARYS'YM%QUIPMENT
EXERCISE 6.4 POSTING THE CASH RECEIPTS JOURNAL
W B
page 95
-ELANIE 7ONG IS THE OWNER OF #ENTRAL 3UPPLIERS WHICH IS RESPONSIBLE FOR SUPPLYING TOILETRIESTOANUMBEROFSMALLHOTELS!SAT3EPTEMBER THEBUSINESSHADTHE FOLLOWINGBALANCESINITSLEDGERACCOUNTS Bank GST Clearing Capital Stock Control Debtors Control – Wincup Hotels – Lloyds Inns
$
1 600 150 40 000 12 100 3 500 2 000 1 500
CR
-ELANIEHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGJOURNALSFOR3EPTEMBER Cash Receipts Journal Date
Details
Receipt number
Bank
Sept. 3
Wincup Hotels
71
500
Sept. 5
Cash Sales
72
660
Sept. 10
Lloyds Inns
73
2 000
Sept. 20
Capital
74
500
Sept. 22
Cash Sales
75
990
Sept. 25
Lloyds Inns
76
3 000
Sept. 29
Cash Sales
77
1 320
Totals
8 970
Debtors Control
Cost of Sales
Sales
Sundries GST
500 400
600
60
2 000 500 600
900
90
800
1 200
120
1 800
2 700
3 000
5 500
500
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
270
Cambridge University Press
133
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
134
UNITS 3&4
Sales Journal Date
Debtor
Invoice number
Cost of Sales
Sales
GST
Debtors Control
Sept. 2
Lloyds Inns
36
1 500
2 250
225
2 475
Sept. 9
Wincup Hotels
37
1 800
2 700
270
2 970
Sept. 16
Both Worlds Hotel
38
900
1 350
135
1 485
Sept. 23
Lloyds Inns
39
1 200
1 800
180
1 980
5 400
8 100
810
8 910
Totals
Required
* *
a ExplainTHEDOUBLE CHECKINGMECHANISMCONTAINEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL b Post THE #ASH 2ECEIPTS *OURNAL AND 3ALES *OURNAL TO THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER AND $EBTORS,EDGEROF#ENTRAL3UPPLIERS c ExplainTHEEFFECTOF'34RECEIVEDONTHEBALANCEOFTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNT d BalanceTHE$EBTORS#ONTROLACCOUNTASAT3EPTEMBER e Foot THE ACCOUNTS IN THE $EBTORS ,EDGER AND prepare A $EBTORS 3CHEDULE AS AT 3EPTEMBER f ExplainHOWUSINGASYSTEMOFCONTROLACCOUNTSANDSUBSIDIARYLEDGERSASSISTSINTHE PREPARATIONOFREPORTS
EXERCISE 6.5 GST CLEARING ACCOUNT
W B
page 98
4HEFOLLOWINGISASUMMARYOF'34TRANSACTIONSRECORDEDINTHEJOURNALSOF4ONYS4OWELS FOR*ULY Cash Receipts Journal:
GST received on cash sales
Cash Payments Journal:
GST settlement
$
640 1 620
GST paid on other cash payments
380
Sales Journal:
GST on credit sales
920
Purchases Journal:
GST on credit purchases
630
!SAT*ULY THE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTHADABALANCEOF#2 Required
*
a Explain WHY THE '34 SETTLEMENT IS not RECORDED IN THE '34 COLUMN OF THE #ASH 0AYMENTS*OURNAL b ShowTHEEFFECTOFTHE'34SETTLEMENTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF4ONYS4OWELS c Prepare THE '34 #LEARING ACCOUNT IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER AFTER ALL JOURNALS HAVE BEENPOSTEDBalanceTHEACCOUNTAT*ULY d ExplainHOWTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF 4ONYS4OWELSASAT*ULY e ExplainWHYITISMORELIKELYTHATABUSINESSWILLENDUPWITHACREDITBALANCEINITS '34#LEARINGACCOUNT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
EXERCISE 6.6 GST CLEARING ACCOUNT
W B
page 99
4HE FOLLOWING IS A SUMMARY OF '34 TRANSACTIONS RECORDED IN THE JOURNALS OF #ONCEPT 0APER3ALESFOR/CTOBER Cash Receipts Journal:
GST received on cash sales
$
800
GST refund
200
Cash Payments Journal:
GST paid on other cash payments
420
Sales Journal:
GST charged to debtors
650
Purchases Journal:
GST charged by creditors
370
!SAT3EPTEMBER THE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTHADABALANCEOF$2 Required
*
a ExplainHOWTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF #ONCEPT0APER3ALESASAT3EPTEMBER b SuggestONEREASONWHY#ONCEPT0APER3ALESHADMORE'34ONITSPURCHASESTHAN '34ONITSSALESINTHEQUARTERENDING3EPTEMBER c ShowHOWTHE'34REFUNDWOULDHAVEBEENRECORDEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL OF#ONCEPT0APER3ALES d ExplainTHEEFFECTOFTHE'34REFUNDONTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF#ONCEPT0APER3ALES e PrepareTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTAFTERALLJOURNALSHAVEBEENPOSTEDBalanceTHE ACCOUNTAT/CTOBER
EXERCISE 6.7 RECORDING IN THE CASH PAYMENTS JOURNAL (DISCOUNTS)
W B
page 100
$IANA!DAMSISTHEOWNEROF$IANAS*EWELLERY WHICHHADTHEFOLLOWINGBALANCESINITS LEDGERACCOUNTSASAT&EBRUARY Bank
$ 12 900
GST Clearing
1 700
Stock Control
74 500
Creditors Control
15 950
– Beads and Stones
8 800
– Carter Diamonds
7 150
CR
4HE0URCHASES*OURNALFOR&EBRUARYSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING Purchases Journal Date
Creditor
Feb. 4
Precious Inc.
Feb. 9
Invoice number
Stock Control
GST
Creditors Control
1702
5 100
510
5 610
Beads and Stones
65
4 000
400
4 400
Feb. 17
Carter Diamonds
c311
6 000
600
6 600
Feb. 22
Beads and Stones
78
7 200
720
7 920
Feb. 28
Carter Diamonds
c346
4 200
420
4 620
26 500
2 650
29 150
Totals
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
135
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
136
UNITS 3&4
$IANAHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGLISTOFCASHPAYMENTSFOR&EBRUARY Feb.
1 3 4 7 10 14 15 20 23 24 27
Paid GST owing to ATO $1 700 Paid Beads and Stones balance outstanding from January, less 5% discount Cash purchase of additional display cabinets for $16 500 including GST Paid Carter Diamonds full amount owing Paid for rent for Feb. – July 2015: $2 400 plus GST Paid wages $1 200 Paid Beads and Stones for Inv. 65 (after 5% discount on invoice price) Paid electricity bill of $110 including GST Paid Carter Diamonds $6 072 for Inv. C311 after receiving 8% discount Cash drawings $1 000 Paid wages $1 250
4HELASTCHEQUEWRITTENIN*ANUARYWASCHEQUENUMBER Required
*
* *
a RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR&EBRUARYINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALOF$IANAS *EWELLERY b PostTHEJOURNALSTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF$IANAS*EWELLERY c PostTHEJOURNALSTOTHE#REDITORS,EDGEROF$IANAS*EWELLERY d BalanceTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNTASAT&EBRUARY e FootTHEACCOUNTSINTHE#REDITORS,EDGERANDprepareA#REDITORS3CHEDULEASAT &EBRUARY f StateTHEEFFECTOFTHECASHPAYMENTON&EBRUARYONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION OF$IANAS*EWELLERY
EXERCISE 6.8 POSTING THE CASH PAYMENTS JOURNAL (DISCOUNTS)
W B
page 104
0ETER /HM OWNS AND OPERATES A SMALL TRADING BUSINESS CALLED 3HOCK %LECTRICS /N *UNE THEBUSINESSHADTHEFOLLOWINGBALANCESINITSLEDGERACCOUNTS Bank GST Clearing Stock Control Creditors Control – Sparkwell – Electron – General PC
$ 2 075 300 10 600 25 500 5 700 15 000 4 800
CR
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
4HEJOURNALSFOR*UNESHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING Cash Payments Journal Date
Details
Cheque number
Bank
*UNE
3PARKWELL
*UNE
$RAWINGS
*UNE
'ENERAL0#
*UNE
7AGES
*UNE
!DVERTISING
*UNE
3PARKWELL
*UNE
7AGES
*UNE
%LECTRON
Totals
Discount Creditors Wages Revenue Control
29 526
Sundries
GST
1 900
100
1 224
24 100
4 650
Purchases Journal Date
Creditor
Invoice number
*UNE
%LECTRON
*UNE
3PARKWELL
!
*UNE
'ENERAL0#
C
11 400
1 140
12 540
Totals
Stock Control
GST
Creditors Control
Required
* *
a b c d
CalculateTHEPERCENTAGEDISCOUNTOFFEREDBY3PARKWELL PostTHEJOURNALSTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERAND#REDITORS,EDGEROF3HOCK%LECTRICS BalanceTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNTASAT*UNE FootTHEACCOUNTSINTHE#REDITORS,EDGERANDprepareA#REDITORS3CHEDULEASAT *UNE e ExplainWHYTHEDISCOUNTRECEIVEDFROMCREDITORSISCLASSIlEDASREVENUE f Explain ONE CONTROL PROCEDURE 3HOCK %LECTRICS SHOULD USE TO DETECT ERRORS IN THE #REDITORS,EDGER
EXERCISE 6.9 RECORDING IN THE CASH RECEIPTS JOURNAL (DISCOUNTS)
W B
page 107
3PORTS"ONANZAISOWNEDBY*OE,ITTLE ANDON$ECEMBER THEBUSINESSHADTHE FOLLOWINGBALANCESINITSLEDGERACCOUNTS Bank Capital Stock Control Debtors Control – Emerald CC – St Carls PS GST Clearing
$
500 30 000 14 000 2 420 1 320 1 100 70
CR
DR
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
137
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
138
UNITS 3&4
4HE3ALES*OURNALFOR$ECEMBERSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING Sales Journal Date
Debtor
Invoice number
Dec. 7
St Carls PS
904
Dec. 15
Emerald CC
Dec. 19 Dec. 22
Cost of Sales
Sales
GST
Debtors Control
800
1 300
130
1 430
905
450
750
75
825
East Bunbury SC
906
700
1 000
100
1 100
St Carls PS
907
550
900
90
990
2 500
3 950
395
4 345
Totals
*OEHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGLISTOFTRANSACTIONSFOR$ECEMBER Dec.
1 3 6 9 10 13 18 21 24
Cash sales $132 including GST (cost price $95) Received amount outstanding from Emerald CC, after discount of 10% Received GST refund from ATO $70 Received $1 100 from debtor – St Carls PS Goods with a cost price of $120 sold for $200 plus GST Received $1 287 from St Carls PS; 10% discount given on Inv. 904 Cash sales of $400 plus GST (cost price $290) Joe Little contributed $5 000 cash East Bunbury SC paid for Inv. 906; 10% discount on invoice price
4HELASTRECEIPTISSUEDIN.OVEMBERWASNO Required
*
* *
a RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR$ECEMBERINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALOF3PORTS "ONANZA b PostTHEJOURNALSTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF3PORTS"ONANZA c PostTHEJOURNALSTOTHE$EBTORS,EDGEROF3PORTS"ONANZA d BalanceTHEDEBTORSCONTROLACCOUNTASAT$ECEMBER e FootTHEACCOUNTSINTHE$EBTORS,EDGERANDprepareA$EBTORS3CHEDULEASAT $ECEMBER f StateTWOBENElTSOFOFFERINGDISCOUNTSTODEBTORS g ExplainWHYNO'34ISATTACHEDTOTHETRANSACTIONON$ECEMBER h StateTHEEFFECTOFTHETRANSACTIONON$ECEMBERONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION OF3PORTS"ONANZA
EXERCISE 6.10 POSTING THE CASH RECEIPTS JOURNAL (DISCOUNTS)
W B
page 111
-AX0OWERSOPERATESALAMPSHOPCALLED-OJO,TD WHICHSPECIALISESINTHESALEOFLAVA LAMPS/N!PRIL ITSLEDGERACCOUNTSSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWINGBALANCES GST Clearing Stock Control Debtors Control – Far Out Lights – Liquid Lamps Bank Capital
$
190 11 300 3 300 1 100 2 200 2 650 23 000
CR
DR
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
139
4HEJOURNALSFOR!PRILSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING Cash Receipts Journal Date
Details
Receipt Bank number
Discount Debtors Cost of Expense Control Sales
Sundries
GST
April 1 Far Out Lights
771
1 050
Apr. 5 Cash Sales
772
660
300
600
60
Apr. 8 Cash Sales
773
495
225
450
45
774
2 100
100
2 200
775
1 680
80
1 760
. 20 Capital contribution
776
500
. 22 Cash Sales
777
935
. 25 Liquid Lamps
778
3 150
. 29 Cash Sales
779
1 320
. 10 Liquid Lamps Apr. 17 Far Out Lights
Totals
50
Sales
1 100
500
150
11 890
380
425
850
85
600
1 200
120
1 550
3 100
3 300
8 360
500
310
Sales Journal Date
Debtor
Invoice number
Cost of Sales
April 4
Far Out Lights
63
800
1 600
160
1 760
Apr. 8
Liquid Lamps
64
1 000
2 000
200
2 200
Apr. 15
Liquid Lamps
65
1 500
3 000
300
3 300
Apr. 21
Far Out Lights
66
700
1 400
140
1 540
Apr. 28
Liquid Lamps
67
900
1 800
180
1 980
4 900
9 800
980
10 780
Totals
Sales
GST
Debtors Control
Required
* *
a StateONEREASONWHYTHETOTALOFTHE$EBTORS#ONTROLCOLUMNDOESnotREPRESENT THECASHRECEIVEDFROMDEBTORSDURING!PRIL b PostTHEJOURNALSTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERANDA$EBTORS,EDGEROF-OJO,TD c BalanceTHE$EBTORS#ONTROLACCOUNTASAT!PRIL d Foot THE ACCOUNTS IN THE $EBTORS ,EDGER AND prepare A $EBTORS 3CHEDULE AS AT !PRIL e ExplainWHYTHEDISCOUNTGRANTEDTODEBTORSISCLASSIlEDASANEXPENSE
EXERCISE 6.11 POSTING SPECIAL JOURNALS
W B
page 114
+IT2EIDISTHEOWNEROF"OOK7ORMS ASHOPTHATSELLSRAREANDANTIQUEBOOKS)TS4RIAL "ALANCEASAT*ULYSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
140
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Account
Debit
Bank
Credit
800
Debtors Control
7 000
Stock Control
3 100
Shop Fittings
23 000
Premises
190 000
GST Clearing
610
Creditors Control
9 000
Loan – VicFin
150 000
Capital – Reid
64 290
Total
$223 900
$223 900
4HEJOURNALSFOR*ULYSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING Cash Receipts Journal Date
Details
Receipt number
Bank
Discount Debtors Cost of Expense Control Sales
Sales
#APITAL#ONTRIBUTION
Sundries GST
Totals
9 900
500
5 000 2 000 4 000
1 000
400
Sundries
GST
Cash Payments Journal Date
Details
Cheque Bank number
Discount Creditors Stock Wages Revenue Control Control
,OANn6IC&IN
)NTEREST%XPENSE
'34#LEARING
$RAWINGS Totals
15 280
900
5 500
1 200
6 500
2 860
120
Sales Journal Date
Debtor
Totals
Invoice number
Cost of Sales 5 000
Sales
GST
Debtors Control
8 000
800
8 800
Purchases Journal Date
Creditor Totals
Invoice number
Stock Control 5 200
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
GST 520
Creditors Control 5 720
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 6
SPECIAL JOURNALS 2: CASH JOURNALS
141
Required
* *
a PostTHEJOURNALSTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF"OOK7ORMS b BalanceTHE"ANKAND'34#LEARINGACCOUNTSASAT*ULY c FootTHEOTHERLEDGERACCOUNTSANDprepareA4RIAL"ALANCEFOR"OOK7ORMSASAT *ULY d ExplainHOWTHE'34CLEARINGACCOUNTWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF "OOK7ORMSASAT*ULY e +ITHASARGUEDTHATBECAUSEHISCAPITALCONTRIBUTIONANDDRAWINGSWEREBOTH HISCAPITALlGUREWILLNOTCHANGEExplainONEREASONWHY+ITISINCORRECT
EXERCISE 6.12 POSTING SPECIAL JOURNALS
W B
page 118
-ADDY-ERCURIOOWNSANDOPERATESASMALLTRADINGBUSINESSCALLED'REENDAY0LANTS SELLINGPLANTSANDGARDENORNAMENTS/N!UGUST THEBUSINESSHADTHEFOLLOWING BALANCESINITSLEDGERACCOUNTS Bank
$ 1 700
GST Clearing
640
Stock Control
5 900
Creditors Control
5 500
– Kris and Marnie’s
2 200
– Wombat Plants
3 300
Debtors Control
CR
2 860
– Glen Golf Club
2 200
– City of Yarra
660
Capital
18 000
Shelving
30 000
4HEJOURNALSFOR!UGUSTSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING Cash Receipts Journal Date
Details
Rec. no.
Bank
Aug. 3 City of Yarra
51
600
Aug. 5 Cash Sales
52
880
53
2 100
54
2 000
55
1 100
56
1 050
57
1 650
10 Glen Golf Club . 20 Capital 22 Cash Sales Au25 Glen Golf Club 29 Cash Sales Totals
9 380
Discount Expense 60
Debtors Control
Cost of Sales
Sundries
GST
660 400
100
Sales
800
80
2 200 2 000
50
210
500
1 000
100
750
1 500
150
1 650
3 300
1 100
3 960
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
2 000
330
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
142
UNITS 3&4
Cash Payments Journal Date
Details
Chq. no.
Bank
Discount Revenue
Creditors Control
Selling Expenses
Shelving
Sundries
Aug. 1
GST Clearing
900
640
640
Aug. 2
Drawings
901
1 000
1 000
Aug. 5
Wages
902
500
Aug. 9
Kris and Marnie’s
903
2 100
Interest
904
100
Aug.17
New Shelving
905
1 760
Au. 21
Advertising
906
440
Au. 25
Wombat Plants
907
3 300
13
Totals
9 840
GST
500 100
2 200 100 1 600
160
400
40
3 300 100
5 500
900
1 600
1 740
200
Sales Journal Date
Debtor
Invoice number
Cost of Sales
Sales
GST
Debtors Control
Aug. 4
City of Yarra
14
1 000
2 000
200
2 200
Aug. 8
Glen Golf Club
15
500
1 000
100
1 100
Aug. 15
Glen Golf Club
16
2 000
4 000
400
4 400
Aug. 21
City of Yarra
17
800
1 600
160
1 760
Aug. 28
Glen Golf Club
18
1 400
2 800
280
3 080
5 700
11 400
1 140
12 540
Totals
Purchases Journal Date Aug. 5
Creditor Wombat Plants
12
Kris and Marnie’s
19
Wombat Plants
26
Kris and Marnie’s Totals
Invoice number
Stock Control
GST
Creditors Control
W12
1 000
100
1 100
34
1 500
150
1 650
W29
1 300
130
1 430
40
2 000
200
2 200
5 800
580
6 380
Required
* *
a ExplainHOWRECORDINGTRANSACTIONSINSPECIALJOURNALSINCREASESTHEEFlCIENCYOFTHE ACCOUNTINGSYSTEM b StateTWOWEAKNESSESINTHEWAY-ADDYRECORDSCASHPAYMENTS c 5SINGTHEINFORMATIONASITISPROVIDED postTHEJOURNALSTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERAND SUBSIDIARYLEDGERSOF'REENDAY0LANTS d BalanceTHE$EBTORS#ONTROLAND#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNTSASAT!UGUST e ExplainTHEROLEOFA$EBTORS3CHEDULE f Foot THE SUBSIDIARY LEDGERS AND prepare A $EBTORS 3CHEDULE AND A #REDITORS 3CHEDULEASAT!UGUST
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s explain the role of the General Journal s use the General Journal to record – commencing entries – non-cash transactions with the owner – bad debts – correcting entries s define the term ‘bad debt’
s explain the need to record and report bad debts, and their relationship to the accounting principles and qualitative characteristics s explain the effect of a bad debt on the accounting equation.
CHAPTER 7
THE GENERAL JOURNAL KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s General Journal s narration s commencing entry s bad debt.
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
144
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
7.1
UNITS 3&4
THE NEED FOR THE GENERAL JOURNAL
The great beauty of recording in special journals is that it allows us to summarise similar transactions, and then post only the totals to the General Ledger at the end of the month, reducing the number of ledger entries required. For instance, the Purchases Journal records all transactions involving the purchase of stock on credit, and the double entry for each of these transactions is exactly the same.
General Journal an accounting record used to record infrequent, non-cash transactions, which cannot be recorded in the special journals
STUDY TIP
If a transaction involves cash, it is recorded in either the Cash Receipts Journal or the Cash Payments Journal, whether or not it is infrequent.
DR
Stock Control
DR
GST Clearing
CR
Creditors Control
CR
(Each individual account in the Creditors Ledger)
The same principle applies to the Sales Journal, where each credit sale results in exactly the same entries. Even in the Cash Receipts Journal and the Cash Payments Journal, where a variety of cash transactions are recorded, all the transactions have something in common by virtue of requiring either a debit (for receipts) or credit (for payments) to Bank. There will, however, be some transactions that cannot be recorded in these special journals because they do not involve cash, and do not involve the purchase or sale of stock. For instance, what happens if the owner contributes her own vehicle for business purposes? This transaction is neither receipt nor payment, nor sale nor purchase. Transactions like this must still be recorded in a journal before they can be posted to the ledger, but they cannot be recorded in the special journals used so far. At the same time, because they are infrequent they do not justify their own special journal as there would be only one entry to summarise. Instead, they are recorded in a more general journal called, unsurprisingly, the General Journal. This General Journal is used to record infrequent, non-cash transactions, which cannot be recorded in any of the special journals.
Uses of the General Journal The main types of transactions that will be recorded in the General Journal are: s COMMENCINGENTRIES s NON CASHTRANSACTIONSWITHTHEOWNER s BADDEBTS s CORRECTINGENTRIES s USEOFSTOCKFORADVERTISINGPURPOSESCOVEREDIN#HAPTER s CLOSINGENTRIESCOVEREDIN#HAPTER s BALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTSCOVEREDIN#HAPTERSAND
REVIEW QUESTIONS 7.1
1 Explain the role of special journals in the accounting process. 2 Explain the role of the General Journal. 3 List seven types of transactions that will be recorded in the General Journal.
7.2
FORMAT OF THE GENERAL JOURNAL
Because the General Journal is used to record a variety of transactions, it must have a fairly simple format. As a result, it has columns for date and details just like a special journal, but no classification columns; it simply has a debit column and a credit column to record amounts. This probably makes it easier to record in the General Journal than ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 7
145
THE GENERAL JOURNAL
in the special journals, and easier to post the General Journal to the ledger. The basic FORMATOFTHE'ENERAL*OURNALISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 7.1 Format of the General Journal General Ledger Date
Details
Debit
Credit
Subsidiary Ledger Debit
Credit
The most obvious and immediate thing to notice is how closely the General Journal resembles the analysing charts we used when learning the ledger process (in Chapter 2). Basically, transactions are recorded in date order (as they occur), with the Details column used to record the name of each ledger account affected by the transaction. Then the amount is simply recorded in the debit or credit column as is necessary. The key thing to remember about the debit and credit columns in the General Journal is that, like all transactions, the debits must equal the credits. If the transaction does not balance in the General Journal, it cannot balance when it is posted to the ledger accounts. Transactions affecting General Ledger accounts are recorded in the debit and credit columns under the heading ‘General Ledger’. The debit and credit columns under the ‘subsidiary ledger’ heading are only used when a subsidiary debtor or creditor account is affected. (This will be covered in more detail later in this chapter.)
Narrations When transactions are recorded in special journals, there is no need to provide a written description of what has occurred because not only are all of a similar nature, but also they are described by the title of the journal in which they are recorded. For instance, the Sales Journal records credit sales, and the Cash Receipts Journal records cash receipts. However, because the General Journal records a wide variety of transactions, it is necessary to give a brief description of the transaction immediately after recording the debit and credit entries. This description is known as a narration. The narration should ‘tell the story’ of what has happened, and also note the source document involved.
REVIEW QUESTIONS 7.2
1 Explain why there are no classification columns in the General Journal. 2 Explain how the rules of double-entry accounting apply to the General Journal. 3 In relation to the General Journal, define the term ‘narration’. 4 Explain why narrations are necessary in the General Journal, but not in the special journals.
7.3
narration a brief description of a transaction recorded in the General Journal, including a reference to the relevant source document
COMMENCING ENTRIES
The first time the General Journal is likely to be used is when the double-entry recording system is established. This is known variously as an establishing, opening or commencing entry. The purpose of a commencing entry is to open or establish ledger accounts for any existing asset, liability and owner’s equity items. This may be when the business is just starting and the owner is contributing starting capital, or when the business has been operating for some time already, and the owner decides to switch from singleentry accounting to double-entry records. ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
commencing entry a General Journal entry to establish double-entry records by entering existing asset, liability and owner’s equity balances in the ledger account
Cambridge University Press
146
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXAMPLE G. Petto is the owner of Toy Bonanza, a toyshop that has been running for three years using a single-entry recording system. On 1 July 2015, he decided to adopt a double-entry recording system (Memo 1). The assets and liabilities of the business at 1 July 2015 were: Assets
$
Bank Stock Control Vehicle
Liabilities
1 400 37 000 22 000
$
Loan GQC Finance GST Clearing
15 600 300
The General Journal entry to record the commencement of double-entry records is shown in Figure 7.2. Figure 7.2 General Journal: simple commencing entry General Journal General Ledger
STUDY TIP
Date
Details
July 1
Bank
Debit
Debit
Credit
1 400
Stock Control
37 000
Vehicle
22 000 Loan GQC Finance
Use the accounting equation (assets = liabilities + owner’s equity) to calculate the capital figure
Credit
Subsidiary ledger
GST Clearing Capital – G. Petto
15 600 300 44 500
Commencement of double-entry records (Memo 1)
By convention, the debit entries are recorded first, followed by the credit entries, with the accounts to be credited indented slightly. The three asset accounts – Bank, Stock Control and Vehicle – require a debit balance, while the liability accounts – Loan GQC Finance and GST Clearing – require a credit balance. But on their own, these five entries do not comprise a complete entry, because THEDEBITENTRIES DONOTMATCHTHECREDITENTRIES AFURTHERCREDITOF ) is required. This balancing amount becomes the owner’s Capital. As noted previously, the narration provides a brief description of the transaction, which in this case is the Commencement of double-entry records. It also identifies the source document that verifies the transaction: -EMO. This General Journal entry would be posted to the General Ledger accounts as shown opposite.
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 7
147
THE GENERAL JOURNAL
General Ledger Bank (A) Date
Cross-reference
July 1
Balance
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
1 400 Stock Control (A)
Date
Cross-reference
July 1
Balance
Amount $
Date
37 000 Vehicle (A)
Date
Cross-reference
July 1
Balance
Amount $
Date
22 000 Loan GQC Finance (L)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
July 1
Balance
Amount $ 15 600
GST Clearing (A/L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
July 1
Balance
Amount $ 300
Capital – G. Petto (OE) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
July 1
Balance
Amount $ 44 500
Commencing entries and subsidiary ledger accounts The basic principles of opening entries apply to all types of businesses, but for businesses using control accounts for creditors and debtors, a little more information is required. The balances of all existing asset, liability and owner’s equity accounts must still be entered in the General Ledger, but all individual debtor and creditor balances must also be entered in the subsidiary ledger accounts, and this must be recorded in the commencing entry in the General Journal.
On 1 August 2015, Harry Norman decided to establish a double-entry recording system for his business, Couch World (Memo 1). The firm already had the following assets and liabilities: Assets Bank Stock Control Debtors – A. Smietenko – S. Grant Shop Fittings
$ 4 200 54 000 2 300 3 500 32 000
Liabilities Creditors – Pine Products – Suede Effects – Steel Frame Co. Loan – Bank of Cicely GST Clearing
EXAMPLE
$ 1 300 4 100 2 900 40 000 500
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
148
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
The General Journal entry to record the commencement of the double-entry records is shown in Figure 7.3. Figure 7.3 General Journal: opening entry (including subsidiary ledger accounts) General Journal General Ledger
Subsidiary ledger Debit
Date
Details
Debit
Aug. 1
Bank
4 200
Stock Control
Credit
Credit
54 000
Debtors Control
5 800
Debtor – A. Smietenko
2 300
Debtor – S. Grant
3 500
Shop fittings
32 000
Creditors Control
8 300
Creditor – Pine Products
1 300
Creditor – Suede Effects
4 100
Creditor – Steel Frame Co.
2 900
Loan – Bank of Cicely
40 000
GST Clearing
500
Capital – Norman
47 200
Commencement of double-entry records (Memo 1)
Note how the double-entry process is preserved in the General Ledger columns (and thus in the General Ledger accounts) with the total debits matching the total credits. The total amount owed by debtors ) is recorded as the opening balance in the Debtors Control account, and the total amount owed to creditors () is recorded as the opening balance in the Creditors Control account. In addition, the accounting equation has been used to determine the amount of Capital (). However, in the subsidiary ledgers, the double-entry process is suspended; only the entry that affects the individual debtor or creditor is recorded. Thus, the entries in the subsidiary ledger columns of the General Journal do not have to be a matching double entry. The opening balances owed by the two individual debtors – A. Smietenko and 3'RANT – are entered under the subsidiary ledger heading on the debit side, just as they would appear in the Debtors Ledger, while the amounts owed by the three creditors – 0INE0RODUCTS, 3UEDE%FFECTS and Steel Frame #O – are entered on the credit side, just as they would appear in the Creditors Ledger. The Debtors Control account would appear in the General Ledger as: General Ledger Debtors Control (A) Date
Cross-reference
Aug. 1
Balance
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
5 800
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 7
THE GENERAL JOURNAL
The individual debtor accounts would appear in the Debtors Ledger as: Debtors Ledger A. Smietenko (A) Date
Cross-reference
Aug. 1
Balance
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
2 300 S. Grant (A)
Date
Cross-reference
Aug. 1
Balance
Amount $
Date
3 500
Similarly, the Creditors Control account would appear in the General Ledger as: General Ledger Creditors’ Control (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Aug. 1
Balance
Amount $ 8 300
The individual creditor accounts would appear in the Creditors Ledger as shown: Creditors Ledger Pine Products (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Aug. 1
Balance
Amount $ 1 300
Suede Effects (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Aug. 1
Balance
Amount $ 4 100
Steel Frame Co. (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Aug. 1
Balance
Amount $ 2 900
REVIEW QUESTIONS 7.3
1 Define the term ‘commencing entry’. 2 State two reasons why a commencing entry may be necessary. 3 In reference to a commencing entry, explain how the entry to the Capital account is determined.
7.4
NON-CASH TRANSACTIONS WITH THE OWNER
Because the owner and business are assumed to be separate entities, transactions between the two must be recorded in the firm’s accounting records. Cash drawings will be recorded in the Cash Payments Journal and capital contributions of cash will be recorded in the Cash Receipts Journal, but drawings or capital contributions of other non-cash items (such as stock or equipment) will need to be recorded in the General Journal.
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
149
150
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Drawings of stock
EXAMPLE
On 16 July 2015, the owner withdrew $300 worth of stock (Memo 13).
4HISTRANSACTIONWOULDBERECORDEDINTHEJOURNALASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 7.4 General Journal: non-cash drawings General Journal General Ledger Date July 16
Details
Debit
Drawings
Credit
Subsidiary ledger Debit
Credit
300
Stock Control
300
Owner withdrew stock for personal use (Memo 13)
Ideally, a narration for drawings of this type would not just refer to ‘stock’, but rather would name the stock item (and/or its stock code) and the quantity withdrawn. However, as this information is unavailable in this example, a more general description will suffice. This entry would be posted to the General Ledger accounts as shown below. General Ledger Drawings (– OE) Date July 31
Cross-reference
Amount
Stock Control
Date
Cross-reference
Amount
Cross-reference
Amount
300 Stock Control (A)
STUDY TIP
The only dates you should see in the General Ledger are the start and the end of the month.
Date
Cross-reference
July 1
Balance
Amount
Date
32 000
July 31
Drawings
300
4HE TRANSACTION WAS RECORDED IN THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ON *ULY THE DAY IT OCCURRED BUTISNOTPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERUNTIL*ULY WHICHISTHEEND of the month. Although there are no totals to post, even the General Journal is posted to the General Ledger only at the end of the month. The General Journal is posted to the General Ledger at the end of the month.
Non-cash capital contributions Whereas assets withdrawn by the owner are debited to a separate Drawings account, assets that are contributed by the owner are credited straight to the Capital account.
EXAMPLE
On 23 July 2015, the owner contributed to the business her own vehicle, which had an agreed value of $23 000 (Memo 16).
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 7
THE GENERAL JOURNAL
Remember that although the business and the owner are separate accounting entities, they are, in fact, the same person, so there can be no actual ‘sale’ of this vehicle by the owner to the business. As a result, the value of the asset cannot be identified by reference to a sales invoice or receipt. At the same time, the asset must be valued at the time it is acquired by the business, so its agreed value (of ) is used, and VERIlEDBYTHE-EMO4HISAGREEDVALUEBECOMESTHEHISTORICALCOSTTOBEUSEDBY the business. 4HISTRANSACTIONWOULDBERECORDEDINTHEJOURNALASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 7.5 General Journal: non-cash capital contributions General Journal General Ledger Date
Details
Debit
July 23
Vehicles
23 000
Capital
Subsidiary ledger
Credit
Debit
Credit
23 000
Owner contributed vehicle for business use – agreed value (Memo 16)
This entry would be posted to the General Ledger accounts as shown below. General Ledger Capital (OE) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
July 1
Balance
40 000
31
Vehicles
23 000
Vehicles (A) Date
Cross-reference
July 1
Balance
30 000
Capital
23 000
31
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
REVIEW QUESTIONS 7.4
1 2 3 4
Explain why drawings of stock must be recorded in the General Journal. Show the General Journal entries necessary to record drawings of stock. Show the effect of drawings on the accounting equation. Show the General Journal entries necessary to record a capital contribution of a vehicle. 5 Show the effect of a capital contribution on the accounting equation.
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
151
152
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
7.5
bad debt an expense incurred when a debt is written off because it is deemed to be irrecoverable
UNITS 3&4
BAD DEBTS
Unfortunately for small business owners, not all debtors can be counted on to repay the amounts they owe, and occasionally a debt may need to be written off as ‘bad’. According to the Conservatism principle, a bad debt should be recognised as an expense when the loss is probable, so that assets (in this case, Debtors Control) are not overstated. This will usually be when the debtor is in liquidation or has been declared bankrupt and the debt is deemed to be irrecoverable. Recognising a bad debt will ensure the reports contain all the information that is useful for decision-making – such as bad debts in the Income Statement and an updated amount for Debtors Control in the Balance Sheet. This ensures Relevance.
Not all debtors can be counted on to repay the amounts they owe, and occasionally a debt may need to be written off as ‘bad’
A bad debt is a good example of how an expense does not have to involve a cash payment. If a bad debt is incurred, the business will need to recognise an expense for the loss of an economic benefit in the form of a decrease in assets (Debtors Control), which decreases owner’s equity. At the same time as it records this expense, the business must record the decrease in Debtors Control (in the General Ledger) and the account of the individual debtor (in the Debtors Ledger).
EXAMPLE
On 16 March 2015, the business was informed that a debtor (A. Micari) was bankrupt, and of the $400 owed by Micari, only $40 would be received (Memo 41).
The cash received from the debtor would be recorded in the Cash Receipts Journal in the usual way, but the remaining would be written off in the General Journal as shown in Figure 7.6.
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 7
THE GENERAL JOURNAL
Figure 7.6 General Journal: bad debt General Journal General Ledger Date March 16
Details
Debit
Bad debts
Subsidiary ledger
Credit
Debit
Credit
360
Debtors Control
360
Debtor – A. Micari
360
Debt written off as irrecoverable (Memo 41)
Note how the double entry is preserved in the General Ledger columns, but in the subsidiary ledger columns, a single entry – to the individual account of A. Micari – is necessary. The entry would be posted to the General Ledger as is shown in Figure 7.7. Figure 7.7 General Ledger: posting a bad debt General Ledger Bad Debts (E) Date
Cross-reference
Mar. 31
Debtors Control
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
360
Debtors Control (A) Date
Cross-reference
Mar. 1
Balance
Amount $ 8 000
Date Mar. 31 31
Bank/Discount Exp.
3 000
Bad Debts
360
Note that the cash received would have been recorded in the ‘Debtors Control’ COLUMN OF THE #ASH 2ECEIPTS *OURNAL AND SO IS INCLUDED IN THE CREDIT TO THE Debtors Control account (and cross-referenced to ‘Bank/Discount expense’). The individual debtor account in the Debtors Ledger would show the following. Debtors Ledger A. Micari (A) Date
Cross-reference
Mar. 1
Balance
Amount $ 400
Date Mar. 16
Cross-reference
Amount $
Bank
40
Bad Debts
360
Effect on the accounting equation A bad debt has the following effect on the accounting equation: Increase/Decrease/No effect Assets
Decrease (Debtors Control)
Liabilities
No effect
Owner’s Equity
Decrease (Bad debts expense decreases Net Profit)
Amount $ 360
360
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
153
154
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 7.5
1 Define the term ‘bad debt’. 2 Referring to one accounting principle, explain when a bad debt should be recognised. 3 Show the General Journal entries necessary to record a bad debt. 4 Show the effect of a bad debt on the accounting equation.
STUDY TIP
The ‘See, Think, Solve’ approach may be used to determine how to correct an error.
EXAMPLE
7.6
CORRECTING ENTRIES
In an accounting system designed and run by humans, it is only natural that mitsakes mistakes will occur from time to time. Where these errors are detected before the journals are posted to the ledger, they can be corrected in the journals. However, if the journals have already been posted to the ledger, errors must be corrected using a General Journal entry. It is difficult to set rules for the correction of errors because such a wide variety of errors may need to be corrected. However, if the error involves recording a transaction in the wrong ledger account, the basic steps to take would be: 1 Undo the incorrect entry by reversing it; that is, record a debit entry to undo an incorrect credit, and vice versa. 2 Enter the correct entry.
On 31 July 2015, it was discovered that $400 in wages was incorrectly recorded as electricity (Memo 20), and that drawings of stock worth $250 had been recorded as stock used for advertising (Memo 21).
4HECORRECTINGENTRIESARESHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 7.8 General Journal: correcting entries General Journal General Ledger Date July 31
Details
Debit
Wages Expense
400
Electricity Expense
Credit
Subsidiary ledger Debit
Credit
400
Correcting entry – wages recorded as electricity (Memo 20) July 31
Drawings
250
Advertising
250
Correcting entry – drawings recorded as advertising (Memo 21)
Electricity is credited to undo the incorrect debit to that account when the error was made, and Wages is debited, as this is the correct entry that should have been recorded in the first place.
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 7
THE GENERAL JOURNAL
The debit to Drawings is how the entry should have been recorded, with the remaining credit entry to Advertising undoing the error. Note that there is no entry to change the Stock Control account, as the stock was removed; the only difference being that it was the owner who took home the stock. If the error was the omission of a transaction, this could be corrected by simply making an additional entry in the General Journal. If the error involved the use of an incorrect amount, it could be corrected either by an additional entry using the additional amount or a reducing entry (to credit the account originally debited and vice versa) using the excess amount.
REVIEW QUESTIONS 7.6
1 Explain why in some situations errors may be corrected in the appropriate special journal, but in others a General Journal entry is required. 2 List three types of errors that may need to be corrected via the General Journal. 3 List the two basic steps for correcting an error involving the use of the wrong ledger account.
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s 4HE'ENERAL*OURNALISUSEDTORECORDINFREQUENT NON CASHTRANSACTIONSTHATCANNOT be recorded in any of the special journals, such as: – commencing entries – non-cash transactions with the owner – bad debts – correcting entries – use of stock for advertising purposes – closing entries – balance day adjustments. s !NARRATIONDESCRIBESEACH'ENERAL*OURNALENTRY INCLUDINGAREFERENCETOTHESOURCE document. s 4HE'ENERAL*OURNALISPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERATTHEENDOFTHEMONTH
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
155
156
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 7.1 COMMENCING ENTRIES
EXERCISES
W B
page 124
The owner of Quality Pool Sweepers has decided to convert his records to a double-entry RECORDINGSYSTEM4HEFOLLOWINGASSETANDLIABILITYBALANCESWERELISTEDIN-EMOON -ARCH Bank
$
Debtors Control
3 400 17 500
Stock Control
4 000
Creditors Control
14 000
GST owing to ATO
2 700
Required a Calculate/WNERS%QUITYASAT-ARCH b Show the General Journal entries necessary to record the opening balances on -ARCH c Post the General Journal to the General Ledger of Quality Pool Sweepers. d Explain why commencing entries must be recorded in the General Journal.
EXERCISE 7.2 COMMENCING ENTRIES
W B
page 126
Claire’s Carpets sells quality flooring and has decided to convert its records to a doubleentry recording system. The following asset and liability balances were determined on -AY Bank Overdraft
$
2 500
Debtors – RACV
4 000
– Borders
6 800
Stock Control
17 000
Creditors – Woolmark
5 000
– NZ Pile
3 000
Delivery Van GST Refund Due from ATO
23 000 450
Required
*
a Show the General Journal entries necessary to record the opening balances on -AY.ARRATIONnot required.) b Explain the role of a narration in a General Journal entry. c Post the General Journal to the General Ledger and subsidiary ledgers of Claire’s Carpets. d PrepareACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR#LAIRES#ARPETSASAT-AY
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 7
THE GENERAL JOURNAL
EXERCISE 7.3 CONTRIBUTION OF ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
W B
page 129
/N *ULY $ANIELLE -ERCER COMMENCED BUSINESS UNDER THE NAME OF $ANIELLES Antiques by contributing: s s s s
CASH AVANWITHANAGREEDVALUEOF WORTHOFSTOCK ANINTEREST ONLYLOANOFDUE-ARCH
Required a Show THE JOURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD THE CONTRIBUTIONS ON *ULY (Narration not required.) b Explain your treatment of the contribution of cash in the journals of Danielle’s Antiques. c Explain why the vehicle contributed by the owner was valued at its agreed vale.
EXERCISE 7.4 NON-CASH TRANSACTIONS WITH THE OWNER
W B
page 130
4OM-ATTHIASOWNS4OOL4OWN WHICHON3EPTEMBERHADWORTHOFSTOCK on hand. Tom has provided the following memo:
Tool Town
memo
73 Date:
16 September 2015
From: Stock Room To: Accounting Department $1 000 worth of stock was given to my son as a birthday present. Please update the records as necessary. Thanks, Tom
Required a Show the General Journal entries necessary to record Memo 73. b Post the General Journal to the General Ledger of Tool Town. c State the effect of Memo 73 on the accounting equation of Tool Town.
EXERCISE 7.5 NON-CASH TRANSACTIONS WITH THE OWNER
W B
page 131
Sybil Hilesio is the owner of Soap and Suds, and let her accountant know of two TRANSACTIONSTHATHADTAKENPLACEDURING*ULY July 2 10
Took office furniture home for personal use $100 (Memo 24) Contributed to the store new shelving worth $2 500 (Memo 25)
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
157
158
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Required a ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORD-EMOSAND b Post the General Journal to the General Ledger of Soap and Suds. c Referring to one accounting principle, explain WHY -EMO DECREASES OWNERS equity. d StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF3OAPAND3UDSASAT*ULYIF -EMOISnot recorded.
EXERCISE 7.6 NON-CASH TRANSACTIONS WITH THE OWNER
W B
page 133
/N!UGUST 7ENDYDONATEDTOHERBUSINESS 7ENDYS7OOLLENS ACOMPUTER THATSHEHADPURCHASEDFORHERSELFAYEARAGOFOR4HECOMPUTER WHICHWILLBE USEDEXCLUSIVELYBYTHEBUSINESS HASANAGREEDVALUEOF BUT7ENDYHASARGUED THATACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLESDEMANDTHATITISVALUEDINTHEBUSINESSSRECORDSAT Required a Referring to one qualitative characteristic, explain why the computer must be valued ATINTHEBUSINESSRECORDS b Show the General Journal entries to record this transaction. (Narration not required.) c Referring to two accounting principles, discuss Wendy’s argument about the valuation of the computer.
EXERCISE 7.7 BAD DEBTS
W B
page 134
/N 3EPTEMBER THE OWNER OF $ODGE $ISHWASHERS WENT TO VISIT ONE OF HIS CUSTOMERSn$ES4#HUTEnTORECOVERADEBT5PONARRIVAL THEOWNERFOUND that Chute had moved three months ago and left no forwarding address. He decided to WRITEOFFTHEDEBTASBAD-EMO Required a b c d
Show the General Journal entries necessary to record the bad debt. Post the General Journal to the General Ledger of Dodge Dishwashers. State the effect of this transaction on the accounting equation of Dodge Dishwashers. Referring to one qualitative characteristic, explain why bad debts must be reported in the Income Statement.
EXERCISE 7.8 BAD DEBTS
W B
page 135
4RAVIS-ILTONOWNS4ERRIFIC4ELLIES/N-ARCH HERECEIVEDALETTERFROMASOLICITOR stating that one of the firm’s debtors (Ian Solvent) was declaring bankruptcy and would ONLYBEABLETOPAYCOFEVERYDOLLAROWED-EMO 4HELETTERWASACCOMPANIED BYACHEQUEFROM)AN3OLVENTFORWHICH4RAVISISSUED2EC/N-ARCH TOTAL DEBTORSOWED WITHOFTHATAMOUNTOWEDBY)AN3OLVENT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 7
THE GENERAL JOURNAL
Required a ShowTHEJOURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHEINFORMATIONON-ARCH b Show how the Debtors Control and Bad Debts accounts would appear after this information was posted to the General Ledger of Terrific Tellies. c Complete the account of Ian Solvent in the Debtors Ledger of Terrific Tellies as at -ARCH d State the effect on the accounting equation of Terrific Tellies if the bad debt was not recorded.
EXERCISE 7.9 CORRECTING ENTRIES
W B
page 137
/N*UNE "ARRY0OWERSDISCOVEREDTHEFOLLOWINGERRORSJUSTPRIORTOPREPARING the financial reports for his business, Powers Tools: s 4ELEPHONE CHARGES OF PLUS '34 WERE INCORRECTLY DEBITED TO )NSURANCE -EMO s RECORDED AS )NTEREST %XPENSE WAS ACTUALLY INTEREST ON 0OWERSS HOME LOAN -EMO s !PAYMENTFOR7AGESOFWASINCORRECTLYRECORDEDINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL AS-EMO s !RECEIPTOFFROMADEBTORn""ILLITENnHADBEENINCORRECTLYRECORDEDASA PAYMENTTOACREDITORn""OLTON-EMO Required a Show the General Journal entries necessary to correct each error. b Explain why the entries to correct the error regarding telephone charges do not affect the GST Clearing account. c Suggest one way the error regarding wages could have been detected. d State the effect on the accounting equation of Power Tools if the error regarding B. Billeten and B. Bolton had not been corrected.
EXERCISE 7.10 CORRECTING ENTRIES
W B
page 139
/N*UNE THEFOLLOWINGERRORSWEREFOUNDINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF"LUE,INES s OFEQUIPMENTWASINCORRECTLYDEBITEDTO#LEANING%XPENSES s 3TOCKTHATHADBEENUSEDFORADVERTISINGWORTH HADBEENINCORRECTLYRECORDED as Drawings. s !PAYMENTOFINTERESTWASINCORRECTLYDEBITEDTO,OANn("- s ! DEBT OF OWED BY " 1UICK THAT HAD BEEN WRITTEN OFF WAS RECORDED IN THE ledger account of B. Quack. s !PAYMENTOFWAGESOFWASINCORRECTLYRECORDEDINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL ASAPAYMENTTOACREDITORn.3MYTHEnFOR Required a Show the General Journal entries necessary to correct each error. (Narrations not required.) b ExplainTHEEFFECTONTHE.ET0ROlTOF"LUE,INESFOR*UNEIFTHEERRORREGARDING equipment had not been corrected. c Explain the effect on owner’s equity of the entries to correct the error regarding stock. d State the effect on the accounting equation of Blue Lines if the error regarding the interest had not been corrected. ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
159
160
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 7.11 DOCUMENTS AND THE GENERAL JOURNAL
W B
page 140
Jorge Nielson owns and operates a small trading business called Nordic Supplies, SELLINGARANGEOFSNOWBOARDS SKISANDCLOTHING/N&EBRUARY THEBALANCEOF THE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTWAS#2 The only documents relating to debtor I.C. Tusche, which have yet to be recorded in the books of Nordic Supplies, are shown below: DOCUMENT A TAX INVOICE Invoice: B905
Nordic Supplies
Mansfield Hwy Mansfield VIC 3724
ABN: 36 701 410 302 Charge to: Date Mar. 2
5/7, n/30
I.C. Tusche Treetops Chalet, Mt Buller
Details
Qty
Thriller Snow Board
Unit Price $
1
800
Total $ 800
GST
80
$
Total
880
Note:.ORDIC3UPPLIESPURCHASEDTHE4HRILLER3NOW"OARDFORPLUS'34 DOCUMENT B
MEMO 7
To:
The Accountant
From:
Jorge Nielson
Date:
29 March 2015
Subject:
I.C. Tusche
Today we received 25 cents in the dollar of the outstanding debt of I.C. Tusche (Rec. 77). However, the insolvency firm representing I.C. Tusche has advised us that the remainder of the debt is irrecoverable.
Nielsen is reluctant to write off the debt, believing that with time the debtor may be able to pay. Required a Referring to one accounting principle, explain why the bad debt must be recognised ON-ARCH b State the journals in which Document A and Document B would be recorded. c State the effect on the accounting equation of Nordic Supplies if Document A was not recorded. d Show how the account of I.C. Tusche would appear in the Debtors Ledger after all journals are posted. e Referring to the definitions, explain why a ‘bad debt’ is reported as an expense. ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 7
161
THE GENERAL JOURNAL
EXERCISE 7.12 POSTING FROM THE JOURNALS
W B
page 141
Jamie Tape operates a sports store called Omni Sports. His main customers are the Eston Football Club, and the Eagles Soccer Club, both of whom use the credit facilities *AMIEOFFERS ANDTHEYFREQUENTLYRECEIVEADISCOUNTFOREARLYPAYMENT/N3EPTEMBER THELEDGERACCOUNTSCONTAINEDTHEFOLLOWINGBALANCES Stock Control Debtors Control
$ 9 000 3 080
– Eston Football Club
1 100
– Eagles SC
1 980
GST Clearing
150
CR
4HEJOURNALSFOR3EPTEMBERSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING Cash Receipts Journal Date
Details
Sept. 1
Rec. no.
Bank
Disc. Exp.
Debtors Control
50
1 100
Cost of Sales
Sales
Sundries
GST
Eston Football Club
451
1 050
5
Cash Sales
452
1 320
600
1 200
120
8
Cash Sales
453
990
450
900
90
10
Eagles SC
454
1 880
100
1 980
17
Eston Football Club
455
1 800
70
1 870
20
Capital Contribution
456
1 500
22
Cash Sales
457
715
25
Eagles SC
458
5 060
29
Cash Sales
459
1 100
1 500 650
65
500
1 000
100
1 875
3 750
5 060
15 415
Totals
325
220
10 010
1 500
375
Sales Journal Date
Debtor
Invoice Cost of number Sales
Sales
GST
Debtors Control
Sept. 4
Eston Football Club
66
850
1 700
170
1 870
Sept. 8
Eagles SC
67
1 000
2 000
200
2 200
Sept. 13
Eagles SC
68
1 300
2 600
260
2 860
Sept. 21
Eston Football Club
69
700
1 400
140
1 540
Sept. 28
Eagles SC
70
550
1 100
110
1 210
4 400
8 800
880
9 680
Totals
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
162
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
General Journal General Ledger Date Sept. 30
Details Drawings
Debit
Credit
Subsidiary ledger Debit
Credit
70
Stock Control
70
Jamie took home stock (Memo 3) Sept. 30
Bad debts
1 210
Debtors Control Debtor – Eagles SC
1 210 1 210
Eagles SC declared bankrupt – debt written off (Memo 4)
Additional information: s !LL PURCHASES OF STOCK ARE MADE ON CREDIT #REDIT PURCHASES FOR 3EPTEMBER AMOUNTEDTOINCLUDING'34 s '34PAIDFOR3EPTEMBERWAS s *AMIEHASSTATEDTHATBADDEBTSAREREDUCINGHISREVENUE SOTHEYARELEAVINGHIM with less cash. Required
*
a Identify one part of Jamie’s statement that is correct. Justify your answer. b Identify one part of Jamie’s statement that is incorrect. Justify your answer. c Referring to one qualitative characteristic, explain why Jamie’s Drawings must be recorded in the accounting records of Omni Sports. d Post the journals to the following accounts in the General Ledger of Omni Sports: Stock Control, Debtors Control, GST Clearing, Sales, Bad Debts, Discount Expense. e BalanceTHE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNTASAT3EPTEMBER f Complete the account of Eagles SC in the Debtors Ledger of Omni Sports. g Explain the effect of the bad debt from Eagles SC on the Balance Sheet of Omni 3PORTSASAT3EPTEMBER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s defineANDidentifySTOCK ANDexplainITSIMPORTANCE TOATRADINGlRM s explainTHEROLEOFASTOCK CARD ANDITSRELATIONSHIPTO THE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNT s recordTRANSACTIONSINSTOCK CARDS s explainANDapplyTHE &IRST)N &IRST/UT&)&/ ASSUMPTIONTOSALESOFSTOCK s explainTHERELATIONSHIP BETWEENSTOCKCARDSAND THESPECIALJOURNALS s explainTHEROLEOFA PHYSICALSTOCKTAKE s stateTHEREASONSFORASTOCK LOSSORSTOCKGAIN
s recordASTOCKLOSSAND STOCKGAININTHESTOCK CARD 'ENERAL*OURNALAND 'ENERAL,EDGER s record THEUSEOFSTOCKFOR ADVERTISINGPURPOSESINTHE STOCKCARD 'ENERAL*OURNAL AND'ENERAL,EDGER s distinguishBETWEEN#OST OF3ALESAND#OSTOF'OODS 3OLD s prepareAN)NCOME 3TATEMENTSHOWING'ROSS 0ROlTAND!DJUSTED'ROSS 0ROlT s explainTHEBENElTSOF USINGAPERPETUALSYSTEMTO ACCOUNTFORSTOCK
CHAPTER 8
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s TRADINGlRM
s STOCKLOSS
s STOCK
s STOCKGAIN
s STOCKCARD
s #OSTOF'OODS3OLD #/'3
s COSTPRICE
s &IRST)N &IRST/UT&)&/ s PERPETUAL SYSTEM OF STOCK RECORDING s STOCKTAKE ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
164
8.1 trading firm a firm that purchases goods in order to resell them at a profit
stock goods purchased by a trading firm for the purpose of resale at a profit
UNITS 3&4
TRADING FIRMS AND STOCK
4HROUGHOUT THIS TEXT WE HAVE DISCUSSED THE PROCEDURES TO RECORD AND REPORT THE TRANSACTIONSOFA trading firmnAlRMTHATBUYSSTOCKWITHTHEINTENTIONOFRESELLINGITFOR APROlT7HATDOWEMEANBYSTOCK
Definition of stock #ONSIDER THE EXAMPLE OF A PLANT NURSERY !MONG THE ASSETS UNDER ITS CONTROL WOULD BE VARIOUS PLANTS POTS GARDEN SUPPLIES AND GARDENING TOOLS AS WELL AS OTHER ITEMS SUCHASSHELVING ABUSINESSVEHICLEANDOFlCEEQUIPMENT7HICHOFTHESESHOULDBE CONSIDEREDTOBEstock /BVIOUSLY ANYPLANTSANDPOTSTHATAREHELDFORRESALESHOULDBECONSIDEREDASSTOCK )NFACT ANYGOODSTHATAREPURCHASEDBYATRADINGlRMWITHTHEINTENTIONOFBEINGRESOLD ATALATERDATEFORPROlT SHOULDBECONSIDEREDSTOCK4HISMAYMEANTHATTHEGARDEN SUPPLIESANDGARDENINGTOOLSARESTOCKIFTHEYAREHELDFORRESALE BUTNOTCONSIDERED STOCKIFTHEYAREHELDFORUSEWITHINTHEBUSINESSTOTENDTHEPLANTSANDMAINTAINTHE APPEARANCE OF THE NURSERY 4HE SHELVING BUSINESS VEHICLE AND OFlCE EQUIPMENT ON THEOTHERHAND WOULDNOTBECONSIDEREDSTOCK4HISISNOTTOSAYTHATTHESEITEMSWILL NEVERBESOLD BUTTHEINTENTIONBEHINDTHEIRPURCHASEWASUSE NOTRESALE SOTHEYARE NOTSTOCK
Any goods that are purchased by a trading firm with the intention of being resold at a later date for profit, should be considered stock
4HIS POTENTIAL FOR RESALE n AT A PROlT n SOME TIME IN THE FUTURE MEANS THAT STOCK REPRESENTSAfuture economic benefit ANDBECAUSETHESTOCKISALSOUNDERTHEcontrol OFTHETRADINGlRM STOCKlTSPERFECTLYTHEDElNITIONOFANASSET'IVENTHATTHElRMS INTENTIONWOULDBETORESELLTHESTOCKwithin the next 12 months ITMEANSTHATSTOCKIS ACURRENTASSET
The importance of stock &ORATRADINGlRM STOCKISOFPARAMOUNTIMPORTANCE&IRST STOCKISITSMAINSOURCEOF REVENUE ANDTHUSTHEKEYTOITSABILITYTOEARNPROlT!TRADINGlRMTHATCANNOTSELLITS STOCKWILLNOTSURVIVE3ECOND STOCKISLIKELYTOBEONEOFTHEMOSTSIGNIlCANTASSETSTHE lRMCONTROLS$ESPITETHE PERHAPSIMMENSE VALUEOFPROPERTYANDPREMISES ITISSTILL POSSIBLEFORSTOCKTOBETHELARGESTSINGLEASSETLISTEDINTHElRMS"ALANCE3HEET ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 8
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
165
Despite the, perhaps immense, value of property and premises, it is still possible for stock to be the largest single asset listed in the firm’s Balance Sheet
5NFORTUNATELY STOCKISNOTONLYONEOFTHEMOSTIMPORTANTASSETSFORATRADINGlRM BUTALSOONEOFTHEMOSTVULNERABLE3TOCKISSUSCEPTIBLETODAMAGE SPOILAGE THEFTAND EVENCHANGESINTASTESANDFASHIONS EACHOFWHICHCANUNDERMINEITSVALUE 'IVENITSIMPORTANCEANDVULNERABILITY ITISVITALTHATTHEACCOUNTINGSYSTEMISABLETO PROVIDEACCURATEINFORMATIONABOUTSTOCK REVIEW QUESTIONS 8.1
1 2 3 4 5
Define THETERM@TRADINGlRM Define THETERM@STOCK Explain HOWSTOCKSHOULDBECLASSIlEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEET State TWOREASONSWHYSTOCKISIMPORTANTTOATRADINGlRM State THREEREASONSWHYSTOCKISCONSIDEREDTOBEAVULNERABLEASSET
8.2
THE STOCK CONTROL ACCOUNT
!LL MOVEMENTS OF STOCK ARE SUMMARISED IN THE 3TOCK #ONTROL ACCOUNT WITH STOCK @IN PRIMARILYTHROUGHPURCHASES RECORDEDONTHEDEBITSIDE ANDSTOCK@OUTMAINLYTHROUGH SALES RECORDEDONTHECREDITSIDE Stock Control (A) Stock IN
Stock OUT Stock Control (A)
Date Aug. 1 Aug. 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Balance
4 900
Aug. 31
Bank Creditors Control
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cost of Sales
3 500
1 500
Cost of Sales
2 200
3 700
Drawings
200
Advertising
100
Balance 10 100 Sept. 1
Balance
4 100 10 100
4 100
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
166
UNITS 3&4
4HE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNTSHOWSASUMMARYOFTOTALCASHANDCREDITPURCHASESONTHE DEBITSIDE WITHTOTALCASHANDCREDITSALESRECORDEDATCOSTPRICE ANDCROSS REFERENCED TO #OST OF 3ALES STOCK WITHDRAWALS BY THE OWNER AND STOCK USED FOR ADVERTISING PURPOSESRECORDEDONTHECREDITSIDE4HEBALANCEOFTHE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNT REPRESENTSTHETOTALVALUEOFallSTOCKONHAND The Stock Control account summarises all stock transactions.
REVIEW QUESTIONS 8.2
1 Explain THEROLEOFTHE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNT 2 Identify TWOTRANSACTIONSTHATWOULDAPPEARONTHEDEBITSIDEOFTHE3TOCK #ONTROLACCOUNT 3 Identify FOURTRANSACTIONSTHATWOULDAPPEARONTHECREDITSIDEOFTHE3TOCK #ONTROLACCOUNT
8.3
stock card a subsidiary accounting record that records each individual transaction involving the movement in and out of the business of a particular line of stock
STOCK CARDS
!LTHOUGH THE 3TOCK #ONTROL ACCOUNT IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER PROVIDES AN IMPORTANT SUMMARYOFALLMOVEMENTSOFSTOCKINANDOUTOFTHElRM THISACCOUNTALONEWILLNOT PROVIDESUFlCIENTINFORMATIONTOMANAGESTOCKEFFECTIVELY-OSTTRADINGlRMSWILLCARRY ANUMBEROFDIFFERENTLINESOFSTOCKDIFFERENTITEMS DIFFERENTCOLOURS DIFFERENTSIZES)TIS VITALTHATTHEOWNERHASDETAILEDINFORMATIONRELATINGTOEACHLINEOFSTOCK FROMBASICS SUCHASITSDESCRIPTION LOCATIONINTHEWAREHOUSEANDSUPPLIER TOlNANCIALINFORMATION SUCHASTHECOSTPRICEOFEACHUNIT THENUMBEROFUNITSPURCHASEDANDSOLD ANDTHE NUMBEROFUNITSONHANDATANYPOINTDURINGTHEPERIOD 4HISINFORMATIONMUSTALSOBERECORDED ANDTHISMUSTBEDONEINFARMOREDETAILTHAN THE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNTCANPROVIDE&ORTHISREASON A3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNTISUSED TOSUMMARISEALLTRANSACTIONSAFFECTINGSTOCK WITHINFORMATIONRELATINGTOINDIVIDUALLINES OFSTOCK INCLUDINGDETAILSOFSTOCKTRANSACTIONS RECORDEDINstock cards!TRADINGlRM WILLONLYEVERHAVEONE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER BUTCOULDHAVEA HUGENUMBEROFSTOCKCARDS WITHONESTOCKCARDFOREVERYDIFFERENTLINEOFSTOCK
Stock cards detail the individual transactions affecting each individual line of stock.
4HISRELATIONSHIPBETWEENTHE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNTANDTHESTOCKCARDSISSIMILAR TO THE RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN THE $EBTORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT AND THE $EBTORS ,EDGER OR THE #REDITORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT AND THE #REDITORS ,EDGER 4HE CONTROL ACCOUNT IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER PROVIDES A SUMMARY OF ALL TRANSACTIONS WITH SPECIlC DETAILED INFORMATIONRELATINGTOEACHINDIVIDUALTRANSACTIONRECORDEDINTHESUBSIDIARYRECORDS )NTHISWAY SUMMARYINFORMATIONISAVAILABLEFORREPORTS WITHSPECIlCDETAILSAVAILABLE FORMANAGINGDEBTORS CREDITORSANDSTOCK!TYPICALSTOCKCARDISSHOWNIN&IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 8
Figure 8.1
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
167
Stock card
Stock item:
Plant pot – terracotta, 60 cm
Location:
Row 16, Bay C3
Stock code:
PTC60
Supplier:
Potty 4 You
IN Date
Details
Qty
Cost
OUT Total
Qty
Cost
BALANCE Total
Qty
Cost
Total
Top portion: details of item 4HETOPPORTIONOFTHESTOCKCARDSHOWSTHEDETAILSRELATINGTOTHESTOCKITEMITSELF INCLUDING ADESCRIPTIONOFTHEITEMINTHISCASE A@0LANTPOTnTERRACOTTA CM )TSCODE04# IS ALSOIDENTIlEDFOREASYREFERENCEWITHINTHElRM4HELOCATION2OW "AY# CANALSOBE VERYIMPORTANT PARTICULARLYFORSTOCKSTOREDINALARGEWAREHOUSEWITHMANYDIFFERENTSTORAGE BAYS,ASTLY THENAMEOFTHESUPPLIER0OTTY9OU ISIDENTIlEDTOASSISTREORDERING )FTHElRMSELLSPLANTPOTSINDIFFERENTsizes EACHDIFFERENT SIZEDPOTWILLNEEDITSOWN STOCKCARD)NADDITION IFTHElRMSELLSPOTSINDIFFERENTcolours EACHOFTHESEWILLALSO REQUIREADIFFERENTSTOCKCARD WITHADIFFERENTONEFOREACHsizeOFEACHcolour
Bottom portion: transactions 4HEBOTTOMPORTIONOFTHESTOCKCARDISUSEDTORECORDTHETRANSACTIONS ANDISDIVIDED INTOFOURMAINSECTIONS$ATEAND$ETAILSANDTHE)NCOLUMN/UTCOLUMNAND"ALANCE COLUMN Date and Details 4HElRSTSECTIONISUSEDTORECORDSTANDARDINFORMATIONRELATINGTOTHEDATEANDDETAILSOF EACHSTOCKTRANSACTION@$ETAILS INTHISCASE REFERSTOTHESOURCEDOCUMENTTHATVERIlES EACHTRANSACTION In, Out and Balance columns 4HESECOLUMNSRECORDEXACTLYWHATTHEYSTATE s 4HE)NCOLUMNRECORDSALLSTOCKCOMINGINTOTHEBUSINESS MAINLYTHROUGHPURCHASES s 4HE /UT COLUMN RECORDS ALL STOCK LEAVING THE BUSINESS THROUGH SALES OR PERHAPS DRAWINGSORADVERTISING s 4HE "ALANCE COLUMN SHOWS THE STOCK ON HAND AND AVAILABLE FOR SALE VALUED AT cost price 7HEREASTHE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNTSHOWSTRANSACTIONSINDOLLARTERMSONLY THESTOCK CARDALSOSHOWSTHEQUANTITY ORNUMBER OFITEMSOFSTOCKANDTHEIRUNITCOSTTHATIS THE COSTPRICEOFEACHINDIVIDUALSTOCKITEM4HETOTALCOSTOFEACHTRANSACTIONISCALCULATED BYMULTIPLYINGTHEQUANTITYBYTHECOST
Total
=
Quantity
x
cost price the original purchase price of stock
Cost
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
168
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 8.3
1 Explain THE RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN THE 3TOCK #ONTROL ACCOUNT AND THE STOCK CARDS 2 Identify FOURDETAILSTHATWILLBEPROVIDEDINTHETOPPORTIONOFASTOCKCARDBUT NOTINTHE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNT 3 Identify THREEDETAILSTHATAREPROVIDEDWHENTRANSACTIONSARERECORDEDINTHE STOCKCARDBUTARENOTPROVIDEDINTHE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNT 4 State HOWMANYSTOCKCARDSATYPICALTRADINGlRMWOULDREQUIREBeware:4HIS ISATRICKQUESTION
8.4
RECORDING TRANSACTIONS IN STOCK CARDS
Where cost prices are constant STUDY TIP
Purchases Aug.
2EMEMBERTHAT'34 DOESNOTAFFECTTHE VALUATIONOFSTOCK NOR THEREVENUEEARNED FROMITSSALE
5
Purchased 6 terracotta pots (60 cm) on credit from Potty 4 You @ $60 (plus $6 GST) each (Inv. 364)
!PURCHASEMEANSTHATSTOCKISCOMINGINTOTHEBUSINESS SOTHISTRANSACTIONMUSTBE RECORDEDINTHE)NCOLUMNASQUANTITY COST TOTALX 4HEEFFECTISTO INCREASETHENUMBEROFITEMSONHANDINTHE"ALANCECOLUMNTOPOTSFOURONHAND plusTHESIXJUSTPURCHASED AT FORACOSTOF Sales Aug.
12
Cash sale of 3 terracotta pots (60 cm) for $100 (plus $10 GST) each (Rec. 23)
!SALEMEANSTHATSTOCKISLEAVINGORMOVINGOUTOFTHEBUSINESS SOTHISTRANSACTIONMUST BERECORDEDINTHE/UTCOLUMN(OWEVER WEHAVEADILEMMAREGARDINGTHEUNITPRICE TOBERECORDEDTHEPRICEOFTHEPOTSISGIVENONTHESOURCEDOCUMENT2EC AS$100 BUTNO$100POTSARELISTEDINTHESTOCKCARD(OWCANTHISBE 2EMEMBERTHATTHEPRICEONTHESOURCEDOCUMENT($100 each WILLBETHEselling price BUT THE STOCK CARD SHOWS THE COST PRICE WHICH IS EACH 4HE COST PRICE OF THESTOCKISNOTREVEALEDTOTHECUSTOMERASTHISPROTECTSTHE'ROSS0ROlTONTHESALE CUSTOMERSWHOAREAWAREOFTHEMARK UPHAVEATENDENCYTOHAGGLEHARDERFORPRICE REDUCTIONS4HECOSTPRICEISREVEALEDONLYWHENTHETRANSACTIONISRECORDEDINTHESTOCK CARD SOTHISSALEISRECORDEDASQUANTITY COSTnot$100 TOTALX 4HE EFFECTISTODECREASETHENUMBEROFITEMSONHANDINTHE"ALANCECOLUMNTOSEVENPOTS ONHANDLESSTHETHREEJUSTSOLD AT FORACOSTOF4HISISSHOWNIN&IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 8
Figure 8.2
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
Stock card: constant prices STOCK CARD
Stock item:
Plant pot – terracotta, 60 cm
Location:
Row 16, Bay C3
Stock code:
PTC60
Supplier:
Potty 4 You
IN Date
Details
Qty
Aug. 1
Balance
5
Inv. 364
12
Rec. 23
6
Cost
60
OUT Total
Qty
Cost
BALANCE Total
360 3
60
180
Qty
Cost
Total
4
60
240
10
60
600
7
60
420
Cost of Sales and Gross Profit 4HEAMOUNTRECORDEDINTHE/UT4OTALCOLUMNREPRESENTSTHE#OSTOF3ALESlGUREFOR THETRANSACTION&ORTHISSALE 3ALESREVENUEWOULDBE$300THREEPOTSAT$100 selling price AND#OSTOF3ALESWOULDBETHREEPOTSATCOSTPRICE LEAVINGA'ROSS 0ROlT OF THAT IS Sales revenue ($300) LESS #OST OF 3ALES 'ROSS 0ROlT
Where cost prices are changing &REQUENTLY THE COST PRICE CHARGED BY THE SUPPLIER WILL CHANGE DURING THE 2EPORTING 0ERIOD4HATIS THEITEMSONHANDMAYHAVETHESAMESELLINGPRICEANDBEIDENTICALIN THEEYESOFTHECUSTOMER BUTMAYHAVEDIFFERENTCOSTPRICES4HESEDIFFERINGCOSTPRICES MUSTBERECORDEDINTHESTOCKCARDS Purchases Aug.
17
Purchased 8 terracotta pots (60 cm) on credit from Potty 4 You @ $70 (plus $7 GST) each (Inv. 370)
!S THIS IS A PURCHASE AND WILL INCREASE THE STOCK ON HAND THIS TRANSACTION MUST BE RECORDEDINTHE)NCOLUMNASQUANTITY COST TOTALX 4HEREARENOW POTSONHANDANDTHE"ALANCECOLUMNMUSTREmECTTHIS BUTWECANNOTSIMPLYAGGREGATE THESTOCKASUNITSATONEPARTICULARUNITCOST3OMEOFTHEPOTSWEREPURCHASEDAT ANDOTHERSWEREPURCHASEDAT SOWHICHUNITCOSTSHOULDBEUSEDFORTHEBALANCE 4HESHORTANSWERISboth %VENTHOUGHTHEPOTSAREIDENTICALINTHEEYESOFTHECUSTOMERS THECOSTPRICESOF THESTOCKBATCHESDIFFERSEVENWEREPURCHASEDFOREACH WHILETHEEIGHTNEWPOTS WEREPURCHASEDFOREACH4HEREFORE THEYMUSTBELISTEDSEPARATELYINTHE"ALANCE COLUMNOFTHESTOCKCARD Sales Aug.
23
Credit sale of 10 terracotta pots (60 cm) for $110 (including $10 GST) each (Inv. 56)
4HISSALEMEANSTHATSTOCKISMOVINGOUTOFTHEBUSINESS SOTHISTRANSACTIONMUSTBE RECORDEDINTHE/UTCOLUMNAND ONCEAGAIN THECOSTPRICEMUSTBEUSED(OWEVER THE BALANCEBEFORETHISTRANSACTIONISSHOWNATTWODIFFERENTCOSTPRICESSEVENUNITSAT EACH ANDEIGHTUNITSATEACH7HICHSTOCKHASBEENSOLD
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
169
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
170
UNITS 3&4
Identified cost /NEOPTIONISTOPHYSICALLYMARKORLABELEACHPOTINSOMEWAYSUCHASASTICKERWITH ACOLOURCODE LETTERCODEORBARCODE ANDTHENKEEPARECORDOFTHECOSTPRICETHAT RELATESTOTHATCODE)NTHISWAY THEBUSINESSCOULDSIMPLYMATCHTHECODEONTHEITEM TOTHEPRICEINITSRECORDSTOIDENTIFYTHEEXACTCOSTPRICEOR OFEVERYPOT (OWEVER NOTALLBUSINESSESWILLIDENTIFYTHECOSTPRICEOFTHEIRSTOCKINTHISWAY FORA VARIETYOFREASONS &IRST THEREWILLBESOMETYPESOFSTOCKFORWHICHITISnot possibleTOLABELEVERYITEM TOIDENTIFYITSCOST)NTHISCATEGORYWOULDBEPETROLATASERVICESTATION WHICHMAYBE BOUGHTATDIFFERENTCOSTPRICES BUTMIXESINTHESAMETANKANDISTHEREFOREIMPOSSIBLE TOLABEL 3ECOND FOROTHERITEMSOFSTOCKITMAYBEPOSSIBLE BUTnot practicalAFRUITSHOP couldLABELEVERYGRAPE BUTTHISISUNLIKELYTOBETHEBESTUSEOFTHESTAFFSSKILLSAND TIME ESPECIALLYSINCEGRAPESARESOLDBYTHEBUNCH RATHERTHANINDIVIDUALLY 4HIRD EVENWHEREIDENTIFYINGTHECOSTISBOTHPOSSIBLEANDPRACTICAL THEOWNERMAY STILLDECIDEITISNOTWORTHTHETIME EFFORTAND PERHAPSMOSTIMPORTANTLY costTOLABEL EVERYITEMOFSTOCK ANDTHENRECORDEACHCODEANDCOSTPRICEINTHEACCOUNTINGRECORDS 4HISAPPEARSTOBETHECASEINTHEEXAMPLE WHERETHEREISNOCODE LABELORMARKERTO IDENTIFYTHECOSTPRICEOFEACHPOT First In, First Out (FIFO)
First In, First Out (FIFO) the assumption that the stock that is purchased first will be sold first
7HERE STOCK IS NOT LABELLED OR MARKED n BECAUSE IT IS IMPOSSIBLE OR IMPRACTICAL OR DEEMEDBYTHEOWNERTOBENOTWORTHTHETIME EFFORTANDCOSTnTHECOSTPRICECANNOT BEIDENTIlED4HEREFORE WHENTHESTOCKISSOLD ANassumptionMUSTBEMADEABOUTITS COSTPRICE5NDERTHEFirst In, First Out (FIFO)ASSUMPTION WEassumeTHATTHESTOCK THATWASPURCHASEDlRSTWILLBESOLDlRST EVENTHOUGHWEHAVENOWAYOFKNOWINGFOR CERTAIN )N THE EXAMPLE PROVIDED &)&/ MEANS THAT FROM THE STOCK STILL ON HAND WE WILL ASSUMETHATTHESEVENPOTSVALUEDATWHICHWEREPURCHASEDlRST WILLBESOLDlRST FOLLOWEDBYTHREEPOTSTOMAKEUPTHEPOTSSOLD ASSUMEDTOBEFROMTHEBATCH 4HISISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 8.3
Stock card: FIFO STOCK CARD
Stock item:
Plant pot – terracotta, 60 cm
Location:
Row 16, Bay C3
Stock code:
PTC60
Supplier:
Potty 4 You
IN Date STUDY TIP
/RDERDOESMATTERIN ASTOCKCARD!LWAYS LISTTHEUNITCOSTINTHE "ALANCECOLUMNINTHE ORDERINWHICHTHESTOCK ENTEREDTHEBUSINESS
Details
Aug. 1
Balance
5
Inv. 364
12
Rec. 23
17
Inv. 370
23
Inv. 56
Qty
6
Cost
60
OUT Total
Qty
70
Total
360 3
8
Cost
BALANCE
60
180
560 7
60
420
3
70
210
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Qty
Cost
Total
4
60
240
10
60
600
7
60
420
7
60
420
8
70
560
5
70
350
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 8
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
171
&)&/MUSTBEAPPLIEDTOALLTRANSACTIONSRECORDEDINTHE/UTCOLUMNINCLUDINGSALES DRAWINGS ADVERTISINGANDSTOCKLOSSES BUTITISANASSUMPTIONONLYITMAYNOTMATCH THEACTUALmOWOFGOODS ANDCUSTOMERSMAYBUYTHEPOTSTHATWEREPURCHASEDMORE RECENTLY RATHERTHANTHOSETHATWERElRSTIN7ITHOUTMARKINGSTOCK THEREISNOWAYOF KNOWINGTHECOSTPRICEOFTHESTOCKTHATHASBEENSOLD MAKING&)&/ANACCEPTABLEAND NECESSARYASSUMPTION
REVIEW QUESTIONS 8.4
1 Explain WHY'34DOESNOTAFFECTTHEVALUATIONOFASTOCKPURCHASE 2 State THEEFFECTONTHEBALANCEOFATRANSACTIONRECORDEDINTHE s )NCOLUMN s /UTCOLUMN 3 Explain WHYTHECOSTPRICEISNOTSHOWNONTHESOURCEDOCUMENTTHATPROVIDES THEEVIDENCEOFASALE 4 Explain HOWTHESTOCKCARDISUSEDTODETERMINETHE#OSTOF3ALESFOREACH TRANSACTION 5 StateTHREEREASONSWHYASMALLBUSINESSMIGHTCHOOSETOVALUEITSSTOCKUSING THE&)&/&IRST)N &IRST/UT ASSUMPTION 6 ExplainTHE&)&/ASSUMPTIONASITAPPLIESTOSTOCKCARDS 7 IdentifyTHREETRANSACTIONSTOWHICHTHE&)&/ASSUMPTIONMUSTBEAPPLIED
8.5
STOCK CARDS AND JOURNALS
%ARLIER WE NOTED THAT THE PRICE ON THE SOURCE DOCUMENT WILL BE THE SELLING PRICE BECAUSETHECOSTPRICEOFTHESTOCKISNOTREVEALEDTOTHECUSTOMER"UTWHENCASHSALES ARERECORDEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL ANDCREDITSALESARERECORDEDINTHE3ALES *OURNAL WE MUST IDENTIFY BOTH THE selling price AND THE cost price 4HIS MAKES THE STOCKCARDSAVITALSOURCEOFINFORMATIONWHENTRANSACTIONSARERECORDEDINTHEJOURNALS BECAUSEITISTHESTOCKCARDSTHATWILLDETERMINETHECOSTPRICEOFEACHSALE The selling price of each sale is detailed on the invoice/receipt. The cost price of each sale is determined in the stock card.
Woolly Good Jumpers has provided the following transactions for July 2015: July 2 5 9
EXAMPLE
Credit sale of 6 jumpers to Noogee: $300 (plus $30 GST) each (Inv. 49) Purchase of 12 jumpers @ $35 (plus $3.50 GST) each (Ch. 142) Cash sale of 10 jumpers for $600 (plus $60 GST) in total (Rec. 23)
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
172
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
4HETRANSACTIONSWOULDBERECORDEDINTHESTOCKCARDASSHOWNBELOW STOCK CARD Stock Item:
Woollen jumpers
Location:
Aisle 16
Stock Code:
WJ
Supplier:
Merino Mills
IN Date
Details
July 1
Qty
Cost
OUT Total
Qty
Cost
BALANCE Total
Qty
Balance
2
Inv. 49
5
Ch. 142
9
6 12
35
30
180
420
Rec. 23
2
30
60
8
35
280
Cost
Total
8
30
240
2
30
60
2
30
60
12
35
420
4
35
140
4HESELLINGPRICEOFTHECREDITSALETO.OOGEEON*ULYCANBESEENONTHE SOURCEDOCUMENTn)NVOICEnAS$300PLUS'34 AND FROMTHESTOCKCARD THE COST PRICE HAS BEEN CALCULATED AS 4HIS COST PRICE CAN THEN BE USED WHEN THE TRANSACTIONISRECORDEDINTHE3ALES*OURNAL ASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 8.4
Sales Journal showing Cost of Sales Sales Journal
Date
Debtor
July 2
Noogee
Invoice number
Cost of Sales
49
180
Sales
GST
300
30
Debtors Control 330
3IMILARLY THE RECEIPT FOR THE CASH SALE ON *ULY SHOWED THE SELLING PRICE AS $600PLUS'34 BUTITISTHESTOCKCARDTHATHASBEENUSEDTODETERMINETHECOST PRICEOF&)&/HASBEENAPPLIEDTOTHESALE ASSUMINGTHATALLTHEJUMPERSWITHA COSTPRICEOFARESOLDlRST FOLLOWEDBYTHEJUMPERSWITHACOSTPRICEOF4HE SELLINGPRICEANDCASHPRICEWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL ASISSHOWN IN&IGURE Figure 8.5
Cash Receipts Journal showing Cost of Sales Cash Receipts Journal
Date July 9
Details Cash Sales
Receipt Bank number 23
660
Discount Expense
Debtors Cost of Sales Control Sales 340
600
Sundries
GST 60
4HEAMOUNTSINTHE4OTALCOLUMNOFTHE/UTSECTIONOFTHESTOCKCARDREPRESENTTHE COSTPRICEOFTHESALE4HESEAMOUNTSREPRESENTTHEEXPENSEINCURREDWHENTHESTOCK ISSOLD ORTHE#OSTOF3ALES4HEYWILLBERECORDEDINTHE#OSTOF3ALESCOLUMNINTHE SPECIALJOURNALS ANDTHENPOSTEDTOTHE#OSTOF3ALESACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERTO SHOWTHEVALUEOFSTOCKCONSUMEDDURINGEACHMONTH
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 8
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
173
REVIEW QUESTIONS 8.5
1 Explain THEIMPORTANCEOFSTOCKCARDSWHENSALESARERECORDEDINTHESPECIAL JOURNALS 2 Explain THE IMPORTANCE OF STOCK CARDS WHEN PURCHASES ARE RECORDED IN THE SPECIALJOURNALS 3 Identify TWO MEANS OF VERIFYING THE AMOUNTS RECORDED IN THE #OST OF 3ALES ACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER
8.6
THE PHYSICAL STOCKTAKE
"ECAUSETHESTOCKCARDSAREUPDATEDAFTEREVERYTRANSACTION THEYPROVIDEACONTINUOUS ORPERPETUAL RECORDOFSTOCKONHAND4HATIS ATANYSTAGE THENUMBEROFUNITSSHOWNIN THE"ALANCECOLUMNSHOULDREmECTTHEQUANTITYOFSTOCKONHANDINTHESHOP SHOWROOM OR WAREHOUSE (OWEVER JUST BECAUSE THE STOCK CARD says THERE SHOULD BE A CERTAIN NUMBEROFITEMSONHANDDOESNOTMEANTHISWILLBETHECASE4HEREFORE THENUMBER OFUNITSONHANDSHOULDBECHECKEDPERIODICALLYBYCONDUCTINGAPHYSICALstocktake! STOCKTAKEINVOLVESAPHYSICALCOUNTOFTHENUMBEROFUNITSOFEACHLINEOFSTOCKONHAND 4HISCOUNTCANTHENBECOMPAREDAGAINSTTHEBALANCESINTHESTOCKCARDSTOCHECKTHEIR ACCURACY ANDDETECTANYSTOCKLOSSESORGAINS
stocktake a physical count of the number of units of each line of stock on hand
A stocktake involves a physical count of the number of units of each line of stock on hand
STUDY TIP
The role of the stocktake is to verify the accuracy of the stock cards and, in the process, detect any stock losses and Stock Gains. !LTHOUGHTHESTOCKTAKECANBEDONEATANYTIME ITISATIME CONSUMINGANDCOSTLY PROCESS!SACONSEQUENCE ASTOCKTAKEISLIKELYTOBEDONEONLYINFREQUENTLY!TTHEVERY LEAST THISWOULDBEATTHEENDOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIOD
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
)FTHESTOCKTAKEAND STOCKCARDSDIFFER ASSUMETHESTOCKTAKE ISCORRECT
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
174
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 8.6
1 Define THETERM@STOCKTAKE 2 Explain THEROLEOFASTOCKTAKE
8.7 stock loss an expense incurred when the stocktake shows a figure for stock on hand that is less than the balance shown in the stock card
STOCK LOSSES
7HENEVERTHENUMBEROFUNITSCOUNTEDATSTOCKTAKEISlessTHANTHEQUANTITYSHOWNIN THEBALANCEOFTHESTOCKCARD Astock lossHASOCCURRED4HISMAYBEFORAVARIETYOF REASONS INCLUDING s THEFT s DAMAGEBREAKAGES s UNDERSUPPLY FROM A SUPPLIER n A SUPPLIER HAS DELIVERED LESS STOCK THAN HAS BEEN CHARGEDFOR s OVERSUPPLYTOACUSTOMERnSTOCKHASBEENSUPPLIEDTOCUSTOMERSINEXCESSOFWHAT THEYHAVEBEENCHARGEDFOR
Whenever the number of units counted at stocktake is less than the quantity shown in the balance of the stock card, a stock loss has occurred. This may be for a variety of reasons, including damage/breakages.
Recording a stock loss !STOCKLOSSMEANSTHATTHEREISLESSSTOCKAVAILABLEFORSALETHANISCURRENTLYSHOWNINTHE STOCKCARDAND3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNT SOTHEQUANTITYMISSINGORLOST MUSTBERECORDED INTHE/UTCOLUMNOFTHESTOCKCARD ANDASACREDITINTHE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNT)N ADDITION THE3TOCK,OSSITSELFISANEXPENSEANOUTmOWOFANECONOMICBENElT3TOCK IN THE FORM OF A DECREASE IN ASSETS 3TOCK #ONTROL LEADING TO A DECREASE IN OWNERS EQUITY4HISMUSTALSOBESHOWNINTHELEDGER
EXAMPLE
On 31 August 2015, the stocktake showed 3 terracotta pots on hand (Memo 19). Comparing this figure against the balance on the stock card (5 pots on hand) revealed a stock loss of 2 pots.
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 8
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
175
4HISSTOCKLOSSWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE/UTCOLUMNOFTHESTOCKCARD ASSHOWNIN &IGURE Figure 8.6
Stock card: stock loss STOCK CARD
Stock item:
Plant pot – terracotta, 60 cm
Location:
Row 16, Bay C3
Stock code:
PTC60
Supplier:
Potty 4 You
IN Date
Details
Aug. 1
Balance
5
Inv. 364
12
Rec. 23
17
Inv. 370
23
31
Qty
6
Cost
60
OUT Total
Qty
70
Total
360 3
8
Cost
BALANCE
60
180
560
Inv. 56
Memo 19
Qty
Cost
Total
4
60
240
10
60
600
7
60
420
7
60
420
8
70
560
7
60
420
3
70
210
5
70
350
2
70
140
3
70
210
STUDY TIP
&)&/MUSTAPPLYTO STOCKLOSSJUSTAS ITAPPLIESTOSALES 3HOULDMORETHANONE COSTPRICEBELISTED INTHESTOCKCARD THE EARLIESTSTOCKSHOULDBE ASSUMEDTOBELOST
4HENEWBALANCEINTHESTOCKCARDnPOTSnISTHESAMEASTHESTOCKTAKE 4HEMEMONOTEDTHENUMBEROFUNITSONHAND ANDTHUSTHENUMBEROFUNITSMISSING BUTITISTHESTOCKCARDTHATPUTSAVALUEONTHOSEITEMSINTHISCASE ALLOWINGIT TOBERECORDEDINTHELEDGERACCOUNTS4HISISDONEBYCREATINGA3TOCK,OSSEXPENSE ACCOUNT ANDDECREASINGTHEBALANCEOFSTOCKONHANDBYCREDITINGTHE3TOCK#ONTROL ACCOUNT4HE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYTOADJUSTTHELEDGERACCOUNTSISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 8.7
General Journal: recording a stock loss General Journal General Ledger
Date Aug. 31
Details Stock Loss Stock Control
Debit
Credit
Subsidiary ledger Debit
Credit
140 140
Stocktake revealed stock loss of 2 pots – PTC60 (Memo 19)
4HENARRATIONHEREISQUITEDETAILED IDENTIFYINGTHESPECIlCSTOCKLINEINVOLVEDINTHIS CASE USINGTHEPRODUCTCODEn04# ANDTHEQUANTITYOFPOTSLOST )NTHECASEOF RECORDINGSTOCKLOSSESFORANUMBEROFDIFFERENTLINESOFSTOCK THISLEVELOFDETAILWOULD BEIMPOSSIBLETOINCLUDE#ONSEQUENTLY ITISTHESOURCEDOCUMENT-EMO THATIS MOSTIMPORTANTTOINCLUDEINTHENARRATION ASITWOULDCONTAINALLTHENECESSARYDETAILS RECORDEDINTHESTOCKCARDS 4HE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYFORTHESTOCKLOSSWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER ASSHOWNIN&IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
176
Figure 8.8
UNITS 3&4
General Ledger: stock loss General Ledger Stock Control (A)
Date
Cross-reference
Aug. 1 31
Amount $
Date
Balance
4 900
Aug. 31
Bank Creditors Control
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cost of Sales
3 500
1 500
Cost of Sales
2 200
3 700
Drawings
100
Stock Loss
140
Stock Loss (E) Date
Cross-reference
Aug. 31
Amount $
Stock Control
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
140
Effect on the accounting equation 4HEEFFECTOFASTOCKLOSSONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONIS Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
Decrease (Stock Control)
Liabilities
No effect
Owner’s Equity
Decrease (Stock Loss expense decreases Net Profit)
140
140
REVIEW QUESTIONS 8.7
1 2 3 4 5 stock gain a revenue earned when the stocktake shows a figure for stock on hand that is more than the balance shown in the stock card
STUDY TIP
3TOCKGAINISAGOOD REMINDERTHATREVENUE DOESNOTNEEDTOBE CASHINTHISCASE STOCK ISTHEASSETTHATHAS INCREASED WITHNO EFFECTONCASH
8.8
Explain WHYASTOCKLOSSISCLASSIlEDASANEXPENSE Identify THREEREASONSFORASTOCKLOSS ExplainHOWTHECOSTPRICEOFASTOCKLOSSISDETERMINED ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDASTOCKLOSS StateTHEEFFECTOFASTOCKLOSSONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION
STOCK GAINS
7HERETHENUMBEROFUNITSCOUNTEDBYTHESTOCKTAKEISmoreTHANTHEQUANTITYSHOWNIN THEBALANCEOFTHESTOCKCARD Astock gain HASOCCURRED4HISMAYBEDUETO s oversupply from a suppliernASUPPLIERHASSENTUSSTOCKFORWHICHWEHAVENOTBEEN CHARGED s undersupply to a customer nWEHAVECHARGEDACUSTOMERFORSTOCKTHATWEHAVENOT DELIVEREDANDTHECUSTOMERHASNOTREALISED
Recording a stock gain !STOCKGAINMEANSTHATTHEREISMORESTOCKAVAILABLEFORSALETHANISCURRENTLYSHOWNIN THESTOCKCARDAND3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNT SOTHEQUANTITYGAINEDMUSTBERECORDEDIN THE)NCOLUMNOFTHESTOCKCARD ANDASADEBITINTHE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNT)NADDITION THESTOCKGAINITSELFISAREVENUEITEMnANINmOWOFANECONOMICBENElTMORESTOCK IN THEFORMOFANINCREASEINASSETS3TOCK#ONTROL LEADINGTOANINCREASEINOWNERSEQUITY ANDTHISMUSTALSOBESHOWNINTHELEDGER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 8
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
177
EXAMPLE
On 31 October 2015, the stocktake revealed 35 pairs of gardening gloves on hand (Memo 31). The stock card for gloves showed a balance of 27 pairs, so a stock gain of eight pairs was detected.
4HISSTOCKGAINWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE)NCOLUMNOFTHESTOCKCARD ASSHOWNIN &IGURE Figure 8.9
Stock card: stock gain STOCK CARD
Stock item: Stock code:
Gardening Gloves G10
Location: Supplier: IN
Date
Details
Oct. 1
Balance
Oct. 15
Inv. 30A
Oct. 23 Oct. 31
Qty
30
Cost
12
OUT Total
8
12
Qty
Cost
BALANCE Total
360
Rec. 30 Memo 31
Row 21, Bay A5 Amsten Products
22
10
220
3
12
36
96
Qty
Cost
Total
22
10
220
22
10
220
30
12
360
27
12
324
35
12
420
)NORDERTOSATISFYTHEDEMANDSOFConservatism ANYSTOCKTHATMUSTBEPUTBACK INTOTHESTOCKCARDMUSTBEVALUEDATTHElowest cost price still on hand4HISENSURES THEASSET3TOCK#ONTROL ANDTHEREVENUESTOCKGAIN ARENOTOVERSTATED)NTHISCASE THELOWESTCOSTPRICESTILLONHANDIS SOTHESTOCKGAINOFEIGHTPAIRSISVALUEDAT INTOTAL4HISLEAVESTHEBALANCEOFSTOCKONHANDASPAIRSASWASDETECTEDINTHE STOCKTAKE EACHWORTH FORATOTALVALUEOF )NTHE'ENERAL*OURNAL THEBALANCEOF3TOCK#ONTROLISINCREASEDVIAADEBITENTRY TOTHATACCOUNT ANDASTOCKGAINREVENUEACCOUNTISCREATEDVIAACREDITENTRY4HISIS SHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 8.10
STUDY TIP
&ORASTOCKGAIN STOCK SHOULDBEVALUEDATTHE LOWESTCOSTPRICESTILL ONHAND
General Journal: stock gain General Journal General Ledger
Date Oct. 31
Details Stock Control stock gain
Debit
Credit
Subsidiary ledger Debit
Credit
96 96
Stocktake revealed stock gain of 8 pairs of gloves – G10 (Memo 31)
4HE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYFORTHESTOCKGAINWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER ASSHOWNIN&IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
178
Figure 8.11
UNITS 3&4
General Ledger: stock gain General Ledger Stock Control (A)
Date
Cross-reference
Oct. 1 31
Amount $
Date
Balance
4 300
Oct. 31
Bank
1 700
Creditors Control
3 900
stock gain
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cost of Sales
3 800
Cost of Sales
1 900
96 Stock Gain (R)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Stock Control
96
Effect on the accounting equation 4HEEFFECTOFASTOCKGAINONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONISTHUS Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
Increase (Stock Control)
Liabilities
No effect
Owner’s Equity
Increase (stock gain revenue increases Net Profit)
96
96
REVIEW QUESTIONS 8.8
1 2 3 4 5
8.9
ExplainWHYASTOCKGAINISCLASSIlEDASREVENUE IdentifyTWOREASONSFORASTOCKGAIN ExplainHOWTHECOSTPRICEOFASTOCKGAINISDETERMINED ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDASTOCKGAIN StateTHEEFFECTOFASTOCKGAINONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION
USE OF STOCK FOR ADVERTISING PURPOSES
/NElNALTRANSACTIONTHATMAYAFFECTBOTHTHESTOCKCARDSANDTHE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNT ISWHERESTOCKISUSEDFORADVERTISINGPURPOSES3OMETIMESSTOCKCANBETAKENOUTOFTHE STORETOBEUSEDFORDISPLAYPURPOSES ANDSMALLBUSINESSESFREQUENTLYDONATESTOCKTO LOCALCOMMUNITYORGANISATIONSSUCHASSCHOOLS CHURCHGROUPSORCHARITIES WHOUSETHE STOCKASPRIZESINRAFmESORFUNDRAISINGEVENTS)NEITHERCASE THEBUSINESSDONATINGTHE STOCKCANLEGITIMATELYCLAIMTHATTHESTOCKHASBEENUSEDFORTHEPURPOSEOFADVERTISING )FSTOCKISUSEDFORTHISPURPOSEITMUSTBERECORDEDINTHE/UTCOLUMNOFTHESTOCK CARD ANDASANEXPENSEANDAREDUCTIONIN3TOCK#ONTROLINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER
EXAMPLE
On 15 August 2015, 3 wheelbarrows were donated to the local fete (Memo 16).
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 8
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
4HISUSEOFSTOCKFORADVERTISINGPURPOSESWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE/UTCOLUMNOF THESTOCKCARD ASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 8.12
Stock card: advertising STOCK CARD
Stock Item: Stock Code:
Wheelbarrows FD100
Location: Supplier: IN
Date
Aug. 1 15
Details
Qty
Cost
Store room Nickwell
OUT Total
Qty
Cost
BALANCE Total
Qty
Cost
Total
2
80
160
10
95
950
9
95
855
Balance Memo 16
2
80
160
1
95
95
!SITISRECORDEDINTHE/UTCOLUMN THESTOCKUSEDFORADVERTISINGISVALUEDACCORDING TO&)&/JUSTLIKEASALE DRAWINGSORSTOCKLOSS SOTWOOFTHEWHEELBARROWSAREVALUED ATEACH BEFOREONEVALUEDAT )N THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL THE BALANCE OF 3TOCK #ONTROL DECREASES VIA A CREDIT ENTRY TOTHATACCOUNT AND!DVERTISINGEXPENSEINCREASESVIAADEBITENTRY4HISISSHOWNIN &IGURE Figure 8.13
General Journal: advertising General Journal General Ledger
Date Aug. 15
Details
Debit
Advertising
Credit
Subsidiary ledger Debit
Credit
255
Stock Control
255
3 wheelbarrows donated to local fete (Memo 16)
4HE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYFORADVERTISINGWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER AS SHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 8.14
General Ledger: advertising General Ledger Stock Control (A)
Date Aug. 1 31
Cross-reference Balance Bank Creditors Control
Amount $
Date
10 000
Aug. 31
3 200 19 800
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cost of Sales
8 500
Cost of Sales
4 900
Advertising
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
255
Cambridge University Press
179
180
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Advertising (E) Date
Cross-reference
Aug. 31
Amount $
Bank
480
Stock Control
255
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
!LTHOUGHTHETRANSACTIONWASRECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNALONTHEDAYTHESTOCK WASDONATED!UGUST THE'ENERAL*OURNALISNOTPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER UNTILTHEENDOFTHEMONTH!UGUST Effect on the accounting equation 4HEEFFECTOFSTOCKUSEDFORADVERTISINGPURPOSESONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONISTHUS Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
Decrease (Stock Control)
Liabilities
No effect
Owner’s Equity
Decrease (Advertising expense decreases Net Profit)
255
255
REVIEW QUESTIONS 8.9
1 2 3 4
StateTWOREASONSWHYASMALLBUSINESSMAYUSESTOCKFORADVERTISINGPURPOSES ExplainWHYSTOCKUSEDFORADVERTISINGPURPOSESISCLASSIlEDASANEXPENSE ExplainHOWTHECOSTOFSTOCKUSEDFORADVERTISINGPURPOSESISDETERMINED Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD STOCK USED FOR ADVERTISINGPURPOSES 5 State THE EFFECT OF STOCK USED FOR ADVERTISING PURPOSES ON THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION
8.10 STOCK AND INFORMATION FLOWS &IGURESANDSUMMARISETHEWAYINFORMATIONABOUTSTOCKTRANSACTIONSmOWS THROUGHTHEACCOUNTINGSYSTEM Figure 8.15
Purchases: In column
Credit purchase Purchase invoice
Purchases Journal
General Ledger
Stock card
Creditors Ledger
Cash Payments Journal
General Ledger
Cash purchase
Cheque butt
Stock card
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 8
Figure 8.16
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
181
Sales: Out column
Credit sale
Sales invoice
(Selling price)
Sales Journal
General Ledger
Stock card (cost price)
Debtors Ledger
Cash sale
Cash receipt
(Selling price)
Cash Receipts Journal
General Ledger
General Journal
General Ledger
Stock card (cost price)
Drawings, stock losses/gains and advertising
Memo
Stock card
8.11 REPORTING FOR STOCK /NCESTOCKTRANSACTIONSAREENTEREDINTHESTOCKCARDSANDRECORDEDINTHEJOURNALS THE JOURNALSMUSTBEPOSTEDTOTHELEDGERACCOUNTS!TTHISPOINT THELEDGERACCOUNTSWILL CONTAINALLTHEINFORMATIONTHATISNECESSARYTOPREPAREREPORTS
Balance Sheet 2ELEVANCESAYSTHATTHEREISLITTLEPOINTINIDENTIFYINGTHEQUANTITYOFEVERYLINEOFSTOCK IN THE "ALANCE 3HEET AS THIS LEVEL OF DETAIL WILL NOT AFFECT DECISION MAKING 4HE ONLY ITEMSPECIlCTOSTOCKTHATMUSTBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETIS3TOCK#ONTROL4HE BALANCEOFTHIS'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTMUSTBEREPORTEDASACURRENTASSETASTHESTOCK ISARESOURCECONTROLLEDBYTHEBUSINESSTHATISEXPECTEDTOPROVIDEAFUTUREECONOMIC BENElTINTHENEXTMONTHSWHENITISSOLD
Income Statement 4HE MAIN REASON ANY BUSINESS EXISTS IS TO GENERATE PROlTS FOR ITS OWNER 4HE )NCOME 3TATEMENTDETAILSTHATPROlTBYREPORTINGREVENUESANDEXPENSES3OHOWDOESSTOCK AFFECTTHEREPORT Sales revenue 1 3ALESOFSTOCKWILLBETHEMAINSOURCEOFREVENUEFORATRADINGlRM ANDTHIS WILLBERECORDEDINTHEJOURNALSANDSHOWNASTHEBALANCEOFTHE3ALESACCOUNTINTHE 'ENERAL,EDGER)TISIMPORTANTTONOTETHAT3ALESREVENUEMUSTBEREPORTEDSEPARATELY TO/THER2EVENUES SUCHASDISCOUNTREVENUE WHICHDONOTRELATESPECIlCALLYTOSTOCK
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
182
UNITS 3&4
Cost of Goods Sold
Cost of Goods Sold (COGS) all costs incurred in getting stock into a condition and location ready for sale
2 !SWASEXPLAINEDEARLIERINTHISCHAPTER THESTOCKCARDSARENECESSARYTOCALCULATE THECOSTPRICEOFEACHSALE ANDTHISINFORMATIONISTHENRECORDEDINTHEAPPROPRIATE SPECIALJOURNALBEFOREITISPOSTEDTOTHE#OSTOF3ALESACCOUNT4HISACCOUNTRECORDS THEEXPENSEINCURREDWHENSTOCKISSOLDOR INTHEPARLANCEOFTHEDElNITION CONSUMED 3PECIlCALLY ITISTHESUPPLIERSPRICEFORTHEGOODSTHATWERESOLD(OWEVER #OSTOF 3ALESMAYBEONLYONEOFANUMBEROFEXPENSESRELATEDTOSTOCK ASOTHERCOSTSMAY HAVEBEENINCURREDBEFORETHESTOCKWASREADYFORSALE4HETERMCost of Goods Sold (COGS)ISUSEDTODESCRIBEallCOSTSINCURREDINGETTINGGOODSINTOACONDITION ANDLOCATIONREADYFORSALE WITH#OSTOF3ALESSIMPLYONEOFTHEITEMSTHATMAYBE REPORTEDUNDERTHISHEADING%XPENSESSUCHAS#USTOMS$UTYAND&REIGHT)NAREALSO PARTOFTHETOTAL#/'3 WHICHMUSTBEDEDUCTEDFROM3ALESREVENUETODETERMINE 'ROSS0ROlT Gross Profit 3 )NMATHEMATICALTERMS 'ROSS0ROlTISTHEDIFFERENCEBETWEENTHE3ALESREVENUEAND #OSTOF'OODS3OLD"ECAUSE'ROSS0ROlTEXPRESSESTHERELATIONSHIPBETWEENTHE lRMSSELLINGANDCOSTPRICES ITISIMPORTANTTHATTHISlGUREISIDENTIlEDWITHITSOWN HEADING TOALLOWTHEOWNERTOASSESSTHEADEQUACYOFTHEIRMARK UP Adjusted Gross Profit 4 !NYSTOCKLOSSMUSTBEDEDUCTEDFROM'ROSS0ROlTTOSHOW!DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlT WHILEANYSTOCKGAINWOULDBEADDED)SOLATINGTHESTOCKLOSSORGAINBRINGSITTOTHE ATTENTIONOFTHEOWNERSOTHATSTRATEGIESMAYBEDEVELOPEDTOADDRESSANYPROBLEMS THATAREIDENTIlED ! STANDARD )NCOME 3TATEMENT FOR A TRADING lRM WOULD BE SIMILAR TO THE ONE SHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 8.17
Income Statement showing Gross Profit and Adjusted Gross Profit MARCONI ELECTRONIC PRODUCTS Income Statement (extract) for August 2015
Revenue
$
Sales
$ 30 000
Less Cost of Goods Sold2
STUDY TIP
Cost of Sales
17 000
Customs Duty
2 000
Freight In/Delivery from Suppliers
1 000
Gross Profit3 Less Stock Loss
$ISCOUNTREVENUEIS NOTREPORTEDHERE ASITISEARNEDNOTBY SELLINGSTOCKBUTBY PAYINGCREDITORSEARLY 4HESAMEAPPLIESTO DISCOUNTEXPENSE ITAFFECTSTHEAMOUNT PAID NOTTHEAMOUNT INCURREDFORSTOCK
Adjusted Gross Profit4
10 000 500 9 500
4HISISOBVIOUSLYNOTACOMPLETE)NCOME3TATEMENT ASITDOESNOTSHOWANYOTHER @GARDENVARIETYEXPENSES SUCHASWAGES RENTORADVERTISING ANDITDOESNOTSHOW.ET 0ROlT4HESEWILLBECOVEREDIN#HAPTERWHENTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTISADDRESSEDIN DETAIL (OWEVER THIS TOP SECTION OF THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT SOMETIMES REFERRED TO AS A 4RADING3TATEMENT DETAILSTHEEFFECTOFSTOCKTRANSACTIONSONPROlT ANDTHISINFORMATION ISVITALTORUNNINGASUCCESSFULTRADINGBUSINESS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 8
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
183
REVIEW QUESTIONS 8.11
1 2 3 4
DefineTHETERM@#OSTOF'OODS3OLD StateTWOREASONSWHY#OSTOF'OODS3OLDMAYBEGREATERTHAN#OSTOF3ALES ExplainWHYITISIMPORTANTTOIDENTIFY'ROSS0ROlTINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT Explain WHY IT IS IMPORTANT TO IDENTIFY !DJUSTED 'ROSS 0ROlT IN THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT
8.12 BENEFITS OF THE PERPETUAL SYSTEM 4HESTOCKRECORDINGSYSTEMNOWCONSISTSOFSTOCKCARDS A3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNTINTHE 'ENERAL,EDGER ANDAPHYSICALSTOCKTAKETHESEARETHEKEYELEMENTSOFWHATISKNOWNAS THEperpetual system of stock recording4HEPERPETUALORCONTINUOUS SYSTEMINVOLVES RECORDINGINDIVIDUALSTOCKTRANSACTIONSINSTOCKCARDSASTHEYOCCUR THENCONDUCTINGA PHYSICALSTOCKTAKEATTHEENDOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIODTOVERIFYTHEBALANCESOFTHOSE STOCKCARDS)NTHEPROCESS ANYSTOCKLOSSESORGAINSWILLBEDETECTED 4HEKEYBENElTSOFADOPTINGAPERPETUALSYSTEMFORRECORDINGSTOCKTRANSACTIONSARE ASFOLLOWS s Reordering of stock is assisted by maintaining a continuous record of the number of units of stock on hand.7ITHOUTACONTINUOUSRECORDOFSTOCKAVAILABLEFORSALE IT ISPOSSIBLETHATTHEONLYWAYTHEBUSINESSWILLKNOWTHATITNEEDSTOREORDERSTOCK IS WHEN THE CUSTOMERS OR STAFF NOTICE THAT THE SHELVES ARE EMPTY 4HIS COULD BE DISASTROUSINTERMSOFLOSTSALES s Stock losses and gains can be detected by comparing the balances of the stock cards against the physical stocktake.4HESTOCKCARDSSTATEWHATSHOULDBEINSTOCK THESTOCKTAKESTATESWHATACTUALLYISONHAND!NYDISCREPANCYMEANSASTOCKLOSSOR GAIN s Fast and slow moving lines of stock can be identified so that stock can be rotated or the stock mix adjusted."YEXAMININGTHEFREQUENCYOFSALESRECORDEDINTHE/UT COLUMN OF EACH STOCK CARD THE OWNER CAN IDENTIFY WHICH LINES ARE SELLING WELL OR NOTSOWELL 3TOCKLINESCANTHENBEMOVEDWITHINTHESHOP ORTHESTOCKMIXTHE KINDANDPROPORTIONSOFSTOCKONHAND CANBEADJUSTEDTOSTOCKMOREKINDSOFHIGH SELLINGSTOCKANDLESSOFTHESTOCKTHATISNOTSELLING
perpetual system of stock recording recording stock transactions in stock cards, then conducting a physical stocktake at the end of the Reporting Period to verify the balances of those stock cards
REVIEW QUESTIONS 8.12
1 Explain THEOPERATIONOFTHEPERPETUALSYSTEMOFSTOCKRECORDING 2 ExplainTHEBENElTSOFTHEPERPETUALSYSTEMOFSTOCKRECORDING
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
184
UNITS 3&4
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s 3TOCKISDElNEDASGOODSHELDBYATRADINGlRMFORTHEPURPOSEOFRESALE s 3TOCKISOFPARAMOUNTIMPORTANCETOATRADINGlRM ASITISITSMAINSOURCEOFREVENUE ANDONEOFITSMOSTSIGNIlCANTASSETS s 4HE 3TOCK #ONTROL ACCOUNT SUMMARISES ALL STOCK TRANSACTIONS STOCK CARDS DETAIL INDIVIDUALTRANSACTIONSAFFECTINGEACHLINEOFSTOCK s &IRST)N &IRST/UT&)&/ ASSUMESTHATSTOCKTHATISPURCHASEDlRSTWILLBESOLDlRST s 3TOCKCARDSAREUSEDTODETERMINETHECOSTPRICEOFSALESTHE#OSTOF3ALES ASTHE SOURCEDOCUMENTSWILLONLYSHOWTHESELLINGPRICE s !PHYSICALSTOCKTAKEISCONDUCTEDATTHEENDOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIODTOVERIFYTHE BALANCESINTHESTOCKCARDSAND INTHEPROCESS DETECTANYSTOCKLOSSESORGAINS s 4HE )NCOME 3TATEMENT REPORTS FOR STOCK BY IDENTIFYING BOTH 'ROSS 0ROlT AND ADJUSTED'ROSS0ROlT
EXERCISES
EXERCISE 8.1 STOCK CARDS: CONSTANT COST PRICES
W B
page 146
-ARKS -ATTRESSES COMMENCED /CTOBER WITH THE FOLLOWING STOCK FOR 3UPER 3OFT MATTRESSES No. of units
Cost
Total
60
$130
$7 800
$URINGTHATMONTHTHEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSTOOKPLACE Oct.
4
Purchased 25 mattresses at $130 (plus $13 GST) each (Chq. 567)
6
Sold 20 mattresses for $200 (plus $20 GST) each (Rec. 62)
12
Purchased 30 mattresses at $130 (plus GST) each (Chq. 577)
18
Sold 40 mattresses for $200 (plus GST) each (Rec. 64)
20
Purchased 20 mattresses at $143 (including $13 GST) each (Chq. 580)
31
Sold 30 mattresses for $220 (including GST) each (Rec. 68)
Required a RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR/CTOBERINTHESTOCKCARDFOR3UPER3OFTMATTRESSES b CalculateTHEVALUEOF3UPER3OFTMATTRESSESONHANDASAT/CTOBER c State WHY YOUR ANSWER TO PART @B IS UNLIKELY TO BE THE AMOUNT REPORTED IN THE "ALANCE3HEETFOR-ARKS-ATTRESSESASAT/CTOBER d CalculateTHE#OSTOF3ALESOF3UPER3OFTMATTRESSESFOR/CTOBER e ExplainTHEIMPACTOF'34ONTHERECORDINGOFTRANSACTIONSINTHESTOCKCARDS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 8
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
EXERCISE 8.2 FIRST IN, FIRST OUT
W B
page 147
$ARRENS$ESKSSUPPLIESOFlCESANDHOMESWITHSOLIDWOODDESKS$ARRENSMOSTPOPULAR BRANDISTHE%XECUTIVE/N-ARCH THEBUSINESSHADTHEFOLLOWINGSTOCK ONHAND
Executive 1000 Desk
Quantity
Cost
Total
4
$290
$1 160
15
300
4 500
10
320
3 200
$URING-ARCH $ARRENS$ESKSSOLDDESKSFORPLUS'34 EACH Required a CalculateTHE#OSTOF3ALESOF%XECUTIVEDESKSFOR-ARCHUSING&)&/ b 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@A explainTHEAPPLICATIONOFTHE&)&/METHODOF STOCKVALUATION c Calculate'ROSS0ROlTON%XECUTIVEDESKSFOR-ARCH d CalculateTHEVALUEOF%XECUTIVEDESKSONHANDASAT-ARCH
EXERCISE 8.3 STOCK CARDS: CHANGING COST PRICES
W B
page 148
#ASEYS #ABINETS COMMENCED -AY WITH THE FOLLOWING STOCK OF GLASS FRONTED CABINETS No. of units
Cost
Total
40
$240
$9 600
$URING-AYTHEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSTOOKPLACE May
2
Purchased 20 cabinets for $240 (plus $24 GST) each (Inv. 745)
4
Sold 35 cabinets at a selling price of $500 (plus $50 GST) each (Rec. 76)
7
Casey took from stock 2 cabinets to give to her niece (Memo 34)
19
Purchased 25 cabinets at $250 (plus GST) each (Inv. 758)
24
Purchased 30 cabinets at $286 (including GST) each (Inv. 786)
31
Sold 15 cabinets at a selling price of $550 (including GST) (Rec. 86)
Required a b c d e f
RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR-AYINTHESTOCKCARDFORGLASS FRONTEDCABINETS ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORD-EMO ShowHOW)NVOICEWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE3ALES*OURNAL CalculateTHEVALUEOFGLASS FRONTEDCABINETSONHANDASAT-AY CalculateTHE#OSTOF3ALESOFGLASS FRONTEDCABINETSFOR-AY ExplainHOWTHE&)&/METHODOFSTOCKVALUATIONCANOVERSTATETHEVALUEOFSTOCK ONHAND
EXERCISE 8.4 STOCK CARDS: CHANGING COST PRICES
W B
page 150
/N*ANUARY %CLIPSE4RADINGHADWORTHOFPICTUREFRAMESONHAND4HIS WASMADEUPOFFRAMESATANDFRAMESAT4HEFRAMESVALUEDAT EACHHADBEENPURCHASEDlRST
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
185
186
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
$URING*ANUARYTHEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSOCCURRED Jan.
3
Purchased 100 frames at $50 (plus GST of $5) each (Ch. 243)
8
Sold 900 frames at $100 (plus GST of $10) each (Inv. 44)
12
Sold 400 frames at $110 (including GST of $10) each (Rec. 68)
16
Took 10 frames from stock to be used in a display at the local shopping
20
Purchased 200 frames at $60 (plus GST) each (Inv. A10)
22
Sold 300 frames at $110 (including GST) each (Inv. 49)
31
Purchased 250 frames at $77 (including GST) each (Inv. 990)
centre (Memo 14)
Required a b c d e f
RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR*ANUARYINTHESTOCKCARDFORFRAMES ShowHOW2ECEIPTWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORD-EMO CalculateTHE#OSTOF3ALESFORFRAMESFOR*ANUARY Calculate'ROSS0ROlTONFRAMESFOR*ANUARY ExplainTHEIMPACTOF&)&/ON#OSTOF3ALESAND.ET0ROlTINTIMESOFRISINGPRICES
EXERCISE 8.5 FIFO AND STOCK LOSS
W B
page 152
&0%LECTRICALSPECIALISESINTHESALEOFDISHWASHERSFORSMALLRESTAURANTS)TSMOSTPOPULAR LINEOFSTOCKISTHE&0!STOCKCARDFORTHEDISHWASHERISMAINTAINEDUNDERTHE &)&/ASSUMPTION/N*ANUARY THElRMHADTHEFOLLOWINGSTOCKONHAND
FP 2000 dishwashers
Quantity
Cost price
Total
6
$600
$3 600
15
620
9 300
3
650
1 950
$URING*ANUARY NODISHWASHERSWEREPURCHASED BUTUNITSOFTHE&0 MODELWERESOLD!STOCKTAKEON*ANUARYSHOWEDASTOCKLOSSOFONEDISHWASHER -EMO Required a b c d e
ExplainTHEROLEOFSTOCKCARDSINANACCOUNTINGSYSTEM 2EFERRINGTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC explainTHEROLEOFAPHYSICALSTOCKTAKE !PARTFROMTHEFT suggestTWOPOSSIBLEREASONSFORTHESTOCKLOSSOFONEDISHWASHER ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORD-EMO Explain THE EFFECT OF THE STOCK LOSS ON THE "ALANCE 3HEET OF &0 %LECTRICAL AS AT *ANUARY
EXERCISE 8.6 STOCK CARDS AND STOCK LOSSES/GAINS
W B
page 153
/N-ARCH #LINNICK-USICHADONHANDTHEFOLLOWINGSTOCKOF-0PLAYERS Quantity
Cost
Total
14
$80
$1 120
7
90
630
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 8
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
$URING-ARCHTHEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSTOOKPLACE March
8
3 players were taken home by the owner (Memo 4)
12
Sold 12 players at $176 (including GST) each (Rec. 555–561)
19
Purchased 20 players at $80 (plus GST) each (Inv. 76)
22
Sold 8 players at $160 (plus GST) each (Rec. 564–566)
28
Purchased 15 players at $99 (including GST) each (Chq. 880)
30
Sold 14 players at $176 (including GST) each (Inv. 43)
Required a RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR-ARCHINTHESTOCKCARDFOR-0PLAYERS b !PHYSICALSTOCKTAKEON-ARCHREVEALEDTHAT-0PLAYERSWEREONHAND -EMO CalculateTHEVALUEOFSTOCKLOSSORGAINON-0PLAYERSFOR-ARCH c RecordTHESTOCKLOSSORGAININTHESTOCKCARDFOR-0PLAYERS d ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHESTOCKLOSSORGAINON-0 PLAYERS e Calculate'ROSS0ROlTAND!DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlTON-0PLAYERSFOR-ARCH f ExplainTHEEFFECTONOWNERSEQUITYASAT-ARCHIF-EMOHADnotBEEN RECORDED
EXERCISE 8.7 STOCK CARDS AND STOCK LOSSES/GAINS
W B
page 155
$URING/CTOBER "AYSIDE3OUNDHADTHEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSREGARDINGSTEREO SYSTEM Oct.
1
Balance on hand – 4 systems at $600 each
4
Purchased 7 systems at $650 (plus GST) each (Inv. D34)
10
Sold 5 systems for $990 (including GST) each (Rec. 87)
14
Sold 2 systems for $900 (plus GST) each (Inv. B101)
20
Purchased 5 systems at $770 (including GST) each (Inv. D45)
26
Donated 1 system to the local school fete (Memo 41)
Required a RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR/CTOBERINTHESTOCKCARDFORSTEREO b /N/CTOBER APHYSICALSTOCKTAKEREVEALEDNINEUNITSONHANDOFITEM -EMO SuggestTWOPOSSIBLEREASONSFORTHEDIFFERENCEBETWEENTHESTOCKTAKE ANDTHESTOCKCARD c RecordTHESTOCKLOSSORGAININTHESTOCKCARDFORSTEREO d ExplainHOWTHESTOCKLOSSORGAINWASVALUEDIdentifyONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLETO SUPPORTYOURANSWER e Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD THE STOCK LOSS OR GAIN ON STEREO f Calculate'ROSS0ROlTAND!DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlTFORSTEREOFOR/CTOBER g Explain HOW -EMO WOULD BE REPORTED IN THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT FOR "AYSIDE 3OUNDFOR/CTOBER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
187
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
188
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 8.8 REPORTING FOR STOCK
W B
page 157
7ARRENS7OKSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWING4RIAL"ALANCEASAT3EPTEMBER WARREN’S WOKS Trial Balance as at 30 September 2015 Account
Debit
Bank Cost of Sales
Credit
4 300 40 000
Creditors Control
9 200
GST Clearing
3 400
Debtors Control
13 100
Drawings
3 000
Prepaid Advertising
1 100
Customs Duty
2 200
Sales
80 000
Capital – Warren
59 400
Mortgage – BH Bank
90 000
Shelving
17 000
Premises
120 000
Advertising Stock Control
4 900 19 500
Interest Wages Totals
600 16 300 $242 000
$242 000
Additional information: s !PHYSICALSTOCKTAKEON3EPTEMBERSHOWEDSTOCKONHANDWORTH s 4HEPRINCIPALOFTHE-ORTGAGEn"("ANKISREPAYABLEATPERMONTH Required
*
*
a StateWHETHERINTERESTISAREVENUEOREXPENSEITEMFOR7ARRENS7OKSFOR3EPTEMBER JustifyYOURANSWER b PrepareAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR7ARRENS7OKSFOR3EPTEMBER c 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@B justifyYOURTREATMENTOF#USTOMS$UTY d ExplainTHEIMPORTANCEOFSHOWING'ROSS0ROlTINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTOFATRADING lRM e 2EFERRINGTOTHEDElNITIONS explainWHYSTOCKLOSSISCONSIDEREDTOBEANEXPENSE f PrepareA"ALANCE3HEETFOR7ARRENS7OKSASAT3EPTEMBER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 8
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
EXERCISE 8.9 REPORTING FOR STOCK
W B
page 159
0OTSN0ANSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWING4RIAL"ALANCEASAT*UNE POTS ’N’ PANS Trial Balance as at 30 June 2015 Account
Debit
Credit
Bank
1 500
Capital – Pamela Cartage In Cost of Sales
41 000 1 900 60 000
Creditors Control
6 300
Debtors Control
4 600
Delivery to Customers
2 500
Drawings
5 000
GST Clearing
500
Loan – QuickFin. Rent
20 000 14 000
Sales
90 000
Shop Fittings
40 000
Stock Control
19 300
Wages
12 000
Totals
$159 300
$159 300
Additional information: s !PHYSICALSTOCKTAKEON*UNESHOWEDA3TOCK'AINOF s 4HE,OANn1UICK&INISANINTERESTONLYLOANDUEFORREPAYMENTON*ULY Required
* *
a b c d e
PrepareAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR0OTSN0ANSFOR*UNE 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@A explainYOURTREATMENTOF$ELIVERYTO#USTOMERS 2EFERRINGTOTHEDElNITIONS explainWHYA3TOCK'AINISCONSIDEREDTOBEREVENUE PrepareA"ALANCE3HEETFOR0OTSN0ANSASAT*UNE StateONEREASONWHYTHE$RAWINGSlGUREMAYBECONSIDEREDTOBETOOHIGH
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
189
190
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 8.10 INTERPRETING STOCK CARDS
W B
page 161
-ICHAEL#ONLONOWNS4HE'OOD/IL WHICHIMPORTSOLIVEOILFROM3ICILYANDSELLSITTO RETAILSTORESTHROUGHOUT-ELBOURNE!LLSTOCKISSOLDATAMARK UP 4HESTOCKCARDFOR6IRGIN/LIVE/ILFOR.OVEMBERISSHOWNBELOW STOCK CARD Stock item: Virgin Olive Oil Stock code: VO01
Location: Supplier: IN
Date
Details
Nov. 1
Balance
Nov. 9
Inv. L63
Nov. 13
Inv. X70
Nov. 16
Nov. 22
Nov. 30
Qty
Cost
OUT Total
Qty
40 50
40
Aisle 17 Familia Oil Co.
Cost
BALANCE Total
30
1 200
2 000
Memo 63
4
Rec. 19
Memo 64
30
120
Qty
Cost
Total
50
30
1 500
10
30
300
10
30
300
50
40
2 000
6
30
180
50
40
2 000
6
30
180
24
40
960
26
40
1 040
3
40
120
23
40
920
Required a DescribeTHETRANSACTIONON.OVEMBER b IdentifyTHESPECIALJOURNALINWHICHTHETRANSACTIONON.OVEMBERWOULD BERECORDEDJustifyYOURANSWER c SuggestTWOPOSSIBLEREASONSFORTHETRANSACTIONON.OVEMBER d RecordTHETRANSACTIONON.OVEMBERINTHEAPPROPRIATEJOURNAL e 4HE STOCK MANAGER SENT -EMO AFTER THE STOCKTAKE WAS COMPLETED Show THE 'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHETRANSACTIONON.OVEMBER f Calculate#OSTOF3ALESFOR6IRGIN/LIVE/ILFOR.OVEMBER g 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@F stateTWOREASONSWHYTHISMAYnotBETHElGURE REPORTEDAS#OSTOF'OODS3OLDFOR.OVEMBER
EXERCISE 8.11 SOURCE DOCUMENTS AND STOCK CARDS
W B
page 163
(UGH'LOWOWNS'LARE AlRMTHATSELLSLIGHTlTTINGSANDBEDSIDELAMPSFROMASMALL SHOPINTHECITY/N&EBRUARY THElRMHADTHEFOLLOWINGSTOCKOFBEDSIDELAMPS ONHAND Quantity
Cost
Total
4
$40
$160
7
50
350
4HEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSOCCURREDDURING&EBRUARY
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 8
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
DOCUMENT A
Bright Lights
TAX INVOICE
Invoice:
!". A"UCKLEY3T #OLLINGWOOD6)#
ORIGINAL 4ERMS N
Charge to: Glare Block Arcade ABN: 65 980 706 511
Date Feb. 2
Details
Qty
Bedside lamps
20
Unit Price $
Total $
50
1 000
GST
100
$
Total
1 100
GL
DOCUMENT B
ARE
TAX INVOICE
Invoice: DUPLICATE
!". "LOCK!RCADE -ELBOURNE6)#
4ERMS N
Charge to: The Hilton Country Inn ABN: 66 009 963 451
Date Feb. 12
Details
Qty
Bedside lamps
10
Unit Price $ 66
660
$
Total
Total $
660
Includes GST of $60
GL
DOCUMENT C
ARE
Charge to:
Order form # G35 !". "LOCK!RCADE -ELBOURNE6)#
DUPLICATE
"RIGHT,IGHTS A"UCKLEY3TREET #OLLINGWOOD6)#
0LEASESUPPLYTHEFOLLOWING Date
Details
&EB
"EDSIDELAMPS
0LEASEDELIVERWITHINWORKINGDAYS
Quantity
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
191
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
192
UNITS 3&4
GL
DOCUMENT D
MEMO 73
ARE
28/2/15
Stocktake determined that there were 18 bedside lamps in stock Required a 2EFERRINGTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC explainTHEROLEOFSOURCEDOCUMENTSIN THEACCOUNTINGPROCESS b RecordTHERELEVANTTRANSACTIONSINTHESTOCKCARDFORBEDSIDELAMPS c ExplainYOURTREATMENTOF$OCUMENT# d RecordTHERELEVANTTRANSACTIONSINTHEAPPROPRIATESPECIALJOURNALSOF'LARE e ExplainTHEEFFECTOF$OCUMENT!ONTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF'LAREASAT&EBRUARY f StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF'LAREIF$OCUMENT$ISnotRECORDED
EXERCISE 8.12 STOCK AND THE GENERAL LEDGER
W B
page 165
-ATTHEW &AREWELL OWNS -ATTS -ATS A STORE THAT SPECIALISES IN SELLING WELCOME MATS TO CARPET AND GENERAL STORES 4HE BUSINESS USES THE PERPETUAL INVENTORY SYSTEM AND ALLSTOCKMOVEMENTSARERECORDEDUSINGTHE&)&/METHODOFCOSTASSIGNMENT0HYSICAL STOCKTAKESARECARRIEDOUTATTHEENDOFEACHMONTHTOUPDATETHERECORDS 4HESPECIALJOURNALSFOR!PRILSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWINGTOTALS Cash Receipts Journal Date
Details
Rec. no.
Bank
Discount Expense
Debtors Control
Cost of Sales
Sales
Sundries
Capital Contribution
GST
1 400
Totals
36 600
900
13 000
11 500
21 000
1 400
2 100
Cash Payments Journal Date
Details
Chq. no.
Bank
Discount Revenue
Creditors Control
Stock Control
Wages
Sundries
Electricity
GST
500
Totals
30 750
300
14 300
12 000
3 000
500
1 250
Sales Journal Date
Debtor Totals
Invoice number
Cost of Sales 15 000
Sales
GST
Debtors Control
30 000
3 000
33 000
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 8
ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK
PURCHASES JOURNAL Date
Invoice number
Creditor
Stock Control
Totals
GST
20 000
2 000
Creditors Control 22 000
4HE STOCK CARD FOR PLAIN WELCOME MATS SHOWED THE FOLLOWING TRANSACTIONS FOR !PRIL STOCK CARD Stock item:
Plain welcome mat
Location:
Shelf 7
Stock code:
PWM
Supplier:
Coir Industries
Date
Details
IN Qty
April 1
April 9
April 17
April 25
April 30
Cost
OUT Total
Qty
Cost
BALANCE Total
Balance
Memo 71
3
Inv. 72
Inv. B72
Memo 72
60
3
45
40
2 700
120
30
90
7
30
210
8
40
320
Qty
Cost
Total
10
30
300
50
40
2 000
7
30
210
50
40
2 000
42
40
1 680
42
40
1 680
60
45
2 700
45
40
1 800
60
45
2 700
Additional information: s -EMORELATEDTOSTOCKWITHDRAWNBYTHEOWNER-EMORELATEDTOTHEPHYSICAL STOCKTAKE4HESEWERETHEONLYMEMOSWRITTENIN!PRIL s !SAT!PRIL THE$EBTORS#ONTROLACCOUNTSHOWEDABALANCEOFANDTHE 3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNTABALANCEOF Required
* *
a IdentifyTHENUMBEROFPLAINWELCOMEMATSDETECTEDBYTHEPHYSICALSTOCKTAKEON !PRIL b ExplainHOWAPHYSICALSTOCKTAKEMAYIMPROVETHEReliabilityOFTHEREPORTSOF-ATTS -ATS c ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORD-EMOAND-EMO d 5SINGALLTHEINFORMATIONPROVIDED completeTHE3TOCK#ONTROLAND$EBTORS#ONTROL ACCOUNTSINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF-ATTS-ATS e PrepareAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR-ATTS-ATSFOR!PRIL f ExplainHOWTHEUSEOF&)&/WILLAFFECTTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONINTIMESOFRISING PRICES
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
193
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s
defineREVENUE EXPENSES ANDPROlT
s
calculatePROlT
s
explainTHEROLEOF ACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLESAND QUALITATIVECHARACTERISTICSIN THEDETERMINATIONOFPROlT
s
explainTHEREASONSFOR @CLOSINGTHELEDGER
s
recordCLOSINGENTRIESIN THE'ENERAL*OURNALAND 'ENERAL,EDGER
s
prepareTHE0ROlTAND,OSS 3UMMARYACCOUNT
s
recordTHETRANSFEROF DRAWINGSTOTHE#APITAL ACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL *OURNALAND'ENERAL,EDGER
s
prepareAN)NCOME 3TATEMENTFORATRADINGlRM
s
explainANDinterpretTHE INFORMATIONPRESENTEDINAN )NCOME3TATEMENT
CHAPTER 9
DETERMINING PROFIT OR LOSS KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s
CLOSINGTHELEDGER
s
)NCOME3TATEMENT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
196
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
9.1
UNITS 3&4
DETERMINING PROFIT OR LOSS
4HEMOSTBASICFUNCTIONOFANYSMALLBUSINESSISTOEARNAPROlTFORTHEOWNER SOFROM TIMETOTIMETHEACCOUNTANTMUSTCALCULATEWHETHERAprofitORlossHASBEENGENERATED 4HECALCULATIONOFPROlTISSIMPLEENOUGHPROlTISWHATISLEFTOVERAFTEREXPENSESARE DEDUCTEDFROMREVENUES
Profit
=
Revenues
– Expenses
)N THIS EQUATION REVENUES ARE DElNED AS INmOWS OF ECONOMIC BENElTS OR SAVINGS IN OUTmOWS IN THE FORM OF INCREASES IN ASSETS OR REDUCTIONS IN LIABILITIES THAT LEAD TO AN INCREASE IN OWNERS EQUITY %XPENSES ARE DElNED AS OUTmOWS OR CONSUMPTIONS OF ECONOMIC BENElTS OR REDUCTIONS IN INmOWS IN THE FORM OF DECREASES IN ASSETS OR INCREASESINLIABILITIES THATLEADTOADECREASEINOWNERSEQUITY
Accounting principles and qualitative characteristics 4HEQUESTIONOFwhen TOCALCULATEPROlTDEPENDSONTHENEEDSOFTHEOWNERS2EMEMBER THAT THE 'OING #ONCERN PRINCIPLE ASSUMES THAT THE LIFE OF A BUSINESS IS CONTINUOUS OR NEVER ENDING SO TO FOLLOW THIS PRINCIPLE ALONE MEANS THAT PROlT COULD NEVER BE DETERMINED!SARESULT OWNERSWOULDNOTHAVEINFORMATIONABOUTTHETRADINGACTIVITIES OFTHEIRlRMUNTILITWASTOOLATETODOANYTHINGABOUTIT4HISISWHYTHE2EPORTING0ERIOD PRINCIPLE IS SO IMPORTANT IT ALLOWS US TO DIVIDE THE LIFE OF THE BUSINESS INTO ARBITRARY PERIODSINORDERTODETERMINEPROlT .OTETHATTHELENGTHOFTHESE2EPORTING0ERIODSISARBITRARY ORSUBJECTIVEITISUP TOTHEOWNERSTODECIDEHOWOFTENTHEYWANTPROlTTOBEDETERMINED3OMEOWNERS WILLWANTPROlTCALCULATEDEVERYMONTH WHILEOTHERSWILLBESATISlEDWITHSEASONALOR QUARTERLY PROlT REPORTS )N SOME INDUSTRIES SUCH AS FAST FOOD HOURLY BREAKDOWNS OF SALESANDEXPENSESMAYBEUSEFUL4HELENGTHOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIODCANBEASSHORT ORASLONGASTHEOWNERDESIRESALTHOUGHTAXATIONREQUIREMENTSMEANTHATITMUSTBE NOLONGERTHANONEYEAR /NCE THE LENGTH OF THE 2EPORTING 0ERIOD IS DETERMINED IT IS IMPORTANT THAT THE CALCULATION OF PROlT INCLUDES ONLY REVENUES AND EXPENSES AND ONLY THOSE REVENUES AND EXPENSES THAT HAVE OCCURRED during THE CURRENT 2EPORTING 0ERIOD 4HIS ENSURES THAT THE REPORTS CONTAIN THE QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTIC OF Relevance BY INCLUDING ONLY INFORMATIONTHATISUSEFULFORDECISION MAKING)FWEINCLUDEDITEMSOTHERTHANREVENUES ANDEXPENSESSUCHASDRAWINGSORLOANREPAYMENTS ORINCLUDEDREVENUESOREXPENSES THATOCCURREDoutsideTHECURRENTPERIODSUCHASLASTYEARSWAGES THEREPORTSWOULD CONTAIN INFORMATION THAT WOULD not BE USEFUL FOR DECISION MAKING 4HE INFORMATION WOULDTHUSDISTORTDECISION MAKING ANDPROBABLYLEADTONEGATIVECONSEQUENCESFOR THEBUSINESSANDITSOWNER REVIEW QUESTIONS 9.1
1
2 3
DefineTHEFOLLOWINGTERMS s REVENUES s EXPENSES s PROFIT Explain HOWTHE2EPORTING0ERIODPRINCIPLEASSISTSINTHECALCULATIONOFPROlT ExplainHOWTHE2EPORTING0ERIODPRINCIPLELEADSTORelevanceINACCOUNTING REPORTS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 9
9.2
DETERMINING PROFIT OR LOSS
197
CLOSING THE LEDGER
/NCETHELENGTHOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIODISESTABLISHED PROlTCANBECALCULATEDSIMPLY BY COMPARING THE REVENUES AND EXPENSES THAT OCCURRED IN THAT PERIOD !ND AS EACH REVENUE AND EXPENSE ITEM HAS ITS OWN LEDGER ACCOUNT THIS INFORMATION IS ALREADY AVAILABLEINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER4HUSTHEPROlTCANBECALCULATEDBYTRANSFERRINGTHE BALANCESFROMALLTHESEREVENUEANDEXPENSEACCOUNTSTOASPECIALACCOUNTCALLEDTHE 0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT4HISISKNOWNASclosing the ledger THE 0ROlT AND ,OSS 3UMMARY ACCOUNT IS LIKE A FUNNEL THAT CHANNELS ALL REVENUE ANDEXPENSESINTOONEACCOUNT WITHASOLElGUREnTHEPROlTORLOSSFORTHECURRENT PERIODnPRODUCEDATTHEEND)NTHEPROCESS THEREVENUEANDEXPENSEACCOUNTSWILL BE@EMPTIED ORRESETTOZEROINREADINESSFORTHENEXTPERIOD4HUS THETWOKEYREASONS FORCLOSINGTHELEDGERARETO s TRANSFERREVENUESANDEXPENSESTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTINORDER TOCALCULATEPROlTFORTHEcurrent2EPORTING0ERIOD s RESETREVENUEANDEXPENSEACCOUNTSTOZEROINPREPARATIONFORTHEnext2EPORTING 0ERIOD )TISONLYREVENUEANDEXPENSEACCOUNTSTHATARECLOSED BECAUSEONLYREVENUESAND EXPENSESAREUSEDTODETERMINEPROlT)NADDITION REVENUESANDEXPENSESEXISTONLY DURINGAPARTICULAR2EPORTING0ERIOD WHEREASASSETSANDLIABILITIESANDOWNERSEQUITY FORTHATMATTER WILLEXISTINTOTHEFUTURE4HATIS "ALANCE3HEETITEMSINVOLVEAfuture BENElTORfutureSACRIlCEANDSOSHOULDNOTBERESETTOZERO BUTTHEIRBALANCESSHOULD CARRYFORWARDINTOTHENEXTnOR@FUTUREn2EPORTING0ERIOD
closing the ledger transferring balances from revenue and expense ledger accounts to the Profit and Loss Summary account so that profit can be calculated
REVIEW QUESTIONS 9.2
1 ExplainTHEPROCESSOFCLOSINGTHELEDGER 2 ExplainTWOREASONSFORCLOSINGTHELEDGER 3 ExplainWHYASSETANDLIABILITYACCOUNTSAREnotCLOSED
9.3
CLOSING ENTRIES AND THE PROFIT AND LOSS SUMMARY ACCOUNT
Closing revenue accounts !S ACCOUNTS THAT INCREASE OWNERS EQUITY REVENUE ACCOUNTS USUALLY HAVE A CREDIT BALANCE)NORDERTOTRANSFERBALANCESFROMTHESEACCOUNTS THEREVENUEACCOUNTSMUST BEdebitedTOREDUCETHEACCOUNTTOZERO WITHACORRESPONDINGCREDITTOTHE0ROlTAND ,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT4HISENTRYISlRSTRECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNAL THENPOSTED TOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
198
EXAMPLE
UNITS 3&4
Pulse Music supplied the following Trial Balance as at 30 September 2015: PULSE MUSIC SHOP Trial Balance as at 30 September 2015 Account
Debit
Bank
Credit
2 300
Stock Control
40 000
Shop Fittings
11 000
Debtors Control
13 000
Creditors Control
6 000
Loan – Markos Bank
30 000
Capital – B. Pressure
25 000
Sales Revenue
34 000
Stock Gain
200
Discount Revenue
500
Cost of Sales
21 000
Wages
5 400
Advertising
1 300
Discount Expense
700
Rent Expense
1 000
Totals
$95 700
$95 700
4HE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYTOCLOSETHEREVENUEACCOUNTSASAT3EPTEMBERIS SHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 9.1
General Journal: closing revenue accounts
STUDY TIP
General Journal 0,3UMMARYISAN ACCEPTEDABBREVIATION
General Ledger Date Sept. 30
Details
Debit
Sales Revenue
34 000
Stock Gain
200
Discount Revenue
500
Profit and Loss Summary
Credit
Subsidiary Ledger Debit
Credit
34 700
Closing revenue accounts to P&L Summary account
!TlRSTITMAYSEEMODDTODEBITAREVENUEACCOUNT BUTREMEMBERTHATWEARETRYING TOreduceTHEREVENUEACCOUNTSBECAUSETHEYHAVEACREDITBALANCE ADEBITENTRYIS NECESSARYTOREDUCETHEMTOZERO
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 9
DETERMINING PROFIT OR LOSS
199
!LSO NOTEHOWALLTHEREVENUEACCOUNTSARECLOSEDINONE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRY WITH EACHINDIVIDUALREVENUEACCOUNTDEBITED ANDONECREDITFORTHETOTALREVENUElGURE POSTED TO THE 0ROlT AND ,OSS 3UMMARY ACCOUNT 4HIS ENTRY WOULD BE POSTED TO THE 'ENERAL,EDGERASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 9.2
General Ledger: closing revenue accounts General Ledger Sales (R)
Date
Cross-reference
Sept. 30 Profit and Loss Summary
Amount $
Date
34 000
Sept. 30
Cross-reference
Amount $
Bank
19 000
Debtors Control
15 000
34 000
34 000
Stock Gain (R) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $ Date
Sept. 30 Profit and Loss Summary
200
Sept. 30
Cross-reference Stock Control
200
Amount $ 200 200
Discount Revenue (R) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $ Date
Sept. 30 Profit and Loss Summary
500
Sept. 30
Cross-reference
Amount $
Creditors Control
500
500
500 STUDY TIP
Profit and Loss Summary (OE) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Sept. 30
Cross-reference Revenues
Amount $ 34 700
!LLREVENUESHAVENOWBEENTRANSFERREDINTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTSO THATPROlTCANBECALCULATEDFOR3EPTEMBER)NADDITION EACHREVENUEACCOUNTHAS NOWBEENRESETTOZEROITHASAZEROBALANCE INREADINESSFORTHENEXT2EPORTING0ERIOD )NOTHERWORDS ONLYTHEREVENUEEARNEDIN/CTOBERTHENEXTMONTH WILLBESHOWN INTHEREVENUEACCOUNTSATTHEENDOFTHENEXT2EPORTING0ERIODTHATIS /CTOBER
0,3UMMARYIS ATEMPORARY/% ACCOUNTITISNOT REPORTEDANYWHERE
Cross-references in the Profit and Loss Summary account )N#HAPTER WESAWTHATTHE"ANKACCOUNTISONEOFONLYTWOLEDGERACCOUNTSWHERE THECROSS REFERENCEMAYBESOMETHINGOTHERTHANTHENAMEOFALEDGERACCOUNT4HE SECONDIS0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARY)NTHECASEOFTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT ABOVE THECREDITENTRYOFISLINKEDTOTHE3ALES2EVENUE $ISCOUNT2EVENUE AND3TOCK'AINACCOUNTS2ATHERTHANLISTEACHANDEVERYONEOFTHESEACCOUNTNAMES THECROSS REFERENCEISSIMPLY2EVENUESTOINDICATETHATTHEREAREANUMBEROFREVENUE ACCOUNTSLINKEDTOTHISTOTALREVENUElGURE
Closing expense accounts 4HESAMEPRINCIPLEAPPLIESWHENCLOSINGEXPENSEACCOUNTSALLEXPENSEACCOUNTSARE CLOSEDUSINGONE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRY WITHTHETOTALEXPENSESlGUREPOSTEDTOTHE 0ROlT AND ,OSS 3UMMARY ACCOUNT 5SING THE SAME INFORMATION SUPPLIED IN THE 4RIAL "ALANCEOF0ULSE-USICASAT3EPTEMBER THE'ENERAL*OURNALWOULDAPPEARAS ISSHOWNIN&IGURE ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
200
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
Figure 9.3
UNITS 3&4
General Journal: closing expense accounts General Journal General Ledger
Date Sept. 30
Details
Debit
Profit and Loss Summary
29 400
Cost of Sales
Credit
Subsidiary ledger Debit
Credit
21 000
Wages
5 400
Advertising
1 300
Discount Expense
700
Rent Expense
1 000
Closing expense accounts to P&L Summary account
4HISENTRYWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 9.4
General Ledger: closing expense accounts General Ledger Cost of Sales (E)
Date Sept. 30
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Stock Control
12 000
Sept. 30
Stock Control
9 000
Cross-reference Profit and Loss Summary
21 000
Amount $ 21 000
21 000
Wages (E) Date Sept. 30
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
5 400
Sept. 30
Cross-reference Profit and Loss Summary
5 400
Amount $ 5 400 5 400
Advertising (E) Date Sept. 30
Cross-reference
Amount $
Bank
800
Stock Control
500
Date Sept. 30
Cross-reference Profit and Loss Summary
1 300
Amount $ 1 300
1 300
Discount Expense (E) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Sept. 30
Debtors Control
700
Sept. 30
Cross-reference Profit and Loss Summary
700
Amount $ 700 700
Rent Expense (E) Date Sept. 30
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
1 000
Sept. 30
1 000
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cross-reference Profit and Loss Summary
Amount $ 1 000 1 000
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 9
DETERMINING PROFIT OR LOSS
201
Profit and Loss Summary (OE) Date
Cross-reference
Sept. 30
Amount $
Date
29 400
Sept. 30
Expenses
Cross-reference
Amount $
Revenues
34 700
!LLEXPENSESHAVENOWBEENTRANSFERREDINTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT SOTHATPROlTCANBECALCULATEDFORTHEcurrent2EPORTING0ERIOD3EPTEMBER %ACH EXPENSEACCOUNTHASNOWBEENRESETTOZEROITHASAZEROBALANCE INREADINESSFORTHE next2EPORTING0ERIODTHATIS /CTOBER
Cross-references in the Profit and Loss Summary account !SWITHREVENUES BECAUSETHEREISNOSINGLE accountLINKEDTOTHETOTALEXPENSESlGURE IN THIS CASE THE CROSS REFERENCE IN THE 0ROlT AND ,OSS 3UMMARY ACCOUNT MUSTBE%XPENSESINPREFERENCETOLISTING#OSTOF3ALES 7AGES !DVERTISING $ISCOUNT %XPENSE AND2ENTSEPARATELY
Closing the Profit and Loss Summary account 7ITH ALL REVENUES AND EXPENSES NOW TRANSFERRED TO THE 0ROlT AND ,OSS 3UMMARY ACCOUNT THE ONLY STEP REMAINING IS TO CALCULATE PROlT BY DEDUCTING EXPENSES FROM REVENUES 4HIS PROlT n OR LOSS n MUST BE TRANSFERRED TO THE OWNERS #APITAL ACCOUNT LEAVINGTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTWITHAZEROBALANCE READYFORTHENEXT 2EPORTING0ERIOD&IGURESHOWSTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESTOCLOSETHE0ROlTAND ,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT Figure 9.5
General Journal: closing the Profit and Loss Summary account General Journal General Ledger
Date Sept. 30
Details
Debit
Profit and Loss Summary
5 300
Credit
Capital – B. Pressure
Subsidiary ledger Debit
Credit
5 300
Transfer of Net Profit from P&L Summary account to Capital account
4HISWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 9.6
General Ledger: closing the Profit and Loss Summary account General Ledger Profit and Loss Summary (OE)
Date Sept. 30
Cross-reference Expenses Capital
Amount $
Date
29 400
Sept. 30
Cross-reference Revenues
STUDY TIP
Amount $ 34 700
5 300 34 700
34 700
Capital – B. Pressure (OE) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Sept. 1 30
Cross-reference Balance Profit and Loss Summary
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Amount $ 25 000
!LTHOUGHTHE ISPROlT RESISTTHE TEMPTATIONTOLABELIT AS@0ROlTINTHE0ROlT AND,OSS3UMMARY ACCOUNT4HEREISNO LEDGERACCOUNTCALLED @0ROlTTHENAMEOFTHE OTHERLEDGERACCOUNTIS @#APITAL
5 300
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
202
STUDY TIP
4HEREWILLONLYEVER BETHREEENTRIESIN THE0ROlTAND,OSS 3UMMARYACCOUNT 2EVENUES %XPENSES ANDTHETRANSFERTOTHE #APITALACCOUNTFORTHE PROlTORLOSS
UNITS 3&4
)NTHISCASE REVENUES AREGREATERTHANEXPENSES MEANINGTHAT APROlTOFHASBEENEARNED4HISPROlTREPRESENTSANINCREASEINOWNERSEQUITY ANDSOLEADSTOACREDITTOTHE#APITALACCOUNT)NTHECASEOFALOSS THE#APITALACCOUNT WOULD BE DEBITED TO SHOW THE DECREASE IN OWNERS EQUITY WITH THE 0ROlT AND ,OSS 3UMMARYACCOUNTCLOSEDWITHACREDITENTRY 4HE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTOPENSWHENTHEREVENUESANDEXPENSESARE TRANSFERREDin ANDCLOSESWHENTHEPROlTORLOSSISTRANSFERREDout ONTHESAMEDAY 4HEACCOUNTITSELFLASTSFORONLYASLONGASITTAKESTOPOSTTHESETHREEENTRIESJUSTAS APIECEOFSCRAPPAPERISUSEDTOMAKEACALCULATIONANDTHENTHROWNAWAYWHENTHE ANSWERISKNOWN)TISNEVERLISTEDINANACCOUNTINGREPORT ASITSFUNCTIONISSIMPLYTO FACILITATETHECALCULATIONOFPROlT
REVIEW QUESTIONS 9.3
1 2 3 4
Identify THETHREEENTRIESTHATWILLBERECORDEDINTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARY ACCOUNT 2EFERRINGTOREVENUESANDEXPENSES explainWHYTHECROSS REFERENCESINTHE 0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTARENOTLEDGERACCOUNTNAMES ExplainHOWTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTWOULDBECLASSIlEDINTHE "ALANCE3HEET"EWARE Show THE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTOCLOSE s REVENUEACCOUNTSTOTHE0ROFITAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT s EXPENSEACCOUNTSTOTHE0ROFITAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT s THE0ROFITAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTTOTHE#APITALACCOUNT
9.4
TRANSFERRING DRAWINGS
)TISCUSTOMARYTORECORDDRAWINGSBYTHEOWNERINASEPARATELEDGERACCOUNTSOTHAT THE OWNERS TRANSACTIONS FOR A PARTICULAR 2EPORTING 0ERIOD CAN BE ISOLATED (OWEVER AT THE END OF THE 2EPORTING 0ERIOD THE BALANCE OF THE $RAWINGS ACCOUNT MUST BE TRANSFERREDTOTHE#APITALACCOUNTSOTHATTHE#APITALACCOUNTCANREmECTTHENETEFFECT OFALLTRANSACTIONSWITHTHEOWNER4HE$RAWINGSACCOUNTISTRANSFERREDTOTHE#APITAL ACCOUNTINMUCHTHESAMEWAYASTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTISCLOSED ASIS SHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 9.7
General Journal: transferring Drawings to Capital General Journal General Ledger
Date Sept. 30
Details Capital – B. Pressure Drawings
Debit
Credit
Subsidiary Ledger Debit
Credit
3 000 3 000
Transfer of Drawings account to Capital account
&IGURE SHOWS HOW THE LEDGER ACCOUNTS WOULD APPEAR AFTER TRANSFERRING THE $RAWINGSTO#APITAL
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 9
Figure 9.8
DETERMINING PROFIT OR LOSS
203
General Ledger: transferring Drawings to Capital General Ledger Drawings (– OE)
Date Sept. 30
Cross-reference
Amount $
Bank
2 500
Stock Control
Date Sept. 30
Cross-reference Capital
Amount $ 3 000
500 3 000
3 000
Capital – B. Pressure (OE) Date
Cross-reference
Sept. 30
Drawings
Amount $ Date 3 000
Cross-reference
Sept. 1 30
Balance Profit and Loss Summary
Amount $ 25 000 5 300
!LTHOUGHTHE$RAWINGSACCOUNTISTRANSFERREDTOTHE#APITALACCOUNT ITISnotCLOSED THROUGHTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT4RANSACTIONSWITHTHEOWNERAREEXPRESSLY EXCLUDED FROM THE DElNITIONS OF REVENUES AND EXPENSES AND MUST not BE COUNTED INTHECALCULATIONOFPROlT4OINCLUDEDRAWINGSINTHECALCULATIONOFPROlTWOULDBEA DIRECTBREACHOFRelevance
REVIEW QUESTIONS 9.4
1 StateONEREASONWHYTRANSACTIONSWITHTHEOWNERARERECORDEDSEPARATELYIN THE$RAWINGSACCOUNTRATHERTHANDIRECTLYINTHE#APITALACCOUNT 2 StateONEREASONWHYTHE$RAWINGSACCOUNTISCLOSEDTOTHE#APITALACCOUNT 3 2EFERRINGTOTHEDElNITIONOFANEXPENSE explainWHYTHE$RAWINGSACCOUNT ISnotCLOSEDTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT 4 2EFERRING TO ONE QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTIC explain WHY $RAWINGS ARE not INCLUDEDINTHECALCULATIONOFPROlT 5 ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTOCLOSETHE$RAWINGSACCOUNTTO THE#APITALACCOUNT
9.5
THE INCOME STATEMENT
(AVINGCLOSEDTHELEDGER THEPROlTlGUREWILLBEKNOWNINTHERECORDS BUTITMUSTSTILL BEREPORTEDTOTHEOWNERINANAPPROPRIATEFORMAT+NOWINGTHE.ET0ROlTlGUREISALL WELLANDGOOD BUTPERHAPSTHEMOSTOBVIOUSQUESTIONFORTHEOWNERTOASKABOUTPROlT IS @(OWWASTHEPROlTGENERATED4HISQUESTIONISANSWEREDBYTHEPREPARATIONOFAN Income Statement WHICHDETAILSTHEREVENUESEARNEDANDEXPENSESINCURREDDURING THEPERIODAND INTHEPROCESS SHOWSBOTH'ROSS0ROlTAND.ET0ROlT /BVIOUSLYTHE.ET0ROlTREPORTEDINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTSHOULDBETHESAMEASTHE lGUREDETERMINEDINTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT BUTTHESTATEMENTWILLSHOW THE REASONS WHY THAT PROlT OR LOSS OCCURRED GIVING THE OWNER FAR MORE INFORMATION ONWHICHTOBASEHISORHERDECISIONS4HISlTSWITHTHEBASICFUNCTIONOFALLACCOUNTING REPORTSTOCOMMUNICATElNANCIALINFORMATIONTHATWILLASSISTTHEOWNERINMAKINGBETTER DECISIONS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Income Statement an accounting report that details the revenues earned and expenses incurred during the current Reporting Period
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
204
EXAMPLE
UNITS 3&4
Bookworms is a book shop and has presented its Trial Balance as at 30 November 2015: BOOKWORMS Trial Balance as at 30 November 2015 Account
Debit
Advertising
Credit
1 200
Bank
3 000
Capital – Isaac Read
8 780
Cash Sales
9 000
Cost of Sales
14 500
Credit Sales
20 000
Creditors Control
11 000
Customs Duty
270
Debtors Control
1 000
Discount Expense
100
Discount Revenue
600
Freight In
520
Freight Out
140
Loan – International Bank
25 000
Rent Expense
3 000
Shop Fittings and Fixtures
12 000
Stock Control
38 000
Stock Loss
350
Wages
6 300
Totals
$77 380
$77 380
!FTER ALL CLOSING ENTRIES HAVE BEEN MADE FOR .OVEMBER THE 0ROlT AND ,OSS 3UMMARYACCOUNTFOR"OOKWORMSWOULDSHOW Profit and Loss Summary (OE) Date Nov. 30
Cross-reference Expenses Capital
Amount $
Date
26 380
Nov. 30
Cross-reference Revenues
Amount $ 29 600
3 220 29 600
29 600
4HE)NCOME3TATEMENTMUSTSHOWTHESAME.ET0ROlTOF BUTINDOINGSOWILL DETAILALLTHEREVENUESEARNEDANDEXPENSESINCURREDINEARNINGTHATPROlT&IGURE SHOWSTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR"OOKWORMSFOR.OVEMBER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 9
Figure 9.9
DETERMINING PROFIT OR LOSS
Income Statement
205
STUDY TIP
BOOKWORMS
0RESENTATIONMATTERS INACCOUNTINGREPORTS ITEMSMUSTBEREPORTED UNDERTHECORRECT HEADINGSFORTHE STATEMENTTOBECORRECT
Income Statement for November 2015 Revenue1
$
Cash Sales
9 000
Credit Sales
20 000
$
29 000
Less Cost of Goods Sold2 Cost of Sales
14 500
Customs Duty
270
Freight In
520
Gross Profit3
15 290 13 710
Less Stock Loss
350
Adjusted Gross Profit4
13 360
Add Other Revenues5 Discount Revenue
600 13 960
Less Other Expenses6 Wages
6 300
Advertising
1 200
Discount Expense
100
Freight Out
140
Rent Expense Net Profit7
3 000
10 740 3 220
)NCOMMONWITHALLACCOUNTINGREPORTS THIS)NCOME3TATEMENTBEGINSBYIDENTIFYING who whatANDwhenTHEwhoREFERRINGTO"OOKWORMSTHEENTITYFORWHOMTHEREPORT WASPREPARED THEwhatREFERRINGTOTHEREPORTASAN)NCOME3TATEMENT ANDTHEwhen REFERRINGTO.OVEMBERTHE2EPORTING0ERIODCOVEREDBYTHEREPORT .OTETHATTHEwhenREFERSNOTTOas at BUTRATHERfor ASTHEINFORMATIONITREPORTS ISNOTCONlNEDTOASINGLEDAY BUTCOVERSAPERIODOFTIMEINTHISCASE THEMONTHOF .OVEMBER 4HEINFORMATIONINTHEREPORTISPRESENTEDUNDERTHEFOLLOWINGHEADINGS Revenue 4HISSECTIONLISTSONLYTHOSEREVENUESEARNEDASAdirect result of selling stock NAMELY 3ALESREVENUE)NTHISBUSINESS THEOWNERHASREQUESTEDSEPARATElGURESFORCASH AND CREDITSALES SOTHEYARERECORDEDINSEPARATELEDGERACCOUNTS ANDREPORTED SEPARATELYINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT)NOTHERBUSINESSES BOTHCASHANDCREDITSALES COULD BE COMBINED IN ONE LEDGER ACCOUNT PERHAPS SIMPLY KNOWN AS 3ALES AND REPORTEDASONElGURE Cost of Goods Sold !SEXPLAINEDIN#HAPTER #OSTOF'OODS3OLDISAHEADINGREFERRINGTOallCOSTS INCURREDINGETTINGGOODSINTOACONDITIONANDLOCATIONREADYFORSALE WITH#OSTOF 3ALESSIMPLYONEOFTHEITEMSTHATMAYBEREPORTEDUNDERTHISHEADING)NTHISCASE #USTOMS$UTYAND&REIGHT)NAREALSOINCLUDEDASPARTOF#OSTOF'OODS3OLD ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
206
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Gross Profit !S THE DIFFERENCE BETWEEN 3ALES 2EVENUE AND #OST OF 'OODS 3OLD 'ROSS 0ROlT REmECTSTHERELATIONSHIPBETWEENTHElRMSSELLINGANDCOSTPRICES)DENTIFYINGTHIS lGUREWITHITSOWNHEADING ALLOWSTHEOWNERTOASSESSTHEADEQUACYOFTHElRMS MARK UP Adjusted Gross Profit 3TOCKLOSSESMUSTBEDEDUCTEDFROM'ROSS0ROlT WHILESTOCKGAINSMUSTBEADDED INORDERTODETERMINE!DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlT Other Revenues !NYREVENUESOTHERTHAN3ALESREVENUEAREREPORTEDAFTERTHE!DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlT INORDERTOPROTECT'ROSS0ROlTASAMEASUREOFTHEMARK UP)NTHISEXAMPLE ONLY $ISCOUNT2EVENUEISIDENTIlEDAS/THER2EVENUE BUTINTERESTREVENUEORCOMMISSION REVENUEWOULDALSOBEREPORTEDHERE 4HElGUREDERIVEDBYADDING/THER2EVENUETO!DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlTn$13 960 IN&IGUREnHASNOTITLE BUTITMUSTBESHOWNNONETHELESS,EAVINGOUTTHISTOTAL MAYRESULTINFAILINGTOACCOUNTFOR@/THER2EVENUESWHEN.ET0ROlTISCALCULATED Other Expenses /THER%XPENSESREFERSTOALLEXPENSESOTHERTHAN#OSTOF'OODS3OLD INCLUDINGDAY TO DAYEXPENSES SUCHAS7AGES 2ENT !DVERTISINGAND"AD$EBTS.OTETHATTHISIS WHEREFREIGHToutTHECOSTOFDELIVERYtoCUSTOMERS ISREPORTED ASTHISISINCURRED AFTERTHESALE WHEREAS&REIGHTInTHECOSTOFDELIVERYfromTHESUPPLIER ISINCURRED INTHEPROCESSOFGETTINGGOODSREADYFORSALE ANDSOISPARTOF#OSTOF'OODS3OLD Net Profit 4HIS IS THE BOTTOM LINE SO FREQUENTLY TALKED ABOUT IN BUSINESS CIRCLES THE OVERALL PROlTORLOSSEARNEDBYTHEBUSINESSINTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD)TISCALCULATED BY DEDUCTING /THER %XPENSES FROM THE PREVIOUS TOTAL IN THIS CASE LESS ORBYDEDUCTINGTOTALEXPENSESFROMTOTALREVENUES)FTHECLOSINGENTRIES HAVE BEEN RECORDED CORRECTLY AND THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT PREPARED CORRECTLY THIS .ET0ROlTlGURESHOULDBEIDENTICALTOTHElGURECALCULATEDINTHE0ROlTAND,OSS 3UMMARYACCOUNT
REVIEW QUESTIONS 9.5
1 ExplainWHYITISNECESSARYTOPREPAREAN)NCOME3TATEMENTEVENWHENTHE PROlTlGUREISKNOWN 2 ExplainTHERELATIONSHIPBETWEENTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTAND THE)NCOME3TATEMENT 3 ExplainWHYTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTISTITLEDforTHEPERIODRATHERTHANas atA PARTICULARDATE 4 ExplainTHEDIFFERENCEBETWEEN#OSTOF3ALESAND#OSTOF'OODS3OLD 5 IdentifyTWOREVENUESTHATWOULDBECLASSIlEDAS@/THER2EVENUE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 9
9.6
DETERMINING PROFIT OR LOSS
USES OF THE INCOME STATEMENT
!S WAS STATED EARLIER AN )NCOME 3TATEMENT MUST BE PREPARED EVEN WHEN THE PROlT IS ALREADY KNOWN IN ORDER TO PROVIDE MORE INFORMATION FOR THE BUSINESS OWNER !FTER ALL CLOSINGTHELEDGERWILLTELLUSTHE.ET0ROlTlGURE ANDEVENTHETOTALREVENUEAND EXPENSElGURES BUTNOTTHEINDIVIDUALAMOUNTSFROMWHICHTHESElGURESWEREDERIVED "YDETAILINGTHEINDIVIDUALREVENUEANDEXPENSEITEMS ANDIDENTIFYING'ROSSAND.ET 0ROlT THEREPORTISMOREUSEFULASADECISION MAKINGTOOL 4HESPECIlCPURPOSESOFPREPARINGAN)NCOME3TATEMENTARE s To aid decision-making about the firm’s trading operations.3PECIlCALLY THE)NCOME 3TATEMENTALLOWSTHEOWNERTOASSESS n THEFIRMSABILITYTOEARNREVENUESODECISIONSCANBEMADEABOUTTHETYPESOF STOCKTHATAREHELDFORSALE THELEVELANDORTYPEOFADVERTISING ORTHELEVELOF SELLINGPRICES n THEADEQUACYOFTHEFIRMSMARK UPSODECISIONSCANBEMADEABOUTADJUSTING SELLINGPRICESORCONTROLLINGCOSTPRICES n THEFIRMSABILITYTOCONTROLITSEXPENSESSODECISIONSCANBEMADEABOUTMANAGING STAFF WAGES PROTECTING STOCK FROM STOCK LOSS OR OPERATING MORE EFFICIENTLY TO CONTROLOPERATINGCOSTS s To assess the firm’s performance in meeting its sales and expense targets. 4HE )NCOME3TATEMENTCANBECOMPAREDAGAINSTBUDGETED OREXPECTED PERFORMANCE ASSHOWNINTHE"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENT WHICHWOULDHAVEBEENPREPAREDIN ADVANCE 4HIS COMPARISON WILL HIGHLIGHT WHERE PERFORMANCE WAS BETTER OR WORSE THANEXPECTED#ORRECTIVEACTIONCANTHENBETAKEN4HISWILLBEEXPLOREDINMORE DETAILIN#HAPTER s To assist in planning for future trading activities."YPROVIDINGABASISFORTHENEXT BUDGET THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT WILL AID IN THE SETTING OF TARGETS FOR THE FUTURE 4HIS MAY INCLUDE STOCK LEVELS STAFlNG REQUIREMENTS OR ADVERTISING EXPENDITURE 4HISWILLBEEXPLOREDINMOREDETAILIN#HAPTER s To facilitate the calculation of financial indicators for analysis and interpretation. 4HESEINDICATORSCANBEUSEDNOTONLYTOUNCOVERWHATHASHAPPENED BUTTOHELP EXPLAINWHY4HISWILLBECOVEREDIN#HAPTER
REVIEW QUESTIONS 9.6
1 ExplainTHEPURPOSEOFPREPARINGAN)NCOME3TATEMENT 2 Explain HOW THE PREPARATION OF AN )NCOME 3TATEMENT CAN ASSIST DECISION MAKING 3 ExplainHOWTHEPREPARATIONOFAN)NCOME3TATEMENTCANASSISTPLANNINGFOR THEFUTURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
207
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
208
UNITS 3&4
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s s
s
s s
s
EXERCISES
0ROlTISCALCULATEDBYMATCHINGREVENUESEARNEDAGAINSTEXPENSESINCURREDINTHAT 2EPORTING0ERIOD #LOSINGTHELEDGERISNECESSARYTO n TRANSFER REVENUE AND EXPENSE AMOUNTS TO CALCULATE PROFIT FOR THE current 2EPORTING0ERIOD n RESET THE REVENUE AND EXPENSE ACCOUNTS TO ZERO IN READINESS FOR THE next 2EPORTING0ERIOD 2EVENUE AND EXPENSE ACCOUNTS MUST BE CLOSED TO THE 0ROlT AND ,OSS 3UMMARY ACCOUNTATTHEENDOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIOD4HE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTIS THENCLOSEDTOTHE#APITALACCOUNT 4HE $RAWINGS ACCOUNT IS TRANSFERRED TO THE #APITAL ACCOUNT AT THE END OF THE 2EPORTING0ERIOD 4HE)NCOME3TATEMENTAIDSDECISION MAKINGBYDETAILINGTHEREVENUESEARNEDAND EXPENSESINCURREDDURINGTHE2EPORTING0ERIOD ANDINTHEPROCESSSHOWINGBOTH 'ROSS0ROlTAND.ET0ROlT 4HE)NCOME3TATEMENTAND0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTSHOULDBOTHCALCULATE THESAME.ET0ROlTlGURE
EXERCISE 9.1 CLOSING THE LEDGER
W B
page 168
2UGGED2UGSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGLEDGERACCOUNTSFOR!UGUST General Ledger Stock Control (A) Date Aug. 1 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Balance
10 000
Aug. 31 Cost of Sales
17 000
Creditors Control
34 000
Cost of Sales
15 000
Advertising
400
Stock Loss
500
Sales (R) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Aug. 31 Bank
Amount $ 34 000
Debtors Control
28 000
Cross-reference
Amount $
Interest Revenue (R) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Aug. 31 Bank
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
1 500
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 9
DETERMINING PROFIT OR LOSS
Cost of Sales (E) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Aug. 31 Stock Control
17 000
Stock Control
15 000
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
Wages (E) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Aug. 31 Bank
Date
12 000 Rent Expense (E)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Aug. 31 Bank
Date
9 000 Advertising (E)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Aug. 31 Bank
Date
8 000
Stock Control
400 Stock Loss (E)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Aug. 31 Stock Control
Date
500
Required a ExplainWHYTHE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNTISBALANCEDRATHERTHANCLOSED b Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO CLOSE THE REVENUE AND EXPENSE ACCOUNTSTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT-EMO c ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTOCLOSETHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARY ACCOUNTTOTHE#APITALACCOUNT-EMO d PostTHE'ENERAL*OURNALTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF2UGGED2UGS
EXERCISE 9.2 CLOSING THE LEDGER
W B
page 171
*IGSAW 7ORLD HAS PROVIDED THE FOLLOWING LEDGER ACCOUNTS FOR THE YEAR ENDED $ECEMBER General Ledger Cash Sales (R) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Dec. 31
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $ 50 000
Credit Sales (R) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Dec. 31
Debtors Control
30 000
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
209
210
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Freight Inwards (E) Date Dec. 31
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
1 600 Cost of Sales (E)
Date Dec. 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Stock Control
25 000
Stock Control
15 000
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Wages (E) Date Dec. 31
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
30 500 Rent Expense (E)
Date Dec. 31
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
8 500 Discount Expense (E)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Dec. 31
Debtors Control
1 300
Date
Required a Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO CLOSE THE REVENUE AND EXPENSE ACCOUNTSTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT-EMO b ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTOCLOSETHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARY ACCOUNTTOTHE#APITALACCOUNT-EMO c PostTHE'ENERAL*OURNALTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF*IGSAW7ORLD d Calculate'ROSS0ROlTFOR*IGSAW7ORLDFORTHEYEARENDED$ECEMBER e ExplainHOWCLOSINGTHELEDGERENSURESRelevanceINTHElNANCIALREPORTS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 9
DETERMINING PROFIT OR LOSS
EXERCISE 9.3 CLOSING THE LEDGER AND TRANSFERRING DRAWINGS
W B
page 174
/N*UNE THE4RIAL"ALANCEOF7OMBAT0LANTSSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING WOMBAT PLANTS Trial Balance as at 30 June 2015 Account Bank
Debit 1 700
Capital – Withered Cost of Sales
30 900 50 000
Creditors Control Debtors Control Discount Expense
4 000 5 000 400
Discount Revenue Drawings
Credit
500 2 000
GST Clearing
1 000
Loan – ANZ (repayable $2 000 per annum)
16 000
Sales
80 000
Shop Fittings
17 000
Stock Control
45 000
Stock Loss Wages Totals
300 11 000 $132 400
$132 400
Required
*
a Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO CLOSE THE REVENUE AND EXPENSE ACCOUNTSTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT.ARRATIONSAREnotREQUIRED b ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTOCLOSETHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARY ACCOUNTANDTRANSFERDRAWINGSTOTHE#APITALACCOUNT.ARRATIONSAREnotREQUIRED c Show HOW THE 0ROlT AND ,OSS 3UMMARY #APITAL AND $RAWINGS ACCOUNTS WOULD APPEAR IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER AFTER ALL CLOSING AND BALANCING ENTRIES HAVE BEEN MADE d ExplainWHY$RAWINGSISnotCLOSEDTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT e Prepare THE EQUITIES SIDE OF THE "ALANCE 3HEET OF 7OMBAT 0LANTS AS AT *UNE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
211
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
212
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 9.4 INCOME STATEMENT
W B
page 176
/N*UNE THE'ENERAL*OURNALOF&ROSTY&RIDGESSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWINGCLOSING ENTRIES General Journal General Ledger Date June 30
Details
Debit
Sales
Subsidiary Ledger
Credit
Debit
Credit
120 000
Discount Revenue
1 800
Profit and Loss Summary
121 800
Closing revenue accounts to P&L Summary account June 30
Profit and Loss Summary
97 800
Cost of Sales
60 000
Stock Loss
500
Wages
19 000
Advertising
3 000
Customs Duty
2 000
Discount Expense
1 300
Rent Expense
12 000
Closing expense accounts to P&L Summary account June 30
Profit and Loss Summary
24 000
Capital – B. Ding
24 000
Transfer of Net Profit from P&L Summary to Capital account June 30
Capital – B. Ding Drawings
5 600 5 600
Transfer of Drawings to Capital account
Required
*
a ShowHOWTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYAND#APITALACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARINTHE 'ENERAL,EDGERASAT*UNEAFTERALLRELEVANTACCOUNTSHAVEBEENCLOSEDAND BALANCED b PrepareAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR&ROSTY&RIDGESFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE c 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@B explainYOURTREATMENTOF#USTOMS$UTY d ExplainONEREASONWHY&ROSTY&RIDGESSHOULDSTILLPREPAREAN)NCOME3TATEMENT EVENWHENITKNOWSTHE.ET0ROlTFORTHEPERIOD e 4HEOWNERHASSTATEDTHATASOWNERSEQUITYINCREASED THElRMSASSETSMUSTALSO HAVEINCREASEDStateONEREASONWHYTHISMAYBEINCORRECT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 9
DETERMINING PROFIT OR LOSS
EXERCISE 9.5 INCOME STATEMENT
page 178
W B
/N-AY THE4RIAL"ALANCEOF2EST%ASY"EDSSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING REST EASY BEDS Trial Balance as at 31 May 2015 Account Advertising
Debit 230
Bank Buying Expenses
3 410 900
Capital – J. Snooze Cost of Sales
25 190 8 380
Creditors Control Debtors Control
3 000 1 000
Discount Revenue Drawings
250 1 500
GST Clearing
350
Loan – Bank of Hope (repayable $5 000 p.a.)
15 000
Office Furniture
7 650
Prepaid Rent
1 920
Rent Expense
1 800
Sales
12 000
Shop Fittings
20 000
Stock Control
14 000
Stock Gain Wages Totals
Credit
300 2 120 $59 500
$59 500
Required
*
*
a Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO CLOSE THE REVENUE AND EXPENSE ACCOUNTSTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT.ARRATIONSAREnotREQUIRED b Show THE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTOCLOSETHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARY ACCOUNTANDTRANSFER$RAWINGSTOTHE#APITALACCOUNT.ARRATIONSAREnotREQUIRED c Show HOW THE 0ROlT AND ,OSS 3UMMARY $RAWINGS AND #APITAL ACCOUNTS WOULD APPEAR IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER OF 2EST %ASY "EDS AFTER ALL CLOSING AND BALANCING ENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE d PrepareAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR2EST%ASY"EDSFOR-AY e ExplainWHYTHEOWNERSHOULDBECONCERNEDABOUTTHElRMSABILITYTOCONTROL#OST OF'OODS3OLD f SuggestONEACTIONTHEOWNERMIGHTTAKETOIMPROVE.ET0ROlT g PrepareACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR2EST%ASY"EDSASAT-AY
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
213
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
214
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 9.6 INCOME STATEMENT
W B
page 181
%DU4OYSPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWING4RIAL"ALANCEASAT$ECEMBER EDUTOYS Trial Balance as at 31 December 2015 Account
Debit
Credit
Advertising
8 000
Bank
2 500
Capital – A.Teacher Cost of Sales
69 430 62 000
Creditors Control Debtors Control Discount Expense
13 000 15 000 600
Discount Revenue
700
Drawings
4 000
Electricity
3 400
GST Clearing Import Duties
270 1 200
Loan – ANZ Bank (repayable $500 per month) Premises
84 000 97 000
Sales
99 000
Shop Fittings
36 000
Stock Control
14 800
Stock Loss Wages Totals
900 21 000 $266 400
$266 400
Required
*
*
a 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainWHYTHELEDGERMUSTBECLOSED b ShowHOWTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYAND#APITALACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARINTHE 'ENERAL,EDGERAFTERALLCLOSINGANDBALANCINGENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE c Prepare AN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR%DU4OYSFORTHEYEARENDED$ECEMBER d SuggestTWOACTIONSTHEOWNERCOULDTAKETOIMPROVE!DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlTWITHOUT AFFECTING'ROSS0ROlT e Explain HOW REDUCING THE DISCOUNT OFFERED TO DEBTORS MIGHT CAUSE .ET 0ROlT TO DECREASE f Prepare ACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR%DU4OYSASAT$ECEMBER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 9
DETERMINING PROFIT OR LOSS
EXERCISE 9.7 INCOME STATEMENT
W B
page 184
4HE4RIAL"ALANCEFOR0RECIOUS0AINTINGSASAT/CTOBERSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING PRECIOUS PAINTINGS Trial Balance as at 31 October 2015 Account
Debit
Advertising
450
Capital – Lovegood
14 200
Cash at Bank
3 520
Cost of Sales
9 600
Creditors Control
6 350
Debtors Control
1 000
Delivery Vehicle
20 000
Discount Expense
70
Discount Revenue
50
Drawings
1 500
Freight In
610
Freight Out
800
GST Clearing
350
Loan – Commonwealth Bank (repayable $5 000 p.a.)
20 000
Prepaid Rent
1 800
Rent Expense
2 400
Sales Stock Control
17 500 14 000
Stock Loss
400
Wages Totals
Credit
2 300 $58 450
$58 450
Additional information: s
0RECIOUS0AINTINGSEMPLOYSONEFULL TIMESHOPASSISTANT
Required
*
*
a Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO CLOSE THE REVENUE AND EXPENSE ACCOUNTSTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT.ARRATIONSAREnotREQUIRED b ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTOCLOSETHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARY ACCOUNTANDTRANSFER$RAWINGSTOTHE#APITALACCOUNT.ARRATIONSAREnotREQUIRED c Prepare AN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR0RECIOUS0AINTINGSFOR/CTOBER d 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@C explainYOURTREATMENTOF&REIGHT/UT e StateTWOREASONSWHYTHEOWNERMAYBEDISAPPOINTEDWITH.ET0ROlTFOR/CTOBER f ExplainHOWANINCREASEIN/THER%XPENSESMIGHTLEADTOANINCREASEIN.ET0ROlT g Prepare ACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR0RECIOUS0AINTINGSASAT/CTOBER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
215
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
216
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 9.8 INCOME STATEMENT
page 187
W B
/N*ULY THE4RIAL"ALANCEOF(OT3TUFF/VENSSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING HOT STUFF OVENS Trial Balance as at 31 July 2015 Account Advertising
Debit
Credit
6 800
Bank
1 200
Capital – Phyre Cost of Sales
74 500 88 500
Creditors Control Debtors Control Discount Expense
44 000 25 000 750
Discount Revenue Drawings
160 1 700
GST Clearing Import Duties
390 1 500
Mortgage – ANQ Bank (repayable $12 000 p.a.) Premises
95 000 120 000
Prepaid Rent
12 000
Rent Expense
6 000
Sales
150 000
Shop Fittings
15 000
Stock Control
65 000
Wages
23 000
Totals
$365 250
$365 250
!DDITIONALINFORMATION s s s
$RAWINGSCONSISTEDOFCASHANDSTOCK OFWAGESWASINCORRECTLYDEBITEDTOTHE!DVERTISINGACCOUNT-EMO !PHYSICALSTOCKTAKEDETERMINEDTHEREWASOFSTOCKONHAND-EMO
Required
* *
a ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHECORRECTINGENTRYANDTHE STOCKLOSSORGAIN b Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO CLOSE THE REVENUE AND EXPENSE ACCOUNTS.ARRATIONSAREnotREQUIRED c Show HOW THE 0ROlT AND ,OSS 3UMMARY $RAWINGS AND #APITAL ACCOUNTS WOULD APPEAR IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER AS AT *ULY AFTER ALL RELEVANT CLOSING AND BALANCINGENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE d PrepareAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR(OT3TUFF/VENSFORTHEYEARENDED*ULY e ExplainONEUSEOFTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT f PrepareACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR(OT3TUFF/VENSASAT*ULY
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s
defineREVENUE EXPENSES ANDPROlT
s
explainHOWTHE2EPORTING 0ERIODPRINCIPLEANDTHE QUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC OFRelevanceAFFECTTHE CALCULATIONOFPROlT
s
defineTHETERM@BALANCE DAYADJUSTMENT
s
explainTHEPURPOSEOFA BALANCEDAYADJUSTMENT
s
identifyANDrecord EXPENSESPAIDINADVANCEIN THE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL AND'ENERAL,EDGER
s
recordBALANCEDAY ADJUSTMENTSFORPREPAID ANDACCRUEDEXPENSESIN THE'ENERAL*OURNALAND 'ENERAL,EDGER
s
stateTHEEFFECTOFBALANCE DAYADJUSTMENTSONTHE ACCOUNTINGEQUATION
s
identifyANDrecordTHE PAYMENTOFANACCRUED EXPENSEINASUBSEQUENT PERIOD
s
distinguishBETWEENAN ACCRUEDEXPENSEANDA SUNDRYCREDITOR
s
reportPREPAIDANDACCRUED EXPENSESINTHE"ALANCE 3HEET
s
explainTHEPURPOSEOF A0OST ADJUSTMENT4RIAL "ALANCE
s
prepareA0OST ADJUSTMENT 4RIAL"ALANCE
CHAPTER 10
BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS: EXPENSES KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s
ACCRUALACCOUNTING
s
BALANCEDAYADJUSTMENT
s
PREPAIDEXPENSE
s
ACCRUEDEXPENSE
s
0RE ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCE
s
0OST ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
218
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
10.1 THE NEED FOR BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS
STUDY TIP
%XPENSESSHOULDBE RECOGNISEDWHENTHEY AREINCURRED4HISISTHE SAMEASSAYINGTHEY SHOULDBERECOGNISED WHENTHEYARE@USEDUP ORCONSUMED
#HAPTER INTRODUCED THE IDEA OF CLOSING THE LEDGER BY TRANSFERRING THE BALANCES OF ALL REVENUE AND EXPENSE ACCOUNTS INTO A NEW ACCOUNT THE 0ROlT AND ,OSS 3UMMARY ACCOUNT INORDERTOCALCULATEPROlT2EMEMBERTHEDElNITIONSOFREVENUESANDEXPENSES OUTLINEDIN#HAPTER 2EVENUES INmOWS OF ECONOMIC BENElTS OR SAVINGS IN OUTmOWS IN THE FORM OF INCREASESINASSETSORREDUCTIONSINLIABILITIESTHATLEADTOANINCREASEIN OWNERSEQUITY %XPENSES OUTmOWS OR CONSUMPTIONS OF ECONOMIC BENElTS OR REDUCTIONS IN INmOWS INTHEFORMOFDECREASESINASSETSORINCREASESINLIABILITIESTHAT LEADTOADECREASEINOWNERSEQUITY .OTE THAT THE DElNITION OF REVENUES DOES NOT REFER TO @CASH RECEIVED BUT RATHER @INmOWS OF ECONOMIC BENElTS 4HE BENElT may BE CASH BUT DOES NOT HAVE TO BE IT COULD BE DEBTORS FOR A CREDIT SALE OR SOME OTHER ASSET SUCH AS STOCK FOR A STOCK GAIN )NTHECASEOFDISCOUNTREVENUE THEBENElTISACTUALLYAREDUCTIONINANOUTmOW WHERENOCASHmOWISINVOLVEDATALL4HISMEANSTHATREVENUESHOULDBERECOGNISEDNOT WHENTHECASHISRECEIVED BUTWHENTHEeconomicbenefitISRECEIVEDTHATIS WHENTHE REVENUEISearned NOTWHENITISRECEIVED !SIMILARPRINCIPLEAPPLIESTOEXPENSESEXPENSESSHOULDBERECOGNISEDWHENTHE ECONOMICBENElTISconsumedORINCURRED NOTWHENTHECASHISPAID 4HUS WHENWESPEAKOFDETERMININGPROlT WEAREACTUALLYCOMPARINGTHEREVENUE EARNED IN THE CURRENT 2EPORTING 0ERIOD AGAINST THE EXPENSES INCURRED IN THE CURRENT 2EPORTING0ERIODTHATIS
Profit
=
Revenue earned in the current Reporting Period less Expenses incurred in the current Reporting Period
accrual accounting calculating profit by comparing revenues earned against expenses incurred in a particular Reporting Period
balance day adjustment (BDA) a change made to a revenue or expense account on balance day so that revenue accounts show revenues earned and expense accounts show expenses incurred in a particular Reporting Period
4HISISTHEESSENCEOF accrual accounting.
Adjusting before closing 4HE ASSUMPTION WE MADE BEFORE CLOSING THE LEDGER IN #HAPTER WAS THAT REVENUE ACCOUNTS ALREADY SHOWED THE AMOUNT earned AND EXPENSE ACCOUNTS ALREADY SHOWED THE AMOUNT incurred 4HUS WHEN WE CALCULATED PROlT WE ASSUMED IT WOULD BE THE CORRECTlGURE 5NFORTUNATELY THISISNOTALWAYSTHECASE)FATBALANCEDAYTHEENDOFTHE2EPORTING 0ERIOD THERE IS REVENUE THAT HAS BEEN earned BUT NOT YET received SUCH AS INTEREST REVENUESTILLOWINGTOTHEBUSINESS THISMAYNOTAPPEARINTHEREVENUEACCOUNTS3IMILARLY IFTHEREAREEXPENSESTHATHAVEBEENincurredBUTNOTYETpaidSUCHASELECTRICITYTHAT HASBEENCONSUMEDBUTWILLNOTBEPAIDFORUNTILTHENEXTPERIOD THISMAYNOTAPPEAR INTHEEXPENSEACCOUNTS!SSUCH ALTHOUGHCLOSINGTHELEDGERCALCULATIONWOULDALLOW FORTHECALCULATIONOFPROlT THATPROlTWOULDBEINACCURATE )N EACH SITUATION SUCH AS THESE A balance day adjustment (BDA) IS NECESSARY TO CHANGEORADJUST THELEDGERACCOUNTSSOTHATTHEREVENUEACCOUNTSINCLUDEALLREVENUES EARNEDANDTHEEXPENSEACCOUNTSINCLUDEALLEXPENSESINCURREDINTHECURRENT2EPORTING 0ERIOD4HISWILLENSURETHATCLOSINGTHELEDGERWILLNOTONLYALLOWFORTHECALCULATIONOF PROlT BUTALSOTHATTHEPROlTlGUREWILLBEACCURATE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 10
219
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : E X P E N S E S
The purpose of a balance day adjustment is to ensure that profit can be calculated accurately, by comparing revenues earned against expenses incurred in the current Reporting Period. 4HISAPPLICATIONOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIODPRINCIPLELEADSTORelevanceINTHEACCOUNTING REPORTSBYENSURINGTHATTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTAND FORTHATMATTER THE"ALANCE3HEET INCLUDESALLINFORMATIONTHATISUSEFULFORDECISION MAKING WHILEEXCLUDINGINFORMATION THATISNOT)NFORMATIONTHATWOULDNOTBEUSEFULINCLUDESREVENUEOREXPENSESTHATWERE EARNEDORINCURREDoutsideTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD
STUDY TIP
!DJUSTINGENTRIESMUST BEMADEBEFORECLOSING ENTRIES*USTREMEMBER !"#!DJUST"EFORE #LOSING
Types of balance day adjustments 4HEBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTSTOBECOVEREDINTHISUNITREFERMAINLYTOEXPENSESWITH STOCKGAINBEINGTHEOBVIOUSEXCEPTION ANDINCLUDE
STUDY TIP
s STOCKLOSSESANDGAINSCOVEREDIN#HAPTER s PREPAIDEXPENSES s ACCRUEDEXPENSES s DEPRECIATIONTOBECOVEREDIN#HAPTER 4HESE BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS MUST BE RECORDED IN THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL BEFORE BEINGPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTS
/THERADJUSTMENTS RELATINGTOREVENUE ACCOUNTS WILLNOT BEEXAMINEDUNTIL SECONDSEMESTERAND SOARECOVEREDINLATER CHAPTERS
REVIEW QUESTIONS 10.1
1 Explain WHY PROlT MAY BE INACCURATE IF BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS ARE not RECORDED 2 ExplainTHEPURPOSEOFABALANCEDAYADJUSTMENT 3 Explain HOW BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS ENSURE 2ELEVANCE IN THE ACCOUNTING REPORTS 4 ListTHEFOURBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTSTHATRELATETOEXPENSES
10.2 PREPAID EXPENSES &REQUENTLY ANAMOUNTWILLBEPAIDFORANITEMTHATISNOTCONSUMEDATTHETIMETHE PAYMENTISMADE&ORINSTANCE WHENABUSINESSPAYSFORRENTORINSURANCETHEYUSUALLY PAYINADVANCE COVERINGTHENEXTMONTHOREVENTHEFORTHCOMINGYEAR4HESAMECOULD BESAIDFORSUPPLIESANDMATERIALSSUCHASOFlCESUPPLIES WHICHAREPURCHASEDINBULK Frequently, amounts are BUTARENOTUSEDIMMEDIATELY4HESEARECOMMONPAYMENTS BUTATTHETIMETHEYARE paid for items such as rent, insurance and office PAIDSHOULDWECONSIDERTHEMTOBEEXPENSES
supplies that are not used immediately. Should these be considered expenses or assets?
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
220
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
prepaid expense an expense paid in advance but yet to be consumed
UNITS 3&4
#ONSIDER THE DElNITION OF AN EXPENSE )T REFERS TO A consumption OR outflow OF ECONOMICBENElTS9ETATTHETIMEOFTHEPAYMENT HOWMUCHOFTHERENT INSURANCE OROFlCESUPPLIESHASBEENCONSUMED4HEANSWERISNONE)NFACT EACHWILLNOTBE CONSUMED UNTIL SOME TIME in the future 4HEREFORE THEY ARE NOT consumptions OF ECONOMICBENElTS BUTRATHERfutureECONOMICBENElTS)NOTHERWORDS THEYAREASSETS 4HISMEANSTHATWHENANEXPENSEISPAIDINADVANCE ITSHOULDBEPROPERLYRECORDED ASACURRENTASSETCALLEDprepaid expenseINTHISCASE 0REPAID2ENT 0REPAID)NSURANCE OR0REPAID/FlCE3UPPLIES
Recording expenses paid in advance
EXAMPLE
On 1 October 2015, Wendell Windows paid $1 200 (plus $120 GST) for insurance for the next 12 months (Ch. 63).
4HISPAYMENTWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 10.1
Cash Payments Journal: prepaid expense Cash Payments Journal
Date
Details
Oct. 1 Prepaid Insurance
Chq. no.
Bank
63
1 320
Totals
16 020
Discount Revenue
400
Creditors Control
5 000
Wages
Drawings
8 000
2 100
Sundries
GST
1 200
120
1 200
120
0OSTINGTHISTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERWOULDSHOW General Ledger Bank (A) Date
Cross-reference
Oct. 1
Balance
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
35 000
Oct. 31
Cash payments
16 020
Cross-reference
Amount $
Amount $
Prepaid Insurance (A) Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
1 200 GST Clearing (A/L)
Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
120
Oct. 1
Balance
400
4HEPAYMENTWILLBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALONTHEDAYITISPAID /CTOBER BUTTHEJOURNALWILLBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERONLYATTHEEND OFTHEMONTH/CTOBER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 10
221
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : E X P E N S E S
2EMEMBERTHATTHISPAYMENTWILLBEONLYONEOFANUMBEROFPAYMENTSDURINGTHE MONTH SOTHElGUREFORtotalCASHPAYMENTS($16 020 WILLBECREDITEDTOTHEBank ACCOUNT /FTHE$1 320PAID WAS'34 WHICHISDEBITEDTOTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTTO REDUCETHELIABILITYTOTHE!4/4HISMEANSTHATONLYnTHEAMOUNTRELATINGTO THEINSURANCEITSELFnISDEBITEDTO0REPAID)NSURANCEASTHEVALUEOFTHECURRENTASSET Effect on the accounting equation !SARESULTOFTHEpaymentOFPREPAIDINSURANCE Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
Decrease (decrease Bank $1 320, increase Prepaid Insurance $1 200)
120
Liabilities
Decrease (GST Clearing)
120
Owner’s Equity
No effect
!TTHISPOINT THEREISNOEXPENSEAMOUNTRECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTS ITISALLRECORDEDASACURRENTASSET
Adjusting for the consumption of a prepaid expense 0REPAIDEXPENSESARERECORDEDASCURRENTASSETSBECAUSEATTHETIMEOFPAYMENT NONE OF THE AMOUNT HAS BEEN CONSUMED IT IS ALL A future ECONOMIC BENElT (OWEVER BY THE TIME BALANCE DAY ARRIVES THE DAY ON WHICH THE LEDGER IS CLOSED AND REPORTS ARE PREPARED ATLEASTPARTOFTHISPREPAIDEXPENSEISLIKELYTOHAVEBEENconsumed)NOTHER WORDS PARTOFTHEASSETHASBECOMEANEXPENSE )TISTHEREFORENECESSARYTOADJUSTTHELEDGERACCOUNTSSOTHAT s THEAMOUNTCONSUMEDINTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIODISTRANSFERREDTOANEXPENSE ACCOUNT s THE0REPAID%XPENSEACCOUNTONLYSHOWSTHEAMOUNTREMAININGTHATIS UNUSED OR TOBEUSEDUPINAFUTURE2EPORTING0ERIOD ,ETSREFERBACKTOOUREARLIEREXAMPLE WHENINSURANCEWASPAIDON/CTOBER BUTPAIDINADVANCEFORTHENEXTMONTHS!T/CTOBER s (OWMUCHINSURANCEHASBEENCONSUMEDDURING/CTOBER s (OWMUCHPREPAIDINSURANCEISLEFTUNUSEDATTHEENDOF/CTOBER )FTHEPAYMENTMADEON/CTOBERCOVERSMONTHS $1 200 prepaid insurance
=
$100 insurance per month
12 months 4HEPREPAIDINSURANCEISCONSUMEDATPERMONTH SOBYBALANCEDAYOF/CTOBER ONEMONTHSWORTH OFPREPAIDINSURANCEHASBEENCONSUMED 4HE BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENT TO RECORD THE INSURANCE CONSUMED IS SHOWN IN THE 'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYIN&IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
STUDY TIP
#ALCULATETHEAMOUNT CONSUMEDUSED UPINCURRED4HISIS THEAMOUNTTOUSE INTHEBALANCEDAY ADJUSTMENT
Cambridge University Press
222
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
Figure 10.2
UNITS 3&4
General Journal: BDA for consumption of prepaid expense General Journal General Ledger
Date Oct. 31
Details
Debit
Insurance Expense
Subsidiary Ledger
Credit
Debit
Credit
100
Prepaid Insurance
100
Adjusting entry to record one month insurance incurred (Memo 9)
4HISENTRYDEBITSTHE)NSURANCE%XPENSEACCOUNTTORECOGNISETHEEXPENSEINCURRED IN THE CURRENT 2EPORTING 0ERIOD WHILE THE 0REPAID )NSURANCE ACCOUNT IS CREDITED TO REDUCETHECURRENTASSETBYTHEAMOUNTCONSUMED4HESOURCEDOCUMENTIS-EMO REmECTINGTHEFACTTHATTHISINFORMATIONHASCOMEFROMWITHINTHEBUSINESS !FTERPOSTING THISENTRYWOULDAPPEARINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 10.3
General Ledger: BDA for consumption of prepaid expense General Ledger
STUDY TIP
Prepaid Insurance (A)
7HENADJUSTINGA PREPAIDEXPENSE @TAKEAWAYTHEAMOUNT INCURREDFROMTHE CURRENTASSET
Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
1 200
Oct. 31
Cross-reference Insurance Expense
Amount $ 100
1 100 Insurance Expense (E) Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Prepaid Insurance
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
100
.OTETHATTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYTORECORDTHEBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTIN&IGURE USESTHEAMOUNTCONSUMEDINTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD 4HEBALANCE OFLEFTINTHE0REPAID)NSURANCEACCOUNTn REPRESENTSTHEAMOUNT unused ORTHEAMOUNTTHATWILLBECONSUMEDINAfuture2EPORTING0ERIOD4HISISTHE NEWCURRENTASSETBALANCE Effect on the accounting equation !SARESULTOFTHEADJUSTMENTFORTHECONSUMPTIONOF0REPAID)NSURANCE Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
Decrease (Prepaid Insurance)
100
Liabilities
No effect
Owner’s Equity
Decrease (increase Insurance Expense decreases Net Profit)
100
4HIS ADJUSTMENT DOES NOT CHANGE "ANK NOR DOES IT AFFECT '34 #LEARING BUT IT DECREASESPROlT ANDDECREASESASSETSINTHE"ALANCE3HEET
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 10
223
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : E X P E N S E S
Closing the ledger .OWTHATTHELEDGERACCOUNTSHAVEBEENADJUSTEDnSOTHATTHEEXPENSEACCOUNTSHOWS THEAMOUNTINCURREDINTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIODnTHEEXPENSEACCOUNTISREADYTO BECLOSEDTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT2EMEMBERTHATALLEXPENSEACCOUNTS ARECLOSEDINONE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRY WITHEACHEXPENSEACCOUNTCREDITED ANDONE DEBITTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT !FTERITHASBEENCLOSED THE)NSURANCE%XPENSEACCOUNTWOULDSHOW General Ledger Insurance Expense (E) Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
100
Oct. 31
Prepaid Insurance
Cross-reference Profit and Loss Summary
100
Amount $ 100 100
REVIEW QUESTIONS 10.2
1 ExplainWHYAPREPAIDEXPENSEISCLASSIlEDASACURRENTASSET 2 State THE EFFECT ON THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION OF A PAYMENT FOR A PREPAID EXPENSE 3 Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD THE BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTFORTHECONSUMPTIONOFAPREPAIDEXPENSE 4 StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOFTHEBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTFOR THECONSUMPTIONOFAPREPAIDEXPENSE
10.3 ACCRUED EXPENSES 0REPAID EXPENSES ARE PAID before THEY ARE CONSUMED BUT IT IS ALSO LIKELY THAT SOME EXPENSESWILLBEPAIDafterTHEYARECONSUMED&OREXAMPLE ATBALANCEDAYTHEREMAY BEWAGESOWINGTOEMPLOYEESFORWORKTHATHASALREADYBEENDONE ORELECTRICITYTHAT HASBEENCONSUMEDBUTNOTPAIDFOR"ECAUSETHISAMOUNTHASALREADYBEENINCURREDOR INTHELANGUAGEOFTHEDElNITION consumed INTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD ITMUSTBE ADDEDTOTHEEXPENSEAMOUNT)NADDITION THEAMOUNTOWINGSHOULDALSOBERECORDED ASALIABILITY4HEAMOUNTSTILLOWINGFORANEXPENSETHATHASALREADYBEENCONSUMEDIS CALLEDANaccrued expense
Adjusting for an accrued expense
accrued expense an expense that has been incurred but not yet paid
0RIOR TO MAKING ANY BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS EXPENSE ACCOUNTS WILL ONLY SHOW THE AMOUNTSPAID&ORINSTANCE THE7AGESACCOUNTWILLSHOWTHEAMOUNTPAIDTOEMPLOYEES THE )NTEREST %XPENSE ACCOUNT WILL SHOW INTEREST PAID TO THE BANK AND %LECTRICITY WILL SHOWTHEAMOUNTPAIDFORELECTRICITY&ORINSTANCE ATBALANCEDAY/CTOBER THE %LECTRICITYACCOUNTMAYSHOW General Ledger Electricity (E) Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
1 500
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
224
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
4HECURRENTLYSHOWNINTHE%LECTRICITYACCOUNTREPRESENTSTHEAMOUNTACTUALLY PAIDFORELECTRICITYDURING/CTOBER"UTISTHISTHETOTALEXPENSEINCURREDINTHE PERIOD "EFORE THE REPORTS CAN BE PREPARED THE ACCOUNTANT MUST ASCERTAIN WHETHER ANY ADDITIONAL AMOUNTS HAVE BEEN CONSUMED BUT NOT YET PAID )F THERE ARE THESE MUST BEADDEDTOTHEEXPENSEACCOUNTSBEFORETHECLOSINGENTRIESAREMADE)TISTHEREFORE NECESSARYTOADJUSTTHELEDGERACCOUNTSSOTHAT s THEEXTRAAMOUNTCONSUMEDINTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIODISADDEDTOTHEEXPENSE ACCOUNT s ACURRENTLIABILITYACCOUNTn!CCRUED%XPENSEnISCREATEDTOSHOWTHEAMOUNTOWING UNPAID WHICHWILLBEPAIDINTHENEXT2EPORTING0ERIOD
EXAMPLE
At 31 October 2015, $300 electricity was owing (Memo 15).
4HEBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTTORECORDTHEACCRUEDELECTRICITYISSHOWNINTHE'ENERAL *OURNALENTRYIN&IGURE Figure 10.4
General Journal: BDA for accrued expense General Journal General Ledger
Date
Details
Debit $
Oct. 31 Electricity Expense
Credit $
Subsidiary Ledger Debit $
Credit $
300
Accrued Electricity
300
Adjusting entry to record electricity consumed but not yet paid (Memo 15)
4HIS ENTRY DEBITS THE %LECTRICITY %XPENSE ACCOUNT TO RECOGNISE THE EXTRA AMOUNT INCURRED IN THE CURRENT 2EPORTING 0ERIOD !T THE SAME TIME THE !CCRUED %LECTRICITY ACCOUNTISCREDITEDTORECOGNISETHELIABILITYTHEOBLIGATIONTOTHEELECTRICITYSUPPLIER &ORANACCRUEDEXPENSE THEAMOUNTUSEDINTHEADJUSTMENT ISnotTHETOTAL EXPENSEFORTHEPERIOD2ATHER ITISSIMPLYTHEEXTRAAMOUNTTHEAMOUNTTHATHASBEEN CONSUMEDBUTNOTYETPAID)TISADDEDTOTHEAMOUNTPAIDTOCALCULATETHETOTALEXPENSE INCURREDFORTHE2EPORTING0ERIOD !FTERPOSTING THISENTRYWOULDAPPEARINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 10.5
General Ledger: BDA for accrued expense General Ledger Electricity Expense (E)
Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference Bank Accrued Electricity
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
1 500 300
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 10
225
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : E X P E N S E S
Accrued Electricity (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Oct. 31
Amount $
Electricity Expense
300
STUDY TIP
Effect on the accounting equation !SARESULTOFTHEADJUSTMENTFOR!CCRUED%LECTRICITY Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
No effect
Liabilities
Increase (Accrued Electricity)
300
Owner’s Equity
Decrease (increase Electricity Expense decreases Net Profit)
300
7HENADJUSTINGAN ACCRUEDEXPENSE @ADD ONTHEEXTRAAMOUNT INCURREDTOTHE EXPENSE
!SWITHTHEADJUSTMENTFORTHECONSUMPTIONOFAPREPAIDEXPENSE THISADJUSTMENT DOESNOTCHANGE"ANK NORDOESITAFFECT'34#LEARING2ATHER ITDECREASESPROlTAND INCREASESLIABILITIESINTHE"ALANCE3HEET
Closing the ledger !SACURRENTLIABILITY THE!CCRUED%LECTRICITYACCOUNTWILLBEBALANCED BUTTHE%LECTRICITY %XPENSEACCOUNTWILLBECLOSEDTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT!FTERITHAS BEENCLOSED THE%LECTRICITY%XPENSEACCOUNTWOULDSHOW ELECTRICITY EXPENSE (E) Date
Cross-reference
Oct. 31
Bank Accrued Electricity
Amount $ 1 500
Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Profit and Loss Summary
1 800
300 1 800
1 800
.OTEHOWTHEAMOUNTCLOSED ISGREATERTHANTHEAMOUNTOFTHEADJUSTMENT ASTHETOTALEXPENSEINCURREDINCLUDESBOTHTHEPAID ANDTHESTILL OWINGATTHEENDOFTHEPERIOD2EMEMBER FORANITEMTOBERECOGNISEDASANEXPENSE THEDElNITIONREQUIRESANITEMTOBECONSUMEDPAYMENTISNOTNECESSARY
Payment of accrued expenses in subsequent periods 3OMETIMEINTHENEXT2EPORTING0ERIOD THEAMOUNTOWINGASANACCRUEDEXPENSEWILL BEPAID4HEREFORE THENEXTTIMEACHEQUEISWRITTENTOPAYFORTHEEXPENSE WEMUST RECOGNISETHATWHILESOMEOFTHEAMOUNTPAIDMAYREPRESENTANEXPENSEOFTHECURRENT 2EPORTING0ERIOD ATLEASTSOMEOFTHEPAYMENTRELATESTOTHEPREVIOUS2EPORTING0ERIOD )NOTHERWORDS SOMEOFTHEAMOUNTPAIDREDUCESTHELIABILITYFORACCRUEDEXPENSESn EXPENSESINCURREDANDACCRUEDlastperiod
On 4 November 2015, a cheque for $1 500 (plus $150 GST) was sent to the electricity company (Ch. 77).
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
EXAMPLE
Cambridge University Press
226
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
4HEPAYMENTOFELECTRICITYON.OVEMBERWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH 0AYMENTS*OURNALASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 10.6
Cash Payments Journal: payment of accrued expense in a subsequent period CASH PAYMENTS JOURNAL
Date Nov. 4
Details
Chq. no.
Accrued Electricity/
77
Bank
Discount Revenue
Creditors Control
Wages
Drawings
1 650
Electricity Expense
Sundries
GST
300
150
1 200
Totals
$
16 350
300
4 000
8 000
3 000
1 500
150
4HEFULLAMOUNTPAIDn$1 650nISRECORDEDINTHE"ANKCOLUMN ASTHISISTHEAMOUNT WRITTENONTHECHEQUE(OWEVER THISISNOTALL%LECTRICITY%XPENSEINCURREDIN.OVEMBER &ORASTART ITINCLUDESWORTHOF'34 WHICHMUSTBEDEBITEDTO'34#LEARING 4HISLEAVESUSWITHTHATHASBEENPAIDFORELECTRICITY"UTHOWMUCHRELATESTO ELECTRICITYTHATWASCONSUMEDIN.OVEMBER 2EMEMBERTHATON/CTOBER WEMADEABALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTTORECORD OFELECTRICITYTHATHADBEENCONSUMEDIN/CTOBER BUTWASNOTYETPAID4HAT IS AT/CTOBER WASOWEDFOR!CCRUED%LECTRICITY3OWHENTHEPAYMENT ISMADEON.OVEMBER SOMEOFTHEISBEINGUSEDTOPAYOFFTHISEARLIER DEBT4HATIS ISPAIDTODECREASETHE!CCRUED%LECTRICITYLIABILITY SOONLY REPRESENTS%LECTRICITY%XPENSECONSUMEDDURING.OVEMBER /NCE THE #ASH 0AYMENTS *OURNAL HAS BEEN POSTED TO THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER THE ACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 10.7
General Ledger: payment of accrued expense in a subsequent period General Ledger Bank (A)
Date Nov. 30
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $
Date
4 000
Nov. 30
Cross-reference Cash payments
Amount $ 16 350
Electricity Expense (E) Date Nov. 30
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
1 200 Accrued Electricity (L)
Date Nov. 30
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
300
Nov. 1
Balance
Amount $ 300
GST Clearing (A/L) Date Nov. 30
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
150
Nov. 1
Balance
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Amount $ 850
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 10
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : E X P E N S E S
!SWASNOTEDIN#HAPTER NOTALLEXPENSESARESUBJECTTO'34 SOWHENPAYINGA NON '34ITEMSUCHASWAGESORINTERESTEXPENSE INASUBSEQUENTPERIOD ITWILLNOTBE NECESSARYTOACCOUNTFORTHE'34(OWEVER ITISLIKELYTHATITWILLSTILLBENECESSARYTOSPLIT THEPAYMENTASPARTWAGESEXPENSE PARTACCRUEDWAGES ORASPARTINTERESTEXPENSE PARTACCRUEDINTEREST Effect on the accounting equation !SARESULTOFTHEPAYMENTOF%LECTRICITYAND!CCRUED%LECTRICITY Increase/Decrease/No effect Assets
Decrease (Bank)
Liabilities
Decrease (Accrued Electricity $300, GST Clearing $150)
Owner’s Equity
Decrease (increase Electricity Expense decreases Net Profit)
Amount $ 1 650 450 1 200
Accrued expense versus sundry creditor )TISIMPORTANTTODISTINGUISHBETWEENAMOUNTSOWEDASACCRUEDEXPENSESANDAMOUNTS OWED TO SUNDRY CREDITORS !N ACCRUED EXPENSE OCCURS WHEN AN EXPENSE HAS BEEN INCURRED BUT THE PAYMENT HAS NOT YET BEEN MADE ! SUNDRY CREDITOR OCCURS WHEN ITEMSOTHERTHANSTOCKAREPURCHASED BUTTHEPAYMENTHASNOTBEENMADE#REDITORS #ONTROLONLYRECORDSCREDITPURCHASESOFSTOCK 'IVENTHEOBVIOUSSIMILARITY WHATISTHE DIFFERENCE7HENSHOULDANAMOUNTOWINGBERECORDEDASANACCRUEDEXPENSE7HEN SHOULDITBERECORDEDASASUNDRYCREDITOR 4OSTART ACCRUEDEXPENSESMUSTRELATESPECIlCALLYTOEXPENSES4HEAMOUNTSMUSTBE OWINGFORITEMSTHATHAVEBEENCONSUMED RATHERTHANFORASSETS"UT MOREIMPORTANTLY ACCRUEDEXPENSESARENOTDUEFORREPAYMENTATBALANCEDAY BECAUSENOINVOICEHAS BEENRECEIVED!CCRUEDEXPENSESOCCURWHENBALANCEDAYFALLSBEFOREANITEMHASBEEN PAID BUTALSOBEFOREITISDUEFORPAYMENT4HUS ANACCRUEDEXPENSEWILLBEVERIlED NOTBYANINVOICE BUTBYSOMETHINGLIKEAMEMO)FANINVOICEHASBEENRECEIVED THE TRANSACTIONISSIMPLYACREDITTRANSACTION ANDTHEAMOUNTOWINGSHOULDBESHOWNASA SUNDRYCREDITOR
REVIEW QUESTIONS 10.3
1 ExplainWHYANACCRUEDEXPENSEISCLASSIlEDASACURRENTLIABILITY 2 ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDANACCRUEDEXPENSE 3 StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOFTHEBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTFOR ANACCRUEDEXPENSE 4 Explain WHY THE PAYMENT OF AN ACCRUED EXPENSE IN A SUBSEQUENT PERIOD REQUIRESTHEPAYMENTTOBESPLITINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL 5 State THE EFFECT ON THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION OF THE PAYMENT OF AN ACCRUED EXPENSEINASUBSEQUENTPERIOD 6 DistinguishBETWEENANACCRUEDEXPENSEANDASUNDRYCREDITOR
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
227
228
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
10.4 THE POST-ADJUSTMENT TRIAL BALANCE Pre-adjustment Trial Balance a list of all General Ledger accounts and their balances before balance day adjustments have been made Post-adjustment Trial Balance a list of all General Ledger accounts and their balances after balance day adjustments have been made
4HE IDEA OF PREPARING A 4RIAL "ALANCE WAS INTRODUCED IN #HAPTER AS PART OF THE LEDGERRECORDINGPROCESS)TSFUNCTIONWASTOCHECKTHATTOTALDEBITSEQUALTOTALCREDITS 4ECHNICALLY THISSHOULDHAVEBEENTITLEDAPre-adjustment Trial Balance ASITISPREPARED BEFOREANYBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTSHAVEBEENRECORDED (OWEVER BALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTSCHANGETHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTS AFTERTHE 4RIAL "ALANCE HAS ALREADY BEEN PREPARED THEY INCREASE CERTAIN EXPENSES DECREASE CERTAIN CURRENT ASSETS AND INCREASE CERTAIN CURRENT LIABILITIES 4HIS MEANS IT MAY BE USEFULTOPREPAREAPost-adjustment Trial Balance TOCHECKTHATEVENAFTERTHEBALANCE DAYADJUSTMENTSHAVEBEENMADE THETOTALDEBITSEQUALTHETOTALCREDITS
KINGSTON HOMEWARES Pre-adjustment Trial Balance as at 30 June 2015
EXAMPLE
Account
Debit
Stock Control
34 000
Debtors Control
12 000
Prepaid Rent
Credit
6 000
Fixtures and Fittings
50 000
Bank
1 000
Creditors Control
19 000
Loan – Wonderbucks
45 000
Capital – Gemeika
29 000
Sales Revenue
100 000
Cost of Sales
60 000
Wages
20 000
Electricity
8 000
Advertising
4 000
Totals
$194 000
$194 000
Additional information as at 30 June 2015:
s Stock loss
$ 1 000
s Rent incurred
$
700
s Accrued wages
$
200
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 10
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : E X P E N S E S
4HE ENTRIES TO RECORD THESE BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS WITH THE NARRATIONS OMITTED WOULDBERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNALASISSHOWNBELOW General Journal General Ledger Date June 30
Details
Debit
Stock Loss
1 000
Stock Control June 30
Rent Expense
Credit
Debit
Credit
1 000 700
Prepaid Rent June 30
Subsidiary Ledger
Wages
700 200
Accrued Wages
200
!FTER THESE BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS WERE POSTED TO THE LEDGER ACCOUNTS A 0OST ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCEWOULDBEPREPARED ASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 10.8
Post-adjustment Trial Balance KINGSTON HOMEWARES Post-adjustment Trial Balance as at 30 June 2015
Account
Debit
Stock Control
33 000
Debtors Control
12 000
Prepaid Rent Fixtures and Fittings
Credit
5 300 50 000
Bank
1 000
Creditors Control
19 000
Loan – Wonderbucks
45 000
Capital – Gemeika
29 000
Sales Revenue
100 000
Cost of Sales
60 000
Wages
20 200
Electricity
8 000
Advertising
4 000
Stock Loss
1 000
Rent Expense
700
Accrued Wages Total
200 $194 200
$194 200
/BVIOUSLYTHEBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTSWEREPOSTEDCORRECTLYnATLEASTINTERMSOF DEBITSMATCHINGCREDITSnBECAUSETHIS0OST ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCESTILLBALANCESATA NEWTOTALOF $194 200 0REPARINGTHE0OST ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCEALSOASSISTSINENSURINGTHATTHECLOSING ENTRIES AND THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT USE THE CORRECT AMOUNTS THE adjusted lGURES FOR THEAMOUNTSincurredRATHERTHANTHEUNADJUSTEDlGURES WHICHDIDNOTACCOUNTFORANY BALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTS ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
229
230
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 10.4
1 Explain THE DIFFERENCE BETWEEN A 0RE ADJUSTMENT 4RIAL "ALANCE AND A 0OST ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCE 2 ExplainHOWA0OST ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCECANASSISTINTHECALCULATIONOFAN ACCURATEPROlTlGURE
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s s
s s s s
EXERCISES
"ALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTSARENECESSARYSOTHATANACCURATEPROlTISCALCULATEDBY COMPARINGREVENUEEARNEDANDEXPENSESINCURREDINTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD "ALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTSMAYBENECESSARYFOR n STOCKLOSSESANDGAINSCOVEREDIN#HAPTER n PREPAIDEXPENSES n ACCRUEDEXPENSES n DEPRECIATIONTOBECOVEREDIN#HAPTER %ACHBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTFORANEXPENSEINCREASESTHEEXPENSE THUSDECREASING PROlTANDOWNERSEQUITY !DJUSTMENTS FOR PREPAID EXPENSES DECREASE ASSETS ADJUSTMENTS FOR ACCRUED EXPENSESINCREASELIABILITIES "ALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTSHAVENOEFFECTONCASH BUTWILLCHANGE.ET0ROlTANDTHE ITEMSINTHE"ALANCE3HEET ! 0OST ADJUSTMENT 4RIAL "ALANCE SHOULD BE PREPARED AFTER THE BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTSHAVEBEENPOSTEDTOTHELEDGERTOCHECKTHATTOTALDEBITSSTILLEQUAL TOTALCREDITS
EXERCISE 10.1 PREPAID EXPENSE
W B
page 192
/N-ARCH $OMS,ARGE'OODSPAIDPLUS'34 TOCOVERTHENEXT SIXMONTHSRENT#H 4HElRMCLOSESITSLEDGERACCOUNTSANDPREPARESITSlNANCIAL REPORTSON*UNEEACHYEAR Required a Record#HEQUEINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALOF$OMS,ARGE'OODS b 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainWHYSOMEOFTHERENTPAIDSHOULDBE REPORTEDASANEXPENSEFORTHEYEARENDING*UNE c CalculateRENTEXPENSEFORTHEYEARENDING*UNE d Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD RENT EXPENSE FOR THE YEAR ENDING*UNE.ARRATIONis notREQUIRED e StateTHEEFFECTOFTHEADJUSTMENTFORRENTEXPENSEONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF $OMS,ARGE'OODS f ShowHOWTHE2ENT%XPENSEAND0REPAID2ENT%XPENSEACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARIN THE'ENERAL,EDGEROF$OMS,ARGE'OODSASAT*UNEAFTERALLCLOSINGAND BALANCINGENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 10
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : E X P E N S E S
EXERCISE 10.2 PREPAID EXPENSE
W B
page 194
/N&EBRUARY 2ONNIES#AR0ARTSPAIDPLUS'34 FOROFlCESUPPLIES#H /N&EBRUARY WORTHOFOFlCESUPPLIESWASSTILLONHAND-EMO Required a RecordTHEPAYMENTFOROFlCESUPPLIESINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL b CalculateOFlCESUPPLIESEXPENSEFOR&EBRUARY c ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDOFlCESUPPLIESEXPENSEFOR &EBRUARY d ShowHOWTHE/FlCE3UPPLIES%XPENSEAND0REPAID/FlCE3UPPLIESACCOUNTSWOULD APPEARINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF2ONNIES#AR0ARTSASAT&EBRUARYAFTERALL CLOSINGANDBALANCINGENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE e Show HOW 0REPAID /FlCE 3UPPLIES WOULD BE REPORTED IN THE "ALANCE 3HEET OF 2ONNIES#AR0ARTSASAT&EBRUARY
EXERCISE 10.3 PREPAID EXPENSE
W B
page 196
-AXWELLS3HOESPRESENTEDTHEFOLLOWINGEXTRACTFROMITS"ALANCE3HEETASAT-ARCH Current assets:
Prepaid Insurance
$1800
4HEYEARLYINSURANCEPREMIUMWASPAIDINADVANCEON*ANUARY4HEBUSINESS PREPARESREPORTSMONTHLY ANDTHENEXTBALANCEDAYOCCURSON!PRIL Required a 2EFERRINGTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC explainWHYBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTSARE NECESSARY b CalculateTHEINSURANCEEXPENSEFOR!PRIL c ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDINSURANCEEXPENSEFOR!PRIL .ARRATIONis notREQUIRED d StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF-AXWELLS3HOESIFTHEADJUSTMENTFOR INSURANCEEXPENSEWASnotMADE e ShowHOW0REPAID)NSURANCEWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF-AXWELLS 3HOESASAT*ULY
EXERCISE 10.4 PREPAID EXPENSE
W B
page 197
/N*UNE (ALIFAX&URNITURE3ALESPAIDINCLUDING'34 FORADVERTISINGIN Furniture TraderMAGAZINE#H 4HEADVERTISEMENTSWILLAPPEARONCEAMONTHFOR lVEMONTHS WITHTHElRSTADVERTISEMENTAPPEARINGIN*ULY-EMO Required a Record#HEQUEINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL b Explain HOW THE AMOUNT PAID FOR ADVERTISING WOULD BE REPORTED IN THE "ALANCE 3HEETOF(ALIFAX&URNITURE3ALESASAT*UNE c CalculateADVERTISINGEXPENSEFORTHEQUARTERENDED3EPTEMBER d ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDADVERTISINGEXPENSEFORTHE QUARTERENDED3EPTEMBER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
231
232
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
e ShowHOWTHE!DVERTISING%XPENSEAND0REPAID!DVERTISINGACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEAR INTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF(ALIFAX&URNITURE3ALESASAT3EPTEMBERAFTERALL CLOSINGANDBALANCINGENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE f StateTHEEFFECTONTHE.ET0ROlTOF(ALIFAX&URNITURE3ALESFORTHEQUARTERENDED 3EPTEMBERIFTHEADJUSTMENTFORADVERTISINGEXPENSESWASnotMADE
EXERCISE 10.5 PREPAID EXPENSE
W B
page 199
$URING #LIVE2APOPENEDHISOWN#$SHOPCALLED(ARD-#/N!UGUST #LIVEPAIDINCLUDING'34 TOCOVERRENTFORTHESIXMONTHSFROM3EPTEMBER TO&EBRUARY#H $URING$ECEMBER THElRMWASINFORMEDTHAT BEGINNINGIN-ARCH RENTWOULDINCREASE SOON&EBRUARY THElRMPAID PLUS'34 FORRENTFORTHESIXMONTHSFROM-ARCHTO!UGUST#H 4HElRMPREPARESITSREPORTSON*UNEEACHYEAR Required a CalculateRENTPAIDFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE b CalculateRENTEXPENSEFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE c 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERSTOPARTS@AAND@B explainWHYRENTPAIDANDRENTEXPENSE AREDIFFERENTAMOUNTS d Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD RENT EXPENSE FOR THE YEAR ENDED*UNE.ARRATIONIS notREQUIRED e ShowHOWTHE2ENT%XPENSEAND0REPAID2ENT%XPENSEACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARIN THE'ENERAL,EDGEROF(ARD-#ASAT*UNEAFTERALLCLOSINGANDBALANCING ENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE f StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF(ARD-#IFTHEADJUSTMENTFORRENT EXPENSEWASnotMADE
EXERCISE 10.6 ACCRUED EXPENSE
W B
page 201
$URING 3TRONG !RM 3ECURITY $EVICES PAID INCLUDING '34 FOR ADVERTISING BUTASAT$ECEMBERAFURTHERWASSTILLOWING-EMO Required a CalculateADVERTISINGEXPENSEFOR b 2EFERRINGTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC explainWHYTHEADVERTISINGOWINGSHOULD BEINCLUDEDINTHEADVERTISINGEXPENSEFOR c Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD ADVERTISING OWING AS AT $ECEMBER d StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF3TRONG!RM3ECURITY$EVICESOFTHE ADJUSTMENTFORADVERTISINGOWING e ShowHOWTHE!DVERTISING%XPENSEAND!CCRUED!DVERTISINGACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEAR INTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF3TRONG!RM3ECURITY$EVICESASAT$ECEMBERAFTER ALLCLOSINGANDBALANCINGENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE f ExplainHOW!CCRUED!DVERTISINGWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF3TRONG !RM3ECURITY$EVICESASAT$ECEMBER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 10
EXERCISE 10.7 ACCRUED EXPENSE
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : E X P E N S E S
W B
page 203
!FTERASERIESOFBREAK INS *IMS'EMSEMPLOYEDASECURITYGUARDON*UNE4HE SECURITYGUARDWORKSSEVENDAYSPERWEEK ANDISPAIDWAGESOFPERFORTNIGHT 7AGES WERE LAST PAID TO COVER THE FORTNIGHT FROM *UNE TO *UNE INCLUSIVE -EMO Required a CalculateACCRUEDWAGESASAT*UNE b ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDACCRUEDWAGESASAT*UNE c ShowHOWTHE7AGES%XPENSEAND!CCRUED7AGESACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARINTHE 'ENERAL,EDGEROF*IMS'EMSASAT*UNEAFTERALLCLOSINGANDBALANCING ENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE d Record THE PAYMENT OF WAGES ON *ULY #H IN THE #ASH 0AYMENTS *OURNAL e 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainWHYONLYSOMEOFTHEWAGESPAIDON *ULYSHOULDBEREPORTEDASANEXPENSEFOR*ULY
EXERCISE 10.8 ACCRUED EXPENSE
W B
page 205
/N.OVEMBER -ILLIE(ALLBORROWEDTOSETUPHERBUSINESS (ALL!NTIQUES )TISANINTERESTONLYLOAN DUETOBEPAIDBACKINlVEYEARSTIME)NTERESTISCALCULATEDAT PAANDISPAYABLEINTWOSEPARATEPAYMENTSON!PRILAND/CTOBEREACHYEAR Required a CalculateINTERESTEXPENSEINCURREDFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE b ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDACCRUEDINTERESTEXPENSEAS AT*UNE.ARRATIONIS notREQUIRED c Show HOW THE )NTEREST %XPENSE AND !CCRUED )NTEREST %XPENSE ACCOUNTS WOULD APPEARINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF(ALL!NTIQUESASAT*UNEAFTERALLCLOSING ANDBALANCINGENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE d StateTHEEFFECTONTHE.ET0ROlTOF(ALL!NTIQUESFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE IFTHEADJUSTMENTFORACCRUEDINTERESTWASnotMADE e RecordTHEPAYMENTOFINTERESTON/CTOBERINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL f State THE EFFECT ON THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION OF (ALL !NTIQUES OF THE PAYMENT OF INTERESTON/CTOBER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
233
234
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 10.9 ACCRUED EXPENSE
W B
page 207
$URING !PRIL "RIGHT ,IGHTS PAID ELECTRICITY WORTH INCLUDING '34 BUT INCURRED ELECTRICITY WORTH -EMO /N -AY THE lRM PAID PLUS'34 FORELECTRICITY#H Required a CalculateACCRUEDELECTRICITYASAT!PRIL b ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESTORECORDACCRUEDELECTRICITYASAT!PRIL c ShowHOWTHE%LECTRICITY%XPENSEAND!CCRUED%LECTRICITYACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEAR IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER OF "RIGHT ,IGHTS AS AT !PRIL AFTER ALL CLOSING AND BALANCINGENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE d State THE EFFECT ON THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION OF "RIGHT ,IGHTS IF THE BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTFORACCRUEDELECTRICITYISnotRECORDED e Record#HEQUEINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL
EXERCISE 10.10 ACCRUED EXPENSE
W B
page 209
!SAT*ULY THE'ENERAL,EDGEROF"ROOKE)RRIGATION3UPPLIESSHOWEDACCRUED CLEANINGEXPENSESOF/N!UGUST THEBUSINESSPAIDINCLUDING'34 FORCLEANING#H 4HISWASTHEONLYPAYMENTFORCLEANINGDURING!UGUST!S AT!UGUST WASOWINGFORCLEANINGEXPENSES-EMO Required a Record#HEQUEINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL b CalculateCLEANINGEXPENSESFOR!UGUST c ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDACCRUEDCLEANINGEXPENSEAS AT!UGUST d CompleteTHE!CCRUED#LEANING%XPENSESACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF"ROOKE )RRIGATION3UPPLIESASAT!UGUST e State THE EFFECT ON THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION OF "ROOKE )RRIGATION 3UPPLIES IF THE BALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTFORACCRUEDCLEANINGISnotRECORDED f StateONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLETHATWOULDBEBREACHEDIFTHEADJUSTMENTFORACCRUED CLEANINGEXPENSEWASnotMADEJustifyYOURANSWER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 10
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : E X P E N S E S
EXERCISE 10.11 REPORTING PREPAID AND ACCRUED EXPENSES
W B
page 211
0ICKFORD0AINTSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWING0RE ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCEASAT*UNE PICKFORD PAINTS Pre-adjustment Trial Balance as at 30 June 2015 Account
Debit
Advertising
3 850
Bank
1 050
Capital – Pickford Cost of Sales
27 050 57 000
Creditors Control Debtors Control Discount Expense
Credit
30 400 23 100 250
Discount Revenue
200
Drawings
4 300
Freight In
600
GST Clearing Interest Expense
120 220
Loan – Bank of Wilco
40 000
Office Equipment
7 900
Prepaid Rent
4 500
Sales
96 000
Shop Fittings
15 800
Stock Control
45 600
Wages
29 600
Totals
$193 770
$193 770
Additional information: s s s s s
4HE,OANn"ANKOF7ILCOISREPAYABLEATPA !PHYSICALSTOCKTAKEON*UNESHOWEDSTOCKONHANDWORTH -ONTHLYRENTEXPENSEIS WAGESREMAINEDOWINGTOEMPLOYEESAT*UNE 2EPORTSAREPREPAREDMONTHLY
Required
* * *
a 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainTHEPURPOSEOFMAKINGBALANCEDAY ADJUSTMENTS b ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHEBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTS ON*UNE.ARRATIONSARE notREQUIRED c PrepareA0OST ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCEFOR0ICKFORD0AINTSASAT*UNE d Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO CLOSE THE LEDGER AND TRANSFER DRAWINGSTOTHE#APITALACCOUNT.ARRATIONSARE notREQUIRED e PrepareAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR0ICKFORD0AINTSFOR*UNE f PrepareACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR0ICKFORD0AINTSASAT*UNE ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
235
236
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 10.12 REPORTING PREPAID AND ACCRUED EXPENSES
W B
page 215
-ARANELLI 3PORTS HAS PROVIDED THE FOLLOWING 0RE ADJUSTMENT 4RIAL "ALANCE AS AT $ECEMBER MARANELLI SPORTS Pre-adjustment Trial Balance as at 31 December 2015 Account Advertising
Debit 8 200
Bank Buying Expenses
2 300 3 000
Capital – Maranelli Cost of Sales
85 430 92 000
Creditors Control Debtors Control Discount Expense
18 300 12 400 1 230
Discount Revenue
580
Drawings
31 000
Fittings and Fixtures
26 800
GST Clearing Interest Expense
320 1 800
Mortgage – HH Finance Premises Prepaid Insurance
180 000 240 000 1 500
Sales Stock Control Wages Totals
Credit
190 000 32 000 9 000 $476 930
$476 930
Additional information: s !PHYSICALSTOCKTAKEON$ECEMBERSHOWEDSTOCKONHANDWORTH s !SAT$ECEMBER PREPAIDINSURANCEAMOUNTEDTO s 9EARLY REPAYMENTS OF ARE MADE ON THE PRINCIPAL OF THE -ORTGAGE n (( &INANCE)NTERESTISCHARGEDATPA ANDPAYABLEON&EBRUARYAND!UGUST EACHYEAR s 4HELEDGERWASLASTCLOSEDANDREPORTSPREPAREDON*UNE Required
*
a ExplainHOWBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTSENSURERelevanceINTHElNANCIALREPORTS b ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHEBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTS ON$ECEMBER.ARRATIONSARE notREQUIRED c Prepare A 0OST ADJUSTMENT 4RIAL "ALANCE FOR -ARANELLI 3PORTS AS AT $ECEMBER d Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO CLOSE THE LEDGER AND TRANSFER DRAWINGSTOTHE#APITALACCOUNT.ARRATIONSARE notREQUIRED
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 10
*
*
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : E X P E N S E S
e Prepare AN )NCOME 3TATEMENT FOR -ARANELLI 3PORTS FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED $ECEMBER f Assess THE SALES MARK UP APPLIED BY -ARANELLI 3PORTS FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED $ECEMBER g PrepareACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR-ARANELLI3PORTSASAT$ECEMBER h 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@G explainYOURTREATMENTOFINTERESTOWING
EXERCISE 10.13 REPORTING FOR PREPAID AND ACCRUED EXPENSES
W B
page 219
!LANNAH &ASHIONS HAS PROVIDED THE FOLLOWING 0RE ADJUSTMENT 4RIAL "ALANCE AS AT -ARCH ALANNAH FASHIONS Pre-adjustment Trial Balance as at 31 March 2015 Account Advertising
Debit 1 750
Bank
4 100
Capital – Alannah Cost of Sales
48 350 24 800
Creditors Control Debtors Control Discount Expense
40 600 21 700 140
Discount Revenue Drawings GST Clearing Interest Expense
310 21 700 400 90
Loan – FinCo.
15 000
Office Equipment Prepaid Office Supplies Prepaid Rent
6 300 180 6 000
Sales
62 000
Shop Fittings
40 000
Stock Control
39 000
Wages Totals
Credit
9 000 $170 360
$170 360
Additional information: s 4HE,OANn&INCOISANINTERESTONLYLOAN DUEFORREPAYMENTON$ECEMBER s !S AT -ARCH THERE WAS STOCK ON HAND BUT !LANNAH DECIDED TO INCREASE IT ! PHYSICAL STOCKTAKE ON -ARCH SHOWED STOCK ON HAND WORTH s 9EARLYRENTISPAIDON!UGUSTEACHYEAR
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
237
238
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
s /N&EBRUARY ACCRUEDWAGESWAS!SAT-ARCH WAS OWINGTOEMPLOYEESINUNPAIDWAGES4HENEXTPAYMENTOFFORWAGESISDUE ON!PRIL s !T-ARCH OFOFlCESUPPLIESWERESTILLONHAND Required
*
* *
a CalculateTHETOTALCASHPAIDFORWAGESDURING-ARCH b 'IVENTHATREPORTSAREPREPAREDMONTHLY showTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESTORECORD THEBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTSON-ARCH.ARRATIONSARE notREQUIRED c PrepareA0OST ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCEFOR!LANNAH&ASHIONSASAT-ARCH d Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO CLOSE THE LEDGER AND TRANSFER $RAWINGSTOTHE#APITALACCOUNT.ARRATIONSARE notREQUIRED e CompleteTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT f PrepareAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR!LANNAH&ASHIONSFOR-ARCH g PrepareACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR!LANNAH&ASHIONSASAT-ARCH h 2EFERRINGTOTHEINFORMATIONSUPPLIED suggestONEREASONWHYTHE'34#LEARING ACCOUNTHASADEBITBALANCEJustifyYOURANSWER i Record THE PAYMENT OF WAGES ON !PRIL IN THE #ASH 0AYMENTS *OURNAL #H j State THE EFFECT OF THE PAYMENT ON !PRIL ON THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION OF !LANNAH&ASHIONS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s IDENTIFYTHECHARACTERISTICS OFADEPRECIABLENON CURRENT ASSET s DElNEDEPRECIATION AND OTHERRELATEDTERMS s EXPLAINTHEPURPOSEOF DEPRECIATION ANDITS RELATIONSHIPTOTHEACCOUNTING PRINCIPLESANDQUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICS s CALCULATEDEPRECIATION EXPENSEUSINGTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD
s RECORDDEPRECIATIONINTHE 'ENERAL*OURNALAND'ENERAL ,EDGER s REPORTFORDEPRECIATIONIN THE)NCOME3TATEMENTAND "ALANCE3HEET s EXPLAINTHEEFFECTOF DEPRECIATIONONTHE ACCOUNTINGEQUATION s DElNETHETERM@COSTASIT REFERSTONON CURRENTASSETS
CHAPTER 11
DEPRECIATION OF NON-CURRENT ASSETS KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s DEPRECIABLEASSET
s DEPRECIABLEVALUE
s lNITELIFE
s CARRYINGVALUE
s DEPRECIATION
s RESIDUALVALUE
s DEPRECIATIONEXPENSE
s USEFULLIFE
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
240
UNITS 3&4
11.1 ASSETS AND EXPENSES 4HERESEEMSTOBEASCHOOLOFTHOUGHTTHATLOOKSUPONASSETSAS@GOOD ANDEXPENSES AS @BAD !CCORDING TO THIS MISGUIDED ANALYSIS ASSETS ARE GOOD BECAUSE THEY HELP COMPANIESTOEARNPROlT BUTEXPENSESAREBADBECAUSETHEYREDUCETHATPROlT"UTIF THISWERETHECASE WHYWOULDABUSINESSHAVEEXPENSESATALL7HYPUTUPWITHPAYING WAGES ORRENT ORADVERTISINGORELECTRICITYEXPENSESWHENALLTHEYDOISLOWERPROlT 4HESIMPLEANSWERISTHAT JUSTLIKEASSETS THESEEXPENSESARENECESSARYnNECESSARYTO HELPEARNREVENUEANDGENERATEPROlT!BUSINESSTHATHADNOEMPLOYEES NOPREMISES NO ADVERTISING AND NO ELECTRICITY COULD SIMPLY NOT DO ITS JOB )N THIS WAY ASSETS AND EXPENSESHAVESOMETHINGINCOMMONTHEYBOTHASSISTINTHEEARNINGOFREVENUE4HIS ISREmECTEDINTHEDElNITIONS !SSET
A RESOURCE CONTROLLED BY THE ENTITY AS A RESULT OF PAST EVENTS FROM WHICH FUTUREECONOMICBENElTSAREEXPECTEDTOmOWTOTHEENTITY
%XPENSE ACONSUMPTIONOROUTmOWORREDUCTIONINANINmOW OFANECONOMICBENElT INTHEFORMOFADECREASEINASSETSORINCREASEINLIABILITIES WHICHRESULTSINA DECREASEINOWNERSEQUITYEXCEPTDRAWINGS "OTH DElNITIONS REFER TO THE economic benefit THAT IS BROUGHT TO THE BUSINESS (OWEVER THE DElNITIONS ALSO HIGHLIGHT THE KEY DIFFERENCE BETWEEN AN ASSET AND AN EXPENSEANASSETISDElNEDASAfutureECONOMICBENElT WHILEANEXPENSEISDElNED AS THE consumption OF AN ECONOMIC BENElT 4HAT IS EXPENSES REFER TO ECONOMIC BENElTSTHATHAVEalready been consumedINTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD WHEREAS ASSETSREFERTOECONOMICBENElTSTHATAREyet to be consumedANDWILLBECONSUMED INFUTURE2EPORTING0ERIODS
$EPRECIABLEASSETS )TEMS SUCH AS VEHICLES OFlCE EQUIPMENT AND SHOP lTTINGS WHICH ARE CONTROLLED BY THEBUSINESS WILLPROVIDEAFUTUREECONOMICBENElTFORMORETHANMONTHS ANDSO SHOULDBERECORDEDASNON CURRENTASSETSWHENTHEYAREPURCHASED
Assets such as vehicles, office equipment and shop fittings are depreciable assets. Over time, their ability to earn revenue is reduced.
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 11
D E P R E C I AT I O N O F N O N - C U R R E N T A S S E T S
!TTHESAMETIME JUSTBECAUSEASSETSSUCHASTHESEWILLLASTFORMORETHANMONTHS DOESNOTMEANTHEYWILLLASTFOREVER!STHEYAGE THEYWEAROUT ANDASTHEIRLIFEEXPIRES SOTOODOESTHEIRABILITYTOEARNREVENUE4HISMEANSTHEYAREDEPRECIABLEASSETSnTHEY HAVEAlNITELIFE ANDWILLBEUSEFULFORAlXEDPERIODOFTIME!TSOMEPOINTINTHEFUTURE THEYWILLBENOLONGERABLETOEARNREVENUE )NEFFECT DEPRECIABLEASSETSAREconsumed over time7EMAYNOTBEABLETOSEE THISCONSUMPTION BUTTHATDOESNOTMEANTHATITISNOTHAPPENING%VERYYEAR partOF THEVALUEOFTHEASSETISCONSUMED UNTILnATTHEENDOFITSLIFEnTHEASSETSREVENUE EARNINGCAPACITYISWHOLLYCONSUMED ANDITISUNABLETOEARNREVENUEANYLONGER!S WEALREADYKNOW AconsumptionOFANECONOMICBENElTISANexpense MEANINGTHAT EACHYEARpartOFTHEASSETSVALUEISCONSUMED SOpartOFITSVALUEBECOMESANEXPENSE 4HISPROCESSOFCALCULATINGhow muchVALUEHASBEENCONSUMEDINEACHPERIODISCALLED @DEPRECIATION
241
DEPRECIABLEASSET a non-current asset that has a finite life, and must be depreciated over its life lNITELIFE the limited period of time (usually measured in years) for which a non-current asset will exist
EXAMPLE
On 1 January 2015, Lane Grove Furniture paid $32 000 (plus $3 200 GST) for a new delivery vehicle. It is expected that it will be kept for five years.
STUDY TIP
)NTHISEXAMPLE LETUSDEALlRSTWITHTHE'34)TISEXCLUDEDFROMOURCONSIDERATIONOF DEPRECIATIONBECAUSEITISNOTINCLUDEDINTHECOSTOFTHEVEHICLEITACTUALLYREPRESENTSA REDUCTIONINTHE'34LIABILITYOWEDTOTHE!4/"UTWHATABOUTTHEVEHICLEITSELF !T PURCHASE DATE January THE VEHICLE IS CLEARLY A non-current asset 4HE ENTIRE IS A FUTURE ECONOMIC BENElT IN TERMS OF THE DELIVERIES IT CAN DO IS CONTROLLEDBYTHElRMANDTHATBENElTWILLBEPROVIDEDFORMORETHANMONTHSUNTIL THEVEHICLECANNOLONGERMAKEDELIVERIES "UTHOWSHOULDTHEVEHICLEBEREPORTEDASATDecember !SSUMINGTHATTHEBUSINESSSTILLHASTHEVEHICLE ITHASNOTBEENconsumed SOTHE SHOULDNOTBEREPORTEDASANEXPENSEFORTHEYEARENDED$ECEMBER )NDEED THE VEHICLE WILL STILL BE AVAILABLE TO PROVIDE AN ECONOMIC BENElT IN future 2EPORTING0ERIODSANDONWARDS ANDSOSHOULDSTILLBEREPORTEDASANON CURRENT ASSET (OWEVER THEVEHICLEISADEPRECIABLEASSETWITHAlNITELIFESLOWLYBUTSURELY THE PRODUCTIVE CAPACITY OF THE VEHICLE WILL BE CONSUMED 4HIS WILL NOT HAPPEN IN ONE 2EPORTING0ERIOD BUTRATHEROVERANUMBEROF2EPORTING0ERIODS SOpartOFTHEASSETS VALUESHOULDBEREPORTEDASANEXPENSEFORTHEYEARENDED$ECEMBER4HE REMAINDERnTHEPARTYETTOBECONSUMEDnSHOULDBEREPORTEDASANON CURRENTASSET THATIS LESSTHEAMOUNTCONSUMEDSOFAR )N ORDER TO CALCULATE THAT PART OF THE COST OF THE VEHICLE CONSUMED IN THE CURRENT 2EPORTING0ERIODTHEYEARENDED$ECEMBER ITISNECESSARYTODEPRECIATETHE ASSET .OTE!SSETSTHATHAVEANINlNITEORNEVER ENDINGLIFEWHERETHEECONOMICBENElT WILLCONTINUEFOREVER SHOULDNOTBEDEPRECIATED ASTHEYMAYBEused BUTARENEVER @used up OR CONSUMED 4HIS MAY APPLY TO AN ASSET SUCH AS LAND BUT VERY FEW OTHER ITEMS
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
)FTHE'34CLEARING ACCOUNTSTARTSOUT WITHADEBITBALANCE '34PAIDWILLINCREASE THISASSET RATHERTHAN DECREASEALIABILITY
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
242
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 11.1
1 2EFERRINGTOTHEDElNITIONS IDENTIFYTHECHARACTERISTICCOMMONTOBOTHASSETS ANDEXPENSES 2 %XPLAINTHEKEYDIFFERENCEBETWEENANASSETANDANEXPENSE 3 )DENTIFYTHECHARACTERISTICSOFADEPRECIABLENON CURRENTASSET 4 %XPLAIN WHY IT IS NOT NECESSARY TO CALCULATE DEPRECIATION FOR ASSETS SUCH AS LAND 5 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE EXPLAINWHYTHEENTIRECOSTOFANON CURRENTASSETSHOULDNOTBEREPORTEDASANEXPENSE 6 %XPLAINWHY'34ISEXCLUDEDFROMTHECONSIDERATIONOFDEPRECIATION
11.2 DEPRECIATION OF NON-CURRENT ASSETS
DEPRECIATION the allocation of the cost of a non-current asset over its useful life DEPRECIATIONEXPENSE that part of the cost of a non-current asset that has been consumed in the current Reporting Period
!LTHOUGHTHETERMDEPRECIATIONISFREQUENTLYUSEDTODESCRIBETHEEXPENSE ITACTUALLY REFERSTOTHEprocessnTHEACCOUNTINGPROCEDUREnTHATCREATESDEPRECIATIONEXPENSE )NTERMSOFTHEPROCESS DEPRECIATIONISTHEALLOCATIONOFTHECOSTOFANON CURRENTASSET OVERITSUSEFULLIFE "ECAUSEANON CURRENTASSETISNOTCONSUMEDENTIRELYWITHINONE2EPORTING0ERIOD depreciation IS AN ATTEMPT TO CALCULATE HOW MUCH OF THE ASSETS VALUE HAS BEEN CONSUMEDINTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD)TTHEREFOREspreads outORallocatesTHECOST OFTHEASSETOVERTHEYEARSINWHICHITISUSEFULFOREARNINGREVENUE RATHERTHANTREATING ALLOFTHECOSTASANEXPENSEINANYONEYEAR !SARESULTOFTHISPROCESS depreciation expenseISCREATED REPRESENTINGTHATPARTOF THECOSTOFANON CURRENTASSETTHATHASBEENCONSUMEDINTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD
4HEPURPOSEOFDEPRECIATION *USTLIKEADJUSTMENTSFORACCRUEDORPREPAIDEXPENSES DEPRECIATIONISABALANCEDAY ADJUSTMENT AND CONSEQUENTLY THE PURPOSE OF DEPRECIATING NON CURRENT ASSETS IS THE SAMEASTHEPURPOSEOFANYOTHERBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENT!LLBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTS DEPRECIATION INCLUDED ARE MADE TO ENSURE THAT AN ACCURATE PROlT IS CALCULATED BY COMPARINGREVENUESEARNEDAGAINSTEXPENSESINCURREDINTHEcurrent2EPORTING0ERIOD $EPRECIATIONDOESTHISBYRECOGNISINGASANEXPENSEONLYTHATPARTOFTHECOSTOFANON CURRENTASSETTHATISCONSUMEDINCURREDINTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD4HISWILLALSO ENSURETHATTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTUPHOLDS2ELEVANCEBYINCLUDINGALLINFORMATIONTHAT ISUSEFULFORDECISION MAKING $EPRECIATIONDOESNOTINVOLVEANYPAYMENTOFCASH4HECASHPAYMENTRELATINGTO EACHNON CURRENTASSETWILLBERECORDEDONLYATTHETIMEWHENTHEASSETISPURCHASED $EPRECIATIONAFFECTSONLYTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTANDTHE"ALANCE3HEET
REVIEW 11.2
1 $ElNETHETERM@DEPRECIATION 2 $ElNETHETERM@DEPRECIATIONEXPENSE 3 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE EXPLAINTHEPURPOSEOFDEPRECIATINGA NON CURRENTASSET 4 %XPLAINTHEEFFECTOFDEPRECIATIONONAlRMSBANKBALANCE
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 11
D E P R E C I AT I O N O F N O N - C U R R E N T A S S E T S
243
11.3 CALCULATING DEPRECIATION EXPENSE 4HEREAREANUMBEROFDIFFERENTWAYSTOCALCULATEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSE EACHOFWHICH MAKESDIFFERENTASSUMPTIONSABOUTTHEWAYASSETSARECONSUMED5NITCONCENTRATES ONONLYONEMETHODTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHODOFDEPRECIATION!NALTERNATIVEMETHOD ISDISCUSSEDIN#HAPTER BUTTHATISPARTOF5NIT
3TRAIGHT LINEMETHODOFDEPRECIATION 4HE STRAIGHT LINE METHOD OF CALCULATING DEPRECIATION ASSUMES THAT NON CURRENT ASSETS CONTRIBUTE EVENLY TO REVENUE DOING THE SAME JOB IN THE LAST YEAR OF THEIR LIFE AS THEY DID IN THEIR lRST !S A RESULT IT ASSUMES THAT THE VALUE OF A NON CURRENT ASSET IS CONSUMEDEVENLYOVERITSLIFE SOTHEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEISTHESAMEEVERYYEAR)FTHIS DEPRECIATIONEXPENSEWASPLOTTEDONAGRAPH THELINEWOULDBEASTRAIGHTLINE GIVING THEMETHODITSNAME $EPRECIATIONEXPENSEFORMULA $EPRECIATIONEXPENSEPERANNUM
(#n26 ,IFE
Where:
HC
Historical Cost: THEORIGINALPURCHASE PRICEOFTHENON CURRENTASSET
RV
residual value: THEESTIMATEDVALUEOF THENON CURRENTASSETATTHEENDOFITS USEFULLIFE
Life
useful life: THEESTIMATEDPERIODOF TIMEFORWHICHTHENON CURRENTASSET WILLBEUSEDBYTHECURRENTENTITYTO EARNREVENUE4HISISUSUALLYMEASURED INYEARS
4HEBASICPREMISEISTODIVIDETHECOSTOFTHEASSETBYTHENUMBEROFYEARSFORWHICH ITISUSED THUSDETERMININGHOWMUCHOFTHATCOSTISCONSUMEDPERYEAR"ECAUSEEACH NON CURRENTDEPRECIABLEASSETISDIFFERENTINTERMSOFITSUSEFULLIFEANDRESIDUALVALUE EACHMUSTBEDEPRECIATEDINDIVIDUALLY
On 1 January 2015, Big Cycles purchased Office Furniture for $5 000 (plus $500 GST). The furniture will be kept for three years, at which time it will have an estimated residual value of $800.
$EPRECIATIONEXPENSE
n
YEARS
PERANNUM
EXAMPLE
(#n26 ,IFE
$4 200
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
244
UNITS 3&4
)NTHISEXAMPLE THEDEPRECIATIONPROCESSCALCULATESTHATTHEBUSINESSISCONSUMING WORTHOFTHEFURNITURESVALUEEACHYEAR4HISAMOUNTWOULDBERECORDEDASAN EXPENSE AND WOULD ALSO DECREASE THE VALUE AT WHICH THE FURNITURE IS VALUED IN THE "ALANCE3HEET Depreciable value
DEPRECIABLEVALUE the total value of the asset that will be consumed by the current entity, and so must be allocated over its useful life
)FWEPLANTOUSETHEASSETUNTILITISUTTERLYWORTHLESS THENTHERESIDUALVALUEWILLSIMPLY BEZERO ANDTHEENTIRECOSTOFTHEASSETWILLBECONSUMEDBYOURBUSINESS (OWEVER WEMAYDISPOSEOFTHEASSETWHILEITSTILLHASSOMEVALUE4HISAMOUNTWILL THENNOTBECONSUMEDBYourBUSINESS BUTBYanother entity4HUS THERESIDUALVALUE MUSTBEDEDUCTEDFROMTHE(ISTORICAL#OST BECAUSETHISISTHEAMOUNTTHATWILLnot be consumed by our business)NTHISEXAMPLE WORTHOFVALUEWILLSTILLEXISTWHENWE ARElNISHEDWITHTHEASSETTHISAMOUNTWILLBECONSUMEDBYTHENEXTOWNER THEASSET WASPURCHASEDFOR BUTONLY$4 200WILLBECONSUMEDBY"IG#YCLES 4HEAMOUNTCALCULATEDBYDEDUCTINGRESIDUALVALUEFROM(ISTORICAL#OSTINTHETOP LINEOFTHEEQUATION ISKNOWNASTHEdepreciable valueITISTHETOTALVALUEOFTHEASSET THATWILLBECONSUMEDBYTHECURRENTOWNERENTITY ANDSOMUSTBEALLOCATEDOVERITS USEFULLIFE Time or use? .OTEALSOTHATWEARENOTDEPRECIATINGTHEASSETMOREORLESSDEPENDINGONUSEYOUR DESKDOESNOTDETERIORATEANYFASTERORSLOWERDEPENDINGONHOWLONGYOUARESITTING THERE)NFACT STRAIGHT LINEDEPRECIATIONASSUMESTHATTHEASSETISCONSUMEDOVERtime NOTACCORDINGTOUSE!NDTHISISREmECTEDINTHEFORMULA WHICHUSES@USEFULLIFERATHER THANSOMEMEASUREOFUSE 4HESTRAIGHT LINEMETHODMAYBELESSSUITABLEFORASSETSTHATDONOTCONTRIBUTEEVENLY TOREVENUE BUTUNTILTHISISCOVEREDIN5NIT allASSETSIN5NITAREDEPRECIATEDUSING THESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD
REVIEW 11.3
1 %XPLAINTHEASSUMPTIONTHATUNDERLIESTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHODOFDEPRECIATION RECIAT ON INRELATIONTOHOWASSETSCONTRIBUTETOREVENUE 2 3TATETHEFORMULAFORCALCULATINGDEPRECIATIONUSINGTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD 3 $ElNETHEFOLLOWINGTERMS s (ISTORICAL#OST s RESIDUALVALUE s USEFULLIFE 4 %XPLAINWHYEACHNON CURRENTASSETMUSTBEDEPRECIATEDINDIVIDUALLYRATHER THANASATOTAL 5 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE EXPLAINWHYRESIDUALVALUEISDEDUCTED FROM (ISTORICAL #OST WHEN CALCULATING DEPRECIATION USING THE STRAIGHT LINE METHOD
11.4 RECORDING DEPRECIATION !SWASNOTEDEARLIER DEPRECIATIONISABALANCEDAYADJUSTMENT!SARESULT ITISRECORDED INTHE'ENERAL*OURNALONBALANCEDAYnATTHEENDOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIODnINCOMMON WITHASTOCKLOSS PREPAIDRENTORACCRUEDWAGES
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 11
D E P R E C I AT I O N O F N O N - C U R R E N T A S S E T S
245
EXAMPLE
On 1 January 2015, Mixwell Paints purchased a new van for plus $3 200 GST. Depreciation on the van has been calculated as $1 200 per year (Memo 5).
!TBALANCEDAY$ECEMBER THEBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTFORDEPRECIATION WOULDBERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNALASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 11.1
General Journal: depreciation of NCA 'ENERAL*OURNAL 'ENERAL,EDGER
$ATE
$ETAILS
$EBIT
31/12/15 Depreciation of Van
#REDIT
3UBSIDIARYLEDGER $EBIT
#REDIT
1 200
Accumulated Depreciation of Van
1 200
Yearly depreciation on van – s/line method (Memo 5)
2EMEMBER DEPRECIATIONCALCULATESTHATPARTOFTHECOSTOFANON CURRENTASSETTHAT HASBEENCONSUMEDINTHEcurrent2EPORTING0ERIOD4HISAMOUNTWOULDBERECORDEDAS ANEXPENSE BYDEBITINGANEWACCOUNTCALLED$EPRECIATIONOF6AN !TTHESAMETIME DEPRECIATIONALSODECREASESTHEVALUEATWHICHTHEASSETISREPORTED INTHE"ALANCE3HEET!FTERALL THENON CURRENTASSETISAFUTUREECONOMICBENElT BUT BYDEPRECIATINGTHEASSETWEARERECOGNISINGTHATSOMEOFTHISBENElTHASNOWBEEN CONSUMED 4HIS REDUCTION IN THE VALUE OF AN ASSET WOULD NORMALLY BE RECORDED AS A CREDITENTRY BUTRATHERTHANCREDITTHEASSETACCOUNTDIRECTLY THECREDITENTRYISMADE TOANEWACCOUNTCALLED!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONOF6AN4HISACCOUNTISANEGATIVE ASSETACCOUNT .OTETHATTHEACCOUNTSARETITLED@$EPRECIATIONofVanAND@!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATION of VanRATHERTHANJUST@$EPRECIATIONOR@!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATION'IVENTHATMOST BUSINESSESWILLDEPRECIATEMORETHANONENON CURRENTASSET ITISIMPERATIVETOIDENTIFY PRECISELYWHICHASSETISBEINGDEPRECIATED 4HE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYIN&IGUREWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERAS SHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 11.2
General Ledger: depreciation of NCA 'ENERAL,EDGER $EPRECIATIONOF6AN%
$ATE 31/12/15
#ROSS REFERENCE
!MOUNT
Acc. Dep. of Van
1 200
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
!MOUNT
!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONOF6ANn! $ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
!MOUNT
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE $EPOF6AN
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
!MOUNT
STUDY TIP
$EPRECIATIONISAN AREAWHEREINTELLIGENT ABBREVIATIONSCANMAKE YOURLIFEMUCHEASIER
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
246
UNITS 3&4
%FFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION $EPRECIATIONHASTHEFOLLOWINGEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION )NCREASE$ECREASE.OEFFECT
!MOUNT
!SSETS
$ECREASE)NCREASE!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONOF6AN
,IABILITIES
.OEFFECT
/WNERS%QUITY
$ECREASE$EPRECIATIONOF6ANEXPENSEDECREASES .ET0ROlT
1 200
1 200
$EPRECIATIONVERSUS!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATION ACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATION the value of a non-current asset that has been consumed/incurred over its life thus far
4HEKEYTOUNDERSTANDINGACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATIONLIESINTHETITLE7HEREASDEPRECIATION EXPENSEREFERSTOTHEAMOUNTCONSUMEDINTHEcurrent2EPORTING0ERIOD accumulated depreciationREFERSTODEPRECIATIONTHATHASACCUMULATEDORBUILTUP over the life of the asset so far!CCUMULATEDDEPRECIATIONWILLGROWEVERYYEARASTHEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSE FOREACH2EPORTING0ERIODISADDEDTOIT !SANEXPENSE THE$EPRECIATIONOF6ANACCOUNTMUSTBECLOSEDTOTHE0ROlTAND ,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTATTHEENDOFEACH2EPORTING0ERIOD)NFACT ITWILLOPENAND CLOSE ON THE VERY SAME DAY LEAVING IT WITH A ZERO BALANCE AT THE END OF THE PERIOD !CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONOF6AN ONTHEOTHERHAND ISANONGOINGACCOUNTITWILLBE BALANCEDATTHEENDOFTHEPERIOD WITHITSBALANCECARRIEDFORWARDTOTHENEXT !FTER THE $EPRECIATION OF 6AN ACCOUNT HAS BEEN CLOSED AND THE !CCUMULATED $EPRECIATIONOF6ANACCOUNTHASBEENBALANCED THELEDGERACCOUNTSWOULDSHOW 'ENERAL,EDGER $EPRECIATIONOF6AN% $ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
!MOUNT
31/12/15
Acc. Dep. of Van
1 200
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
31/12/15 Profit and Loss Summary
1 200
!MOUNT 1 200 1 200
!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONOF6ANn! $ATE 31/12/15
#ROSS REFERENCE Balance
!MOUNT
$ATE
1 200
31/12/15
#ROSS REFERENCE Dep. of Van
1 200
!MOUNT 1 200 1 200
1/1/16
Balance
1 200
.OTETHATTHEENTRYTOCLOSETHE$EPRECIATIONOF6ANACCOUNTISMADEINTHE'ENERAL *OURNAL AT THE SAME TIME THAT ALL THE EXPENSE ACCOUNTS INCLUDING EXPENSES SUCH AS #OSTOF3ALES 7AGESAND!DVERTISING ARECLOSED!LLTHEEXPENSEACCOUNTSARECREDITED INDIVIDUALLYINORDERTOTRANSFERTHEAMOUNTSOTHATPROlTORLOSSCANBECALCULATED AND RESETTHEMTOZEROFORTHENEXT2EPORTING0ERIOD(OWEVER ONLYONEDEBITENTRYISMADE TO THE 0ROlT AND ,OSS 3UMMARY 4HE DEPRECIATION EXPENSE ACCOUNT WOULD NEVER BE CLOSEDONITSOWN3EE#HAPTERFORAREMINDER
3UBSEQUENTPERIODS ,ETUSCONTINUETODEPRECIATETHEVAN!TTHEENDOFTHENEXTYEAR ANOTHEROF DEPRECIATIONMUSTBERECORDED4HISREPRESENTSTHEVALUEOFTHEASSETCONSUMED DURING AND SO IS ONCE AGAIN DEBITED TO $EPRECIATION OF 6AN AND CREDITED TO !CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONOF6AN
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 11
D E P R E C I AT I O N O F N O N - C U R R E N T A S S E T S
'ENERAL*OURNAL 'ENERAL,EDGER $ATE 31/12/16
$ETAILS
$EBIT
Depreciation of Van
1 200
Accumulated Depreciation of Van
#REDIT
3UBSIDIARYLEDGER $EBIT
#REDIT
1 200
Yearly depreciation on van – s/line method (Memo 12)
!FTER DEPRECIATION FOR HAS BEEN RECORDED IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER AND THE ACCOUNTSHAVEBEENCLOSEDORBALANCED THELEDGERACCOUNTSWOULDSHOW 'ENERAL,EDGER $EPRECIATIONOF6AN% $ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
!MOUNT
31/12/16 Acc. Dep. of Van
1 200
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
31/12/16 Profit and Loss Summary
1 200
!MOUNT 1 200 1 200
!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONOF6ANn! $ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
!MOUNT
$ATE
31/12/16 Balance
#ROSS REFERENCE "ALANCE
31/12/16 Dep. of Van 2 400
!MOUNT 1 200 2 400
1/1/17
Balance
2 400
4HE $EPRECIATION OF 6AN ACCOUNT HAD BEEN CLOSED AT THE END OF SO THE DEPRECIATIONEXPENSEFORWILLBETHEONLYENTRYINTHATACCOUNTUNTILITISCLOSED AGAINON$ECEMBER (OWEVER THE!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONOF6ANACCOUNTALREADYHADAbalance of $1 200THEAMOUNTACCUMULATEDFROMLASTYEAR 7HENDEPRECIATIONOF FORTHECURRENTYEAR ISRECORDED THEBALANCEOFTHISACCOUNTINCREASESTO /NCEAGAIN THEACCOUNTWOULDBEBALANCEDINREADINESSFORTHENEXTPERIOD
REVIEW QUESTIONS 11.4
1 3HOWTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESTORECORDTHEBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTFOR DEPRECIATIONEXPENSE 2 3TATE ONE REASON WHY THE LEDGER ACCOUNTS MUST NAME THE ASSET BEING DEPRECIATED 3 3TATETHEEFFECTOFDEPRECIATIONONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION 4 2EFERRING TO ONE ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLE EXPLAIN THE DIFFERENCE BETWEEN DEPRECIATIONEXPENSEANDACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATION 5 3TATETWOREASONSWHYTHE$EPRECIATIONEXPENSEACCOUNTMUSTBECLOSEDAT THEENDOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIOD 6 3TATEONEREASONWHYTHE!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONACCOUNTISBALANCEDAT THEENDOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIOD
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
247
248
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
11.5 REPORTING DEPRECIATION 4HE)NCOME3TATEMENT 2EPORTING DEPRECIATION IN THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT IS PROBABLY THE EASIEST PART OF ACCOUNTINGFORDEPRECIATION"ECAUSEDEPRECIATIONISANEXPENSE ITISREPORTEDINTHE )NCOME3TATEMENTWITHALLTHE@OTHEREXPENSES SUCHASWAGES ADVERTISINGANDRENT Figure 11.3
Income Statement: depreciation MIXWELL PAINTS )NCOME3TATEMENTFOR
2EVENUE
3ALES
,ESS#OSTOF'OODS3OLD #OSTOF3ALES
"UYING%XPENSES
'ROSS0ROlT
,ESS3TOCK,OSS
!DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlT
,ESS/THER%XPENSES 7AGES
!DVERTISING
$ISCOUNT%XPENSE
$EPRECIATIONOF6AN
2ENT
.ET0ROlT
2EMEMBER THAT IT IS ONLY THE DEPRECIATION expense THE AMOUNT CONSUMED IN THE current 2EPORTING 0ERIOD THAT IS REPORTED IN THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT !CCUMULATED DEPRECIATIONISANEGATIVEASSET NOTANEXPENSE ANDSOMUSTNOTBEREPORTEDINTHE )NCOME3TATEMENT
4HE"ALANCE3HEET 4HElRSTEFFECTOFDEPRECIATIONONTHE"ALANCE3HEETISVIAOWNERSEQUITY!SWEHAVE ALREADYSEEN DEPRECIATIONEXPENSEDECREASES.ET0ROlT)NTERMSOFTHE"ALANCE3HEET THISDECREASESOWNERSEQUITY4HESECONDEFFECTOCCURSONTHEASSETSIDE!CCUMULATED DEPRECIATIONREPORTSTHEVALUEOFTHEASSETTHATHASBEENCONSUMEDOVERITSLIFESOFAR )TISREPORTEDDIRECTLYUNDERTHEASSETITSELF ASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 11.4
Balance Sheet: accumulated depreciation MIXWELL PAINTS "ALANCE3HEETEXTRACT ASAT$ECEMBER
.ON CURRENTASSETS 6AN ,ESS!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATION
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 11
D E P R E C I AT I O N O F N O N - C U R R E N T A S S E T S
249
.OTETHATNOWINSTEADOFJUSTREPORTINGTHEASSETASONElGURE THREEAREINVOLVED Historical Cost $32 000 4OKEEPTHEREPORTSFREEFROMBIASANDTHEREFORE2ELIABLE THEASSETMUSTALWAYSBE REPORTEDINITIALLYATITS(ISTORICAL#OSTITSORIGINALPURCHASEPRICE ASTHISAMOUNTIS VERIlABLEBYREFERENCETOTHESOURCEDOCUMENT !CCUMULATEDDEPRECIATION "ECAUSESOMEOFTHEASSETSVALUEHASBEENCONSUMED ITISNOLONGERAPPROPRIATETO REPORTITATITS(ISTORICAL#OSTALONEINORDERTOENSURE2ELEVANCE THE"ALANCE3HEET MUSTALSOREPORTTHEASSETSACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATION!CCUMULATEDDEPRECIATION REPRESENTSTHETOTALVALUEOFTHEASSETTHATHASBEENCONSUMEDOVERITSLIFESOFAR PERYEARFOREACHOFTHETWOYEARSTHEASSETHASBEENUNDERTHElRMSCONTROL #ARRYINGVALUE 4HEcarrying valueISCALCULATEDBYDEDUCTINGANYACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATIONFROM THE(ISTORICAL#OSTOFTHEASSET)TREPRESENTSTHEUNALLOCATEDCOSTOFTHEASSETTHAT IS THE VALUE OF THE ASSET THAT IS YET TO BE CONSUMED AND YET TO BE ALLOCATED AS DEPRECIATION EXPENSE PLUS ANY RESIDUAL VALUE "ECAUSE THIS CARRYING VALUE IS YET TOBECONSUMED ITREPRESENTSAfutureECONOMICBENElT WHICHSHOULDBYNOWBE OBVIOUSASTHEDElNITIONOFANASSET
CARRYINGVALUE the value of a non-current asset that is yet to be consumed/allocated as an expense, plus any residual value
!S THE ASSET IS DEPRECIATED IT WILL BE THE ACCUMULATED DEPRECIATION lGURE THAT INCREASES THUSDECREASINGTHECARRYINGVALUE&OREXAMPLE THEVANOWNEDBY-IXWELL 0AINTSWILLAPPEARINSUCCESSIVE"ALANCE3HEETSASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 11.5
Balance Sheet: successive periods MIXWELL PAINTS
STUDY TIP
"ALANCE3HEETEXTRACT ASAT$ECEMBER .ON CURRENTASSETS 6AN ,ESS!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATION
32 000
32 000
32 000
32 000
#ARRYINGVALUEISALSO KNOWNASCARRYINGCOST WRITTEN DOWNVALUE UNALLOCATEDCOSTAND BOOKVALUE
2EPRESENTINGDEPRECIATIONGRAPHICALLY )NORDERTOSATISFYUnderstandability REPORTSMUSTBEPREPAREDINAMANNERTHATISREADILY UNDERSTANDABLEBYTHEUSER WITHTHEPREPARATIONOFGRAPHSONESIMPLESTRATEGYTHATCAN BEEMPLOYED0REPARINGAGRAPHCANMAKEITEASIERFORTHEOWNERTOUNDERSTANDBOTH THEIDEAOFDEPRECIATIONANDITSEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGREPORTS&OREXAMPLE &IGURE SHOWSHOWTHEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSE ACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATIONANDCARRYINGVALUE COULDBEREPRESENTEDGRAPHICALLY $35 000
Figure 11.6
$30 000
Depreciation
Graphing depreciation
$25 000
Accumulated depreciation
$20 000 $15 000
Carrying value
$10 000 $5 000 $0 2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
Year © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
250
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
4HISGRAPHCLEARLYSHOWSWHYITISCALLEDTHE@STRAIGHT LINEMETHOD ASTHEAMOUNTOF DEPRECIATIONEXPENSEISCONSTANTEVERYYEAR CREATINGASTRAIGHTLINEACROSSTHELIFEOF THEASSET 4HEACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATIONSTARTSATZEROANDGROWSATACONSTANTRATE INCREASED EVERYYEARBYTHEAMOUNTOFTHEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSE!TTHESAMETIME THECARRYING VALUESTARTSATTHE(ISTORICAL#OSTANDMOVESINEXACTLYTHEOPPOSITEDIRECTION DECREASING EVERYYEAR BYTHEAMOUNTOFTHEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSE ENDINGATTHERESIDUALVALUE IF THEGRAPHSHOWSTHEASSETSENTIREUSEFULLIFE
REVIEW QUESTIONS 11.5
1 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE EXPLAINWHYTHEORIGINALPURCHASEPRICE OFANON CURRENT ASSETMUSTBEDISCLOSEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEET 2 $ElNETHETERM@CARRYINGVALUE 3 2EFERRING TO ONE QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTIC EXPLAIN WHY NON CURRENT ASSETS MUSTBEREPORTEDATTHEIRCARRYINGVALUEINTHE"ALANCE3HEET
11.6 THE RATE OF DEPRECIATION 4HEFORMULAUSEDSOFARCALCULATESTHEamountOFDEPRECIATIONEXPENSE EXPRESSEDIN DOLLARTERMS BUTDEPRECIATIONCANALSOBEEXPRESSEDASArateAPERCENTAGEOFTHECOST $EPRECIATIONRATEFORMULA $EPRECIATIONRATEPERANNUM
$EPRECIATIONEXPENSE (ISTORICAL#OST
X
5SING THE lGURES FROM THE EARLIER EXAMPLE REGARDING THE /FlCE &URNITURE THE DEPRECIATIONRATEWOULDBECALCULATEDAS Historical Cost Residual value Useful life Depreciation expense
YEARS PERYEAR
$EPRECIATIONRATEPERANNUM $EPRECIATIONEXPENSE
(ISTORICAL#OST
X
X
PERANNUM
4HISMEANSPERANNUMOFTHEASSETSCOSTWILLBECONSUMEDeach yearFORTHE THREEYEARSOFITSLIFE 4HEMOREMATHEMATICALLYAWAREREADERSMAYATTHISPOINTBEALITTLEPUZZLED FORTHREEYEARSMEANSONLYOFTHEASSETSCOSTWILLBECONSUMEDTHATIS X YEARS7HATHAPPENSTOTHEREMAININGOFTHECOST7HYISITNOTALLOCATED ASDEPRECIATION
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 11
D E P R E C I AT I O N O F N O N - C U R R E N T A S S E T S
251
4HEANSWERISRESIDUALVALUETHEREMAINING OROF WILLBECONSUMED BYADIFFERENTENTITYWHENITTAKESCONTROLOFTHEASSET SOTHISAMOUNTCANNOTBEALLOCATED ASDEPRECIATION
#ALCULATINGDEPRECIATIONUSINGTHERATE )NSOMECASES ITMAYBETHERATEOFDEPRECIATIONTHATISGIVENRATHERTHANTHE(ISTORICAL #OST RESIDUALVALUEANDUSEFULLIFE)NTHESECASES THEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEINDOLLAR TERMS CANBECALCULATEDBYSIMPLYMULTIPLYINGTHERATEBYTHE(ISTORICAL#OST $EPRECIATIONEXPENSERATEFORMULA $EPRECIATIONEXPENSEPERANNUM $EPRECIATIONRATEX(ISTORICAL#OST
EXAMPLE
On 1 July 2015, Carlton Clothing purchased shop fittings for $9 000 (plus $900 GST). The shop fittings are to be depreciated at 15% p.a. Balance day is 30 June 2016.
$EPRECIATIONEXPENSEPERANNUM $EPRECIATIONRATEX(ISTORICAL#OST
X PERANNUM
5SINGTHEFORMULAORTHERATETOCALCULATEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEWILLPRODUCEEXACTLY THESAMEANSWERTHECHOICEOFMETHODDEPENDSONLYONTHEINFORMATIONAVAILABLE
2%6)%715%34)/.3
1 3HOWTHEFORMULAFORCALCULATINGTHERATEOFDEPRECIATION 2 3HOW THE FORMULA FOR CALCULATING DEPRECIATION EXPENSE USING THE RATE OF DEPRECIATION
THE COST OF A NON-CURRENT ASSET !SWASSTATEDATTHEBEGINNINGOFTHISCHAPTER DEPRECIATIONINVOLVESALLOCATINGTHECOST OFANON CURRENTASSETOVERITSUSEFULLIFE3OFAR WEHAVEONLYEXAMINEDASSETSWHOSE COSTISTHEIRPURCHASEPRICE(OWEVER ITISQUITECOMMONFORABUSINESSTOMODIFYAN ASSET ORINCURCOSTSFORITSINSTALLATION THATMUSTALSOBEINCLUDEDINTHISDElNITIONOF COST!FTERALL IFTHESEOTHERCOSTSWILLPROVIDEAFUTUREECONOMICBENElTover the life of the asset THENTHEYSHOULDBECLASSIlEDASNON CURRENTASSETS ANDDEPRECIATED4HE cost of a non-current assetISTHUSDElNEDASALLCOSTSINCURREDINORDERTOBRINGTHE ASSETINTOALOCATIONANDCONDITIONREADYFORUSE WHICHWILLPROVIDEABENEFITFORTHELIFE OFTHEASSET s s s s
4HECOSTOFANON CURRENTASSETMAYTHEREFOREINCLUDE THEPURCHASEPRICESUPPLIERSPRICE DELIVERYCOSTS MODIlCATIONCOSTS INSTALLATIONCOSTS
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
COSTOFANON CURRENT ASSET all costs incurred in order to bring the asset into a location and condition ready for use, which will provide a benefit for the life of the asset.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
252
EXAMPLE
UNITS 3&4
On 1 March 2015 Danny’s Donuts paid $26 000 (plus $2 600 GST) to purchase a new oven (Ch. 32). The payment covered the following costs: Supplier’s price for the oven
$22 000
Installation costs
3 000
Maintenance fee
1 000 per year
GST
2 600
Total paid
$28 600
7EHAVEALREADYNOTEDTHATTHE'34ISNOTPARTOFTHECOSTOFTHEASSET BUTWHATOF THEOTHERCOSTS "OTHTHESUPPLIERSPRICE ANDTHEINSTALLATIONCOSTS ARENECESSARYTO BRINGTHEASSETINTOACONDITIONANDLOCATIONREADYFORUSE"UTJUSTASIMPORTANTLY THEY WILLNOTBECONSUMEDINONEYEAR BUTWILLBRINGABENElTOVERTHELIFEOFTHEASSET4HIS MEANSTHEYMUSTBEINCLUDEDINTHECOSTOFTHEASSET WHICHWOULDBE
0LUS
3UPPLIERSPRICEFORTHEOVEN )NSTALLATIONCOSTS #OSTOFOVEN
4HIS lGURE OF IS THE AMOUNT TO BE USED AS THE COST IN THE CALCULATION OF DEPRECIATION 4HE MAINTENANCE FEE MAY ALSO BE A NECESSARY COST BUT IT IS A YEARLY FEE ITSBENElTWILLBECONSUMEDWITHINAYEAR4HISMEANSITISNOTPARTOFTHEVALUEOFA NON CURRENT ASSET BUT RATHER A current ASSET 0REPAID -AINTENANCE )T SHOULD NOT BE RECORDEDASPARTOFTHECOSTOFTHEOVEN BUTRATHERINITSOWNSEPARATELEDGERACCOUNT )TWOULDTHENBESUBJECTTOABALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTATTHEENDOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIOD TO CALCULATE THE MAINTENANCE INCURRED !NY COSTS WHERE THE BENElT DOES NOT EXTEND FOR THE LIFE OF THE ASSET ARE NOT INCLUDED IN THE COST OF THE ASSET BUT RATHER TREATED SEPARATELYASEXPENSESORPREPAIDEXPENSES 4HEPURCHASEOFTHEOVENWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALASSHOWN IN&IGURE Figure 11.7
Cash Payments Journal: cash purchase of a non-current asset #ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL
$ATE
$ETAILS
#HQ NO
March 1
/VEN
32
"ANK
$ISCOUNT #REDITORS 2EVENUE #ONTROL
7AGES $RAWINGS
28 600
Prepaid Maintenance 4OTALS
3UNDRIES
GST
1 000
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 11
D E P R E C I AT I O N O F N O N - C U R R E N T A S S E T S
253
4HISPURCHASEWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHELEDGERASSHOWNBELOW 'ENERAL,EDGER "ANK! $ATE March 1
#ROSS REFERENCE
!MOUNT
Balance
2 700
Cash Receipts
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
!MOUNT
-ARCH
#ASHPAYMENTS
83 000 /VEN!
$ATE -ARCH
#ROSS REFERENCE
!MOUNT
"ANK
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
!MOUNT
#ROSS REFERENCE
!MOUNT
0REPAID-AINTENANCE!
$ATE March 31
#ROSS REFERENCE Bank
!MOUNT
$ATE
1 000 '34#LEARING!,
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
March 31
Creditors Control Bank
!MOUNT
$ATE
700
March 1
2 600
31
#ROSS REFERENCE
!MOUNT
Balance
800
Bank
1 600
Debtors Control
1 300
2EMEMBERTHATTHEPAYMENTWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALON THEDATEITOCCURRED-ARCH BUTNOTPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERUNTILTOTALS ARECALCULATEDATTHEENDOFTHEMONTH-ARCH
2%6)%715%34)/.3
1 2 3 4
11.8
$ElNETHETERM@COSTASITREFERSTONON CURRENTASSETS )DENTIFYTHREECOSTSTHATMIGHTBEINCLUDEDINTHECOSTOFANON CURRENTASSET %XPLAINWHY'34ISEXCLUDEDFROMTHECOSTOFANON CURRENTASSET %XPLAINWHYYEARLYCOSTSAREEXCLUDEDFROMTHECOSTOFANON CURRENTASSET
DEPRECIATING A NON-CURRENT ASSET FOR LESS THAN A YEAR
"ECAUSE THE LIFE OF THE ASSET IS USUALLY MEASURED IN YEARS THE FORMULA WILL CALCULATE DEPRECIATIONINTERMSOFYEARS)FBYTHEENDOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIODTHElRMHASHAD CONTROLOFTHEASSETFORless than a year THEDEPRECIATIONlGUREWILLNEEDTOBEAPPLIED ONAPRO RATABASISIFTHEBUSINESSHASHADTHEASSETFORONLYONEMONTH THENONLYONE MONTHSWORTHOFDEPRECIATIONOFAYEAR SHOULDBECHARGEDASANEXPENSE
On 31 March 2015, Ferguson Plants paid $21 000 (plus $2 100 GST) for a new vehicle. It has an estimated useful life of eight years, at which point it will be disposed of for $1 800. Balance day is 30 June 2015.
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
STUDY TIP
0AYVERYCAREFUL ATTENTIONTOTHEDATE ONWHICHTHEASSET ISACQUIRED ASTHIS WILLDETERMINEHOW MANYMONTHSWORTHOF DEPRECIATIONNEEDTO BEAPPLIED
EXAMPLE
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
254
UNITS 3&4
9EARLYDEPRECIATIONWOULDBECALCULATEDASUSUAL
STUDY TIP
2ATHERTHANMULTIPLY BYFRACTIONS SUCHAS OR ITISSAFER TOMULTIPLYBYTHE NUMBEROFMONTHSOUT OFFOREXAMPLE OR(OW MANYMONTHSISOF AYEAR$IDYOUTHINK THREE4HEANSWERIS FOUR
$EPRECIATIONEXPENSE
(#n26 ,IFE
n
YEARS
PERANNUM
(OWEVER THISVEHICLEWASPURCHASEDON-ARCH SOATBALANCEDAY*UNE THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UNDER THE CONTROL OF THE BUSINESS FOR ONLY THREE MONTHS !PRIL -AYAND*UNE !SARESULT ONLYTHREEMONTHSWORTHOFDEPRECIATIONSHOULDBE CHARGEDASANEXPENSEFORTHEPERIODENDING*UNE
$EPRECIATIONEXPENSE
= =
$2 400 per annum $600
X
3/12 months
4HEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEFORTHETHREEMONTHSFROMPURCHASEUNTILBALANCEDAYIS ANDONLYTHISAMOUNTSHOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTFORTHEYEAR ENDED*UNE4HEFOLLOWINGYEAR THElRMWILLHAVECONTROLOFTHEVEHICLEFORTHE FULLMONTHS ANDSOFORTHEYEARENDED*UNEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSESHOULD BEREPORTEDAS
2%6)%715%34)/.3
1 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE EXPLAINWHYITISNOTALWAYSACCURATETO REPORTDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEPERANNUM 2 %XPLAINTHEPROCESSFORCALCULATINGDEPRECIATIONOFANASSETWHENTHElRMHAS HADCONTROLOFTHEASSETFORLESSTHANAYEAR
11.9 USE OF ESTIMATES IN CALCULATING DEPRECIATION /NEOFTHEKEYISSUESINCALCULATINGDEPRECIATIONISESTIMATINGTHEASSETSRESIDUALVALUE ANDUSEFULLIFEWITHOUTTHESEESTIMATES DEPRECIATIONCANNOTBECALCULATED(OWEVER BECAUSETHERESIDUALVALUEANDUSEFULLIFEAREestimates USINGTHEMINTHECALCULATIONOF DEPRECIATIONMEANSTHATTHEREPORTSWILLNOTBEFREEFROMBIAS4OSOMEEXTENTTHISWILL UNDERMINETHEReliabilityOFTHEACCOUNTINGREPORTS 4HE OBVIOUS QUESTION THEN ARISES WHY DEPRECIATE NON CURRENT ASSETS IF WE ARE UNDERMININGAKEYQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC4HEANSWERLIESINADIFFERENTQUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICRelevance$EPRECIATIONENSURESTHATTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTINCLUDESALL INFORMATIONTHATISUSEFULFORDECISION MAKINGABOUTPROlT BYSHOWINGTHECONSUMPTION OFNON CURRENTASSETSINTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD3IMILARLY BYSHOWINGACCUMULATED
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 11
D E P R E C I AT I O N O F N O N - C U R R E N T A S S E T S
255
DEPRECIATION IN THE "ALANCE 3HEET IT ENSURES THAT ASSETS ARE SHOWN AT THEIR CARRYING VALUE WHICHISVITALFORDECISION MAKINGABOUTTHEIRREPLACEMENT )NTHISSENSE RelevanceOVERRIDESReliabilitySOTHATTHEACCOUNTINGREPORTSFULlLTHEIR FUNCTIONOFPROVIDINGUSEFULlNANCIALINFORMATIONNOTACCOUNTINGFORANYDEPRECIATIONAT ALLWOULDBEMOREINCORRECTTHANACCOUNTINGFORDEPRECIATIONUSINGESTIMATES
2%6)%715%34)/.3
1 %XPLAINHOWDEPRECIATIONCANUNDERMINETHEReliability OFACCOUNTINGREPORTS 2 %XPLAINHOWDEPRECIATIONENSURESRelevance INTHE s )NCOME3TATEMENT s "ALANCE3HEET
7(%2%(!6%7%"%%. s $EPRECIATIONISTHEALLOCATIONOFTHECOSTOFANON CURRENTASSETOVERITSUSEFULLIFE s 4HE PURPOSE OF DEPRECIATION IS TO ENSURE THAT AN ACCURATE PROlT IS CALCULATED BY COMPARING REVENUES EARNED AGAINST EXPENSES INCURRED IN THE CURRENT 2EPORTING 0ERIOD s 4HE STRAIGHT LINE METHOD ASSUMES THAT NON CURRENT ASSETS CONTRIBUTE EVENLY TO REVENUEOVERTHEIRLIFE!SARESULT DEPRECIATIONEXPENSEISALLOCATEDEVENOVERTHE ASSETSLIFE s 4HE COST OF AN ASSET INCLUDES ALL COSTS INCURRED IN ORDER TO BRING THE ASSET INTO A LOCATIONANDCONDITIONREADYFORUSE WHICHWILLPROVIDEABENElTFORTHELIFEOFTHE ASSET s "ECAUSE RESIDUAL VALUE AND USEFUL LIFE ARE ESTIMATES DEPRECIATION MEANS THAT THE REPORTSWILLBELESSFREEFROMBIASReliability s 7ITHOUTDEPRECIATION THEREPORTSWILLNOTINCLUDEALLINFORMATIONTHATISUSEFULFOR DECISION MAKINGRelevance
EXERCISE 11.1 CALCULATION OF DEPRECIATION
W B
page 224
EXERCISES
/N*ULY 3HOVELAND3HIFTPURCHASEDNEW/FlCE&URNITUREFORPLUS'34 )TISEXPECTEDTHATTHEOFlCEFURNITUREWILLHAVEAUSEFULLIFEOFlVEYEARS ANDWILLBE DISPOSEDOFATTHATTIMEFOR Required a $ElNETHETERM@DEPRECIATION B #ALCULATEDEPRECIATIONOFTHEOFlCEFURNITUREFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE C %XPLAINWHYTHE'34PAIDONTHEPURCHASEOFTHEOFlCEFURNITUREISNOTINCLUDEDIN THECALCULATIONOFDEPRECIATION
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
256
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 11.2 CALCULATION OF DEPRECIATION
W B
page 225
/N*ULY &RAGRANT0ERFUMESPURCHASEDSHELVINGFORPLUS'34 4HESHELVINGHASANESTIMATEDUSEFULLIFEOFEIGHTYEARS WITHARESIDUALVALUEOF Required a 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE EXPLAINWHYITISNECESSARYTODEPRECIATENON CURRENTASSETS B #ALCULATEDEPRECIATIONOFTHESHELVINGFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE C %XPLAINWHYTHERESIDUALVALUEOFTHESHELVINGISDEDUCTEDFROMITS(ISTORICAL#OSTIN THECALCULATIONOFDEPRECIATIONEXPENSE d %XPLAINTHEEFFECTOFDEPRECIATIONONTHElRMSBANKBALANCE
EXERCISE 11.3 RECORDING DEPRECIATION
W B
page 226
/N*ULY 2OAMIN"LINDSPURCHASEDNEWBLIND CUTTINGEQUIPMENT PAYING CASHINCLUDING'344HEEQUIPMENTISEXPECTEDTOLASTFORSIXYEARS ATWHICHTIMEITWILL HAVEARESIDUALVALUEOF/N*UNE THEACCOUNTINGDEPARTMENTRECEIVED -EMOTOSAYTHATDEPRECIATIONONTHEEQUIPMENTHADNOTYETBEENRECORDED Required a #ALCULATEDEPRECIATIONOFTHEEQUIPMENTFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE B 3HOWTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDDEPRECIATIONOFEQUIPMENT FORTHEYEARENDED*UNE C 0OST THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES FROM PART @B TO THE RELEVANT ACCOUNTS IN THE 'ENERAL,EDGEROF2OAMIN"LINDS d 3HOWHOW%QUIPMENTWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF2OAMIN"LINDSAS AT*UNE e 2EFERRINGTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC EXPLAINWHYTHEASSETMUSTBESHOWNIN THE"ALANCE3HEETATITSCARRYINGVALUE
EXERCISE 11.4 DEPRECIATION AND THE BALANCE SHEET
W B
page 228
*UNGLE*ANESELLSGYMEQUIPMENT)TSOWNERHASPRESENTEDTHEFOLLOWINGEXTRACTFROM THElRMS"ALANCE3HEET *5.',%*!.% "ALANCE3HEETEXTRACT ASAT*UNE
.ON #URRENT!SSETS /FlCE&URNITURE n!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATION
Additional information: s 4HE/FlCE&URNITUREHASANESTIMATEDRESIDUALVALUEOF s 4HE)NCOME3TATEMENTFORTHEYEARENDED*UNESHOWED$EPRECIATIONOF /FlCE&URNITUREOF
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 11
D E P R E C I AT I O N O F N O N - C U R R E N T A S S E T S
Required a %XPLAINWHATISREPRESENTEDBYTHEAMOUNTSLABELLED AND B 3HOWTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDDEPRECIATIONOFOFlCEFURNITURE FORTHEYEARENDED*UNE.ARRATIONIS NOT REQUIRED C 0OST THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES FROM PART @B TO THE RELEVANT ACCOUNTS IN THE 'ENERAL,EDGER d 3HOWHOW/FlCE&URNITUREWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETASAT*UNE e #ALCULATETHEUSEFULLIFEOFTHE/FlCE&URNITURE
EXERCISE 11.5 DEPRECIATION RATE
W B
page 230
/N *ULY +NIGHTS 0RAWNS PURCHASED NEW CABINETS FOR PLUS '34 )TISDECIDEDTHATTHECABINETSWILLBEDEPRECIATEDUSINGTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHODAT PERANNUM-EMO Required a #ALCULATEDEPRECIATIONOFTHECABINETSFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE B 3HOWTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDDEPRECIATIONOFCABINETSFOR THEYEARENDED*UNE C 3HOWHOWTHE$EPRECIATIONOF#ABINETSAND!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONOF#ABINETS ACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERAFTERALLBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTS AND CLOSINGANDBALANCINGENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE d 3TATETHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONASAT*UNEIFTHEADJUSTMENTFOR DEPRECIATIONWASNOTMADE e 3HOWHOWTHE#ABINETSWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETASAT*UNE
EXERCISE 11.6 COST OF A NON-CURRENT ASSET
W B
page 232
/N*ULY %ILEENS,ADDERSPURCHASEDACOMPUTER LINKEDCASHREGISTERSYSTEMFOR PLUS'34 ANDPAIDANADDITIONALCOSTOFPLUS'34FORANANNUALSOFTWARE LICENCEFEE%ILEENDECIDEDTOUSETHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHODOFDEPRECIATION DETERMINING THATTHESYSTEMWILLHAVEAUSEFULLIFEOFlVEYEARSANDARESIDUALVALUEOF Required a %XPLAINWHYTHESOFTWARELICENCEFEESHOULDNOTBEINCLUDEDINTHECOSTOFTHECASH REGISTER B 3HOWHOWTHESOFTWARELICENCEFEEWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETASAT *ULY C #ALCULATEDEPRECIATIONOFTHECASHREGISTERFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE d #ALCULATETHERATEOFDEPRECIATIONONTHECASHREGISTER e 3HOWHOWTHE#ASH2EGISTERWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETASAT*UNE F 3TATETHEEFFECTOFTHEDEPRECIATIONOFTHECASHREGISTERONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION OF%ILEENS,ADDERSASAT*UNE
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
257
258
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
%8%2#)3% COST OF AN NCA, DEPRECIATION FOR LESS THAN ONE YEAR
W B
page 233
/N!PRIL -ATTS-ATSPAIDCASHFORANEWDELIVERYVAN4HEDOCUMENTFORTHE PURCHASEISSHOWNBELOW
Dan’s Vans
TAX INVOICE: X36
Dan’s Vans
105 Blackburn Rd Nunawading VIC 3110 ABN: 173 254 009
CASH SALE:
-ATTS-ATS .AISMITH3T "LACKBURN6)# !".
Details
!PRIL 2015
$ELIVERYVAN &ITTINGOFSHELVES 3ERVICECONTRACTMONTHS '34
Total
4OTALPRICE
$26 070
!MOUNTRECEIVED
$26 070
"ALANCEOWING
NIL
-ATTEXPECTSTOHAVETHEDELIVERYVANFORlVEYEARSANDTHENDISPOSEOFITFOR Required a B C d e
#ALCULATETHECOSTOFTHEDELIVERYVAN 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@A EXPLAINYOURTREATMENTOF@lTTINGOFSHELVES #ALCULATEDEPRECIATIONOFTHEVANFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE #ALCULATETHERATEOFDEPRECIATIONONTHEVAN 3HOWHOWTHESERVICECONTRACTWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF-ATTS -ATSASAT*UNE F 3HOWHOWTHE6ANWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF-ATTS-ATSASAT *UNE
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 11
D E P R E C I AT I O N O F N O N - C U R R E N T A S S E T S
EXERCISE 11.8 DEPRECIATION FOR LESS THAN ONE YEAR
W B
page 235
3CRATCHAND$ENT$ISCOUNTERSPRESENTTHEFOLLOWINGEXTRACTFROMTHEIR"ALANCE3HEETAS AT*ULY SCRATCH AND DENT DISCOUNTERS "ALANCE3HEETEXTRACT ASAT*ULY
.ON #URRENT!SSETS /FlCE&URNITURE n!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATION
Additional information: s ! SPECIALLY DESIGNED OFlCE CHAIR WAS PURCHASED ON *ANUARY FOR PLUS'34 s /FlCE &URNITURE IS DEPRECIATED AT PER ANNUM USING THE STRAIGHT LINE METHOD -EMO Required a 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE EXPLAINWHYTHE/FlCE&URNITURESHOULDBE DEPRECIATED B #ALCULATEDEPRECIATIONOFTHE/FlCE&URNITUREFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE C 3HOWTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDDEPRECIATIONOFOFlCEFURNITURE FORTHEYEARENDED*UNE d 3HOWHOWTHE$EPRECIATIONOF/FlCE&URNITUREAND!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONOF /FlCE&URNITUREACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERAFTERALLCLOSINGAND BALANCINGENTRIESAREMADE e 3HOWHOW/FlCE&URNITUREWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF3CRATCHAND $ENTASAT*UNE
EXERCISE 11.9 DEPRECIATION FOR LESS THAN A YEAR
W B
page 237
!SAT*UNE &ROST&RIDGESHADSHOPlTTINGSTHATHADBEENPURCHASEDFOR BUTHADACURRENTCARRYINGVALUEOF/N-ARCH INCLUDING'34 WASPAIDFORADDITIONALSHOPlTTINGS$EPRECIATIONISALLOCATEDUSINGTHESTRAIGHT LINE METHODATTHERATEOFPERANNUM-EMO Required a #ALCULATETHE ACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATIONOFTHESHOPlTTINGSASAT*UNE B #ALCULATEDEPRECIATIONOFTHESHOPlTTINGSFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE C 3HOWTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDDEPRECIATIONOFSHOPlTTINGS FORTHEYEARENDED*UNE d 3HOW HOW THE $EPRECIATION OF 3HOP &ITTINGS AND !CCUMULATED $EPRECIATION OF 3HOP &ITTINGS ACCOUNTS WOULD APPEAR IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER AFTER ALL CLOSING AND BALANCINGENTRIESAREMADE e 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE EXPLAIN WHYTHEORIGINALPURCHASEPRICEOF THEASSETISDISCLOSEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEET F 3HOWHOWTHE3HOP&ITTINGSWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF&ROST&RIDGES ASAT*UNE
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
259
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
260
UNITS 3&4
%8%2#)3% REPORTING DEPRECIATION
W B
page 239
4IM"ARROWNS(ACKAND3AW ASTORESPECIALISINGINTHESALEOFSAWS CHAINSAWSANDAXES 4HEBUSINESSHASPROVIDEDITS0RE ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCEASAT*UNE HACK AND SAW 0RE ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCEASAT*UNE !CCOUNT
$EBIT
!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONn$ISPLAY%QUIPMENT !DMINISTRATIVE%XPENSES
"ANK
#APITALn"ARR #OSTOF3ALES
#REDIT3ALES
$EBTORS#ONTROL
$ISPLAY%QUIPMENT
$RAWINGS
'34#LEARING )NTEREST%XPENSE
,OANn$2&INANCEREPAYABLEPERMONTH 0REPAID!DVERTISING
2ENT%XPENSE
3TOCK#ONTROL
7AGES
4OTALS
#REDIT
Additional information: s s s s s
!PHYSICALSTOCKTAKEON*UNESHOWEDSTOCKONHAND 4HEDISPLAYEQUIPMENTISTOBEDEPRECIATEDATPA !SEVEN MONTHADVERTISINGCAMPAIGNWASPAIDINADVANCEON&EBRUARY !PAYMENTOFADMINISTRATIVEEXPENSESHASBEENINCORRECTLYPOSTEDTO7AGES 2EPORTSAREPREPAREDYEARLY
Required
* *
*
a %XPLAINTHEPURPOSEOFBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTS B 3HOW THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD THE ADDITIONAL INFORMATION .ARRATIONSARE NOTREQUIRED C 0REPAREA0OST ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCEFOR(ACKAND3AWASAT*UNE d 3HOW THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO CLOSE THE LEDGER AND TRANSFER $RAWINGSTOTHE#APITALACCOUNT.ARRATIONSNOTREQUIRED e 0REPAREAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR(ACKAND3AWFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE F !SSESSTHEMARK UPAPPLIEDBY(ACKAND3AWFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE G 3TATETWOACTIONS(ACKAND3AWCOULDTAKETOIMPROVE.ET0ROlTWITHOUTCHANGING !DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlT h 0REPAREACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR(ACKAND3AWASAT*UNE I $ISCUSSWHETHERTHEAMOUNTOFDRAWINGSTAKENBYTHEOWNERINTHEYEARENDED *UNEISAPPROPRIATE
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 11
D E P R E C I AT I O N O F N O N - C U R R E N T A S S E T S
EXERCISE 11.11 REPORTING DEPRECIATION
W B
page 243
.GUYEN 3KI 'EAR HAS PROVIDED THE FOLLOWING 0RE ADJUSTMENT 4RIAL "ALANCE AS AT $ECEMBER NGUYEN SKI GEAR 0RE ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCEASAT$ECEMBER !CCOUNT
$EBIT
Accumulated Depreciation – Vehicle Bank
8 000 2 400
Capital – Nguyen Cost of Sales
32 620 48 000
Creditors Control Debtors Control Discount Expense
#REDIT
18 000 16 000 820
Discount Revenue Drawings
300 14 000
GST Clearing Interest Expense
700 1 400
Loan – NAB (repayable $9 000 p.a.) Prepaid Rent
21 000 18 000
Sales
120 000
Stock Control
24 000
Vehicle
40 000
Wages
36 000
4OTALS
Additional information: s s s s s
!PHYSICALSTOCKTAKEON$ECEMBERSHOWEDSTOCKONHAND 4HEVEHICLEISTOBEDEPRECIATEDATPA !SAT$ECEMBER WAGESWERESTILLOWINGTOEMPLOYEES 0REPAIDRENTASAT$ECEMBERWAS 4HELASTREPORTSWEREPREPAREDON*UNE
Required
*
*
a 3HOW THE 'ENERAL *OURNALENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD THE ADDITIONALINFORMATION .ARRATIONSARE NOTREQUIRED B 0REPAREA0OST ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCEFOR.GUYEN3KI'EARASAT$ECEMBER C 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE EXPLAINTHEPURPOSEOFCLOSINGENTRIES d 3HOW THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO CLOSE THE LEDGER AND TRANSFER $RAWINGSTOTHE#APITALACCOUNT.ARRATIONSNOTREQUIRED e 0REPARE AN )NCOME 3TATEMENT FOR .GUYEN 3KI 'EAR FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED $ECEMBER F %XPLAIN WHAT THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT REVEALS ABOUT THE REPUTATION OF .GUYEN 3KI 'EAR
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
261
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
262
*
UNITS 3&4
G 0REPAREACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR.GUYEN3KI'EARASAT$ECEMBER h 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@G IDENTIFYONEITEMTHATCANBEUSEDTOSUPPORT THEVIEWTHATTHElRMSlNANCIALPOSITIONISSOUND*USTIFYYOURANSWER
EXERCISE 11.12 ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
W B
page 247
/N-ARCH THESHOPlTTINGSOF&UNK&ASHIONSWEREDESTROYEDINAlRE SOTHE OWNER#OLIN-ILLER CONTRIBUTEDSOMElTTINGSTHATHEHADPURCHASEDFORHISOWNHOME -EMO #OLINHADPURCHASEDTHElTTINGSIN PAYING BUTATTHEENDOF &EBRUARYHADTHEMPROFESSIONALLYVALUEDAT(ECALCULATESTHATTHEYWILLBE OFUSEFORFOURYEARS ANDBYTHEENDOFTHEIRUSEFULLIFEHEEXPECTSTOSELLTHEMFOR Required a 3HOWTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHECONTRIBUTIONOFTHESHOP lTTINGSBYTHEOWNERON-ARCH B 2EFERRINGTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC JUSTIFYYOURVALUATIONOFTHESHOPlTTINGS ASAT-ARCH C #ALCULATEDEPRECIATIONOFTHESHOPlTTINGSFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE d 3HOWTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORD$EPRECIATIONOF3HOP&ITTINGS FORTHEYEARENDED*UNE.ARRATIONIS NOT REQUIRED e 3HOW HOW THE FOLLOWING ACCOUNTS WOULD APPEAR IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER AS AT *UNE AFTERALLBALANCINGANDCLOSINGENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE3HOP&ITTINGS $EPRECIATIONOF3HOP&ITTINGS AND!CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONOF3HOP&ITTINGS F 3HOWHOW3HOP&ITTINGSWOULDAPPEARINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF&UNK&ASHIONSASAT *UNEAND
EXERCISE 11.13 ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
W B
page 249
/N /CTOBER -ARK 2ENDLE PURCHASED A NEW DELIVERY VAN FOR HIS BUSINESS 2ENDLE #LOTHING 4HE VAN WAS ADVERTISED FOR PLUS '34 BUT -ARK BARGAINED WITHTHESALESPERSONWHOAGREEDTOPROVIDETHEVANANDWORTHOFON ROADCOSTS FORINCLUDING'34)NSTALLATIONOFHEAVY DUTYSUSPENSIONCOSTAFURTHERPLUS '34 AND-ARKHASINSUREDTHEVANFORlREANDTHEFTWITH//-9)NSURANCEATANANNUAL COSTOFPLUS'344HEVANISEXPECTEDTOHAVEAUSEFULLIFEOFlVEYEARS AFTER WHICH-ARKCANTRADEITINONANEWONE)TWILLHAVEATRADE INVALUEOFAPPROXIMATELY Required a #ALCULATETHECOSTOFTHEVANPURCHASEDON/CTOBER B 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@A EXPLAINYOURTREATMENTOF s THEHEAVY DUTYSUSPENSION s INSURANCE C 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE EXPLAINWHYTHEENTIRECOSTOFTHEVANCANNOT BETREATEDASANEXPENSEINTHEYEARENDED*UNE d #ALCULATE DEPRECIATION OF THE VAN FOR THE YEAR ENDED *UNE USING THE STRAIGHT LINEMETHOD e 3HOWTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHEDEPRECIATIONOFTHEVAN FORTHEYEARENDED*UNE.ARRATIONIS NOTREQUIRED F 2EFERRINGTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC EXPLAINWHYTHEVANSHOULDNOTBEVALUED ONLYATITS(ISTORICAL#OSTINTHE"ALANCE3HEETASAT*UNE G )N*ULY THEDELIVERYDRIVERFELLILL SOTHEVANWASNOTUSEDFORDELIVERIESFORTWO MONTHS%XPLAINWHETHERTHEVANSHOULDBEDEPRECIATEDFOR*ULYAND!UGUST © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s EXPLAINTHENEEDTOREPORTFOR CASH s PREPAREA3TATEMENTOF 2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTS s EXPLAINTHEROLEOFCASH JOURNALSINREPORTINGFORCASH s DElNETHETERMS@CASH SURPLUSAND@CASHDElCIT s DElNEANDIDENTIFY /PERATING )NVESTINGAND &INANCINGCASHmOWS
s PREPAREA#ASH&LOW 3TATEMENT s EXPLAINTHEUSESOFTHE#ASH &LOW3TATEMENT s EXPLAINTHEDIFFERENCE BETWEENCASHANDPROlT AND IDENTIFYREASONSWHYAlRMS CASHANDPROlTPERFORMANCE MAYDIFFER
CHAPTER 12
THE CASH FLOW STATEMENT KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s 3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTS s CASHSURPLUS s CASHDElCIT s #ASH&LOW3TATEMENT s /PERATING!CTIVITIES s )NVESTING!CTIVITIES s &INANCING!CTIVITIES © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
264
UNITS 3&4
12.1 THE NEED TO REPORT FOR CASH !CCOUNTINGEXISTSASANINFORMATIONSYSTEM!SPARTOFTHATSYSTEM ACCOUNTINGREPORTS HAVE THE FUNCTION OF COMMUNICATING lNANCIAL INFORMATION TO THE OWNER TO ASSIST DECISION MAKING4HELASTFEWCHAPTERSFROMDETERMININGPROlTORLOSSIN#HAPTERTO DEPRECIATIONIN#HAPTER HAVEBEENCONCERNEDMAINLYWITHREPORTINGFORPROlTAND GIVENTHATEARNINGAPROlTISTHEPRIMARYREASONFORBEINGINBUSINESS THISISCERTAINLY AVALIDCONCERN!FTERALL OWNERSMUSTHAVEACCURATEINFORMATIONABOUTREVENUESAND EXPENSESIFTHEYARETOIMPROVETHETRADINGPERFORMANCEOFTHEIRlRMS (OWEVER MANYPROlTABLEBUSINESSESSTILLFAILBECAUSETHEYHAVENOTPAIDSUFlCIENT ATTENTIONTOMANAGINGTHEIRCASH-ANYSMALLBUSINESSOWNERSINCORRECTLY ASSUMETHAT CASHANDPROlTARETHESAMETHING ANDTHATIFTHEYCANSELLTHEIRPRODUCTSATAPROlTTHEN THEYWILLAUTOMATICALLYHAVECASHAVAILABLETOPAYTHEIRDEBTS5NFORTUNATELY THISISNOT THECASE#ASHANDPROlTAREDIFFERENTMEASURESOFPERFORMANCE ANDTHEREAREMANY POSSIBLEREASONSWHYAlRMTHATISEARNINGAPROlTCANSTILLSUFFERFROMALACKOFCASH 'IVENTHATCASHANDPROlTAREDIFFERENT ITISIMPORTANTTHATTHEOWNERISPROVIDED WITHDIFFERENTINFORMATIONONBOTHITEMS)FYOUARESTILLQUESTIONINGWHETHERCASHAND PROlTAREACTUALLYDIFFERENTTHINGS SKIPAHEADTO@#ASHVERSUSPROlTONPAGE TOMAKESURE 7ITHOUTINFORMATIONONBOTHCASHANDPROlT THEOWNERWILLNOTBEABLE TO MANAGE BOTH EFFECTIVELY #HAPTER CONSIDERED REPORTING FOR PROlT THIS CHAPTER CONSIDERSREPORTINGFORCASH Cash and profit are different measures of performance, and there are many possible reasons why a firm that is earning a profit can still suffer from a lack of cash
REVIEW QUESTIONS 12.1
1 %XPLAINTHEBASICFUNCTIONOFALLACCOUNTINGREPORTS 2 %XPLAINWHYITISIMPORTANTTOREPORTONBOTHCASHANDPROlT
3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTS AND0AYMENTS an accounting report that details cash received and paid during a Reporting Period, and the change in the firm’s bank balance over that period
12.2 THE STATEMENT OF RECEIPTS AND PAYMENTS 4HEMOSTBASICWAYOFREPORTINGONCASHISTODETAILCASHreceivedANDCASHpaidDURING THEPERIOD ANDTHENIDENTIFYTHECHANGEINTHElRMSBANKBALANCE4HISISACHIEVEDBY PREPARINGAStatement of Receipts and Payments ! TYPICAL 3TATEMENT OF 2ECEIPTS AND 0AYMENTS WOULD LOOK LIKE THE ONE SHOWN IN &IGURE )N COMMON WITH ALL ACCOUNTING REPORTS THIS STATEMENT IDENTIlES THE who -AKRIS -ANCHESTER THEwhat3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTS ANDTHEwhenTHEQUARTER ENDED$ECEMBER ABOUTWHICHITISREPORTING!SWITHTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT THEWHENREFERSTOAPERIODOFMORETHANONEDAY ANDSOSTATESTHATITISforTHEQUARTER RATHERTHANas at WHICHAPPLIESTOTHE"ALANCE3HEET
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 12
Figure 12.1
T H E C A S H F L O W S TAT E M E N T
265
Statement of Receipts and Payments MAKRIS MANCHESTER
3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTSFORTHEQUARTERENDED$ECEMBER $
#ASH2ECEIPTS Cash Sales
43 000
Receipts from Debtors
41 500
Loan – Aust. Bank
25 000
Capital Contribution
5 000
GST Received
4 300
$
118 800
,ESS#ASH0AYMENTS Payments to Creditors
61 400
Wages
31 000
Drawings
12 700
GST Paid
1 170
Electricity
500
Prepaid Insurance
1 200
Shelving
10 000
Interest Expense
600
Loan – Aust. Bank
2 000
Office Equipment
4 500
125 070
3URPLUS$ElCIT
!DD"ANK"ALANCEATSTART/CTOBER
"ANK"ALANCEATEND$ECEMBER
"YLISTINGTHESOURCESOFCASHCASHRECEIPTS ANDUSESOFTHATCASHCASHPAYMENTS THISREPORTALLOWSTHEOWNERTOIDENTIFYWHETHERTHElRMSCASHBALANCEHASINCREASEDOR DECREASED ANDTHEMAINREASONSWHYTHISHASOCCURRED
2OLEOFTHECASHJOURNALS 4HEINFORMATIONREPORTEDINTHESTATEMENTABOVECOULDBEGARNEREDDIRECTLYFROMTHE SOURCEDOCUMENTSCASHRECEIPTSANDCHEQUEBUTTS BUTTHISINFORMATIONWOULDNOTBE CLASSIlEDORSUMMARISEDINANYWAY)NSTEAD THE3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTSIS BASEDONTHECASHJOURNALSTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALPROVIDESTHEINFORMATIONRELATING TOCASHRECEIVED ANDTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALDETAILSCASHPAID &URTHER THE3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTSDOESNOTREPORTINDIVIDUALAMOUNTS BUTRATHERCOLUMN TOTALS SUCHAStotalCASHRECEIVEDFROMDEBTORSANDtotalCASHSALES ORtotalCASHPAIDTOCREDITORSANDtotalCASHDRAWINGS4HEOBVIOUSEXCEPTIONISTHE SUNDRIESCOLUMN"YDElNITION THETRANSACTIONSRECORDEDINTHISCOLUMNAREINFREQUENT ANDSOMUSTBEREPORTEDINDIVIDUALLY
3URPLUSDElCIT "YDEDUCTINGPAYMENTSFROMRECEIPTS THEcash surplusORcash deficitCANBECALCULATED Surplus (Deficit)
=
Cash Receipts
–
Cash Payments
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
CASHSURPLUS an excess of cash receipts over cash payments, leading to an increase in the bank balance CASHDElCIT an excess of cash payments over cash receipts, leading to a decrease in the bank balance
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
266
UNITS 3&4
!CASHSURPLUSOCCURSWHENCASHRECEIVEDISgreaterTHANCASHPAIDDURINGTHEPERIOD ANDWILLLEADTOANOVERALLINCREASEINTHEBANKBALANCE!CASHDElCITOCCURSWHENCASH RECEIVEDISlessTHANCASHPAID ANDWILLLEADTOANOVERALLDECREASEINTHEBANKBALANCE
REVIEW QUESTIONS 12.2
1 %XPLAINTHEFUNCTIONOFA3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTS 2 %XPLAIN WHY THE INFORMATION REPORTED IN THE 3TATEMENT OF 2ECEIPTS AND 0AYMENTSISTAKENFROMTHECASHJOURNALSRATHERTHANDIRECTLYFROMTHESOURCE DOCUMENTS $ElNETHEFOLLOWINGTERMS s CASHSURPLUS s CASHDElCIT 4 2EFERRING TO &IGURE STATE ONE REASON WHY THE OWNER MIGHT NOT BE CONCERNEDABOUTTHElRMS#ASH0OSITION 2EFERRING TO &IGURE EXPLAIN ONE REASON WHY THE OWNER SHOULD BE CONCERNEDABOUTTHElRMSCASHPERFORMANCE
#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT an accounting report that details all cash inflows and outflows from Operating, Investing and Financing activities, and the overall change in the firm’s cash balance /PERATINGACTIVITIES cash flows related to dayto-day trading activities )NVESTINGACTIVITIES cash flows related to the purchase and sale of noncurrent assets &INANCINGACTIVITIES cash flows related to changes in the financial structure of the firm
STUDY TIP
THE CASH FLOW STATEMENT 7HILETHE3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTSISAGOODSTARTINGPOINTFORASSESSING CHANGESINTHElRMS#ASH0OSITION ITISSOMEWHATLIMITEDINITSUSES BECAUSEITONLY CLASSIlES THE CASH TRANSACTIONS AS RECEIPTS OR PAYMENTS )NFORMATION ABOUT CASH IS MOREUSEFULFORDECISION MAKINGIFITCLASSIlESCOMMONSOURCESANDUSESOFCASH AND SEPARATELYIDENTIlESTHEIREFFECTONTHEBANKBALANCE4HE Cash Flow StatementREPORTS ON CASH INmOWS CASH RECEIVED AND CASH OUTmOWS CASH PAID SEPARATELY IDENTIFYING CASHmOWSRELATINGTO/PERATINGACTIVITIES )NVESTINGACTIVITIESAND&INANCINGACTIVITIES
/PERATINGACTIVITIES Operating activities REFERS TO ALL CASH mOWS RELATED TO THE lRMS DAY TO DAY TRADING ACTIVITIESOperating inflowsMAYINCLUDECASHSALES RECEIPTSFROMDEBTORS '34RECEIVED ANDANYOTHERCASHREVENUESOperating outflowsMAYINCLUDEALLPAYMENTSRELATEDTO EXPENSESINCLUDINGINTEREST PAYMENTSTOCREDITORS '34PAID PREPAIDEXPENSES AND ANYPAYMENTSFOREXPENSESINCURREDINPREVIOUSPERIODSSUCHASACCRUEDWAGES
)NVESTINGACTIVITIES Investing activitiesARECASHmOWSRELATINGTOTHEPURCHASEORSALEOFNON CURRENTASSETS )NPRACTICETHISWILLMEANTHEREAREONLYTWOPOSSIBLE)NVESTINGITEMSCASHRECEIVEDFROM THESALEOFANON CURRENTASSETInvesting inflow ANDCASHPAIDFORTHEPURCHASEOFANON CURRENTASSETInvesting outflow
&INANCINGACTIVITIES 'IVENTHAT5NITOF THISCOURSEDOESNOT INCLUDETHESALEOFNON CURRENTASSETS THEONLY )NVESTINGACTIVITYWE ARELIKELYTOSEEINTHE MID YEAREXAMISTHE CASHPURCHASEOFANON CURRENTASSET
Financing activitiesARECASHmOWSTHATARETHERESULTOFCHANGESINTHElRMSlNANCIAL STRUCTURE)NESSENCE THISWILLMEANONLYCASHTRANSACTIONSTHATCHANGELOANSANDOWNERS EQUITY SUCH AS RECEIVING OR REPAYING THE PRINCIPAL OF A LOAN OR CASH CONTRIBUTIONS OR DRAWINGSBYTHEOWNER 5SING THE SAME INFORMATION THAT WAS REPORTED IN THE 3TATEMENT OF 2ECEIPTS AND 0AYMENTSIN&IGURE THE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR-AKRIS-ANCHESTERWOULDAPPEAR ASISSHOWNIN&IGURE
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 12
Figure 12.2
T H E C A S H F L O W S TAT E M E N T
Cash Flow Statement
267
STUDY TIP
MAKRIS MANCHESTER
2ESISTTHETEMPTATION TOCLASSIFYINTERESTAS @&INANCING)NTEREST ISAPAYMENTFORAN EXPENSE SOINTERESTIS ALWAYS@/PERATING
#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFORTHEQUARTERENDED$ECEMBER $
$
CASH FLOW FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES #ASH)NmOWS Cash Sales
43 000
Receipts from Debtors
41 500
GST Received
4 300
88 800
,ESS#ASH/UTmOWS Payments to Creditors
61 400
Wages
31 000
GST Paid Electricity Prepaid Insurance Interest Expense
1 170 500 1 200 600
.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM/PERATIONS
95 870 STUDY TIP
CASH FLOW FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES #ASH)NmOWS Nil
)FNOINmOWEXISTS THIS INFORMATIONMAYBE OMITTED
0
,ESS#ASH/UTmOWS Shelving Office Equipment
10 000 4 500
.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM)NVESTING!CTIVITIES
14 500
CASH FLOW FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES #ASH)NmOWS Loan – Aust. Bank Capital Contribution
25 000 5 000
STUDY TIP
30 000
,ESS#ASH/UTmOWS Drawings Loan – Aust. Bank
12 700 2 000
14 700
.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM&INANCING!CTIVITIES
15 300
.ET)NCREASE$ECREASE IN#ASH0OSITION
!DD"ANK"ALANCEATSTART/CTOBER
"ANK"ALANCEATEND$ECEMBER
)FTHEREAREINSUFlCIENT LINESTOINCLUDETHE HEADINGS@#ASHINmOWS OR@#ASHOUTmOWS ITEMSMAYJUSTBELISTED BUTOUTmOWSSHOULDBE INBRACKETS
.ETINCREASEDECREASE IN#ASH0OSITION 4HENETINCREASEOR INTHISCASE DECREASE IN#ASH0OSITIONOF $6 270 ISCALCULATEDBY ADDINGTOGETHERTHE.ET#ASH&LOWSFROMEACHACTIVITY
.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM/PERATIONS
.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM)NVESTING!CTIVITIES
.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM&INANCING!CTIVITIES
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
268
STUDY TIP
7HENCLASSIFYINGCASH mOWS WORKFROMTHE BOTTOMUPIDENTIFY THE&INANCINGAND )NVESTINGACTIVITIESlRST SOYOUKNOWTHATTHE REMAINDERMUSTBE /PERATINGACTIVITIES
UNITS 3&4
)T CAN ALSO BE CALCULATED BY DEDUCTING TOTAL PAYMENTS AS SHOWN IN THE #ASH 0AYMENTS*OURNAL FROMTOTALRECEIPTSASSHOWNINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL %ITHER WAY THEANSWERSHOULDBETHESAME ANDREmECTTHETOTAL ORNET CHANGEINTHElRMS BANKBALANCEFROMTHESTARTOFTHEPERIODTOTHEEND .OTETHATTHElNALlGUREINTHISSTATEMENTnBank Balance at EndnISEXACTLYTHE SAMEASTHATGENERATEDINTHE3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTS$7 230!FTERALL BOTHSTATEMENTSREPORTEXACTLYTHESAMEITEMSTHEONLYDIFFERENCEISTHATTHE#ASH&LOW 3TATEMENTclassifiesTHECASHmOWSAS/PERATING )NVESTINGAND&INANCINGACTIVITIES
5SESOFTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT 0OORMANAGEMENTOFCASHISONEOFTHEMAINREASONSWHYSMALLBUSINESSESFAIL)NTHIS REGARD THE #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT IS A VITAL TOOL FOR IMPROVING THE OWNERS DECISION MAKINGINRELATIONTOCASHMANAGEMENT 4HESPECIlCUSESOFA#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTARE s To aid decision-making about the firm’s cash activities by detailing the sources and uses of cash in a particular period. )N PARTICULAR THE OWNER WOULD WANT TO ASSESS WHETHER THE BUSINESS IS GENERATING ENOUGH CASH FROM ITS /PERATING ACTIVITIES TO FUNDITS)NVESTINGAND&INANCINGACTIVITIES!lRMWITHNEGATIVE.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM /PERATIONS SUCH AS -AKRIS -ANCHESTER IN &IGURE WILL BE UNABLE TO MEET ITS OTHERPAYMENTSWITHOUTCONTRIBUTIONSFROMTHEOWNEROREXTERNALlNANCE s To assess the firm’s performance in meeting its cash targets. 4HE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT CAN BE COMPARED AGAINST BUDGETED OR EXPECTED PERFORMANCE AS SHOWN IN THE "UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT WHICHWOULDHAVEBEENPREPAREDINADVANCE4HIS COMPARISON WILL HIGHLIGHT WHERE PERFORMANCE WAS BETTER OR WORSE THAN EXPECTED #ORRECTIVE ACTION CAN THEN BE TAKEN 4HIS WILL BE EXPLORED IN GREATER DETAIL IN #HAPTER s To assist in planning for future cash activities. "YPROVIDINGABASISFORTHENEXTBUDGET THE #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT WILL AID IN THE SETTING OF TARGETS FOR THE FUTURE 4HIS MAY INCLUDECASHRECEIVEDFROMSALESORDEBTORS PAYMENTSFORSTOCKOREXPENSES CASH PURCHASESOFNON CURRENTASSETS CASHDRAWINGS ANDREPAYMENTOFLOANS4HISWILLBE EXPLOREDINMOREDETAILIN#HAPTER s To facilitate the calculation of financial indicators for analysis and interpretation. 4HESEINDICATORSCANBEUSEDNOTONLYTOUNCOVERWHATHASHAPPENED BUTALSOTO HELPEXPLAINWHY4HISWILLBECOVEREDIN#HAPTER
'RAPHINGCASHmOWS 4HEUnderstandabilityOFTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTMAYBEENHANCEDFURTHERIF.ET#ASH &LOWSnFROM/PERATIONS )NVESTINGACTIVITIESAND&INANCINGACTIVITIESnAREREPRESENTED GRAPHICALLY&IGURESHOWSHOWTHECASHmOWSOF-AKRIS-ANCHESTERFORTHEQUARTER ENDED$ECEMBERCOULDBEREPRESENTED Figure 12.3
Graphing Net Cash Flows
$20 000
Net Cash Flows from Operations
$12 000 $4 000
Net Cash Flows from Investing Activities
– $4 000 – $12 000
Net Cash Flows from Financing Activities
– $20 000
Net Decrease in Cash Position
Net cash flows © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 12
T H E C A S H F L O W S TAT E M E N T
269
&ROM THIS GRAPH IT IS CLEAR THAT CASH mOWS ARE NEGATIVE FOR BOTH /PERATING AND )NVESTINGACTIVITIES BUTTHAT&INANCINGACTIVITIESHAVEMADEASIGNIlCANTCONTRIBUTIONTO CASHONHAND(OWEVER THEOVERALLRESULTISNEGATIVETHEREHASBEENANet Decrease in Cash Position4HISMEANSTHEREISLESSCASHONHAND
REVIEW QUESTIONS 12.3
1 $ElNETHEFOLLOWINGTERMSASTHEYRELATETOTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT s /PERATINGACTIVITIES s )NVESTINGACTIVITIES s &INANCINGACTIVITIES 2 %XPLAIN ONE REASON WHY IT MAY BE MORE BENElCIAL TO PREPARE A #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENTTHANJUSTA3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTS %XPLAINHOWTHEPREPARATIONOFA#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTCANASSISTINDECISION MAKING 4 %XPLAINHOWTHEPREPARATIONOFA#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTCANASSISTINPLANNING FORTHEFUTURE 2EFERRINGTO&IGURE a %XPLAINONEREASONWHYTHEOWNERMIGHTBECONCERNEDABOUTTHElRMS .ET#ASH&LOWSFROM/PERATIONS B $ISCUSS WHETHER THE lRMS &INANCING ACTIVITIES WILL HAVE A POSITIVE OR NEGATIVEEFFECTONITSFUTURECASHACTIVITIES 2EFERRINGTO&IGURE EXPLAINONEWAYTHEOWNERMIGHTUSETHISGRAPHTO AIDDECISION MAKING
12.4 USING THE CASH JOURNALS 7HENUSINGTHECASHJOURNALSTOPREPARETHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT ITISIMPORTANTTO REMEMBERTHATNOTALLTHEINFORMATIONRECORDEDINEACHJOURNALRELATESTOANACTUALCASH mOW3OMECAREMUSTBETAKENTOENSURETHATONLYCASHmOWINFORMATIONISREPORTEDIN THE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT
#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL 4HE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALSHOWSALLcash inflows BUTALSOOTHERINFORMATIONTHATDOES NOTINVOLVECASH
EXAMPLE
Williams Windscreens has provided the following Cash Receipts Journal (totals only) for December 2015: #ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL $ATE
$ETAILS
2ECEIPT "ANK NUMBER
$ISCOUNT $EBTORS #OSTOF %XPENSE #ONTROL 3ALES
3ALES
Capital 4OTALS
3UNDRIES
GST
30 000 70 700
18 000
30 000
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
1 800
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
270
STUDY TIP
$ISCOUNTEXPENSEISNOT ACASHmOWITISACTUALLY THEabsenceOFACASH mOWnANAMOUNTTHAT THEDEBTORSDIDnot HAVETOPAY
UNITS 3&4
4HElGUREFORTOTALCASHRECEIVEDISSHOWNINTHE"ANKCOLUMNAS WITHMOST OFTHEOTHERCOLUMNSSHOWINGTHESOURCESOFTHATCASH(OWEVER NOTALLOFTHEOTHER COLUMNTOTALSREFERTOCASHmOWS s #OSTOF3ALES 4HISCOLUMNDOESNOTRECORDAcashmOW BUTRATHERAstockmOWITRECORDSTHECOST PRICEOFSTOCKSOLD RATHERTHANTHECASHRECEIVEDFROMTHESALE4HISlGURESHOULDnot BEREPORTEDINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT ASITDOESNOTINVOLVECASH s Debtors Control: $21 500AND$ISCOUNT%XPENSE 2EMEMBER THAT THE Debtors Control COLUMN RECORDS THE total AMOUNT BY WHICH DEBTORS WILL DECREASE AND IN MOST CASES THIS lGURE WILL COMPRISE SOME CASH BUT ALSOSOMEDISCOUNTEXPENSE(OWEVER THE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTONLYREPORTSCASH mOWS n SPECIlCALLY CASH 2ECEIPTS FROM $EBTORS !S A RESULT THE DISCOUNT EXPENSE MUSTBEdeductedFROMTHElGUREINTHEDebtors ControlCOLUMN$21 500 TODETERMINERECEIPTSFROMDEBTORS 2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS
Debtors Control $21 500
n n
$ISCOUNT%XPENSE
4HEONLYCASHmOWIS2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORSOF SOONLYTHISAMOUNTSHOULD BEREPORTEDINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT
#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL 4HEISSUESRELATINGTOTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALAREALITTLESIMPLER4HE#ASH0AYMENTS *OURNALSHOWSALLcash outflows ANDTHEONLYREALISSUEISTHETREATMENTOFPAYMENTSTO CREDITORS
EXAMPLE
Williams Windscreens has provided the following Cash Payments Journal for December 2015: #ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL $ATE
$ETAILS
#HEQUE NUMBER
"ANK
$ISCOUNT #REDITORS 3TOCK 2EVENUE #ONTROL #ONTROL
7AGES
Dec. 31 Advertising
3UNDRIES 1 300
Office Supplies
200
GST Clearing
900
Vehicle
32 000
Drawings
400
Loan – Q Bank 4OTALS
GST
1 500 $
94 250
24 000
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
2 500
36 300 5 750
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 12
T H E C A S H F L O W S TAT E M E N T
4HElGUREFORTOTALCASHPAIDISSHOWNINTHE"ANKCOLUMNAS WITHMOSTOF THEOTHERCOLUMNSSHOWINGTHEUSESOFTHATCASH(OWEVER NOTALLOFTHEOTHERCOLUMN TOTALSREFERTOCASHmOWS s Creditors Control: $26 000AND$ISCOUNT2EVENUE 4HE Creditors Control COLUMN INCLUDES BOTH THE CASH PAYMENTS TO CREDITORS andTHEDISCOUNTREVENUE BUTONLYTHECASHpaidSHOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE#ASH &LOW3TATEMENT!SWITHRECEIPTSFROMDEBTORS THEDISCOUNTMUSTBEDEDUCTEDTO DETERMINETHECASHmOW 0AYMENTSTO#REDITORS
Creditors Control n $26 000 n
$ISCOUNT2EVENUE
4HEONLYCASHmOWIS0AYMENTSTO#REDITORSOF SOONLYTHISAMOUNTSHOULD BEREPORTEDINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT
'34PAIDANDRECEIVED !LLCASHTRANSACTIONSRELATINGTO'34MUSTBEREPORTEDAS/PERATINGCASHmOWS BUTTHERE ISANIMPORTANTDIFFERENCEINTHEREPORTINGOFTHE'34PAIDANDRECEIVEDONEVERYDAY PURCHASESANDSALES ANDTHE'34PAIDTOORRECEIVEDFROMthe ATO )NTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL THE'34COLUMNRECORDSTHE'34RECEIVEDFROMCASH SALESINTHISEXAMPLE ANDSOSHOULDSIMPLYBEREPORTEDAS'34RECEIVED'34 COLLECTEDISALSOACCEPTABLE (OWEVER ASANINFREQUENTCASHRECEIPT A'34REFUNDFROM THE!4/WOULDBERECORDEDINTHE3UNDRIESCOLUMN4HISAMOUNTISSTILLAN/PERATING INmOW BUTASITCOMESFROMADIFFERENTSOURCEnTHE!4/RATHERTHANCUSTOMERSnITMUST BEREPORTEDSEPARATELYINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTAS'34REFUND2EMEMBERTHAT'34 RECEIVEDFROMSALESREPRESENTSTAXCOLLECTEDBYTHElRMONBEHALFOFTHEGOVERNMENT WHICH INCREASES THE LIABILITY OWED TO THE !4/ )F '34 REFUND IS CONFUSED WITH '34 RECEIVEDFROMSALES THElRMWOULDOWETHEREFUNDTOTHE!4/ 4HESAMEPRINCIPLEAPPLIESTO'34PAYMENTSRECORDEDINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL 4HE'34PAIDTOSUPPLIERS ISRECORDEDINTHE'34COLUMN ANDCANBEREPORTED AS '34 PAID (OWEVER '34 PAYMENTS RECORDED IN THE 3UNDRIES COLUMN ARE MADETOCLEARA'34LIABILITYWITHTHE!4/ ANDSOMUSTBEREPORTEDSEPARATELYAS'34 SETTLEMENT"OTHPAYMENTSRELATETO'34 BUTARERECORDEDANDREPORTEDSEPARATELYAS THEYAREPAIDTODIFFERENTENTITIES4HISMEANSTHEREAREFOURPOTENTIALCASHmOWSRELATED TO'34 /PERATINGINmOWS
/PERATINGOUTmOWS
GST received
GST paid
GST refund
GST settlement
'34PAIDAND'34RECEIVEDWILLBEREPORTEDEACHPERIOD BUTNOTEVERY#ASH&LOW 3TATEMENTWILLNEEDTOINCLUDEALLFOUR'34ITEMS AS'34REFUNDOR'34SETTLEMENTARE UNLIKELYTOOCCUREVERYMONTH
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
271
272
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
4HE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR7ILLIAMS7INDSCREENSFOR$ECEMBERWOULDTHUS BE WILLIAMS WINDSCREENS #ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR$ECEMBER $
$
CASH FLOW FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES #ASH)NmOWS Cash Sales
18 000
Receipts from Debtors
20 900
GST Received
1 800
40 700
,ESS#ASH/UTmOWS Payments to Creditors
25 700
Cash Purchase of Stock
24 000
Wages
2 500
GST Paid
5 750
Advertising
1 300
Office Supplies
200
GST Settlement
900
.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM/PERATIONS
60 350
CASH FLOW FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES #ASH/UTmOWS Vehicle
32 000
.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM)NVESTING!CTIVITIES
CASH FLOW FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES #ASH)NmOWS Capital Contribution
30 000
,ESS#ASH/UTmOWS Loan – Q Bank Drawings
1 500 400
1 900
.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM&INANCING!CTIVITIES
.ET)NCREASE$ECREASE IN#ASH0OSITION
!DD"ANK"ALANCEATSTART$ECEMBER "ANK"ALANCEATEND$ECEMBER
REVIEW QUESTIONS 12.4
1 %XPLAINWHY#OSTOF3ALESISNOTREPORTEDINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT 3TATEONEREASONWHYTHETOTALOFTHE$EBTORS#ONTROLCOLUMNOFTHE#ASH 2ECEIPTS*OURNALMAYNOTREPRESENTCASHRECEIVEDFROMDEBTORS 3HOW HOW RECEIPTS FROM DEBTORS IS CALCULATED WHEN DISCOUNT EXPENSE HAS BEENRECORDEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL 4 %XPLAINWHYTHETOTALOFTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLCOLUMNOFTHE#ASH0AYMENTS *OURNALISNOTREPORTEDINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT )DENTIFYTHEFOUR'34ITEMSTHATMAYBEREPORTEDINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 12
T H E C A S H F L O W S TAT E M E N T
273
CASH VERSUS PROFIT 4HEINTRODUCTIONTOTHISCHAPTERHIGHLIGHTEDTHEFACTTHATMANYPROlTABLESMALLBUSINESSES STILL END UP FAILING LARGELY DUE TO AN INABILITY TO MANAGE CASH EFFECTIVELY )T IS ALL TOO COMMON TO HEAR OF BUSINESSES THAT ARE SELLING THEIR PRODUCTS AT A PROlT BUT END UP BEINGUNABLETOPAYTHEIRDEBTSBECAUSETHEYCANTMANAGETHEIRCASH ANDULTIMATELY ENDUPGOINGOUTOFBUSINESS "UTHOWCANTHISBE(OWCANAlRMTHATISEARNINGAPROlTSUFFERFROMALACKOFCASH TOPAYITSBILLS#ONVERSELY HOWCANAlRMTHATISTRADINGATALOSSSTILLBOASTAHEALTHY BANKBALANCE 4HESIMPLEANSWERISTHATCASHANDPROlTAREDIFFERENTRESOURCES ANDBUSINESSOWNERS NEEDTOUNDERSTANDTHISDIFFERENCEINORDERTOMANAGEBOTHEFFECTIVELY4HECHANGEIN A lRMS BANK BALANCE IS CALCULATED BY COMPARING CASH INmOWS AND CASH OUTmOWS IN APERIOD WHEREASPROlTISDETERMINEDBYCOMPARINGREVENUESEARNEDANDEXPENSES INCURREDINTHATPERIODAND ASWEHAVESEENANUMBEROFTIMES THESEITEMSARENOT NECESSARILYTHESAME4HEMAINDIFFERENCESARE s SOMECASHITEMSDONOTAFFECTPROlT s SOMEPROlTITEMSDONOTAFFECTCASH s SOMEITEMSAFFECTBOTHCASHANDPROlT BUTBYDIFFERINGAMOUNTS
#ASHITEMSTHATDONOTAFFECTPROlT 3OMEITEMSAREREPORTEDONLYINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT ASTHEYONLYAFFECTCASHON HANDBECAUSETHEYARENOTREVENUESOREXPENSES THEYARENOTREPORTEDINTHE)NCOME 3TATEMENT Some cash inflows are not revenues at all#APITALCONTRIBUTIONSANDLOANSRECEIVED ARECASHINmOWSTHATINCREASE"ANK BUTARENOTREVENUESANDSOHAVENOEFFECTONPROlT )TEMSSUCHASTHESEWILLEXPLAINWHYAlRMHASBEENABLETOGENERATEANINCREASEINITS CASHBALANCEEVENIFITHASINCURREDA.ET,OSS 3IMILARLY some cash outflows are not expenses #ASH DRAWINGS LOAN REPAYMENTS ANDCASHOUTmOWSFORNON CURRENTASSETSAREPAYMENTSTHATWILLDECREASE"ANK BUTARE NOTEXPENSESANDSOLEAVEPROlTUNCHANGED4HISMAYEXPLAINWHYAlRMHASSUFFERED ADECREASEINCASHDESPITEEARNINGAPROlT
STUDY TIP
!LTHOUGHTHESEARE THEGENERALREASONS WHYCASHANDPROlT PERFORMANCEMAYDIFFER THEYARENOTNEARLY SPECIlCENOUGHINAN EXAMSITUATION2EFERTO THESPECIlCEXAMPLES BELOW
STUDY TIP
#ASHINmOWSTHATARENOTREVENUES
#ASHOUTmOWSTHATARENOTEXPENSES
Capital contribution
Cash drawings
Loan received
Loan repayments Cash payments for non-current assets
GST received (including GST refund)
GST paid (including GST settlement)
)NTHECASEOF'34CASHmOWS IFTHETOTAL'34RECEIVEDINCLUDINGANY'34REFUND IS GREATERTHANTHETOTAL'34PAIDINCLUDINGANY'34SETTLEMENT THEREWILLBEANINCREASE INCASHIFTHEOPPOSITEOCCURS THEREWILLBEADECREASEINCASH)NEITHERCASE THEREWILL BENOEFFECTONPROlT AS'34ISNEITHERAREVENUENORANEXPENSE
%XCEPTFOR'34 THESE DIFFERENCESWOULD BEREPORTEDASEITHER )NVESTINGOR&INANCING ACTIVITIESINTHE#ASH &LOW3TATEMENTTHIS ISTHEBESTPLACETO STARTWHENLOOKING FORREASONSWHYCASH ANDPROlTRESULTSARE DIFFERENT
0ROlTITEMSTHATDONOTAFFECTCASH *UST AS SOME ITEMS ARE REPORTED ONLY IN THE #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT OTHER ITEMS ARE REPORTEDONLYINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
274
UNITS 3&4
&IRST some revenues are not cash inflows3TOCKGAINISAGOODEXAMPLE ASITISA REVENUETHATINCREASESPROlT BUTASITREPRESENTSAGAINOFSTOCK NOTCASH ITWILLNOT AFFECT CASH ON HAND 4HIS MAY EXPLAIN WHY A lRM CAN EARN A PROlT BUT STILL SUFFER A DECREASEINCASH /N THE OTHER HAND some expenses are not cash outflows AND AS A RESULT WILL DECREASEPROlT WHILELEAVINGCASHUNCHANGED$EPRECIATION BADDEBTSANDSTOCKLOSS ALLFALLINTOTHISCATEGORY%XPENSESSUCHASTHESEMAYEXPLAINWHYAlRMCANGENERATE MORECASHWITHOUTEARNINGAPROlT STUDY TIP
-OREEXAMPLESOFTHIS KINDWILLCOMETOLIGHT IN5NIT
2EVENUESTHATARENOTCASHINmOWS
%XPENSESTHATARENOTCASHOUTmOWS
Stock gain
Stock loss Bad debts Depreciation
)TEMSTHATAFFECTBOTHPROlT ANDCASH 7EHAVESOFARCONSIDEREDITEMSTHATAFFECTONEREPORT BUTNOTTHEOTHERTHATIS THEY HAVEACASHEFFECTorAPROlTEFFECT BUTNOTBOTH"UTMANYITEMSAFFECTBOTHCASHAND PROlT7HERETHEITEMAFFECTSBOTH BUTBYdiffering amounts, THElRMSPROlTWILLNOTBE THESAMEASITSCASHPERFORMANCE Credit sales and receipts from debtors 3ELLINGGOODSONCREDITWILLINCREASEPROlTIMMEDIATELY BUTMAYNOTINVOLVEACASHmOW UNTILMUCHLATER#ONVERSELY WHENTHECASHISRECEIVEDFROMTHEDEBTORITWILLINCREASE "ANK BUTITISNOTREVENUE4HUS THEDIFFERENTAMOUNTSREPORTEDAS#REDIT3ALESAND RECEIPTSFROMDEBTORSCOULDEXPLAINWHYCASHANDPROlTARENOTTHESAME)F#REDIT3ALES ISgreaterTHANRECEIPTSFROMDEBTORS THElRMMAYHAVEMOREPROlTTHANCASH)F#REDIT 3ALESISlessTHANRECEIPTSFROMDEBTORS THElRMMAYVERYWELLHAVELESSPROlTTHANCASH Cost of Sales and payments for stock 4HEWAYSTOCKISPAIDFORCANALSOMEANTHATCASHANDPROlTARENOTTHESAME#OSTOF 3ALESREPRESENTSTHEVALUEOFSTOCKSOLD BUTTHISMAYNOTBETHESAMEASTHEAMOUNTTHAT HASBEENPAIDFORTHATSTOCKASCASHPURCHASESORPAYMENTSTOCREDITORS 2EMEMBER #OSTOF3ALESREPRESENTSASTOCKmOW NOTACASHmOW)F#OSTOF3ALESISgreaterTHAN PAYMENTSFORSTOCK ITWILLREDUCEPROlTMORETHANITREDUCESCASH)F#OSTOF3ALESISless THANPAYMENTSFORSTOCK ITWILLMEANAGREATERREDUCTIONINCASHTHANINPROlT Expenses: amount incurred versus amount paid $UETOBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTS THEAMOUNTPAIDFOREXPENSESISFREQUENTLYDIFFERENT FROMTHEAMOUNTINCURRED7HENEXPENSESAREPAIDINADVANCEFORTHENEXT2EPORTING 0ERIOD SUCHASPREPAIDRENTORPREPAIDINSURANCE THEAMOUNTPAIDWILLBEgreaterTHAN THEAMOUNTINCURRED MEANINGTHATCASHDECREASESMORETHANPROlT/NTHEOTHERHAND IFEXPENSESAREACCRUEDATTHEENDOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIOD THEAMOUNTINCURREDWILLBE greaterTHANTHEAMOUNTPAID MEANINGPROlTDECREASESMORETHANCASH 2EVENUEEXPENSE
#ASHINmOWOUTmOW
Credit Sales
Receipts from debtors
Cost of Sales
Payments to creditors/Cash purchases
Other expense incurred
Other expense paid (may be titled Accrued and/or Prepaid)
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 12
T H E C A S H F L O W S TAT E M E N T
275
)NREALITY THEREWILLUSUALLYBEACOMBINATIONOFREASONSWHYAlRMSCASHANDPROlT PERFORMANCEDIFFER !lRMMAYEARNA.ET0ROlTBUTSUFFERADECREASEINCASHDUETO 2EASON
%XAMPLES
Cash outflows that decrease cash but are not expenses and so do not affect profit
Cash drawings Loan repayments Cash payments for non-current assets Overall more GST paid than received, including GST settlement
Revenues that increase profit but are not cash inflows and so do not affect cash
Stock gain
Revenue items that increase profit more than the corresponding cash inflow increases cash
Credit Sales greater than Receipts from Debtors
Expense items that decrease profit less than the corresponding cash outflow decreases cash
Cost of Sales less than payments for stock Other expense incurred less than paid
!lRMMAYSUFFERA.ET,OSSBUTGENERATEANINCREASEINCASHDUETO 2EASON
%XAMPLES
Cash inflows that increase cash but are not revenues and so do not affect profit
Capital contribution Loan received Overall more GST received than paid (including GST refund)
Expenses that decrease profit but are not cash outflows and so do not affect cash
Stock loss Bad debts Depreciation
Revenue items that increase profit less than the corresponding cash inflow increases cash
Credit Sales less than Receipts from Debtors
Expense items that decrease profit more than the corresponding cash outflow decreases cash
Cost of Sales greater than Payments for Stock
STUDY TIP
Other expense incurred greater than paid
7HENLOOKINGFOR REASONSTOEXPLAINTHE DIFFERENCEBETWEENCASH ANDPROlTPERFORMANCE REMEMBEROPPOSITES CAPITALCONTRIBUTION VERSUSDRAWINGSLOAN RECEIVEDVERSUSREPAID STOCKLOSSVERSUSGAIN ANDEXPENSESPREPAID VERSUSACCRUED
REVIEW QUESTIONS 12.5
1 )DENTIFYTHETHREEMAINREASONSWHYTHECHANGEINAlRMS#ASH0OSITIONMAY BEDIFFERENTFROMITSPROlTOVERTHESAMEPERIOD 2 )DENTIFYTWOCASHINmOWSTHATARENOTREVENUES%XPLAINTHEEFFECTTHESEITEMS WILLHAVEONBOTHCASHAND.ET0ROlT )DENTIFYTHREECASHOUTmOWSTHATARENOTEXPENSES%XPLAINTHEEFFECTTHESE ITEMSWILLHAVEONBOTHCASHAND.ET0ROlT 4 %XPLAIN HOW A STOCK GAIN MAY BE THE REASON WHY A lRM CAN EARN A PROlT DESPITESUFFERINGACASHDElCIT
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
276
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
)DENTIFYTHREEITEMSTHATWILLBEREPORTEDASEXPENSESINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT BUTWILLNOTBEREPORTEDASCASHOUTmOWSINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT %XPLAINTHEEFFECTONBOTHCASHANDPROlTIF s #REDIT3ALESISGREATERTHAN2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS s #REDIT3ALESISLESSTHAN2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS s #OSTOF3ALESISGREATERTHAN0AYMENTSFOR3TOCK s #OSTOF3ALESISLESSTHAN0AYMENTSFOR3TOCK s EXPENSESAREACCRUEDATTHEENDOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIOD s EXPENSESAREPREPAIDFORTHENEXT2EPORTING0ERIOD
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s 4HE3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTSREPORTSCASHRECEIVEDANDPAID ANDTHE CHANGEINTHElRMSBANKBALANCEOVERA2EPORTING0ERIOD s 4HE #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT REPORTS CASH INmOWS AND CASH OUTmOWS RELATING TO /PERATINGACTIVITIES )NVESTINGACTIVITIESAND&INANCINGACTIVITIES ANDTHECHANGEIN THElRMSBANKBALANCEOVERA2EPORTING0ERIOD s /PERATINGACTIVITIESARECASHmOWSRELATEDTODAY TO DAYTRADINGACTIVITIES s )NVESTINGACTIVITIESARECASHmOWSRELATEDTOTHEPURCHASEANDSALEOFNON CURRENT ASSETS s &INANCING ACTIVITIES ARE CASH mOWS RELATED TO CHANGES IN THE lNANCIAL STRUCTURE OF THElRM s 4HE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTISUSEDTOAIDDECISION MAKINGANDPLANNING s 4HEREAREFOURPOTENTIALCASHmOWSRELATEDTO'344HESEARETHE/PERATINGINmOWS OF'34RECEIVEDAND'34REFUNDANDTHE/PERATINGOUTmOWSOF'34PAIDAND'34 SETTLEMENT s #ASHANDPROlTAREDIFFERENTMEASURESOFPERFORMANCE ANDTHEREAREMANYPOSSIBLE REASONSWHYAlRMTHATISEARNINGAPROlTCANSTILLSUFFERFROMALACKOFCASH n 3OMECASHINmOWSARENOTREVENUES n 3OMECASHOUTmOWSARENOTEXPENSES n 3OMEREVENUESARENOTCASHINmOWS n 3OMEEXPENSESARENOTCASHOUTmOWS n 3OMEITEMSAFFECTBOTHCASHANDPROlT BUTBYDIFFERINGAMOUNTS
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 12
T H E C A S H F L O W S TAT E M E N T
EXERCISE 12.1 STATEMENT OF RECEIPTS AND PAYMENTS
W B
page 252
277
EXERCISES
#RAFTY#ABINETSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONRELATINGTOITSCASHTRANSACTIONS FOR*ULY #ASH2ECEIPTS Cash Sales Receipts from Debtors GST Received Capital Contribution
$ 100 000 50 000 10 000 15 000
#ASH0AYMENTS Payments to Creditors Electricity Interest Office Expenses Wages Purchase of Equipment Drawings GST Paid Loan Repayment Prepaid Rent
$ 70 000 2 400 600 5 000 30 000 5 600 40 000 3 100 6 000 18 000
Additional information: s 4HEBANKBALANCEOF#RAFTY#ABINETSASAT*UNEWAS$2 s 2ENTISPAIDINADVANCEIN*ULYEACHYEAR Required
* *
a #OMPLETETHE"ANKACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF#RAFTY#ABINETSASAT*ULY B 0REPAREA3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTSFOR#RAFTY#ABINETSFOR*ULY C 3TATEONEREASONWHYTHEOWNERWOULDBEUNHAPPYWITHTHECASHPERFORMANCEOF THElRMDURING*ULY d %XPLAINONEWAYTOIMPROVETHEINFORMATIONREPORTEDTOTHEOWNERABOUTTHElRMS CASHPERFORMANCE
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
278
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 12.2 CASH FLOW STATEMENT
W B
page 254
"OOF(AIR#ARE0RODUCTSHASPROVIDEDITS3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTSFORTHE YEARENDING*UNE BOOF HAIR CARE PRODUCTS 3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTSFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE #ASH2ECEIPTS
$
Cash Sales
50 000
Receipts from Debtors
25 000
Capital Contribution
10 000
GST Received
5 000
$
90 000
,ESS#ASH0AYMENTS Payments to Creditors
24 000
Wages
28 000
Drawings
12 000
GST Paid
930
Electricity
1 500
Prepaid Insurance
1 800
Display Cabinets
6 000
74 230
3URPLUS$ElCIT
15 770
!DD"ANK"ALANCEATSTART*ULY
(13 500)
"ANK"ALANCEATEND*UNE
2 270
Required a 0REPARE A #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT FOR "OOF (AIR #ARE 0RODUCTS FOR THE YEAR ENDED *UNE B 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@A EXPLAINYOURTREATMENTOF$RAWINGS C 3UGGESTONEREASONWHYTHEOWNERMADETHECAPITALCONTRIBUTIONOF d %XPLAINONEBENElTOFPREPARINGA#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTRATHERTHANA3TATEMENTOF 2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTS
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 12
T H E C A S H F L O W S TAT E M E N T
%8%2#)3% CASH FLOW STATEMENT
W B
page 256
&LIP&LOPSSPECIALISESINTHESALESOFTHONGS ANDHASPROVIDEDITS3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTS AND0AYMENTSFORTHEQUARTERENDING3EPTEMBER FLIP FLOPS 3TATEMENTOF2ECEIPTSAND0AYMENTSFORTHEQUARTERENDED3EPTEMBER #ASH2ECEIPTS Cash Sales Receipts from Debtors Loan – Bodgey Bank GST Received
$
$
10 000 7 000 25 000 1 000
43 000
,ESS#ASH0AYMENTS Payments to Creditors
14 000
Cash Purchase of Stock
5 000
Wages
6 000
Drawings
2 000
GST Paid
950
Electricity
500
Prepaid Rent
2 400
Shelving
1 600
Loan Repayment
1 000
Interest Expense
550
34 000
3URPLUS$ElCIT
9 000
!DD"ANK"ALANCEATSTART*ULY
1 500
"ANK"ALANCEATEND3EPTEMBER
10 500
4HEOWNER +ARL7INEFELD ISHAPPYTHATTHEBANKBALANCEHASINCREASEDSOMUCHOVER THEQUARTER Required a 0REPAREA#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR&LIP&LOPSFORTHEQUARTERENDED3EPTEMBER B %XPLAIN ONE REASON WHY THE OWNER SHOULD BE CONCERNED ABOUT THE lRMS CASH PERFORMANCEFORTHEQUARTERENDED3EPTEMBER
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
279
280
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 12.4 OPERATING ACTIVITIES
W B
page 258
+ATHERINE 1UINN OWNS -IGHTY 7INDS A SHOP SPECIALISING IN ELECTRIC FANS AND HAS PROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGDATAFROMHERlNANCIALRECORDSFOR GST Paid Loan Repayment – Principal Electricity Paid Discount Expense Wages Paid GST Settlement Payments to Creditors
$
380 12 000 1 200 2 400 6 000 3 000 45 000
Cash Sales Interest Paid GST Received Wages Owing GST Charged on Credit Sales Cash Purchase of Office Furniture Accrued Interest Paid
$ 60 000 150 6 000 1 600 10 000 2 600 1 700
Required a #ALCULATE.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM/PERATIONSFOR-IGHTY7INDSFOR B 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@A EXPLAINYOURTREATMENTOF!CCRUED)NTEREST0AID C %XPLAIN THE IMPORTANCE OF .ET #ASH &LOWS FROM /PERATIONS TO THE SUCCESS OF A TRADINGBUSINESS
%8%2#)3% OPERATING ACTIVITIES
W B
page 259
'OT)T#OVEREDSELLSCARSEATCOVERSANDHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGDATAFROMITSlNANCIAL RECORDSFOR!PRIL Credit Sales Interest Expense Paid Discount Expense Credit Purchase Of Stock GST on Credit Purchases GST Paid Depreciation of Vehicle
$ 28 000 4 800 850 32 000 3 200 1 900 600
GST Refund Receipts from Debtors Drawings Cash Sales Rent Expense Incurred Prepaid Rent Paid GST Received on Cash Sales
$
300 15 000 1 800 16 000 12 000 15 000 1 600
Required a #ALCULATE.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM/PERATIONSFOR'OT)T#OVEREDFOR!PRIL B 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@A EXPLAINYOURTREATMENTOF$ISCOUNT%XPENSE C %XPLAINWHYTHE'34RECEIVEDAND'34REFUNDMUSTBEREPORTEDSEPARATELYINTHE #ASH&LOW3TATEMENT
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 12
T H E C A S H F L O W S TAT E M E N T
%8%2#)3% INVESTING ACTIVITIES
W B
page 260
2AG$OLL&ASHIONSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGDATAFROMITSlNANCIALRECORDSFORTHESIX MONTHSENDING$ECEMBER Cash Sales Cash Purchase of Stock Cash Purchase of Fittings Deposit Paid on Furniture
$ 47 000 15 000 5 600 800
GST Received GST Paid on Purchase of Stock GST Paid on Purchase of Fittings Drawings of Stock
$ 4 700 1 500 560 2 800
Required a )NTERMSOFTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT EXPLAINWHATISMEANTBYTHETERM@)NVESTING !CTIVITIES B #ALCULATE.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM)NVESTING!CTIVITIESFOR2AG$OLL&ASHIONSFORTHESIX MONTHSENDED$ECEMBER C 2EFERRING TO YOUR ANSWER TO PART @B EXPLAIN YOUR TREATMENT OF #ASH 0URCHASE OF 3TOCK d %XPLAINWHYTHE'340AIDON0URCHASEOF&ITTINGSISNOTREPORTEDASAN)NVESTING ACTIVITY
%8%2#)3% INVESTING ACTIVITIES
W B
page 261
.EIL .G %NTERPRISES HAS PROVIDED THE FOLLOWING DATA FROM ITS lNANCIAL RECORDS FOR .OVEMBER Loan Repayment Interest Expense Cash Purchase of Vehicle GST Paid
$ 12 000 4 800 32 000 5 600
Depreciation of Vehicle Cash Purchase of Shelving Receipt of Loan GST Settlement
$ 2 100 10 000 20 000 1 200
Required a #ALCULATE .ET #ASH &LOWS FROM )NVESTING !CTIVITIES FOR .EIL .G %NTERPRISES FOR .OVEMBER B 3TATEONEREASONWHY'34PAIDISGREATERTHANOF.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM)NVESTING !CTIVITIESFOR.OVEMBER C 3UGGESTTHREEWAYSTHEPURCHASEOFTHENEWVEHICLEMAYHAVEBEENlNANCED d %XPLAIN HOW NEGATIVE .ET #ASH &LOWS FROM )NVESTING !CTIVITIES MAY LEAD TO A REDUCTIONIN.ET0ROlT
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
281
282
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 12.8 FINANCING ACTIVITIES
W B
page 262
%DEN -ONARO-OTORSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGDATAFROMITSlNANCIALRECORDSFORTHE YEARENDING*UNE Credit Sales Receipt of Loan – NAB Accrued Wages Paid Payments to Creditors
$ 100 000 12 000 800 35 000
Interest Paid Net Profit Cash Drawings Drawings of Stock
$ 1 800 16 000 25 000 700
Required a )NTERMSOFTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT EXPLAINWHATISMEANTBYTHETERM@&INANCING !CTIVITIES B #ALCULATE.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM&INANCING!CTIVITIESFOR%DEN -ONARO-OTORSFORTHE YEARENDED*UNE C 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@B EXPLAINYOURTREATMENTOF)NTEREST0AID d #OMPLETETHE#APITALACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF%DEN -ONARO-OTORSASAT *UNE
%8%2#)3% FINANCING ACTIVITIES
W B
page 263
&LASH$ANCE7EARHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGDATAFROMITSlNANCIALREPORTSFORTHE MONTHSENDED$ECEMBER Repayment of Loan Principal Cash Drawings Receipts from Debtors Credit Purchase of Stock
$ 15 000 8 700 20 000 32 000
Cash Sales Cash Purchase of Shop Fittings Cash Contribution by Owner Contribution of Vehicle by Owner
$ 50 000 6 500 30 000 3 800
Required a #ALCULATE.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM&INANCING!CTIVITIESFOR&LASH$ANCE7EARFORTHESIX MONTHSENDED$ECEMBER B %XPLAINWHYACAPITALCONTRIBUTIONISNOTREPORTEDINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT C %XPLAIN HOW POSITIVE .ET #ASH &LOWS FROM &INANCING !CTIVITIES MAY LEAD TO A REDUCTIONIN.ET0ROlT
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 12
T H E C A S H F L O W S TAT E M E N T
%8%2#)3% CASH VERSUS PROFIT
283
page 264
W B
"UZZ7AX0RODUCTSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGJOURNALTOTALSFOR!UGUST 3ALES*OURNAL $ATE
$EBTOR
Aug.
Totals
)NVOICE NUMBER
#OSTOF 3ALES
3ALES
GST
1 000
2 000
200
$EBTORS #ONTROL 2 200
#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL $ATE
$ETAILS
Aug.
Capital contribution
2ECNO
"ANK
$ISCOUNT $EBTORS %XPENSE #ONTROL
#OSTOF 3ALES
3ALES
3UNDRIES
GST
5 000
Totals
19 420
380
3 800
3 500
10 000
5 000
7AGES
3UNDRIES
1 000
#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL #HQ NO
"ANK
$ISCOUNT #REDITORS 3TOCK 2EVENUE #ONTROL #ONTROL
$ATE
$ETAILS
Aug.
Computer
1 000
Drawings
2 450
Interest Totals
GST
750 17 450
400
4 700
3 000
5 000
4 200
400
Additional information: s !SAT!UGUSTTHElRMSBANKACCOUNTWASOVERDRAWN s $URING!UGUSTTHEBUSINESSINCURREDA.ET,OSSOF Required
*
a 3TATEONEREASONWHYTHETOTALOFTHE$EBTORS#ONTROLCOLUMNINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS *OURNALDOESNOTEQUALRECEIPTSFROMDEBTORS B 0REPAREA#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR"UZZ7AX0RODUCTSFOR!UGUST C 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@B EXPLAINWHYTHEOWNERSHOULDBECONCERNED ABOUT THE lRMS #ASH 0OSITION BUT LESS CONCERNED ABOUT ITS CASH PERFORMANCE IN !UGUST d )DENTIFYTWOEXAMPLESFROMTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTTHATEXPLAINHOW"UZZ7AX 0RODUCTSWASABLETORECORDANINCREASEINCASHDESPITESUFFERINGA.ET,OSS%XPLAIN YOURRESPONSE e %XPLAINHOWTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTCANAIDDECISION MAKING
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
284
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 12.11 CASH VERSUS PROFIT
W B
page 266
3AW-ILLER&URNITUREHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGJOURNALTOTALSFORTHEQUARTERENDED *UNE 3ALES*OURNAL $ATE
)NVOICE NUMBER
$EBTOR Totals
#OSTOF 3ALES
3ALES
GST
$EBTORS #ONTROL
11 000
22 000
2 200
24 200
#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL $ATE
2EC NO
$ETAILS Totals
"ANK
$ISCOUNT %XPENSE
90 000
3UNDRIESINCLUDES s ,OANn')."ANK s #APITAL
$EBTORS #OSTOF 3ALES #ONTROL 3ALES
3UNDRIES
GST
38 000
26 000*
2 500
1 500
12 500
25 000
#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL
$ATE
$ETAILS
#HQ NO
Totals
"ANK
3TOCK #ONTROL
96 350
40 700
!DMINISTRATION $RAWINGS %XPENSE 3 000
13 500
7AGES 11 500
3UNDRIES
GST
21 300* 6 350
3UNDRIESINCLUDES s 0OLISHINGEQUIPMENT s 0REPAIDINSURANCE MONTHPOLICYBEGINNING!PRIL s 2EPAYMENTOFLOANPRINCIPAL s !CCRUEDWAGES Additional information: s !LLSTOCKISPURCHASEDUSINGCASH s 4HEBANKBALANCEAT!PRILWASOVERDRAFT 4HEBUSINESSHASNEGOTIATED ANOVERDRAFTLIMITOF s 4HEREWERENOBADDEBTSDURINGTHEQUARTERENDED*UNE Required
*
a 3TATEWHETHERTHEBALANCEOF$EBTORS#ONTROLASAT*UNEWOULDBEHIGHER ORLOWERTHANTHEBALANCEASAT!PRIL*USTIFYYOURANSWER B 0REPARE A #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT FOR 3AW -ILLER &URNITURE FOR THE QUARTER ENDED *UNE C 3TATEWHYTHEOWNERHADTOCONTRIBUTEADDITIONALCAPITALDURINGTHEQUARTER d 3AW-ILLER&URNITUREREPORTEDAPROlTOFFORTHEQUARTERENDED*UNE 5SINGTWOEXAMPLESOTHERTHANDRAWINGS EXPLAINHOW3AW-ILLER&URNITUREWASABLE TOEARNA.ET0ROlTDESPITEASIGNIlCANTFALLINCASHDURINGTHESAMEPERIOD
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 12
EXERCISE 12.12 CASH VERSUS PROFIT
T H E C A S H F L O W S TAT E M E N T
W B
page 268
&ULL #OLLECTION COMMENCED BUSINESS ON *ANUARY WHEN THE OWNER DEPOSITED INTOTHEBUSINESSBANKACCOUNT/NTHESAMEDAYABANKLOANOFWAS RECEIVEDFROMTHE+YNETON"ANK)NTERESTONTHELOANISPERANNUM ANDREPAYMENTS OFINTERESTANDPRINCIPALWILLOCCURONTHElRSTOFEVERYMONTH BEGINNINGON&EBRUARY $URING*ANUARYTHEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSOCCURRED s !WAREHOUSEWASRENTEDANDSIXMONTHSRENTWASPAIDINADVANCE TOTALLING INCLUDING'34 s PLUS'34 WASPAIDFOROFlCEEQUIPMENT4HEBUSINESSUSESTHESTRAIGHT LINE METHOD FOR DEPRECIATION )T WILL USE THE OFlCE EQUIPMENT FOR FOUR YEARS AND THEN EXPECTSTODISPOSEOFITFOR s !LL SALES ARE ON CREDIT AT A MARK UP OF $URING *ANUARY THE BUSINESS INVOICEDCUSTOMERSFORPLUS'34!SAT*ANUARY OF THISWASSTILLOWING s 3TOCKISPURCHASEDONCREDITANDPAIDFORINTHEMONTHFOLLOWINGPURCHASE s 7AGESOFWEREPAID s !DMINISTRATIONEXPENSESOFPLUS'34WEREPAID s !DVERTISINGOFWASINCURREDBUTNOTYETPAID s $RAWINGSWERE CONSISTINGOFCASHANDWORTHOFSTOCK Required
* *
a B C d
#ALCULATE'34PAIDFOR&ULL#OLLECTIONFOR*ANUARY 0REPAREA#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR&ULL#OLLECTIONFOR*ANUARY 0REPAREAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR&ULL#OLLECTIONFOR*ANUARY %XPLAIN PROVIDINGTWOEXAMPLES WHY&ULL#OLLECTIONHASMADEA.ET,OSSYETAT THESAMETIMEGENERATEDACASHSURPLUSFOR*ANUARY e 4HEOWNERBELIEVESTHATTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTISABETTERINDICATOROFBUSINESS PERFORMANCE THAN THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT %XPLAIN WHY THE OWNER IS INCORRECT IN MAKINGTHISSTATEMENT
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
285
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
286
UNITS 3&4
%8%2#)3% CASH FLOWS
page 270
W B
'IACOMO "ATUSTA OWNS 4HE 'LASS (OUSE A lRM THAT SELLS GLASSWARE FROM A SHOP AT 7ATERGARDENS 3HOPPING #ENTRE AND HAS PROVIDED THE FOLLOWING JOURNAL TOTALS FOR /CTOBER #ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL $ATE
$ETAILS
Oct.
GST Refund
2EC NO
$ISCOUNT %XPENSE
"ANK
$EBTORS #OSTOF 3ALES #ONTROL 3ALES
3UNDRIES
GST
500
4OTALS
7AGES
3UNDRIES
GST
#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL
$ATE
$ETAILS
Oct.
Interest
#HQ NO
"ANK
$ISCOUNT #REDITORS $RAWINGS 2EVENUE #ONTROL
100
Drawings
2 110
Shelving
1 600
4OTALS
Additional information: s !SAT/CTOBERTHElRMSBANKACCOUNTWASOVERDRAWN Required
* *
a 0REPAREA#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR4HE'LASS(OUSEFOR/CTOBER B #OMPLETE THE "ANK ACCOUNT IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER OF 4HE 'LASS (OUSE AS AT /CTOBER C 'IACOMOISCONCERNEDTHATTHEBANKOVERDRAFTHASINCREASEDDESPITETHEBUSINESS GENERATINGPOSITIVE.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM/PERATIONS%XPLAIN GIVINGTWOEXAMPLES FROMTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT HOWTHISOCCURRED d %XPLAINONEBENElTOFPREPARINGA#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT 'IACOMO PROVIDED THE FOLLOWING GRAPH REPRESENTING THE lRMS CASH ACTIVITIES FOR .OVEMBER $ 10 000
Net Cash Flows from Operations
$ 6 000 $ 2 000
Net Cash Flows from Investing Activities
– $ 2 000
Net Cash Flows from Financing Activities
– $ 6 000 – $ 10 000
Net Cash Flows
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 12
T H E C A S H F L O W S TAT E M E N T
287
Required e 3TATEWHETHERTHElRMSBANKBALANCEWILLINCREASEORDECREASEDURING.OVEMBER *USTIFYYOURANSWER F %XPLAINONEREASONWHY'IACOMOSHOULDBECONCERNEDABOUTTHElRMS.ET#ASH &LOWSFROM/PERATIONSFOR.OVEMBER G $ISCUSSWHETHER'IACOMOSHOULDBECONCERNEDABOUTTHElRMS.ET#ASH&LOWS FROM)NVESTING!CTIVITIESFOR.OVEMBER
EXERCISE 12.14 CASH VERSUS PROFIT
W B
page 273
2UBY)CEOWNS"LING2INGS AREPUTABLEJEWELLERYSTORE ANDHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWING JOURNALTOTALSFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE 3ALES*OURNAL $ATE
)NV NO
$EBTOR 4OTALS
#OSTOF 3ALES
GST
3ALES
4OTAL $EBTORS
$EBTORS #ONTROL
3UNDRIES
#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL $ATE
2EC NO
$EBTOR
"ANK
$ISCOUNT %XPENSE
Loan – QZ FinCo.
4OTALS
#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL $ATE
$ETAILS
#HQ NO
"ANK
$ISCOUNT 2EVENUE
#REDITORS #ONTROL
$RAWINGS
7AGES
3UNDRIES
Admin. Expenses
1 000
Display Cabinets
8 000
Rent Expense
11 000
Prepaid Insurance
4 200
Interest Expense
3 000
GST Settlement
1 100
4OTALS
GST
Additional information: s !LLSALESANDPURCHASESAREMADEONCREDIT ANDALLDEBTORSRECEIVEADISCOUNT!SAT *ULYTHEBALANCEOFTHE$EBTORS#ONTROLACCOUNTWAS$2 s "ADDEBTSFORTHEYEARENDED*UNEAMOUNTEDTO s !SAT*ULYTHElRMHADABANKBALANCEOF$2 s )NSURANCEFOR*UNEn!UGUSTWASPAIDINADVANCEON-AY
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
288
UNITS 3&4
Required
* *
a )DENTIFYTWOEFFECTSONTHEFORMATOFTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALOFTHEDECISIONTO MAKEALLSALESONCREDIT B #ALCULATETHEPERCENTAGEDISCOUNTGRANTEDTODEBTORS C #OMPLETETHE$EBTORS#ONTROLACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF"LING2INGSASAT *UNE d 0REPAREA#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR"LING2INGSFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE e 5SINGTWOEXAMPLES EXPLAINHOW"LING2INGSWASABLETOEARNA.ET0ROlTDESPITE SUFFERINGNEGATIVE.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM/PERATIONS
© Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
UNIT
4
CONTROL AND ANALYSIS OF BUSINESS PERFORMANCE
In Unit 4 of the VCE Accounting course, we will cover the following chapters: 291
CHAPTER 13
RETURNS OF STOCK
CHAPTER 14
STOCK VALUATION
CHAPTER 15
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
333
CHAPTER 16
BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS: REVENUES
367
CHAPTER 17
BUDGETS
CHAPTER 18
EVALUATING PROFITABILITY
CHAPTER 19
EVALUATING LIQUIDITY
309
387 427
455
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s IDENTIFY a return of stock FROMACREDITNOTE s LIST possible reasons for a return of stock s DISTINGUISH between a PURCHASERETURNANDASALES return s record a purchase return INTHESTOCKCARD 'ENERAL *OURNAL 'ENERAL,EDGERAND #REDITORS,EDGER s IDENTIFY the effect of a purchase return on the accounting equation
s record a sales return in the STOCKCARD 'ENERAL*OURNAL 'ENERAL,EDGERAND$EBTORS ,EDGER s EXPLAIN the role of the stock CARDINDETERMININGTHECOST price of a sales return s IDENTIFY the effect of a sales return on the accounting equation s REPORT a sales return in the )NCOME3TATEMENT
CHAPTER 13
RETURNS OF STOCK KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s PURCHASERETURN s SALESRETURN s CREDITNOTE s .ET3ALES
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
292
UNITS 3&4
13.1 RETURNS OF STOCK
PURCHASERETURN the return of stock by our firm to a trade creditor SALESRETURN the return of stock to our firm by a trade debtor
4HEMAINOBJECTIVEOFATRADINGlRMISTOEARNAPROlTBYPURCHASINGSTOCK THENRESELLING ITATAHIGHERPRICE(OWEVER GIVENTHESHEERNUMBEROFTRANSACTIONSATRADINGlRMWILL HAVEWITHITSCUSTOMERSANDSUPPLIERS ITISONLYLOGICALTOEXPECTTHATNOTEVERYITEMOF STOCKSOLDORPURCHASEDWILLPROVETOBESUITABLE4HISMEANSTHATINTHENORMALCOURSE OFBUSINESS/PERATIONS ACERTAINNUMBEROFRETURNSOFSTOCKCANBEEXPECTED 4HEREAREBASICALLYTWOTYPESOFRETURNS s PURCHASERETURNS s 3ALES2ETURNS A purchase returnOCCURSWHENSTOCKISRETURNEDby our firmTOASUPPLIER!sales return OCCURSWHENSTOCKISRETURNEDto our firmBYACUSTOMER4HISCHAPTERCONCENTRATES ONHOWTORECORDANDREPORTPURCHASERETURNSTOTRADECREDITORS AND3ALES2ETURNSBY TRADEDEBTORS Note:2ETURNSFORACASHREFUNDAREBEYONDTHESCOPEOFTHISCOURSE
2EASONSFORRETURNSOFSTOCK 4HEREAREPROBABLYASMANYREASONSFORRETURNINGSTOCKASTHEREAREFORPURCHASINGIT Some of the more common reasons to return stock are because: s THESTOCKISFAULTYDAMAGED s THESTOCKISTHEWRONGSIZECOLOURSHAPEMODEL s TOOMANYITEMSOFSTOCKWEREPURCHASED s THECUSTOMERSHAVESIMPLYCHANGEDTHEIRMIND
There are probably as many reasons for returning stock as there are for purchasing it. One of the most common reasons is that the stock is faulty or damaged.
$AMAGEDORFAULTYSTOCKMUSTBEACCEPTEDFORRETURN PROVIDEDTHECUSTOMERHAS THESOURCEDOCUMENTSUCHASTHESALESINVOICE ASPROOFOFPURCHASE ANDTHEBUSINESS IS SATISlED THE FAULT LIES WITH THE PRODUCT RATHER THAN WITH HOW IT WAS USED "USINESS OWNERSSHOULDOBTAINADVICEREGARDINGTHEIRLEGALOBLIGATIONSINTHISAREA )T IS UP TO INDIVIDUAL BUSINESSES TO DECIDE WHETHER THEY WILL ACCEPT RETURN FROM CUSTOMERSWHOHAVECHANGEDTHEIRMINDS&ORSOMEBUSINESSESnANDSOMEPRODUCTSn ITMAYBEINAPPROPRIATETOACCEPTRETURNSCUTMATERIALAND PERHAPS UNDERWEARMAYFALL INTOTHISCATEGORY (OWEVER BUSINESSESTHATDOACCEPTRETURNSMAYACTUALLYGENERATE GREATER SALES WITH CUSTOMERS MORE WILLING TO BUY IF THEY KNOW THEY CAN RETURN THE PRODUCTIFITTURNSOUTTOBEUNSUITABLE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 13
RETURNS OF STOCK
293
REVIEW QUESTIONS 13.1
1 %XPLAINTHEDIFFERENCEBETWEENAPURCHASERETURNANDASALESRETURN 2 3TATEFOURREASONSWHYSTOCKMAYBERETURNEDTOASUPPLIER 3 %XPLAINONEBENElTTHATMAYBEDERIVEDBYACCEPTINGRETURNSFROMCUSTOMERS WHOCHANGETHEIRMIND
13.2 CREDIT NOTES !SWITHALLTRANSACTIONS THEPROCESSOFRECORDINGANDREPORTINGRETURNSOFSTOCKMUST BEGINWITHASOURCEDOCUMENT)NFORMATIONTHATCANNOTBEVERIlEDBYASOURCEDOCUMENT WILL UNDERMINE THE Reliability OF THE lNANCIAL REPORTS !S THIS COURSE DEALS ONLY WITH CREDITRETURNSTOTRADECREDITORSANDBYTRADEDEBTORS THEONLYDOCUMENTTOPROVIDETHE EVIDENCEOFARETURNWILLBEA credit note SUCHASTHEONESHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 13.1
Credit note
Marcon Tool Co.
23 Aug. 2015
TAX INVOICE
ABN 98 756 458 751 ϯϯ'ĂīŶĞLJ^ƚ Coburg VIC 3058
Returned by:
Qty 4
Credit note: 85
Hardware Plus Johnson St, Collingwood VIC 3066 Item Arcwell electric drills
STUDY TIP
Unit price
Total cost
120
480
GST (10%)
Transactions in this COURSEWILLIDENTIFY WHETHER'34APPLIES BUTNOTNECESSARILYTHE '34AMOUNT
48 528
Reason
CREDITNOTE a source document that verifies the return of stock either to a trade creditor or by a trade debtor
Wrong stock items ordered
%VERYCREDITNOTEMUSTIDENTIFYTHETYPEANDQUANTITYOFSTOCKRETURNEDTHENAMEOF THECUSTOMERWHOISRETURNINGTHESTOCKANDTHEREASONFORTHERETURN&IGURESHOWS ARETURNOFFOUR!RCWELLELECTRICDRILLSto-ARCON4OOL#Oby(ARDWARE0LUS BECAUSETHE WRONGSTOCKITEMSWEREORDERED !CREDITNOTESUCHASTHISISNOTSTORECASH ASITMIGHTBEIFSTOCKWASRETURNEDTO A DEPARTMENT STORE IT CANNOT BE USED TO PAY FOR MORE STOCK 2ATHER IT PROVIDES THE EVIDENCETHATSTOCKHASBEENRETURNED ANDTHATTHEDEBTOWEDBYTHEDEBTORORTOTHE CREDITORHASBEENREDUCED
0URCHASEORSALESRETURN 'IVEN THAT A CREDIT NOTE WILL PROVIDE THE EVIDENCE OF BOTH A PURCHASE RETURN and a SALESRETURN HOWARETHETWOTOBEDISTINGUISHED.OTEHOWSIMILARACREDITNOTEISIN APPEARANCETOANINVOICEAND JUSTLIKEANINVOICE THENAMEOFTHESELLERISIDENTIlED ATTHETOPOFTHEDOCUMENT)NTHECASEOFARETURN THESELLERISALSOTHEBUSINESSTHAT ISRECEIVINGTHESTOCKASARETURN4HEBUSINESSRETURNINGTHESTOCKISIDENTIlEDINTHE MIDDLEOFTHECREDITNOTE4HISMEANSTHATIFOURBUSINESSNAMEISINTHEmiddle of the CREDITNOTE WEARERETURNINGTHESTOCK ANDTHETRANSACTIONISApurchase return)FOUR business name is at the topOFTHECREDITNOTE WEARERECEIVINGTHESTOCKINRETURN SO the transaction is a sales return ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
294
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 13.2
1 Referring to one qualitative characteristic, EXPLAIN the importance of source DOCUMENTSINTHEACCOUNTINGPROCESS 2 3TATETHElVEPIECESOFDATATHATMUSTBENOTEDONACREDITNOTE 3 %XPLAINHOWTHECREDITNOTECANBEUSEDTODISTINGUISHAPURCHASERETURNFROM ASALESRETURN
13.3 RECORDING PURCHASE RETURNS TO TRADE CREDITORS !PURCHASERETURNOCCURSWHENOURlRMRETURNSSTOCKTOATRADECREDITOR4HISWILLREDUCE THEQUANTITYOFSTOCKONHANDANDTHEAMOUNTOWEDTOTHETRADECREDITOR)TWILLALSO AFFECTTHEBALANCEOFTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNT
EXAMPLE
On 28 March 2015, Pete’s Tyre Mart returned 20 tyres to Billstone Tyres because they were the wrong type. The tyres were purchased for $80 each, plus $8 GST (Credit note 11).
4HESTOCKCARD !SWITHALLTRANSACTIONSAFFECTINGSTOCK APURCHASERETURNMUSTBERECORDEDINTHESTOCK CARDOFTHEAPPROPRIATESTOCKITEM)NTHEACCOUNTINGRECORDSFOR0ETES4YRE-ARTTHIS PURCHASERETURNWOULDBERECORDEDINTHESTOCKCARD ASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 13.2
Stock card: purchase return STOCK CARD
3TOCKITEM Tyres
,OCATION
Bay 17
3TOCKCODE BST
3UPPLIER
Billstone Tyres
IN $ATE
March 25
28
$ETAILS
1TY
#OST
OUT 4OTAL
1TY
#OST
BALANCE 4OTAL
Balance
Cr. note 11
20
80
1 600
1TY
#OST
4OTAL
60
75
4 500
90
80
7 200
60
75
4 500
70
80
5 600
!STHESTOCKLEAVESTHElRMTORETURNTOTHESUPPLIER ITISRECORDEDINTHE/UTCOLUMN OFTHESTOCKCARD WHICHDECREASESTHEQUANTITYOFSTOCKONHAND/NLYTHECOSTPRICEOF THESTOCKPERTYRE ISRECORDEDINTHESTOCKCARDTHE'34COMPONENTISEXCLUDED Purchase returns and FIFO )TISNECESSARYTOAPPLY&IRST)N &IRST/UT&)&/ TOSALESBECAUSETHECASHRECEIPTORSALES INVOICEWILLNOTIDENTIFYTHECOSTPRICEOFTHESTOCKTHATHASBEENSOLDTHECOSTPRICECAN ONLYBEDETERMINEDBYREFERENCETOTHESTOCKCARD4HESAMEISnot true for purchase RETURNSTHECREDITNOTEMUSTIDENTIFYTHECOSTPRICEOFTHESTOCKTHATISBEINGRETURNED 4HISMEANSTHATRETURNSMAYCOMEFROMTHESTOCKTHATWASPURCHASEDlRSTBUT EQUALLY MAY COME FROM NEWER BATCHES OF STOCK %FFECTIVELY &)&/ IS NOT APPLIED TO PURCHASE RETURNS ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 13
RETURNS OF STOCK
295
4HE'ENERAL*OURNAL 'ENERAL,EDGERAND#REDITORS,EDGER 7HILETHEREISASPECIALJOURNALDEDICATEDTORECORDINGCREDITpurchasesOFSTOCKTHE 0URCHASES*OURNAL PURCHASEreturnsARERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNALBECAUSETHEY DONTINVOLVECASHAND HOPEFULLY AREINFREQUENT4HEPURCHASERETURNTHATISRECORDED INTHESTOCKCARDIN&IGUREWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNALASSHOWNIN &IGURE Figure 13.3
General Journal: purchase return
STUDY TIP
'ENERAL*OURNAL 'ENERAL,EDGER $ATE
$ETAILS
$EBIT
March 28
Creditors Control
1 760
#REDIT
Creditor – Billstone Tyres
3UBSIDIARYLEDGER $EBIT
#REDIT
A purchase return is the EXACTREVERSEOFACREDIT PURCHASE
1 760
Stock Control
1 600
GST Clearing
160
20 tyres returned to supplier – wrong type (Cr. note 11)
)TISIMPORTANTTHATTHENARRATIONIDENTIlESTHESOURCEDOCUMENT#REDITNOTE SO THESTOCKITEMCANBEIDENTIlEDANDRECORDEDINTHESTOCKCARD )NTERMSOFTHE'ENERAL,EDGER APURCHASERETURNISSIMPLYTHEREVERSALOFAPURCHASE 4OBEGINWITH RETURNINGTHESTOCKTOTHESUPPLIERREDUCESTHEAMOUNTTHATISOWEDTOTHAT SUPPLIER4HISISRECORDEDASADEBITTO#REDITORS#ONTROL2EMEMBERTHATTHEORIGINAL AMOUNT OWING TO THE CREDITOR CONSISTED OF TWO AMOUNTS THE COST PRICE OF THE STOCK $1 600 PLUSTHE'34$160 2ETURNINGTHESTOCKDECREASESTHECREDITORBYTHESUM OFTHESETWOlGURES$1 760 4HISDEBITENTRYMUSTALSOBERECORDEDINTHESUBSIDIARY LEDGERTODECREASETHEBALANCEOWEDTO#REDITORn"ILLSTONE4YRES "ECAUSE THE STOCK LEVEL DECREASES Stock Control DECREASES VIA A CREDIT TO THIS ACCOUNT BUTTHISISONLYFORTHEAMOUNTTHATRELATESTOSTOCK$1 600 *USTLIKETHESTOCK CARD THEAMOUNTINTHE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNTEXCLUDESTHE'34COMPONENT 4HE'34AMOUNT$160 ISRECORDEDASASEPARATECREDITTO'34#LEARING, increasing THE LIABILITY TO THE !4/ OR POSSIBLY REDUCING THE ASSET 7HEREAS '34 ON THE CREDIT PURCHASEOFSTOCKREDUCEDTHE'34LIABILITYnBECAUSETHESUPPLIERWILLFORWARDTHE'34 TOTHE!4/nTHISENTRYISREINSTATINGTHAT'34LIABILITYBECAUSETHESUPPLIERWILLNOLONGER COLLECTIT 4HETRANSACTIONIN&IGUREWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSAS SHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 13.4
General Ledger: purchase return 'ENERAL,EDGER
STUDY TIP
'34ONAPURCHASE RETURNUNDOESTHE DECREASEINTHE'34 LIABILITYCAUSEDBYA CREDITPURCHASE
STUDY TIP
Resist the temptation to use the cross- reference @0URCHASE2ETURNSIN THE#REDITOR#ONTROL account as there is no SUCHLEDGERACCOUNT
#REDITOR#ONTROL, $ATE March 31
#ROSS REFERENCE Bank/Discount Revenue Stock Control/GST Clearing
!MOUNT
$ATE
32 900
March 1
1 760
31
#ROSS REFERENCE
!MOUNT
Balance
24 000
Stock Control/GST Clearing
38 500
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
296
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
Figure 13.4 (cont.)
UNITS 3&4
General Ledger: purchase return 3TOCK#ONTROL!
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
March 31
!MOUNT
$ATE
14 000
March 31
Balance
31
Bank
6 500
Creditors Control
#ROSS REFERENCE Cost of Sales Creditors Control
!MOUNT 41 000 1 600
35 000 '34#LEARING!,
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
March 31 Creditors Control Bank
!MOUNT
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
3 500
March 1
2 400
31
Balance
!MOUNT 600
Debtors Control
4 000
Bank
2 900
Creditors Control
160
.OTEHOWTHECROSS REFERENCEFORTHEDEBITENTRYINTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNT is not @0URCHASE 2ETURNS ALTHOUGH THIS DESCRIBES THE TRANSACTION THERE IS NO LEDGER ACCOUNT CALLED @0URCHASE 2ETURNS SO THIS CANNOT BE THE CROSS REFERENCE 2ATHER THE DEBITENTRYOF$1 760 is a combinationPARTSTOCKANDPART'347ENOLONGEROWETHE CREDITORFORTHESTOCK ANDWENOLONGEROWETHECREDITORFORTHE'34ONTHATSTOCK4HE cross-reference is Stock Control'34#LEARING .OTE ALSO THAT THE CROSS REFERENCE @#REDITORS #ONTROL NOW APPEARS ON BOTH SIDES OFTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTTHE'34ONCREDITPURCHASES ISONTHEDEBITSIDE AS A REDUCTION IN THE '34 LIABILITY AND THE '34 ON PURCHASE RETURNS $160 IS ON THE CREDITSIDE &IGURESHOWSHOWTHEPURCHASERETURNWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE#REDITORS,EDGER Figure 13.5
Creditors Ledger: purchase return CREDITORS,EDGER #REDITORn"ILLSTONE4YRES,
$ATE
!MOUNT
$ATE
Bank/ Discount Revenue
5 000
March 1
22
Bank
2 000
28
Stock Control/ GST Clearing
1 760
March 9
#ROSS REFERENCE
#ROSS REFERENCE
!MOUNT
Balance
5 000
12
Stock Control/ GST Clearing
3 300
27
Stock Control/ GST Clearing
2 750
!SHASALWAYSBEENTHECASE THECROSS REFERENCESUSEDINTHESUBSIDIARYLEDGERARE IDENTICALTOTHOSEUSEDINTHE#ONTROLACCOUNTS BUTINSTEADOFJOURNALTOTALS THISACCOUNT USESINDIVIDUALTRANSACTIONDATESANDAMOUNTS Effect on the accounting equation "ECAUSE A PURCHASE RETURN IS THE OPPOSITE OF A CREDIT PURCHASE ITS EFFECT ON THE ACCOUNTINGEQUATIONISALSOTHEOPPOSITE7HEREASACREDITPURCHASEWILLINCREASESTOCK CREDITORSAND'34#LEARING APURCHASERETURNHASTHEFOLLOWINGEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTING equation:
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 13
RETURNS OF STOCK
)NCREASE$ECREASE.OEFFECT
297
!MOUNT
!SSETS
Decrease (Stock Control)
1 600
,IABILITIES
Decrease (decrease Creditors Control $1 760, increase GST Clearing $160)
1 600
/WNERS%QUITY
No effect
)FTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTHASADEBITBALANCE ANDISANASSET THENAPURCHASE RETURN WILL DECREASE THAT ASSET 4HIS WILL CHANGE THE OVERALL EFFECT ON THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION ASSET AND LIABILITIES WILL STILL DECREASE BUT BY THE TOTAL ON THE CREDIT NOTE INCLUDINGTHE'34
2EPORTINGPURCHASERETURNS "ECAUSE A PURCHASE RETURN DOES NOT AFFECT ANY REVENUE OR EXPENSE ITEMS AND DOES NOT INVOLVE A CASH mOW IT WILL NOT BE REPORTED IN EITHER THE #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT OR THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT )N FACT IT WILL NOT BE REPORTED ANYWHERE ! PURCHASE RETURN WILLCHANGETHEBALANCESOF3TOCK#ONTROL #REDITORS#ONTROLAND'34#LEARINGINTHE "ALANCE3HEET BUTWILLNOTBEREPORTEDASASEPARATEITEM REVIEW QUESTIONS 13.3
1 %XPLAINHOWTHECOSTPRICEOFSTOCKISDETERMINEDWHENAPURCHASERETURN ISRECORDEDINTHESTOCKCARD 2 ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDAPURCHASERETURN 3 3TATEONEREASONWHYTHETERM@0URCHASE2ETURNISNOTUSEDASACROSS REFERENCEINTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNT 4 3TATETHEEFFECTOFAPURCHASERETURNONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION 5 %XPLAINHOWAPURCHASERETURNISREPORTEDINTHElNANCIALSTATEMENTS
13.4 RECORDING SALES RETURNS FROM TRADE DEBTORS 7HEREASAPURCHASERETURNOCCURSWHENSTOCKISRETURNED by our firm to a trade creditor, ASALESRETURNOCCURSWHENSTOCKISRETURNEDto our firm by a trade debtor!SALESRETURN WILLINCREASESTOCKONHAND BUTREDUCEDEBTORSANDALSOPROlT4HEBALANCEOFTHE'34 #LEARINGACCOUNTWILLALSOBEAFFECTED
EXAMPLE
On 23 May 2015, Books By Gosh received a sales return of three books from M.S. Howard worth $30 (plus $3 GST) each (Credit note 21). The books had been sold on 4 May 2015.
4HESTOCKCARD !SSTOCKISCOMINGBACKINTOOURBUSINESS ASALESRETURNMUSTBERECORDEDINTHE)N COLUMNOFTHERELEVANTSTOCKCARD)NTHEACCOUNTINGRECORDSFOR"OOKS"Y'OSH THIS SALESRETURNWOULDBERECORDEDINTHESTOCKCARDASSHOWNIN&IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
298
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
Figure 13.6
UNITS 3&4
Stock card: sales return STOCK CARD
3TOCKITEM Books 3TOCKCODE 171
,OCATION 3UPPLIER IN
$ATE
May 1 4 10
13
15
18
23
$ETAILS
1TY
#OST
Shelf next to front counter Cambridge Publishing
OUT 4OTAL
1TY
#OST
BALANCE 4OTAL
Balance Inv. 30 Ch. 901
7 15
12
20
14
2
10
20
5
12
60
280
Inv. 32
Cr. note 21
60
180
Inv. 31
Ch. 904
10
10
12
120
2
14
28
1TY
#OST
4OTAL
9
10
80
2
10
20
2
10
20
15
12
180
10
12
120
10
12
120
20
14
280
18
14
252
1
12
12
1
12
12
2
14
28
20
14
280
!LTHOUGHTHECREDITNOTEIDENTIlEDTHEPRICEOFEACHBOOKAS$30, this is the selling price4RANSACTIONSMUSTBERECORDEDINTHESTOCKCARDATcost price, but which cost price SHOULDBEUSED)N&IGURE THEORIGINALSALEON-AYVALUEDTHESTOCKATA cost price of $10 per book7HY THEN ISNTTHISCOSTPRICEUSEDINTHESALESRETURNON -AY 4HEKEYPRINCIPLEBEHINDRECORDINGASALESRETURNISTHATTHESTOCKCARDSHOULDBE RETURNEDTOTHEPOSITIONITWOULDHAVEBEENINIFTHESALEHADNEVERTAKENPLACE)FTHE sale on -AY HAD not TAKEN PLACE THEN WE WOULD ASSUME THAT THE STOCK WOULDSTILLBEONHAND(OWEVER THEAPPLICATIONOF&)&/WOULDASSUMETHATTHISSTOCK WOULDBEPARTOFTHEnextSALEON-AY )NPRACTICE THISMEANSTHAT3ALES2ETURNSSHOULDVALUESTOCKATTHECOSTPRICEUSED INTHEMOSTRECENTTRANSACTIONINTHE/UTCOLUMN)FTHEMOSTRECENTSALEINVOLVEDTWO DIFFERENTCOSTPRICES THENAREVERSALOF&)&/ASSUMESTHATTHElastSTOCKOUTISTHElRST STOCKTOBERETURNED A sales return should value stock at the cost price used in the most recent transaction in the Out column. Using the cost price in the most recent transaction in the Out column means that the sales return on -AYSHOULDUSETHECOSTPRICESFROMTHESALEON-AY valuing two of the items at $14EACHTHELASTTWOBOOKSSOLD WITHTHEOTHERVALUEDAT 4HETOTALCOSTPRICEOFTHERETURN$40 WILLBEUSEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRY
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 13
RETURNS OF STOCK
4HE'ENERAL*OURNAL 'ENERAL,EDGERAND$EBTORS,EDGER #REDIT3ALESARERECORDEDINTHEIROWNJOURNALTHE3ALES*OURNAL BUT INCOMMONWITH PURCHASERETURNS 3ALES2ETURNSARERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNAL4HESALESRETURN RECORDEDINTHESTOCKCARDIN&IGUREWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNALAS SHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 13.7
General Journal: sales return 'ENERAL*OURNAL 'ENERAL,EDGER
$ATE
$ETAILS
$EBIT
May 23
Sales Returns
90
GST Clearing
9
#REDIT
3UBSIDIARYLEDGER $EBIT
#REDIT
99
$EBTORS#ONTROL
$EBTORn-3(OWARD
99
Stock Control
40
Cost of Sales
40
3 books returned by customer – too many supplied (Cr. note 21)
4HEORIGINALCREDITSALEWASRECORDEDASACREDITTOTHE3ALESREVENUEACCOUNT SO A SALES RETURN REQUIRES THE OPPOSITE "UT RATHER THAN SIMPLY DEBIT THE 3ALES REVENUE ACCOUNT ASEPARATELEDGERACCOUNTISUSEDTORECORDSales Returns4HISACCOUNTISA negative revenue account ANDISDEBITED$90TORECORDTHEREDUCTIONINREVENUE'34 ClearingISALSODEBITED BY$9 TOREDUCETHE'34LIABILITYOWEDTOTHE!4/4HISIS'34 WEWILLNEVERRECEIVE ANDTHEREFORENOWDONOTOWETOTHE!4/ 2EVERSINGTHESALEALSOMEANSTHATTHEDEBTOWEDBYTHEDEBTORISREDUCED4HIS IS ACHIEVED BY CREDITING THE Debtors Control ACCOUNT IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER AND SIMULTANEOUSLYCREDITINGTHEINDIVIDUALACCOUNTDebtor – M.S. Howard INTHE$EBTORS ,EDGER4HEDEBTOROWEDUSBOTHTHESELLINGPRICE$90 ASWELLASTHE'34ONTHESALE $9 SO BY RETURNING THE STOCK THE FULL AMOUNT $99 IS DEDUCTED FROM THE DEBTORS BALANCE *USTASACREDITSALEINVOLVESTWODOUBLEENTRIESONEATcost priceANDONEATselling price SODOESASALESRETURN4HECOSTPRICEOF$40 ASDETERMINEDVIATHESTOCKCARD ISDEBITEDTOTHEStock Control account to reflect that the stock is coming back in to THE BUSINESS !S A CONSEQUENCE THE EXPENSE Cost of Sales IS REDUCED VIA A CREDIT ENTRY BECAUSETHESALEHASBEENRETURNED!GAIN THEENTRIESAFFECTINGTHE3TOCK#ONTROL ACCOUNTDONOTINCLUDE'34 4HETRANSACTIONIN&IGUREWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHELEDGERACCOUNTSASSHOWNIN &IGURE Figure 13.8
General Ledger: sales return 'ENERAL,EDGER $EBTORS#ONTROL!
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
May 1 May 31
!MOUNT
$ATE
Balance
16 500
May 31
Sales/GST Clearing
37 400
#ROSS REFERENCE Bank/Discount Expense Sales Returns/GST Clearing
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
!MOUNT 32 900 99
Cambridge University Press
299
300
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
Figure 13.8 (cont.)
UNITS 3&4
General Ledger: sales return '34#LEARING!,
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
May 31
Creditors Control Bank
!MOUNT
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
2 700
May 1
Balance
2 100
31
Debtors Control
9
!MOUNT 800
Debtors Control
3 400
Bank
1 700
3ALES2ETURNSn2 $ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
May 31
Debtors Control
!MOUNT
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
!MOUNT
90 3TOCK#ONTROL!
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
May 1
Balance
14 000
Creditors Control
11 000
31
!MOUNT
Cost of Sales
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
March 31
Cost of Sales
!MOUNT 24 000
40 #OSTOF3ALES%
$ATE May 31
#ROSS REFERENCE Stock Control
!MOUNT
$ATE
24 000
May 31
#ROSS REFERENCE Stock Control
!MOUNT 40
4HE CROSS REFERENCE FOR THE CREDIT ENTRY IN BOTH DEBTOR ACCOUNTS IN THE 'ENERAL ,EDGERAND$EBTORS,EDGER ISSales Returns'34#LEARING, reflecting the fact that both THESELLINGPRICEOFTHESTOCK$90 ANDTHE'34COMPONENT$9 HAVEBEENDEDUCTED FROMTHEDEBTORSBALANCE Note also thatTHECROSS REFERENCE@$EBTORS#ONTROLAPPEARSONBOTHSIDESOFTHE '34#LEARINGACCOUNT'34CHARGEDON#REDIT3ALESINCREASESTHE'34LIABILITYVIAAN ENTRYONTHECREDITSIDE BUT'34ON3ALES2ETURNSDECREASESTHATLIABILITYVIAANENTRY ONTHEDEBITSIDE &IGURESHOWSHOWASALESRETURNWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE$EBTORS,EDGER Figure 13.9
Debtors Ledger: sales return DEBTORS LEDGER $EBTORn-3(OWARD!
$ATE
#ROSS REFERENCE
May 1 4
!MOUNT
$ATE
Balance
200
May 12
Sales/GST Clearing
231
23
#ROSS REFERENCE Bank/Discount expense Sales Returns/ GST Clearing
!MOUNT 200 99
Effect on the accounting equation ! CREDIT SALE OF STOCK AFFECTS ASSETS BY INCREASING DEBTORS AND DECREASING STOCK ITINCREASESTHE'34LIABILITYANDITINCREASESOWNERSEQUITYVIATHEPROlTONTHESALE A sales return reverses this effect:
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 13
RETURNS OF STOCK
)NCREASE$ECREASE.OEFFECT
301
!MOUNT
Assets
Decrease (decrease Debtors Control $99, increase Stock Control $40)
Liabilities
Decrease (GST Clearing)
Owner’s Equity
Decrease (Sales Returns $90 less decrease Cost of Sales $40 = less profit)
59 9 50
REVIEW QUESTIONS 13.4
1 %XPLAINHOWTHECOSTPRICEOFSTOCKISDETERMINEDWHENASALESRETURNIS RECORDEDINTHESTOCKCARD 2 ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDASALESRETURN 3 %XPLAINWHYASALESRETURNLEADSTOAREDUCTIONINTHE'34LIABILITY 4 3TATETHEEFFECTOFASALESRETURNONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION
13.5 REPORTING SALES RETURNS 4HEVALUEANDNUMBEROF3ALES2ETURNSCANBEANIMPORTANTINDICATOROFTHEQUALITYAND SUITABILITYOFTHESTOCKTHATISBEINGTRADED)F3ALES2ETURNSAREHIGH ITMAYINDICATE CUSTOMERDISSATISFACTIONWITHTHEGOODSTHATAREBEINGSOLD4HISMAYBEBECAUSETHE GOODS ARE OF INFERIOR QUALITY OR SIMPLY BECAUSE CUSTOMERS HAVE BEEN PROVIDED WITH GOODSTHATDIDNOTSUITTHEIRPURPOSE )NORDERTOINVESTIGATETHECAUSEOFHIGH3ALES2ETURNS THEOWNERMUSTlRSTBEAWARE THAT3ALES2ETURNSAREINDEEDAPROBLEM4HISISWHY3ALES2ETURNSARERECORDEDINTHEIR OWNSEPARATELEDGERACCOUNT ANDREPORTEDSEPARATELYINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT /FCOURSE THEOWNERSHOULDNOTRELYSOLELYONTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTFORINFORMATION ABOUT THE SUITABILITY OF STOCK 3TOCK MOVEMENTS SHOULD BE ASSESSED REGULARLY BY CONSULTINGWITHSTAFFANDCUSTOMERS ANDBYEXAMININGTHESTOCKCARDS &IGURESHOWSHOW3ALES2ETURNSAREREPORTEDINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT Figure 13.10
Income Statement: Sales Returns BOOKS BY GOSH )NCOME3TATEMENTEXTRACT FOR-AY
2EVENUE Sales Less Sales Returns
51 000 90
50 910
Less Cost of Goods Sold Cost of Sales Freight In
23 960 1 200
Gross Profit
25 160 25 750
As a negative revenue 3ALES2ETURNSISREPORTEDASADEDUCTIONFROMSALES LEAVING Net Sales)N&IGURE THIS.ET3ALESlGUREIS 4HE#OSTOF3ALESISNOTREPORTEDANYDIFFERENTLY ASTHEEFFECTOFANY3ALES2ETURNS WILLHAVEALREADYBEENRECORDEDINTHE#OSTOF3ALESACCOUNT ANDACCOUNTEDFORINTHE lGURECLOSEDTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT)N&IGURE THECOSTPRICEOF THESALESRETURNHASALREADYBEENDEDUCTEDTOLEAVEANOVERALLlGUREOF ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
.ET3ALES sales revenue after the deduction of Sales Returns; that is, Sales less Sales Returns
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
302
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 13.5
1 2 3 4
%XPLAINWHY3ALES2ETURNSAREREPORTEDSEPARATELYINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT 3UGGESTTWOREASONSFORHIGH3ALES2ETURNS Show HOW.ET3ALESISREPORTEDINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT %XPLAIN WHY THE COST PRICE OF A SALES RETURN IS NOT REPORTED SEPARATELY IN THE )NCOME3TATEMENT
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s 2ETURNSOFSTOCKAREVERIlEDBYACREDITNOTE ANDRECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNAL s !PURCHASERETURNISTHERETURNOFSTOCKBYOURlRM TOATRADECREDITOR s 0URCHASERETURNSARERECORDEDINTHE/UTCOLUMNOFTHESTOCKCARD ANDDECREASE STOCKONHAND s !SALESRETURNISTHERETURNOFSTOCKTOOURlRM BYATRADEDEBTOR s 3ALES2ETURNSARERECORDEDINTHE)NCOLUMNOFTHESTOCKCARD ANDINCREASESTOCK ONHAND s 3ALES2ETURNSSHOULDVALUESTOCKATTHECOSTPRICEUSEDINTHEMOSTRECENTTRANSACTION INTHE/UTCOLUMNOFTHESTOCKCARD s 3ALES2ETURNSAREREPORTEDSEPARATELYINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTSOTHATTHEOWNERIS ALERTEDTOPOTENTIALPROBLEMSANDCUSTOMERDISSATISFACTIONWITHSTOCK
EXERCISES
EXERCISE 13.1 RECORDING A PURCHASE RETURN
W B
page 278
/N3EPTEMBER *OSEPH"OAT3UPPLIESHADPAIRSOFOARSONHAND EACHPAIR WITHACOSTPRICEOFPLUS'34 /N3EPTEMBER FOURPAIRSOFOARSWERE RETURNEDTO/ARS25SBECAUSETHEYWERETHEWRONGSIZE#REDITNOTE Required a Record#REDITNOTEINTHESTOCKCARDFOR/ARS B ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORD#REDITNOTE c 3TATE THE EFFECT OF #REDIT NOTE ON THE ACCOUNTING EQUATION OF *OSEPH "OAT 3UPPLIES
EXERCISE 13.2 PURCHASE RETURNS AND THE CREDITORS LEDGER
W B
page 279
"ENNY %LECTRICALS PURCHASES A PARTICULAR TYPE OF FRIDGE FROM &REEZING &RIDGES )TS TRANSACTIONSFOR!PRILWEREASFOLLOWS April
6 11 18 26 29
Purchased 5 fridges from Freezing Fridges at $400 (plus GST) each (Inv. 45) Paid $7 600 to Freezing Fridges, and received $400 discount Sold 12 fridges for $1 100 (including GST) each (Inv. 74) Purchased 8 fridges from Freezing Fridges at $420 (plus GST) each (Inv. 51) One of the fridges purchased on 26 April 2015 was returned (Cr. note 38)
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 13
RETURNS OF STOCK
Additional information: "ALANCESAT!PRIL
Required
*
#REDITORn&REEZING&RIDGES 3TOCKOFFRIDGES
EACH
a B c d e
3TATETHESOURCEDOCUMENTTHATWOULDVERIFYTHETRANSACTIONON!PRIL Record THETRANSACTIONSFOR!PRILINTHESTOCKCARDFOR&RIDGES %XPLAINWHY#REDITNOTEMUSTBERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNAL ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORD#REDITNOTE #OMPLETE THE ACCOUNT FOR &REEZING &RIDGES IN THE #REDITORS ,EDGER OF "ENNY %LECTRICALS F !SSUMINGTHEREWERENOOTHERTRANSACTIONSINVOLVING'34 CALCULATETHE'34LIABILITY OF"ENNY%LECTRICALSASAT!PRIL
EXERCISE 13.3 RECORDING A SALES RETURN
page 281
W B
/N*ULY 2ICH%ARTHFURNITUREHADTABLESONHAND EACHWITHACOSTPRICEOF /N*ULY 4.ICOLERETURNEDATABLETHATSHEHADPURCHASEDONCREDITON *ULYFORPLUS'34 BECAUSEITDIDNTMATCHHEROTHERFURNITURE #REDITNOTEWASISSUEDTO.ICOLEFORTHERETURN Required a B c d
Record#REDITNOTEINTHESTOCKCARDFORTABLES Show THE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORD#REDITNOTE 3TATETHEEFFECTOF#REDITNOTEONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF2ICH%ARTH !SSUMINGTHE3ALESACCOUNTHADACREDITBALANCEOF SHOW how the sales RETURNWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTOF2ICH%ARTHFOR*ULY e %XPLAINONEBENElTOFOFFERING3ALES2ETURNSTOCUSTOMERSWHOCHANGETHEIRMINDS
EXERCISE 13.4 SALES RETURNS AND THE DEBTORS LEDGER
W B
page 283
.ICKOF4IMEISACLOCKSHOP)TSTRANSACTIONSFOR!UGUSTWEREASFOLLOWS Aug.
4
Sold 4 clocks to Mega World for $150 (plus GST) each (Inv. 12)
7
Purchased 10 clocks from TimeStar Clocks for $90 (plus GST) each (Inv. 202)
9
Received $1 000 from Mega World
13
Sold 5 clocks to Mega World for $165 (including GST) each (Inv. 13)
20
Purchased 12 clocks from TimeStar Clocks for $110 (including GST) each (Inv. 211)
25
Mega World returned 2 clocks (Cr. note 4)
Additional information: "ALANCESAT!UGUST
Required
* *
$EBTORn-EGA7ORLD 3TOCKOFCLOCKS
EACH
a 3TATETHESPECIALJOURNALTHATWOULDBEUSEDTORECORDTHETRANSACTIONON!UGUST B RecordTHETRANSACTIONSINTHESTOCKCARDFORCLOCKS c ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHERETURNOFSTOCK d #OMPLETETHEACCOUNTFOR-EGA7ORLDINTHE$EBTORS,EDGEROF.ICKOF4IME e Assuming there were no other sales, prepare an Income Statement for Nick of Time FOR!UGUSTSHOWING'ROSS0ROlT!FULL)NCOME3TATEMENTISNOTREQUIRED ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
303
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
304
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 13.5 PURCHASE RETURNS AND THE GENERAL LEDGER
W B
page 285
4HOMMOS4OYSPRESENTEDTHEFOLLOWINGSUMMARYOFITSTRANSACTIONSFOR/CTOBER Stock Control – balance 1 October 2015 Creditors Control – balance 1 October 2015
$42 000 34 000
GST Clearing – balance 1 October 2015 Credit purchases for October 2015
800 50 000
CR (plus GST $5 000)
Cash paid to creditors plus discount revenue
59 400
Credit Sales
66 000
(incl. GST); cost price $30 000
Cash sales
30 000
(plus GST); cost price $15 000
GST paid
2 500
Additional information: s /N /CTOBER STOCK WORTH PLUS '34 WAS RETURNED TO A SUPPLIER 7ILSON)NDUSTRIES Required
*
a 3TATE THE SOURCE DOCUMENT THAT WOULD VERIFY THE RETURN OF STOCK ON /CTOBER B 3TATETWOREASONSWHYSTOCKMAYBERETURNEDTOASUPPLIER c Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD THE RETURN OF STOCK ON /CTOBER.ARRATIONNOTREQUIRED d #OMPLETETHE3TOCK#ONTROL #REDITORS#ONTROLAND'34#LEARINGACCOUNTSINTHE 'ENERAL,EDGEROF4HOMMOS4OYSASAT/CTOBER e 3TATETWOOTHERPIECESOFINFORMATIONTHATWOULDBENECESSARYTORECORDTHERETURN OFSTOCKINTHESTOCKCARD
EXERCISE 13.6 SALES RETURNS AND THE GENERAL LEDGER
W B
page 287
$REW#URTAINSPRESENTEDTHEFOLLOWINGSUMMARYOFITSTRANSACTIONSFOR.OVEMBER Stock Control – balance 1 November 2015 Debtors Control – balance 1 November 2015
$13 000 25 000
GST Clearing – balance 1 November 2015 Credit Sales
950 40 000
GST paid Credit purchases for November 2015
1 500 39 600
CR (plus GST); cost price: $25 000 (plus $3 600 GST) (including GST)
Cash Receipts Journal column totals: Debtors Control
38 000
Cash sales
12 000
Cost of Sales
8 000
GST
1 200
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 13
RETURNS OF STOCK
Additional information: s /N.OVEMBER ADEBTOR +$OWLING RETURNEDSTOCKBECAUSEITWASFAULTY 4HESTOCKHADASELLINGPRICEOFPLUS'34 ANDACOSTPRICEOF#RNOTE s $REWHASSTATEDTHATDISCOUNTSWEREGRANTEDTODEBTORSDURING.OVEMBER Required
* *
a Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD THE RETURN OF STOCK ON .OVEMBER B 3TATE THE EFFECT OF THE RETURN OF STOCK ON .OVEMBER ON THE ACCOUNTING EQUATIONOF$REW#URTAINS c #OMPLETE THE $EBTORS #ONTROL 3ALES 2ETURNS '34 #LEARING 3TOCK #ONTROL AND #OSTOF3ALESACCOUNTSINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF$REW#URTAINSASAT.OVEMBER d Assuming there are no other transactions, prepare an Income Statement for Drew #URTAINSFOR.OVEMBER SHOWING'ROSS0ROlT!FULL)NCOME3TATEMENTISNOT REQUIRED
EXERCISE 13.7 RETURNS AND THE STOCK CARD
page 289
W B
%LIZABETH*EWELLERYSELLSNECKLACES RINGSANDOTHERJEWELLERY)TSSTOCKCARDFORNECKLACES SHOWEDTHEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSFOR*ANUARY STOCK CARD 3TOCKITEM Necklaces, 60cm 3TOCKCODE AU60cm
,OCATION 3UPPLIER IN
$ATE
$ETAILS
1TY
#OST
Front cabinet Gems Warehouse
OUT 4OTAL
1TY
#OST
BALANCE 4OTAL
1TY
#OST
4OTAL
Jan. 3
Memo 32
1
120
120
8
120
960
Jan. 9
Inv. 30
3
120
360
5
120
600
5
120
600
10
130
1 300
9
130
1 170
9
130
1 170
10
140
1 400
Jan. 13
Jan. 17
Jan. 22
Inv. A91
10
130
1 300
Rec. 009
Inv. A98
10
140
1 400
5
120
600
1
130
130
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
305
306
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Additional information: 4HEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSHAVENOTYETBEENRECORDED
Elizabeth Jewellery
25/1/2015
Little Bourke St Melbourne VIC 3000
TAX INVOICE
Credit note: 29
ABN 07 012 000 070 Returned by: Qty 2
M. Brooke Beach St, Frankston VIC 3199 Item Necklaces
Unit price
Total cost
200
400
GST (10%)
40 440
Reason
Damaged
s /N*ANUARY THEDAMAGEDNECKLACESWERERETURNEDTOTHESUPPLIER 'EMS 7AREHOUSE FORACREDITOFPLUS'34#RNOTE s /N *ANUARY A STOCKTAKE REVEALED THAT THERE WERE NECKLACES ON HAND -EMO s !LLNECKLACESHAVEASELLINGPRICEOFINCLUDING'34 Required a 3UGGESTTWOPOSSIBLEREASONSFORTHETRANSACTIONON*ANUARY B RecordTHEADDITIONALINFORMATIONINTHESTOCKCARDFORNECKLACES c %XPLAINHOWTHEAPPLICATIONOF&)&/AFFECTSTHERECORDINGOFASALESRETURNINTHE STOCKCARD d ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHEADDITIONALINFORMATION e #ALCULATE#OSTOF3ALESFORNECKLACESFOR*ANUARY F #ALCULATE!DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlTONNECKLACESFOR*ANUARY
EXERCISE 13.8 POSTING JOURNALS TO THE LEDGER
W B
page 291
'ARRYS 'ARDEN 3UPPLIES BUYS AND SELLS PLANTS )TS "ALANCE 3HEET AS AT *UNE INCLUDEDTHEFOLLOWINGITEMS #URRENTASSETS Stock Control
$ 5 000
Debtors Control
3 080
s -ACARTHUR0ARKS
s *AMES'REVILLE
#URRENTLIABILITIES Bank GST Clearing
2 000
CR
300
Creditors Control
1 430
s #ITYOF(UME
s #HASAND-ARYS0LANTS
)TSOWNER 'ARRY HASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGSPECIALJOURNALSRELATINGTOITSTRADING ACTIVITIESFOR*UNE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 13
RETURNS OF STOCK
307
#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL 2ECEIPT NUMBER
"ANK
Cash Sales
20
1 056
James Greville
21
1 881
10
Cash Sales
22
858
14
Growth Solutions
23
1 254
19
Capital
24
5 000
24
Macarthur Park
25
400
25
Cash Sales
26
726
$ATE June 1 6
$ETAILS
$ISCOUNT %XPENSE
99
3ALES
640
960
96
520
780
78
3UNDRIES
GST
1 980
66
1 320 5 000 400
11 175
4OTALS
$EBTORS #OSTOF #ONTROL 3ALES
165
440
660
66
3UNDRIES
GST
#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL $ATE
$ETAILS
#HEQUE NUMBER
June 1
GST Clearing
112
300
3
Stock Control
113
715
4
Chas and Mary’s Plants
114
836
8
Advertising
115
3 960
10
City of Hume
116
550
11
Stock Control
117
1 540
13
Wages
118
500
18
City of Hume
119
2 508
22
Drawings
120
1 000
27
Wages
121
500
4OTALS
$ISCOUNT 2EVENUE
"ANK
#REDITORS 3TOCK #ONTROL #ONTROL
7AGES
300 650 44
65
880 3 600
360
550 1 400
140 500
132
2 640 1 000 500
176
565
PURCHASES *OURNAL $ATE June 12
)NVOICE NUMBER
#REDITOR
3TOCK #ONTROL
GST
#REDITORS #ONTROL
City of Hume
90
2 400
240
2 640
17
Chas and Mary’s Plants
91
3 040
304
3 344
20
City of Hume
92
1 540
154
1 694
698
7 678
4OTALS 3ALES*OURNAL $ATE June 6
$EBTOR
)NVOICE NUMBER
#OSTOF 3ALES
3ALES
GST
$EBTORS #ONTROL
Macarthur Parks
65
900
1 350
135
1 485
11
Growth Solutions
66
800
1 200
120
1 320
18
James Greville
67
1 400
2 100
210
2 310
25
Growth Solutions
68
1 200
1 800
180
1 980
645
4OTALS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
308
UNITS 3&4
Additional information: s /N*UNE 'ARRYRETURNEDSTOCKTHATHADORIGINALLYCOSTINCLUDING'34 TO#ITYOF(UME s /N*UNE -ACARTHUR0ARKSRETURNEDSTOCKTO'ARRYS'ARDEN3UPPLIES WHICH HADORIGINALLYBEENSOLDFORPLUS'344HESTOCKHADACOSTPRICEOF s /N*UNE ALETTERWASRECEIVEDINFORMING'ARRYTHAT-ACARTHUR0ARKSWAS BANKRUPT ANDITSBALANCEOFSHOULDBEWRITTENOFF Required
*
* *
a Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD THE ADDITIONAL INFORMATION .ARRATIONSARENOTREQUIRED B #OMPLETETHEFOLLOWING'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSASAT*UNE s Debtors Control s #REDITORS#ONTROL s Stock Control s Cost of Sales s '34#LEARING c #OMPLETETHEACCOUNTOF-ACARTHUR0ARKSINTHE$EBTORS,EDGERASAT*UNE d #OMPLETETHEACCOUNTOF#ITYOF(UMEINTHE#REDITORS,EDGERASAT*UNE e PrepareAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR'ARRYS'ARDEN3UPPLIESFOR*UNE F %XPLAINHOWTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF 'ARRYS'ARDEN3UPPLIESASAT*UNE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s defineANDcalculateTHE COSTOFSTOCK s explainTHEIMPORTANCEOF ACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLESAND QUALITATIVECHARACTERISTICSIN THEVALUATIONOFSTOCK s defineANDidentifyPRODUCT ANDPERIODCOSTS s recordPRODUCTANDPERIOD COSTSINTHEJOURNALS STOCK CARDSAND'ENERAL,EDGER s reportPRODUCTAND PERIODCOSTSINTHE)NCOME 3TATEMENTAND"ALANCE 3HEET
s explainTHEEFFECTOFPERIOD COSTINGONTHEACCOUNTING EQUATIONANDACCOUNTING REPORTS s defineANDapplyTHELOWER OFCOSTAND.ET2EALISABLE 6ALUE.26 RULE s statePOSSIBLEREASONSFORA 3TOCK7RITE DOWN s recordA3TOCK7RITE DOWN INTHE'ENERAL*OURNAL STOCK CARDSAND'ENERAL,EDGER s reportA3TOCK7RITE DOWN INTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT s stateTHEEFFECTOFA 3TOCK7RITE DOWNONTHE ACCOUNTINGEQUATION
CHAPTER 14
STOCK VALUATION KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s COSTOFSTOCK s UNITCOST s PRODUCTCOST s PERIODCOST s .ET2EALISABLE6ALUE.26 s 3TOCK7RITE DOWN ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
310
UNITS 3&4
14.1 THE COST OF STOCK (OW MUCH IS OUR STOCK WORTH )T SEEMS LIKE A FAIRLY OBVIOUS QUESTION FOR A BUSINESS OWNERTOASK ANDTHEOWNERWOULDEXPECTTHEACCOUNTANTTOBEABLETOANSWERITWITH ABSOLUTECERTAINTY!FTERALL STOCKISOFTENTHEMOSTSIGNIlCANTASSETATRADINGBUSINESS WILLHOLDAND JUSTASIMPORTANTLY ITISITSMAINSOURCEOFREVENUE3OHOWSHOULDWE VALUEOURSTOCK )FYOUUNDERSTANDTHEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLESANDQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTICS THENTHE ANSWER SEEMS EASY ENOUGH !PPLYING THE (ISTORICAL #OST PRINCIPLE MEANS THAT STOCK SHOULD BE VALUED AT ITS ORIGINAL PURCHASE PRICE AS THIS IS VERIlABLE BY REFERENCE TO A SOURCEDOCUMENT)NTURN THISENSURESReliabilityINTHEREPORTS BECAUSETHISVALUATION WILLBEFREEFROMERRORANDBIAS )NESSENCETHEN STOCKISVALUEDBYCALCULATINGITSCOST)NMANYCASES THISWILLSIMPLY BETHEPRICECHARGEDTOUSBYOURSUPPLIER"UTINOTHERCASES THEREMAYBEOTHERCOSTS ASSOCIATEDWITHTHEPURCHASE ANDTHESEMUSTBEACCOUNTEDFORINDETERMININGTHECOST PRICEOFTHESTOCK
EXAMPLE
Sleepworld sell beds and bedroom furniture. On 18 October 2015, it purchased a new item of stock, a king-size waterbed, and incurred the following costs: Waterbed – supplier’s price Delivery to Sleepworld from supplier GST on purchase and delivery
$800 100 90
Total invoice price
$990
The bed will have a selling price of $1 200 plus $120 GST.
cost of stock all costs incurred in order to bring stock into a condition and location ready for sale
7HATISTHE@COSTOFTHEBED,ETSSTARTBYELIMINATINGTHESELLINGPRICEASAPOSSIBILITY BECAUSETHISlGUREISNOTTHEPURCHASEPRICE!VALUATIONBASEDONSELLINGPRICEWOULD DIRECTLY BREACH THE (ISTORICAL #OST PRINCIPLE (OWEVER THERE IS AN ADDITIONAL REASON NOT TO VALUE THE STOCK AT ITS SELLING PRICE THERE IS NO GUARANTEE THAT THE BED CAN BE SOLDFORTHISAMOUNT4OVALUETHEBEDATITSSELLINGPRICEWOULDBREACHTHEPRINCIPLE OF#ONSERVATISMBECAUSEITWOULDRECOGNISEAGAINTHEPROlTONTHESALEOFTHESTOCK BEFOREITISCERTAIN WHICHWOULDOVERSTATETHEVALUEOFASSETSNAMELY STOCK#LEARLY THE SELLINGPRICESHOULDnotBEUSEDTOVALUETHESTOCK 'IVENTHATWEMUSTUSETHEpurchasePRICE WHICHAMOUNTSSHOULDBEINCLUDED ,ETSSTARTWITHWHATISnotINCLUDEDTHE'34!NY'34ONTHEPURCHASEOFSTOCKWILL BEDEBITEDTOTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNT ANDWILLSIMPLYREDUCETHELIABILITYTHEBUSINESS OWESTOTHE!4/)TDOESNOTAFFECTTHEECONOMICBENElTTOBEGAINEDWHENTHESTOCK ISSOLD "YCONTRAST THESUPPLIERSPRICEOF$800isINCLUDEDASTHISISTHEKEYCOSTOFTHEBED (OWEVER WE MUST ALSO CONSIDER THAT WITHOUT THE DELIVERY CHARGES OF $100 THE STOCK WOULDNOTBEAVAILABLETOSELLTOCUSTOMERSITISPARTOFTHEPURCHASEPRICE ANDMUSTBE INCLUDEDINTHE cost of stock
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 14
S T O C K VA L U AT I O N
)NFACT ANYCOSTSINCURREDINORDERTOBRINGTHESTOCKINTOACONDITIONANDLOCATION READYFORSALEMUSTBEINCLUDEDINITSCOSTPRICE4HESEMAYINCLUDE s THESUPPLIERSPRICE s FREIGHTINDELIVERYTOTHElRMFROMTHESUPPLIER s MODIlCATIONS s CUSTOMSIMPORTDUTIES s ANYOTHERBUYINGEXPENSES !DDINGTOGETHERTHESUPPLIERSPRICEANDTHEDELIVERYCHARGES THECOSTOFTHEBEDIS $900OR PUTANOTHERWAY THEBEDISworth$900
The importance of an accurate calculation of cost price #ALCULATINGANACCURATECOSTPRICEFORSTOCKISIMPORTANTNOTONLYINTERMSOFVALUINGSTOCK INTHE"ALANCE3HEET BUTALSOINTERMSOFEARNINGPROlT-ANYBUSINESSESDETERMINE THEIRSELLINGPRICEBYAPPLYINGSOMESORTOFMARK UP WHICHISITSELFBASEDONTHECOST PRICE&OREXAMPLE IFAlRMAPPLIESAMARK UP ITSSELLINGPRICEWILLBETWICEITS COSTPRICE)FTHElRMCALCULATESTHECOSTPRICEOFITSSTOCKINCORRECTLY THENITMAYSET ITSSELLINGPRICESTOOHIGH LEADINGTOALOSSOFSALESVOLUME ORTOOLOW LEADINGTOAN INSUFlCIENTMARK UP 4HEUSEOFTHECOSTPRICEINSETTINGSELLINGPRICESMEANSTHATITISESSENTIALTHATTHE OWNER HAVE ACCURATE INFORMATION RELATING TO THE COST PRICE OF EACH INDIVIDUAL UNIT OF STOCK4HISISSOMETIMESKNOWNASITSunit cost
REVIEW QUESTIONS 14.1
311
STUDY TIP
)TEMSSUCHAS ADVERTISING WAGESOR FREIGHTOUTTHECOST OFDELIVERINGSTOCKTO OURCUSTOMERS ARE EXCLUDED ASTHEYARE ONLYINCURREDafter THESALE
unit cost the cost price of each individual item/unit of stock
1 DefineTHE(ISTORICAL#OSTPRINCIPLE 2 2EFERRINGTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC explainWHYSTOCKSHOULDBEVALUED ATITS(ISTORICAL#OST 3 ExplainWHYVALUINGSTOCKATITSSELLINGPRICEWOULDBREACH#ONSERVATISM 4 ExplainWHY'34ISEXCLUDEDFROMTHECALCULATIONOFTHECOSTOFSTOCK 5 DefineTHETERM@COSTASITISUSEDINREFERENCETOSTOCK 6 StateTHREECOSTS OTHERTHANTHESUPPLIERSPRICE WHICHMAYBEINCLUDEDIN THECOSTPRICEOFSTOCK 7 StateTWOREASONSWHYITISIMPORTANTTOHAVEANACCURATECALCULATIONOFTHE COSTPRICEOFSTOCK
14.2 PRODUCT COSTS 7EHAVEALREADYESTABLISHEDTHATTHECOSTOFSTOCKINCLUDESALLCOSTSINCURREDINORDERTO BRINGSTOCKINTOACONDITIONANDLOCATIONREADYFORSALE"UTTOCALCULATETHEUNITCOSTn THECOSTper itemnITISALSONECESSARYTHATWEAREABLETOallocateTHOSECOSTSTOEACH INDIVIDUALUNITOFSTOCK
Identifying product costs )NCLUDINGAPARTICULAREXPENSEINTHECALCULATIONOFTHEUNITCOSTOFANINDIVIDUALITEMOF STOCKREQUIRESTHATTHECOSTlTSTHEDElNITIONOFAproduct cost;THATIS ACOSTINCURREDIN ORDERTOBRINGSTOCKINTOACONDITIONANDLOCATIONREADYFORSALE WHICHCANBEALLOCATED TOINDIVIDUALUNITSOFSTOCKONALOGICALBASIS 4HISIS INEFFECT ATWO WAYTEST&IRST THECOSTMUSTBEINCURREDINORDERTOBRINGTHE STOCKINTOACONDITIONANDLOCATIONREADYFORSALE)FTHISTESTISNOTMET THECOSTCANNOT BEINCLUDEDINTHEUNITCOSTOFTHESTOCK4HISWOULDINCLUDECOSTSSUCHASTHESUPPLIERS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
product cost a cost incurred in order to bring stock into a condition and location ready for sale, which can be allocated to individual units of stock on a logical basis
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
312
STUDY TIP
!NABSENCEOFALOGICAL BASISTOALLOCATECOSTS WOULDMEANTHATACOST CANNOTBETREATEDASA PRODUCTCOST ANDMUST BETREATEDASAPERIOD COSTSEEPAGE
EXAMPLE
UNITS 3&4
PRICE FREIGHTINANDMODIlCATIONS#OSTSINCURREDONLYafterTHESTOCKISREADYFORSALE SUCHASADVERTISINGANDWAGES WOULDBEEXCLUDED /NCEITHASBEENESTABLISHEDTHATTHECOSTISINCURREDTOGETSTOCKREADYFORSALE WE MUSTDETERMINEIFITCANBEALLOCATEDTOINDIVIDUALUNITSOFSTOCKONALOGICALBASIS4HIS MEANSTHECOSTMUSTBEDIRECTLYTRACEABLETOAPARTICULARLINEOFSTOCK ANDAper item COSTCANBECALCULATEDONSOMELOGICALBASIS
On 15 April 2015, MacEvoy Golf Gear purchased 15 golf bags from Bear Industries (Ch. 51). The purchase of the golf bags showed the following: Golf bags – supplier’s price Cartage in Total – before GST GST (10%)
(15 bags @ $190 each)
Total
2 850 150 3 000 300 $3 300
4HEUNITCOSTTHATIS THECOSTPRICEOFONEGOLFBAG WOULDBECALCULATEDAS Supplier’s price Cartage in Unit cost of one bag
190 10
($150/15 bags)
$ 200
4HESUPPLIERSPRICEISOBVIOUSLYAPRODUCTCOSTITISINCURREDTOGETTHESTOCKREADY FORSALE ANDCANEASILYBEALLOCATEDTOINDIVIDUALUNITSOFSTOCKONALOGICALBASISASITIS ALREADYEXPRESSEDAS$190per bag #ARTAGEINISALSOINCURREDTOGETSTOCKREADYFORSALE BUTITAPPLIESTOTHEWHOLE PURCHASE#ANITBEALLOCATED'IVENTHATTHECARTAGEAPPLIESONLYTOTHISPURCHASE AND BAGSWEREORDERED ITISLOGICALTODIVIDETHETOTALCOST BYTHENUMBEROFBAGS PURCHASED TOCALCULATETHECOSTOFCARTAGEper bag$10 4HUS BOTHTHESUPPLIERS PRICEANDTHECARTAGEINCANBETREATEDASPRODUCTCOSTS ANDINCLUDEDINTHECOSTOF EACHBAG OR@PRODUCTHENCETHETERMPRODUCTCOST
Recording product costs "ECAUSEPRODUCTCOSTSARETREATEDASPARTOFTHEUNITCOSTOFEACHITEMOFSTOCK THEYARE NOTRECORDEDSEPARATELY BUTRATHERASPARTOFTHEVALUEOFSTOCKINTHESTOCKCARDANDTHE 3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNT4HEYARETREATEDASPARTOFTHEASSET STOCK Stock cards )NTHESTOCKCARD THEGOLFBAGSWOULDBEVALUEDUSINGTHEPRODUCTCOSTOF$200EACH $190SUPPLIERSPRICEPLUS$10CARTAGEIN ASISSHOWNIN&IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 14
Figure 14.1
S T O C K VA L U AT I O N
313
Stock card: product costs STOCK CARD
Stock item:
Golf bags
Location:
Storeroom
Stock code:
B140332
Supplier:
Bear Industries
IN Date
April 1 15
Details
Qty
Cost
OUT Total
Qty
Cost
BALANCE Total
Balance Ch. 51
15
200
3 000
Qty
Cost
Total
10
180
1 800
10
180
1 800
15
200
3 000
4HESUPPLIERSPRICEANDCARTAGEINARENOTIDENTIlEDSEPARATELYTHEYARENOWJUST PARTOFTHESAMECOSTPRICEOF$200 Cash Payments Journal and General Ledger *USTASTHEPRODUCTCOSTSARERECORDEDASPARTOFTHEVALUEOFSTOCKINTHESTOCKCARD SO ARETHEYRECORDEDTOGETHER ASONElGURE INTHEJOURNALSAND'ENERAL,EDGER &IGURESHOWSHOWTHEPURCHASEOFTHEGOLFBAGSWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH 0AYMENTS*OURNAL Figure 14.2
Cash Payments Journal: product costs Cash Payments Journal
Date April 15
Details
Chq. no.
Bank
Stock Control
51
3 300
Totals
25 000
Discount Revenue
Creditors Control
Stock Control
Drawings Sundries
3 000 800
19 000
3 000
GST 300
3 500
–
300
!SWITHALLPAYMENTS THEENTIREAMOUNTPAID$3 300 WOULDBEENTEREDINTHE"ANK COLUMN4HEAMOUNTINTHE3TOCK#ONTROLCOLUMN INCLUDESBOTHTHESUPPLIERS PRICE ANDTHECARTAGEIN 4HEREISNOSEPARATELEDGERACCOUNTFORCARTAGE IN ASTHISAMOUNTISINCLUDEDASPARTOFTHEVALUEOFSTOCKRECORDEDINTHE3TOCK#ONTROL ACCOUNT 4HE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERASUSUAL LEAVING THE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNTSHOWINGTHEFOLLOWING General Ledger Stock Control (A) Date
Cross-reference
April 1
Balance
30
Bank
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
18 000 3 000
)F THE PURCHASE WAS ON CREDIT THE EFFECT ON THE STOCK CARD AND THE 3TOCK #ONTROL ACCOUNTWOULDBETHESAME BUTTHETRANSACTIONWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE0URCHASES *OURNAL ANDCREDITEDTO#REDITORS#ONTROLINSTEADOF"ANK
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
314
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Product costs from other suppliers 4HETREATMENTOFPRODUCTCOSTSISTHESAMEEVENWHENADIFFERENTSUPPLIERPROVIDESTHE SERVICEOFDELIVERINGORMODIFYINGOURSTOCK&ORINSTANCE LETSCONTINUETOASSUMETHAT THEGOLFBAGSWEREPURCHASEDFROM"EAR)NDUSTRIES BUTASSUMETHATTHECARTAGEINWAS PROVIDEDBY'REEN3QUAREDELIVERYCOMPANY ANDPAIDFORUSING#HEQUE 4HETWOPAYMENTSAREMADETODIFFERENTSUPPLIERSBUT ASSUMINGTHECARTAGECANBE TRACEDDIRECTLYTOTHEGOLFBAGS BOTHAREFORTHESAMEORDEROFSTOCK ANDSOCANSTILL BETREATEDASPRODUCTCOSTS4HEREFORE THECOSTPRICEOFEACHGOLFBAGISSTILL$200 THE ONLYDIFFERENCEBEINGTHENEEDTORECOGNISETHATtwo paymentsWEREINVOLVEDINTHE PURCHASEOFTHESTOCK&IGURESHOWSHOWTHISWOULDBERECORDEDINTHESTOCKCARD Figure 14.3
Stock card: product costs – more than one supplier STOCK CARD
Stock item:
Golf bags
Location:
Storeroom
Stock code:
B140332
Supplier:
Bear Industries
IN Date
Details
Qty
Cost
OUT Total
Qty
Cost
BALANCE Total
April 1 Balance 15 Ch. 51/Ch. 52
15
200
3 000
Qty
Cost
Total
10
180
1 800
10
180
1 800
15
200
3 000
!SLONGASTHEYRELATETOTHESAMEITEMSOFSTOCK ALLPRODUCTCOSTSMUSTBERECORDED INTHESTOCKCARDBYADDINGTOTHECOSTPRICEOFEACHUNITOFSTOCK)NTHISEXAMPLE THE EXTRAPRODUCTCOSTTHECARTAGEIN WASINCURREDONTHEDAYTHESTOCKWASPURCHASED AND SO CAN BE RECORDED AS PART OF THE SAME LINE IN THE STOCK CARD WITH THE @$ETAILS COLUMNIDENTIFYINGBOTHSOURCEDOCUMENTS#HEQUEAND#HEQUE (ADTHESETWOPAYMENTSBEENMADEONDIFFERENTDATESSUCHAS!PRILAND!PRIL THETRANSACTIONSWOULDBEREPORTEDSEPARATELY BUTTHEVALUEOFSTOCKWOULDSTILLEND UPAS$200 ASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 14.4
Stock card: product costs – more than one supplier (different dates) STOCK CARD
Stock item:
Golf bags
Location:
Storeroom
Stock code:
B140332
Supplier:
Bear Industries
IN Date
April 1 15
17
Details
Qty
Cost
OUT Total
Qty
Balance Ch. 51
Ch. 52
15
15
190
10
2 850
150
Cost
BALANCE Total
Qty
Cost
Total
10
180
1 800
10
180
1 800
15
190
2 850
10
180
1 800
15
200
3 000
4HETRANSACTIONON!PRILDOESNOTINCREASETHEquantityOFSTOCKONHAND JUST ITSvalueFROM$190TO$200PERUNIT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 14
S T O C K VA L U AT I O N
315
!SSUMINGTHEORIGINALSCENARIOnWITHBOTHPAYMENTSMADEON!PRILn&IGURE SHOWSHOWTHETWOPAYMENTSWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL Figure 14.5
Cash Payments Journal: product costs – more than one supplier Cash Payments Journal
Date
Details
Apr. 15
Chq. no.
Bank
Discount Revenue
Creditors Control
Stock Control
Drawings
Sundries
GST
Stock Control
51
3 135
2 850
285
Stock Control
52
165
150
15
Totals
25 000
800
19 000
3 000
3 500
–
300
)F THE PURCHASE WAS MADE ON CREDIT WITH ADDITIONAL COSTS PAID IN CASH OR ALSO ON CREDIT SIMPLY RECORD THE TWO TRANSACTIONS IN THEIR APPROPRIATE JOURNAL AND SHOW THEMBOTHINTHESTOCKCARDASISSHOWNIN&IGUREORUSINGWHATEVERSOURCE DOCUMENTWOULDBEAPPROPRIATE REVIEW QUESTIONS 14.2
1 2 3 4
DefineTHETERM@PRODUCTCOST ExplainHOWPRODUCTCOSTSARERECORDEDINTHESTOCKCARDS ExplainHOWPRODUCTCOSTSARERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER ExplainHOWTHERECORDINGOFPRODUCTCOSTSDIFFERSIFMORETHANONESUPPLIERIS INVOLVED
14.3 PERIOD COSTS AND OTHER EXPENSES Identifying period costs )NTHEEXAMPLECONCERNINGTHEGOLFBAGS THEREWASALOGICALBASISONWHICHTOALLOCATE THECARTAGEIN SOITCOULDBEEXPRESSEDASCARTAGEper unitANDTREATEDASAPRODUCTCOST )NOTHERCASESWHERETHEREISnoLOGICALBASISFORALLOCATION THISMAYNOTBEPOSSIBLE )NCASESSUCHASTHIS THECOSTMUSTBETREATEDASAperiod cost
On 23 May 2015, MacEvoy Golf Gear purchased golf clothing from Nickwell Clothing (Ch. 65). The order showed the following: Golf shirts – supplier’s price Golf hats – supplier’s price Cartage in
(20 shirts @ $23 each) (10 hats @ $8 each)
Total – before GST GST (10%) Total
460 80 50
period cost a cost incurred in order to bring stock into a condition and location ready for sale that is not allocated to individual units of stock because there is no logical basis to do so
EXAMPLE
590 59 $649
)NTHISCASE THEREISNOLOGICALBASISTOALLOCATETHECARTAGEINOF BECAUSETHERE ARETWOdifferentTYPESOFSTOCKORDEREDGOLFSHIRTSANDGOLFHATS BOTHOFWHICHWOULD INCURCARTAGE7ECANNOTASSUMETHATTHECARTAGEINWOULDBETHESAMEFORSHIRTSAS ITISFORHATS ANDSIMPLYDIVIDETHECOSTBETWEENTHEITEMSSHIRTSANDHATS 4HEREFORE WEDONOTKNOWTHEper itemCOSTOFTHECARTAGE ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
316
STUDY TIP
"OTHPERIODAND PRODUCTCOSTSARE INCURREDTOGETSTOCK READYFORSALE SOTHIS CHARACTERISTICWILLNOT DISTINGUISHBETWEEN THETWO)TWILLONLY DISTINGUISHBETWEEN COSTSRELATEDTOSTOCK AND/THER%XPENSES SEEPAGE
UNITS 3&4
!SARESULT WEHAVENOCHOICEBUTTOTREATTHECARTAGEINASAPERIODCOST ANDVALUE THESTOCKONLYATTHEPRICECHARGEDBYTHESUPPLIER WHICHISPERSHIRTAND$8PERHAT 4HEDISTINCTIONBETWEENPERIODANDPRODUCTCOSTSRESTSPRIMARILYONTHEEXISTENCE OFAlogical basis for allocation)FACOSTCANBEALLOCATEDONAPERUNITBASIS ITMUSTBE TREATEDASAPRODUCTCOST/NLYWHENTHISALLOCATIONISNOTPOSSIBLESHOULDTHEITEMBE TREATEDASAPERIODCOST
Recording period costs 0ERIODCOSTSAREUNABLETOBETREATEDASPARTOFTHEUNITCOSTOFEACHITEMOFSTOCK SO THEYMUSTBERECORDEDANDREPORTEDSEPARATELYFROMTHESTOCKITSELF)NFACT THEYARE TREATEDASANEXPENSE)NTERMSOFTHESTOCKCARDS THEGOLFSHIRTSWOULDBEVALUEDONLYAT THEIRSUPPLIERSPRICEOFEACH ANDTHEGOLFHATSAT$8EACH ASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 14.6
Stock card: period costs STOCK CARD
Stock item:
Golf Shirt, 40 inch, Yellow
Location:
Storeroom
Stock code:
NCS40iY
Supplier:
Nickwell Clothing
IN Date
Details
May 1
Qty
OUT
Cost
Total
Qty
Cost
BALANCE Total
Balance
23
Ch. 67
20
23
460
Qty
Cost
Total
8
20
160
8
20
160
20
23
460
STOCK CARD Stock item:
Golf Hats, Large
Location:
Storeroom
Stock code:
NCHL
Supplier:
Nickwell Clothing
IN Date
Details
May 1 23
Qty
Cost
OUT Total
Qty
Cost
BALANCE Total
Balance Ch. 67
10
8
80
Qty
Cost
Total
20
7
140
20
7
140
10
8
80
"ECAUSETHECARTAGEINISNOTRECORDEDINTHESTOCKCARDS ITMUSTBERECORDEDINITS OWNSEPARATELEDGERACCOUNT&IGURESHOWSHOWTHEPURCHASEOFTHEGOLFSHIRTSAND HATSWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL Figure 14.7
Cash Payments Journal: period costs Cash Payments Journal
Date May 23
Details
Chq. no.
Stock Control
67
Bank
Discount Revenue
Creditors Control
Stock Control
649
Drawings
GST 59
540
Cartage In Totals
Sundries
50 31 000
200
26 500
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
540
4 051
50
59
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 14
S T O C K VA L U AT I O N
317
4HISSHOWSTHATOFTHE$649PAIDFORTHECLOTHING WASFORTHESTOCK WASFOR THECARTAGEIN ANDWAS'34"ECAUSETHECARTAGEINCANNOTBEITEMISED ITCANNOT BEINCLUDEDINTHESTOCKlGURE ANDMUSTBERECORDEDASASEPARATEEXPENSE)NTHE 'ENERAL,EDGERTHEREWOULDBEASEPARATELEDGERACCOUNTFORCARTAGEIN ASISSHOWN BELOW General Ledger Stock Control (A) Date
Cross-reference
May 1
Balance
31
Amount $
Bank
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
18 000 540 Cartage In (E)
Date May 31
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $
Date
50
Other Expenses
STUDY TIP
/NLYCOSTSTHATAREINCURREDTOGETSTOCKREADYFORSALECANBECLASSIlEDASPRODUCTOR PERIODCOSTS#OSTSTHATAREnotRELATEDTOTHEPURCHASEOFSTOCKARENEITHERPRODUCT COSTSNORPERIODCOSTS)NSTEAD THEYARECLASSIlEDAS/THER%XPENSES &ORTHESE/THER%XPENSES THEISSUEOFALOGICALBASISFORALLOCATIONDOESNOTAPPLY !SACONSEQUENCE ITSHOULDNOTBEGIVENASAREASONFOREXCLUDINGAPARTICULARITEM FROMTHECALCULATIONOFAUNITCOSTFORSTOCK4HEIRDElNINGCHARACTERISTICISTHATRATHER THANBEINGINCURREDTOBRINGSTOCKINTOACONDITIONANDLOCATIONREADYFORSALE THEYARE INCURREDAFTERTHESALE
)TCOULDBEARGUEDTHAT ANYCOSTTHATISNOTA PRODUCTCOSTISAPERIOD COST BUTTHISCOURSE DISTINGUISHESBETWEEN PERIODCOSTSAND/THER %XPENSES
REVIEW QUESTIONS 14.3
1 DefineTHETERM@PERIODCOST 2 #OMPAREDTOPRODUCTCOSTS explainONEDIFFERENCEINTHEWAYPERIODCOSTS ARERECORDEDIN s THESTOCKCARD s THE'ENERAL,EDGER 3 ExplainWHYDELIVERYTOCUSTOMERSISNOTCONSIDEREDTOBEPARTOFTHECOST OFSTOCK
14.4 REPORTING PRODUCT AND PERIOD COSTS !SWEHAVENOTED TREATINGCOSTSASPRODUCTCOSTSISPREFERRED BECAUSEallTHECOSTS INCURREDTOGETSTOCKREADYFORSALEAREALLOCATEDDIRECTLYTOTHEITEMSOFSTOCKTHEMSELVES )FTHESTOCKISUNSOLD THEPRODUCTCOSTSAREINCLUDEDINTHEVALUEOFTHEASSET 3TOCK #ONTROL7HENTHESTOCKISSOLD THEPRODUCTCOSTSARESIMPLYINCLUDEDINTHE#OSTOF 3ALESlGURE)NFACT PRODUCTCOSTSARERECOGNISEDASBEINGINCURRED ANDTHEIRBENElT CONSUMED INTHE2EPORTING0ERIODwhen stock is sold 0ERIODCOSTS ONTHEOTHERHAND ARERECORDEDSEPARATELYINTHELEDGER ANDREPORTED UNDER THE HEADING @#OST OF 'OODS 3OLD IN THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT &URTHER THEY ARE RECOGNISEDASBEINGINCURREDINTHEPERIODINWHICHTHEstock is purchased REGARDLESS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
318
UNITS 3&4
OFWHETHERORNOTTHESTOCKISSOLD5NLESSALLTHESTOCKISSOLD THISWILLOVERSTATE#OSTOF 'OODS3OLDANDUNDERSTATEPROlTANDTHEREFOREOWNERSEQUITY ANDUNDERSTATEASSETS BYUNDERSTATINGTHEVALUEOFSTOCKONHAND
EXAMPLE
During October 2015, HiFi Central imported 10 CD players for $120 (plus GST) each, incurring $350 (plus GST) to have the items modified to Australian specifications. The CD players will sell for $250 (plus GST) each.
Product costing !SSUMINGTHEMODIlCATIONSWERECORRECTLY TREATEDASPRODUCTCOSTS THECOSTOFONE #$PLAYERWOULDBE Supplier’s price Plus Modifications
120 35
Unit cost of one CD player
($350/10 CD players)
$155
!SSUMINGFOUR#$PLAYERSWERESOLDDURING/CTOBER THE)NCOME3TATEMENT EXTRACT WOULDAPPEARASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 14.8
Income Statement: product costs HIFI CENTRAL Income Statement (extract) for October 2015
Revenue
$
Sales
$ 1 000
(4 CD players x $250)
Less Cost of Goods Sold Cost of Sales
(4 CD players x $155)
620
Gross Profit
380
0RODUCT COSTING RECOGNISES THE EXPENSE AS BEING INCURRED ONLY IN THE 2EPORTING 0ERIODWHENTHESTOCKISSOLD"ECAUSEONLYFOUROUTOF#$PLAYERSHAVEBEENSOLD ONLY 10OFTHESPENTONMODIlCATIONSHASBEENRECOGNISEDASBEINGINCURREDIN /CTOBER4HISISINCLUDEDINTHE#OSTOF3ALESlGUREOF 4HEREMAINING 10OFTHEMODIlCATIONSCOSTnyet to be incurredBECAUSETHESTOCK HASNOTYETSOLDnISINCLUDEDINTHEVALUEOFSTOCKONHANDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETATTHE ENDOF/CTOBERASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 14.9
Balance Sheet: product costs HIFI CENTRAL Balance Sheet (extract) as at 31 October 2015
Current Assets Stock Control
$ (6 CD players x $155)
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
930
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 14
S T O C K VA L U AT I O N
319
Period costing !SSUMINGTHESAMEDATABUTUSINGPERIODCOSTINGWOULDPRODUCEVERYDIFFERENTREPORTS 0ERIODCOSTINGWOULDnotALLOCATETHEMODIlCATIONSTOEACH#$PLAYER ANDHENCEVALUE THEMATONLYTHEIRSUPPLIERSPRICEOF$120EACH(OWEVER ITWOULDRECOGNISETHEENTIRE SPENTONMODIlCATIONSASINCURREDINTHEPERIODWHENTHESTOCKISPURCHASED4HAT IS THEENTIREWOULDBEREPORTEDASANEXPENSEIN/CTOBER SOTHE)NCOME 3TATEMENTEXTRACT WOULDAPPEARASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 14.10
Income Statement: period costs HIFI CENTRAL Income Statement (extract) for October 2015
Revenue
$
Sales
$ 1 000
(4 CD players x $250)
Less Cost of Goods Sold Cost of Sales
(4 CD players x $120)
480
Modifications
350
Gross Profit
830 170
5NDERPERIODCOSTING THEENTIRECOSTOFTHEMODIlCATIONSHASBEENRECOGNISEDASAN EXPENSE EVENTHOUGHSIXREMAINUNSOLDONLY10OFTHE#$PLAYERSHAVEBEENSOLD BUT 10 10OFTHEHASBEENRECOGNISEDASBEINGINCURRED4HESIXREMAININGUNSOLD #$ PLAYERSWILLBEVALUEDONLYATTHEIRSUPPLIERSPRICEOF$120 ANDTHUSWOULDBESHOWNIN THE"ALANCE3HEETASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 14.11
Balance Sheet: period costs HIFI CENTRAL Balance Sheet (extract) as at 31 October 2015
Current Assets Stock Control
$ (6 CD players x $120)
720
!COMPARISONOFPRODUCTANDPERIODCOSTINGTHUSSHOWS Product costing Income Statement Sales Cost of Goods Sold Cost of Sales Plus Period Costs Gross Profit Balance Sheet Stock Control
4 units @ $250 4 units @ $155*
Period costing $ 1 000 620
$ 4 units @ $250 4 units @ $120 Modifications
380 6 units @ $155
930
6 units @ $120
480 350
$ 1 000
830 170 720
)NCLUDESpartOFCOSTOFMODIlCATIONS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
320
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
)NTHISEXAMPLE PERIODCOSTINGHASOVERSTATED#OSTOF'OODS3OLDAND ASARESULT HASUNDERSTATEDPROlTANDTHUSOWNERSEQUITY BY10UNSOLDX !TTHESAME TIME ITHASUNDERSTATED3TOCK#ONTROLANDTHUSASSETS BYTHESAMEAMOUNT BECAUSE THESIXREMAINING#$PLAYERSWILLBEONLYBEVALUEDATTHEIRSUPPLIERSPRICEOF 0ERIOD COSTING RECOGNISES THE ENTIRE COST AS AN EXPENSE IN THE 2EPORTING 0ERIOD WHENTHESTOCKISpurchased WHEREASPRODUCTCOSTINGINCLUDESTHECOSTASANEXPENSE ONLYINTHEPERIODINWHICHTHESTOCKIS sold!SARESULT UNLESSALLSTOCKISSOLD AND THISISANIMPORTANTCAVEAT PERIODCOSTINGWILLUNDERSTATE#OSTOF'OODS3OLDANDTHUS UNDERSTATE PROlT AND OWNERS EQUITY AND UNDERSTATE 3TOCK #ONTROL AND ASSETS 4HE EXACTAMOUNTBYWHICHTHESEITEMSWILLBEDIFFERENTCANBECALCULATEDBYMULTIPLYINGTHE PERIODCOSTBYTHEFRACTIONOFITEMSOFSTOCKREMAININGUNSOLD
Conclusion )FACOSTISINCURREDTOGETSTOCKREADYFORSALE ANDCANBEALLOCATEDTOINDIVIDUALUNITS ONALOGICALBASIS THENITisAPRODUCTCOST%XCEPTWHERETHECOSTISINSIGNIlCANTSEE BELOW TREATINGAPRODUCTCOSTASAPERIODCOSTLEADSTOTHEOMISSIONOFINFORMATIONTHAT WOULDBEUSEFULFORDECISION MAKING ANDTHUSBREACHESRelevance 7HERE THERE IS no LOGICAL BASIS ON WHICH TO ALLOCATE THE COST TO INDIVIDUAL UNITS PERIODCOSTINGmustBEUSED)NTHISSITUATION TREATINGAPERIODCOSTASAPRODUCTCOST WOULDLEADTOTHEINCLUSIONOFINFORMATIONTHATISnotUSEFULFORDECISION MAKING "UT EQUALLY PERIOD COSTING may BE USED IF THE COST CONCERNED CAN BE ALLOCATED BUT IS too small TO AFFECT DECISION MAKING THAT IS IS IMMATERIAL (ERE WE ARE TALKING ABOUTCOSTSTHATWOULDOTHERWISEBE CORRECTLY TREATEDASPRODUCTCOSTS BUTDUETOTHEIR INSIGNIlCANCEMAYBETREATEDASPERIODCOSTS4HEINSIGNIlCANCEOFSUCHITEMSMEANS THATITSHOULDNOTREALLYMATTERHOWTHEYARETREATED BECAUSE BYDElNITION THEYWILL NOTAFFECTDECISION MAKING REVIEW QUESTIONS 14.4
1 #OMPAREDTOPRODUCTCOSTS explainONEDIFFERENCEINTHEWAYPERIODCOSTS AREREPORTEDINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT 2 ExplainTHEEFFECTONPROlTIFPERIODCOSTINGISUSEDINSTEADOFPRODUCTCOSTING 3 ExplainTHEEFFECTONTHE"ALANCE3HEETIFPERIODCOSTINGISUSEDINSTEADOF PRODUCTCOSTING 4 StateTWOCIRCUMSTANCESINWHICHITWOULDBEACCEPTABLETOUSEPERIODCOSTING 5 2EFERRING TO ONE QUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTIC explain WHY THE CORRECT STOCK VALUATIONMETHODSHOULDBEAPPLIED
14.5 THE LOWER OF COST AND NET REALISABLE VALUE (NRV) RULE )NTHEVASTMAJORITYOFCASES VALUINGSTOCKATITSCOSTPRICEENSURESTHATBOTHTHE(ISTORICAL #OSTAND#ONSERVATISMPRINCIPLESAREUPHELD)TISUSUALFORTHECOSTPRICEOFTHESTOCK TOBElessTHANITSSELLINGPRICE SORECORDINGITINTHESTOCKCARDSATITSORIGINALPURCHASE PRICE WHICH IS REQUIRED BY THE (ISTORICAL #OST PRINCIPLE ALSO MEANS THE STOCK IS NOT OVERSTATED WHICHISTHEGOALOF#ONSERVATISM )N SOME SITUATIONS HOWEVER THE SELLING PRICE OF THE STOCK WILL FALL below THE COST PRICEAND INSTEADOFGENERATINGAPROlTONTHESALE ITISPROBABLETHATALOSSWILLOCCUR &OR INSTANCE IF STOCK IS DAMAGED IT MAY END UP BEING SOLD FOR LESS THAN ITS ORIGINAL PURCHASEPRICE)NCASESSUCHASTHESE CONTINUINGTOVALUESTOCKATITSCOSTPRICEWOULD BREACH#ONSERVATISMINTWOWAYSITWOULDNOTRECOGNISETHELOSSTHATISPROBABLEON THESALEOFTHESTOCKANDITWOULDOVERSTATETHEASSETSTOCK INTHE"ALANCE3HEET ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 14
S T O C K VA L U AT I O N
321
4OAVOIDBREACHING#ONSERVATISM STOCKMUSTBEVALUEDATWHICHEVERISLOWERITSCOST PRICE ORWHATISKNOWNASITS.ET2EALISABLE6ALUE4HISISKNOWNASTHELOWEROFCOST AND.ET2EALISABLE6ALUE.26 RULE Stock must be valued at the lower of ‘cost’ and ‘Net Realisable Value’.
Net Realisable Value 4HESELLINGPRICEOFSTOCKISALSOKNOWNASITSREALISABLEVALUEWHATITCANREALISEINDOLLAR TERMSONITSSALE4HEOWNERMUST HOWEVER TAKEINTOACCOUNTTHATTHEREAREDIRECTCOSTS INVOLVEDINTHESALEOFPARTICULARSTOCKITEMS SUCHASMARKETINGANDDISTRIBUTION4HESE MUSTBESUBTRACTEDTODETERMINEAPARTICULARSTOCKITEMSNETWORTH HENCETHETERMNet Realisable Value (NRV).26ISTHEESTIMATEDSELLINGPRICEOFTHESTOCKLESSANYCOSTS INVOLVEDINITSSELLING MARKETINGORDISTRIBUTION)NESSENCE ITMEANSWHATWECANSELLIT FORlessWHATITWILLCOSTUSTOCARRYOUTTHESELLING
Net Realisable Value (NRV) = Estimated selling – Direct selling price expenses
Net Realisable Value (NRV) the estimated selling price of stock less any costs involved in its selling, marketing or distribution
STUDY TIP
'34 ASITAPPLIESTOEITHERTHESELLINGPRICEORTHECOSTPRICE ISNOTAFACTORTOBE CONSIDEREDINTHEVALUATIONOFSTOCK ASITAFFECTS'34CLEARING NOTSTOCKORPROlT#OST ISCALCULATEDWITHTHE'34EXCLUDED ANDSOIS.26 Reasons why NRV may fall below cost 4RADINGlRMSAIMTOGENERATEPROlTBYSETTINGTHEIRSELLINGPRICESHIGHERTHANTHECOST PRICE3O INNORMALCIRCUMSTANCES THECOSTOFTHESTOCKWOULDBElowerTHANITS.26 ANDSTOCKWILLCONTINUETOBEVALUEDACCORDINGTOITSCOSTPURCHASEPRICE (OWEVER IN SOMESITUATIONSTHE.26MAYFALLbelowCOST DUETO s physical deteriorationBECAUSETHESTOCKISDAMAGED ORSHOPSOILED MEANINGITCAN NOLONGERBESOLDATAPROlT s a purposeful decrease in selling price PERHAPSEVENBELOWCOSTPRICE ASADELIBERATE MARKETINGPLOYTOATTRACTNEWCUSTOMERSORFORCEACOMPETITOROUTOFTHEMARKET s a decrease in demandBECAUSETHEITEMISNOLONGERINFASHION ORISOUTOFSEASON #ONSEQUENTLY CUSTOMERS MAY NOT BE WILLING TO PAY HIGH PRICES 4HIS APPLIES PARTICULARLYTOCLOTHES SPORTINGEQUIPMENTANDFADS s obsolescenceBECAUSETHEITEMISTECHNICALLYOBSOLETE SUPERSEDEDBYANEWMODEL OR INTHECASEOFFOODITEMS OUTOFDATE)TEMSSUCHASTHESEWILLBEDIFlCULTTOSELL FORMORETHANTHEIRCOSTPRICE !PPLYING THE LOWER OF COST AND .26 RULE UPHOLDS #ONSERVATISM BY RECOGNISING LOSSES ON THE STOCK AS SOON AS THEY ARE PROBABLE IT ENSURES THAT STOCK AN ASSET IS NOTOVERSTATED)NTHEPROCESS AMOREREALISTICVALUATIONOFSTOCKWILLBEDERIVED AND Relevance WILL BE UPHELD AS THE INFORMATION IN THE REPORTS WILL BE MORE USEFUL FOR DECISION MAKING 4HISRULEMUSTBEAPPLIEDONANINDIVIDUALBASIS BECAUSETHECOSTPRICEOFSOMELINES OFSTOCKMAYSTILLBELOWERTHANTHEIR.264HESEITEMSWILLNEEDTOREMAINVALUEDATTHEIR COSTPRICE ANDSHOULDNOTBEWRITTENDOWN
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
4HECOSTPRICEOFSTOCK ISITSORIGINALPURCHASE PRICEplusANYCOSTTO GETITREADYFORSALE .26ISTHEESTIMATED SELLINGPRICElessANY COSTSINVOLVEDINITSSALE
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
322
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 14.5
1 2EFERRINGTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC explainWHYSTOCKISUSUALLYVALUED ATITS(ISTORICAL#OST 2 ExplainTHECIRCUMSTANCESUNDERWHICHVALUINGSTOCKATITS(ISTORICAL#OSTMAY BREACH#ONSERVATISM 3 Defi[email protected] 4 ExplainWHYSTOCKWOULDNORMALLYBEVALUEDATITSCOST RATHERTHANITS.26 5 StateFOURREASONSWHY.26MAYFALLBELOWCOST 6 Explain HOW THE APPLICATION OF THE LOWER OF COST AND .26 RULE SUPPORTS #ONSERVATISM 7 ExplainWHYTHELOWEROFCOSTAND.26RULESHOULDBEAPPLIEDTOINDIVIDUAL STOCKLINES
14.6 STOCK WRITE-DOWN
Stock Write-down the expense incurred when the NRV of an item of stock falls below its original purchase price
EXAMPLE
7HENTHE.26OFASTOCKITEMFALLSbelowITSCOSTPRICE s ANEXPENSEWILLBEINCURRED INTHEFORMOFALOSSONTHESALEOFTHESTOCK s THEASSETSTOCKMUSTBE@WRITTENDOWNTOREmECTITSLOWERVALUE 4HIS IS RECOGNISED BY RECORDING A Stock Write-down WHICH IS THE EXPENSE THAT IS INCURREDWHENTHE.26OFANITEMFALLSBELOWITSCOSTPRICE4HEAMOUNTOFTHE3TOCK 7RITE DOWNCANBECALCULATEDASTHEDIFFERENCEBETWEENITSCOSTANDITS.26
During August 2015, Dave’s Discount Appliance Store had the following transactions: Aug.
1 8 23 31
Purchased 10 ‘Clarity’ dishwashers for $500 (plus GST) each (Inv. 29) Sold 4 dishwashers for $650 (plus GST) each (Rec. 17) Release of new dishwasher model – ‘Clarity Plus’ Dave decided to reduce the selling price of the remaining ‘Clarity’ dishwashers to $550 (plus GST) each, and spend $720 (plus GST) on a special advertising campaign to promote the sale (Memo 31)
'34DOESNOTAFFECTPROlTORTHEVALUATIONOFSTOCK SOITCANBEIGNOREDWHENCALCULATING BOTHTHECOSTAND.26
Calculating the NRV 4HE.26OFTHESIXREMAININGDISHWASHERSWOULDBECALCULATEDAS NRV
= = =
Estimated selling price $550 $430 per dishwasher
– –
Direct selling expenses per unit $120 ($720/6 dishwashers)
7HEN THE DISHWASHERS WERE PURCHASED ON !UGUST EACH WAS VALUED AT ITS COSTPRICEOF ASTHISWASNOTONLYTHE(ISTORICAL#OST BUTALSOlowerTHANTHE.26 THATIS THESELLINGPRICEOF$6504HISISTHEVALUEATWHICHEACHWOULDCONTINUETOBE SHOWNINTHESTOCKCARD ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 14
S T O C K VA L U AT I O N
323
"Y !UGUST THE .26 OF EACH DISHWASHER HAS FALLEN BELOW ITS COST "ECAUSESTOCKMUSTBEVALUEDATTHELOWEROFCOSTAND.26 EACHDISHWASHER MUSTBEWRITTENDOWNFROMITSCOST TOITS.26 VIAA3TOCK7RITE DOWN Calculating the Stock Write-down STUDY TIP
4HE3TOCK7RITE DOWNOFEACHDISHWASHERWOULDBECALCULATEDAS Stock Write-down
= = =
Historical Cost $500 $70 per dishwasher
– –
NRV $430
'IVEN THAT THERE ARE SIX DISHWASHERS STILL ON HAND EACH OF WHICH MUST BE WRITTEN DOWNBY$70 THETOTAL3TOCK7RITE DOWNISX$70
)FTHE3TOCK7RITE DOWN lGURETURNSOUTTOBE NEGATIVE THE.26IS greaterTHANTHECOST SO A3TOCK7RITE DOWNIS NOTNECESSARY
Recording the Stock Write-down 2EMEMBER ATTHETIMEOFPURCHASESTOCKISRECORDEDATITSCOST)FTHESTOCKMUSTBE WRITTEN DOWN TO ITS .26 THEN BOTH THE STOCK CARD AND THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER MUST BE ADJUSTED 4HE STOCK CARD FOR DISHWASHERS MUST RECORD THE WRITE DOWN per item AS IS SHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 14.12
Stock card: Stock Write-down STOCK CARD
Stock item:
Dishwasher, Clarity
Location:
Row 5, Bay 2
Stock code:
CD3000
Supplier:
Fusher and Pake
IN Date
Aug. 31 31
Details
Qty
Cost
OUT Total
Qty
Cost
BALANCE Total
Balance Memo 31
6
70
420
Qty
Cost
Total
6
500
3 000
6
430
2 580
.OTICETHATEVENTHOUGHTHISENTRYISRECORDEDINTHE/UTCOLUMNOFTHESTOCKCARD NOUNITSOFSTOCKAREACTUALLYLEAVINGTHEBUSINESSSTOCKHASBEENREDUCEDINvalue NOT INquantity%ACHDISHWASHERISWRITTENDOWNBY$70 LEAVINGEACHONEVALUEDATITS.26 OFCOSTPRICELESS$703TOCK7RITE DOWN 4HE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYTORECORDTHEWRITE DOWNOFSTOCKATITS.26ISSHOWNIN &IGURE Figure 14.13
General Journal: Stock Write-down General Journal
Date Aug. 31
Details Stock Write-down Stock Control
General Ledger
Subsidiary ledger
Debit
Debit
Credit
Credit
420 420
Write down of 6 dishwashers to NRV – release of new model (Memo 31)
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
324
STUDY TIP
4HEAMOUNTUSEDINTHE 'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYIS THEAMOUNTOFTHE3TOCK 7RITE DOWN NOTTHE NEWBALANCEOFSTOCK ONHAND
UNITS 3&4
3TOCK 7RITE DOWN IS DEBITED TO RECOGNISE THE EXPENSE THE LOSS OF AN ECONOMIC BENElTINTHEFORMOFAREDUCTIONINASSETSSTOCK WHICHDECREASESOWNERSEQUITY!T THE SAME TIME THE ASSET 3TOCK #ONTROL IS CREDITED TO RECOGNISE THAT THE ASSET IS NO LONGERWORTHITS(ISTORICAL#OST 4HIS'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERASISSHOWNIN &IGURE Figure 14.14
General Ledger: Stock Write-down General Ledger Stock Write-down (E)
Date Aug. 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
420
Aug. 31
Stock Control
Cross-reference Profit and Loss Summary
420
Amount $ 420 420
Stock Control (A) Date Aug. 1
Cross-reference
Amount $ Date
Balance
10 000
Creditors Control
11 000
Aug. 31
Cross-reference Cost of Sales
5 600
Cost of Sales
3 400
Stock Write-down Balance $21 000 Sept. 1
Balance
Amount $
420 11 580 $21 000
11 580
!SANEXPENSEACCOUNT 3TOCK7RITE DOWN WOULDBECLOSEDTOTHE0ROlTAND ,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTATTHEENDOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIOD WITHALLTHE/THER%XPENSE ACCOUNTS)TISTHENEWSTOCKBALANCE THATMUSTBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE 3HEET Effect on the accounting equation 4HEOVERALLEFFECTOFA3TOCK7RITE DOWNIS Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
Decrease (Stock Control)
Liabilities
No effect
Owner’s Equity
Decrease (Stock Write-down expense decreases Profit)
420
420
REVIEW QUESTIONS 14.6
1 2 3 4
DefineTHETERM@3TOCK7RITE DOWN ShowHOWTHEAMOUNTOFA3TOCK7RITE DOWNISCALCULATED ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDA3TOCK7RITE DOWN ExplainWHYA3TOCK7RITE DOWNISRECORDEDINTHE/UTCOLUMNOFTHESTOCK CARD 5 StateTHEEFFECTOFA3TOCK7RITE DOWNONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 14
S T O C K VA L U AT I O N
325
14.7 REPORTING A STOCK WRITE-DOWN "ECAUSE3TOCK7RITE DOWNISNOTACOSTINVOLVEDINGETTINGTHESTOCKINTOAPOSITIONOR CONDITIONREADYFORSALE ITSHOULDNOTBECLASSIlEDUNDER#OSTOF'OODS3OLDITWILLNOT AFFECTTHEMARK UPONSTOCKWHICHISREmECTEDIN'ROSS0ROlT(OWEVER ITISrelatedTO STOCK ANDWILLAFFECTTHEOVERALLMARGINTHATTHEBUSINESSWILLEARNFROMTHESALEOFSTOCK )NTHISWAY A3TOCK7RITE DOWNHASTHESAMEEFFECTASASTOCKLOSSORGAIN ANDSOITIS REPORTEDASADEDUCTIONFROM'ROSS0ROlT TODETERMINE!DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlT &IGURESHOWSHOW3TOCK7RITE DOWNWOULDAPPEARINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT Figure 14.15
Income Statement: Stock Write-down DAVE’S DISCOUNT APPLIANCE STORE Income Statement for August 2015
Revenue
$
$
Sales
18 500
Less Cost of Goods Sold Cost of Sales
9 000
Customs Duty
1 000
10 000
Gross Profit
8 500
Less Stock Write-down
420
Adjusted Gross Profit
8 080
STUDY TIP
.OWTHATTHEDISHWASHERSHAVEBEENWRITTENDOWN ALLSTOCKISVALUEDATTHELOWEROF COSTAND.26 ANDTHEBALANCEOFSTOCKONHANDWILLBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEET ASITNORMALLYWOULD
!3TOCK7RITE DOWNIS REPORTEDINTHESAME PLACEASASTOCKLOSS ORGAIN
DAVE’S DISCOUNT APPLIANCE STORE Balance Sheet (extract) as at 31 August 2015 Current Assets
$
Bank
1 200
Debtors Control
5 600
Stock Control
11 580
$
18 380
REVIEW QUESTIONS 14.7
1 ExplainWHY3TOCK7RITE DOWNISNOTREPORTEDASPARTOF#OSTOF'OODS3OLD INTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT 2 ExplainHOWA3TOCK7RITE DOWNAFFECTS!DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
326
UNITS 3&4
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s 4HE (ISTORICAL #OST PRINCIPLE STATES THAT STOCK SHOULD BE VALUED AT ITS ORIGINAL PURCHASEPRICE ASTHISISVERIlABLEBYREFERENCETOASOURCEDOCUMENT s 4HE COST OF STOCK INCLUDES ALL COSTS INCURRED IN ORDER TO BRING THE STOCK INTO A CONDITIONANDLOCATIONREADYFORSALE s 0RODUCTCOSTSCANBEALLOCATEDTOINDIVIDUALUNITSOFSTOCKONALOGICALBASISPERIOD COSTSCANNOT s 0RODUCTCOSTSARERECORDEDASINCREASESTOTHEUNITCOSTOFSTOCKINTHESTOCKCARDS PERIODCOSTSARERECORDEDSEPARATELYINTHELEDGER s 0RODUCTCOSTSARERECOGNISEDASBEINGINCURREDONLYINTHEPERIODINWHICHSTOCKIS SOLDPERIODCOSTSARERECOGNISEDASBEINGINCURREDINTHEPERIODINWHICHTHESTOCK ISPURCHASED s 4OAVOIDBREACHING#ONSERVATISM STOCKMUSTBEVALUEDATTHELOWEROFCOSTAND.ET 2EALISABLE6ALUE.26 s .26ISTHEESTIMATEDSELLINGPRICEOFTHESTOCKLESSANYCOSTSINVOLVEDINITSSELLING MARKETINGORDISTRIBUTION s 3TOCK7RITE DOWNISCALCULATEDBYDEDUCTING.26FROMHISTORICAL COST s 4HE OVERALL EFFECT OF A 3TOCK 7RITE DOWN IS TO DECREASE BOTH ASSETS AND OWNERS EQUITY
EXERCISES
EXERCISE 14.1 COST OF STOCK
W B
page 296
/N-ARCH %L&RESCO,IVINGHADBARBECUESONHANDWORTHEACH/N -ARCH THEBUSINESSPURCHASEDBARBECUESATACOSTOFPLUS'34 EACH WITH CARTAGEINCOSTINGPLUS'34 PERBARBECUE#H 4HEBARBECUESWILLHAVEA SELLINGPRICEOFPLUS'34 EACH Required a ExplainWHYTHE'34ONTHEPURCHASEISnotINCLUDEDINTHECALCULATIONOFTHECOST PRICEOFSTOCK b CalculateTHECOSTPRICEOFONEOFTHEBARBECUESPURCHASEDON-ARCH c 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@B explainYOURTREATMENTOF@CARTAGEIN d RecordTHEPURCHASEON-ARCHINTHESTOCKCARDFORBARBECUES e Record#HEQUEINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALOF%L&RESCO,IVING
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 14
EXERCISE 14.2 COST OF STOCK
S T O C K VA L U AT I O N
W B
page 297
!SAT*ANUARY #OMFY#OUCHESHADEIGHTCOUCHESONHANDWITHACOSTPRICEOF EACH /N*ANUARY THEBUSINESSPURCHASEDCOUCHESFROM7ILSON0RODUCTS)NV WITHTHEDETAILSOFTHEPURCHASEPROVIDEDASFOLLOWS Supplier’s price
15 000
Anti-stain treatment
1 300
Sub-total
16 300
GST Total invoice cost
1 630 $17 930
%ACHCOUCHHASASELLINGPRICEOFPLUS'34 WITHASPECIALADVERTISINGCAMPAIGN TOSELLTHECOUCHESCOSTINGINCLUDING'34 Required a 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainWHYTHECOUCHESCANNOTBEVALUEDAT THEIRSELLINGPRICE b CalculateTHECOSTPRICEOFONEOFTHECOUCHESPURCHASEDON*ANUARY c 2EFERRING TO YOUR ANSWER TO PART @B explain YOUR TREATMENT OF THE ADVERTISING CAMPAIGN d RecordTHEPURCHASEON*ANUARYINTHESTOCKCARDFOR#OUCHES e RecordTHEPURCHASEON*ANUARYINTHEAPPROPRIATEJOURNALOF#OMFY#OUCHES
EXERCISE 14.3 PRODUCT VERSUS PERIOD COSTING
W B
page 298
"EN3COTTOWNSANELECTRICALSHOPCALLED(IGH6OLTAGE WHICHISTHESOLEDISTRIBUTOROFA NEWCOMBINEDWASHERDRYER4HEDETAILSOFTHENEWWASHERDRYERARE Invoice price
900
per unit
Freight in
10%
of invoice price
Modification costs
$25
per unit
Insurance of stock
$400
per month
)N.OVEMBER "ENPURCHASEDWASHERDRYERS"Y.OVEMBER OF THEWASHERDRYERSHADBEENSOLDFORPLUS'34 EACH Required a b c d e
ExplainWHYTHEMODIlCATIONCOSTSSHOULDBETREATEDASPRODUCTCOSTS ExplainWHYINSURANCEOFSTOCKMUSTBETREATEDASAPERIODCOST CalculateTHEUNITCOSTOFONEWASHERDRYER Calculate'ROSS0ROlTONWASHERDRYERSFOR.OVEMBER 2EFERRINGTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC explainWHYITISIMPORTANTTHATTHECOST PRICEOFSTOCKISCALCULATEDACCURATELY
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
327
328
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 14.4 PRODUCT VERSUS PERIOD COSTS
W B
page 299
!S AT &EBRUARY &0 "ICYCLES HAD FOUR MOUNTAIN BIKES ON HAND THAT IT HAD PURCHASEDFORPLUS'34 EACH/N&EBRUARY &0"ICYCLESPURCHASED MOUNTAINBIKESFORATOTALCOSTOFINCLUDING'34 FROM7ONDER#YCLES)NV! /NTHESAMEDAY &0"ICYCLESPAIDAFURTHERPLUS'34 FORSIGNWRITINGONTHE NEWBIKES#H !TTHEENDOF&EBRUARY EIGHTMOUNTAINBIKESREMAINEDON HAND Required a CalculateTHECOSTOFONEOFTHEMOUNTAINBIKESPURCHASEDON&EBRUARY b 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@A explainYOURTREATMENTOFTHECOSTOFSIGNWRITING c RecordTHEPURCHASEOFSTOCKON&EBRUARYINTHESTOCKCARDFORMOUNTAIN BIKES d RecordTHEPURCHASEOFSTOCKON&EBRUARYINTHEAPPROPRIATEJOURNALSOF&0 "ICYCLES e CalculateTHEVALUEOFMOUNTAINBIKESONHANDASAT&EBRUARY f CalculateTHEVALUEOFMOUNTAINBIKESONHANDASAT&EBRUARYIFTHECOSTOF THESIGNWRITINGHADBEENTREATEDASAPERIODCOST g StateTHEEFFECTONTHEVALUATIONOFSTOCKONHANDASAT&EBRUARYIFTHECOST OFSIGNWRITINGHADBEENTREATEDASAPERIODCOST
EXERCISE 14.5 PRODUCT VERSUS PERIOD COSTS
W B
page 301
3TATIC 3OUND AND 6ISION COMMENCED /PERATIONS ON !PRIL SELLING TELEVISIONS AND STEREO SYSTEMS 4HE OWNER HAS PROVIDED THE FOLLOWING DOCUMENT RELATING TO THE PURCHASEOFSTOCKON!PRIL
Wired Electronics
TAX INVOICE Invoice 201
ABN: 66 765 400 008 89 Mill St Bendigo VIC 3550 Charge to:
Terms: 5/7, n/30
Static Sound and Vision (ABN: 12 500 438 966) Bell St, Coburg VIC 3058
Date
Details
Apr. 1
60 inch television Mini stereo system
Qty
Unit price $
$
12
650
7 800
5
300
1 500
Freight
300
Subtotal
9 600
GST
960 Total
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Total
$
10 560
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 14
S T O C K VA L U AT I O N
$URING!PRIL THREETELEVISIONSWERESOLDFORINCLUDING'34 EACH AND TWOSTEREOSYSTEMSWERESOLDFORINCLUDING'34 EACH/NETELEVISIONWASWRITTEN OFFAS3TOCK,OSSDUEAFTERITWASDROPPEDINTHESHOWROOM Required
*
a Record )NVOICEINTHEJOURNALSOF3TATIC3OUNDAND6ISION b 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@A explainYOURTREATMENTOFFREIGHT c PrepareAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR3TATIC3OUNDAND6ISIONFOR!PRIL SHOWING 'ROSS0ROlTAND!DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlT!FULL)NCOME3TATEMENTISnotREQUIRED d ExplainHOWPERIODCOSTSCANUNDERSTATEPROlT
EXERCISE 14.6 PRODUCT VERSUS PERIOD COSTS
W B
page 303
.ORDIC3UPPLIESPURCHASESSKIGOGGLESINSHIPMENTSOFUNITS4HEYARESOLDUNDER .ORDIC 3UPPLIES OWN BRAND NAME AND FREE DELIVERY IS OFFERED TO CUSTOMERS 4HE FOLLOWINGDETAILSHAVEBEENPROVIDEDFORAPURCHASEON*ULYAMOUNTSDOnot INCLUDE'34 Supplier’s invoice price Attachment of brand badges Packaging and delivery to Nordic Supplies Cost of delivery to customers Insurance of stock in Nordic Supplies store
$9 000 80 1 600 9 1 800
per unit per annum
Additional information: s $URING*ULY PAIRSOFGOGGLESWERESOLD s 4HEACCOUNTANTHASDECIDEDTOTREATTHECOSTOFATTACHINGTHEBRANDBADGESASA PERIODCOST Required a DiscussTHEACCOUNTANTSDECISIONTOTREATTHECOSTOFATTACHINGTHEBRANDBADGESAS APERIODCOST b CalculateTHECOSTPRICEOFEACHPAIROFGOGGLESPURCHASEDON*ULY c 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@B explainYOURTREATMENTOFINSURANCEOFSTOCK d Calculate#OSTOF'OODS3OLDFORGOGGLESFOR*ULY e Calculate#OSTOF'OODS3OLDFORGOGGLESFOR*ULYIFPACKAGINGANDDELIVERY HADBEENTREATEDASAPERIODCOST f StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF.ORDIC3UPPLIESIFPACKAGINGAND DELIVERYHADBEENTREATEDASAPERIODCOST
EXERCISE 14.7 LOWER OF COST AND NRV
W B
page 304
$URING -ALCOLMS -EMORABILIA PURCHASED COMMEMORATIVE PLATES OF !USTRALIAS lRST7ORLD#UPQUALIlCATIONINYEARS!SAT-AYITSTILLHADPLATESONHAND EACHWITHACOSTPRICEOF4HEPLATESWEREORIGINALLYSOLDFORPLUS'34 BUTON -AY THE OWNER ESTIMATED THEY COULD BE SOLD FOR ONLY PLUS '34 EACH -EMO Required a CalculateTHEVALUEOFPLATESONHANDASSHOWNINTHESTOCKCARDAT-AY b 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainWHYTHEPLATESSHOULDBEVALUEDAT THELOWEROFCOSTAND.26 ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
329
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
330
UNITS 3&4
c CalculateTHETOTAL3TOCK7RITE DOWNONTHEPLATESASAT-AY d ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHE3TOCK7RITE DOWNOFTHE PLATES e RecordTHE3TOCK7RITE DOWNINTHESTOCKCARDFORPLATES f Explain HOW THE 3TOCK 7RITE DOWN WILL AFFECT THE "ALANCE 3HEET OF -ALCOLMS -EMORABILIAASAT-AY
EXERCISE 14.8 LOWER OF COST AND NRV
W B
page 306
3UKHVEER 'UNERATNE OWNS 3IR 6AYLANCE A SHOP THAT SELLS SECURITY CAMERAS !S AT 3EPTEMBER THElRMHAD6IEWMASTERVIDEOCAMERASINSTOCK VALUEDAT EACH/N3EPTEMBER SIXVIDEOCAMERASWERESOLDFORPLUS'34 EACH 2EC /N3EPTEMBER THEOWNERDECIDEDTOLOWERTHESELLINGPRICEOFTHE REMAININGCAMERASTOPLUS'34 EACH-EMO 4OENCOURAGETHESALEOFTHESE CAMERASTOMAKEWAYFORNEWSTOCKSHEHASOFFEREDHERSALESSTAFFCOMMISSIONON EACHSALE Required
*
a Defi[email protected].26 b CalculateTHETOTAL.26OFTHECAMERAS c ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHE3TOCK7RITE DOWNOFTHE CAMERAS d RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR3EPTEMBERINTHESTOCKCARDFORCAMERAS e PrepareAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR3IR6AYLANCEFOR3EPTEMBER WHICHSHOWS 'ROSS0ROlTAND!DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlT!FULL)NCOME3TATEMENTISnotREQUIRED
EXERCISE 14.9 LOWER OF COST AND NRV
W B
page 308
'IRLFRIEND&ASHIONSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONAFTERCONDUCTINGASTOCKTAKE ON$ECEMBER-EMO Cost price per unit
Estimated selling price per unit
Direct selling expenses per unit
Stock item
Qty
Jeans
200
$50
$75
$5
Shirts
50
$35
$40
$8
Hats
400
$20
$28
$3
Required a CalculateTHEVALUEOFSTOCKONHANDASAT$ECEMBERASWOULDBESHOWNIN THESTOCKCARDS b CalculateTHEVALUEOFSTOCKONHANDASAT$ECEMBERBYAPPLYINGTHELOWER OFCOSTAND.26RULE c State THREE REASONS THAT MAY EXPLAIN WHY THE .26 OF THE STOCK HAS FALLEN BELOW ITSCOST d Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO WRITE DOWN THE VALUE OF STOCK ON $ECEMBER.ARRATIONIS notREQUIRED e RecordTHE3TOCK7RITE DOWNINTHEAPPROPRIATESTOCKCARD f StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF'IRLFRIEND&ASHIONSIFTHESTOCKISnot WRITTENDOWN ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 14
S T O C K VA L U AT I O N
EXERCISE 14.10 LOWER OF COST AND NRV
W B
page 310
(IGH#OUNTRY#AMPINGHASPRODUCEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONREGARDINGITSSTOCKOF SNOWJACKETSASAT/CTOBER Snow jackets:
Stock on hand
50 @ $70
3 500
20 @ $72
1 440
4HE NORMAL SELLING PRICE OF EACH JACKET IS PLUS '34 EACH BUT AS IT IS NEARINGTHEENDOFTHESKISEASON THEOWNERESTIMATESEACHJACKETWILLONLYSELLFOR PLUS'34 EACH-EMO 4HISWILLREQUIREEXTRASELLINGEXPENSESCOSTING PLUS'34 Required a ReferringTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainWHYITWOULDBEINCORRECTTOVALUE THEJACKETSATEACH b ReferringTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC explainWHYTHEJACKETSSHOULDNOLONGER BEVALUEDATTHEIR(ISTORICAL#OST c CalculateTHE3TOCK7RITE DOWNONSNOWJACKETSASAT/CTOBER d ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTOWRITEDOWNTHESNOWJACKETSASAT /CTOBER e RecordTHE3TOCK7RITE DOWNINTHESTOCKCARDFORSNOWJACKETS
EXERCISE 14.11 PRODUCT VERSUS PERIOD COSTS
W B
page 312
/N!UGUST 3UAVE3UITSHADPUREWOOLSUITSONHAND WHICHITHADPURCHASED FORPLUS'34 EACHDURING*ULY4HEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSOCCURREDDURING !UGUST
Woollen Mills Australia
TAX INVOICE Invoice: 85
Quality Clothing
Original ABN: 45 111 981 342 Charge to:
Date 3/8/15
less
Woollen Mills Australia Terms: 10/7, n/30
Suave Suits (ABN: 44 505 612 349) Geelong VIC 3220 Details
Qty
Unit price $
Total $
Pure wool suits
16
175
2 800
Tailoring costs
480
Sales discount
80
Subtotal plus
3 200
GST Total
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
320 $
3 520
Cambridge University Press
331
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
332
UNITS 3&4
/N!UGUST 3UAVE3UITSPAID7OOLLEN-ILLS!USTRALIA RECEIVINGA DISCOUNTFOREARLYPAYMENT!TTHEENDOF!UGUST FOUROFTHESUITSPURCHASEDON !UGUSTREMAINEDONHAND Required a CalculateTHECOSTOFONEOFTHESUITSPURCHASEDON!UGUST b RecordTHEPURCHASEOFSTOCKON!UGUSTINTHESTOCKCARDFORWOOLSUITS c ReferringTOYOURANSWERTOPART@B explainYOURTREATMENTOFTHEDISCOUNTFOREARLY PAYMENT d RecordTHEPURCHASEOFSTOCKON!UGUSTINTHEAPPROPRIATEJOURNAL e ExplainTHEEFFECTONTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF3UAVE3UITSASAT!UGUSTIFTHE TAILORINGCOSTSHADBEENTREATEDASPERIODCOSTS f 'IVENTHATTHEDISCOUNTAND'34AREBOTHAPPLIEDATARATEOF explainWHYTHE DOLLARAMOUNTOFTHEDISCOUNTISGREATERTHANTHEDOLLARAMOUNTOF'34
EXERCISE 14.12 RECORDING AND REPORTING FOR STOCK
W B
page 314
:IPPY 3COOTERS SELLS ONE TYPE OF SCOOTER TO SELECTED RETAIL STORES 4HE SCOOTERS ARE MANUFACTUREDBY"8"IKESIN7ANGARATTAANDDELIVEREDTOTHESHOPIN#ARLTONINLOTSOF lVE4HEFOLLOWINGTRANSACTIONSTOOKPLACEDURING*ULY July 1 5 12
Stock on hand: 16 scooters valued at $1 800 each Credit sale of 9 scooters for $3 000 (plus GST) each (Inv. V23) Purchase of 5 scooters at $1 400 each plus $2 000 freight (Inv. 42). Total GST on the purchase amounted to $900. A local mechanic was paid $110 (including GST) per scooter to fit each one with a sports kit (Ch. 188)
14
A customer, J. Fangio, returned a scooter due to a faulty engine (CN 17) and received a credit for $3 000 plus GST
16
Faulty scooter returned to the manufacturer; Zippy Scooters received a credit note for $1 980 including GST (CN 922)
26
Credit sale of 9 scooters for $3 300 (including GST) per bike (Inv. V24)
31
Stocktake revealed three scooters on hand, but one is scratched and damaged, and can only be sold for $1 200 (Memo 36)
Required
*
a CalculateTHECOSTPRICEOFEACHSCOOTERPURCHASEDON*ULY b 2EFERRING TO YOUR ANSWER TO PART @A explain YOUR TREATMENT OF THE COST OF THE SPORTSKIT c 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainWHY-EMOSHOULDBERECOGNISED INTHElNANCIALREPORTSOF:IPPY3COOTERS d RecordTHETRANSACTIONSFOR*ULYINTHESTOCKCARDFORSCOOTERS e Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD THE TRANSACTIONS ON AND*ULY f PrepareAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR:IPPY3COOTERSFOR*ULY WHICHSHOWS'ROSS 0ROlTAND!DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlT!FULL)NCOME3TATEMENTISnotREQUIRED g StateTHEEFFECTONTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF:IPPY3COOTERSASAT*ULYIFTHECOST OFTHESPORTSKITHADBEENTREATEDASAPERIODCOST h Discuss WHETHERTHEDAMAGEDSCOOTERSHOULDBERECORDEDINASEPARATESTOCKCARD
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s identifyAND record THE CREDITPURCHASEOFANON CURRENTASSETINTHE'ENERAL *OURNALAND'ENERAL,EDGER s distinguishBETWEEN #REDITORS#ONTROLANDA SUNDRYCREDITOR s record APAYMENTTOASUNDRY CREDITORINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS *OURNALAND'ENERAL,EDGER s reportAPAYMENTTOASUNDRY CREDITORINTHE#ASH&LOW 3TATEMENT s defineANDidentifyTHECOST OFANON CURRENTASSET s define ‘DEPRECIATIONAND OTHERRELATEDTERMS s explain THEPURPOSE OFDEPRECIATIONANDITS RELATIONSHIPTOACCOUNTING PRINCIPLESANDQUALITATIVE CHARACTERISTICS s calculate DEPRECIATIONUSING THEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHOD
s justify THESELECTIONOFA PARTICULARDEPRECIATION METHOD s explain THEEFFECTONTHE ACCOUNTINGREPORTSOFUSING DIFFERENTDEPRECIATION METHODS s recordACASHSALEOFA DEPRECIABLENON CURRENTASSET INTHEJOURNALSAND'ENERAL ,EDGER s recordATRADE INOFA DEPRECIABLENON CURRENTASSET INTHE'ENERAL*OURNALAND 'ENERAL,EDGER s reportAPROlTORLOSS ONTHEDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSETINTHE)NCOME 3TATEMENT s identifyANDexplainTHE REASONSFORAPROlTORLOSSON THEDISPOSALOFANON CURRENT ASSET
CHAPTER 15
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s DEPRECIATION s DEPRECIATIONEXPENSE s LOSSONDISPOSALOFASSET s PROlTONDISPOSALOFASSET s TRADE IN s UNDER DEPRECIATION s OVER DEPRECIATION ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
334
UNITS 3&4
15.1 CREDIT PURCHASES OF NON-CURRENT ASSETS 'IVENTHELARGEOUTLAYSOFCASHTHATARESOMETIMESNECESSARYTOPURCHASENON CURRENT ASSETS SUCH AS VEHICLES FURNITURE OR EQUIPMENT MANY BUSINESSES NOW CHOOSE TO PURCHASETHESEITEMSONCREDIT4HISALLOWSTHEMTOREPAYTHECREDITORININSTALMENTS RATHERTHANINONELARGEPAYMENT
Given the large outlays of cash that are sometimes required to purchase noncurrent assets, such as vehicles, many businesses now choose to purchase these items on credit
7HEREABUSINESSPURCHASESANON CURRENTASSETONCREDIT THETRANSACTIONMUSTBE RECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNALBEFOREITISPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER
EXAMPLE
On 4 July 2015 an invoice for $1 650 was received from Max’s Mart for $1 500 worth of office furniture, plus $150 GST (Inv. A13).
4HISTRANSACTIONWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNALASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 15.1
General Journal: credit purchase of a non-current asset General Journal General Ledger
Date
Details
July 4
Office Furniture GST Clearing Sundry Creditor – Max’s Mart
Debit
Credit
Subsidiary ledger Debit
Credit
1 500 150 1 650
Credit purchase of office furniture (Inv. A13)
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
335
!S THE BUSINESS HAS ACQUIRED A NEW ASSET /FlCE &URNITURE IS DEBITED TO INCREASETHISASSET AND'34#LEARINGISDEBITED TODECREASETHELIABILITYOWED TOTHE!4/"OTHTHECOSTOFTHE/FlCE&URNITUREANDTHE'34AREOWEDTO-AXS-ART SOTHESUMOFTHESETWOlGURES ISCREDITEDTOANEWLIABILITY ACCOUNTCALLED3UNDRY#REDITORn-AXS-ART 4HISENTRYWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 15.2
General Ledger: credit purchase of a non-current asset General Ledger Office Furniture (A)
Date
Cross-reference
July 1
Balance
31
Sundry Creditor – Max’s Mart
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Balance
26 000 1500 GST Clearing (A/L)
Date July 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Bank
600
July 1
Creditors Control
800
31
Sundry Creditor – Max’s Mart
150
690
Bank
1 100
Debtors Control
1 900
Sundry Creditor – Max’s Mart (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
July 31
Office Furniture/ GST Clearing
1 650
4HE CROSS REFERENCE ON THE CREDIT SIDE OF THE SUNDRY CREDITOR ACCOUNT REFERS TO /FlCE &URNITURE/'34 #LEARING TO REmECT THAT THE CREDITOR IS OWED AN AMOUNT FOR THE ASSET ANDALSOTHE'34ONTHEPURCHASEOFTHATASSET
Sundry creditors )N THE EXAMPLE ABOVE THE AMOUNT OWING WAS NOT CREDITED TO THE #REDITORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT BUTRATHERTOANEWLIABILITYACCOUNTCALLED3UNDRY#REDITORn-AXS-ART4HISIS BECAUSETHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNTISUSEDONLYFORAMOUNTSOWEDFORTHEPURCHASE OFSTOCK7HEREAlRMPURCHASESANASSETOTHERTHANSTOCK ASEPARATESUNDRYCREDITOR ACCOUNT WHICHNAMESTHESUNDRYCREDITOR MUSTBECREATEDINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER4HE SUNDRYCREDITORISSTILLACURRENTLIABILITY BUTHASITSOWNACCOUNTINTHE'ENERAL,EDGER ANDWOULDBEREPORTEDSEPARATELYINTHE"ALANCE3HEET "ECAUSE THEY ARE SEPARATE TO THE #REDITORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT PAYMENTS MADE TO THESE SUNDRY CREDITORS MUST BE RECORDED IN THE 3UNDRIES RATHER THAN THE #REDITORS #ONTROL COLUMNOFTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL!NDBECAUSESUCHAPAYMENTWOULDBE ACASHOUTmOWRELATEDTOTHEPURCHASEOFANON CURRENTASSET ITWOULDBEREPORTEDAS AN)NVESTINGOUTmOWINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
STUDY TIP
!BUSINESSMAYHAVE MORETHANONESUNDRY CREDITOR SOTHENAME OFEACHSUNDRYCREDITOR MUSTALWAYSBE IDENTIlED
STUDY TIP
7ENOWHAVETWO )NVESTINGOUTmOWSIN THE#ASH&LOW 3TATEMENTCASH PURCHASEOFNON CURRENT ASSET ANDPAYMENTTO SUNDRYCREDITOR
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
336
UNITS 3&4
The cost of a non-current asset !SWEALREADYKNOW THECOSTOFANASSETINCLUDESALLCOSTSINCURREDINORDERTOBRINGTHE ASSETINTOALOCATIONANDCONDITIONREADYFORUSETHATWILLPROVIDEABENElTFORTHELIFE OFTHEASSET3EE#HAPTERFORAREMINDER 4HISWILLOBVIOUSLYINCLUDETHESUPPLIERS PRICE BUTMAYALSOINCLUDECOSTSSUCHASDELIVERY MODIlCATIONANDINSTALLATION7HERE THESEOTHERCOSTSEXIST THEYMUSTBEINCLUDEDINTHECOSTPRICEOFTHEASSETRECORDEDIN THE'ENERAL*OURNAL
EXAMPLE
On 12 March 2015, Johnson’s Deliveries purchased a new delivery van on credit from Jane Motors. The invoice (Inv. 42) showed: Delivery van Shelving (installed) Service contract (12 months) GST Invoice total
$21 000 500 800 2 230 $24 530
Costs such as delivery, modification and installation are included in the cost of a non-current asset if they will bring a benefit over its useful life
!SITISANON CURRENTASSET THECOSTOFTHEVANINCLUDESALLCOSTSTHATWILLEXTENDOVER ITSLIFE Delivery van Plus Shelving
$21 000 500
Cost of van
$21 500
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
)NCONTRAST THESERVICECONTRACTDOESNOTEXTENDFORTHELIFEOFTHEASSET SOITISNOT PARTOFTHECOSTOFTHEDELIVERYVAN!SAMONTHCONTRACT ITISINSTEADACURRENTASSET Prepaid Service Contract )T MAY NOT YET BE PAID BUT WHEN THE CASH IS PAID TO THE CREDITORTOSETTLETHEDEBT WILLBEFORTHEPURCHASEOFTHISCURRENTASSET 4HE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYTORECORDTHECREDITPURCHASEOFTHEDELIVERYVANISSHOWN IN&IGURE Figure 15.3
General Journal: credit purchase of a non-current asset (with other costs) General Journal General Ledger
Date
Details
March 12
Delivery Van
Debit
Credit
Subsidiary ledger Debit
Credit
21 500
Prepaid Service Contract
800
GST Clearing
2 230
Sundry Creditor – Jane Motors
24 530
Credit purchase of delivery van (Inv. 42)
4HISENTRYWOULDBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 15.4
General Ledger: credit purchase of a non-current asset (with other costs) General Ledger Delivery Van (A)
Date Mach 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Sundry Creditor – Jane Motors
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Cross-reference
Amount $
21 500 Prepaid Service Contract (A)
Date March 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Sundry Creditor – Jane Motors
Date
800 GST Clearing (A/L)
Date March 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Bank
610
March 1
Creditors Control
950
31
Sundry Creditor – Jane Motors
2 230
Balance
Amount $ 720
Bank
1 320
Debtors Control
1 640
Sundry Creditor – Irene Motors (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
July 31
Van/Prepaid Service Contract/ GST Clearing
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Amount $ 24 530
Cambridge University Press
337
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
338
UNITS 3&4
4HEFULLCOSTOFTHEVANISDEBITEDTO$ELIVERY6AN THEPrepaid Service ContractISDEBITED$800 ANDTHETOTAL'34ONTHEVAN SHELVINGANDSERVICECONTRACT IS DEBITED TO '34 #LEARING 4HE TOTAL INVOICE PRICE IS CREDITED TO 3UNDRY#REDITORn*ANE-OTORSTOSHOWTHETOTALOWINGFORTHEVAN THESERVICECONTRACT ANDTHE'34
REVIEW QUESTIONS 15.1
1 ExplainONEREASONWHYAlRMMAYCHOOSETOUSECREDITTOPURCHASEANON CURRENTASSET 2 ExplainWHYACREDITPURCHASEOFANON CURRENTASSETMUSTBERECORDEDINTHE 'ENERAL*OURNAL 3 ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDACREDITPURCHASEOFA NON CURRENTASSET 4 ExplainTHEDIFFERENCEBETWEEN#REDITORS#ONTROLANDASUNDRYCREDITOR 5 ExplainHOWAPAYMENTTOASUNDRYCREDITORWOULDBE s RECORDEDINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNAL s REPORTEDINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT 6 Define THETERM@COSTASITREFERSTONON CURRENTASSETS
15.2 DEPRECIATION OF NON-CURRENT ASSETS depreciation the allocation of the cost of a non-current asset over its useful life depreciation expense that part of the cost of a non-current asset that has been consumed in the current Reporting Period
#HAPTERINTRODUCEDTHEPROCESSOFdepreciationFORNON CURRENTASSETS4HISPROCESS IS APPLIED BECAUSE ALTHOUGH NON CURRENT ASSETS PROVIDE AN ECONOMIC BENElT FOR MORE THAN MONTHS THROUGH THEIR CONTRIBUTION TO REVENUE MOST DO NOT PROVIDE AN ECONOMIC BENElT FOREVER THEY HAVE A lNITE USEFUL LIFE 4HIS MEANS THAT GRADUALLY OVER THEIR USEFUL LIFE THEIR VALUE IS BEING CONSUMED BY THE BUSINESS 4HE PROCESS OF DEPRECIATIONISAPPLIEDASAMECHANISMFORCALCULATING depreciation expense WHICHIS THATPARTOFTHECOSTOFANON CURRENTASSETTHATHASBEENCONSUMED ORINCURRED INTHE CURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD 4HE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESTORECORDDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEARE $2 #2
carrying value the value of a non-current asset that is yet to be consumed/allocated as an expense, plus any residual value
$EPRECIATIONn.ON #URRENT!SSET% !CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONn.ON #URRENT!SSETn!
4HIS BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENT HAS THE EFFECT OF INCREASING EXPENSES IN THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT)TALSODECREASESTHEcarrying valueOFTHENON CURRENTASSETINTHE"ALANCE 3HEET BYINCREASINGTHENEGATIVEASSETOF accumulated depreciation !S A RESULT DEPRECIATION EXPENSE ENSURES THE ACCURATE CALCULATION OF PROlT BY COMPARINGREVENUESEARNEDAGAINSTEXPENSESINCURREDINTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD )TALSOENSURESTHATTHEREPORTSTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTANDTHE"ALANCE3HEET INCLUDEALL INFORMATIONTHATISUSEFULFORDECISION MAKING THEREFOREUPHOLDING2ELEVANCE
accumulated depreciation the value of a non-current asset that has been consumed/incurred over its life thus far
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
REVIEW QUESTIONS 15.2
1 DefineTHEFOLLOWINGTERMS s DEPRECIATION s DEPRECIATIONEXPENSE s ACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATION s CARRYINGVALUE 2 ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESTORECORDTHEBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTFOR DEPRECIATIONEXPENSE 3 StateTHEEFFECTOFDEPRECIATIONONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION 4 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainTHEPURPOSEOFDEPRECIATINGA NON CURRENTASSET
15.3 METHODS OF DEPRECIATION #HAPTERINTRODUCEDONLYONEMETHODOFDEPRECIATIONTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD
Straight-line method 5NDERTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD DEPRECIATIONEXPENSEISCALCULATEDUSINGTHESTRAIGHT LINEFORMULA Depreciation expense: straight-line formula $EPRECIATIONEXPENSEPERANNUM
(#n26 ,IFE
Where:
HC
Historical Cost: THEORIGINALPURCHASE PRICEOFTHENON CURRENTASSET
RV
residual value: THEESTIMATEDVALUEOF THENON CURRENTASSETATTHEENDOFITS USEFULLIFE
Life
useful life: THEESTIMATEDPERIODOF TIMEFORWHICHTHENON CURRENTASSET WILLBEUSEDBYTHECURRENTENTITYTO EARNREVENUE4HISISUSUALLYMEASURED INYEARS
!LTERNATIVELY STRAIGHT LINE DEPRECIATION COULD BE CALCULATED USING THE STRAIGHT LINE RATEFORMULA
Depreciation expense: straight-line rate formula $EPRECIATIONEXPENSEPERANNUM (ISTORICAL#OSTX$EPRECIATION RATE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
339
340
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
4HE ASSUMPTION MADE BY THIS METHOD OF DEPRECIATION IS THAT THE ASSET BEING DEPRECIATED WILL contribute evenly to revenue DOING THE SAME JOB WHEN IT IS OLD AS WHENITISNEW4YPICALLY THISWOULDINCLUDEASSETSWITHFEWMOVINGPARTS SUCHAS/FlCE &URNITURE ANDlXTURESANDlTTINGS4HEVALUEOFANASSET ASMEASUREDBYITSCOST THAT CONTRIBUTESEVENLYTOREVENUEISTHEREFOREconsumed evenly over its useful life. 4HISIS RECOGNISEDBYTHEFACTTHATOVERTHELIFEOFTHEASSETTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHODALLOCATES DEPRECIATIONEVENLYTHATIS BYTHESAMEAMOUNTEACHYEAR)NTHISWAY THESTRAIGHT LINE METHODATTEMPTSTOMATCHTHEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEINCURREDAGAINSTTHEREVENUETHAT THENON CURRENTASSETHASEARNEDINEACH2EPORTING0ERIOD
Reducing balance method .OT ALL ASSETS CONTRIBUTE TO REVENUE EVENLY OVER THEIR LIVES !N ASSET WITH MOVING PARTSSUCHASEQUIPMENT APHOTOCOPIERORAVEHICLE ISLIKELYTOBEMOREEFlCIENTAND PRODUCTIVEWHENITISNEW ANDTHEREFOREcontribute more to revenue at the start of its useful life THANATITSEND4HEVALUECOST OFANASSETTHATCONTRIBUTESMORETOREVENUE WHENITISNEWANDLESSASITAGES ISTHEREFOREconsumed more at the start of its useful lifeTHANATITSEND ANDTHISMUSTBEREmECTEDBYTHEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSE 4HEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHODOFDEPRECIATIONASSUMESTHATTHEASSETWILLCONTRIBUTE MORE TO REVENUE AT THE START OF ITS LIFE WHEN IT IS NEW EFlCIENT AND PRODUCTIVE !S A CONSEQUENCE THIS METHOD ALLOCATES MORE DEPRECIATION EXPENSE AT THE START OF THE ASSETSLIFE5NDERTHISMETHOD ASTHEASSETAGES ITSCONTRIBUTIONTOREVENUEDECREASES ANDSOTOODOESTHEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSE 5SINGTHEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHODENSURESTHATTHEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEANDTHE REVENUETHEASSETEARNSAREMATCHEDINEACH2EPORTING0ERIOD"OTHAREHIGHERATTHE START BUTREDUCEOVERTHELIFEOFTHEASSET
REVIEW QUESTIONS 15.3
1 ShowTHEFORMULAFORCALCULATINGDEPRECIATIONUNDERTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD USINGTHE s USEFULLIFE s RATEOFDEPRECIATION 2 StateTHEASSUMPTIONTHATUNDERLIESTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHODOFDEPRECIATION INRELATIONTOHOWASSETSCONTRIBUTETOREVENUE 3 State THE ASSUMPTION THAT UNDERLIES THE REDUCING BALANCE METHOD OF DEPRECIATIONINRELATIONTOHOWASSETSCONTRIBUTETOREVENUE 4 Identify THREE NON CURRENT ASSETS THAT SHOULD BE DEPRECIATED USING THE REDUCINGBALANCEMETHODOFDEPRECIATION 5 Explain HOW THE REDUCING BALANCE METHOD OF DEPRECIATION ALLOCATES DEPRECIATIONEXPENSE
15.4 CALCULATING DEPRECIATION EXPENSE USING THE REDUCING BALANCE METHOD 5NDERTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD DEPRECIATIONEXPENSEISTHESAMEEACHYEARBECAUSEITIS CALCULATEDASAPERCENTAGEOFTHE Historical CostOFTHEASSET"YCONTRAST THEREDUCING BALANCEMETHODCALCULATESDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEASAPERCENTAGEOFTHECARRYINGVALUE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
341
EXAMPLE
On 1 January 2015, Finch Fabrics purchased a cutting machine for $10 000 plus $1 000 GST. The asset is expected to have a useful life of five years and a residual value of $2 000, and is to be depreciated at 27.52% per annum using the reducing balance method.
Reducing balance rate of depreciation 4HElRSTTHINGTHATMAYSTRIKEYOUABOUTTHEEXAMPLEABOVEISTHATTHERATEISNOTGIVEN ASASIMPLElGURE BUTRATHERAS!SARULEOFTHUMB THEREDUCINGBALANCERATE ISAPPROXIMATELYTIMESTHESTRAIGHT LINERATE(OWEVER THEWORDapproximatelyIS IMPORTANTITISNOTexactlyTIMES4HEFORMULAFORCALCULATINGTHERATEOFDEPRECIATION UNDERTHEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHODISQUITECOMPLICATED Depreciation expense: reducing balance rate Depreciation rate
=
100 1 —
n
STUDY TIP
Residual value Historical Cost
4HEREDUCINGBALANCE RATEWILLALWAYSBE SPECIlEDINTHISCOURSE
Where ‘n’ refers to the ‘number’ of years for which the non-current asset will be used to earn revenue; that is, its useful life.
+NOWLEDGEOFTHISFORMULAISBEYONDTHEREQUIREMENTSOFTHISCOURSETHERATEWILL ALWAYSBEPROVIDED SOTHEREISNONEEDTOREMEMBERIT)FTHERATEISKNOWN WHICHIN THISCOURSEITWILLBE CALCULATINGDEPRECIATIONEXPENSESIMPLYINVOLVESMULTIPLYINGTHE CARRYINGVALUEBYTHERATE
Depreciation expense: reducing balance formula Depreciation expense: reducing balance rate $EPRECIATIONEXPENSEPERANNUM #ARRYINGVALUEX$EPRECIATIONRATE WHERECARRYINGVALUEHistorical Cost nACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATION
"ECAUSETHISFORMULACALCULATESDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEASAPERCENTAGEOFTHECARRYING VALUE ANDTHECARRYINGVALUEREDUCESEVERYPERIOD SOTOOWILLTHEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSE Depreciation expense for the year ended 31 December 2015 5SINGTHEREDUCINGBALANCEFORMULA THEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEFOR&INCH&ABRICSCUTTING MACHINEFORTHEYEARENDED$ECEMBERWOULDBECALCULATEDASSHOWN Depreciation expense
=
Carrying value
x
Depreciation rate
=
$10 000
x
27.52%
=
$2 752
&ORTHElRSTYEAROFTHEASSETSLIFE ITSCARRYINGVALUEWILLBETHESAMEASITSHistorical Cost THAT IS $10 000 AND DEPRECIATION EXPENSE WILL BE !S IT IS THE lRST YEAROFTHEASSETSLIFE ITSDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEWOULDTHENBECOMEITSACCUMULATED DEPRECIATIONATTHEENDOFTHEYEAR4HEASSETWOULDTHUSBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE 3HEETASISSHOWNONTHENEXTPAGE ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
342
UNITS 3&4
FINCH FABRICS Balance Sheet (extract) as at 31 December 2015 Non-current Assets
$
Cutting Machine
$
10 000
Less Accumulated Depreciation
2 752
7 248
Depreciation expense for the year ended 31 December 2016 &ORTHEsecondYEAROFTHEASSETSLIFE ITSCARRYINGVALUEWOULDBEREDUCEDBYTHE VALUEOFACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATIONFROM5SINGTHISNEWCARRYINGVALUE THE Depreciation expense
=
Carrying value
x
Depreciation rate
=
$7 248
x
27.52%
=
$1 995
DEPRECIATIONEXPENSEFORWOULDBECALCULATEDASSHOWN "ECAUSEOFTHEACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATIONFROM THECARRYINGVALUEFOR HASDECREASEDFROMTO RESULTINGINAdecreaseINDEPRECIATION EXPENSE FROM TO 4HUS THE REDUCING BALANCE METHOD ALLOCATES MORE DEPRECIATIONEXPENSEATTHESTARTOFTHEASSETSLIFE ANDLESSASITAGES4HISPATTERNWILL CONTINUEFORTHELIFEOFTHEASSET ASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 15.5
STUDY TIP
Reducing balance depreciation over time*
Historical Cost Less Accumulated Depreciation
3EE3ECTION ONPAGEFORA REMINDEROFHOWTO ADJUSTFORDEPRECIATION FORLESSTHANAYEAR 2EMEMBERTOUSE THEREDUCINGBALANCE FORMULATOCALCULATE DEPRECIATIONEXPENSE INTHElRSTPLACE
Carrying Value Depreciation Expense
2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
10 000
10 000
10 000
10 000
10 000
Nil
2 752
4 747
6 193
7 241
10 000
7 248
5 253
3 807
2 759
2 752
1 995
1 446
1 048
759
3OMElGURESADJUSTEDFORROUNDINGPURPOSES
Calculating depreciation for less than a year *USTLIKETHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD THEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHODCALCULATESDEPRECIATION FORAYEAR3HOULDTHEASSETBEUNDERTHECONTROLOFTHElRMFORLESSTHANAYEAR ORTHE 2EPORTING0ERIODBELESSTHANAYEAR THEAMOUNTWOULDNEEDTOBEADJUSTED4HESAFEST WAYTODOTHISISTODIVIDETHEYEARLYDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEBYMONTHS THENMULTIPLY BYTHENUMBEROFMONTHSAPPROPRIATETOTHE2EPORTING0ERIOD
REVIEW QUESTIONS 15.4
1 Explain HOW THE STRAIGHT LINE AND REDUCING BALANCE METHODS DIFFER IN THEIR CALCULATIONOFDEPRECIATIONEXPENSE 2 Show THE FORMULA FOR CALCULATING DEPRECIATION UNDER THE REDUCING BALANCE METHOD 3 2EFERRINGTOTHEFORMULA explainWHYTHEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHODALLOCATES LESSDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEOVERTHELIFEOFTHEASSET
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
343
15.5 COMPARING DEPRECIATION METHODS !LTHOUGHTHEMETHODOFCALCULATIONWILLCHANGETHEAMOUNTOFDEPRECIATIONEXPENSE SOMEASPECTSremain the sameREGARDLESSOFWHICHMETHODISCHOSEN4HESEINCLUDE s THE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESREQUIREDTORECORDDEPRECIATIONEXPENSETHATIS $2 #2
$EPRECIATIONn.ON #URRENT!SSET% !CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONn.ON #URRENT!SSETn!
s THEREPORTINGOFDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTAS@/THER%XPENSE ANDACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATIONINTHE"ALANCE3HEETASANEGATIVEASSET s THEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONAND"ALANCE3HEETTHATIS n ANINCREASEINACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATIONLEADINGTOADECREASEINASSETS n AN INCREASE IN EXPENSES LEADING TO A DECREASE IN .ET 0ROlT AND DECREASE IN OWNERSEQUITY 7HATwillDIFFERDEPENDINGONTHEDEPRECIATIONMETHODISTHEAMOUNTOFDEPRECIATION EXPENSECHARGEDINEACH2EPORTING0ERIOD s 5SINGTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD DEPRECIATIONEXPENSEWILLBETHEsame each year 4HISDOESNOTMEANTHATTHEASSETISNOTAGEING ORTHATITSPRODUCTIVECAPACITYISNOT BEINGCONSUMED JUSTTHATITISBEINGCONSUMEDEVENLY s 5SINGTHEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHOD DEPRECIATIONEXPENSEWILLBEhigher at the start and decrease as the asset ages )FTHEFABRICCUTTINGMACHINEFROMTHEEXAMPLEONPAGE HADBEENDEPRECIATED USINGTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD DEPRECIATIONEXPENSEWOULDBEPERYEARnARATE OFOFTHEHistorical Cost 4HISCOMPARESWITHAREDUCINGBALANCERATEOF OFTHECARRYINGVALUE &IGURESHOWSHOWTHESTRAIGHT LINEANDREDUCINGBALANCEMETHODSWILLGENERATE DIFFERING AMOUNTS FOR DEPRECIATION EXPENSE AND AS A RESULT DIFFERENT RESULTS IN THE )NCOME3TATEMENTAND"ALANCE3HEET OVERTHELIFEOFTHEASSET Figure 15.6
Comparison of straight-line and reducing balance methods Straight-line method (Historical Cost x 16%)
Year
Reducing balance method (carrying value x 27.52%)
Historical Accumulated Carrying Depreciation Cost depreciation value expense
Historical Cost
Accumulated Carrying depreciation value
Depreciation expense
2015
10 000
Nil
10 000
1 600
10 000
Nil
10 000
2 752
2016
10 000
1 600
8 400
1 600
10 000
2 752
7 248
1 995
2017
10 000
3 200
6 800
1 600
10 000
4 747
5 253
1 446
2018
10 000
4 800
5 200
1 600
10 000
6 193
3 807
1 048
2019
10 000
6 400
3 600
1 600
10 000
7 241
2 759
759
Total
8 000
Total
8 000
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
344
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
4HISDIFFERENCEINDEPRECIATIONEXPENSECANBEREPRESENTEDGRAPHICALLY ASISSHOWN IN&IGURE Figure 15.7
Depreciation expense: graphical comparison
$3 000 $2 500 $2 000
Depreciation expense: straight line
$1 500
Depreciation expense: reducing balance
$1 000 $500 $0 2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
Year 4HESTRAIGHT LINEMETHODALLOCATESDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEPERYEAR FOREVERY YEAR OF THE ASSETS USEFUL LIFE )N COMPARISON THE REDUCING BALANCE METHOD ALLOCATES MORE DEPRECIATION EXPENSE THAN THE STRAIGHT LINE METHOD IN AND BUTLESSIN AND 4HEREFORE INTHEEARLYYEARSTHEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHODWILLCAUSE.ET0ROlTTOBE LOWERTHANITWOULDBEUSINGTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD BUTINLATERYEARS.ET0ROlTWOULD BEHIGHERTHANIFTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHODWASUSED )NTERMSOFTHE"ALANCE3HEET THEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHODWILLMEANTHECARRYING VALUEOFTHEASSETDECREASESFASTERTHANUSINGTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD4HISISSHOWNIN &IGURE
Figure 15.8
Carrying value: graphical comparison
$12 000 $10 000 $8 000
Carrying value: straight line
$6 000
Carrying value: reducing balance
$4 000 $2 000 $0 2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
Year !LTHOUGH&IGURESHOWSTHEDIFFERENCEATTHEENDOFEACHINDIVIDUAL2EPORTING 0ERIOD ITALSOSHOWSTHATBOTHMETHODSENDUPATTHESAMEPOINTACARRYINGVALUEAT THEENDOFTHEASSETSLIFEOF WHICHISITSRESIDUALVALUE4HISISBECAUSEALTHOUGH EACH METHOD GIVES A DIFFERENT DEPRECIATION EXPENSE IN each Reporting Period BOTH METHODS WILL IF THE RATES HAVE BEEN CALCULATED ACCURATELY CALCULATE THE SAME TOTAL DEPRECIATIONEXPENSEover the life of the asset)NTHISEXAMPLE BOTHMETHODSRESULTIN ATOTALDEPRECIATIONOF
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
Selecting a depreciation method 4HEKEYFACTORTOCONSIDERINCHOOSINGADEPRECIATIONMETHODISTHEREVENUE EARNING PATTERNOFTHEASSET s )FTHEASSETCONTRIBUTESEVENLYTOREVENUE ANDITSCOSTISCONSUMEDEVENLY OVERITS LIFE THESTRAIGHT LINEMETHODSHOULDBEUSED s )FTHEASSETCONTRIBUTESMORETOREVENUE ANDITSCOSTISCONSUMEDMORE ATTHESTART OFITSLIFEANDLESSASITAGES THEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHODSHOULDBEUSED )TISTHEASSETITSELF ANDHOWITCONTRIBUTESTOREVENUE THATDETERMINESWHICHMETHOD OFDEPRECIATIONISAPPROPRIATE4HEREFORE ABUSINESSMAYUSETHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD FORSOMEASSETS ANDTHEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHODFOROTHERS 7HILETHISCHOICEEXISTS THEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLEOF#ONSISTENCYDEMANDSTHATONCE A METHOD IS CHOSEN THAT METHOD SHOULD BE USED FROM ONE PERIOD TO THE NEXT 4HIS ALLOWSREPORTSTOBECOMPAREDFROMONEPERIODTOTHENEXT MAINTAINING#OMPARABILITY #HANGINGDEPRECIATIONMETHODSISPOSSIBLE BUTTHECHANGEMUSTBECLEARLYDISCLOSED INTHEREPORTS
REVIEW QUESTIONS 15.5
1 StateTHREEWAYSINWHICHTHEEFFECTOFDEPRECIATIONISTHESAMEUNDERBOTH THESTRAIGHT LINEANDREDUCINGBALANCEMETHODS 2 #OMPARED TO THE STRAIGHT LINE METHOD explain HOW THE REDUCING BALANCE METHODOFDEPRECIATIONWILLAFFECT.ET0ROlTDURINGEACH2EPORTING0ERIOD 3 ExplainHOWTHEMETHODOFDEPRECIATIONAFFECTSTOTALDEPRECIATIONOVERTHE LIFEOFTHEASSET 4 Explain THEMAINFACTORTOBECONSIDEREDINSELECTINGAMETHODOFDEPRECIATION 5 Identify THE ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLE THAT PREVENTS CHANGES OF DEPRECIATION METHODBETWEENPERIODS 6 2EFERRINGTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC explainWHYDEPRECIATIONMETHODS SHOULDnotBECHANGEDFROMONEPERIODTOTHENEXT
15.6 RECORDING THE CASH SALE OF A NON-CURRENT ASSET 4RADINGlRMSEARNPROlTBYPURCHASINGSTOCKANDTHENMARKINGITUPBEFORESELLINGIT!S ARESULT RECORDINGACASHSALEOFSTOCKINTHELEDGERINVOLVESRECORDINGTHELOSSOFSTOCK ATONEAMOUNTTHECOSTPRICE ANDRECORDINGTHECASHRECEIVEDATADIFFERENTAMOUNT THESELLINGPRICE )TIS INFACT TWODOUBLEENTRIES ! SIMILAR PRINCIPLE APPLIES TO THE SALE OR DISPOSAL OF NON CURRENT ASSETS WE MUST RECORDTHEVALUEOFTHENON CURRENTASSETTHATHASBEENDISPOSEDOFITSCOSTPRICE AND THE REVENUE THAT HAS BEEN EARNED FROM ITS DISPOSAL ITS SELLING PRICE 4HE DIFFERENCE BETWEENTHESETWOAMOUNTSWILLPRODUCEAPROlTORLOSSONTHEDISPOSALOFTHEASSET !LTHOUGHNON CURRENTASSETSWILLFREQUENTLYBESOLD THEYWILLSOMETIMESBETRADED IN SOWEWILLREFERTOTHEdisposalRATHERTHANTHESALEOFTHEASSET 2ECORDINGTHEDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSETINVOLVESTHREESTEPS TRANSFERRINGTHECARRYINGVALUETHECOSTPRICEOFTHEASSET RECORDINGTHEPROCEEDSFROMTHESALETHESELLINGPRICEOFTHEASSET TRANSFERRINGTHEPROlTORLOSSONDISPOSALOFTHEASSET
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
345
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
346
UNITS 3&4
Step 1: transferring the carrying value (the cost price of the asset) 7HEN A NON CURRENT ASSET IS DISPOSED OF THE lRM LOSES THE ASSET IN MUCH THE SAME WAYTHATITLOSESSTOCKORPREPAIDRENTASITISCONSUMED)TISINCURRINGANEXPENSEBY INCURRINGANOUTmOW ORLOSS OFANECONOMICBENElT INTHEFORMOFADECREASEINASSETS THEASSETTHATHASBEENSOLD 4HISALSODECREASESOWNERSEQUITYHOWEVER THEBUSINESS IS NOT LOSING THE (ISTORICAL #OST OF THE ASSET AS IT WILL HAVE ALREADY CONSUMED SOME OFTHEASSETSVALUE VIADEPRECIATION4HISMEANSTHATTHEVALUETHATISLOSTWHENTHE ASSETISDISPOSEDOFISMEASUREDBYITSCARRYINGVALUETHATIS ITS(ISTORICAL#OSTlessITS ACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATION4HISLOSSOFTHEASSETVALUEDATITSCARRYINGVALUE ISTHElRST THINGTHATMUSTBERECORDEDWHENTHEASSETISDISPOSEDOF
EXAMPLE
On 31 January 2015, Duke Industries sold some equipment for $1 100 cash (Rec. 17). The equipment had originally been valued at $12 000, but accumulated depreciation amounted to $10 000 when it was sold.
4HE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES TO TRANSFER THE CARRYING VALUE OF THE EQUIPMENT ARE SHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 15.9
General Journal: transferring the carrying value General Journal General Ledger
Date Jan. 31
Details
Debit
Disposal of Equipment
12 000
Equipment Accumulated Depreciation – Equipment
Credit
Subsidiary Ledger Debit
Credit
12 000 10 000
Disposal of Equipment
10 000
"ECAUSE THE EQUIPMENT HAS BEEN SOLD IT IS NO LONGER IN THE lRMS POSSESSION OR CONTROL SOITISREMOVEDFROMTHEACCOUNTSBYCREDITINGTHE%QUIPMENTACCOUNT4HISENTRY ISRECORDEDAT(ISTORICAL#OST 3IMULTANEOUSLY THEACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATION THAT ACCOMPANIES THE EQUIPMENT IS ALSO REMOVED BY DEBITING THE !CCUMULATED $EPRECIATIONn%QUIPMENTACCOUNT "OTHAMOUNTSARETRANSFERREDTOANEW ACCOUNT$ISPOSALOF%QUIPMENT !LTHOUGHTHISEXAMPLEREFERSTOAsaleOFANON CURRENTASSET THEENTRIESWOULDBE IDENTICALIFTHEASSETWERETRADEDIN2EGARDLESSOFHOWTHEASSETISDISPOSEDOF THElRM HAS@LOSTTHEASSET WHICHMUSTBEVALUEDATITSCARRYINGVALUE 4HE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYISPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERASSHOWNIN&IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
Figure 15.10
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
347
General Ledger: transferring the carrying value General Ledger Equipment (A)
Date
Cross-reference
Jan. 1
Balance
Amount $ 12 000
Date Jan. 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Disposal of Equipment
12 000
Accumulated Depreciation – Equipment (– A) Date Jan. 31
Cross-reference Disposal of Equipment
Amount $ 10 000
Date Jan. 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Balance
10 000
Disposal of Equipment (OE) Date Jan. 31
Cross-reference Equipment
Amount $ 12 000
Date Jan. 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Acc. Dep. – Equipment
10 000
!T THIS STAGE THE $ISPOSAL OF %QUIPMENT ACCOUNT HAS A DEBIT BALANCE OF REPRESENTINGTHECARRYINGVALUEOF ANDTHEEXPENSEINCURREDFOR THEEQUIPMENTSOLD STUDY TIP
Step 2: recording the proceeds on disposal (the selling price of the asset) !TTHESAMETIMEASTHEASSETISLOST THElRMWILLALSORECEIVESOMEFORMOFREVENUE FROMWHOEVERISTAKINGTHEASSET)NTHECASEOFACASHSALE THEPROCEEDSFROMTHESALE OFTHEASSETAREANINmOWOFANECONOMICBENElTCASH INTHEFORMOFANINCREASEIN ASSETS"ANK WHICHINCREASESOWNERSEQUITY 4HEPROCEEDSRECEIVEDFROMTHECASHSALEOFANON CURRENTASSETWILLBERECORDEDIN THE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 15.11
Cash Receipts Journal: proceeds on cash sale
4HISMAKESATOTALOF THREETYPESOF)NVESTING ITEMSTOREPORTINTHE #ASH&LOW3TATEMENT INmOWSCASHPROCEEDS ONTHEDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSET OUTmOWS CASHPURCHASEOFANON CURRENTASSET ANDCASH PAIDTOSUNDRYCREDITOR
Cash Receipts Journal Date Jan. 31
Details Disposal of Equip. Totals
Rec. no. 17
Bank
Discount Expense
Debtors Control
Cost of Sales
Sales
1 100 42 100
Sundries
GST
1 100 500
14 000
16 000
25 000
1 100
2 500
4HIS AMOUNT WOULD BE REPORTED AS AN )NVESTING INmOW IN THE #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENTBECAUSEACASHINmOWWASRELATEDTOTHESALEOFTHENON CURRENTASSET 4HE PROCEEDS FROM THE SALE WOULD BE POSTED TO THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER AS SHOWN IN &IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
348
Figure 15.12
UNITS 3&4
General Ledger: proceeds on cash sale General Ledger
STUDY TIP
Bank (A)
2EMEMBER THETOTALS OFTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS *OURNALAREPOSTEDTO THE'ENERAL,EDGERAT THEENDOFTHEMONTH
Date
Cross-reference
Jan. 1
Balance
31
Amount $ 4 000
Cash Receipts
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Jan. 31
Cash Payments
35 000
42 100 Disposal of Equipment (OE)
Date Jan. 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Equipment
12 000
Date Jan. 31
Cross-reference Acc. Dep. – Equipment Bank
Amount $ 10 000 1 100
7HEREAS TRANSFERRING THE CARRYING VALUE INTO THE $ISPOSAL OF %QUIPMENT ACCOUNT RECOGNISES THE EXPENSE RELATED TO THE DISPOSAL RECORDING THE PROCEEDS RECOGNISES THEREVENUEEARNEDFROMTHEDISPOSAL7ITHTHISINFORMATION THEPROlTORLOSSONTHE DISPOSALCANBECALCULATED
Step 3: transferring the profit or loss on disposal 4HE$ISPOSALOF!SSETACCOUNTSHOWSINFORMATIONABOUTBOTHTHEREVENUEEARNEDFROM THEDISPOSALTHEPROCEEDSFROMTHESALE ANDTHEEXPENSEINCURREDBYTHEDISPOSALTHE CARRYINGVALUEOFTHEASSET (OWEVER ONLYTHENETEFFECTTHEOVERALLPROlTORLOSSON DISPOSAL WILLBEREPORTEDINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT4HUS THE$ISPOSALOF!SSETACCOUNT MUSTBECLOSED ANDITSBALANCETRANSFERREDTOASEPARATEACCOUNTCALLEDEITHER@0ROlTON $ISPOSALOF!SSETOR@,OSSON$ISPOSALOF!SSET Transferring a loss on disposal 4HEEXAMPLESHOWSTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONRELATINGTOTHESALEOFTHEEQUIPMENT
loss on disposal of asset where the proceeds from the disposal of an asset is less than its carrying value
2EVENUE 0ROCEEDSONSALE
,ESS %XPENSE #ARRYINGVALUE
(ISTORICAL#OSTn!CC$EP
0ROlT,OSS ONDISPOSAL
)NTHISCASE THEPROCEEDSFROMTHESALEOFTHEEQUIPMENT ISLESSTHANITS CARRYINGVALUE MEANINGAloss on disposal of asset HASOCCURRED4HIS LOSSISALSOREmECTEDBYTHE$ISPOSALOF%QUIPMENTACCOUNTIN&IGURE WHICHHAS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
ADEBITBALANCEOF JUSTLIKEANEXPENSEACCOUNT4HISCONlRMSTHATTHEREHASBEEN ALOSSONDISPOSALOFEQUIPMENT 4HE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYTOTRANSFERTHELOSSONTHEDISPOSALOFTHEEQUIPMENTIS SHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 15.13
General Journal: transferring a loss on disposal of asset General Journal General Ledger
Date Jan. 31
Details
Debit
Loss on Disposal of Equipment
Credit
Subsidiary ledger Debit
Credit
900
Disposal of Equipment
900
Disposal of equipment at a loss (Rec. 17)
!LTHOUGHHERETHEDISPOSALHASBEENSHOWNASTHREESEPARATECOMPONENTS ITISONE TRANSACTION!LLTHREECOMPONENTSTHETRANSFEROFTHECARRYINGVALUE THERECORDINGOF THEPROCEEDSONDISPOSALANDTHETRANSFEROFTHELOSSONDISPOSAL FORMONEENTRY TO RECORDTHEONETRANSACTION!SACONSEQUENCE THENARRATIONISMADEONLYATTHEENDOF THE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRY !SARESULT THE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 15.14
General Ledger: transferring a loss on disposal of asset General Ledger Disposal of Equipment (OE)
Date Jan. 31
Cross-reference Equipment
Amount $ 12 000
Date Jan. 31
Cross-reference Acc. Dep. – Equipment Bank Loss on Disp. of Equip.
12 000
Amount $ 10 000 1 100 900 12 000
Loss on Disposal of Equipment (E) Date Jan. 31
Cross-reference Disposal of Equipment
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
900
4HE$ISPOSALOF%QUIPMENTACCOUNTHASBEENEMPTIEDITNOWHASAZEROBALANCE 4HE,OSSON$ISPOSALOF%QUIPMENTACCOUNTSHOWSTHEOVERALLLOSSINCURREDONTHESALE WHICHWILLBECLOSEDTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTATTHEENDOFTHE PERIOD ANDREPORTEDINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTASAN@/THER%XPENSE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
349
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
350
UNITS 3&4
Transferring a profit on disposal )FTHE$ISPOSALOF!SSETACCOUNTHASACREDITBALANCE LIKEAREVENUEACCOUNT ITWOULD REPRESENT A PROlT BECAUSE THE PROCEEDS FROM THE SALE WOULD BE GREATER THAN THE CARRYINGVALUE)NTHISCASE THE$ISPOSALOF!SSETACCOUNTWOULDBECLOSEDTOTHE0ROlT ON$ISPOSALOF!SSETACCOUNT
EXAMPLE
The accounts of Mallacoota Wines showed the following: General Ledger Disposal of Furniture (OE) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Oct. 31 Furniture
8 000
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Oct. 31 Acc. Dep. – Furniture Bank
profit on disposal of asset where the proceeds from the disposal of an asset are greater than its carrying value
6 000 2 300
4HISACCOUNTCURRENTLYHASACREDITBALANCEOF REPRESENTINGAprofit on disposal of asset INTHISCASE FURNITURE4HISPROlTWOULDBETRANSFERREDASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 15.15
General Journal: transferring a profit on disposal of asset General Journal
Date Oct. 31
Details
General Ledger
Subsidiary ledger
Debit
Debit
Disposal of Furniture
Credit
Credit
300
Profit on Disposal of Furniture
300
Disposal of furniture at a profit (Rec. 41)
!SARESULT THE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 15.16
General Ledger: transferring a profit on disposal of asset General Ledger Disposal of Furniture (OE)
Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Furniture
8 000
Profit on Disp. of Furn.
Date
Cross-reference
Oct. 31
Acc. Dep. – Furniture
6 000
Bank
2 300
300 8 300
Amount $
8 300
Profit on Disposal of Furniture (R) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Oct. 31
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cross-reference Disposal of Furniture
Amount $ 300
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
351
!SAREVENUEACCOUNT 0ROlTON$ISPOSALOF&URNITUREWOULDBECLOSEDTOTHE0ROlT AND ,OSS 3UMMARY ACCOUNT AT THE END OF THE 2EPORTING 0ERIOD WITH OTHER REVENUES SUCHAS3ALES STOCKGAINANDDISCOUNTREVENUE)NTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT ITWOULDBE REPORTEDWITHDISCOUNTREVENUE AS/THER2EVENUE REVIEW QUESTIONS 15.6
1 ListTHETHREESTEPSINVOLVEDINRECORDINGTHEDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSET 2 StateONEREASONWHYTHEASSETISMEASUREDBYITSCARRYINGVALUERATHERTHAN ITS(ISTORICAL#OSTWHENITISSOLDORTRADEDIN 3 ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTOTRANSFERTHECARRYINGVALUEOFA NON CURRENTASSETTHATHASBEENSOLD 4 State THE JOURNAL USED TO RECORD THE PROCEEDS FROM THE CASH SALE OF A NON CURRENTASSET 5 ExplainHOWTHEPROCEEDSFROMTHECASHSALEOFANON CURRENTASSETWOULDBE REPORTEDINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT 6 DefineTHETERMS s LOSSONDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSET s PROlTONDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSET 7 StateWHATISINDICATEDIFTHE$ISPOSALOF!SSETACCOUNTHASA s DEBITBALANCE s CREDITBALANCE 8 Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO CLOSE THE $ISPOSAL OF !SSET ACCOUNTIFITHASA s DEBITBALANCE s CREDITBALANCE
15.7
RECORDING THE TRADE-IN OF A NON-CURRENT ASSET
)NSOMESITUATIONSAlRMWILLNOTSELLANASSETFORCASH BUTRATHERUSETHATASSETASA trade-inONANEWERMODEL4HISWOULDMEANTHATRATHERTHANRECEIVINGCASHFORTHESALE OFTHEASSET THElRMWOULDRECEIVEAREDUCTIONINTHEAMOUNTPAYABLETOTHESUNDRY CREDITOR FORTHEPURCHASEOFANEWASSET
On 30 April 2015, Lexis Midnight Runners purchased a new delivery van worth $30 000 (plus $3 000 GST) from IQ Motors (Inv. 65). As part of the purchase, the firm traded in an old delivery van with a carrying value of $1 200 (cost $26 000 less accumulated depreciation $24 800) for $700.
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
trade-in when a firm uses the proceeds from the sale of a non-current asset to reduce the amount payable for the purchase of a new non-current asset
EXAMPLE
Cambridge University Press
352
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
&IGURESHOWSHOWTHETRADE INOFTHEOLDVANWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL *OURNAL Figure 15.17
General Journal: trade-in of a non-current asset General Journal General Ledger
Date April 30
Details
Debit
Disposal of Van
26 000
Van
Credit
Subsidiary ledger Debit
Credit
26 000
Accumulated Dep. – Van
24 800
Disposal of Van
24 800
Sundry Creditor – IQ Motors
700
Disposal of Van
700
Loss on Disposal of Van
500
Disposal of Van
500
4HEENTRIESTOTRANSFERTHECARRYINGCOSTOFTHEASSETANDTRANSFERTHELOSSONTHESALE AREEXACTLYTHESAMEFORATRADE INASTHEYWOULDBEIFTHEASSETHADBEENSOLDFORCASH 4OVERIFYTHIS GOBACKANDCHECK&IGURESAND 4HEONLYDIFFERENCEISTHATFORATRADE IN THEPROCEEDSFROMTHEDISPOSALARERECORDED ASADECREASEINALIABILITY3UNDRY#REDITORn)1-OTORS RATHERTHANASANINCREASETO ANASSET"ANK ASWOULDBETHECASEFORACASHSALE!SACONSEQUENCE THEPROCEEDS FROMATRADE INWILLBERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNALRATHERTHANTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS *OURNAL 4HETRADE INISSTILLREVENUEASITISASAVINGOFANOUTmOWOFECONOMICBENElTAS LESSCASHMUSTBEPAIDTOTHECREDITOR INTHEFORMOFAREDUCTIONINALIABILITY3UNDRY #REDITORn)1-OTORS WHICHINCREASESOWNERSEQUITY(OWEVER THEREISNOCASHmOW SO THEPROCEEDSTHETRADE IN AREnotREPORTEDINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT 4HEONLYREMAININGSTEPISTORECORDTHEPURCHASEOFTHENEWVAN WHICHWASCOVERED EARLIERINTHISCHAPTER3ECTION ANDISSHOWNBELOW General Journal General Ledger Date April 30
Details
Debit
Van
30 000
GST Clearing Sundry Creditor – IQ Motors
Credit
Subsidiary ledger Debit
Credit
3 000 33 000
Credit purchase of van (Inv. 65)
!FTERTHETRADE INANDPURCHASEHAVEBEENPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER ANDTHE $ISPOSALOF6ANACCOUNTHASBEENCLOSED THEACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARASSHOWNIN&IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
Figure 15.18
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
353
General Ledger: trade-in and credit purchase of a non-current asset General Ledger Van (A)
Date
Cross-reference
April 1 30
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Balance
26 000
April 30
Disposal of Van
26 000
Sundry Cred. – IQ Motors
30 000
Accumulated Depreciation – Van (– A) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
April 30
Disposal of Van
24 800
April 30
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $ 24 800
GST Clearing (A/L) Date April 30
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
3 000
April 1
Sundry Cred. – IQ Motors
Cross-reference Balance
Amount $ 4 900
Sundry Creditor – IQ Motors (L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
April 30
Disposal of Van
700
April 30
Cross-reference Van/GST Clearing
Amount $ 33 000
Disposal of Van (OE) Date April 30
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
26 000
April 30
Acc. Dep. – Van
Van
Amount $ 24 800
Sundry Cred. – IQ Motors
700
Loss on Disposal of Van
500
26 000
26 000
Loss on Disposal of Van (E) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
April 30
Disposal of Van
500
April 30
Cross-reference Profit and Loss Summary
500
Amount $
STUDY TIP
500 500
4HE ACCOUNTS SHOW THAT THE OLD VEHICLE IS GONE AND THE NEW VEHICLE VALUED AT $30 000 IS RECORDED IN THE 6AN ACCOUNT 4HE 3UNDRY #REDITOR n )1 -OTORS SHOWS A CREDITBALANCEOFTHATIS $30 000FORTHENEWVANPLUS'34 lessTHE TRADE INONTHEOLDONE4HE$ISPOSALOF6ANACCOUNTHASBEENCLOSED ANDTHE LOSSHASBEENTRANSFERREDTOTHE,OSSON$ISPOSALOF6ANACCOUNT WHICHITSELFHAS BEENCLOSEDTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT
)FTHENEWASSETIS PURCHASEDUSINGCASH THEENTRYTORECORDTHE PROCEEDSONTHESALE WOULDDEBITTHEASSET ACCOUNTDIRECTLY RATHER THANTHESUNDRYCREDITOR 4HECREDITENTRYWOULD STILLBE$ISPOSALOF !SSET
REVIEW QUESTIONS 15.7
1 ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHETRADE INOFANON CURRENTASSET 2 ExplainHOWATRADE INISREPORTEDINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT"ECAREFUL
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
354
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
15.8 REPORTING A PROFIT OR LOSS ON DISPOSAL IN THE INCOME STATEMENT !SYOUALREADYKNOW ONLYTHEOVERALLPROlTORLOSSONTHEDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSET ISREPORTEDINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT
Reporting a loss on disposal )F THE PROCEEDS FROM THE SALE ARE less THAN THE CARRYING VALUE OF THE ASSET THEN THE ASSETWILLBESOLDATALOSS"ECAUSEALOSSONDISPOSALOFANASSETISANEXPENSE ITMUST BECLOSEDTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTATTHEENDOFTHE2EPORTING0ERIOD ALONGWITHALLTHE/THER%XPENSESSUCHAS#OSTOF3ALES 7AGESAND2ENT TOHELPINTHE DETERMINATIONOF.ET0ROlT3EE#HAPTERFORCLOSINGREVENUEANDEXPENSEACCOUNTS )N THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT ,OSS ON $ISPOSAL OF !SSET WILL BE REPORTED AS AN /THER %XPENSE ASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 15.19
Income Statement: loss on disposal of a non-current asset LEXIS MIDNIGHT RUNNERS Income Statement for quarter ended 30 April 2015
Revenue
$
Sales
$ 60 000
Less Cost of Goods Sold Cost of Sales Freight In
35 000 2 000
Gross Profit
37 000 23 000
Less Stock Loss
300
Stock Write Down
100
Adjusted Gross Profit
400 22 600
Add Other Revenue Discount Revenue
800 23 400
Less Other Expenses Wages Advertising
14 050 2 700
Discount Expense
350
Loss on Disposal of Van
500
Rent Expense Net Profit
4 000
21 600 1 800
Reporting a profit on disposal /BVIOUSLYTHEOPPOSITEISTRUEFORAPROlTONDISPOSALOFANASSETACCOUNTITWOULDBE CLOSEDTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNTWITHTHEOTHERREVENUEACCOUNTS SUCHAS 3ALESAND$ISCOUNT2EVENUE ANDREPORTEDINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTAS/THER2EVENUE 4HISISSHOWNIN&IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
Figure 15.20
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
Income Statement: profit on disposal of a non-current asset MALLACOOTA WINES Income Statement for year ended 31 December 2015
Revenue
$
$
Sales
145 000
Less Cost of Goods Sold Cost of Sales
39 000
Customs Duty
2 000
Gross Profit
41 000 104 000
Less Stock Loss
1 000
Adjusted Gross Profit
103 000
Add Other Revenue Discount Revenue
500
Profit on Disposal of Vehicle
300
800 103 800
Less Other Expenses Wages
53 000
Advertising
11 500
Discount Expense Rent Expense Net Profit
1 300 16 000
81 800
$
22 000
REVIEW QUESTIONS 15.8
1 ExplainHOWALOSSONTHEDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSETWOULDBEREPORTED INTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT 2 ExplainHOWAPROlTONTHEDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSETWOULDBEREPORTED INTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT
15.9 REASONS FOR PROFIT OR LOSS ON DISPOSAL 'IVENTHATDEPRECIATIONISANATTEMPTTOCALCULATETHEVALUEOFANON CURRENTASSETTHAT HASBEENCONSUMEDINEACHPERIODOFITSLIFE THECARRYINGVALUEOFTHATASSETISALSOAN ATTEMPTTOGAUGETHEASSETSVALUETOTHEBUSINESS ATANYPOINTINTIME4HISISnot ITS MARKET VALUE !ND BECAUSE THE PROCEEDS ARE BASED ON THE SALE DOCUMENT AND THEREFORECANNOTBE@INCORRECT APROlTORLOSSONTHEDISPOSALOFTHEASSETINDICATES THATTHISCARRYINGVALUEANDTHEDEPRECIATIONTHATLEADTOITSCARRYINGVALUE WASINSOME WAYINCORRECT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
355
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
356
UNITS 3&4
Reasons for a loss on disposal !LOSSONTHEDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSETOCCURSWHENTHECARRYINGVALUEOFTHEASSET ISgreaterTHANTHEPROCEEDSFROMITSSALEITSRESALEVALUE 4HATIS WEHADVALUEDTHE ASSETATmoreTHANITWASREALLYWORTH Under-depreciation under-depreciation occurs when insufficient depreciation has been allocated over the life of the asset, so that the carrying value of the asset is overstated
STUDY TIP
@0OORESTIMATESISA BADEXPLANATION ASIT DOESNOTDISTINGUISH BETWEENOVER DEPRECIATIONAND UNDER DEPRECIATION
)F THE CARRYING VALUE OF THE ASSET IS OVERSTATED IT IS BECAUSE IT HAS BEEN underdepreciatedWEHAVENOTWRITTENOFFENOUGHDEPRECIATIONOVERTHEASSETSLIFE)NTERMS OFTHECALCULATIONS THISMAYBEBECAUSE s THEESTIMATEDRESIDUALVALUEWASTOOHIGHOROVERSTATED ANDOR s THEESTIMATEDUSEFULLIFEWASTOOHIGHOVERSTATED "OTHTHESEFACTORSWOULDBEREmECTEDINADEPRECIATIONRATETHATWASTOOLOW 4HEREAREAVARIETYOFREASONSWHYTHERESIDUALVALUEANDORUSEFULLIFEOFTHEASSET MAYBEOVERSTATED&OREXAMPLE s 4HE ORIGINAL ESTIMATES DID NOT ANTICIPATE THAT THE ASSET WOULD BE damaged 4HIS WOULDAUTOMATICALLYREDUCEITSRESALERESIDUAL VALUE ANDCOULDALSODECREASEITS USEFULLIFEBELOWWHATWASORIGINALLYANTICIPATED s 4HE ORIGINAL ESTIMATES DID NOT ANTICIPATE THAT THE ASSET WOULD BE outdated OR supersededBYANEWER TECHNOLOGICALLYSUPERIORMODEL4HISWOULDALSOREDUCEITS RESALEVALUE /VERSTATINGTHERESIDUALVALUEORUSEFULLIFEWOULDMEANNOTENOUGHDEPRECIATION WOULDHAVEBEENALLOCATEDOVERTHELIFEOFTHEASSET!SARESULT THECARRYINGVALUEOF THEASSETWOULDBEgreaterTHANITSRESALEVALUE 4HUS ALOSSONDISPOSALOCCURSWHENTHEASSETSCARRYINGVALUEISGREATERTHANTHE PROCEEDS FROM ITS DISPOSAL 4HIS COULD BE CAUSED BY UNDER DEPRECIATION WHERE THE RESIDUALVALUEORUSEFULLIFEWASOVERSTATEDPERHAPSBECAUSETHEASSETWASDAMAGED SUPERSEDEDBYANEWERMODELORNOTINDEMAND
Reasons for a profit on disposal )N CONTRAST TO A LOSS A PROlT ON THE DISPOSAL OF A NON CURRENT ASSET OCCURS WHEN THE CARRYINGVALUEOFTHEASSETISlessTHANTHEPROCEEDSFROMITSSALE4HISMEANSTHEASSET WASVALUEDATlessTHANITWASWORTH Over-depreciation over-depreciation occurs when excess depreciation has been allocated over the life of the asset, so that the carrying value of the asset is understated
)F THE CARRYING VALUE OF THE ASSET IS UNDERSTATED IT IS BECAUSE IT HAS BEEN overdepreciatedWEHAVEWRITTENOFFTOOMUCHDEPRECIATIONOVERTHEASSETSLIFE)NTERMSOF THECALCULATIONS THISMAYBEBECAUSE s THEESTIMATEDRESIDUALVALUEWASTOOLOWORUNDERSTATED ANDOR s THEESTIMATEDUSEFULLIFEWASTOOLOWUNDERSTATED "OTHTHESEFACTORSWOULDBEREmECTEDINADEPRECIATIONRATETHATWASTOOHIGH 4HEACTUALRESIDUALVALUEANDORUSEFULLIFEOFTHEASSETMAYBEUNDERSTATEDBECAUSE s 4HEORIGINALESTIMATESDIDNOTANTICIPATETHATTHEASSETWOULDBEIN good condition 4HISWOULDINCREASEITSRESALERESIDUAL VALUE ANDCOULDALSOINCREASEITSUSEFULLIFE s 4HEORIGINALESTIMATESDIDNOTANTICIPATETHATTHEASSETWOULDBEin high demand 4HISMAYBEBECAUSEITISrare ANDWOULDALSOINCREASEITSRESALEVALUE 5NDERSTATINGTHERESIDUALVALUEORUSEFULLIFEWOULDMEANTHATTOOMUCHDEPRECIATION WOULDHAVEBEENALLOCATEDOVERTHELIFEOFTHEASSET!SARESULT THECARRYINGVALUEOF THEASSETWOULDBElessTHANITSRESALEVALUE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
4HUS A PROlT ON DISPOSAL OCCURS WHEN THE ASSETS CARRYING VALUE IS LESS THAN THE PROCEEDS FROM ITS DISPOSAL 4HIS COULD BE CAUSED BY OVER DEPRECIATION WHERE THE RESIDUALVALUEORUSEFULLIFEWASUNDERSTATEDPERHAPSBECAUSETHEASSETWASINGOOD CONDITION RAREORINHIGHDEMAND
REVIEW QUESTIONS 15.9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
DefineTHETERM@UNDER DEPRECIATION StateTWOCAUSESOFUNDER DEPRECIATION StateTWOREASONSWHYTHERESIDUALVALUEMAYBEOVERSTATED ExplainHOWUNDER DEPRECIATIONMAYLEADTOALOSSONTHEDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSET DefineTHETERM@OVER DEPRECIATION StateTWOCAUSESOFOVER DEPRECIATION StateTWOREASONSWHYTHERESIDUALVALUEMAYBEUNDERSTATED ExplainHOWOVER DEPRECIATIONMAYLEADTOAPROlTONTHEDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSET
357
STUDY TIP
4HEREASONSFORAPROlT ARETHEOPPOSITEOFTHE REASONSFORALOSSLEARN ONESETOFREASONSAND SIMPLYREVERSETHEMFOR THEOTHERRESULT
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s !SUNDRYCREDITORACCOUNTISUSEDTORECORDAMOUNTSOWEDFORPURCHASESOTHERTHAN STOCK s 4HE COST OF AN ASSET INCLUDES ALL COSTS INCURRED IN ORDER TO BRING THE ASSET INTO A LOCATION AND CONDITION READY FOR USE THAT WILL PROVIDE A BENElT FOR THE LIFE OF THE ASSET s 4HEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHODOFDEPRECIATIONASSUMESTHATTHEASSETCONTRIBUTES MORETOREVENUEATTHESTARTOFITSLIFE ANDLESSASITAGES s 4HEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHODCALCULATESDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEASAPERCENTAGEOF THEASSETSCARRYINGVALUE s /VER THE LIFE OF THE ASSET THE STRAIGHT LINE AND REDUCING BALANCE METHODS WILL ALLOCATETHESAMETOTALDEPRECIATIONEXPENSE s #ONSISTENCYDEMANDSTHATDEPRECATIONMETHODSARENOTCHANGEDFROMPERIODTO PERIOD ENSURING#OMPARABILITYINTHEREPORTS s 2ECORDINGTHEDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSETINVOLVESTHREESTEPS n TRANSFERRINGTHECARRYINGVALUEOFTHEASSET n RECORDINGTHEPROCEEDSFROMTHEDISPOSAL n TRANSFERRINGTHEPROlTORLOSSONDISPOSAL s 4HECASHRECEIVEDFROMTHESALEOFANON CURRENTASSETISAN)NVESTINGCASHINmOW WHILEAPAYMENTTOASUNDRYCREDITORISAN)NVESTINGOUTmOW s /NLYTHEOVERALLPROlTORLOSSONTHEDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSETISREPORTEDIN THE)NCOME3TATEMENT AS/THER2EVENUEFORAPROlT OR/THER%XPENSEFORALOSS s !LOSSONTHEDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSETOCCURSWHENTHECARRYINGVALUEOFTHE ASSETISmoreTHANTHEPROCEEDSFROMITSSALE s !PROlTONTHEDISPOSALOFANON CURRENTASSETOCCURSWHENTHECARRYINGVALUEOFTHE ASSETISlessTHANTHEPROCEEDSFROMITSSALE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
358
EXERCISES
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 15.1 CREDIT PURCHASE OF A NON-CURRENT ASSET
W B
page 320
/N-AY 3HOWCASE7ORLDHADWORTHOFDISPLAYCABINETS/N-AY ITPURCHASEDMOREDISPLAYCABINETSATACOSTOFINCLUDING'34 FROM #ARLS#ABINETS)NV /N-AY 3HOWCASE7ORLDPAIDTHEAMOUNTOWINGTO #ARLS#ABINETS#H Required a ExplainWHY)NVOICEWOULDnotBERECORDEDINTHE0URCHASES*OURNALOF3HOWCASE 7ORLD b ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHEPURCHASEOFTHEDISPLAY CABINETS c Record#HEQUEINTHE#ASH0AYMENTS*OURNALOF3HOWCASE7ORLD d Show HOW THE $ISPLAY #ABINETS AND 3UNDRY #REDITOR n #ARLS #ABINETS ACCOUNTS WOULDAPPEARAFTERALLJOURNALSHAVEBEENPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGER
EXERCISE 15.2 CREDIT PURCHASE OF A NON-CURRENT ASSET
W B
page 321
/N!PRIL .EIL$OWNEPURCHASEDANEWCOMPUTERFORHISBUSINESS +NIBSAND 0ENS4HEDOCUMENTRELATINGTOTHEPURCHASEISSHOWNBELOW
Debit to:
Date April 30
CRASH COMPUTERS
Invoice: X.24
ABN: 34 354 365 887 Wells Rd Frankston VIC 3199
TA X I N V O I C E
Knibs and Pens (ABN: 56 575 334 102) Elizabeth St, Dandenong VIC 3175 Details Computer System and Software Installation Subtotal GST Total invoice price
Total 2 400 250 2 650 265 $2 915
+NIBSAND0ENSPAID#RASH#OMPUTERSINTHElRSTWEEKOF-AY#H Required a ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHISPURCHASE b 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@A explainYOURTREATMENTOFINSTALLATION c ShowHOWTHE#OMPUTERACCOUNTWOULDAPPEARAFTERTHE'ENERAL*OURNALHASBEEN POSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF+NIBSAND0ENSASAT!PRIL d ShowHOWTHEAMOUNTOWINGTO#RASH#OMPUTERSWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE 3HEETOF+NIBSAND0ENSASAT!PRIL e ShowHOWTHEPAYMENTTO#RASH#OMPUTERSWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE#ASH&LOW 3TATEMENTOF+NIBSAND0ENSFOR-AY ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
EXERCISE 15.3 CREDIT PURCHASE OF A NON-CURRENT ASSET
W B
page 322
/N!PRIL -ATTS-OWERSPURCHASEDANEWPHOTOCOPIER4HEDOCUMENTRELATING TOTHEPURCHASEISSHOWNBELOW
Phil’s Photocopiers Main St Mornington VIC 3931 Debit to:
Invoice: 36 ABN: 35 444 000 121
Matt’s Mowers (ABN: 65 555 760 012) Ferntree Gully VIC 3156
Date
Details
Total
1/4/15
Photocopier T – 1000
21 000
Fitting of card-identification system
1 500
Technical assistance (12-month period)
1 200
Subtotal
23 700
GST
2 370
Total invoice price
$26 070
Required a DefineTHETERM@COSTASITAPPLIESTONON CURRENTASSETS b Show THE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORD)NVOICEINTHEACCOUNTSOF -ATTS-OWERS c Show HOWTHECOSTOFTECHNICALASSISTANCEWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEET OF-ATTS-OWERSASAT!PRIL d ExplainTHEDIFFERENCEBETWEEN#REDITORS#ONTROLANDASUNDRYCREDITOR
EXERCISE 15.4 DEPRECIATION BASICS
W B
page 323
/N3EPTEMBER +RISTINES+ITESPURCHASEDNEWSHELVINGFORANDANEW SEWINGMACHINEFORFROM4ROJAN0RODUCTS)NV '34CHARGEDONTHEINVOICE AMOUNTEDTO+RISTINEHASNOTYETSELECTEDADEPRECIATIONMETHOD Required a ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESTORECORDTHEPURCHASEON3EPTEMBER b 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainWHYITISNECESSARYTODEPRECIATENON CURRENTASSETS c ExplainWHYTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHODSHOULDBEUSEDTODEPRECIATETHESHELVING d ExplainWHYTHEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHODSHOULDBEUSEDTODEPRECIATETHESEWING MACHINE e ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESTORECORDDEPRECIATIONEXPENSE!MOUNTSAND NARRATIONSAREnotREQUIRED
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
359
360
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 15.5 REDUCING BALANCE DEPRECIATION
W B
page 324
/N*ULY "ENANEE2UBBERPURCHASEDANEWDELIVERYVANFORPLUS'34 4HEVANISTOBEDEPRECIATEDATPERANNUMUSINGTHEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHOD -EMO Required a StateTHEASSUMPTIONTHATUNDERLIESTHEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHODOFDEPRECIATION INRELATIONTOHOWASSETSCONTRIBUTETOREVENUE b CalculateDEPRECIATIONOFTHEVANFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE c Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES TO RECORD DEPRECIATION OF THE VAN FOR THE YEAR ENDED*UNE d Show HOW THE VAN WOULD APPEAR IN THE "ALANCE 3HEET OF "ENANEE 2UBBER AS AT *UNE e CalculateTHEDEPRECIATIONOFTHEVANFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE
EXERCISE 15.6 REDUCING BALANCE DEPRECIATION
W B
page 325
!SAT*UNE THE"ALANCE3HEETOF(EAVENLY$ESIGNSSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWINGNON CURRENTASSETS $ Computers Less Accumulated Depreciation
$
10 000 1 800
Shop Fittings
40 000
Less Accumulated Depreciation
13 104
8 200 26 896
"OTHASSETSAREDEPRECIATEDATPERANNUMUSINGTHEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHOD Required a CalculateDEPRECIATIONOFTHECOMPUTERSFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE b ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESTORECORDDEPRECIATIONOFTHECOMPUTERSFORTHE YEARENDED*UNE.ARRATIONISnotREQUIRED c Show HOW THE #OMPUTERS WOULD BE REPORTED IN THE "ALANCE 3HEET OF (EAVENLY $ESIGNSASAT*UNE d ExplainONEREASONWHYTHEOWNERSHOULDCHANGETHEMETHODOFDEPRECIATIONUSED FORTHESHOPlTTINGS e 2EFERRINGTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC explainONEREASONWHYTHEOWNERSHOULD not CHANGETHEMETHODOFDEPRECIATIONUSEDFORTHESHOPlTTINGS f 'IVEN THAT THEY WERE PURCHASED ON *ULY calculate THE YEAR IN WHICH THE SHOP lTTINGSWEREPURCHASED
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
EXERCISE 15.7 COMPARING DEPRECIATION METHODS
W B
page 327
/N*ULY "ABYLANDPURCHASEDSHOPEQUIPMENTFORINCLUDING'344HE OWNERARGUESTHATTHEBESTWAYTOUPHOLDTHEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLEOF#ONSISTENCYISTO DEPRECIATETHESHOPEQUIPMENTATPERANNUMUSINGTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD4HE ACCOUNTANTHASARGUEDTHATTHESHOPEQUIPMENTSHOULDBEDEPRECIATEDATUSING THEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHOD Required a SuggestONEREASONWHYTHEOWNERMIGHTINCORRECTLY ARGUETHATTHESTRAIGHT LINE METHODPROVIDES#ONSISTENCY b 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@A stateONEREASONWHYTHEOWNERISINCORRECT c IdentifyONEEXTRAPIECEOFINFORMATIONYOUWOULDREQUIREBEFOREAGREEINGWITHTHE ACCOUNTANTJustifyYOURANSWER d CalculateDEPRECIATIONOFSHOPEQUIPMENTFORTHEYEARENDED*UNEUSING THESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD e CalculateDEPRECIATIONOFSHOPEQUIPMENTFORTHEYEARENDED*UNEUSING THEREDUCINGBALANCEMETHOD f ExplainHOWTHECHOICEOFDEPRECIATIONMETHODWILLAFFECT.ET0ROlTFORTHEYEAR ENDED*UNE g Calculate THEYEARINWHICHTHEDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEUNDERTHEREDUCINGBALANCE METHODWILLBELOWERTHANDEPRECIATIONEXPENSEUNDERTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHOD
EXERCISE 15.8 GRAPHING DEPRECIATION
W B
page 329
*USTINIAN0RINTINGHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGGRAPHSRELATINGTODEPRECIATIONOFITSNON CURRENTASSETS $8 000
$12 000
$7 000
$10 000
$6 000 $8 000 $5 000 $6 000 $4 000 $4 000 $3 000 $2 000 $2 000 $0 $1 000 2015
2016
2017
2018
2019 $0
Photocopiers
2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
Office Equipment Depreciation expense
Depreciation expense
Line A
Line B
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
361
362
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Required a IdentifyTHEDEPRECIATIONMETHODUSEDFORTHE s 0HOTOCOPIERS s /FlCE%QUIPMENT b IdentifyTHELINESLABELLED@,INE!AND@,INE" c Discuss WHETHER THE OWNER SHOULD CHANGE THE METHOD USED TO CALCULATE THE DEPRECIATIONOFTHEPHOTOCOPIERS d ExplainTHEEFFECTONTHECARRYINGVALUEOFTHEOFlCEEQUIPMENTATTHEENDOFITS USEFULLIFEIFTHEOWNERHADUSEDTHEOTHERDEPRECIATIONMETHOD
EXERCISE 15.9 CASH SALE OF A NON-CURRENT ASSET
W B
page 330
/N!UGUST 0ARTY0OTSSOLDAVANFORCASH2EC 4HEVANHADBEEN PURCHASEDFORANDALREADYDEPRECIATEDBYATTHETIMEOFSALE Required a Record2ECEIPTINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALOF0ARTY0OTS b ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHEDISPOSALOFTHEVANAND TRANSFERTHEPROlTORLOSSONDISPOSAL c ShowHOWTHE6AN !CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONOF6AN $ISPOSALOF6ANAND0ROlTOR ,OSSON$ISPOSALOF6ANACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARAFTERTHEJOURNALSWEREPOSTEDTOTHE 'ENERAL,EDGEROF0ARTY0OTS d ShowHOWTHEPROCEEDSFROMTHESALEWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT OF0ARTY0OTSFOR!UGUST
EXERCISE 15.10 CASH SALE OF A NON-CURRENT ASSET
W B
page 332
!SAT$ECEMBER THE"ALANCE3HEETOF4RIFlC4OYSSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING TRIFFIC TOYS Balance Sheet as at 31 December 2014 Non-Current Assets
$
Fittings
36 000
Less Accumulated Depreciation
32 800
$ 3 200
4HElTTINGSAREDEPRECIATEDUSINGTHESTRAIGHT LINEMETHODATPERANNUM/N -ARCHTHElTTINGSWERESOLDFORCASH2EC Required a CalculateCARRYINGVALUEOFTHElTTINGSASAT-ARCH b RecordTHEPROCEEDSFROMTHEDISPOSALOFTHElTTINGSINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL OF4RIFlC4OYS c ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHEDISPOSALOFTHElTTINGS d ShowHOWTHE&ITTINGS !CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONOF&ITTINGS $ISPOSALOF&ITTINGS AND0ROlTOR,OSSON$ISPOSALOF&ITTINGSACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARAFTERTHESALEWAS POSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF4RIFlC4OYS e SuggestTWOREASONSFORTHEPROlTORLOSSONTHEDISPOSALOFTHElTTINGS f ShowHOWTHEPROlTORLOSSONTHEDISPOSALOFTHElTTINGSWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE )NCOME3TATEMENTOF4RIFlC4OYSFOR-ARCH
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
EXERCISE 15.11 CASH SALE OF A NON-CURRENT ASSET
W B
page 334
!NEXTRACTFROMTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF6ICKIS6INYLSASAT/CTOBERSHOWEDTHE FOLLOWING Disposal of Furniture Date Oct. 31
Cross-reference Furniture
Amount $
Date
8 000
Oct. 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Acc. Dep. – Furniture
5 000
Bank
1 900
4HESALEOFFURNITUREOCCURREDON/CTOBER ANDWASVERIlEDBY2EC Required a ExplainHOWTHEPROCEEDSFROMTHEDISPOSALOFFURNITUREWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE #ASH&LOW3TATEMENTOF6ICKIS6INYLSFOR/CTOBER b CalculateTHEPROlTORLOSSMADEONTHEDISPOSALOFFURNITURE c ExplainONEREASONFORTHEPROlTORLOSSONTHEDISPOSALOFFURNITURE d ShowHOWTHEPROlTORLOSSONTHEDISPOSALOFFURNITUREWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE )NCOME3TATEMENTOF6ICKIS6INYLSFOR/CTOBER e Show HOW THE DISPOSAL OF FURNITURE WOULD HAVE BEEN RECORDED IN THE JOURNALS OF 6ICKIS6INYLS
EXERCISE 15.12 TRADE-IN OF A NON-CURRENT ASSET
W B
page 336
/N-AY AVANPURCHASEDFORBY3WING3EATSANDALREADYDEPRECIATED BYWASTRADEDINFORONANEWVAN BOUGHTONCREDITFORPLUS '34 FROM$ODGE-OTORS)NV Required a DefineTHETERM@TRADE IN b ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHEDISPOSALOFTHEOLDVAN ANDTHEPURCHASEOFTHENEWVAN c ShowHOWTHE6AN !CCUMULATED$EPRECIATIONOF6AN $ISPOSALOF6AN 0ROlTOR,OSS ON$ISPOSALOF6ANAND3UNDRY#REDITORn$ODGE-OTORSACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEAR AFTERTHEDISPOSALWASPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF3WING3EATS d DefineTHETERM@UNDER DEPRECIATION e StateTWOCAUSESOFUNDER DEPRECIATION
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
363
364
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 15.13 TRADE-IN OF A NON-CURRENT ASSET
W B
page 338
1UILTS)NCRECENTLYTRADEDINITSCASHREGISTERANDPURCHASEDAMUCHNEWERVERSION4HE OLDCASHREGISTERWASPURCHASEDFORINCLUDING'34 BUTHADBEENDEPRECIATEDBY ATTHETIMEOFTRADE IN4HEINVOICEFORTHETRANSACTIONISSHOWNBELOW
Cash Controllers
Invoice: A330
ABN: 45 765 300 118 Moore St, Moe VIC 3825
Charge to: Date 1 June 15
Terms: 10/7, n/60 Tax invoice
Quilts Inc. (ABN: 52 590 436 466) Keilor Rd, Essendon VIC 3040 Details Electronic cash register
Qty 1
Unit price
6 000
6 000
GST
600
Invoice price less
6 600
Trade in Balance owing
Total
500
$
6 100
/N*UNE 1UILTS)NCPAID#ASH#ONTROLLERSTHEBALANCEOWING Required a ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHEDISPOSALOFTHEOLDCASH REGISTERANDTHEPURCHASEOFTHENEWCASHREGISTER b ShowHOWTHE#ASH2EGISTER $ISPOSALOF#ASH2EGISTERAND3UNDRY#REDITORn#ASH #ONTROLLERS ACCOUNTS WOULD APPEAR AFTER THE DISPOSAL WAS POSTED TO THE 'ENERAL ,EDGEROF1UILTS)NC c ExplainHOWTHEVALUEOFTHETRADE INSHOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT FOR1UILTS)NCFOR*UNE d ShowHOWTHEPAYMENTTO#ASH#ONTROLLERSON*UNEWOULDBEREPORTEDIN THE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTOF1UILTS)NCFOR*UNE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 15
ACCOUNTING FOR NON-CURRENT ASSETS
EXERCISE 15.14 DISPOSAL OF A NON-CURRENT ASSET AND FINANCIAL REPORTS
W B
page 340
+YABRAM+ITESHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWING0RE ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCEASAT*UNE KYABRAM KITES Pre-adjustment Trial Balance as at 30 June 2015 Account
Debit
Accumulated Depreciation – Fittings Advertising
24 000 1 000
Bank
390
Capital – Darling Cost of Sales
34 720 14 820
Creditors Control Debtors Control Discount Expense
8 600 12 750 280
Discount Revenue Drawings Fittings
130 3 200 60 000
GST Clearing
1 060
Loan – Northern Bank (repayable $500 per month) Prepaid Rent
24 000 1 800
Sales Stock Control Stock Write-down Wages Totals
Credit
33 100 26 670 230 5 250 $126 000
$126 000
Additional information: s 4HElTTINGSARETOBEDEPRECIATEDATPERANNUMUSINGTHEREDUCINGBALANCE METHOD s /N*UNE SOMESHOPlTTINGSWERETRADEDINFORONNEWSHOPlTTINGS WHICHCOSTPLUS'34 FROM&ITS7ELL4HEOLDSHOPlTTINGSHADBEEN PURCHASEDFOR BUTHADACARRYINGVALUEOF s !PHYSICALSTOCKTAKEON*UNESHOWEDA3TOCK,OSSOF s !S AT *UNE INTEREST EXPENSE WAS ACCRUED AND PREPAID RENT WAS s 2EPORTSAREPREPAREDMONTHLY
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
365
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
366
UNITS 3&4
Required
* * *
a Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNALENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD THE ADDITIONALINFORMATION .ARRATIONSAREnotREQUIRED b Prepare A0OST ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCEFOR+YABRAM+ITESASAT*UNE c ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTOCLOSETHEEXPENSEACCOUNTS d PrepareAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR+YABRAM+ITESFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE e Suggest TWO ACTIONS +YABRAM +ITES COULD TAKE TO IMPROVE !DJUSTED 'ROSS 0ROlT WITHOUTCHANGINGITSMARK UP f PrepareACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR+YABRAM+ITESASAT*UNE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s define@REVENUE @EXPENSES AND@PROlT s explainHOWTHE2EPORTING 0ERIODPRINCIPLEAND QUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC OF2ELEVANCEAFFECTTHE CALCULATIONOFPROlT s explainTHEPURPOSEOFA BALANCEDAYADJUSTMENT s identifyANDrecordPREPAID REVENUEINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS *OURNALAND'ENERAL,EDGER
s stateTHEEFFECTOFBALANCE DAYADJUSTMENTSONTHE ACCOUNTINGEQUATION
s recordBALANCEDAY ADJUSTMENTSINTHE'ENERAL *OURNALAND'ENERAL,EDGER FORPREPAIDANDACCRUED REVENUES
s identifyANDrecordTHE RECEIPTOFANACCRUEDREVENUE INASUBSEQUENTPERIOD s distinguishBETWEENACCRUED REVENUEANDASUNDRYDEBTOR s reportPREPAIDANDACCRUED REVENUESINTHE"ALANCE 3HEET
CHAPTER 16
BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS: REVENUES KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s PREPAIDREVENUE s ACCRUEDREVENUE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
368
UNITS 3&4
16.1 THE NEED FOR BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS #HAPTER POINTED OUT THAT WHEN WE SPEAK OF DETERMINING PROlT WE ARE ACTUALLY COMPARINGTHEREVENUEEARNEDAGAINSTTHEEXPENSESINCURREDINTHECURRENT2EPORTING 0ERIOD "ALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS ARE MADE TO ENSURE THAT REVENUE ACCOUNTS SHOW REVENUESEARNEDANDEXPENSEACCOUNTSSHOWEXPENSESINCURREDINAPARTICULAR2EPORTING 0ERIOD SOANACCURATEPROlTCANBECALCULATED
Types of balance day adjustments 3O FAR WE HAVE COVERED BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS THAT ENSURE THAT EXPENSE accounts SHOWTHEAMOUNTSINCURREDCONSUMED: s STOCKLOSSES#HAPTER s PREPAIDEXPENSESANDACCRUEDEXPENSES#HAPTER s DEPRECIATION#HAPTER 4OTHISPOINT THEONLYREVENUEWEHAVECOVEREDISASTOCKGAIN)NTHISCHAPTER WEWILL COVER TWO OTHER BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS TO ENSURE THAT REVENUE ACCOUNTS SHOW THE AMOUNTSEARNED: s PREPAIDREVENUES s ACCRUEDREVENUES 2EMEMBER REVENUE IS DElNED AS AN INmOW OF ECONOMIC BENElTS OR SAVING IN OUTmOWS INTHEFORMOFANINCREASEINASSETSORAREDUCTIONINLIABILITIESTHATLEADSTO AN INCREASE IN OWNERS EQUITY 4HE DElNITION DOES NOT REQUIRE THAT CASH BE RECEIVED FOR REVENUE TO BE RECOGNISED THE RECEIPT OF CASH MAY OR MAY NOT BE INVOLVED &OR EXAMPLE ACREDITSALEINCREASESDEBTORSRATHERTHANCASH)NDEED MANYTRANSACTIONSARE NOTREVENUESEVENWHENCASHISRECEIVED4HEKEYISTHATSOMETYPEOFeconomic benefit HASBEENRECEIVEDEITHERBYASSETSINCREASINGORLIABILITIESDECREASING ANDTHATOWNERS EQUITYHASINCREASEDASACONSEQUENCE
REVIEW QUESTIONS 16.1
1 ExplainTHEPURPOSEOFABALANCEDAYADJUSTMENT 2 DefineTHETERM@REVENUE 3 StateTHREENON CASHREVENUEITEMS
16.2 PREPAID REVENUES
prepaid revenue a revenue received but yet to be earned
!LTHOUGH PERHAPS LESS FREQUENT THAN A PREPAID EXPENSE IT IS POSSIBLE FOR A lRM TO RECEIVEREVENUEINADVANCEOFSUPPLYINGTHEGOODS4HISWOULDBETHECASEIFAlRM ACCEPTEDSUBSCRIPTIONS SUCHASTOAMAGAZINERENTEDOUTEXTRASPACEINITSWAREHOUSE OFFEREDLAY BYFACILITIESORACCEPTEDCASHASADEPOSITTOSECUREASALE3ECTION COVERSTHELASTPOSSIBILITY )NCASESSUCHASTHESE THElRMWOULDHAVERECEIVEDTHECASH BUTBECAUSEITHASNOT SUPPLIEDANYGOODSORSERVICES TOTHECUSTOMER ITHASNOTEARNEDANYREVENUE4HIS MEANSTHERECEIPTISprepaid revenue ORREVENUERECEIVEDINADVANCE 7HERE REVENUE IS PREPAID THE GOODSERVICE IS OWED TO THE CUSTOMER SO THE lRM HAS AN OBLIGATION TO PROVIDE THEM SOMETIME IN THE FUTURE 4HUS PREPAID REVENUE IS NOTREVENUEATALL BUTRATHERAcurrent liabilityAPRESENTOBLIGATIONTHATISEXPECTEDTO RESULTINANOUTmOWOFECONOMICBENElTSWHENTHEGOODSERVICEISSUPPLIEDSOMETIME INTHENEXTMONTHS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 16
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : R E V E N U E S
369
Although perhaps less frequent than a prepaid expense, it is possible for a firm to receive revenue in advance of supplying the goods; for example, a newspaper subscription
Recording revenues received in advance 7HEN REVENUE IS RECEIVED IN ADVANCE OR PREPAID IT MUST BE RECORDED AS A CURRENT LIABILITYINTHEJOURNALSANDLEDGERACCOUNTS
EXAMPLE
The Bag Emporium owns a warehouse, and rents out some office space to a small courier business. On 1 August 2015, the Bag Emporium received $420 rent (plus $42 GST) for use of the office space for the next six months. Reports are prepared monthly.
/FTHECASHRECEIVEDFROMTHECOURIERCOMPANY IS'34THATISNOWOWEDTO THE!4/7HATOFTHEREMAINING? 4HEKEYHEREISTHATTHECASHRECEIPTCOVERSTHENEXTMONTHSITISRECEIVEDINADVANCE OFPROVIDINGTHEUSEOFTHEOFlCESPACE!SAT!UGUST NONEOFTHEOFlCESPACE HASBEENPROVIDEDTOTHECOURIERBUSINESS THEREFORENOREVENUEHASBEENEARNED)N FACT 4HE"AG%MPORIUMOWESTOTHECOURIERCOMPANYUSEOFTHEOFlCESPACEFORSIX MONTHS SOTHISCASHRECEIPTISINFACTALIABILITYn0REPAID2ENT2EVENUE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
370
UNITS 3&4
4HISRECEIPTWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALASSHOWNIN&IGURE STUDY TIP
)F'34ISIDENTIlED IT CANBERECORDEDINTHE #ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL
Figure 16.1
Cash Receipts Journal: prepaid revenue CASH RECEIPTS JOURNAL
Date Aug.1
Rec. no.
Details Prepaid Totals
Debtors Cost of Control Sales
Sales
Sundries
462
18
Rent Rev.
Disc. Exp.
Bank
33 020
300
12 000
12 500
19 000
GST
420
42
420
1 942
!FTERPOSTING THE'ENERAL,EDGERWOULDAPPEARASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 16.2
General Ledger: prepaid revenue GENERAL LEDGER Bank (A)
Date Aug. 1 Dec. 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Balance
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
5 000
Cash Receipts
33 020 Prepaid Rent Revenue (L)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Aug. 31
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $ 420
GST Clearing (A/L) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Aug. 1 31
Cross-reference Balance Bank
Amount $ 700 1 942
4HISENTRYINCREASESBank ANDINCREASESTWOLIABILITIES0REPAID2ENT2EVENUEAND'34 #LEARING!TTHISPOINT THEREISNOREVENUERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL,EDGERNORENTHAS BEENPROVIDED SONORENTREVENUEHASBEENEARNED Effect on the accounting equation !SARESULTOFTHERECEIPTOFPREPAIDREVENUE Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
Increase (Bank)
462
Liabilities
Increase (Prepaid Rent Revenue $420, GST Clearing $42)
462
Owner’s Equity
No effect
.OTETHATTHEREISNOEFFECTONOWNERSEQUITY SOTHECASHRECEIVEDCANNOTBEREVENUE
Adjusting for prepaid revenues earned 0REPAIDREVENUESARERECORDEDASCURRENTLIABILITIESBECAUSEWHENTHECASHISRECEIVED NONEOFTHEAMOUNTHASBEENEARNEDITISAPRESENTOBLIGATIONTOPROVIDETHEGOOD ORSERVICE)FBYBALANCEDAYTHEGOODSERVICEHASBEENPROVIDEDTOTHECUSTOMER THE lRMWILLHAVEFULlLLEDITSOBLIGATIONTHELIABILITYHASBEENEXTINGUISHED SOTHEREVENUE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 16
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : R E V E N U E S
HASBEENEARNED4HISISAGOODEXAMPLEOFAREVENUEINTHEFORMOFADECREASEINA LIABILITYPREPAIDREVENUE RATHERTHANTHEUSUALINCREASEINASSETSCREATEDBYACASHOR CREDITSALE )TISNECESSARYTOADJUSTTHELEDGERACCOUNTSSOTHAT s THE AMOUNT EARNED IN THE CURRENT 2EPORTING 0ERIOD IS TRANSFERRED TO A REVENUE ACCOUNT s THE0REPAID2EVENUEACCOUNTONLYSHOWSTHEAMOUNTREMAININGTHATIS UNEARNED ORTOBEEARNEDINAFUTURE2EPORTING0ERIOD )NTHEEXAMPLE THERECEIVEDON!UGUSTRELATEDTOTHENEXTSIXMONTHS SO 2ENT2EVENUEFORONEMONTHWOULDBECALCULATEDAS $420 Prepaid Rent Revenue
=
$70 Rent per month
6 months 4HISREVENUEISONLYEARNEDASTHERENTISPROVIDEDEACHMONTH"Y!UGUST RENT WOULDHAVEBEENPROVIDEDFORONEMONTH!UGUST MEANING4HE"AG%MPORIUMWOULD HAVEEARNEDONEMONTHSWORTH OR2ENT2EVENUEOF-EMO !SARESULT THIS AMOUNTISNOLONGEROWEDTOTHECOURIERCOMPANY 4HEBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTTORECORDTHEPREPAIDRENTREVENUEEARNEDISSHOWNIN THE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYIN&IGURE Figure 16.3
General Journal: BDA for prepaid revenue earned GENERAL JOURNAL
Date
Details
Aug. 31
Prepaid Rent Revenue
General Ledger
Subsidiary ledger
Debit
Debit
Credit
Credit
70
Rent Revenue
70
Adjusting entry to record one month’s rent revenue earned (Memo 12)
4HISENTRYCREDITSTHE2ENT2EVENUEACCOUNTTORECOGNISETHEREVENUEEARNEDINTHE CURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD WHILETHE0REPAID2ENT2EVENUEACCOUNTISDEBITEDTOREDUCE THECURRENTLIABILITYBECAUSETHEOBLIGATIONHASBEENFULlLLED!FTERPOSTING THE'ENERAL ,EDGERWOULDAPPEARASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 16.4
General Ledger: BDA for prepaid revenue earned GENERAL LEDGER Prepaid Rent Revenue (L)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Aug. 31
Rent Revenue
70
Aug. 31
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $ 420
350 Rent Revenue (R) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date Aug. 31
Cross-reference Prepaid Rent Revenue
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Amount $ 70
Cambridge University Press
371
372
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
4HE BALANCE OF THE 2ENT 2EVENUE ACCOUNT REPRESENTS THE REVENUE EARNED IN THECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD WHILETHEBALANCEREMAININGINTHE0REPAID2ENT2EVENUE ACCOUNT REPRESENTSTHEREVENUETHATHASNOTYETBEENEARNED ANDWILLBEEARNED INAFUTURE2EPORTING0ERIOD Effect on the accounting equation !SARESULTOFTHEADJUSTMENTFORPREPAIDREVENUEEARNED Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
No effect
Liabilities
Decrease (Prepaid Rent Revenue)
70
Owner’s Equity
Increase (Rent Revenue increases Net Profit)
70
!S A CONSEQUENCE OF THE BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENT A LIABILITY BECOMES A REVENUE DECREASINGLIABILITIESANDINCREASINGOWNERSEQUITY!SSETSDONOTCHANGE
Closing the ledger 4HEADJUSTEDlGUREINTHEREVENUEACCOUNTCANNOWBECLOSEDTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS 3UMMARYACCOUNT2EMEMBER ALLREVENUEACCOUNTSARECLOSEDINONE'ENERAL*OURNAL ENTRY WITHEACHREVENUEACCOUNTDEBITEDTOREDUCEITSBALANCETOZERO ANDONECREDIT TOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT!FTERITHASBEENCLOSED THE2ENT2EVENUE ACCOUNTINOUREXAMPLEWOULDSHOW Rent Revenue (R) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Aug. 31
P&L Summary
70
Aug. 31
Cross-reference Prepaid Rent Revenue
Amount $ 70
!SACURRENTLIABILITY THE0REPAID2ENT2EVENUEACCOUNTWOULDBEBALANCED ANDTHE AMOUNTSTILLOWINGCARRIEDFORWARDTOTHENEXTPERIOD Prepaid Rent Revenue (L) Date
Cross-reference
Aug. 31
Rent Revenue
Amount $
Balance
70
Date Aug. 31
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $ 420
350 420
420 Sept. 1
Balance
350
REVIEW QUESTIONS 16.2
1 2 3 4
DefineTHETERM@PREPAIDREVENUE ExplainHOWPREPAIDREVENUEISREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEET StateTHEEFFECTOFARECEIPTOFPREPAIDREVENUEONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATION Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD THE BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTFORPREPAIDREVENUEEARNED 5 StateTHEEFFECTOFTHEBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTFORPREPAIDREVENUEEARNEDON THEACCOUNTINGEQUATION
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 16
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : R E V E N U E S
373
16.3 PREPAID SALES REVENUE: SALES OF STOCK INVOLVING A DEPOSIT 3ECTION DESCRIBED THE RECORDING OF PREPAID REVENUE WHERE CASH IS RECEIVED IN ADVANCEFORREVENUETHATISYETTOBEEARNED/NCETHEREVENUEISEARNED ENTRIESARE NECESSARYTORECORDTHEREVENUEEARNED ANDTHEREDUCTIONINTHELIABILITYOWEDTOTHE CUSTOMER 4HISAPPLIESTOALLPREPAIDREVENUES BUTPREPAIDSales2EVENUEISAPARTICULARTYPEOF PREPAIDREVENUE BECAUSEITINCLUDESTHEPROVISIONOFSTOCK0REPAID3ALESMIGHTOCCUR WHEN A NEW PRODUCT SUCH AS A $6$ OR ELECTRONIC GAME IS RELEASED AND CUSTOMERS PAYINADVANCETOENSURETHEYAREAMONGTHElRSTTOOWNTHEITEM)TMIGHTALSOOCCUR WHENACUSTOMERPAYSADEPOSITONANITEMOFSTOCKINORDERTOSECURETHESALE7HEN THISSTOCKISPROVIDED THEENTRIESAREREQUIREDTORECORDTHEREVENUEEARNEDANDTHE REDUCTIONOFTHELIABILITY BUTALSOTHESTOCKLEAVINGTHEBUSINESS
EXAMPLE
Wollard Prints sells a signed and framed poster of the Australian soccer team for $1 200 (plus $120 GST). On 14 September 2015, Wollard Prints received a deposit of $500 from B. Hogan for the sale of one poster (Rec. 35). On 23 September 2015, Hogan collected the poster, paying the balance in cash (Rec. 39). The poster has a cost price of $650.
Recording the deposit )NCOMMONWITHANYPREPAIDSALE THEDEPOSITRECEIVEDON3EPTEMBERINCREASES CASHINTHE"ANKACCOUNT ANDCREATESALIABILITYINTHISCASE 0REPAID3ALESREVENUE "UT BECAUSETHISISSIMPLYADEPOSITTOGUARANTEETHESALEnANDNOTARECEIPTOFTHEFULL AMOUNTOFCASHFORTHESALEnTHETRANSACTIONDOESNOTIDENTIFYANY'34RECEIVED!SA RESULT '34NEEDNOTBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL ASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 16.5
Cash Receipts Journal: deposit (no GST) Cash Receipts Journal
Date Sept. 14
Details Prepaid Sales
Rec. no.
Bank
35
500
Disc. Exp.
Debtors Control
Cost of Sales
Sales
Sundries 500
Recording a cash sale involving a deposit
STUDY TIP
/NCE THE CUSTOMER (OGAN COLLECTS THE POSTER ON 3EPTEMBER THE 3ALES 2EVENUEHASBEENEARNED ANDTHELIABILITYMET&IGURESHOWSTHE'ENERAL*OURNAL ENTRYTORECORDTHISINFORMATION
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
GST
$EPOSITSDONOT INCLUDE'34
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
374
Figure 16.6
UNITS 3&4
General Journal: deposit earned GENERAL JOURNAL General Ledger
Date Sept. 23
Details
Debit
Prepaid Sales
Credit
Subsidiary ledger Debit
Credit
500
Sales
500
Prepaid sales revenue earned (Rec. 39)
STUDY TIP
7HEREADEPOSIT ISINVOLVED '34IS RECOGNISEDATTHE POINTOFSALE
4HISISTHESAMEASANYENTRYTORECORDPREPAIDREVENUEEARNED ANDTHEREFORETHE SAMEASTHEENTRIESSHOWNIN&IGURE4HEENTRYDEBITS0REPAID3ALESREVENUETO REDUCE THE AMOUNT OWED TO THE CUSTOMER AND CREDITS 3ALES REVENUE BOTH BY TORECORDTHEREVENUEEARNEDWHENTHEGOODTHEPOSTER ISPROVIDEDTOTHECUSTOMER (OGAN (OWEVER THESELLINGPRICEOFTHEPOSTERSISNOTJUSTTHISTHESELLINGPRICEWAS ACTUALLY 4HUS WHEN THE POSTER IS SOLD ON 3EPTEMBER WE MUST ALSO RECORDANextraOF3ALESREVENUE4HISAMOUNT ALONGWITHTHEFULLAMOUNTOF'34 ONTHESALE nATOTALOFnWILLBERECEIVEDINCASHON3EPTEMBER ANDSOMUSTBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL 7EMUSTALSORECORDTHATASTHEPOSTERWASCOLLECTED $650WORTHCost of SalesHAS BEENINCURRED ANDStock ControlHASDECREASEDBYTHESAMEAMOUNT 4HE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALENTRYTORECORDTHISEXTRASALESINFORMATIONISSHOWNIN &IGURE Figure 16.7
Cash Receipts Journal: cash sale (involving a deposit) CASH RECEIPTS JOURNAL
STUDY TIP
!SADOUBLE CHECK ADDTOGETHERANY AMOUNTSLABELLED @3ALESTHEYSHOULD EQUALTHESELLINGPRICE OFTHESTOCKEXCLUDING '34
Date
Details
Sept. 23
Sales
Rec. No.
Bank
39
820
Disc. Exp.
Debtors Control
Cost of Sales 650
Sales Sundries 700
GST
120
4HIS#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALENTRYLOOKSLIKEASTANDARD ORDINARYCASHSALEWHICH FORTHE MOSTPART ITIS (OWEVER THE'34AMOUNT ISnotOFTHEAMOUNTRECORDED INTHE3ALESCOLUMN )NSTEAD THE'34ISOFTHEtotal3ALESlGUREOF WHERE • HASBEENRECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNALASSHOWNIN&IGURE AND • HASBEENRECORDEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL&IGURE 4HESEtwoENTRIESnTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYIN&IGURE ANDTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS *OURNALIN&IGURE nARENECESSARYTORECORDTHESALEON3EPTEMBER Effect on the accounting equation !SARESULTOFRECORDINGTHECASHSALEINVOLVINGADEPOSIT Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
Increase (increase Bank $820, decrease Stock Control $650)
170
Liabilities
Decrease (decrease Prepaid Sales Revenue $500; increase GST Clearing $120)
380
Owner’s Equity
Increase (Sales Revenue $1 200* less Cost of Sales $650 = Net Profit)
550
3ALES2EVENUEPREPAID'* #ASH3ALES#2* ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 16
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : R E V E N U E S
375
Recording a credit sale involving a deposit )N THE PREVIOUS EXAMPLE THE CUSTOMER (OGAN PAID CASH FOR THE BALANCE REMAINING WHENCOLLECTINGTHEGOODSON3EPTEMBER4HISWASVERIlEDBY2ECEIPT!S ACONSEQUENCE THE CASHRECEIVEDWASRECORDEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALAS WASTHEOF@EXTRA3ALES2EVENUE THE'34ANDTHECost of Sales of $650 )NTHEEVENTTHATTHESALEISMADEon credit THESAMEINFORMATIONMUSTBERECORDED THEONLYDIFFERENCESBEINGTHATITWOULDBEVERIlEDBYANinvoiceRATHERTHANBYACASH RECEIPT ANDRECORDEDINTHE3ALES*OURNALRATHERTHANTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL&IGURE SHOWSHOWTHISWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNALAND3ALES*OURNAL Figure 16.8
Journals: credit sale (involving a deposit) GENERAL JOURNAL General Ledger
Date Sept. 23
Details
Debit
Prepaid Sales
Subsidiary ledger
Credit
Debit
Credit
500
Sales
500
Prepaid Sales Revenue earned (Inv. 12) SALES JOURNAL Date Sept. 23
Debtor B. Hogan
Invoice number 12
Cost of Sales 650
Sales
GST
700
120
Debtors Control 820
4HIS'ENERAL*OURNALENTRYISIDENTICALTOTHATUSEDIFTHEREMAINDERISPAIDINCASH IN&IGURE !NDTHEINFORMATIONRECORDEDINTHIS3ALES*OURNALISTHESAMEASTHAT RECORDEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALIN&IGURE THEONLYDIFFERENCEBEINGTHAT FORACREDITSALEITIS$EBTORS#ONTROLANDINTHESUBSIDIARYLEDGER $EBTORn(OGAN NOT "ANK THATINCREASESBY)NBOTHCASES THETOTAL3ALESREVENUEEARNEDAMOUNTS TOTHESELLINGPRICEOFTHEPOSTER THECost of SalesIS$650 THE0REPAID3ALES REVENUELIABILITYDECREASESAND'34OFISRECOGNISED!SACONSEQUENCE THEEFFECT ONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONISIDENTICALTOTHATOFACASHSALE
STUDY TIP
2EMEMBER ADD TOGETHERANYAMOUNTS LABELLED@3ALESTOCHECK THATTHEYEQUALTHE SELLINGPRICEOFTHESTOCK EXCLUDING'34
Posting to the General Ledger "ECAUSEPARTOFASALEINVOLVINGADEPOSITISRECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNALTHEEARNING OFTHEDEPOSIT THISMUSTBEPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERSEPARATELY3EE&IGURE FORAREMINDER 4HE@EXTRASALEINFORMATIONISRECORDEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALFOR ACASHSALE OR3ALES*OURNALFORACREDITSALE ASWITHANYOTHERSALE SOTHISINFORMATION ISSIMPLYPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL,EDGERATTHEENDOFTHEMONTHASPARTOFTHECOLUMN TOTALSFROMTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL3ALES*OURNAL REVIEW QUESTIONS 16.3
1 Identify TWOSITUATIONSTHATMAYLEADTOTHERECEIPTOFADEPOSIT 2 StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOFTHERECEIPTOFADEPOSIT 3 ShowTHEDEBITANDCREDITENTRIESREQUIREDTORECORDACASHSALEINVOLVINGA DEPOSIT 4 StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOFASALEINVOLVINGADEPOSIT 5 IdentifyTHREEDIFFERENCESBETWEENRECORDINGACASHSALEINVOLVINGADEPOSIT ANDRECORDINGACREDITSALEINVOLVINGADEPOSIT ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
376
UNITS 3&4
16.4 ACCRUED REVENUE
accrued revenue a revenue that has been earned but not yet received
0REPAID REVENUES ARE RECEIVED BEFORE THEY ARE EARNED BUT IN SOME CASES REVENUES WILL BE RECEIVED after THEY ARE EARNED &OR EXAMPLE INTEREST ON A TERM DEPOSIT MAY HAVEBEENearned BUTISNOTDUETOBERECEIVEDUNTILNEXTMONTH/THERITEMSSUCHAS ROYALTIESANDCOMMISSIONSMAYONLYBERECEIVEDAFTERTHEYHAVEBEENEARNED"ECAUSE THISAMOUNTHASBEENEARNEDINTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD ITMUSTBERECOGNISEDAS REVENUE4HEAMOUNTOWINGSHOULDALSOBERECORDEDASAcurrent asset ASSOMETIME INTHEFUTURE THECASHWILLBERECEIVED4HEAMOUNTOWEDTOUSFORREVENUEWEHAVE ALREADYEARNEDISCALLEDaccrued revenue
Accrued revenue versus debtors !CCRUEDREVENUEANDDEBTORSARESIMILARINTHATTHEYARECURRENTassets)NBOTHCASESTHE REVENUEISEARNEDBEFORETHECASHISRECEIVED SOTHEYREPRESENTARESOURCECONTROLLED BYTHEENTITYTHEDEBTOWEDTOTHEBUSINESS WHICHWILLBRINGAFUTUREECONOMICBENElT INTHENEXTMONTHSWHENTHECASHISRECEIVED (OWEVER THEYAREDIFFERENTINASUBTLE BUTIMPORTANTWAY)FTHECUSTOMERHASTHEgoods and the invoice THENACREDITSALE HASOCCURRED ANDADEBTORSHOULDBERECOGNISED(OWEVER IFTHEREVENUERELATESTO ATRANSACTIONOTHERTHAN3ALES ANDTHECUSTOMERHAS not been sent the invoice THEN ACCRUEDREVENUEHASBEENEARNED!SSUCH ACCRUEDREVENUEWILLBEVERIlEDBYAMEMO RATHERTHANANINVOICE
Adjusting for accrued revenues 0RIORTOMAKINGANYBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTS THEREVENUEACCOUNTSWILLONLYSHOWTHE AMOUNTSRECEIVED
EXAMPLE
On 1 August 2014, Kilvington Kites invested $10 000 in a term deposit, earning interest at 9% per annum. Interest is received on 31 January and 31 July each year. The firm prepares its reports on 30 June each year.
/N*ANUARY THElRMWOULDRECEIVEINTERESTREVENUEFORTHElRSTSIX MONTHSOFTHETERMDEPOSIT Interest revenue for first 6 months
= =
$10 000 $450
x
9%
x
6 12
!SARESULT ASAT*UNETHE)NTEREST2EVENUEACCOUNTWOULDSHOW GENERAL LEDGER Interest Revenue (R) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date June 30
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $ 450
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 16
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : R E V E N U E S
4HENEXTINTERESTRECEIPTISNOTDUEUNTIL*ULYnSOMETIMEINTHEnext2EPORTING 0ERIODnSOTHECURRENTLYSHOWNINTHE)NTEREST2EVENUEACCOUNTREPRESENTSTHE AMOUNTACTUALLYRECEIVEDBY*UNE"UTISTHISTHETOTALREVENUEEARNEDINTHE PERIOD "EFORETHEREPORTSCANBEPREPARED THEACCOUNTANTMUSTCALCULATEHOWMUCHEXTRA REVENUEHASBEENEARNED BUTNOTYETRECEIVED ANDADDTHISTOTHEREVENUEACCOUNT BEFORE THE CLOSING ENTRIES ARE MADE )T IS THEREFORE NECESSARY TO ADJUST THE LEDGER ACCOUNTSSOTHAT • THEEXTRAAMOUNTEARNEDINTHEcurrent2EPORTING0ERIODISADDEDTOTHEREVENUE ACCOUNT • ACURRENTASSETACCOUNTn!CCRUED2EVENUEnISCREATEDTOSHOWTHEAMOUNTOWING TOUSWHICHWILLBERECEIVEDINTHEnext2EPORTING0ERIOD "ETWEENTHELASTRECEIPTOFINTEREST*ANUARY ANDBALANCEDAY*UNE ARElVEMONTHSINWHICHTHEBUSINESSWILLSTILLBEEARNINGINTERESTREVENUE Interest revenue for 5 months
= =
$10 000 $375
x
9%
x
5 12
4HISEXTRAINTERESTOFHASBEENEARNED BUTISNOTYETRECEIVED-EMO ANDTHISMUSTBERECORDEDINTHE'ENERAL*OURNALASABALANCEDAYADJUSTMENT ASIS SHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 16.9
General Journal: BDA for accrued revenue GENERAL JOURNAL
Date
Details
June 30
Accrued Interest Revenue
General Ledger
Subsidiary ledger
Debit
Debit
Credit
Credit
375
Interest Revenue
375
Adjusting entry to record interest earned but not received (Memo 8)
4HIS ENTRY CREDITS THE )NTEREST 2EVENUE ACCOUNT TO RECOGNISE THE EXTRA AMOUNT EARNEDINTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD!TTHESAMETIME THE!CCRUED)NTEREST2EVENUE ACCOUNTISDEBITEDTORECOGNISETHECURRENTASSETTHEINTERESTOWEDTOUS!FTERPOSTING THE'ENERAL,EDGERWOULDAPPEARASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 16.10
General Ledger: BDA for accrued revenue General Ledger Interest Revenue (R)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date June 30
Cross-reference
Amount $
Bank
450
Accrued Interest Rev.
375
825 Accrued Interest Revenue (A) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
June 30
Interest Revenue
375
Date
Cross-reference
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Amount $
Cambridge University Press
377
378
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
.OTETHATTHEAMOUNTUSEDINTHEADJUSTMENT ISNOTTHETOTALREVENUEFORTHE PERIODITISSIMPLYTHEAMOUNTOWING)TISaddedTOTHEAMOUNTRECEIVEDTOCALCULATE THETOTALREVENUEEARNEDOF Effect on the accounting equation !SARESULTOFTHEADJUSTMENTFOR!CCRUED)NTEREST2EVENUE Increase/Decrease/No effect
Amount $
Assets
Increase (Accrued Interest Revenue)
Liabilities
No effect
Owner’s Equity
Increase (increase Interest Revenue increases Net Profit)
375
375
Closing the ledger !S A CURRENT ASSET THE !CCRUED )NTEREST 2EVENUE ACCOUNT WILL BE BALANCED BUT THE )NTEREST2EVENUEACCOUNTWILLBECLOSEDTOTHE0ROlTAND,OSS3UMMARYACCOUNT!FTER ITHASBEENCLOSED THE)NTEREST2EVENUEACCOUNTWOULDSHOW Interest Revenue (R) Date June 30
Cross-reference P&L Summary
Amount $
Date
825
June 30
Cross-reference
Amount $
Bank
450
Accrued Interest Rev.
375
825
825
4HEAMOUNTCLOSED ISGREATERTHANTHEAMOUNTOFTHEADJUSTMENT THE TOTALREVENUEINCLUDESBOTHTHERECEIVED ANDTHESTILLOWINGTOUSATTHEEND OFTHEPERIOD&ORANITEMTOBERECOGNISEDASREVENUE THEDElNITIONREQUIRESANITEM TOBEEARNEDTHERECEIPTOFCASHISnotNECESSARY
Receipt of accrued revenues in subsequent periods 3OMETIMEINTHENEXT2EPORTING0ERIOD THEAMOUNTOWINGTOUSASACCRUEDREVENUEWILL BERECEIVED4HEREFORE WHENTHECASHISRECEIVED SOMEMAYREPRESENTAREVENUEOF THEcurrent2EPORTING0ERIOD BUTATLEASTSOMEOFTHERECEIPTWILLRELATETOTHEprevious 2EPORTING 0ERIOD )N OTHER WORDS SOME OF THE AMOUNT RECEIVED REDUCES THE ASSET !CCRUED2EVENUEnREVENUEEARNEDANDACCRUEDLASTPERIOD )NOUREXAMPLE WECREATEDTHECURRENTASSET!CCRUED)NTEREST2EVENUEON*UNE TOREPRESENTTHEWORTHOFINTERESTWEHADEARNED BUTNOTYETRECEIVED4HUS WEHAVEALREADYCOUNTEDITASREVENUE3O WHENTHESECONDINSTALMENTOFINTERESTOF $450ISRECEIVEDON*ULY2EC WECANNOTCOUNTITASALLREVENUE 7EMUSTRECOGNISETHATOFTHE$450RECEIVED WASEARNEDINAprevious2EPORTING 0ERIOD4HISAMOUNTISNOTREVENUEINTHECURRENTPERIOD BUTRATHERAREDUCTIONINTHE CURRENTASSET!CCRUED)NTEREST2EVENUE/NLYTHEREMAINING$450RECEIVEDn ACCRUEDREVENUE REPRESENTSREVENUEEARNEDINTHEcurrent2EPORTING0ERIOD 4HE RECEIPT OF INTEREST ON *ULY WOULD BE RECORDED IN THE #ASH 2ECEIPTS *OURNALASSHOWNIN&IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 16
Figure 16.11
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : R E V E N U E S
379
Cash Receipts Journal: accrued revenue received Cash Receipts Journal
Date
Rec. no.
Details
July 31 Accrued Interest Rev./
Bank
78
Disc. exp.
Debtors Control
Cost of Sales
Sales
Sundries
GST
375
450
Interest Revenue
75
Totals
41 000
900
21 650
12 000
18 000
450
1 800
4HEFULLAMOUNTRECEIVED$450 ISRECORDEDINTHE"ANKCOLUMN ASTHISISTHETOTAL CASHRECEIVED(OWEVER RELATESTOINTERESTTHATWASEARNEDINANDADJUSTEDATTHE ENDOF *UNE4HISPARTOFTHERECEIPTDECREASES!CCRUED)NTEREST2EVENUE4HE REMAININGIS)NTEREST2EVENUEEARNEDINTHECURRENTPERIODnTHENEWlNANCIALYEAR WHICHINCLUDES*ULY /NCE THE #ASH 2ECEIPTS *OURNAL HAS BEEN POSTED TO THE 'ENERAL ,EDGER THE ACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARASSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 16.12
General Ledger: accrued revenue received GENERAL LEDGER Bank (A)
Date July 1 31
Cross-reference
Amount $
Balance
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
3 000
Cash Receipts
41 000 Accrued Interest Revenue (A)
Date
Cross-reference
July 1
Balance
Amount $ Date 375
July 31
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $ 375
Interest Revenue (R) Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date July 31
Cross-reference Bank
Amount $ 75
.OT ALL OF THE $450 RECEIPT WILL BE RECORDED AS REVENUE WAS EARNED IN THE previous 2EPORTING0ERIODANDONLYWASEARNEDINTHEcurrent2EPORTING0ERIOD Effect on the accounting equation !SARESULTOFTHERECEIPTOFINTERESTREVENUEAND!CCRUED)NTEREST2EVENUE Increase/Decrease/No effect Assets
Increase (increase Bank $450, decrease Accrued Interest Revenue $375)
Liabilities
No effect
Owner’s Equity
Increase (Interest Revenue increases Net Profit)
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Amount $ 75
75
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
380
STUDY TIP
)F'34APPLIESTOTHE CASHRECEIVED ITWILL BEIDENTIlEDINTHE INFORMATIONPROVIDED
Date
UNITS 3&4
GST on receipt of accrued revenues )NTHEEVENTTHAT'34APPLIESTOTHERECEIPTOFACCRUEDREVENUE ITISONLYTHENON '34 AMOUNTTHATWOULDBEALLOCATEDBETWEENTHE2EVENUEAND!CCRUED2EVENUEACCOUNTS )NOUREXAMPLE ITWOULDBERECORDEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALASSHOWN Cash Receipts Journal Rec. no.
Details
July 31 Accrued Revenue
Bank
Disc. exp.
Debtors Control
495
Revenue
Cost of Sales
Sales
Sundries
GST
375
45
75
REVIEW QUESTIONS 16.4
1 2 3 4
DefineTHETERM@ACCRUEDREVENUE ExplainHOWACCRUEDREVENUEISREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEET DistinguishBETWEENACCRUEDREVENUEANDDEBTORS Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD THE BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTFORACCRUEDREVENUE 5 State THE EFFECT OF THE BALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENT FOR ACCRUED REVENUE ON THE ACCOUNTINGEQUATION 6 ExplainWHYTHERECEIPTOFACCRUEDREVENUEINASUBSEQUENTPERIODREQUIRES THERECEIPTTOBESPLITINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL 7 StateTHEEFFECTOFTHERECEIPTOFACCRUEDREVENUEINASUBSEQUENTPERIODON THEACCOUNTINGEQUATION
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 16
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : R E V E N U E S
381
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s "ALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTSARENECESSARYSOTHATANACCURATEPROlTISCALCULATEDBY COMPARINGREVENUEEARNEDANDEXPENSESINCURREDINTHECURRENT2EPORTING0ERIOD s "ALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTSMAYBENECESSARYFOR n STOCKLOSSESANDGAINS n PREPAIDEXPENSES n ACCRUEDEXPENSES n DEPRECIATION n PREPAIDREVENUES n ACCRUEDREVENUES s %ACHBALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTFORREVENUEINCREASESREVENUE THUSINCREASINGPROlT ANDOWNERSEQUITY s !DJUSTMENTS FOR PREPAID REVENUES DECREASE LIABILITIES ADJUSTMENTS FOR ACCRUED REVENUESINCREASEASSETS s "ALANCEDAYADJUSTMENTSHAVENOEFFECTONCASH BUTWILLCHANGE.ET0ROlTANDTHE ITEMSINTHE"ALANCE3HEET
EXERCISE 16.1 PREPAID REVENUE
W B
page 346
EXERCISES
/N-ARCH 3OLS3MALL'OODSRECEIVEDRENTPLUS'34 FROMTHE SOLICITORWHORENTSOUTTHETOPmOOROFTHEBUILDING2EC 4HESOLICITORPAYSRENTIN ADVANCEFORTHENEXTSIXMONTHS-EMO AND3OLS3MALL'OODSPREPARESITSlNANCIAL REPORTSON*UNE Required a RecordTHECASHRECEIVEDINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALOF3OLS3MALL'OODS b 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainWHYONLYPARTOFTHERENTRECEIVED SHOULDBERECOGNISEDASREVENUEFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE c CalculateTHERENTREVENUEEARNEDFORTHEYEARENDING*UNE d ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDRENTREVENUEEARNEDFORTHE YEARENDING*UNE e StateTHEEFFECTOFTHEADJUSTMENTFORRENTREVENUEONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF 3OLS3MALL'OODS f ShowHOWTHE2ENT2EVENUEAND0REPAID2ENT2EVENUEACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARIN THE'ENERAL,EDGEROF3OLS3MALL'OODSASAT*UNEAFTERALLCLOSINGAND BALANCINGENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
382
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 16.2 CASH SALE INVOLVING A DEPOSIT
W B
page 348
/N*ANUARY #LINK'LASSWARERECEIVEDADEPOSITOFONABULKORDERFROM ONEOFITSCUSTOMERS2EC 4HEGOODS WHICHHADASELLINGPRICEOFPLUS '34 ANDACOSTPRICEOF WEREDELIVEREDON&EBRUARY WITHTHECUSTOMER PAYINGTHEBALANCEINCASH2EC Required a RecordTHEDEPOSITRECEIVEDON*ANUARYINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALOF #LINK'LASSWARE b ExplainHOWTHEDEPOSITWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEETOF#LINK'LASSWARE ON*ANUARY c RecordTHESALEON&EBRUARYINTHEJOURNALSOF#LINK'LASSWARE d 2EFERRINGTOTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALINPART@C explainWHYTHEAMOUNTRECORDED INTHE'34COLUMNDOESNOTEQUALOFTHEAMOUNTRECORDEDINTHE3ALESCOLUMN e ShowHOWTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARAFTERPOSTINGTHEJOURNALSIN PARTS@AAND@C
EXERCISE 16.3 CREDIT SALE INVOLVING A DEPOSIT
W B
page 350
$URING$ECEMBER 4ERRYS!PPLIANCESRECEIVEDADEPOSITOFFROM(ARTWELL (OSPITALSFORAWASHINGMACHINETHATSELLSFORPLUS'342EC 4HEWASHING MACHINE WHICHHADACOSTPRICEOF WASDELIVEREDON*ANUARY WITHTHE BALANCEONCREDIT)NV Required a StateTHEEFFECTOFTHEDEPOSITONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF4ERRYS!PPLIANCES b 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainWHYTHEDEPOSITISnotRECOGNISEDAS REVENUEFOR$ECEMBER c RecordTHESALEON*ANUARYINTHEJOURNALSOF4ERRYS!PPLIANCES d StateTHEEFFECTOFTHESALEON*ANUARYONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF4ERRYS !PPLIANCES e ShowHOWTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARAFTERPOSTINGTHEJOURNALSIN PART@C
EXERCISE 16.4 CREDIT SALE INVOLVING A DEPOSIT
W B
page 352
)NSENSITELRECENTLYADVERTISEDFORSALEANEWVERSIONOFITSAWARD WINNING'AME3TATION CONSOLE4HECONSOLEISPURCHASEDFORPLUS'34 ANDISSOLDFORINCLUDING'34 /N.OVEMBER 3POT/NDEPARTMENTSTORESORDEREDGAMECONSOLES PAYING ADEPOSITONTHETOTALINVOICEPRICE2EC /N.OVEMBER )NSENSITEL DELIVEREDALLGAMECONSOLESTO3POT/N)NV
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 16
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : R E V E N U E S
Required a CalculateTHECASHRECEIVEDBY)NSENSITELON.OVEMBER b ExplainWHYNO'34ISRECOGNISEDON.OVEMBER c RecordTHECASHRECEIVEDON.OVEMBERINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNALOF )NSENSITEL d 2EFERRINGTOTHEDElNITIONSOFTHEELEMENTSOFTHEREPORTS explainWHYTHETRANSACTION ON.OVEMBERMUSTnotBEREPORTEDASREVENUE e RecordTHESALEON.OVEMBERINTHEJOURNALSOF)NSENSITEL f ShowHOWTHE'ENERAL,EDGERACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEARAFTERPOSTINGTHEJOURNALSIN PART@E g StateTHEEFFECTONTHEACCOUNTINGEQUATIONOF)NSENSITELIFTHESALEON.OVEMBER HADnotBEENRECORDED
EXERCISE 16.5 ACCRUED REVENUE
W B
page 355
$URING !UGUST 'AVIN *EWELLERY RECEIVED INTEREST REVENUE BUT AS AT !UGUSTITWASSTILLOWEDINTERESTFROMONEOFITSINVESTMENTS-EMO Required a 2EFERRING TO ONE ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLE justify WHY THE INTEREST OWING SHOULD BE INCLUDEDINTHE)NTEREST2EVENUEACCOUNTFOR!UGUST b ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDACCRUEDINTERESTREVENUEASAT !UGUST c StateTHEEFFECTOFTHEADJUSTMENTFORACCRUEDINTERESTREVENUEONTHEACCOUNTING EQUATIONOF'AVIN*EWELLERY d ShowHOWTHEINTERESTREVENUEANDACCRUEDINTERESTREVENUEACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEAR INTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF'AVIN*EWELLERYASAT!UGUSTAFTERALLCLOSINGAND BALANCINGENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE e ExplainHOWTHEACCRUEDINTERESTREVENUEWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"ALANCE3HEET OF'AVIN*EWELLERYASAT!UGUST
EXERCISE 16.6 ACCRUED REVENUE
W B
page 357
/N-ARCH $IANAS$ELICACIESINVESTEDINA YEARTERMDEPOSITATA lXED RATE OF PER ANNUM )NTEREST REVENUE IS DIRECTLY CREDITED TO THE lRMS BANK ACCOUNTINEQUALINSTALMENTSONTHELASTDAYOF-AY !UGUST .OVEMBERAND&EBRUARY 4HISISVERIlEDBYTHEBANKSTATEMENT"ALANCEDAYIS*UNE Required a CalculateINTERESTREVENUERECEIVEDON-AY b CalculateACCRUEDINTERESTREVENUEASAT*UNE c ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDACCRUEDINTERESTREVENUEFOR THEYEARENDED*UNE.ARRATIONIS notREQUIRED d ShowHOWTHEINTERESTREVENUEANDACCRUEDINTERESTREVENUEACCOUNTSWOULDAPPEAR INTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF$IANAS$ELICACIESASAT*UNEAFTERALLCLOSINGAND BALANCINGENTRIESHAVEBEENMADE e RecordTHERECEIPTOFINTERESTON!UGUSTINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL f Explain WHY ONLY SOME OF THE INTEREST RECEIVED ON !UGUST SHOULD BE REPORTEDASREVENUEFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
383
384
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 16.7 ACCRUED REVENUE
W B
page 359
$URING!PRIL 7EIGHTS7ORLDRECEIVEDCOMMISSIONREVENUEOFPLUS'34FOR WEIGHTSITHADSOLDONBEHALFOFSPECIALISTGYMS!SAT!PRIL AFURTHER WAS STILL OWING -EMO /N -AY INCLUDING '34 WAS RECEIVED FOR COMMISSIONREVENUE2EC Required a CalculateCOMMISSIONREVENUEEARNEDFOR!PRIL b ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDACCRUEDCOMMISSIONREVENUE ASAT!PRIL c StateTHEEFFECTON.ET0ROlTFOR!PRILIFTHEADJUSTMENTFORACCRUEDCOMMISSION REVENUEWASnotMADE d RecordTHERECEIPTOFTHECOMMISSIONON-AYINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL e StateTHEEFFECTOFTHERECEIPTOFTHECOMMISSIONON-AYONTHEACCOUNTING EQUATIONOF7EIGHTS7ORLD f ShowHOWTHE#OMMISSION2EVENUEAND!CCRUED#OMMISSION2EVENUEACCOUNTS WOULDAPPEARINTHE'ENERAL,EDGEROF7EIGHTS7ORLDAFTERALLTHEINFORMATIONWAS RECORDED
EXERCISE 16.8 ACCRUED REVENUE
W B
page 361
/N3EPTEMBER 3OUND7AVESINVESTEDINTOASIX MONTHTERMDEPOSIT WITHINTERESTEARNEDATPERANNUM PAYABLEATTHEENDOFTHESIX MONTHTERM/N MATURITYAT&EBRUARY ACHEQUEFORWASRECEIVEDFROMTHEBANK2EC Required a ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHEINTERESTREVENUEEARNED FORTHEYEARENDED$ECEMBER.ARRATIONISnotREQUIRED b RecordTHECASHRECEIVEDON&EBRUARYINTHE#ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL c ShowHOWTHECASHRECEIVEDON&EBRUARYWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE#ASH &LOW3TATEMENTOF3OUND7AVESFORTHEYEARENDED$ECEMBER d DiscussHOWTHECASHRECEIVEDFROMTHE4ERM$EPOSITSHOULDBEREPORTEDIN THE#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 16
B A L A N C E D AY A D J U S T M E N T S : R E V E N U E S
EXERCISE 16.9 REPORTING FOR PREPAID AND ACCRUED REVENUES
W B
page 362
2AWSON2UGSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWING4RIAL"ALANCEASAT$ECEMBER RAWSON RUGS Trial Balance as at 31 December 2015 Account Advertising Bank
Debit 2 100
Capital – Parker Cartage In Cost of Sales
51 540 990 20 620
Creditors Control Debtors Control Depreciation – Premises Discount Expense Drawings
31 070 29 600 3 900 690 8 610
GST Clearing Interest Expense
390 400
Accumulated Depreciation – Premises
19 500
Mortgage – Bank of Erica (repayable $12 000 p.a.) Premises Prepaid Advertising
100 000 130 000 1 360
Prepaid Sales Revenue
1 680
Profit on Disposal of Vehicle
650
Sales
43 000
Sales Returns
860
Stock Control
38 750
Stock Gain Stock Write-down Term Deposit (matures 15 April 2020) Wages Totals
Credit
340
130 240 3 600 5 900 $247 960
$247 960
Additional information: s 2EPORTS ARE PREPARED ON $ECEMBER EACH YEAR "ALANCE DAY ADJUSTMENTS FOR EXPENSEITEMSHAVEALREADYBEENRECORDED s $URINGTHElNANCIALYEARACUSTOMERRETURNEDARUGTHATHADBEENSOILEDDURINGTHE DELIVERYTOHERHOUSE4HISRUGWASTHROWNAWAY s 4HE4ERM$EPOSITWASTAKENOUTON$ECEMBER)NTERESTISEARNEDATPER ANNUM WITHINTERESTFOR$ECEMBERDUETOBERECEIVEDON*ANUARY s 0REPAID3ALES2EVENUERELATESTOANORDERFROM&+HARITHERUGSHADASELLINGPRICE OFINCLUDING'34ANDACOSTPRICEOF4HERUGS AND)NVOICE WERE DELIVEREDON$ECEMBERAFTERTHEJOURNALSHADBEENPOSTEDTOTHE'ENERAL ,EDGER Required a 2EFERRINGTOONEACCOUNTINGPRINCIPLE explainTHEPURPOSEOFMAKINGBALANCEDAY ADJUSTMENTS b ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTORECORDTHEADDITIONALINFORMATIONON $ECEMBER.ARRATIONSARE notREQUIRED ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
385
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
386
* *
*
UNITS 3&4
c PrepareA0OST ADJUSTMENT4RIAL"ALANCEFOR2AWSON2UGSASAT$ECEMBER d PrepareAN)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR2AWSON2UGSFORTHEYEARENDED$ECEMBER e 2EFERINGTOYOURANSWERTOPARTDidentifyTWOITEMSTHATRESULTEDFROMTHERUGTHAT WASRETURNEDANDTHROWNAWAY f PrepareACLASSIlED"ALANCE3HEETFOR2AWSON2UGSASAT$ECEMBER
EXERCISE 16.10 REVENUES, RECORDS AND REPORTS
W B
page 366
--S-USICHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGEXTRACTFROMITS4RIAL"ALANCEASAT*UNE MM’s MUSIC Trial Balance (extract) as at 30 June 2015 Account
Debit
Credit
$
$
Accrued Wages
1 900
Bank Cost of Sales
1 800 120 000
Creditors Control Debtors Control Discount Expense
44 900 12 300 860
Discount Revenue
410
GST Clearing
630
Loan – QuickFin (repayable $600 per month) Prepaid Advertising
25 000 10 400
Prepaid Sales Revenue
16 000
Sales Stock Control Stock Write-down
160 000 83 460 1 500
Additional information: s /N*UNE AVEHICLEWASTRADEDINFORONANEWVEHICLEWITHACOST PRICEOFPLUS'34 WHICHWASPURCHASEDONCREDITFROM1-OTORS4HEOLD VEHICLEHADBEENPURCHASEDFOR ANDHADACARRYINGVALUEOFATTHE TIMEOFTHETRADE IN s $URING*UNE ASALEFORPLUS'34WASMADETO!'ERLING)NV 4HE STOCKHADACOSTPRICEOF BUT'ERLINGHADPAIDADEPOSITEARLIERINTHE MONTH s )NTERESTREVENUEOFHADBEENEARNEDBUTNOTYETRECEIVED Required
*
a SuggestTWOPOSSIBLEREASONSOTHERTHANDAMAGE FORTHESTOCKWRITE DOWN b Show THE 'ENERAL *OURNAL ENTRIES NECESSARY TO RECORD THE ADDITIONAL INFORMATION .ARRATIONSAREnotREQUIRED c SuggestTWOREASONSFORTHEPROlTORLOSSONTHEDISPOSALOFTHEVEHICLE d 2EFERRINGTOONEQUALITATIVECHARACTERISTIC explainTHEPURPOSEOFCLOSINGTHELEDGER e ShowTHE'ENERAL*OURNALENTRIESNECESSARYTOCLOSETHEREVENUEACCOUNTS f Prepare A "ALANCE 3HEET FOR --S -USIC AS AT *UNE SHOWING THE lRMS #URRENT!SSETSAND#URRENT,IABILITIES!FULL"ALANCE3HEETISnotREQUIRED g 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@F explainYOURCLASSIlCATIONOF'34#LEARING
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restriced under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s define@BUDGETING s distinguishBETWEEN BUDGETEDANDACTUALREPORTS s explainTHEPURPOSESOF BUDGETING s describeTHEBUDGETING PROCESS s prepareBUDGETEDREPORTS FORCASH PROlTANDlNANCIAL POSITION s explainTHEUSESOFBUDGETED REPORTS s suggestSTRATEGIESTOADDRESS PROBLEMSIDENTIlEDBY BUDGETEDREPORTS s distinguishBETWEENCASH ANDPROlTITEMSINBUDGETED REPORTS
s prepareA3CHEDULEOF 2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS s reconstructLEDGERACCOUNTS TODETERMINEBUDGETED lGURES s prepareVARIANCEREPORTSFOR CASHANDPROlT s distinguishBETWEEN FAVOURABLEANDUNFAVOURABLE VARIANCES
CHAPTER 17
BUDGETS KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s BUDGETING s BUDGET s "UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT s "UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENT s "UDGETED"ALANCE3HEET s 3CHEDULEOF2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS s 3CHEDULEOF0AYMENTSTO#REDITORS s VARIANCEREPORT s #ASH"UDGET6ARIANCE2EPORT s VARIANCE s )NCOME3TATEMENT6ARIANCE2EPORT ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
388
UNITS 3&4
17.1 BUDGETING
budgeting the process of predicting/ estimating the financial consequences of future events budget an accounting report that predicts/estimates the financial consequences of future events
3OFARTHISTEXTHASDEALTONLYWITHHISTORICALTRANSACTIONS CONCENTRATINGONHOWTOIDENTIFY RECORDANDREPORTEVENTSTHATHAVEALREADYOCCURRED4HISISALOGICALSTARTINGPOINTTO ANALYSEBUSINESSPERFORMANCE ASWITHOUTINFORMATIONONWHATHASALREADYHAPPENED WE AREUNABLETOIDENTIFYAREASTHATMAYNEEDTOBEIMPROVED(OWEVER ITISALSOIMPORTANT TOKEEPANEYEONTHEFUTURE"USINESSOWNERSMUSTATTEMPTTOPREDICTWHATWILLHAPPEN INTHEFUTURE SOTHATTHEYCANPLANAHEADANDBEPREPAREDFORWHATISLIKELYTOOCCUR 4HISISTHEFOCUSOFbudgetingTHEPROCESSOFPREPARINGREPORTSTHATestimateORPREDICT THElNANCIALCONSEQUENCESOFLIKELYfutureTRANSACTIONS
Budgeted reports ! SMALL BUSINESS OWNER COULD PREPARE A budget ON JUST ABOUT ANY AREA OF BUSINESS PERFORMANCE RANGING FROM HOW MANY SALES ARE MADE IN A MONTH TO HOW MUCH WILL BE SPENT ON ADVERTISING AND HOW MANY RETURNS WILL BE MADE )N THIS COURSE WE WILL CONCENTRATEONTHREEGENERAL PURPOSEBUDGETS s THEBudgeted Cash Flow Statement WHICHSHOWSALLEXPECTEDFUTURECASHINmOWS AND CASH OUTmOWS THE ACTUAL BANK BALANCE AT THE START OF THE PERIOD AND THE EXPECTEDBANKBALANCEATTHEENDOFTHEPERIOD s THE Budgeted Income Statement WHICH SHOWS ALL EXPECTED FUTURE REVENUES AND EXPENSES ANDTHEEXPECTED'ROSS0ROlT !DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlTAND.ET0ROlT s THEBudgeted Balance Sheet WHICHSHOWSALLEXPECTEDASSETS LIABILITIESANDOWNERS EQUITYATSOMEPOINTINTHEFUTURE
Budgeted versus actual reports
STUDY TIP
)FYOUCANPREPARE REPORTS YOUCAN PREPAREBUDGETED REPORTS BECAUSETHEY CONTAINTHESAME TYPESOFITEMS
"UDGETS OR BUDGETED REPORTS DIFFER FROM THE ACTUAL OR HISTORICAL REPORTS WE HAVE PREPAREDSOFARINTWOKEYWAYS s "UDGETSREPORTfutureEVENTSRATHERTHANHISTORICALEVENTS4HEYFOCUSONWHATWILL HAPPENRATHERTHANWHATHASALREADYHAPPENED s !SACONSEQUENCE BUDGETSUSEestimatesORpredictionsRATHERTHANACTUAL VERIlABLE DATA )NALLOTHERWAYS BUDGETEDREPORTSARETHESAMEASACTUALREPORTSTHEYUSETHESAME HEADINGS ANDINCLUDETHESAMEITEMS
The importance of budgeted Sales !SWEHAVESEENINEARLIERCHAPTERS THEACCOUNTINGREPORTS ARE INTERCONNECTED WITH TRANSACTIONSREPORTEDINONEAFFECTINGITEMSREPORTEDINANOTHER ANDTHISISNODIFFERENT FORBUDGETS4HISMEANSITISESSENTIALTHATTHEPREPARATIONOFBUDGETEDREPORTSBEGIN WITHANACCURATEESTIMATEOFBUDGETEDSALES &IRST SALES IS THE MAIN REVENUE ITEM IN THE "UDGETED )NCOME 3TATEMENT AND GENERATESSIGNIlCANTCASHINmOWSEITHERAS#ASH3ALESOR IFCREDITSALESAREINVOLVED AS 2ECEIPTS FROM $EBTORS 3ECOND THE LEVEL OF SALES WILL BE CRUCIAL IN ESTIMATING THE EXPENSESTHATVARYWITHTHENUMBEROFUNITSSOLDSUCHAS#OSTOF3ALESAND7AGES AND THEIRCORRESPONDINGCASHOUTmOWS4HIRD THELEVELOFSALESWILLAFFECTHOWMUCHSTOCKIS PURCHASED WHICHWILL INTURN AFFECTCASHPAIDTOCREDITORS 4HE"ALANCE3HEETDOESNOTREPORTSALESDIRECTLY BUTBECAUSEITUSESlGURESDERIVED FROMTHEOTHERTWOREPORTS ITSACCURACYISALSODEPENDANTONANACCURATEESTIMATEOF SALES!TTHEVERYLEAST THEEXPECTEDBANKlGUREWILLCOMESTRAIGHTFROMTHE"UDGETED
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
BUDGETS
389
#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT ANDTHEEXPECTED.ET0ROlTOR,OSSWILLBEDETERMINEDINTHE "UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENT
The purpose of budgeting )N COMMON WITH ALL ACCOUNTING REPORTS BUDGETS HAVE A ROLE IN BOTH PLANNING AND DECISION MAKING3PECIlCALLY s "UDGETINGassistsplanningBYPREDICTINGWHATISLIKELYTOOCCURINTHEFUTURE4HIS ALLOWS THE OWNER TO PREPARE SO THAT POSSIBLE PROBLEMS MAY BE MANAGED AND POSSIBLEOPPORTUNITIESMAYBETAKEN s "UDGETING aids decision-making BY PROVIDING A STANDARD AGAINST WHICH ACTUAL PERFORMANCE CAN BE MEASURED 4HIS ALLOWS THE OWNER TO IDENTIFY AREAS IN WHICH PERFORMANCEISUNSATISFACTORY SOTHATREMEDIALACTIONCANBETAKEN4HISCANINCLUDE THECALCULATIONOFBUDGETEDRATIOSANDOTHERINDICATORSOFPERFORMANCE
In common with all accounting reports, budgets have a role in both planning and decision-making
REVIEW QUESTIONS 17.1
1 DefineTHETERM@BUDGETING 2 Identify THEINFORMATIONTHATISREPORTEDINA s "UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT s "UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENT s "UDGETED"ALANCE3HEET 3 StateTWODIFFERENCESBETWEENTHEINFORMATIONPRESENTEDINBUDGETEDREPORTS ANDACTUALREPORTS 4 ExplainWHYITISIMPORTANTTOHAVEANACCURATEESTIMATEOFBUDGETEDSALES 5 ExplainHOWBUDGETSASSISTPLANNING 6 ExplainHOWBUDGETSASSISTDECISION MAKING
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
390
STUDY TIP
)F'34ISIDENTIlED IT CANBERECORDEDINTHE #ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL
UNITS 3&4
17.2 THE BUDGETING PROCESS )THASBEENSAIDTHATFAILINGTOPLANISPLANNINGTOFAIL SOTHEPREPARATIONOFBUDGETED REPORTSSHOULDBEONEOFTHElRSTSTEPSINSTARTINGANEWBUSINESS(OWEVER BUDGETING SHOULDBEAcontinuous processBUDGETSSHOULDBECOMPAREDAGAINSTACTUALREPORTSTO ALLOWPROBLEMSTOBEIDENTIlED DECISIONSSHOULDBEMADEBASEDONTHATASSESSMENT ANDTHENNEWBUDGETSSHOULDBEPREPAREDFORTHEnextPERIOD4HISBUDGETINGPROCESS ISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 17.1
The budgeting process
Budgeted reports are prepared, predicting what is likely to occur
Decisions are made to improve business performance for the next period
Actual reports are prepared to detail what has happened in the current period
Variance reports are prepared to highlight differences/problem areas
!BUDGETHASLIMITEDVALUEIFITISNOTUSEDTOMAKEDECISIONSTOIMPROVEBUSINESS PERFORMANCE IN THE FUTURE )N ADDITION IT MAKES LITTLE SENSE TO DEVELOP A BUDGET FOR ONE PERIOD WITHOUT PREPARING ANOTHER BUDGET FOR THE NEXT PERIOD 5NDER THE 'OING #ONCERNPRINCIPLE BUSINESSESAREASSUMEDTOBECONTINUOUS SOTHEBUDGETINGPROCESS SHOULDBECONTINUOUSTOO 4HEINFORMATIONPRESENTEDINTHEBUDGETEDREPORTSSHOULDBEBASEDONTHEHISTORICAL DATA BUTALLOWANCESMUSTBEMADEFORCHANGESANDTHEEFFECTOFNEWBUSINESSDECISIONS /BVIOUSLY ABRANDNEWBUSINESSWILLNOTHAVEANYHISTORICALDATAONWHICHTORELYTHIS MAKESBUDGETINGHARDERFORNEWBUSINESSES BUTNOLESSIMPORTANT
REVIEW QUESTIONS 17.2
1 ExplainWHYBUDGETINGISDESCRIBEDASAPROCESS 2 OutlineTHEVARIOUSSTAGESINTHEBUDGETINGPROCESS 3 ExplainTHEROLEOFHISTORICALDATAINTHEPREPARATIONOFBUDGETEDREPORTS
17.3 THE BUDGETED CASH FLOW STATEMENT Budgeted Cash Flow Statement an accounting report that attempts to predict all future cash inflows and cash outflows, and thus the estimated bank balance at the end of the budget period
)NORDERTOSURVIVE ASMALLBUSINESSMUSTHAVESUFlCIENTCASHTOMEETITSOBLIGATIONS 4HESEOBLIGATIONSWILLINCLUDEMAKING0AYMENTSTO#REDITORS PAYINGEXPENSESSUCHAS WAGES RENTANDADVERTISING MEETINGLOANREPAYMENTSANDPROVIDINGDRAWINGSFORTHE OWNER)NORDERTODOTHIS THEBUSINESSMUSTGENERATESUFlCIENTCASHINmOWS CHIEmY THROUGHITS#ASH3ALESAND2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS4HE Budgeted Cash Flow Statement ATTEMPTSTOPREDICTALLFUTURECASHINmOWSANDCASHOUTmOWS ANDTHUSTHEESTIMATED BANKBALANCEATTHEENDOFTHEBUDGETEDPERIOD TOASSISTTHEOWNERINASSESSINGTHE lRMSABILITYTOMEETITSOBLIGATIONSOVERTHEBUDGETPERIOD
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
BUDGETS
391
2EMEMBER THAT THE #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT CLASSIlED THE INmOWS AND OUTmOWS AS /PERATING )NVESTING AND &INANCING ACTIVITIES AND THESE CLASSIlCATIONS MUST ALSO BE PRESENTINTHE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT
Operating activities /PERATINGACTIVITIESAREALLCASHmOWSRELATEDTOTHElRMSDAY TO DAYTRADINGACTIVITIES /PERATINGCASHmOWSTHATWEWOULDEXPECTTOSEEINATYPICAL"UDGETED#ASH&LOW 3TATEMENTMIGHTINCLUDE Operating cash inflows #ASH3ALES 2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS /THERREVENUEreceived MAYALSOBETITLED@ACCRUEDANDOR@PREPAID '34RECEIVED '34REFUND
Operating cash outflows #ASHPURCHASESOFSTOCK 0AYMENTSTO#REDITORS /THER%XPENSESpaid MAYALSOBETITLED@ACCRUEDANDOR@PREPAID '34PAID '34SETTLEMENT
)DEALLY THEBUDGETED.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM/PERATIONSWILLBEPOSITIVE4HISMEANS THATTHEBUSINESSWILLGENERATESUFlCIENTCASHFROMITS/PERATIONSTOMEETITSONGOING OBLIGATIONS "Y PREPARING THE "UDGETED #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT THE OWNER WILL BE FOREWARNEDIFTHE/PERATINGCASHmOWSAREEXPECTEDTOBENEGATIVE4HEOWNERCANTHEN TAKESTEPSTOADDRESSTHECASHSHORTAGEBEFOREITOCCURSBYIMPLEMENTINGSTRATEGIESTO s INCREASEEXPECTEDINmOWS SUCHAS n INCREASE3ALESFOREXAMPLE VIAPROMOTIONS GREATERADVERTISINGORDISCOUNTING PRICES n INCREASE2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORSFOREXAMPLE VIAOFFERINGDISCOUNTS CONTACTING SLOWPAYERSORSENDINGREMINDERNOTICES s DECREASEEXPECTEDOUTmOWS SUCHAS n DEFER0AYMENTSTO#REDITORS n CUTBACKONCASHPAIDFOREXPENSES 4HEOWNERMUSTBEPARTICULARLYMINDFULOFREDUCINGCASHPAIDFOREXPENSES ASTHE BENElTSTHATEXPENSESPROVIDEAREVITALINTHEEARNINGOFSALES ANDHENCETHEGENERATION OFCASHINmOWSCUTTINGEXPENSESMAYMAKETHECASHSITUATIONWORSERATHERTHANBETTER
Investing activities )NVESTINGACTIVITIESAREALLCASHmOWSRELATINGTOTHEPURCHASEORSALEOFNON CURRENTASSETS )NVESTINGCASHmOWSTHATWEWOULDEXPECTTOSEEINATYPICAL"UDGETED#ASH&LOW 3TATEMENTMIGHTINCLUDE Investing cash inflows
Investing cash outflows
#ASHSALEOFANON CURRENTASSET
#ASHPURCHASEOFANON CURRENTASSET
#ASHPAIDTOASUNDRYCREDITOR
STUDY TIP
'IVEN THAT NON CURRENT ASSETS ARE FREQUENTLY EXPENSIVE AND SALES OF NON CURRENT ASSETSARERARE ITWILLBECOMMONFORBUDGETED.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM)NVESTING!CTIVITIES TOBENEGATIVE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
4HESETHREE)NVESTING CASHmOWSARETHEONLY ONESINTHISCOURSEBUT THEREMAYBEMORETHAN ONEOFEACHTYPE
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
392
STUDY TIP
4HESEFOUR&INANCING CASHmOWSARETHEONLY ONESINTHISCOURSE
UNITS 3&4
Financing activities &INANCINGACTIVITIESAREALLCASHmOWSTHATARETHERESULTOFCHANGESINTHElRMSlNANCIAL STRUCTURE &INANCINGCASHmOWSTHATWEWOULDEXPECTTOSEEINATYPICAL"UDGETED#ASH&LOW 3TATEMENTMIGHTINCLUDE Financing cash inflows
Financing cash outflows
,OANRECEIPTOF
,OANREPAYMENTPRINCIPALONLY
#APITALCONTRIBUTIONCASHONLY
#ASHDRAWINGS
7HETHER.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM&INANCING!CTIVITIESISPOSITIVEORNEGATIVEWILLDEPEND VERYMUCHONWHETHERTHEBUSINESSISEXPANDING ORSIMPLYCONTINUINGITSOPERATIONSAS THEYARE4HEREMAYINFACTBEARELATIONSHIPBETWEEN&INANCINGAND)NVESTING!CTIVITIES NEGATIVE )NVESTING CASH mOWS DUE TO THE PURCHASE OF NON CURRENT ASSETS COULD BE lNANCEDBYPOSITIVE&INANCINGCASHmOWSINTHEFORMOFALOANORCAPITALCONTRIBUTION
EXAMPLE Denzel Washing Machines will begin trading Operations on 1 March 2016, and has provided the following estimates for its first month of Operations: s 4HEOWNERWILLMAKEACAPITALCONTRIBUTIONOF$30 000 to commence Operations. s #ASH3ALESAREESTIMATEDTOBE$24 000PLUS'34 s #REDIT3ALESAREESTIMATEDTOBEINCLUDING'34/FTHIS amount, $11 000 is expected to be received in March 2016. s !LLSTOCKWILLBEPURCHASEDONCREDIT0URCHASESFOR-ARCHARE EXPECTEDTOBEPLUS'34!TTHEENDOF-ARCH it is anticipated that $6 500 will be owed to creditors. s #OSTOF3ALESISEXPECTEDTOBEAND BASEDONTHE experience of similar firms, Stock Loss is expected to be $300. s 4HEFOLLOWINGEXPENSESWILLBEINCURREDDURING-ARCH – wages $ 8 000 – advertising 1 300 (plus $130 '34 – depreciation of office equipment 100 s 2ENTFORTHENEXTSIXMONTHSWILLBEPAIDON-ARCH$9 000 plus $900'34 s .EWOFFICEEQUIPMENTWORTH$5 000 (plus $500'34 WILLBE purchased on 1 March 2016 using cash. s #ASHDRAWINGSWILLBE$1 000. Drawings of stock is expected to be $600. s /N-ARCH $10 000 will be borrowed from AXC Bank to purchase a new vehicle. Beginning in April 2016, $500 will be paid OFFTHEPRINCIPALEACHMONTH4HEVEHICLEWILLNOTBEPURCHASEDUNTIL April 2016.
4HE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR$ENZEL7ASHING-ACHINESISSHOWNIN&IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
Figure 17.2
BUDGETS
Budgeted Cash Flow Statement
STUDY
DENZEL WASHING MACHINES Budgeted Cash Flow Statement for March 2016 $
$
CASH FLOW FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES Cash inflows Cash Sales
24 000
2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS
11 0001
'342ECEIVED
2 4002
Less Cash Outflows 0AYMENTSTO#REDITORS
32 0003
Wages
8 000
Advertising
1 300
0REPAID2ENT
9 0004
'340AID
1 5305
Net Cash Flows from Operations
51 830 (14 430)
CASH FLOW FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES Cash Inflows .IL Less Cash Outflows Office Equipment
5 000
Net Cash Flows from Investing Activities
(5 000)
CASH FLOW FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES Cash Inflows Capital Contribution
30 000
Loan – AXC Bank
10 000
40 000
Less Cash Outflows Drawings
1 000
Net Cash Flows from Financing Activities
39 000
Net Increase (Decrease) in Cash Position
19 570
Add Bank Balance at start (1 March 2016) Bank Balance at end (31 March 2016)
Nil 19 570
.OTETHEFOLLOWINGIN&IGURE #REDIT3ALESISAREVENUEBUTNOTACASHmOWONLYTHECASHRECEIVEDFROMDEBTORS ISREPORTEDHERE '34RECEIVEDISCALCULATEDASOFTHE#ASH3ALESlGURETHATIS
#ASH3ALESX'34'342ECEIVED
#REDITPURCHASESOFSTOCKPLUS'34 WILLCREATEADEBT TOCREDITORS BUTATTHEENDOF-ARCHONLYWILLREMAINOWING MEANING THEDIFFERENCEWILLBEPAIDTOCREDITORSTHATIS
393
n0AYMENTSTO#REDITORS
2EGARDLESSOFHOWMUCHHASBEENincurred THETOTALCASHpaidFORRENT IS REPORTEDHERE"ECAUSEITISPAIDin advance ITISTITLED@0REPAID2ENT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
394
STUDY TIP
4OTAL'34PAIDISCALCULATEDBYADDINGTHE'34PAIDONADVERTISING PREPAIDRENT ANDOFlCEEQUIPMENTTHATIS
2EADINGSKILLSARE ESSENTIALINBUDGETING QUESTIONSYOUWILLlND MOSTOFTHEANSWERSIN THEQUESTIONITSELFIFYOU LOOKHARDENOUGH
UNITS 3&4
'34PAID
)N ADDITION NOTE THAT NOT ALL THE TRANSACTIONS ARE REPORTED IN THE "UDGETED #ASH &LOW3TATEMENT BECAUSENOTALLINVOLVECASH)NTHISEXAMPLE #REDIT3ALESANDCREDIT PURCHASES AND THE '34 RELATED TO EACH #OST OF 3ALES 3TOCK ,OSS DEPRECIATION OF OFlCE EQUIPMENT AND DRAWINGS OF STOCK HAVE BEEN EXCLUDED AS THEY ARE NON CASH TRANSACTIONS4HEYMAYAFFECTOTHERBUDGETEDREPORTS BUTNOTTHE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW 3TATEMENT
Consecutive budgets 4HEPRECEDINGBUDGETRELATESONLYTOONEMONTHTAKENINISOLATION BUTITWOULDBEWISE FORABUSINESSTOPREPAREBUDGETSFORCONSECUTIVEMONTHSTOSHOWTHEEFFECTOFMONTHLY VARIATIONSTHATIS SEPARATEBUDGETSFOR-ARCH !PRIL -AY ETCCOULDBEPREPAREDAND PRESENTEDSIDEBYSIDETOSHOWTRENDSININmOWSANDOUTmOWSFROMMONTHTOMONTH 3UCHABUDGETMAYAPPEARASISSHOWNIN&IGURE .OTEHOWTHEBALANCEATTHEENDOF-ARCH ISTHENTRANSFERREDTOBECOME THEBALANCEATTHESTARTOF!PRIL!PRILSCLOSINGBALANCE BECOMESTHEOPENING BALANCEFOR-AYANDSOON 4HISTYPEOFBUDGETALLOWSTHEOWNERTOIDENTIFYMONTHLYANDEVENSEASONALTRENDS ANDCANBEVERYUSEFULFORIDENTIFYINGwhenTOUNDERTAKEAPARTICULARCASHACTIVITY SUCH ASTHEPURCHASEOFANON CURRENTASSETORREPAYMENTOFALOAN )NGENERAL MOREFREQUENTBUDGETSWILLBEMOREACCURATE ANDTHEREFOREMOREUSEFUL ASBENCHMARKSFORCOMPARISON)NADDITION THEYWILLALLOWFORTHEEARLIERDETECTIONOF PROBLEMS SO THAT CORRECTIVE ACTION CAN BE TAKEN IN A MORE TIMELY FASHION AND CAN PERHAPSSTOPASMALLPROBLEMFROMBECOMINGLARGE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
Figure 17.3
BUDGETS
Budgeted Cash Flow Statement: consecutive periods DENZEL WASHING MACHINES Budgeted Cash Flow Statement for March–May 2016 March
April
May
Cash Sales
24 000
28 000
2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS
11 000
15 000
13 000
2 400
2 800
CASH FLOW FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES Cash Inflows
'342ECEIVED
–
1 100
45 800
43 800
32 000
36 000
33 000
Wages
8 000
9 000
8 500
Advertising
1 300
1 300
1 300
0REPAID2ENT
9 000
'342EFUND 4OTAL/PERATING)NmOWS
–
Less Cash Outflows 0AYMENTSTO#REDITORS
'340AID 4OTAL/PERATING/UTmOWS Net Cash Flows from Operations
–
–
1 530
130
830
51 830
46 430
43 630
(14 430)
(630)
170
CASH FLOW FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES Cash Inflows 0ROCEEDSON3ALEOF%QUIPMENT
–
–
1 600
Less Cash Outflows Office Equipment
5 000
–
(5 000)
Nil
(5 400)
Capital Contribution
30 000
–
–
Loan – AXC Bank
10 000
–
–
4OTAL&INANCING)NmOWS
40 000
.IL
.IL
1 000
1 000
Net Cash Flows from Investing Activities CASH FLOW FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES Cash Inflows
Less Cash Outflows Drawings
1 000
Net Cash Flows from Financing Activities
39 000
(1 000)
(1 000)
Net Increase (Decrease) in Cash Position
19 570
(1 630)
(6 230)
Add Bank Balance at start Bank Balance at end
Nil
19 570
17 310
19 570
17 310
11 080
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
395
396
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 17.3
1 DefineTHEFOLLOWINGTERMSASTHEYRELATETOTHE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT ANDPROVIDEONEEXAMPLEOFANINmOW ANDONEEXAMPLEOFANOUTmOWTHAT WOULDFALLUNDEREACHOFTHESEHEADINGS s /PERATING!CTIVITIES s )NVESTING!CTIVITIES s &INANCING!CTIVITIES 2 ExplainWHYITISIMPORTANTTHATBUDGETED.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM/PERATIONSIS POSITIVE 3 StateTWOACTIONSTHEOWNERCOULDTAKETO s IMPROVEESTIMATED/PERATINGINmOWS s REDUCEESTIMATED/PERATINGOUTmOWS 4 StateTWOEXPECTEDEXPENSESTHATWILLnotBEREPORTEDINTHE"UDGETED#ASH &LOW3TATEMENT 5 Explain WHY IT IS USUAL FOR .ET #ASH &LOWS FROM )NVESTING !CTIVITIES TO BE NEGATIVE 6 ExplainTHEPOSSIBLERELATIONSHIPBETWEENTHECASHmOWSFROM)NVESTINGAND &INANCINGACTIVITIES 7 ExplainTWOBENElTSOFPREPARINGBUDGETSMOREFREQUENTLYTHANONCEAYEAR
17.4 USES OF THE BUDGETED CASH FLOW STATEMENT Planning 4HE "UDGETED #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT aids planning BY ALLOWING THE OWNER TO PREPARE INADVANCEFORANEXPECTEDCASHSURPLUSORCASHDElCIT3HOULDTHEBUDGETPREDICTAN OVERALL.ET$ECREASEIN#ASH0OSITION THEOWNERMIGHT s DEFER THE PURCHASE OF NON CURRENT ASSETS OR USE CREDIT FACILITIES OR A LOAN FOR A PURCHASE s DEFERLOANREPAYMENTS s TAKELESSCASHASDRAWINGS s MAKEACASHCAPITALCONTRIBUTION s ORGANISEOREXTEND ANOVERDRAFTFACILITY 3HOULDTHEBUDGETPREDICTANOVERALL.ET)NCREASEIN#ASH0OSITION THEOWNERMIGHT USETHEEXTRACASHTO s PURCHASEMORENEWERNON CURRENTASSETS s INCREASELOANREPAYMENTS s INCREASECASHDRAWINGS s EXPAND TRADING ACTIVITIES BY INCREASING ADVERTISING OR EMPLOYING MORE STAFF FOR EXAMPLE !LTERNATIVELY ABUSINESSSTARTINGAPERIODWITHABANKOVERDRAFTMAYCHOOSETODO NOTHING ANDLETTHEEXPECTEDCASHSURPLUSBRINGITSBANKBALANCEBACKINTOTHEBLACK
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
BUDGETS
397
Decision-making )NADDITION THE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTaids decision-makingBECAUSEITSETS A STANDARD BENCHMARK FOR THE ASSESSMENT OF THE lRMS ACTUAL CASH PERFORMANCE "Y COMPARINGBUDGETEDANDACTUALCASHmOWS THEOWNERCANIDENTIFYPROBLEMSAREAS AND THENACTTOCORRECTTHESITUATION 3PECIlCALLY THEOWNERCOULDASSESS s THEEFFECTIVENESSOFADVERTISINGINGENERATING#ASH3ALES s DEBTORCOLLECTIONPROCEDURES s CREDITORPAYMENTPOLICIES s THELEVELOFCASHPAYMENTSFOREXPENSES s THELEVELOFCASHDRAWINGS s THEADEQUACYOFlNANCEFORTHEPURCHASEOFNON CURRENTASSETS
REVIEW QUESTIONS 17.4
1 2 3 4
ExplainHOWTHE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTCANASSISTPLANNING StateTHREEACTIONSTHEOWNERCOULDTAKETOADDRESSABUDGETEDCASHDECREASE StateTHREEACTIONSTHEOWNERCOULDTAKETOUTILISEABUDGETEDCASHINCREASE ExplainHOWTHE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTCANASSISTDECISION MAKING
17.5 CALCULATING CASH FLOWS Schedule of Receipts from Debtors )NTHEEXAMPLEIN WEREPORTED2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORSINTHE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW 3TATEMENTRATHERTHAN#REDIT3ALES ASWEWEREINTERESTEDONLYINREPORTINGCASHmOWS 4HISDISTINCTIONISVERYIMPORTANTTHECREDITSALEANDRECEIPTOFTHECASHMAYEVENTAKE PLACEINDIFFERENTREPORTINGPERIODS)NSOMECASES ITMAYBENECESSARYTOCALCULATEHOW MUCHWILLBERECEIVEDFROMDEBTORSDURINGTHEbudgetPERIODFROM#REDIT3ALESMADE INpreviousPERIODSAND INSOMECASES THEcurrentPERIOD )NTEGRAL TO THIS TYPE OF CALCULATION IS KNOWLEDGE OF THE HISTORICAL BEHAVIOUR OF DEBTORSINMAKINGTHEIRREPAYMENTS4HEBUSINESSOWNERNEEDSTOBEABLETOESTIMATE APPROXIMATELYHOWLONGDEBTORSTAKETOPAY"ASEDONTHEINFORMATIONINTHE$EBTORS ,EDGER OWNERSCANESTIMATEWHATPERCENTAGEOFDEBTORSPAYWITHINAMONTHOFTHESALE WITHINTWOMONTHS ANDSOON THEREBYALLOWINGTHEMTOCALCULATETHEEXPECTED2ECEIPTS FROM$EBTORSFORTHEBUDGETPERIOD4HISCALCULATIONISFACILITATEDBYTHEPREPARATIONOF A 3CHEDULEOF2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS
Facial Attractions sells make-up and other cosmetics, and wants to prepare A"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR/CTOBER .OVEMBERAND$ECEMBER 2016. On 30 September 2016, its owner provided the following Sales data: Actual Sales
Budgeted Sales
July August September October .OVEMBER December
Schedule of Receipts from Debtors a table used to calculate how much cash will be received from debtors in the budget period as a consequence of Credit Sales in the current and previous periods
EXAMPLE
$21 000 20 000 22 000 19 000 25 000
s3ALESFIGURESDONOTINCLUDE'34 sOF3ALESAREMADEONCREDITAREMADEONCASHTERMS ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
398
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
)FWEWEREPREPARINGA"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENT WEWOULDNOTHAVETOMAKE ANYCALCULATIONS ASWEALREADYHAVEINFORMATIONRELATINGTOEXPECTED3ALES2EVENUEFOR EACHMONTH(OWEVER INORDERTOPREPAREA"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT WENEED TOCALCULATEEXPECTED2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS &IRST WEMUSTCALCULATEHOWMUCHOFTHETOTAL3ALESlGUREIS#ASH3ALES ANDHOW MUCHISMADEONCREDIT4HISISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 17.4
Schedule of cash and credit sales Total Sales
Cash Sales 20%
July
21 000
4 200
16 800
August
20 000
4 000
16 000
September
22 000
4 400
October
19 000
3 800
15 200
.OVEMBER
23 000
4 600
18 400
December
25 000
5 000
20 000
Month
Credit Sales 80%
4HE#ASH3ALESlGURESFOR/CTOBERTO$ECEMBERCANGOSTRAIGHTINTOTHE"UDGETED #ASH&LOW3TATEMENTAS/PERATINGINmOWS ASTHEYREPRESENTCASHmOWSINTHEMONTHS WHENTHESALEISMADE#ASH3ALESFOR*ULYTO3EPTEMBERAREOUTSIDETHEBUDGETPERIOD ANDSOAREEXCLUDED !STHESEARE3ALES '34WILLALSOBERECEIVEDATTHERATEOFOFTHE#ASH3ALES lGURE4HECASHRECEIPTSARISINGFROM#ASH3ALESFOR/CTOBERTO$ECEMBERWOULD THUSBE October
November
December
CASH FLOW FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES Cash Inflows Cash Sales '342ECEIVED
3 800
4 600
5 000
380
460
500
(OWEVER WE NEED TO CALCULATE HOW MUCH CASH WILL BE RECEIVED IN /CTOBER TO $ECEMBER AS A RESULT OF CREDIT SALES IN EARLIER MONTHS )N ORDER TO DO THIS WE MUST lRSTADDTOOURCREDITSALESTHE'34WEWILLCHARGEDEBTORS ASBOTHAMOUNTSMUSTBE COLLECTEDFROMDEBTORS Figure 17.5 Month
Credit Sales and GST Credit Sales (excluding GST)
GST charged (10%)
Credit Sales (including GST)
July
16 800
1 680
18 480
August
16 000
1 600
17 600
September
19 360
October
15 200
1 520
16 720
.OVEMBER
18 400
1 840
20 240
December
20 000
2 000
22 000
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
BUDGETS
399
'IVENTHETOTALAMOUNTOWEDTOUSBYDEBTORSCredit Sales including GST WECAN NOWMOVETOCALCULATING2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORSFROMTHOSECREDITSALES4HISREQUIRES MOREINFORMATIONABOUTTHEREPAYMENTPATTERNSOFTHElRMSDEBTORS
EXAMPLE
Additional information "ASEDONANANALYSISOFTHEFIRMSDEBTORS THEOWNEREXPECTSOF DEBTORSTOPAYINTHEMONTHAFTERTHESALE4HESEDEBTORSRECEIVEA DISCOUNT/FTHEREMAINDER OFDEBTORSPAYTWOMONTHSAFTERTHE SALE ANDPAYINTHETHIRDMONTHAFTERSALE
"ASEDONTHISINFORMATION WECANPREPAREA3CHEDULEOF2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORSLIKE THEONESHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 17.6
STUDY TIP
Schedule of Receipts from Debtors
Month
Credit Sales (including GST)
October
November
December
July
18 480
August
17 600
10 560
2 640
September
19 360
4 598
11 616
2 904
October
16 720
10 032
.OVEMBER
20 240
December
22 000
Budgeted Receipts from Debtors
17 930
18 227
17 743
4HEMONTHSACROSSTHETOPOFTHETABLE/CTOBER .OVEMBER $ECEMBER ARETHOSEFOR WHICHWEAREPREPARINGTHEBUDGET4HEMONTHSDOWNTHELEFTSIDE*ULYTO$ECEMBER ARETHOSEFORWHICHWEHAVE3ALESDATA )FWEEXAMINETHEAMOUNTOWINGFORCREDITSALESMADEIN3EPTEMBER WECANSEE HOWTHECALCULATIONSWEREMADE"ASEDONTHEANALYSISOFWHENDEBTORSPAY OF THE3EPTEMBERCREDITSALESlGURE$19 360INCLUDING'34 LESSTHEDISCOUNTWILLBE COLLECTEDINTHEMONTHAFTERTHESALETHATIS IN/CTOBER !MOUNTOWINGFORCREDITSALESINCLUDING'34 XRECEIVEDONEMONTHAFTERSALE LESSDISCOUNTX
$19 360 242
#ASHRECEIVEDFROMDEBTORSIN/CTOBER
$ 4 598
4HE3CHEDULEOF 2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS ISNOTABUDGETED REPORTITISSIMPLYA TECHNIQUEUSEDTO CALCULATE2ECEIPTSFROM $EBTORS WHICHCAN THENBESHOWNINTHE "UDGETED#ASH&LOW 3TATEMENT
STUDY TIP
7ITHTHEDISCOUNT DONT JUSTMULTIPLYBY THATIS LESS THISWOULDGIVETHE DISCOUNTTOALLDEBTORS RATHERTHANJUSTTHOSE WHOPAYWITHINONE MONTH
!FURTHEROF $19 360 WILLBECOLLECTEDTWOMONTHSLATERIN.OVEMBER ANDTHElNALOF$19 360 WILLBECOLLECTEDTHREEMONTHSAFTERTHE SALEIN$ECEMBER 4HESAMEPROCESSAPPLIESTOTHEOTHERMONTHSTOSHOWTHATALTHOUGHACREDITSALEIS MADEINONEMONTH THECASHMAYBERECEIVEDOVERANUMBEROFMONTHS )FWEADDUPALLTHElGURESINTHECOLUMNSFOR/CTOBER .OVEMBERAND$ECEMBER WE CAN CALCULATE ESTIMATED 2ECEIPTS FROM $EBTORS FOR EACH MONTH 4HIS INFORMATION CANNOWBEREPORTEDINTHE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT ALONGWITHTHE#ASH3ALES lGURESWEHADALREADYCALCULATED ASISSHOWNOVERTHEPAGE ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
400
UNITS 3&4
FACIAL ATTRACTIONS Budgeted Cash Flow Statement (extract) for October–December 2016 CASH FLOW FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES Cash Inflows Cash Sales '342ECEIVED 2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS
October
November
December
3 800 380
4 600 460
5 000 500
2EMEMBERTHATALTHOUGHTHECASHRECEIVEDFROMDEBTORSINCLUDESSOME'34 ITISNOT NECESSARYTOIDENTIFYTHISAMOUNTSEPARATELYASTHE'34ISONLYIDENTIlEDATTHEPOINTOF SALEONLY'34RECEIVEDON#ASH3ALES MUSTBEREPORTEDSEPARATELY
Schedule of Payments to Creditors Schedule of Payments to Creditors a table used to calculate how much cash will be paid to creditors in the budget period as a consequence of credit purchases in the current and previous periods
4HIS TECHNIQUE CAN ALSO BE APPLIED TO CALCULATE 0AYMENTS TO #REDITORS WITH CREDIT PURCHASESSUBSTITUTINGFORCREDITSALES)NORDERTODRAWUPA3CHEDULEOF0AYMENTSTO Creditors WEREQUIREINFORMATIONONHOWFREQUENTLYCREDITORSAREPAIDSOTHATWECAN CALCULATEwhen ANDhow much CREDITORSWILLBEPAIDDURINGTHEBUDGETPERIOD
REVIEW QUESTIONS 17.5
1 2EFERRING TO ONE ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLE explain WHY IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO PREPARE A 3CHEDULE OF 2ECEIPTS FROM $EBTORS WHEN PREPARING A "UDGETED #ASH&LOW3TATEMENT 2 ExplainTHEROLEOFHISTORICALDATAINTHEPREPARATIONOFA3CHEDULEOF2ECEIPTS FROM$EBTORS 3 Explain WHY 2ECEIPTS FROM $EBTORS MUST BE CALCULATED USING CREDIT SALES INCLUDING'34 4 Explain WHYTHE'34MUSTBEIDENTIlEDWHEN#ASH3ALESARESHOWNINTHE "UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT 5 StateONEREASONWHYTHE'34ISnotIDENTIlEDWHENCASHISRECEIVEDFROMA DEBTOR
17.6 THE BUDGETED INCOME STATEMENT
Budgeted Income Statement an accounting report that shows expected future revenues and expenses
'IVENTHATTHEMAINOBJECTIVEOFATRADINGBUSINESSISTOEARNAPROlT THEOWNERSHOULD PLANAHEADFORHOWTOACHIEVETHISGOAL)NADDITION THElRMMUSTHAVESOMETYPEOF BENCHMARKAGAINSTWHICHITCANASSESSITSTRADINGPROlT PERFORMANCE"OTHOFTHESE AIMSAREMETBYTHEPREPARATIONOFA"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENT WHICHATTEMPTSTO PREDICTREVENUESANDEXPENSESFORTHEBUDGETPERIOD
Cash versus profit !TTHISPOINTITISPROBABLYWORTHREMEMBERINGTHATCASHANDPROlTAREDIFFERENTMEASURES OFPERFORMANCE ANDTHEREFORETHEITEMSREPORTEDINTHE"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENT WILLNOTNECESSARILYBETHESAMEASTHOSEREPORTEDINTHE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT 7HEREASTHE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTREPORTSEXPECTEDcash inflowsANDcash outflowsOVERTHEBUDGETPERIOD THE"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENTREPORTSexpected revenues earnedANDexpected expensesincurredOVERTHEBUDGETPERIOD
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
BUDGETS
401
!S SOME CASH ITEMS ARE NOT REVENUES OR EXPENSES THEY WILL BE OMITTED FROM THE "UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENT Cash inflows that are not revenues
Cash outflows that are not expenses
'34RECEIVED
'34PAID
'34REFUND
'34SETTLEMENT
#ASHSALEOF.#!
#ASHPAYMENTFOR.#!TOSUNDRYCREDITOR
Cash capital contribution
Cash drawings
2ECEIPTOFLOAN
2EPAYMENTOFLOANPRINCIPAL
3TRICTLYSPEAKING CASHSALEFROMAN.#!REPRESENTSREVENUE(OWEVER ITISONLYTHEOVERALL PROlTORLOSS ONTHEDISPOSALTHATISREPORTEDINTHE"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENT
(OWEVER THE"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENTWILLINCLUDESOMEREVENUESANDEXPENSES THATARENOTREPORTEDASCASHmOWS Revenues that are not cash inflows
Expenses that are not cash outflows
Stock gain
Stock Loss Stock write-down
0ROlTONDISPOSALOF.#!
,OSSONDISPOSALOF.#! Bad debts Depreciation
&INALLY SOMEOFTHEITEMSWILLAFFECTBOTHBUDGETS BUTTHEAMOUNTSMAYDIFFER Revenue/expense
Cash inflow/cash outflow
Credit Sales
2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS
Cost of Sales
0AYMENTSFORSTOCK
Other revenue earned
Other revenue received (may also be TITLEDACCRUEDANDORPREPAID
Other Expense incurred
Other Expense paid (may also be titled ACCRUEDANDORPREPAID
,ETS USE THE INFORMATION THAT WAS USED TO GENERATE THE "UDGETED #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENTIN&IGURETOILLUSTRATEHOWTHE"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENTWILLAPPEAR BUTTHISTIMEWITHTHEREVENUESANDEXPENSESHIGHLIGHTED
Denzel Washing Machines will begin trading Operations on 1 March 2016, and has provided the following estimates for its first month of Operations: s 4HEOWNERWILLMAKEACAPITALCONTRIBUTIONOFTOCOMMENCE Operations. s #ASH3ALESAREESTIMATEDTOBE$24 000PLUS'34 s #REDIT3ALESAREESTIMATEDTOBE$17 600 including GST. Of this amount, $11 000 is expected to be received in March 2016. s !LLSTOCKWILLBEPURCHASEDONCREDIT0URCHASESFOR-ARCHARE EXPECTEDTOBEPLUS'34!TTHEENDOF-ARCHIT is anticipated that $6 500 will be owed to creditors.
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
EXAMPLE
Cambridge University Press
402
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
s #OSTOF3ALESISEXPECTEDTOBE$20 000 and, based on the experience of similar firms, Stock Loss is expected to be $300. s 4HEFOLLOWINGEXPENSESWILLBEINCURREDDURING-ARCH – wages $ 8 000 – advertising 1 300 PLUS'34 100 – depreciation of office equipment s 2ENTFORTHENEXTsix months will be paid on 1 March 2016: $9 000 plus '34 s .EWOFFICEEQUIPMENTWORTHPLUS'34WILLBEPURCHASEDON 1 March 2016 using cash. s #ASHDRAWINGSWILLBE$RAWINGSOFSTOCKISEXPECTEDTOBE s /N-ARCH WILLBEBORROWEDFROM!8#"ANKTO purchase a new vehicle. Beginning in April 2016, $500 will be paid off THEPRINCIPALEACHMONTH4HEVEHICLEITSELFWILLNOTBEPURCHASEDUNTIL April 2016.
4HE"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR-ARCHISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 17.7
Budgeted Income Statement DENZEL WASHING MACHINES Budgeted Income Statement for March 2016
Revenue
$
Cash Sales
24 000
Credit Sales
16 0001
$
40 000
Less Cost of Goods Sold Cost of Sales
20 000
Gross Profit
20 000
Less Stock Loss
300
Adjusted Gross Profit
19 700
Less Other Expenses Wages
8 000
Advertising
1 300
Depreciation of Office Equipment
100 1 5002
2ENT Net Profit
10 900 8 800
.OTETHEFOLLOWINGIN&IGURE #REDIT3ALESOF$17 600includes GST4HUS THEAMOUNTOF#REDIT3ALESREVENUEIS ONLYTHATIS
$17 600
X
#REDIT3ALES
0REPAID RENT IS NOT SHOWN IN THIS REPORT AS IT IS THE PURCHASE OF A CURRENT ASSET )NTERMSOFEXPENSES ONLYONEMONTHHASBEENINCURREDTHATIS
X
MONTHS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
2ENT%XPENSE Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
BUDGETS
403
Uses of the Budgeted Income Statement 4HE "UDGETED )NCOME 3TATEMENT aids planning BECAUSE IT INDICATES THE FUTURE REQUIREMENTSOFTHElRMRELATINGTOISSUESSUCHASSTAFlNG WHICHMAYREQUIREHIRINGOR lRINGSTOCKLEVELSORADVERTISINGCAMPAIGNS !S A decision-making TOOL THE "UDGETED )NCOME 3TATEMENT PROVIDES A STANDARD AGAINSTWHICHTRADINGPERFORMANCECANBEMEASURED ALLOWINGPROBLEMSTOBEIDENTIlED ANDCORRECTIVEACTIONTAKEN4HISBENCHMARKCANALSOACTASAtargetORgoalTOMOTIVATE STAFFANDMANAGEMENT 3PECIlCALLY THEOWNERCOULDASSESS s THELEVELOFSALESANDTHEEFFECTIVENESSOFADVERTISING s THEMARK UPACHIEVED s THELEVELOFSTOCKLOSSTOASSESSSTOCKMANAGEMENTPROCEDURES s EXPENSECONTROL s STAFFPERFORMANCE
REVIEW QUESTIONS 17.6
1 Explain THE DIFFERENCE BETWEEN A "UDGETED #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT AND A "UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENT 2 StateTWOEXAMPLESOF s CASHINmOWSTHATARENOTREVENUES s CASHOUTmOWSTHATARENOTEXPENSES 3 StateTWOEXAMPLESOF s REVENUESTHATARENOTCASHINmOWS s EXPENSESTHATARENOTCASHOUTmOWS 4 ExplainHOWA"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENTCANBEUSEDTOASSISTPLANNING 5 Explain HOW A "UDGETED )NCOME 3TATEMENT CAN BE USED TO ASSIST DECISION MAKING 6 StateTHREEAREASOFBUSINESSPERFORMANCETHEOWNERMIGHTASSESSBYUSING THE"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENTASABENCHMARK
17.7 THE BUDGETED BALANCE SHEET 4HEBudgeted Balance SheetATTEMPTSTOPREDICTTHElRMSASSETS LIABILITIESANDOWNERS EQUITYATSOMEPOINTINTHEFUTURE2EMEMBERTHEEXAMPLEFROMEARLIERINTHISCHAPTER
Denzel Washing Machines will begin trading Operations on 1 March 2016, and has provided the following estimates for its first month of Operations: s 4HEOWNERWILLMAKEACAPITALCONTRIBUTIONOFTOCOMMENCE Operations. s #ASH3ALESAREESTIMATEDTOBEPLUS'34. s #REDIT3ALESAREESTIMATEDTOBEINCLUDING'34. Of this amount, $11 000 is expected to be received in March 2016. s !LLSTOCKWILLBEPURCHASEDONCREDIT0URCHASESFOR-ARCHARE expected to be $35 000 PLUS'34. At the end of March 2016 it is anticipated that $6 500 will be owed to creditors. s #OSTOF3ALESISEXPECTEDTOBE$20 000 and, based on the experience of similar firms, Stock Loss is expected to be $300.
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Budgeted Balance Sheet an accounting report that predicts assets, liabilities and owner’s equity at some point in the future
EXAMPLE
Cambridge University Press
404
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
s 4HEFOLLOWINGEXPENSESWILLBEINCURREDDURING-ARCH – wages $8 000 – advertising 1 300 (PLUS'34 100 – depreciation of office equipment s 2ENTFORTHENEXTSIXMONTHSWILLBEPAIDON-ARCHplus '34 s .EWOFFICEEQUIPMENTWORTHPLUS'34 WILLBEPURCHASED on 1 March 2016 using cash. s #ASHDRAWINGSWILLBE$RAWINGSOFSTOCKISEXPECTEDTOBE$600. s /N-ARCH WILLBEBORROWEDFROM!8#"ANKTO purchase a new vehicle. Beginning in April 2016, $500 will be paid off THEPRINCIPALEACHMONTH4HEVEHICLEITSELFWILLNOTBEPURCHASEDUNTIL April 2016.
4HEBUDGETED"ALANCE3HEETASAT-ARCHISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 17.8
Budgeted Balance Sheet DENZEL WASHING MACHINES Budgeted Balance Sheet as at 31 March 2016
Current Assets Bank1 Stock Control
2
$
$
Current Liabilities
$
Creditors Control
6 500
14 100
Loan – AXC Bank
6 000
Debtors Control3
6 600
0REPAID2ENT4
'34#LEARING5
1 030
6
$
12 500
Non-Current Liabilities 48 800
Non-Current Assets
Loan – AXC Bank 6
4 000
Owner’s Equity
Office Equipment
5 000
Less Accumulated Depreciation
100
Capital – Denzel 4 900
.ET0ROlT
30 000 8 800 38 800
Less Drawings8 Total Assets
53 700
1 600
Total Equities
53 700
.OTETHEFOLLOWINGIN&IGURE
"ANK
#ASHBALANCEATENDSEE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT n&IGUREnBank Balance at end
3TOCK#ONTROL
3EETHEFOLLOWINGPAGE
$EBTORS#ONTROL
#REDIT3ALESINCLUDING LESS2ECEIPTSFROM $EBTORS
0REPAIDRENT
0REPAIDRENT LESSRENTEXPENSE
'34#LEARING
3EETHEFOLLOWINGPAGE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
BUDGETS
,OANn!8#"ANK
2EPAYABLEPERMONTHX#, REMAINDER.#,
3EE"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENTn&IGURE
.ET0ROlT
$RAWINGS
#ASHDRAWINGS PLUSDRAWINGSOFSTOCK
)T IS WORTH CONSIDERING IN DETAIL HOW TWO OF THESE ITEMS IN THE BUDGETED "ALANCE 3HEET n 3TOCK #ONTROL AND '34 #LEARING n WERE CALCULATED 'IVEN OUR KNOWLEDGE OF DOUBLE ENTRYACCOUNTING WEWILLEXPRESSTHECALCULATIONINTHEFORMOFALEDGERACCOUNT Figure 17.9
Reconstructed ledger accounts Stock Control (A)
Date March 1 31
Cross-reference Balance Creditors Control
Amount .IL
Date March 31
35 000
Cross-reference Cost of Sales
600
Stock Loss
300
35 000 Balance
20 000
Drawings
Balance
April 1
Amount
14 100 35 000
14 100 GST Clearing (A/L)
Date
Cross-reference
March 31 Bank Creditors Control
Amount
DCate
Cross-reference
1 530
March 1
Balance
3 500
31
.IL
Bank
2 400
Debtors Control
1 600
Balance
1 030
5 030 April 1 Balance
Amount
5 030
1 030
4HE DEBIT BALANCE IN THIS ACCOUNT MEANS '34 #LEARING IS AN ASSET A RESOURCE CONTROLLED BY THE BUSINESS FROM WHICH FUTURE ECONOMIC BENElTS WILL mOW THE REFUND OWED TO THE BUSINESS BY THE !4/ 4HIS HAS OCCURRED BECAUSE THE BUSINESS HAS JUST STARTED SOITHASPURCHASEDMORESTOCKTHANITHASSOLD ANDPURCHASEDANUMBEROF ASSETS SUCH AS OFlCE EQUIPMENT AND PREPAID RENT 4HUS THE '34 ON ITS PURCHASES ISgreaterTHANTHE'34ONITSSALES
Uses of the Budgeted Balance Sheet 4HE "UDGETED "ALANCE 3HEET CAN BE USED AS A planning DOCUMENT "Y DETAILING THE EXPECTEDCARRYINGVALUEOFNON CURRENTASSETSATSOMETIMEINTHEFUTURE ITHELPSTHE OWNER PREPARE FOR THEIR REPLACEMENT 7HEN USED IN CONJUNCTION WITH THE "UDGETED #ASH&LOW3TATEMENT ITCANALSOBEUSEDTOPLANFORTHEREPAYMENTOFLOANS ANDTOSET THELEVELFORDRAWINGSFORTHECOMINGPERIOD )NADDITION ITCAN assist decision-making BYSETTINGABENCHMARKFORINDICATORSTHAT ASSESSLIQUIDITYANDSTABILITY3PECIlCALLY ITWILLALLOWTHEOWNERTOCALCULATETHE"UDGETED 7ORKING#APITAL2ATIO WHICHCANBEUSEDTOASSESSLIQUIDITYANDTHE$EBT2ATIO WHICH CANBEUSEDTOASSESSSTABILITY4HESERATIOSARECOVEREDINDETAILIN#HAPTER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
405
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
406
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 17.7
1 StateTHREEITEMSREPORTEDINTHE"UDGETED"ALANCE3HEETTHATAREAFFECTED BYTHETRANSACTIONSREPORTEDINTHE s "UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT s "UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENT 2 ExplainHOWTHE"UDGETED"ALANCE3HEETCANBEUSEDTOASSISTPLANNING 3 Explain HOW THE "UDGETED "ALANCE 3HEET CAN BE USED TO ASSIST DECISION MAKING STUDY TIP
4OSELECTWHICH ACCOUNTTORECONSTRUCT THINKOFTHETRANSACTION THATISMISSINGIT WILLAPPEARINTWO LEDGERACCOUNTS4HEN CHOOSETHEACCOUNT FORWHICHYOUHAVETHE BESTINFORMATION
EXAMPLE
17.8 ACCOUNT RECONSTRUCTION 4HEPRECEDINGEXAMPLEILLUSTRATEDHOWLEDGERACCOUNTSCANBEUSEDTOCALCULATECLOSING BALANCESFORTHE"UDGETED"ALANCE3HEET4HISISNOTTHEONLYUSEOFLEDGERACCOUNTSIN THEBUDGETINGPROCESS)FWEALREADYKNOWTHECLOSINGBALANCE WECANWORKBACKWARDS TOCALCULATEOTHERlGURESTHATMAYBENECESSARYTOCOMPLETETHE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW 3TATEMENT ORTHE"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENT 7HEREONLYSOMEINFORMATIONISKNOWN WECANUSEOURKNOWLEDGEOFLEDGERACCOUNTS ANDDOUBLE ENTRYACCOUNTINGTOCALCULATEMISSINGORUNKNOWNlGURESBYRECONSTRUCTING THERELEVANTLEDGERACCOUNT2ECONSTRUCTINGALEDGERACCOUNTINVOLVESTHREESTEPS IdentifyTHEENTRIESWEWOULDEXPECTTOSEEINAPARTICULARLEDGERACCOUNT MatchTHESEENTRIESWITHlGURESTHATAREKNOWN CompleteTHELEDGERACCOUNTTOCALCULATETHElGURESTHATARENOTKNOWN
On 1 July 2015, Kings Sportswear had debtors of $12 000. During THEMONTHOF*ULY #REDIT3ALESWEREINCLUDING'34 AND 3ALES2ETURNSWEREPLUS'34$ISCOUNT%XPENSEAMOUNTEDTO $400. On 16 July 2016, a Bad Debt for $900 was written off. At 31 July 2016, debtors owed $15 000.
4HEDATAABOVEISSUFlCIENTTOPREPARETHE"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENTAS#REDIT 3ALESISKNOWN ANDTHE"UDGETED"ALANCE3HEETCANBEPREPAREDAS$EBTORS ATTHEENDISKNOWN (OWEVER THE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTcannotBE PREPARED AS2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORSISunknown7EDONOTHAVESUFlCIENTINFORMATION TOPREPAREA3CHEDULEOF2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS BUTWECANRECONSTRUCTTHE$EBTORS #ONTROLACCOUNT
Step 1: identify the entries we would expect to see )NCLUDINGEVERYTRANSACTIONTHISCOURSEHASCOVEREDSOFAR ACOMPLETE$EBTORS#ONTROL ACCOUNT EXCLUDINGAMOUNTS WOULDSHOW
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
Figure 17.10
BUDGETS
407
Debtors Control template Debtors Control (A)
Date
Cross-reference
July 1 31
Balance 3ALES'34#LEARING
Aug. 1
Amount
Date
Cross-reference
July 31
Bank/ Discount Expense 3ALES2ETURNS'34#LEARING Bad Debts Balance
Amount
STUDY TIP
Balance
+EEP IN MIND THAT ALTHOUGH WE ARE CALCULATING 2ECEIPTS FROM $EBTORS IT WILL BE IDENTIlEDINTHE$EBTORS#ONTROLACCOUNTBYTHECROSS REFERENCE@"ANK!LSONOTETHAT THELINE@"ANK$ISCOUNT%XPENSEHASBEENSPLITACROSSTWOLINES4HISISUSUALLYWRITTEN ONONELINE BECAUSEITISPOSTEDFROMTHETOTALOFTHE$EBTORS#ONTROLCOLUMNINTHE #ASH2ECEIPTS*OURNAL(OWEVER THISONEAMOUNTREPRESENTSTHETOTALBYWHICHDEBTORS WILL DECREASE THAT IS CASH RECEIVED PLUS ANY DISCOUNT EXPENSE &OR THE PURPOSE OF THE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT WEAREONLYINTERESTEDINTHECASHRECEIVEDFROM DEBTORS"ANK NOTTHEDISCOUNTEXPENSE SOTHETWOAMOUNTSHAVEBEENIDENTIlEDON SEPARATELINESINTHELEDGERACCOUNT
$EVISEACODETO REMEMBERTHENUMBER OFENTRIESINEACH ACCOUNT$EBTORS #ONTROLHASTWOONTHE DEBITSIDE ANDFOUR ONTHECREDITSIDE&OR EXAMPLE YOUCOULDCALL IT@THEBYACCOUNT
Step 2: match these entries with figures that are known !FTERENTERINGTHEINFORMATIONTHATISKNOWN THE$EBTORS#ONTROLACCOUNTWOULDSHOW Debtors Control (A) Date
Cross-reference
July 1 31
Amount
Date
Balance
12 000
July 31
3ALES'34#LEARING
88 000
Cross-reference
Amount
Bank/ Discount Expense
400 1 320
3ALES2ETURNS'34#LEARING Bad Debts Balance Aug. 1
Balance
900 15 000
15 000
4HE3ALESRETURNSlGUREWASPROVIDEDASplus'34 MEANINGTHETOTALlGURE TOBERECORDEDHEREISPLUS'34
Step 3: complete the ledger account to calculate the missing figure "YCOMPLETINGTHEACCOUNT WECANDETERMINETHEMISSINGlGURE WHICHINTHISCASEIS 2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS Debtors Control (A) Date
Cross-reference
Amount
Date
July 1
Balance
12 000
July 31
3ALES'34#LEARING
88 000
31
Cross-reference Bank/ Discount Expense 3ALES2ETURNS'34#LEARING Bad Debts Balance
100 000 Aug. 1
Balance
Amount 82 380 400 1 320 900 15 000 100 000
15 000
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
408
STUDY TIP
4HISACCOUNTISALMOST THEOPPOSITEOFDEBTORS CONTROL BUTITHASNO BADDEBTSENTRY
UNITS 3&4
4HETOTALONTHEDEBITSIDEEQUALS SOTHISMUSTALSOBETHETOTALONTHE CREDITSIDE)NORDERTOMAKETHECREDITENTRIESTOTAL 2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS MUSTBE WHICHCANNOWBEREPORTEDINTHE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT 4HESAMEAPPROACHCOULDBEUSEDTORECONSTRUCTOTHERLEDGERACCOUNTS Figure 17.11
Creditors Control template Creditors Control (L)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount
Bank/
Date
Cross-reference
Start
Balance
Amount
$ISCOUNT2EVENUE 3TOCK#ONTROL'34 Clearing End
3TOCK#ONTROL'34 Clearing
Balance Balance
)NTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLACCOUNT THE3TOCK#ONTROL'34#LEARINGENTRYONTHECREDIT SIDEISCREDITPURCHASESTHESAMEENTRYONTHEDEBITSIDEISPURCHASERETURNS Figure 17.12
Stock Control template Stock Control (A)
Date
Cross-reference
Start
Balance Creditors Control
Amount $
Date
Cross reference Cost of Sales
Amount $
4
Cost of Sales5
1
Bank2
Cost of Sales6
Cost of Sales3
Creditors Control Advertising Drawings Stock Write-down
3TOCK'AIN
End
3TOCK,OSS
Balance
Balance
'IVENTHENUMBEROFENTRIESINTHE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNT ITISWORTHCLARIFYINGAFEW Debit side 1 2 3
Credit purchases Cash purchases 3ALESRETURNSCOSTPRICE
Credit side 4 5 6
#ASH3ALESCOSTPRICE #REDIT3ALESCOSTPRICE 0REPAID3ALESCOSTPRICE 0URCHASERETURNS
3TOCKLOSSor stock gain will be recorded, but not both
.OTE THAT ALTHOUGH #OST OF 3ALES MAY INVOLVE THREE ENTRIES IN THE 3TOCK #ONTROL ACCOUNT ITWOULDONLYBEreportedASASINGLElGUREINTHE"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENT AND HENCE MAY IN SOME CASES BE PROVIDED AS ONLY ONE lGURE .OTE ALSO THE LINKS BETWEENTHE#REDITORS#ONTROLAND3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNTSRELATINGTOCREDITPURCHASES ANDPURCHASERETURNS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
Figure 17.13
BUDGETS
GST Clearing template GST Clearing (A/L)
Date
Cross-reference Bank
Amount
1
Date
Cross-reference
Start
Balance
Bank
Bank6
Creditors Control3
Debtors Control
Debtors Control4
Creditors Control8
2
Amount
Sundry Creditor5 End
Balance Balance
4HEENTRIESINTHE'34#LEARINGACCOUNTARE Debit side 1 2 3 4 5
Credit side 6 8
'34SETTLEMENT '34ONCASHPURCHASES '34ON#REDIT0URCHASES '34ON3ALES2ETURNS '34ONCREDITPURCHASEOF.#!
'34ON#ASH3ALES '34ON#REDIT3ALES '34ONPURCHASERETURNS
4HIS EXAMPLE ASSUMES A CREDIT BALANCE '34 LIABILITY TO BEGIN WITH SO A '34 SETTLEMENTISALSOLIKELYINTHECASEOFADEBITBALANCE'34ASSET A'34REFUNDWOULD BEEXPECTED)NTERMSOFTHE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT ONLYTHETHREEBANKENTRIES '34SETTLEMENT '34ONCASHPURCHASESAND'34ON#ASH3ALES WOULDBEREPORTED Figure 17.14
Capital template Capital (OE)
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Drawings End
Date
Cross-reference
Start
Balance
0,3UMMARY
Bank
Balance
.#!
Amount $
0,3UMMARY Balance
4HECROSS REFERENCE@0,3UMMARYREFERSTOTHE.ET0ROlTOR.ET,OSSFORTHEPERIOD SOOBVIOUSLYONLYONEOFTHESEENTRIESWILLAPPEARATANYONETIME)FAPROlTISGENERATED ITWILLAPPEARONTHECREDITSIDEIFALOSSISINCURRED ITWILLAPPEARONTHEDEBITSIDE Figure 17.15
Disposal of NCA template Disposal of NCA
Date
Cross-reference
Amount $
Date
Cross-reference
.#!
!CC$EPOF.#!
0ROlTON$ISPOF.#!
Bank or Sundry Creditor
Amount $
,OSSON$ISPOF.#!
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
409
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
410
STUDY TIP
)FYOUONLYKNOW TWOOFTHEBIGFOUR lGURES SEEIFTHEREIS ENOUGHINFORMATIONTO RECONSTRUCTARELATED ACCOUNTFOREXAMPLE 3TOCK#ONTROLAND #REDITORS#ONTROLARE LINKED ITMAYALLOW YOUTOCALCULATETHE THIRDlGURESOYOU CANRECONSTRUCTTHE ORIGINALACCOUNT
UNITS 3&4
4HISLISTISBYNOMEANSEXHAUSTIVEANYLEDGERACCOUNTCOULDBERECONSTRUCTEDTO CALCULATEAMISSINGlGURE FORANYOFTHETHREEGENERAL PURPOSEBUDGETS 4HEONLYRESTRICTIONISWENEEDTOKNOWTHREEOFTHE@BIGFOURPIECESOFINFORMATION &ORDEBTORSANDCREDITORS THISMEANSATLEASTTHREEOF s OPENINGBALANCE s CLOSINGBALANCE s #REDIT3ALES#REDIT0URCHASES s 2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS0AYMENTSTO#REDITORS s s s s
&ORSTOCK ITMEANSTHREEOF OPENINGBALANCE CLOSINGBALANCE #OSTOF3ALES PURCHASESCASHORCREDIT
)F WE KNOW ONLY ONE OR TWO OF THE BIG FOUR WE HAVE INSUFlCIENT INFORMATION TO RECONSTRUCTTHEACCOUNT
REVIEW QUESTIONS 17.8
1 StateTHEPURPOSEOFRECONSTRUCTINGALEDGERACCOUNT 2 ListTHETHREESTEPSINVOLVEDINRECONSTRUCTINGALEDGERACCOUNT 3 ExplainWHENITWOULDBEMOREAPPROPRIATETORECONSTRUCTTHE$EBTORS#ONTROL ACCOUNTRATHERTHANPREPAREA3CHEDULEOF2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS 4 ShowTHETEMPLATESFORTHEFOLLOWINGLEDGERACCOUNTS s $EBTORS#ONTROL s '34#LEARING s #REDITORS#ONTROL s #APITAL s 3TOCK#ONTROL s $ISPOSALOF.#!
17.9 VARIANCE REPORTS: CASH AND PROFIT
variance report an accounting report that compares actual and budgeted figures, highlighting variances, so that problems can be identified and corrective action taken
! NUMBER OF TIMES IN THIS CHAPTER WE HAVE NOTED THE BENElT OF BUDGETS IN TERMS OF PROVIDING A BENCHMARK FOR THE ASSESSMENT OF ACTUAL PERFORMANCE "Y COMPARING ACTUAL AND BUDGETED lGURES SIGNIlCANT DIFFERENCES AND PROBLEMS IN PARTICULAR CAN BEIDENTIlED ALLOWINGTHEOWNERTOMAKEDECISIONSTOIMPROVETHElRMSPERFORMANCE 4HISCOMPARISONISFACILITATEDBYTHEPREPARATIONOFAvariance report !VARIANCEREPORTCOMPARESACTUALANDBUDGETEDlGURES HIGHLIGHTINGANYSIGNIlCANT DIFFERENCES WHICH ARE KNOWN AS VARIANCES SO THAT PROBLEMS CAN BE IDENTIlED AND CORRECTED)TISPREPAREDONCETHElGURESAREAVAILABLE BUTBEFORETHENEXTBUDGET )NTHISCOURSE WEWILLPREPARETWOVARIANCEREPORTS s #ASH"UDGET6ARIANCE2EPORT s )NCOME3TATEMENT6ARIANCE2EPORT
Cash Budget Variance Report Cash Budget Variance Report an accounting report that compares actual and budgeted cash flows, highlighting variances
! #ASH "UDGET 6ARIANCE 2EPORT COMPARES ACTUAL AND BUDGETED CASH mOWS )N APPEARANCE ITISVERYSIMILARTOA"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT BUTISHASADDITIONAL COLUMNSFORACTUALlGURES ANDTHECALCULATIONOFTHEVARIANCE &IGURESHOWSTHE#ASH"UDGET6ARIANCE2EPORTFOR$ENZEL7ASHING-ACHINES FOR-ARCH
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
Figure 17.16
BUDGETS
411
Cash Budget Variance Report DENZEL WASHING MACHINES
STUDY TIP
Cash Budget Variance Report for March 2016 Budget
Actual
Variance
F/U
Cash Sales
24 000
29 000
5 000
F
2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS
11 000
8 000
3 000
U
2 400
2 900
500
F
39 900
2 500
F
32 000
30 000
2 000
F
Wages
8 000
8 600
600
U
Advertising
1 300
1 100
200
F
0REPAID2ENT
9 000
9 000
–
'340AID
1 530
1 610
80
U
51 830
50 310
1 520
F
(14 430)
(10 410)
4 020
F
CASH FLOW FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES Cash Inflows
'342ECEIVED 4OTAL/PERATING)NmOWS
6ARIANCEREPORTSAREALSO KNOWNASPERFORMANCE REPORTS ASTHEYASSESS THElRMSPERFORMANCE INMEETINGITSBUDGET
Less Cash Outflows 0AYMENTSTO#REDITORS
4OTAL/PERATING/UTmOWS Net Cash Flows from Operations
–
CASH FLOW FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES Cash Inflows .IL Less Cash Outflows Office Equipment Net Cash Flows from Investing Activities
5 000
5 000
–
–
(5 000)
(5 000)
–
–
CASH FLOW FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES Cash Inflows Capital Contribution
30 000
30 000
–
–
Loan – AXC Bank
10 000
11 000
1 000
F
4OTAL&INANCING)NmOWS
40 000
41 000
1 000
F
1 000
1 200
200
U
Net Cash Flows from Financing Activities
39 000
39 800
800
F
Net Increase (Decrease) in Cash Position
19 570
24 390
4 820
F
Nil
Nil
–
–
19 570
24 390
4 820
F
STUDY TIP
Less Cash Outflows Drawings
add Bank Balance at start Bank Balance at end
! variance IS SIMPLY THE DIFFERENCE BETWEEN THE BUDGETED lGURE AND THE ACTUAL lGURE7HETHERITISFAVOURABLEORUNFAVOURABLEDEPENDS INTHE#ASH"UDGET6ARIANCE 2EPORT ONITSEFFECTONCASH!VARIANCEISFAVOURABLE& IFITMEANSCASHWILLBEHIGHER THANEXPECTEDINTHEBUDGETAVARIANCEISUNFAVOURABLE5 IFITMEANSCASHWILLBELOWER THANEXPECTEDINTHEBUDGET .OTE THAT IN OUR EXAMPLE THE VARIANCE IN THE ,OAN n !8# "ANK IS REPORTED AS FAVOURABLEBECAUSECASHWILLINCREASEMORETHANEXPECTED4HEFACTTHATTHELIABILITIES WILLALSOINCREASEDOESNOTAFFECTITSCLASSIlCATIONINTHE#ASH"UDGET6ARIANCE2EPORT 3IMILARLY 0AYMENTSTO#REDITORSISCLASSIlEDASFAVOURABLE EVENTHOUGHITCOULDMEAN THEBALANCEOWEDTOCREDITORSISHIGHERTHANEXPECTED
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
)FTHEREISNOVARIANCE ATALL THENITIS NEITHERFAVOURABLENOR UNFAVOURABLE
variance the difference between an actual figure and a budgeted figure, expressed as ‘favourable’ or ‘unfavourable’
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
412
UNITS 3&4
Uses of the Cash Budget Variance Report
STUDY TIP
)TDOESNTREALLYMATTER WHETHERYOUSUBTRACT BUDGETEDlGURES FROMACTUAL ORTHE OTHERWAYAROUND4HE IMPORTANTTHINGISTO IDENTIFYTHEVARIANCE CORRECTLYASfavourable ORunfavourable
)TISPOSSIBLETHATTHEVARIANCESREVEALEDINTHE#ASH"UDGET6ARIANCE2EPORTARECAUSED SIMPLYBYPOORBUDGETING(OWEVER THISDOESNOTMEANTHEREPORTISUSELESSITSHOULD BEUSEDINplanningTHENEXTBUDGET SOTHATITISMOREACCURATE !SSUMING THE VARIANCES ARE NOT CAUSED BY POOR ESTIMATES THEN THE #ASH "UDGET 6ARIANCE 2EPORT IS A VALUABLE aid to decision-making 4HE UNFAVOURABLE VARIANCES SHOULD BE INVESTIGATED AND THEIR CAUSE IDENTIlED 4HIS WILL ALLOW THE OWNER TO TAKE CORRECTIVEACTION)NOUREXAMPLE $ENZEL7ASHING-ACHINESMAYBECONCERNEDATTHE UNFAVOURABLE VARIANCE IN 2ECEIPTS FROM $EBTORS DOES IT INDICATE A DECLINE IN #REDIT 3ALES POORCOLLECTIONPOLICIESORSOMETHINGELSE 7HENUSINGTHEREPORTINTHISWAY ITISALSOIMPORTANTTOCONSIDERTHELINKSBETWEEN ITEMS &OR INSTANCE AN UNFAVOURABLE VARIANCE IN !DVERTISING MAY ACTUALLY GENERATE A FAVOURABLEVARIANCEIN#ASH3ALES BUTACORRESPONDINGUNFAVOURABLEVARIANCEIN7AGES
Income Statement Variance Report Income Statement Variance Report an accounting report that compares actual and budged revenues and expenses, and highlights variations
)NTHESAMEWAYTHATA#ASH"UDGET6ARIANCE2EPORTCOMPARESACTUALANDBUDGETED CASHmOWS AN)NCOME3TATEMENT6ARIANCE2EPORTCANBEPREPAREDTOCOMPAREACTUAL ANDBUDGETEDREVENUESANDEXPENSES 6ARIANCESINTHISREPORTARECLASSIlEDASFAVOURABLEORUNFAVOURABLEDEPENDINGON THEIREFFECTONPROlT)NTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT6ARIANCE2EPORT AVARIANCEISFAVOURABLE & IFITMEANSPROlTWILLBEHIGHERTHANEXPECTEDINTHEBUDGETAVARIANCEISUNFAVOURABLE 5 IFITMEANSPROlTWILLBELOWERTHANEXPECTEDINTHEBUDGET Figure 17.17
Income Statement Variance Report DENZEL WASHING MACHINES Income Statement Variance Report for March 2016 Budget
Actual
Variance
F/U
Revenue Cash Sales
24 000
29 000
5 000
F
Credit Sales
16 000
14 000
2 000
U
4OTAL2EVENUE
40 000
43 000
3 000
F
Cost of Sales
20 000
19 000
1 000
F
Gross Profit
20 000
24 000
4 000
F
300
900
600
U
19 700
23 100
3 400
F
Wages
8 000
8 600
600
U
Advertising
1 300
1 100
200
F
100
100
–
–
1 500
1 500
–
–
10 900
11 300
400
U
8 800
11 800
3 000
F
Less Cost of Goods Sold
Less Stock Loss Adjusted Gross Profit Less Other Expenses
Depreciation of Office Equipment 2ENT 4OTAL%XPENSES Net Profit
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
BUDGETS
Uses of the Income Statement Variance Report 4HE)NCOME3TATEMENT6ARIANCE2EPORTCANBEUSEDFOREXACTLYTHESAMEPURPOSESAS THE#ASH"UDGET6ARIANCE2EPORTASAplanningDOCUMENTANDTOaid decision-making 4HEPRECEDINGREPORTIDENTIlESTHAT3ALESOVERALLHASINCREASED SOTHISMAYEXPLAINTHE UNFAVOURABLEVARIANCESIN#OSTOF3ALESAND7AGES 4HE UNFAVOURABLE VARIANCE IN 3TOCK ,OSS IS PERHAPS MORE PROBLEMATIC IT MAY BE CAUSED BY POOR STOCK MANAGEMENT PROCEDURES WHICH MAY NEED TO BE IMPROVED 7ITHOUT THE BUDGET PROVIDING THE BENCHMARK AND THE VARIANCE REPORT MAKING THE COMPARISON THISPROBLEMMAYNOTHAVEBEENIDENTIlED
REVIEW QUESTIONS 17.9
1 State WHATINFORMATIONISSHOWNINA s #ASH"UDGET6ARIANCE2EPORT s )NCOME3TATEMENT6ARIANCE2EPORT 2 DefineTHETERM@VARIANCE 3 ExplainWHENAVARIANCEWOULDBECONSIDEREDTOBEFAVOURABLEIFREPORTEDIN THE s #ASH"UDGET6ARIANCE2EPORT s )NCOME3TATEMENT6ARIANCE2EPORT 4 ExplainHOWAVARIANCEREPORTCANBEUSEDTOASSISTPLANNING 5 Explain HOWAVARIANCEREPORTCANBEUSEDTOASSISTDECISION MAKING
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
413
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
414
UNITS 3&4
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s "UDGETINGISTHEPROCESSOFPREPARINGREPORTSTHATESTIMATEORPREDICTTHElNANCIAL CONSEQUENCESOFLIKELYFUTURETRANSACTIONS s "UDGETSASSISTPLANNINGBYPREDICTINGWHATISLIKELYTOOCCURINTHEFUTUREANDAID DECISION MAKINGBYPROVIDINGABENCHMARKORYARDSTICKASTANDARD AGAINSTWHICH ACTUALPERFORMANCECANBEMEASURED s "UDGETEDCASHANDBUDGETEDPROlTARENOTNECESSARILYTHESAME s &IGURES CAN BE CALCULATED BY PREPARING 3CHEDULES OF 2ECEIPTS FROM $EBTORS 0AYMENTSTO#REDITORS ORBYRECONSTRUCTINGLEDGERACCOUNTS s 6ARIANCE REPORTS COMPARE ACTUAL AND BUDGETED lGURES HIGHLIGHTING VARIANCES SO THATPROBLEMSCANBEIDENTIlEDANDCORRECTED s !VARIANCEISTHEDIFFERENCEBETWEENTHEBUDGETEDlGUREANDTHEACTUALlGURE AND CLASSIlEDASFAVOURABLEORUNFAVOURABLEDEPENDINGONITSEFFECTONBANKORPROlT
EXERCISE 17.1 CASH BUDGET
EXERCISES
W B
page 370
/N*ULY 4OP(ATSHADINITSBANKACCOUNT)THASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWING LISTOFEXPECTEDTRANSACTIONSFOR*ULY s #ASH3ALESAREEXPECTEDTOBEPLUS'34#REDIT3ALESAREEXPECTEDTOBE PLUS'34 BUTONLYISEXPECTEDTOBECOLLECTEDIN*ULY s !LLSTOCKISSOLDATAMARK UP s #ASHPURCHASESOFSTOCKWILLBEPLUS'34 s $RAWINGSWILLCONSISTOFCASHANDWORTHOFSTOCK s 4HEFOLLOWINGEXPENSESWILLBEPAID n ADVERTISING PLUS'34 n WAGES n INTEREST s WAGESWILLBEOWINGATTHEENDOF*ULY s 9EARLYRENTWILLBEPAIDON*ULY COSTINGPLUS'34 s 4HEMONTHLYLOANREPAYMENTOFWILLBEMADEON*ULY s .EWSHOPlTTINGSWORTHINCLUDING'34 WILLBEPURCHASEDFORCASHFROM&ITTS "EST Required
a CalculateBUDGETED'34PAIDFOR*ULY b PrepareA"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR4OP(ATSFOR*ULY c SuggestTWOACTIONSTHEOWNERMAYTAKETOPLANFORTHEOUTCOMEPREDICTEDINTHE "UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
EXERCISE 17.2 CASH BUDGET: CONSECUTIVE PERIODS
W B
BUDGETS
page 372
,OCKHARDT,OCKSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONREGARDINGITSEXPECTEDACTIVITIES FOR*ANUARYTO-ARCH s !SAT*ANUARY THEBUSINESSHADINTHEBANK s 3ALES ARE MADE ON CASH ONLY TERMS AND ARE BUDGETED TO BE IN *ANUARY IN &EBRUARY AND IN -ARCH '34 WILL ALSO BE RECEIVED ON THESE AMOUNTS s 3TOCK IS PURCHASED ON CREDIT WITH CREDITORS PAID THE MONTH FOLLOWING PURCHASE #REDIT PURCHASES FOR $ECEMBER WERE BUT ARE EXPECTED TO RISE TO IN*ANUARY ANDIN&EBRUARYAND-ARCH'34WILLALSOBEOWINGON THESEAMOUNTS s 4HEFOLLOWINGEXPENSESWILLBEPAIDEACHMONTH n WAGES n ADVERTISING PLUS'34 n INTEREST s 2ENTFORTHENEXTSIXMONTHSWILLBEPAIDDURING*ANUARYnINCLUSIVEOF'34 s )N*ANUARY THEBUSINESSWILLSELLANOLDVEHICLEFORCASH ANDIN&EBRUARY WILLPAYCASHFORANEWVEHICLE WHICHWILLCOSTPLUS'34 s !'34SETTLEMENTISDUEIN*ANUARYn s -ONTHLYCASHDRAWINGSWILLBE s !REPAYMENTONTHEPRINCIPALOFALOANISDUEON*ANUARYn s 4HE OWNER PLANS TO CONTRIBUTE CASH AND SOME OFlCE EQUIPMENT WORTH IN-ARCH Required
a CalculateBUDGETED'34PAIDFOR*ANUARY &EBRUARYAND-ARCH b PrepareA"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR,OCKHARDT,OCKSFOR*ANUARY &EBRUARY AND-ARCH c Suggest TWO ACTIONS THE OWNER MIGHT TAKE TO ADDRESS ANY PROBLEMS REVEALED BY YOURANSWERTOPART@B d Explain ONEBENElTOFPREPARINGA"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFORCONSECUTIVE PERIODS
EXERCISE 17.3 SCHEDULE OF RECEIPTS FROM DEBTORS
W B
page 375
"ATS @N "ALLS HAS PROVIDED THE FOLLOWING BUDGETED INFORMATION RELATING TO ITS CREDIT SALESDURING Month
Credit Sales
!UGUSTACTUAL
8 000
3EPTEMBERACTUAL
9 000
/CTOBERBUDGETED
10 000
.OVEMBERBUDGETED
11 000
$ECEMBERBUDGETED
12 000
'34WILLALSOBECHARGEDONTHESEAMOUNTS)TISEXPECTEDTHATOFDEBTORSWILL PAYINTHEMONTHFOLLOWINGTHESALE WHILETHEREMAININGWILLPAYINTHESECOND MONTH
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
415
416
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Required a SuggestONEREASONFORTHETRENDIN3ALESFROM!UGUSTTO$ECEMBER b PrepareA3CHEDULEOF2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORSFOR/CTOBER .OVEMBERAND$ECEMBER c 2EFERRINGTOTHEINFORMATIONPROVIDED explainONEREASONWHYBUDGETED.ET0ROlT AND"UDGETED.ET)NCREASE$ECREASE IN#ASH0OSITIONARELIKELYTOBEDIFFERENTFOR $ECEMBER
EXERCISE 17.4 SCHEDULE OF RECEIPTS FROM DEBTORS
W B
page 376
*AZZY *ACKETS HAS PROVIDED THE FOLLOWING INFORMATION TO AID IN THE PREPARATION OF ITS "UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR!PRIL -AYAND*UNE Month
Credit Sales
Cash Sales
January
50 000
43 000
February
40 000
32 000
March
45 000
35 000
April
35 000
May
30 000
32 000
June
20 000
26 000
4HESEAMOUNTSDONOTINCLUDE'34
)T IS EXPECTED THAT OF DEBTORS WILL PAY IN THE MONTH OF SALE OF DEBTORS WILLPAYINTHEMONTHFOLLOWINGTHESALE ANDTHEREMAININGWILLPAYINTHESECOND MONTHFOLLOWINGTHESALE Required a CalculateBUDGETED2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORSFOR!PRIL -AYAND*UNE b Prepare AN EXTRACT OF THE "UDGETED #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT FOR *AZZY *ACKETS THAT SHOWS/PERATINGCASHINmOWSFOR!PRIL -AYAND*UNE c ExplainHOWTHEPREPARATIONOFA"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTCANASSISTPLANNING
EXERCISE 17.5 SCHEDULES AND THE BUDGETED CASH FLOW STATEMENT
W B
page 377
/N *ANUARY "ETTYS "AGS COMMENCED /PERATIONS 0ROJECTED PURCHASES AND 3ALESFORTHElRSTFOURMONTHSARE Month
Credit purchases
Credit Sales
Cash Sales
January
12 000
20 000
30 000
February
13 000
25 000
34 000
March
14 000
28 000
36 000
Additional information: s 4HEAMOUNTSABOVEDOnotINCLUDE'34 s "ETTYS "AGS ALLOWS A DISCOUNT IF DEBTORS PAY WITHIN THE MONTH THAT THE SALE OCCURRED)TISEXPECTEDTHATOFTHE3ALESWILLBECOLLECTEDWITHINTHEDISCOUNT PERIOD BYTHEENDOFTHEMONTHAFTERPURCHASE INTHEFOLLOWINGMONTH ANDTHATWILLBEUNCOLLECTABLE ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
BUDGETS
s /F CREDIT PURCHASES ARE PAID IN THE MONTH OF PURCHASE WITH THE REMAINDER PAIDINTHEFOLLOWINGMONTH s -ONTHLYEXPENSESINCLUDEADVERTISINGOFPLUS'34 WAGESOFAND DEPRECIATIONONEQUIPMENTOF4HEREARENOPREPAIDORACCRUEDEXPENSES s #ASHDRAWINGSWILLBEPERMONTH Required
a CalculateBUDGETED2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORSFOR*ANUARY &EBRUARYAND-ARCH b CalculateBUDGETED0AYMENTSTO#REDITORSFOR*ANUARY &EBRUARYAND-ARCH c Prepare AN EXTRACT OF THE "UDGETED #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT FOR "ETTYS "AGS THAT SHOWSTHE/PERATINGACTIVITIESFOR*ANUARY &EBRUARYAND-ARCH d 2EFERRING TO YOUR ANSWER TO PART @C explain YOUR TREATMENT OF DEPRECIATION OF EQUIPMENT e ExplainHOWCASHDRAWINGSWOULDBEREPORTEDINTHE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENT f ExplainHOWTHEPREPARATIONOFA"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTCANASSISTDECISION MAKING
EXERCISE 17.6 BUDGETED REPORTS
W B
page 379
$ANAS$ETERGENTSWILLBEGINTRADING/PERATIONSON-AY ANDHASPROVIDEDTHE FOLLOWINGESTIMATESFORITSlRSTMONTHOF/PERATIONS s 4HEOWNERWILLMAKEACAPITALCONTRIBUTIONOFTOCOMMENCE/PERATIONS s 3HELVINGWORTHPLUS'34 WILLBEPURCHASEDONCREDITFROM*ANCKE&ITTINGS ON-AY"EFORETHEENDOF-AY WILLBEPAIDTOTHECREDITOR s #ASH3ALESAREESTIMATEDTOBEPLUS'34 s #REDIT3ALESAREESTIMATEDTOBEINCLUDING'34$EBTORSOWINGATTHEEND OF-AYISEXPECTEDTOBE s !LLSTOCKWILLBEPURCHASEDONCREDIT0URCHASESFOR-AYAREEXPECTEDTOBE PLUS'34!TTHEENDOF-AY ITISANTICIPATEDTHATWILLBE OWEDTOCREDITORS s #OSTOF3ALESISEXPECTEDTOBEAND BASEDONINDUSTRYAVERAGES 3TOCK,OSS ISEXPECTEDTOBE s 3IXMONTHSADVERTISINGWILLBEPAIDINADVANCEON-AY ATACOSTOF PLUS'344HEREWILLBENOOTHERPREPAYMENTSORACCRUALS s 4HEFOLLOWINGEXPENSESWILLBEINCURREDDURING-AY n WAGES n DEPRECIATIONOFSHELVING n RENT PLUS'34 s /N-AY ALOANFORWILLBERECEIVEDFROM:.!"ANK4HELOANWILL BE USED TO PURCHASE A VAN IN *UNE %ACH MONTH WILL BE PAID OFF THE PRINCIPAL STARTINGON*UNE s #ASHDRAWINGSWILLBE$RAWINGSOFSTOCKISEXPECTEDTOBE Required
a Prepare A"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR$ANAS$ETERGENTSFOR-AY b Prepare A"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR$ANAS$ETERGENTSFOR-AY c ExplainTWOREASONSWHYTHEBUDGETED.ET)NCREASEIN#ASH0OSITIONISMUCHLARGER THANTHEBUDGETED.ET0ROlTFOR-AY d Show HOW THE 3TOCK #ONTROL AND '34 #LEARING ACCOUNTS WOULD APPEAR IN THE 'ENERAL,EDGERASAT-AY e Prepare A"UDGETED"ALANCE3HEETFOR$ANAS$ETERGENTSASAT-AY f ExplainHOWA"UDGETED"ALANCE3HEETCANASSISTPLANNING ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
417
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
418
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 17.7 BUDGETED REPORTS
W B
page 382
/N*UNE THE"ALANCE3HEETOF*ACUZZI*OINTSHOWEDTHEFOLLOWING JACUZZI JOINT Balance Sheet as at 30 June 2016 Current Assets
$
Bank
$
4 000
Stock Control
28 000
Debtors Control
0REPAID2ENT
6 000
Current Liabilities
$
Creditors Control
9 900 200
'34#LEARING 45 480
Non-Current Assets
$
!CCRUED)NTEREST%XPENSE
300
Sundry Creditor – Wilks
11 150
Non-Current Liabilities
Office Equipment
24 000
Less Accumulated Depreciation
30 000
,OANn!03&INANCE 16 800
Owner’s Equity Capital – Jacqui
Total Assets
$62 280
Total Equities
21 130 $62 280
4HE OWNER HAS PROVIDED THE FOLLOWING INFORMATION TO ASSIST IN THE PREPARATION OF BUDGETEDREPORTSFOR*ULY Month
Credit purchases
Credit Sales
Cash Sales
June
9 000
19 000
July
11 000
18 000
22 000
4HESEAMOUNTSDOnotINCLUDE'34 s !LLSTOCKISMARKEDUP s 4HEOWNEREXPECTSA3TOCK,OSSOFFOR*ULY s #REDIT3ALESARERECEIVEDINTHEMONTHOFTHESALEANDINTHEMONTHAFTER THESALE s !LLPURCHASESAREMADEONCREDIT!MOUNTSOWINGTOCREDITORSAREPAIDINTHEMONTH FOLLOWINGPURCHASETOEARNADISCOUNT s 3IXMONTHSRENTWASPREPAIDON-AY s 7AGES PAID DURING *ULY WILL BE BUT WAGES IS EXPECTED TO BE OWINGATTHEENDOF*ULY s $EPRECIATIONOFOFlCEEQUIPMENTFOR*ULYWILLBE s %LECTRICITYEXPENSEWILLBEPLUS'344HISAMOUNTWILLBEPAIDINFULLDURING*ULY s )N*ULY WILLBEPAIDTOCOVERTHEINTERESTEXPENSEFOR-AY *UNEAND*ULY s $URING *ULY NEW OFlCE EQUIPMENT COSTING INCLUDING '34 WILL BE PURCHASEDONCREDITFROM0HELPS#O!PAYMENTOFWILLBEMADETO0HELPS #OBEFORETHEENDOF*ULY s /N*ULY THEOWNERPLANSTOCONTRIBUTECASHANDHEROWNVEHICLE WORTH$RAWINGSOFCASHBYTHEOWNERWILLBE s 4HEAMOUNTOWINGTO3UNDRY#REDITORn7ILKSWILLBEPAIDINFULL s 4HE,OANn!03&INANCEISANINTERESTONLYLOANDUEINFULLIN/CTOBER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
BUDGETS
Required
a b c d e
CalculateBUDGETED2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORSFOR*ULY CalculateBUDGETED0AYMENTSTO#REDITORSFOR*ULY Prepare A"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR*ACUZZI*OINTFOR*ULY Prepare A"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR*ACUZZI*OINTFOR*ULY ExplainTWOREASONSWHYTHE.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM/PERATIONSISBUDGETEDTOBE GREATERTHANTHE.ET0ROlTFOR*ULY f Show HOW THE 3TOCK #ONTROL AND '34 #LEARING ACCOUNTS WOULD APPEAR IN THE 'ENERAL,EDGERASAT*ULY g Prepare A"UDGETED"ALANCE3HEETFOR*ACUZZI*OINTASAT*ULY
EXERCISE 17.8 ACCOUNT RECONSTRUCTION
W B
page 386
-OVING "OXES SELLS CARDBOARD BOXES FOR PEOPLE WHO ARE MOVING HOUSE AND HAS PROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONRELATINGTOTHEIR$EBTORS#ONTROLACCOUNT s "ALANCEASAT*ULY s "UDGETEDBALANCEASAT*UNE s "UDGETED#REDIT3ALESFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE INCLUDING'34 s "UDGETED$ISCOUNT%XPENSE Required a &OREACHITEMABOVE identifyTHEBUDGETEDREPORTINWHICHTHEITEMWILLAPPEAR b Reconstruct THE $EBTORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT TO DETERMINE BUDGETED 2ECEIPTS FROM $EBTORSFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE c ExplainTHEIMPORTANCEOFBUDGETED3ALESINTHEBUDGETINGPROCESS
EXERCISE 17.9 ACCOUNT RECONSTRUCTION
W B
page 387
"ULLY(IDESSELLSLEATHERPRODUCTSANDHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONRELATINGTO ITSEXPECTEDTRANSACTIONSFOR s ACTUALBALANCESASAT*ANUARY n $EBTORS#ONTROL n #REDITORS#ONTROL s BUDGETEDBALANCESASAT$ECEMBER n $EBTORS#ONTROL n #REDITORS#ONTROL s FROMTHE"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENT n #ASH3ALES
n #REDIT3ALES
n 3ALES2ETURNS
n $ISCOUNT2EVENUE n "AD$EBTS n $ISCOUNT%XPENSE s OTHERINFORMATION n CASHPURCHASES
n CREDITPURCHASES
&IGURESDONOTINCLUDE'34
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
419
420
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Required a Reconstruct THE $EBTORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT TO DETERMINE BUDGETED 2ECEIPTS FROM $EBTORSFOR b PrepareANEXTRACTFROMTHE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR"ULLY(IDESFOR THATSHOWS/PERATINGCASHINmOWS c Reconstruct THE #REDITORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT TO DETERMINE BUDGETED 0AYMENTS TO #REDITORSFOR
EXERCISE 17.10 ACCOUNT RECONSTRUCTION
W B
page 388
4ONYS4YRE%MPORIUMHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONRELATINGTOITSEXPECTED TRANSACTIONSFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE s BALANCESASAT*ULY n 3TOCK#ONTROL n #REDITORS#ONTROL s FROMTHE"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENT n 3ALES
n 3ALES2ETURNS
n 3TOCK'AIN n $ISCOUNT2EVENUE s EXPECTEDBALANCESASAT*UNE n 3TOCK#ONTROL n #REDITORS#ONTROL s OTHERINFORMATION n CASHPURCHASES
n DRAWINGSOFSTOCK
&IGURESDONOTINCLUDE'34
INCLUDESCASH ANDSTOCK
!LLSTOCKISSOLDATAMARK UP Required a ReconstructTHE3TOCK#ONTROLACCOUNTTODETERMINEBUDGETEDCREDITPURCHASESFOR THEYEARENDED*UNE b Reconstruct THE #REDITORS #ONTROL ACCOUNT TO DETERMINE BUDGETED 0AYMENTS TO #REDITORSFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
EXERCISE 17.11 CASH BUDGET VARIANCE REPORT
W B
BUDGETS
page 389
3IMPLY3TUNNINGSELLSHAIRCAREPRODUCTSTOHAIRDRESSERSIN-ELBOURNEANDHASPROVIDED THEFOLLOWING#ASH"UDGET6ARIANCE2EPORTFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE SIMPLY STUNNING Cash Budget Variance Report for the year ended 30 June 2016 Budgeted
Actual
Variance
Fav./ Unfav.
–
–
CASH FLOW FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES 2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS
99 200
89 200
Cash Sales
85 000
94 000
8 500
9 400
'342ECEIVED 0AYMENTSTO#REDITORS
Advertising
)NTEREST%XPENSE
'343ETTLEMENT
0REPAID2ENT '340AID Wages
Net Cash Flows from Operations
25 460
5 410
0ROCEEDSON3ALEOF%QUIPMENT
5 000
3 000
Shelving
–
Net Cash Flows from Investing Activities
5 000
(9 000)
Capital Contribution
–
20 000
Loan
CASH FLOW FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES
CASH FLOW FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES –
Drawings
Net Cash Flows from Financing Activities
(41 000)
(20 000)
Net Increase (Decrease) in Cash Position
(10 540)
(23 590)
Add Bank Balance at start
8 500
8 500
Bank Balance at end
(2 040)
(15 090)
3OPHIEHADORGANISEDANOVERDRAFTLIMITWITHTHEBANKOF Required a ExplainONEBENElTOFPREPARINGA#ASH"UDGET6ARIANCE2EPORT b CompleteTHE#ASH"UDGET6ARIANCE2EPORTFOR3IMPLY3TUNNINGFORTHEYEARENDED *UNE c StateWHETHERTHEVARIANCEIN0AYMENTSTO#REDITORSISFAVOURABLEORUNFAVOURABLE JustifyYOURANSWER d SuggestONEPOSSIBLEREASONFORTHE#APITAL#ONTRIBUTION
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
421
422
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
e ExplainTHEEFFECTONTHEACTUALCLOSINGBANKBALANCEOFTHEVARIANCESIN)NVESTING ACTIVITIES f Identify TWO ASSETS THAT WILL DIFFER AS AT *UNE AS A CONSEQUENCE OF THE VARIANCESINTHE#ASH"UDGET6ARIANCE2EPORTJustifyYOURANSWER
EXERCISE 17.12 CASH VARIANCE REPORT
W B
page 391
"RIGHT ,IGHTS HAS PROVIDED THE FOLLOWING PARTIALLY COMPLETED #ASH "UDGET 6ARIANCE 2EPORTFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE BRIGHT LIGHTS Cash Budget Variance Report (extract) for the year ended 30 June 2016 Budgeted
Actual
Variance
Fav./ Unfav.
5 000
F
300
U
1 000
U
2 500
F
CASH FLOW FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES 2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS
100 000
0AYMENTSTO#REDITORS
105 000
)NTEREST%XPENSE '340AID 0REPAID2ENT
CASH FLOW FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES Sale of Shelving Van
5 000
CASH FLOW FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES Loan Drawings
Additional information: s 4HEBUDGETEDFOR0REPAID2ENTFAILEDTOTAKEINTOACCOUNTINPREPAID RENTAT*ULYANDPREPAIDRENTOFAT*UNE s 4HEOWNERHASARGUEDTHATTHE,OANVARIANCEISUNFAVOURABLEBECAUSEITINCREASES THElRMSLIABILITIES Required a Calculate ACTUAL 0REPAID2ENTFORTHEYEARENDING*UNE b Complete THE#ASH"UDGET6ARIANCE2EPORTEXTRACT FOR"RIGHT,IGHTSFORTHEYEAR ENDED*UNE c ExplainWHETHERTHE,OANVARIANCEISFAVOURABLEORUNFAVOURABLE d 'IVENTHAT#REDIT3ALESDECREASED suggestONEPOSSIBLEREASONFORTHEVARIANCEIN 2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS e ExplainONEPOSSIBLEEFFECTOF&INANCINGACTIVITIESONTHElRMSACTUAL.ET0ROlTFOR THEYEARENDED*UNE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
EXERCISE 17.13 INCOME STATEMENT VARIANCE REPORT
W B
BUDGETS
page 393
4OOTAND4WANGSELLSMUSICALINSTRUMENTSFROMASHOPIN-ELTON ANDHASPROVIDEDTHE FOLLOWING)NCOME3TATEMENT6ARIANCE2EPORTFORTHEYEARENDED*ULY TOOT AND TWANG Income Statement Variance Report for the year ended 30 June 2016 Budgeted
Actual
120 000
110 000
Cost of Sales
55 000
Gross Profit
50 000
55 000
!DD3TOCK'AIN,OSS
1 500
Adjusted Gross Profit
51 500
50 800
Variance
Fav./ Unfav.
Revenue Sales Less Cost of Goods Sold
Add Other Revenue 1 500
6 500
53 000
57 300
Wages
18 000
19 000
2ENT
12 000
14 000
Depreciation of Vehicles
2 300
1 600
)NTEREST%XPENSE
1 400
1 800
Net Profit/(Loss)
19 300
20 900
0ROlTON$ISPOSALOF6EHICLE Less Other Expenses
Required a Explain THEIMPORTANCEOFVARIANCEANALYSISINTHEBUDGETINGPROCESS b Complete THE)NCOME3TATEMENT6ARIANCE2EPORTFOR4OOTAND4WANGFORTHEYEAR ENDED*ULY c Explain WHETHERTHEVARIANCEIN#OSTOF3ALESISFAVOURABLEORUNFAVOURABLE d Suggest ONEPOSSIBLEREASONFORTHEVARIANCEIN$EPRECIATIONOF6EHICLES e Explain WHY THE OWNER SHOULD BE CONCERNED ABOUT THE lRMS PROlT PERFORMANCE WHENCOMPAREDTOTHEBUDGET
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
423
424
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 17.14 INCOME STATEMENT VARIANCE REPORT
W B
page 395
"LADES WHICH SELLS KITCHEN KNIVES AND CUTTING UTENSILS HAS PROVIDED THE FOLLOWING )NCOME3TATEMENT6ARIANCE2EPORTFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE BLADES Income Statement Variance Report for the year ended 30 June 2016 Budgeted
Actual
Variance
Fav./.Unfav.
Revenue Sales 3ALES2ETURNS
105 000
90 000
8 500
4 500
F
5000
U
300
F
96 500 Less Cost of Goods Sold Cost of Sales #ARTAGE)NWARDS Gross Profit Less Stock Loss Adjusted Gross Profit
48 000
54 000
3 000
1 000
45 500 1 800
2 300
43 700
Less Other Expenses Wages
28 000
2ENT
15 000
18 000
1 400
2 200
Depreciation – Equipment )NTEREST
800
Net Profit/(Loss)
4HEBUSINESSHADANOVERDRAFTOFASAT*ULY Required a Complete THE)NCOME3TATEMENT6ARIANCE2EPORTFOR"LADESFORTHEYEARENDED *UNE b SuggestTWOPOSSIBLEREASONSFORTHEVARIANCEIN3ALES2ETURNS c SuggestONEPOSSIBLEREASONFORTHEVARIANCEIN)NTEREST%XPENSE d Explain THEIMPLICATIONSOFTHEVARIANCEIN'ROSS0ROlT
EXERCISE 17.15 ACCOUNT RECONSTRUCTION AND BUDGETED REPORTS
W B
page 396
3ETH"AYESISTHEPROPRIETOROF"AYES3URFBOARDS WHICHSELLSSURFGEARONTHE6ICTORIAN WESTCOAST(EHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONTOASSISTINTHEPREPARATIONOF BUDGETSFOR
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 17
BUDGETS
BAYES SURFBOARDS Assets and equities as at 31 December 2015 Assets
$
Equities
$
Debtors Control
Bank
5 000
'34#LEARING
3 000
Stock Control
62 400
Creditors Control
41 800
Shop Fittings
52 000
Capital – Bayes
69 500
Less Accumulated Depreciation
18 000
Total Assets
$117 000
Accrued Wages
Total Equities
$117 000
%XPECTEDTRANSACTIONSFOR s #REDIT3ALESAREEXPECTEDTOBEANDWILLINCLUDEFOR$ECEMBER '34WILLALSOBECHARGEDONTHESEAMOUNTS$EBTORSUSUALLYPAYINTHEMONTH FOLLOWINGSALETOTAKEADVANTAGEOFASETTLEMENTDISCOUNT s #REDITPURCHASESAREBUDGETEDTOBEPLUS'34 AND ASAT$ECEMBER ISEXPECTEDTOBEOWINGTOCREDITORS s !LLSTOCKISSOLDATAMARK UP s /THERESTIMATESFORINCLUDE n OCCUPANCYEXPENSES PLUS'34 n OFlCEEXPENSES PLUS'34 n WAGESEXPENSE n DEPRECIATIONEXPENSE n CASHDRAWINGS n STOCKLOSS s !'34REFUNDOFISDUEFROMTHE!4/IN s !NEWADVERTISINGCONTRACTWILLBESIGNEDANDPAIDON3EPTEMBER WITHTHE PAYMENTOFINCLUDING'34 COVERINGMONTHSSTARTINGON/CTOBER !SIDE FROM THE ADVERTISING THERE WILL BE NO OTHER PREPAYMENTS OR ACCRUALS AS AT $ECEMBER s %ARLYIN$ECEMBER 3ETHWANTSTOBORROWFROM!8"ANKTOlNANCE THE PURCHASE OF NEW SHOP lTTINGS EARLY IN 4HE LOAN WILL BE REPAID IN FULL IN $ECEMBER BUTINTERESTOFDUEON $ECEMBERWILLNOTBEPAID UNTILTHENEXTWORKINGDAYON*ANUARY s )N.OVEMBER SOMEOLDSHOPlTTINGSWILLBESOLDTOALOCALSUPERMARKETATA PROlTOF4HESHOPlTTINGSWEREORIGINALLYWORTH BUTBYTHESALEDATE WILLHAVEACCUMULATEDDEPRECIATIONOF Required
a b c d e f g
Calculate THECASHPROCEEDSFROMTHEDISPOSALOFTHESHOPlTTINGS CalculateBUDGETED2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORSFOR CalculateBUDGETED0AYMENTSTO#REDITORSFOR Calculate BUDGETED'34PAIDFOR Prepare A"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTFOR"AYES3URFBOARDSFOR Explain ONEADVANTAGEOFPREPARINGBUDGETSMORETHANONCEAYEAR Show HOW THE 3TOCK #ONTROL AND '34 #LEARING ACCOUNTS WOULD APPEAR IN THE 'ENERAL,EDGERASAT$ECEMBER h Prepare AN EXTRACT OF THE "UDGETED "ALANCE 3HEET OF "AYES 3URFBOARDS AS AT $ECEMBERTHATSHOWS#URRENT!SSETSAND#URRENT,IABILITIES!FULL"ALANCE 3HEETISnotREQUIRED i ExplainHOWA"UDGETED"ALANCE3HEETCANBEUSEDTOASSISTPLANNING
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
425
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
426
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 17.16 ACCOUNT RECONSTRUCTION AND BUDGETED REPORTS
W B
page 399
0OPPY -ARCEL IS THE PROPRIETOR OF $IGITAL -ASTERS WHICH SELLS DIGITAL CAMERAS FROM A SHOPIN4ORQUAY3HEHASREQUESTEDSOMEASSISTANCEINPREPARINGTHEBUDGETSANDHAS PROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATION DIGITAL MASTERS Account balances as at 30 June 2015 Debit
$
Credit
$
0REPAID0HOTOCOPIER2ENT
1 000
'34#LEARING
3 400
Debtors Control Bank
16 000 1 200
Creditors Control
Acc. Depreciation – Shop Fittings
21 600
Stock Control
35 000
Accrued Wages
1 300
Shop Fittings
48 000
Capital – Marcel
61 200
$101 200
$101 200
!NTICIPATEDTRANSACTIONSFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE s #ASH3ALESAREEXPECTEDTOBEPLUS'34AND#REDIT3ALESOFPLUS '34$EBTORSASAT*UNEAREEXPECTEDTOBE s !LLSTOCKISPURCHASEDONCREDITANDSOLDATAMARK UP s /THERESTIMATESFORTHEYEARINCLUDE n PURCHASESOFSTOCK PLUS'34 n SALESRETURNS PLUS'34 n DISCOUNTEXPENSE n WAGEEXPENSEINCURRED n DEPRECIATIONnSHOPlTTINGS n CASHDRAWINGS n STOCKLOSS s 0OPPYISCURRENTLYRENTINGAPHOTOCOPIERATINCLUDING'34 PERMONTH PAYABLE MONTHS IN ADVANCE 0OPPY HAS RECEIVED NOTIlCATION THAT THE RENT WILL INCREASE TO INCLUDING '34 PER MONTH COMMENCING WITH THE NEXT PAYMENT DUE ON 3EPTEMBER s /N!PRIL THEBUSINESSWILLINVESTINATHREE YEARTERMDEPOSIT)NTEREST ISEARNEDATPERANNUM PAYABLEON-ARCHEACHYEAR s %STIMATEDBALANCESASAT*UNEINCLUDE – 3TOCK#ONTROL n "ANK/VERDRAFT n '34#LEARING #2 Required
a CalculateBUDGETEDRENTEXPENSEFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE b CalculateBUDGETEDINTERESTREVENUEFORTHEYEARENDED*UNE c PrepareA"UDGETED)NCOME3TATEMENTFOR$IGITAL-ASTERSFORTHEYEARENDED *UNE d Explain HOW THE PREPARATION OF A "UDGETED )NCOME 3TATEMENT COULD ASSIST WITH PLANNINGTOACHIEVEANIMPROVED'ROSS0ROlT e Prepare AN EXTRACT OF THE "UDGETED "ALANCE 3HEET OF $IGITAL -ASTERS AS AT *UNETHATSHOWS#URRENTAND.ON CURRENT!SSETS!FULL"ALANCE3HEETIS notREQUIRED f ExplainONEBENElTOFPREPARINGA"UDGETED"ALANCE3HEET
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s define@PROlTABILITY AND distinguishBETWEENPROlT ANDPROlTABILITY s analysePROlTABILITYUSING TRENDS VARIANCES BENCHMARKS ANDPROlTABILITYINDICATORS s calculateANDexplainVARIOUS PROlTABILITYINDICATORS s explainTHERELATIONSHIPS BETWEENVARIOUSPROlTABILITY INDICATORS s analyseANDevaluate PROlTABILITYUSINGNON lNANCIALINDICATORS s suggestSTRATEGIESTO IMPROVEPROlTABILITY
Course advice: advice: 4HE 6#% !CCOUNTING 3TUDY 4HE6#%!CCOUNTING3TUDY $ESIGNSTATESTHATSTUDENTS $ESIGN STATES THAT STUDENTS WILL WILLNOTBEREQUIREDTO NOT BE REQUIRED TO CALCULATElNANCIALINDICATORS CALCULATE lNANCIAL INDICATORS INTHEEXAMINATION(OWEVER IN THE EXAMINATION (OWEVER CALCULATIONSAREINCLUDED CALCULATIONS ARE INCLUDED INTHISTEXTASANESSENTIAL IN THIS TEXT AS AN ESSENTIAL MECHANISMFORUNDERSTANDING MECHANISM FOR UNDERSTANDING THEINFORMATIONTHESEINDICATORS THE INFORMATION THESE INDICATORS PRESENT
CHAPTER 18
EVALUATING PROFITABILITY KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s ANALYSING
s PROlTABILITYINDICATORS
s INTERPRETING s PROlTABILITY
s 2ETURNON/WNERS )NVESTMENT2/)
s LIQUIDITY
s 2ETURNON!SSETS2/!
s EFlCIENCY
s !SSET4URNOVER!4/
s STABILITY
s EXPENSECONTROL
s TREND
s .ET0ROlT-ARGIN.0-
s HORIZONTALANALYSIS
s 'ROSS0ROlT-ARGIN'0-
s VARIANCE
s VERTICALANALYSIS
s BENCHMARK
s NON lNANCIALINFORMATION
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
428
UNITS 3&4
18.1 ANALYSIS AND INTERPRETATION OF PROFITABILITY
analysing examining the financial reports in detail to identify changes or differences in performance interpreting examining the relationships between the items in the financial reports in order to explain the cause and effect of changes or differences in performance profitability the ability of the business to earn profit, as compared against a base, such as Sales, assets or owner’s equity liquidity the ability of the business to meet its short-term debts as they fall due efficiency the ability of the business to manage its assets and liabilities stability the ability of the business to meet its debts and continue its operations in the long term
4O THIS POINT WE HAVE DEVOTED MOST OF OUR TIME TO THE lRST THREE PHASES OF THE ACCOUNTINGPROCESSGATHERINGSOURCEDOCUMENTS RECORDINGTHEDATASOITISCLASSIlED AND SUMMARISED AND REPORTING THE INFORMATION THAT IS THEN GENERATED 4HIS CHAPTER CONCENTRATESONanalysingANDinterpretingTHEINFORMATIONCONTAINEDINTHEREPORTSIN ORDERTOPROVIDEADVICETOHELPTHEOWNERMAKEMOREINFORMEDDECISIONS )N ACCOUNTING TERMS ANALYSING INVOLVES EXAMINING THE REPORTS IN GREAT DETAIL TO identify changes or differences in performance WHILEINTERPRETINGINVOLVESEXAMINING THE RELATIONSHIPS BETWEEN THE ITEMS IN THE REPORTS IN ORDER TO EXPLAIN THE cause and effect of those changes or differences /NCE THE CAUSES AND EFFECTS OF CHANGES OR DIFFERENCESINPERFORMANCEAREUNDERSTOOD ACOURSEOFACTIONCANBERECOMMENDEDTO THEOWNERTOASSISTDECISION MAKING !NYANALYSISOFBUSINESSPERFORMANCEMUSTINCLUDEANASSESSMENTOF s profitabilitynTHEABILITYOFTHEBUSINESSTOEARNPROlT MEASUREDBYCOMPARINGITS PROlTAGAINSTABASE SUCHAS3ALES ASSETSOROWNERSEQUITY s liquiditynTHEABILITYOFTHEBUSINESSTOMEETITSSHORT TERMDEBTSASTHEYFALLDUE s efficiencynTHEABILITYOFTHEBUSINESSTOMANAGEITSASSETSANDLIABILITIES s stabilitynTHEABILITYOFTHEBUSINESSTOMEETITSDEBTSANDCONTINUEITS/PERATIONS INTHELONGTERM #LEARLY BUSINESS SURVIVAL DEPENDS ON HAVING BOTH SATISFACTORY PROlTABILITY AND SATISFACTORYLIQUIDITYAPROlTABLEBUSINESSWILLSTILLFAILIFITCANNOTPAYITSDEBTS 4HISCHAPTERCONCENTRATESONANASSESSMENTOFPROlTABILITY WHILELIQUIDITYISADDRESSED IN#HAPTER)NTHEPROCESS THElRMSEFlCIENCYANDSTABILITYWILLALSOBEASSESSED
Assessing profitability !TITSMOSTELEMENTAL AlRMSABILITYTOEARNPROlTISDEPENDENTONITSABILITYTO s EARNREVENUEAND s CONTROLEXPENSES #ONSEQUENTLY ANYASSESSMENTOFPROlTABILITYMUSTEXAMINETHElRMSPERFORMANCE INTHESETWOAREAS WITHANANALYSISOFTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTALOGICALSTARTINGPOINT (OWEVER ANASSESSMENTOFPROlTABILITYMUSTNOTCONCENTRATEONPROlTINDOLLARTERMS ALONE-ANYFACTORSMAYAFFECTAlRMSABILITYTOEARNREVENUEANDCONTROLITSEXPENSES ANDTHESIGNIlCANCEOFTHESEFACTORSMUSTBECONSIDEREDWHENASSESSINGPROlTABILITY 4HESIZEOFTHEBUSINESSINTERMSOFTHEASSETSITCONTROLS THESIZEOFTHEINVESTMENTBY THEOWNER ANDTHELEVELOF3ALESAREALLSIGNIlCANTINDETERMININGHOWMUCHPROlTA BUSINESSISableTOEARN &OREXAMPLE AlRMWITHASSETSOFUNDERITSCONTROLISLIKELYTOGENERATEA MUCHLARGERPROlTINDOLLARTERMS THANAlRMWITHONLYWORTHOFASSETSUNDER ITSCONTROL#OMPARINGTHESElRMSONTHEBASISOFPROlTALONEWILLNOTTELLUSWHICHONE ISMOREableTOUSEITSASSETSTOEARNPROlT ITWILLSIMPLYTELLUSTHATONElRMHADMORE ASSETSTOUSE(OWEVER IFTHEPROlTWASEXPRESSEDper dollar of assets ACOMPARISON OFTHEABILITYOFEACHlRMTOEARNPROlTIFITHADTHEsame asset baseWOULDBEPOSSIBLE SHOWINGWHICHWASMOREPROlTABLE 0ROlTABILITYISMORETHANASSESSINGTHElRMSPROlTITISABOUTASSESSINGTHElRMS capacityORabilityTOEARNPROlT ASSUMINGALLTHESEOTHERFACTORSWEREEQUAL%XPRESSING PROlTrelative to another measureALLOWSFORCOMPARISONSBETWEENDIFFERENTlRMS AND DIFFERENTPERIODS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 18
E VA L U AT I N G P R O F I TA B I L I T Y
429
/BVIOUSLY THE level OF PROlT IS AN IMPORTANT MEASURE OF PERFORMANCE AND AN ASSESSMENTOFPROlTABILITYMAYBEGINWITHANEXAMINATIONOFPROlT ANDTHEREVENUES ANDEXPENSESBYWHICHITWASDERIVED"UTITMUSTTHENGOFURTHERBYCOMPARINGTHAT PROlTAGAINSTABASEOFSOMESORTTOEXAMINETHElRMSABILITYTOUSEITS3ALES ITSASSETS ORTHEOWNERSCONTRIBUTIONTOEARNPROlT)NTHISSENSEPROlTABILITYISArelativemeasure
REVIEW QUESTIONS 18.1
1 Explain THE RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN ANALYSING AND INTERPRETING ACCOUNTING REPORTS 2 DefineTHEFOLLOWINGTERMS s PROlTABILITY s LIQUIDITY s EFlCIENCY s STABILITY 3 StateTHETWOBASICFACTORSONWHICHTHEABILITYTOEARNAPROlTISDEPENDENT 4 ExplainHOWPROlTABILITYCANBEASSESSEDBETWEENDIFFERENTlRMS
18.2 TOOLS FOR ASSESSING PROFITABILITY 4HEREAREVARIOUSTOOLSAVAILABLETOASSESSPROlTABILITY INCLUDING s TRENDS s VARIANCES s BENCHMARKS s PROlTABILITYINDICATORS
Trends 7EWILLBEGINANANALYSISOFPROlTABILITYBYANALYSINGCONSECUTIVE)NCOME3TATEMENTSTO IDENTIFYCHANGESINREVENUESANDEXPENSESFROMONEPERIODTOTHENEXT7HERECHANGES OVERANUMBEROFPERIODSFORMAPATTERN THISISKNOWNASAtrend
Clear View Windows has provided the following (summarised) Income Statements for the year ended 31 December:
trend the pattern formed by changes in an item over a number of periods
EXAMPLE
CLEAR VIEW WINDOWS Income Statement for the year ended 31 December 2014
2015
2016
100 000
112 000
115 000
Less Cost of Goods Sold
62 000
72 800
78 200
Gross Profit
38 000
39 200
36 800
700
600
500
Adjusted Gross Profit
37 300
38 600
36 300
Less Other Expenses
25 000
25 600
26 000
Net Profit
12 300
13 000
10 300
Sales
Less Stock Loss
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
430
UNITS 3&4
4HEREPORTSSHOWTHAT3ALESINCREASEDEVERYYEARlRSTBYFROMTO THENBYAFURTHERIN4HETRENDIN3ALESISFAVOURABLEITISHIGHEREVERYYEAR 4HETRENDIN3TOCK,OSSISALSOFAVOURABLEASITDECREASEDEVERYYEARANDTHEFACTTHAT THISHASHAPPENEDDESPITEHIGHERSALESISPARTICULARLYPLEASINGPERHAPSSTOCKCONTROL PROCEDURES WERE MORE EFFECTIVE (OWEVER THERE IS AN UNFAVOURABLE UPWARD TREND IN #OSTOF'OODS3OLDAND/THER%XPENSES!SACONSEQUENCE AINCREASEIN3ALES INRESULTEDINANINCREASEIN.ET0ROlTOFONLY AND.ET0ROlTISACTUALLYLOWER INDESPITE3ALESBEINGHIGHERTHANITWASIN )NORDERTOAIDTHEUnderstandabilityOFTHEACCOUNTINGINFORMATION TRENDSMAYBE PRESENTEDASLINEORBARGRAPHS4HISMAKESTHEMEASIERTOUNDERSTANDFORUSERSWHO HAVELITTLEORNOACCOUNTINGKNOWLEDGE&IGURESHOWSALINEGRAPHSHOWING3ALES 2EVENUE 'ROSS0ROlTAND.ET0ROlTFORTO Figure 18.1
Sales Revenue, Gross Profit and Net Profit
$120 000
Sales Revenue
$90 000 $60 000
Gross Profit
$30 000
Net Profit
$0 2014
2015
2016
Year
horizontal analysis comparing reports from one period to the next, and identifying the increase or decrease in specific items in the report
4HERISINGTRENDIN3ALESISCLEAR BUTTHEINCREASINGGAPBETWEEN3ALESAND.ET0ROlT ISCAUSEFORCONCERN )N THE PREVIOUS EXAMPLE BOTH 3ALES AND #OST OF 'OODS 3OLD INCREASED BUT THE FACTTHAT'ROSS0ROlTDECREASEDININDICATESTHAT#OSTOF'OODS3OLDINCREASED by more7ECANREACHTHISCONCLUSIONINTUITIVELY BUTPREPARINGAhorizontal analysis WILLSHOWTHENUMERICALPROOF!HORIZONTALANALYSISCALCULATESTHECHANGEINITEMSFROM ONEPERIODTOTHENEXT EXPRESSINGTHECHANGEINBOTHDOLLARANDPERCENTAGETERMSSO THATTHERELATIVESIZEOFTHECHANGESCANBEASSESSED5SINGTHEINFORMATIONABOVE THE HORIZONTALANALYSISOFTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTWOULDAPPEARASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 18.2
Horizontal analysis of the Income Statement Increase/ Decrease
Difference Difference $ %
2014
2015
100 000
112 000
Increase
12 000
12.0
Less Cost of Goods Sold
62 000
72 800
Increase
10 800
17.4
Gross Profit
38 000
39 200
Increase
1 200
3.2
700
600
Decrease
100
14.3
Adjusted Gross Profit
37 300
38 600
Increase
1300
3.5
Less Other Expenses
25 000
25 600
Increase
600
2.4
Net Profit
12 300
13 000
Increase
700
5.7
Sales
Less Stock Loss
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 18
E VA L U AT I N G P R O F I TA B I L I T Y
431
4HEPERCENTAGEDIFFERENCEISCALCULATEDBYDIVIDINGTHEdifferenceINDOLLARTERMS BY THEPREVIOUSYEARSlGUREFOREXAMPLE 3ALESX 4HEHORIZONTALANALYSISSHOWSTHATALTHOUGH3ALESHASINCREASEDBYIN #OST OF'OODS3OLDHASACTUALLYINCREASEDBYAlargerINCREASE ANDTHISHASLEDTO 'ROSS0ROlTONLYINCREASINGBY AND.ET0ROlTBYONLY!LTHOUGHREVENUE CAPACITYHASIMPROVED EXPENSECONTROLHASWORSENED
Variances 4RENDSHIGHLIGHTCHANGESINREVENUESANDEXPENSESFROMONEPERIODTOTHENEXT BUT THEYDONTALLOWTHEOWNERTOASSESSWHETHERTHEYHAVEMETTHElRMSGOALSFORTHAT PERIOD 4HIS ASSESSMENT IS PERFORMED USING A variance REPORT WHICH HIGHLIGHTS THE DIFFERENCEBETWEENACTUALANDBUDGETEDlGURES SOTHATPROBLEMAREASCANBEIDENTIlED AND ADDRESSED SEE #HAPTER )N THIS SENSE THESE REPORTS ARE INVALUABLE TOOLS FOR ASSESSINGPROlTABILITYBECAUSETHEYDRAWATTENTIONTOAREASINWHICHPERFORMANCEHAS BEENBELOWEXPECTATION
variance the difference between an actual figure and a budgeted figure, expressed as ‘favourable’ or ‘unfavourable’
Benchmarks )NTERMSOFPROlTANDPROlTABILITY ITISIMPOSSIBLETOSAYWHETHERARESULTISSATISFACTORY WITHOUTREFERENCETOAbenchmarkOFSOMESORT!BENCHMARKISANACCEPTABLESTANDARD AGAINSTWHICHTHElRMSACTUALPERFORMANCECANBEASSESSED4HEREISNOSETLEVELOF PROlTABILITYTHATISCONSIDEREDTOBESATISFACTORY BUTAlRMMAYCOMPAREITSACTUALPROlT PERFORMANCEAGAINST s Performance IN previous periods 4HIS ALLOWS FOR THE PREPARATION OF A HORIZONTAL ANALYSISANDIDENTIlCATIONOFTRENDS5SINGTHISBENCHMARKENABLESANASSESSMENTOF WHETHERPROlTABILITYHASimprovedORworsenedFROMONEPERIODTOTHENEXT s "UDGETED performance for the current year 4HIS ALLOWS FOR THE PREPARATION OF A VARIANCEREPORT ANDENABLESANASSESSMENTOFWHETHERPROlTABILITYWASsatisfactory ORunsatisfactoryINTERMSOFMEETINGTHElRMSGOALSEXPECTATIONS s Performance of other similar firms4HISISSOMETIMESEXPRESSEDASAN@INDUSTRYAVERAGE )TALLOWSTHElRMSPERFORMANCETOBECOMPAREDAGAINSTOTHERlRMSOPERATINGUNDER SIMILARCONDITIONS4HISISSOMETIMESKNOWNASAN@INTER lRMCOMPARISON
benchmark an acceptable standard against which the firm’s actual performance can be assessed
Profitability indicators )NADDITIONTOTHETOOLSOUTLINEDABOVE THEOWNERMAYASKTHEACCOUNTANTTOCALCULATE ANY NUMBER OF profitability indicators 4HESE ARE SOMETIMES KNOWN AS @PROlTABILITY RATIOS EVEN THOUGH MOST ARE ACTUALLY PRESENTED AS PERCENTAGES 4HESE INDICATORS EXPRESSANELEMENTOFPROlTin relation to some other aspect of business performance !SARESULT DIFFERENCESINPROlTABILITYBETWEENYEARSANDALSOBETWEENBUSINESSESCAN BEASSESSED ASTHEINDICATOREXPRESSESPROlTABILITYACCORDINGTOACOMMONBASE 4HISCOURSECONSIDERSTHEFOLLOWINGINDICATORS s 2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENT2/) s 2ETURNON!SSETS2/! s !SSET4URNOVER!4/ s .ET0ROlT-ARGIN.0- s 'ROSS0ROlT-ARGIN'0-
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
profitability indicators measures that express an element of profit in relation to some other aspect of business performance
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
432
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 18.2
1 DefineTHEFOLLOWINGTERMS s TREND s BENCHMARK s VARIANCE s PROlTABILITYINDICATOR 2 ExplainHOWTRENDSCANBEUSEDTOASSESSPROlTABILITY 3 ExplainHOWVARIANCESCANBEUSEDTOASSESSPROlTABILITY 4 DescribeTHREEBENCHMARKSTHATCANBEUSEDTOASSESSPROlTABILITY 5 ListlVEINDICATORSTHATCANBEUSEDTOASSESSPROlTABILITY
18.3 RETURN ON OWNER’S INVESTMENT (ROI) Return on Owner’s Investment (ROI) a profitability indicator that measures how effectively a business has used the owner’s capital to earn profit
&ROMANINVESTORSPOINTOFVIEW THEMAINMEASUREOFPROlTABILITYISReturn on Owner’s Investment (ROI) WHICHMEASURESTHEPROlTRETURN EARNEDPERDOLLAROFCAPITALINVESTED BYTHEOWNER!SARESULT ITINDICATESHOWEFFECTIVELYTHEBUSINESSHASUSEDTHEOWNERS FUNDSTOEARNPROlT WHICHISUSEFULINHELPINGTHEOWNERTODECIDEBETWEENALTERNATIVE INVESTMENTS Return on Owner’s Investment: formula Return on Owner’s Investment (ROI)
=
Net Profit
x
Average Capital
100
'IVENTHATTHE.ET0ROlTlGUREISEARNEDOVERAPERIOD BUTCAPITALISMEASUREDATA PARTICULARPOINTINTIME !VERAGE#APITALISUSEDINTHECALCULATIONOF2ETURNON/WNERS )NVESTMENTSOTHATANYINCREASESORDECREASESINCAPITALOVERTHEYEARAREACCOUNTEDFOR ANDISCALCULATEDAS
Average Capital
=
Capital at start + Capital at end 2
EXAMPLE
The following data was provided by two clothing stores. Carl’s Clothing
Anna’s Attire
$14 000
$10 000
Capital – 1 July 2014
72 000
41 000
Capital – 30 June 2015
68 000
39 000
Net Profit
#LEARLY#ARLS#LOTHINGHASEARNEDMOREPROlTTHAN!NNAS!TTIRE BUTHISINVESTMENT ISALSOHIGHER&ROMANINVESTORSPOINTOFVIEW WHICHISMOREPROlTABLE 4HE2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTFOREACHBUSINESSWOULDBECALCULATEDASISSHOWN IN&IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 18
Figure 18.3
E VA L U AT I N G P R O F I TA B I L I T Y
Calculating Return on Owner’s Investment (ROI) Carl’s Clothing
ROI
=
433
14 000 (72 000 + 68 000)/2
= =
14 000 70 000
Anna’s Attire x 100
ROI
x 100
=
10 000 (41 000 + 39 000)/2
=
20%
10 000 40 000
=
x 100
x 100 STUDY TIP
25%
4HE lGURES SHOW THAT DESPITE EARNING LESS PROlT !NNAS !TTIRE IS ACTUALLY MORE PROlTABLE FOR ITS OWNER FOR EVERY DOLLAR SHE HAS INVESTED !NNA OWNER EARNS PROlT WHEREAS FOR EVERY DOLLAR HE HAS INVESTED #ARL ONLY EARNS %VEN THOUGH #ARLHASEARNEDMOREPROlTTHAN!NNA HEHASHADTOMAKEASUBSTANTIALLYLARGER INVESTMENTOFHISOWNFUNDSTODOSO
7HENENTERINGTHESE lGURESINYOURCALCULATOR PRESS@BEFORE DIVIDING ORYOULLONLY DIVIDETHELASTlGURE NOTTHETOTAL BY
Benchmarks !SWITHMOSTPROlTABILITYINDICATORS THEREISNOSETLEVELATWHICH2ETURNON/WNERS )NVESTMENTWOULDBECONSIDEREDSATISFACTORY BUTITCOULDBECOMPAREDAGAINST s THE2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTFROMprevious periods s THEbudgeted2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENT s THE2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTOFsimilar businesses/alternative investments 4HISLASTBENCHMARKISPARTICULARLYIMPORTANT BECAUSE2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENT ASSESSESPROlTABILITYFROMANinvestor’sPOINTOFVIEW!LTHOUGHWEHAVEAPPROACHEDTHIS COURSEFROMTHEPERSPECTIVETHATTHEOWNERISALSOTHEOPERATOR WEMUSTNOTLOSESIGHT OFTHEFACTTHATTHEOWNERHASINVESTEDHISORHEROWNMONEYINTHEBUSINESS"YDOING SO THEOWNERHASGIVENUPTHEOPPORTUNITYTOINVESTELSEWHERE ANDTHEREFOREFORGONE THE RETURN THAT MIGHT BE EARNED BY INVESTING IN PROPERTY SHARES lNANCIAL PRODUCTS OROTHERVALUABLES SUCHASART WINE ANTIQUESOREVENSPORTINGMEMORABILIA&ORTHIS REASON THE2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTMUSTBECOMPARABLEWITHTHEINTERESTRATEON ATERMDEPOSIT THERENTEARNEDONPROPERTY THEDIVIDENDEARNEDONSHARES ORSIMPLY THERETURNEARNEDBYSIMILARBUSINESSES )NFACT GIVENTHERISKTHEOWNERTAKESBYINVESTING ANDTHELONGHOURSMANYOWNERS WORK HEORSHEMAYREQUIREA2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTTHATISHIGHERTHANTHESE ALTERNATIVEINVESTMENTS/NTHEOTHERHAND ASMALLBUSINESSOWNERMAYBEWILLINGTO ACCEPTASLIGHTLYLOWERRETURNASATRADE OFFFORTHESATISFACTIONTHATCOMESFROMRUNNING HISORHEROWNBUSINESS
Changes in Return on Owner’s Investment 2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTCANALSOBEUSEDTOASSESSCHANGESINPROlTABILITYFROM ONEPERIODTOTHENEXT
Filmore Doors has provided the following information relating to its trading activities for the year ended 31 December: 2015 Net Profit
$
6 400
EXAMPLE
2016 $
5 400
Average Capital
40 000
30 000
Return on Owner’s Investment
16%
18%
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
434
STUDY TIP
0ROlTABILITYINDICATORS ARETHEFUNCTIONOF WHATEVERISINTHEIRTOP LINEANDBOTTOMLINEIF THEINDICATORCHANGES ITISBECAUSEONE OR BOTH OFTHESELINES HASCHANGED
UNITS 3&4
)N PROlTDECREASEDBYFROMTO ANDYETTHE2ETURNON /WNERS)NVESTMENTINCREASEDFROMTOHOWISTHISPOSSIBLE4HEANSWERLIES INTHEFACTTHATTHEAVERAGE CAPITALDECREASEDTHEOWNERISEARNINGPROlTONASMALLER BASE4HISMAYMEANTHEBUSINESSISMORERELIANTONDEBTORHASAHIGHER$EBT2ATIO SEE3ECTION ANDTHUSTHERISKTOTHEBUSINESSISINCREASED BUTFROMTHEPOINTOF VIEWOFTHEOWNERASANINVESTOR ITRESULTSINIMPROVEDPROlTABILITY
REVIEW QUESTIONS 18.3
1 StateWHATISMEASUREDBY@2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENT2/) 2 ShowTHEFORMULATOCALCULATE2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENT 3 Explain WHY THE FORMULA TO CALCULATE 2ETURN ON /WNERS )NVESTMENT USES !VERAGE#APITAL 4 List THREE BENCHMARKS THAT COULD BE USED TO ASSESS THE ADEQUACY OF THE 2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENT 5 ExplainTHESIGNIlCANCEOFTHE@RETURNONSIMILARINVESTMENTSASABENCHMARK FORASSESSINGTHE2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENT 6 Explain HOW THE 2ETURN ON /WNERS )NVESTMENT CAN INCREASE EVEN THOUGH PROlTHASDECREASED
18.4 DEBT RATIO
Debt Ratio a stability indicator that measures the percentage of a firm’s assets that are financed by liabilities
STUDY TIP
4HE$EBT2ATIOIS SOMETIMESREFERREDTO AS@GEARING
3ECTIONREFERREDTOTHEFACTTHATTHE2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTCANINCREASE WITHOUT AN INCREASE IN PROlT IF THE OWNERS CAPITAL REDUCES 4HIS POINT ILLUSTRATES THAT THE2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTISNOTJUSTRELIANTONPROlT BUTALSODEPENDSONTHE lNANCIALSTRUCTUREOFTHEBUSINESSWHETHERITHASRELIEDONOWNERSCAPITALTOPURCHASE THEASSETSTHATEARNITSPROlT ORHASINSTEADRELIEDONBORROWEDFUNDS4HUS ANANALYSIS OFTHE2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTMUSTALSOINCLUDEANANALYSISOFTHE$EBT2ATIO 4HE Debt Ratio MEASURES THE PERCENTAGE OF A lRMS ASSETS THAT ARE lNANCED BY LIABILITIES AND THUS INDICATES THE EXTENT TO WHICH THE BUSINESS IS RELIANT ON LIABILITIES DEBTRATHERTHANOWNERSCAPITAL TOPURCHASEITSASSETS
Debt Ratio: formula Debt Ratio
=
Total liabilities Total assets
x
100
!HIGH$EBT2ATIOMEANSAGREATERRELIANCEONBORROWEDFUNDSLIABILITIES TOPURCHASE ASSETS AND CONSEQUENTLY A LOWER RELIANCE ON FUNDS CONTRIBUTED BY THE OWNER 4HIS WILLHAVEIMPLICATIONSFORTHElRMSPROlTABILITY ANDITS2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENT (OWEVER THE$EBT2ATIOISALSOAMEASUREOFTHElRMSLONG TERMSTABILITY ANDCANBE USEDTOEVALUATETHELEVELOFRISKASSOCIATEDWITHTHEBUSINESS
EXAMPLE
High Fashions Net Profit $ 8 000 Capital 32 000 Return on Owner’s Investment 24% Total liabilities 68 000 Total assets 100 000
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Low RIders $
8 000 80 000 10% 20 000 100 000
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 18
E VA L U AT I N G P R O F I TA B I L I T Y
!LTHOUGHBOTHlRMSHAVEEARNEDTHESAME.ET0ROlT THE2ETURNON/WNERS )NVESTMENTISHIGHERFOR(IGH&ASHIONS THANITISFOR,OW2IDERS 4HEREASON FORTHISDIFFERENCEISREVEALEDBYTHE$EBT2ATIOOFEACHBUSINESS Figure 18.4
Calculating Debt Ratio High Fashions
Debt Ratio
=
68 000
x 100
Low Riders Debt Ratio
=
68%
x 100
100 000
100 000 =
20 000
=
20%
!LTHOUGHBOTHlRMSARETHESAMESIZEWITHASSETSOFUNDERTHEIRCONTROL OFTHEASSETSOF(IGH&ASHIONSAREFUNDEDFROMLIABILITIES WITHTHEREMAINING lNANCED USING FUNDS FROM THE OWNERS CAPITAL 4HIS RELATIVELY HIGH $EBT 2ATIO AND THEREFORE LOW RELIANCE ON CAPITAL EXPLAINS WHY THE 2ETURN ON /WNERS )NVESTMENT OF (IGH &ASHIONS IS )T COULD HOWEVER MEAN THAT (IGH &ASHIONS IS EXPOSED TO A GREATERRISKOFlNANCIALCOLLAPSESEEBELOW &OR,OW2IDERS ONLYOFTHEASSETSAREFUNDEDFROMLIABILITIESWITHTHEMAJORITY lNANCEDBYTHEOWNER4HISLOWRELIANCEONDEBTMEANSLESSRISK BUTITALSOMEANS A HIGHER RELIANCE ON OWNERS CAPITAL AND THUS A LOWER 2ETURN ON /WNERS )NVESTMENT
Benchmarks )NASSESSINGTHE$EBT2ATIO ITSHOULDBECOMPAREDAGAINSTprevious reporting periods ANDTHEbudgeted$EBT2ATIO BUTTHECOMPARISONAGAINSTsimilar firmsISPARTICULARLY USEFUL AS BY DElNITION THEY OPERATE IN THE SAME INDUSTRY USING SIMILAR ASSETS AND SELLING SIMILAR PRODUCTS (OWEVER THE $EBT 2ATIO CANNOT BE ASSESSED IN ISOLATION IT SHOULDBEASSESSEDINCONJUNCTIONWITHTHE2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENT
The Debt Ratio: risk and return ! HIGHER $EBT 2ATIO MEANS THE lRM IS MORE HEAVILY RELIANT ON BORROWED FUNDS THAN IT IS ON THE OWNERS CAPITAL AND THIS IS ONE WAY OF INCREASING THE 2ETURN ON /WNERS )NVESTMENTWITHOUTACTUALLYINCREASINGPROlT7ITHAHIGHER$EBT2ATIO THEBUSINESSIS USINGSOMEONEELSESFUNDSTOBUYTHEASSETSTOEARNPROlT BUTTHEOWNERSTILLRECEIVES ALLTHATPROlT(OWEVER AHIGHER$EBT2ATIOMEANSTHEREISAHIGHERRISKTHATTHEBUSINESS WILLBEUNABLETOREPAYITSDEBTSANDMEETTHEINTERESTPAYMENTS&URTHER INTERESTRATE RISESCOULDHAVEASIGNIlCANTIMPACTONPROlTANDCASHASTHEBUSINESSISCARRYINGSO MUCHDEBT /NTHEOTHERHAND ALOW$EBT2ATIOMEANSTHElRMISNOTVERYRELIANTONBORROWED FUNDS ANDISTHEREFOREATRELATIVELYLOWRISKOFBEINGUNABLETOREPAYITSDEBTS(OWEVER ITALSOMEANSTHATMOSTOFTHElNANCEUSEDTOPURCHASEASSETSHASCOMEFROMTHEFUNDS OF THE OWNER AND AS THE OWNER HAS HAD TO CONTRIBUTE MORE PERSONAL FUNDS A LOWER 2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTWILLENSUE 4HEOWNERMUSTJUDGECAREFULLYSOTHATTHE$EBT2ATIOISHIGHENOUGHTOMAXIMISE THE2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENT BUTNOTTOOHIGHTHATITWILLCREATEDIFlCULTIESFORTHE BUSINESSINRELATIONTOITSDEBTBURDEN
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
435
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
436
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 18.4
1 2 3 4 5
ExplainWHATISMEASUREDBYTHE$EBT2ATIO ShowTHEFORMULATOCALCULATETHE$EBT2ATIO ExplainTHESIGNIlCANCEOF@SIMILARlRMSINASSESSINGTHE$EBT2ATIO ExplainWHYAHIGH$EBT2ATIOMEANSHIGHRISKOFlNANCIALCOLLAPSE ExplainWHYAHIGH$EBT2ATIOISLIKELYTORESULTINAHIGH2ETURNON/WNERS )NVESTMENT
18.5 RETURN ON ASSETS (ROA) Return on Assets (ROA) a profitability indicator that measures how effectively a business has used its assets to earn profit
7HEREAS 2ETURN ON /WNERS )NVESTMENT ASSESSES PROlTABILITY FROM AN investor’s POINT OFVIEW Return on Assets (ROA)ASSESSESPROlTABILITYFROMAmanager’sPOINTOFVIEW 3PECIlCALLY ITMEASURES.ET0ROlTPERDOLLAROFASSETSCONTROLLEDBYTHEBUSINESS!SA RESULT ITINDICATESHOWEFFECTIVELYTHElRMHASUSEDITSASSETSTOEARNPROlT
Return on Assets: formula Return on Assets (ROA)
=
Net Profit Average total assets
x
100
*USTASTHEFORMULAFOR2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTUSEDAVERAGECAPITAL 2ETURN ON!SSETSUSESAVERAGETOTALASSETS)FTOTALASSETSHASNOTCHANGEDSIGNIlCANTLYOVER THEPERIOD ORANAVERAGECANNOTBECALCULATED TOTALASSETSATTHEENDOFTHEPERIOD MAYBEUSED
EXAMPLE
The following data was provided by two similar book stores. Barry’s Books Net Profit Total assets – 1 January 2015 Total assets – 31 January 2015
$
15 000 73 000 77 000
Tina’s Texts $
18 700 105 000 115 000
4HElRSTPOINTTONOTEFROMTHElGURESISTHAT4INAS4EXTSHASEARNEDMOREPROlT BUTTHISMAYBESIMPLYBECAUSEITHASMOREASSETSTHATIS ITISALARGERBUSINESS ANDIS THEREFORECAPABLEOFGENERATINGLARGER3ALESANDPROlT"UTWHICHISMOREPROlTABLE 4HE 2ETURN ON !SSETS FOR EACH BUSINESS WOULD BE CALCULATED AS IS SHOWN IN &IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 18
Figure 18.5
E VA L U AT I N G P R O F I TA B I L I T Y
Calculating Return on Assets (ROA) Barry’s Books
ROA
=
437
15 000 (73 000 + 77 000)/2
= =
15 000 75 000 20%
Tina’s Texts x 100
x 100
ROA
=
18 700 (105 000 + 115 000)/2
= =
18 700 110 000
x 100
x 100
17%
4HElGURESSHOWTHATITISACTUALLY"ARRYS"OOKSTHATISMOREPROlTABLE ASITEARNS PROlTFROMEVERYDOLLAROFASSETSITCONTROLS WHEREAS4INAS4EXTSONLYEARNS PROlTPERDOLLAROFASSETS"ARRYISUSINGHISlRMSASSETSMOREEFFECTIVELYTOEARNPROlT ANDTHISCOULDBEFORANUMBEROFREASONSPERHAPSHISSTOCKISINHIGHERDEMAND ORHIS STOREISINABETTERLOCATION ORHISEXPENSECONTROLISBETTER!STHEMANAGER 4INAMAY WISHTOADOPTSOMEOF"ARRYSSTRATEGIESIFHEISWILLINGTOTELL
Benchmarks 4HEPRECEDINGEXAMPLEUSEDTHE2ETURNON!SSETSOFAsimilar businessASABENCHMARK BUTITCOULDALSOBEASSESSEDAGAINSTTHE2ETURNON!SSETSFROMprevious periods ORTHE budgeted2ETURNON!SSETS
Return on Owner’s Investment and Return on Assets
STUDY TIP
!SMANYSMALLBUSINESSOWNERSAREBOTHINVESTORSANDMANAGERS THEYWILLNEEDTOLOOK AT BOTH THE 2ETURN ON /WNERS )NVESTMENT AND THE 2ETURN ON !SSETS WHEN ASSESSING PROlTABILITY /NE THING THEY WILL NOTICE IS THAT THE 2ETURN ON /WNERS )NVESTMENT WILL ALWAYSBEhigherTHANTHE2ETURNON!SSETS4HISISBECAUSEOWNERSEQUITYWILLALWAYS BELOWERTHANTOTALASSETS WHICHINTURNISDUETOITSBORROWINGSnITSLIABILITIES/NLY INAlRMTHATHASNOLIABILITIES WHICHISEXTREMELYUNLIKELY WILLTHE2ETURNON/WNERS )NVESTMENTBETHESAMEASTHE2ETURNON!SSETS
4HEEXACTSIZEOFTHE GAPBETWEEN2/)AND 2/!WILLDEPENDONTHE lRMS$EBT2ATIO
Changes in Return on Assets 7HENASSESSINGCHANGESINTHE2ETURNON!SSETS ITISIMPORTANTTOKEEPINMINDTHE lGURESTHATAREUSEDINITSFORMULAONTHETOPLINE THEPROlTTHEBUSINESSHASEARNED ANDONTHEBOTTOM THEASSETSITCONTROLS)FASSETSINCREASE AND.ET0ROlTINCREASES BY A SMALLER PROPORTION THEN THE 2ETURN ON !SSETS WILL FALL INDICATING DETERIORATING PROlTABILITY/NTHEOTHERHAND IF.ET0ROlTINCREASESBYMORETHANASSETS THE2ETURN ON!SSETSWILLRISE INDICATINGIMPROVEDPROlTABILITY 4HE .ET 0ROlT lGURE ITSELF IS RELIANT ON THE TWO BASIC FACTORS WE IDENTIlED EARLIER EARNINGREVENUEANDCONTROLLINGEXPENSES4HEREFORE ASSUMINGASSETSDONOTCHANGE ANIMPROVEMENTINTHE2ETURNON!SSETSMAYBETHERESULTOFANIMPROVEDABILITYTO EARNREVENUEORBETTEREXPENSECONTROL ORBOTH!DETERIORATIONINTHE2ETURNON!SSETS WOULD OF COURSE BE CAUSED BY THE OPPOSITE %ITHER WAY THE 2ETURN ON !SSETS WILL DEPENDHEAVILYONTHElRMSABILITYTOEARNREVENUEANDCONTROLITSEXPENSES SOTHISIS THENEXTPHASEINOURANALYSISOFPROlTABILITY
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
438
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 18.5
1 StateWHATISMEASUREDBY2ETURNON!SSETS2/! 2 ShowTHEFORMULATOCALCULATE2ETURNON!SSETS 3 List THREE BENCHMARKS THAT COULD BE USED TO ASSESS THE ADEQUACY OF THE 2ETURNON!SSETS 4 ExplainWHY2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTWILLALWAYSBEHIGHERTHAN2ETURN ON!SSETS 5 IdentifyTWOFACTORSTHATCOULDCAUSEANINCREASEINTHE2ETURNON!SSETS
18.6 EARNING REVENUE: ASSET TURNOVER (ATO) Asset Turnover (ATO) an efficiency indicator that measures how productively a business has used its assets to earn revenue
4ECHNICALLY Asset Turnover (ATO)ISANefficiencyINDICATORITINDICATESHOWEFlCIENTLY THElRMHASUSEDITASSETSTOGENERATEREVENUE"UTASEARNINGREVENUEISONEOFTHEKEYS TOEARNINGPROlT !SSET4URNOVERWILLHAVEADIRECTANDSIGNIlCANTEFFECTONPROlTABILITY Asset Turnover: formula Asset Turnover (ATO)
=
Sales Average total assets
3PECIlCALLY THIS INDICATOR MEASURES THE NUMBER OF TIMES IN A PERIOD THE VALUE OF ASSETSISEARNEDAS3ALESREVENUETHEHIGHERTHE!SSET4URNOVER THEMORECAPABLETHE lRMISOFUSINGITSASSETSTOEARNREVENUE
EXAMPLE
Pino’s Plant Nursery has provided the following information relating to its trading activities for the year ended 30 June: 2015 Sales revenue Average total assets
$
96 000 80 000
2016 $
121 500 90 000
!VERAGEASSETSINCREASEDBY IN SOANINCREASEIN3ALESREVENUEIS EXPECTED(OWEVER HASTHElRMUSEDTHESEEXTRAASSETSMOREORLESSPRODUCTIVELYTHAN ITDIDIN 4HE!SSET4URNOVERFOREACHBUSINESSWOULDBECALCULATEDASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 18.6
Calculating Asset Turnover (ATO) 2015
ATO ATO
=
ATO
=
96 000
2016 =
80 000
ATO ATO
1.2 times
ATO
=
121 500 90 000 1.35 times
)N THEBUSINESSEARNEDTIMESTHEVALUEOFITSASSETSASREVENUE ANDTHIS HASRISENTOTIMESIN4HISCONlRMSTHAT0INOS0LANT.URSERYHASEARNEDMORE REVENUEINNOTONLYBECAUSEITHASMOREASSETS BUTBECAUSEITHASUSEDTHOSE ASSETSMOREPRODUCTIVELY ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 18
E VA L U AT I N G P R O F I TA B I L I T Y
439
Benchmarks 4HE PRECEDING EXAMPLE COMPARED !SSET 4URNOVER AGAINST A previous period BUT IT COULDEQUALLYBEASSESSEDAGAINSTTHEbudgeted!SSET4URNOVER ORTHE!SSET4URNOVER OFsimilar businesses)NCASESWHEREANEXPANSIONISPLANNED ANDAVERAGEASSETSARE EXPECTEDTOINCREASE BUDGETED!SSET4URNOVERMAYBETHEBESTBENCHMARKTOUSEFOR ASSESSMENT ASITREmECTSTHElRMSGOALFORINCREASED3ALESREVENUEONAGREATERASSET BASE
Asset Turnover and Return on Assets 4HESIMILARITYBETWEEN!SSET4URNOVERANDTHE2ETURNON!SSETSREmECTSTHEFACTTHATTHEY BOTHASSESSTHElRMSABILITYTOUSEITSASSETSTHEONLYDIFFERENCEBEINGTHAT2ETURNON !SSETSRELATESTOprofit WHEREAS!SSET4URNOVERRELATESONLYTOrevenue4HEORETICALLY AN INCREASEIN!SSET4URNOVERMEANINGANINCREASEDABILITYTOEARN3ALESREVENUE SHOULD MEANANINCREASEINTHE2ETURNON!SSETS ANDINCREASED.ET0ROlT(OWEVER THISISNOT ALWAYSTHECASE ,ETUSRETURNTOTHEPREVIOUSEXAMPLE0INOS0LANT.URSERY WITHADDITIONALINFORMATION PROVIDED
2015 Sales revenue Net Profit Average total assets Asset Turnover Return on Assets
$ 96 400 12 000 80 000 1.2 times 15%
EXAMPLE
2016 $ 121 500 12 600 90 000 1.35 times 14%
STUDY TIP
!SNOTEDPREVIOUSLY THE!SSET4URNOVERSHOWSTHEBUSINESSISMOREPRODUCTIVE IN TERMSOFUSINGITSASSETSTOEARNREVENUE IN(OWEVER THElGURESSHOWTHATINSPITE OFTHISINCREASEIN!SSET4URNOVER PROlTABILITYASMEASUREDBYTHE2ETURNON!SSETS HAS ACTUALLYFALLENBYPERCENTAGEPOINT 4HEONLYDIFFERENCEBETWEENTHE!SSET4URNOVER ANDTHE2ETURNON!SSETSISTHEDIFFERENCEBETWEEN3ALES2EVENUEAND.ET0ROlT IE EXPENSES 4HEREFORE WHERE THE !SSET 4URNOVER AND THE 2ETURN ON !SSETS MOVE IN DIFFERENT DIRECTIONS OR TO DIFFERING DEGREES IT INDICATES A change in expense control )N THIS EXAMPLE THE !SSET 4URNOVER INCREASED AND THE 2ETURN ON !SSETS DECREASED INDICATINGWORSEEXPENSECONTROL
7HENINDICATORSARE ALREADYEXPRESSED ASPERCENTAGES THE CHANGESHOULDBE DESCRIBEDINTERMSOF PERCENTAGEPOINTS
REVIEW QUESTIONS 18.6
1 StateWHATISMEASUREDBY!SSET4URNOVER!4/ 2 ShowTHEFORMULATOCALCULATE!SSET4URNOVER 3 ListTHREEBENCHMARKSTHATCOULDBEUSEDTOASSESSTHEADEQUACYOFAlRMS !SSET4URNOVER 4 ExplainHOWTHERELATIONSHIPBETWEENAlRMS!SSET4URNOVERANDITS2ETURN ON!SSETSCANBEUSEDTOASSESSITSEXPENSECONTROL
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
440
UNITS 3&4
18.7 CONTROLLING EXPENSES
expense control the firm’s ability to manage its expenses so that they either decrease or, in the case of variable expenses, increase no faster than Sales revenue
7ENOTEDIN#HAPTERTHATEXPENSESSHOULDNOTNECESSARILYBELOOKEDONAS@BAD BECAUSETHEYASSISTINTHEEARNINGOFREVENUE4HISDOESNOTMEANTHATTHElRMSHOULD BE HAPPY TO SEE MORE AND MORE OF ITS 3ALES REVENUE BEING CONSUMED BY EXPENSES !FTERALL EVERYDOLLARTHATISCONSUMEDBYEXPENSESMEANSONEDOLLARLESS.ET0ROlT 4HISMEANSTHElRMSABILITYTOCONTROLITSEXPENSESISAKEYFACTORINITSABILITYTOEARN PROlT Expense controlREFERSTOTHElRMSABILITYTOMANAGEITSEXPENSESSOTHATTHEYEITHER DECREASE ORINCREASENOFASTERTHAN3ALESREVENUE4HISLASTPOINTMAYSEEMALITTLEODD WHYSHOULDTHEOWNERSETTLEFORANYTHINGLESSTHANAREDUCTIONINEXPENSES2EMEMBER THATINTHEPURSUITOFGREATER3ALES ITISUNAVOIDABLETHATSOMEEXPENSESWILLINCREASE %XPENSESSUCHAS#OSTOF3ALESAND7AGESVARYDIRECTLYWITHTHELEVELOF3ALES SOITIS LOGICALTHATAS3ALESVOLUMEINCREASES THESEEXPENSESWILLINCREASETOO0ROVIDEDTHEY DONOTINCREASEmoreTHAN3ALES WECANCONSIDERTHISTOBEEVIDENCEOFSATISFACTORY EXPENSECONTROL3HOULDTHEYACTUALLYINCREASEBYlessTHAN3ALES WEWOULDCONSIDER THISTOBEEVIDENCEOFIMPROVEDEXPENSECONTROL )FEXPENSECONTROLIMPROVES THENPROlTABILITYSHOULDALSOIMPROVE7EWILLEVALUATE EXPENSECONTROLBYANALYSINGTWOINDICATORSTHATCALCULATETHEPERCENTAGEOFEACHDOLLAR OF3ALESTHATISRETAINEDASPROlT s .ET0ROlT-ARGIN.0- s 'ROSS0ROlT-ARGIN'0- )NASSESSINGTHESEINDICATORS WEWILLUSETHEBENCHMARKSESTABLISHEDEARLIERINTHIS CHAPTER NAMELY s PERFORMANCEIN previous periods s budgetedPERFORMANCE s PERFORMANCEOFsimilar firms
REVIEW QUESTIONS 18.7
1 DefineTHETERM@EXPENSECONTROL 2 StateTWOREASONSWHYTHEOWNEROFASMALLBUSINESSWILLTOLERATEINCREASESIN SOMEEXPENSES 3 StateTWOPROlTABILITYINDICATORSTHATASSESSEXPENSECONTROL
18.8 NET PROFIT MARGIN (NPM)
Net Profit Margin (NPM) a profitability indicator that measures expense control by calculating the percentage of Sales revenue that is retained as Net Profit
#OMPETITIONINMANYMARKETSMEANSTHATEARNINGREVENUEISACHALLENGINGEXERCISEFOR MOSTSMALLBUSINESSES7ITHTHISINMIND ITISVITALTHATONCEASALEISMADE THEBUSINESS RETAINSASMUCHOFTHATREVENUEASPROlTASISPOSSIBLE4HE Net Profit Margin (NPM) MEASURESTHEPERCENTAGEOF3ALESREVENUETHATISRETAINEDAS.ET0ROlT0UTANOTHER WAY ITMEASURESHOWMUCHOFEACHDOLLAROF3ALESREVENUEREMAINSAS.ET0ROlTAFTER EXPENSESAREDEDUCTED!SARESULT ITISAGOODINDICATOROFEXPENSECONTROL
Net Profit Margin: formula Net Profit Margin (NPM)
=
Net Profit Sales revenue
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
x
100
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 18
E VA L U AT I N G P R O F I TA B I L I T Y
441
$UETODIFFERENCESIN3ALESREVENUE COMPARING.ET0ROlTBETWEENBUSINESSESAND BETWEEN PERIODS CAN BE DIFlCULT IT IS DIFlCULT TO ISOLATE HOW MUCH OF THE DIFFERENCE IS DUE TO EXPENSE CONTROL AND HOW MUCH IS SIMPLY DUE TO DIFFERENT 3ALES REVENUE "ECAUSETHISINDICATOREXPRESSES.ET0ROlTper dollar of Sales ITCANIDENTIFYCHANGESIN PROlTINDEPENDENTOFCHANGESIN3ALESREVENUE
EXAMPLE
Misha’s Shoe Barn has provided the following information from its Income Statement for the year ended 30 June: 2015 Sales revenue Net Profit
$ 72 000 14 400
2016 $ 80 000 15 200
!SWEWOULDEXPECT HIGHER3ALESREVENUEINHASGENERATEDEXTRAPROlT BUT HASITGENERATEDenoughEXTRAPROlT(ASEXPENSECONTROLCHANGED 4HE.ET0ROlT-ARGINFOREACHYEARWOULDBECALCULATEDASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 18.7
Calculating Net Profit Margin (NPM) 2015
NPM
=
14 400
2016 NPM
x 100
=
x 100
80 000
72 000 =
15 200
=
20%
19%
STUDY TIP
4HElGURESTELLUSTHATIN COFEVERYDOLLAROF3ALESREVENUEWASRETAINEDAS .ET0ROlT BUTINTHISFELLTOCPERDOLLAR!LTERNATIVELY CWASCONSUMEDBY EXPENSESIN ANDTHISINCREASEDTOCIN4HISMEANSTHATEXPENSECONTROL WASWORSEIN
$EDUCTINGTHE.0- FROMWILLREVEALTHE PERCENTAGEOFEACH 3ALESDOLLARTHATIS CONSUMEDBYEXPENSES
Net Profit Margin, Asset Turnover and Return on Assets 4HEEARLIERDISCUSSIONOF2ETURNON!SSETSHIGHLIGHTEDTHATTHEABILITYOFAlRMTOUSE ITSASSETSTOEARNPROlTDEPENDSONITSABILITYBOTHTOEARNREVENUEANDTOCONTROLITS EXPENSES7ENOWHAVEANINDICATORTHATMEASURESEACHOFTHESEFACTORS s Asset TurnoverMEASURESTHEABILITYOFTHElRMTOUSEITSASSETSTOEARNREVENUE s Net Profit MarginMEASURESTHEABILITYOFTHElRMTOCONTROLITSEXPENSESANDRETAIN 3ALESREVENUEAS.ET0ROlT 4HUS 2ETURNON!SSETSDEPENDSONBOTHTHE!SSET4URNOVERANDTHE.ET0ROlT-ARGIN 4HISRELATIONSHIPISBORNEOUTMATHEMATICALLYTOO)FWEMULTIPLYTHE!SSET4URNOVER ANDTHE.ET0ROlT-ARGIN WEGET
= =
ATO
x
NPM
Sales revenue Average total assets
x
Net Profit Sales revenue
Net Profit Average total assets
WHICH OFCOURSE ISTHEFORMULAFOR2ETURNON!SSETS ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
442
UNITS 3&4
@#ANCELLING DOWN PROVES THAT THE 2ETURN ON !SSETS AND THEREFORE PROlTABILITY DEPENDSONTHEABILITYOFTHElRMTOUSEITSASSETSTOEARNREVENUEASMEASUREDBY !SSET4URNOVER ANDTOCONTROLITSEXPENSESASMEASUREDBYTHE.ET0ROlT-ARGIN
REVIEW QUESTIONS 18.8
1 StateWHATISMEASUREDBYTHE.ET0ROlT-ARGIN.0- 2 ShowTHEFORMULATOCALCULATETHE.ET0ROlT-ARGIN 3 ExplainTHERELATIONSHIPBETWEEN!SSET4URNOVER .ET0ROlT-ARGINAND2ETURN ON!SSETS
18.9 GROSS PROFIT MARGIN (GPM)
Gross Profit Margin (GPM) a profitability indicator that measures the average mark-up by calculating the percentage of Sales revenue that is retained as Gross Profit
"ECAUSETHE.ET0ROlT-ARGINUSESNet0ROlTINITSCALCULATION ITCANBEUSEDTOASSESS OVERALLEXPENSECONTROL)FGross0ROlTISUSEDINSTEAD WEAREABLETOASSESSEXPENSE CONTROLSPECIlCALLYASITRELATESTOSTOCKAND#OSTOF'OODS3OLD4HUS THEGross Profit Margin (GPM)MEASURESTHEPERCENTAGEOF3ALESREVENUETHATISRETAINEDASGross0ROlT
Gross Profit Margin: formula Gross Profit Margin (GPM)
=
Gross Profit
x
Sales revenue
100
'ROSS0ROlTISTHEDIFFERENCEBETWEEN3ALESREVENUEAND#OSTOF'OODS3OLD ANDIS USEDTOASSESSTHEADEQUACYOFTHElRMSMARK UPTHEDIFFERENCEBETWEENTHESELLING PRICEANDTHECOSTPRICEOFITSSTOCK4HEREFORE THE'ROSS0ROlT-ARGINCANBEUSEDTO ASSESSTHEAVERAGEMARK UPONALLGOODSSOLDDURINGAPARTICULARPERIOD ,ETS REFER BACK TO OUR EARLIER EXAMPLE n -ISHAS 3HOE "ARN n WITH SOME EXTRA INFORMATIONNOWAVAILABLE
EXAMPLE Sales revenue Gross Profit Net Profit Net Profit Margin
2015
2016
$ 72 000 38 160 14 400 20%
$ 80 000 44 800 15 200 19%
"Y CALCULATING THE .ET 0ROlT -ARGIN WE ESTABLISHED THAT ALTHOUGH .ET 0ROlT INCREASED THISWASONLYDUETOHIGHER3ALES)NFACT THE.ET0ROlT-ARGINFELLIN INDICATINGWORSEEXPENSECONTROL3OWHICHEXPENSES ISARE THECAUSE 4HE'ROSS0ROlT-ARGINFOREACHYEARWOULDBECALCULATEDASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 18.8
Calculating Gross Profit Margin 2015
GPM
=
38 160
2016 x 100
GPM
=
53%
x 100
80 000
72 000 =
44 800
=
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
56% Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 18
E VA L U AT I N G P R O F I TA B I L I T Y
443
)N COFEACHDOLLAROF3ALESWASRETAINEDAS'ROSS0ROlT)N THISROSETO CPERDOLLAR REmECTINGAHIGHERAVERAGEMARK UP0UTANOTHERWAY COFEVERY3ALES DOLLARWASCONSUMEDBY#OSTOF'OODS3OLDINLESSC#OSTOF'OODS3OLD C'ROSS0ROlT BUTTHISFELLTOCPERDOLLARIN7HY!LTHOUGH3ALESREVENUE AND'ROSS0ROlTBOTHINCREASED 'ROSS0ROlTINCREASEDPROPORTIONALLY MORE DUETOA PROPORTIONALLY SMALLERINCREASEIN#OSTOF'OODS3OLD 'IVENTHATTHE'ROSS0ROlT-ARGININCREASED POORCONTROLOF#OSTOF'OODS3OLDIS notRESPONSIBLEFORTHEDECREASEINTHE.ET0ROlTRATEWEWILLHAVETOINVESTIGATETHE /THER%XPENSES
Changes in mark-up !HIGHER'ROSS0ROlT-ARGINMEANSAHIGHERAVERAGEMARK UPONAVERAGE ABIGGER GAPBETWEENSELLINGANDCOSTPRICES4HISCOULDOCCURIF s SELLINGPRICESINCREASEDANDCOSTPRICESREMAINEDCONSTANT s COSTPRICESDECREASED ANDSELLINGPRICESREMAINEDCONSTANT s BOTHINCREASED BUTSELLINGPRICESINCREASEDBYMORE s BOTHDECREASED BUTCOSTPRICESDECREASEDBYMORE )NCREASINGSELLINGPRICESWILLINCREASETHEAVERAGEMARK UP BUTITCARRIESTHERISKOF LOWERINGDEMAND ANDTHUSREDUCINGTHEVOLUMEOF3ALES4HISCOULDMEANTHATWHILE THE'ROSS0ROlTMarginINCREASES 'ROSSProfitINDOLLARS MAYACTUALLYDECREASE4HATIS THEBUSINESSMAYMAKEMORE'ROSS0ROlTper item BUTMAKEFEWERACTUAL3ALES)FTHE DROPINTHENUMBEROF3ALESOUTWEIGHSTHEINCREASEINPROlTPERITEM 'ROSS0ROlTWILL ACTUALLYFALL &INDINGACHEAPERSUPPLIERWILLAVOIDTHISRISK BUTITCARRIESARISKOFITSOWN)FTHE QUALITY OF THE STOCK IS REDUCED THIS COULD CAUSE A DECREASE IN 3ALES OR AN INCREASE IN3ALESRETURNSOR3TOCK,OSSESTHROUGHDAMAGE !LLTHESEFACTORSCOULDPOTENTIALLY UNDERMINETHEBENElTSOFAHIGHERAVERAGEMARK UP4HISDOESNOTMEANTHEBUSINESS SHOULDNOTLOOKFORACHEAPERSUPPLIER BUTITDOESMEANTHEBUSINESSMUSTBEVIGILANT ABOUTTHEQUALITYOFITSSTOCK !SSUMINGTHEBUSINESSCANMAINTAINITS3ALESVOLUMETHENUMBEROF3ALESITMAKES AND CUSTOMER SATISFACTION A HIGHER MARK UP WILL MEAN NOT ONLY A HIGHER 'ROSS 0ROlT -ARGIN BUTALSOAHIGHER'ROSS0ROlT
REVIEW QUESTIONS 18.9
1 2 3 4
StateWHATISMEASUREDBYTHE'ROSS0ROlT-ARGIN'0- ShowTHEFORMULATOCALCULATETHE'ROSS0ROlT-ARGIN ExplainTWOWAYSABUSINESSCOULDINCREASEITSAVERAGEMARK UP ExplainHOWANINCREASEINMARK UPCOULDLEADTOADECREASEIN'ROSS0ROlT
18.10
VERTICAL ANALYSIS OF THE INCOME STATEMENT
7HEN WE CALCULATED THE .ET 0ROlT -ARGIN AND 'ROSS 0ROlT -ARGIN WE DIVIDED THE vertical analysis APPROPRIATEPROlTlGUREBY3ALESREVENUE4HISALLOWEDUSTOEVALUATEEXPENSECONTROL a report that expresses BYASSESSINGWHATHADHAPPENEDTOEACHDOLLAROF3ALESREVENUE4HISAPPROACHCANBE every item as a percentage APPLIEDTOEVERYITEMINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTINWHATISKNOWNASAvertical analysis of a base figure; in this 4HEVERTICALANALYSISFOR-ISHAS3HOE"ARNISSHOWNIN&IGURE case, Sales revenue
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
444
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
Figure 18.9
UNITS 3&4
Vertical analysis of the Income Statement MISHA’S SHOE BARN Income Statement for the year ended 30 June 2015
2016
$
%
$
%
Sales Revenue
72 000
100
80 000
100
Less Cost of Goods Sold
33 840
47
35 200
44
Gross Profit
38 160
53
44 800
56
720
1
800
1
37 440
52
44 000
55
12 240
17
16 800
21
Rent
7 200
10
7 200
9
Advertising
3 600
5
4 800
6
14 400
20
15 200
19
Less Stock Loss Adjusted Gross Profit Less Other Expenses Wages
Net Profit
"YCOMPARINGTHEVERTICALANALYSISFROMONEYEARTOTHENEXT WECANSEECHANGES NOTJUSTINEXPENSEamountsASWOULDBESHOWNINAHORIZONTALANALYSIS BUTCHANGES INEXPENSESASApercentage of Sales4HATIS ITSHOWSWHATEACHREVENUEANDEXPENSE WOULDBEif Sales had been constant 4HISVERTICALANALYSISCONlRMSWHATWEIDENTIlEDBYCALCULATINGTHE.ET0ROlT-ARGIN AND'ROSS0ROlT-ARGIN s 3ALESREVENUEINCREASEDBY ANDTHISLEDTOANINCREASEIN.ET0ROlTOF (OWEVER THE .ET 0ROlT -ARGIN DECREASED FROM TO INDICATING A SLIGHT DETERIORATIONINEXPENSECONTROL s 4HE'ROSS0ROlT-ARGININCREASEDFROMTO INDICATINGAHIGHERAVERAGE MARK UP s !LTHOUGH 3TOCK ,OSS INCREASED THIS WAS IN PROPORTION TO THE INCREASE IN 3ALES REVENUE SO AS A PERCENTAGE OF REVENUE IT WAS CONSTANT AT %XPENSE CONTROL HEREWASSATISFACTORY s (IGHER3ALESLEDTOHIGHERWAGES BUTTHEEXPENSEINCREASEDPROPORTIONATELYMORE THAN3ALESREVENUE INCREASINGFROMTOOF3ALESREVENUE4HESAMEAPPLIES TOADVERTISING WHICHINCREASEDFROMTOOF3ALESREVENUE s !SAlXEDEXPENSE RENTWASCONSTANTINDOLLARTERMS BUTAS3ALESREVENUEINCREASED ITABSORBEDLESSOFEACHDOLLAROF3ALES DECREASINGFROMTO
Using graphs 'IVENTHATNOTALLBUSINESSOWNERSAREACCOUNTANTS PRESENTINGAVERTICALANALYSISINAPIE CHARTISONEWAYOFENSURINGUnderstandabilityINTHEACCOUNTINGREPORTS&IGURE SHOWSTHEPIECHARTFOR
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 18
Figure 18.10
E VA L U AT I N G P R O F I TA B I L I T Y
445
Graphical representation of vertical analysis Cost of Goods Sold Wages Net Profit Rent Advertising Stock Loss
4HISPIECHARTSHOWSTHAT#OSTOF'OODS3OLDISCLEARLYTHEMOSTSIGNIlCANTEXPENSE CONSUMING ALMOST HALF OF EVERY 3ALES DOLLAR SO ACTION HERE MAY PROVE VERY EFFECTIVE INTERMSOFIMPROVINGPROlTABILITY/NTHEOTHERHAND 3TOCK,OSSSHOWNINYELLOW IS RELATIVELYSMALL SOEVENIFSTOCKMANAGEMENTWASIMPROVEDSIGNIlCANTLY ONLYASMALL IMPROVEMENTINPROlTABILITYISLIKELY
REVIEW QUESTIONS 18.10
1 ExplainWHATISSHOWNINAVERTICALANALYSISOFTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT 2 ExplainONEBENElTOFPREPARINGAVERTICALANALYSISASAPIECHART
18.11
NON-FINANCIAL INFORMATION
4HE ASSESSMENT OF PROlTABILITY IN THIS CHAPTER HAS RELIED PRIMARILY ON THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT ANDPROlTABILITYINDICATORS WHICHARETHEMSELVESDERIVEDINLARGEPARTFROM THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT 4HESE ARE OBVIOUSLY VERY IMPORTANT IN EVALUATING PROlTABILITY BUTWENEEDTOBEMINDFULTHATTHEREARELIMITSONTHEABILITYOFTHISINFORMATIONTOASSIST THEOWNERINMAKINGlNANCIALDECISIONS4HESEINCLUDETHEFACTTHAT s THEREPORTSUSEhistorical datanTHEYDONOTGUARANTEEWHATWILLHAPPENINTHEFUTURE s MANY INDICATORS RELY ON averages AND THIS MAY CONCEAL DETAILS ABOUT INDIVIDUAL ITEMS s lRMSUSEdifferent accounting methods WHICHCANUNDERMINETHEComparabilityOF THEREPORTS ANDPROlTABILITYINDICATORSAND • THEreports contain limited informationTHEREAREMANYITEMSOFINFORMATIONSIMPLY NOTREPORTEDINAN)NCOME3TATEMENT !S A CONSEQUENCE OF THESE LIMITATIONS THE OWNER SHOULD NOT RELY ON PROlTABILITY INDICATORSANDTHE)NCOME3TATEMENTALONE)NFACT non-financial information CANBE JUSTASIMPORTANTINAIDINGDECISION MAKING Non-financial informationISAFAIRLYBROADTERMCOVERINGBASICALLYANYINFORMATION THATISNOTEXPRESSEDINDOLLARSANDCENTS ORRELIANTONDOLLARSANDCENTSFORITSCALCULATION )TREFERSTOINFORMATIONTHATCANNOTBEFOUNDINTHElNANCIALSTATEMENTS4HETYPESOF NON lNANCIAL INFORMATION THAT COULD BE USEFUL TO THE OWNER OF A SMALL BUSINESS ARE IMPOSSIBLE TO QUANTIFY BUT IN ASSESSING THE lRMS PERFORMANCE THE OWNER MAY WANT INFORMATIONABOUTTHEFOLLOWING
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
non-financial information any information that cannot be found in the financial statements, and is not expressed in dollars and cents, or reliant on dollars and cents for its calculation
Cambridge University Press
446
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
The firm’s relationship with its customers 'IVENTHEDIFlCULTIESTHEYFACEINATTRACTINGCUSTOMERS ITISVITALTHATSMALLBUSINESSES RETAIN THOSE CUSTOMERS THEY ALREADY HAVE )T IS THEREFORE ESSENTIAL TO HAVE FEEDBACK FROMCURRENTCUSTOMERSONTHEIRDEGREEOFSATISFACTIONORDISSATISFACTION WITHCURRENT PRODUCTSANDSERVICESOFFEREDBYTHElRM#USTOMERSATISFACTIONSURVEYSAREDESIGNED FORTHISPURPOSE BUTOTHERMEASURESCOULDBEUSED SUCHAS s NUMBEROFREPEATSALES s NUMBEROFSALESRETURNS s NUMBEROFCUSTOMERCOMPLAINTS s NUMBEROFSALESENQUIRIESCATALOGUEREQUESTS s DEGREEOFBRANDRECOGNITION BASEDONMARKETRESEARCH
The suitability of stock "USINESSES MUST ASSESS THE SUITABILITY OF THEIR STOCK ON A CONTINUOUS BASIS TO ENSURE THATTHEYAREMEETINGTHEDEMANDSOFCONSUMERS4HELEVELOF3ALESREPORTSHOWMUCH WAS SOLD BUT IT GIVES LITTLE FEEDBACK ON WHETHER CUSTOMERS WERE SATISlED WITH THEIR PURCHASE .OT EVERY CUSTOMER CAN BE SURVEYED BUT THE NUMBER OF SALES RETURNS WILL PROVIDEAUSEFULGUIDETOTHESUITABILITYOFSTOCK WITHTHElRMKEEPINGDETAILEDRECORDS ONTHEREASONSFORTHOSERETURNS4HENUMBEROFPURCHASERETURNSWILLPROVIDEAGOOD GUIDEASTOTHEQUALITYOFSTOCK ASWILLTHENUMBEROFCUSTOMERCOMPLAINTS
The firm’s relationship with its employees !LTHOUGHNOTREPORTEDDIRECTLYINTHE)NCOME3TATEMENT THEPERFORMANCEOFEMPLOYEES HASADIRECTANDSIGNIlCANTBEARINGONWHETHERAPROlTORLOSSISGENERATED3TAFFMAY BE RESPONSIBLE FOR IMPORTANT TASKS SUCH AS GENERATING 3ALES OR MANAGING STOCK SO APPRAISINGTHEIRPERFORMANCEISANIMPORTANTPARTOFASSESSINGTHElRMSPERFORMANCE 4HISCOULDBEDONEBYSTRUCTUREDPERFORMANCEAPPRAISALS 4HE DEGREE OF EMPLOYEE SATISFACTION AND WORKPLACE HARMONY ON THE OTHER HAND COULDBEASSESSEDBYTHENUMBEROFDAYSLOSTDUETOSICKLEAVEINDUSTRIALACTION ORTHE STAFFTURNOVERAVERAGELENGTHOFEMPLOYMENT
The state of the economy %VENTHEMOSTPROlTABLEBUSINESSWILLSTRUGGLETOSURVIVEINASHRINKINGECONOMY SOTHE STATEOFTHEECONOMYMUSTBEFACTOREDINTOANYEVALUATIONOFPROlTABILITY3PECIlCALLY THEOWNERMAYWISHTOCONSIDERINTERESTRATES THEUNEMPLOYMENTRATE ANDTHENUMBER OFCOMPETITORSITFACES ALLOFWHICHWILLAFFECTTHElRMSABILITYTOGENERATE3ALES4HELEVEL OFINmATIONWILLALSOBERELEVANTWHENASSESSINGTHElRMSABILITYTOCONTROLITSEXPENSES
REVIEW QUESTIONS 18.11
1 Explain FOUR LIMITATIONS OF RELYING SOLELY ON THE )NCOME 3TATEMENT AND PROlTABILITYINDICATORSTOEVALUATEPROlTABILITY 2 DefineTHETERM@NON lNANCIALINFORMATION 3 StateTWOMEASURESTHATCOULDBEUSEDTOASSESS s THElRMSRELATIONSHIPWITHITSCUSTOMERS s THESUITABILITYOFSTOCK s THElRMSRELATIONSHIPWITHITSEMPLOYEES s THESTATEOFTHEECONOMY
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 18
18.12
E VA L U AT I N G P R O F I TA B I L I T Y
STRATEGIES TO IMPROVE PROFITABILITY
4HEWHOLEPOINTOFGATHERINGANDRECORDINGlNANCIALDATA REPORTINGlNANCIALINFORMATION ANDANALYSINGANDINTERPRETINGTHElNANCIALREPORTSISTOENABLETHEACCOUNTANTTOASSIST THEOWNERINMAKINGDECISIONS)NMANYCASESTHEACCOUNTANTWILLDOTHISBYPROVIDING ADVICESUGGESTINGSTRATEGIESTOIMPROVETHElRMSPERFORMANCE )FPROlTABILITYISAFUNCTIONOFTHElRMSABILITYTOEARNREVENUEANDCONTROLITSEXPENSES THENSTRATEGIESTOIMPROVEPROlTABILITYSHOULDCONCENTRATEONTHESETWOAREAS
Earning revenue )NORDERTOIMPROVEITSABILITYTOEARNREVENUE ABUSINESSCOULDCHANGEITS s Selling price. 3ELLINGPRICESCOULDBEDECREASEDTOGENERATEMORE3ALESVOLUME OR INCREASEDTOGENERATEGREATERREVENUEPERSALE s Advertising. !DVERTISING COULD BE INCREASED OR TARGETED MORE ACCURATELY AT PROSPECTIVECUSTOMERS s Stock mix. 3TOCKHELDFORSALECOULDBECHANGEDSOTHATONLYTHOSEPRODUCTSTHATARE INDEMANDAREKEPTONHANDSLOW MOVINGLINESSHOULDBEREMOVED ANDREPLACED WITHTHOSETHATSELL s Non-current assets. .ON CURRENT ASSETS COULD BE INCREASED OR REPLACED BY MORE EFlCIENT VERSIONS TO ENABLE THE lRM TO INCREASE 3ALES OR LOWER OPERATING AND MAINTENANCE EXPENSES 4HIS MAY BE BETTER EQUIPMENT DISPLAY lTTINGS DELIVERY VEHICLESOR INEXTREMECASES ANEWLOCATION s Customer service. )NTERNAL PROCEDURES SUCH AS PAPERWORK COULD BE MADE MORE CUSTOMER FRIENDLY STAFF TRAINING COULD IMPROVE EMPLOYEES SERVICEPRODUCT KNOW LEDGE EXTRA SERVICES SUCH AS DELIVERIES WRAPPING INTERNETPHONE ACCESS AND PRODUCTADVICE COULDBEOFFERED
Controlling expenses )NORDERTOIMPROVEITSABILITYTOCONTROLEXPENSES ABUSINESSCOULDCHANGEITS s Management of stock. !NALTERNATIVESUPPLIERMAYBEABLETOPROVIDECHEAPERAND OR BETTER QUALITY STOCK WHILE DIFFERENT ORDERING PROCEDURES COULD REDUCE STORAGE COSTSAND3TOCK,OSSES ORGENERATEPRICEDISCOUNTS3EE#HAPTERFORADETAILED DISCUSSIONOFSTOCKMANAGEMENTPRINCIPLES s Management of staff. $IFFERENTROSTERINGSYSTEMS APPROPRIATEINCENTIVESANDEXTRA TRAININGMAYIMPROVESTAFFPRODUCTIVITYANDPERFORMANCE s Management of NCAs. !SSETSTHATAREINEFlCIENT UNDER UTILISEDORUN2ELIABLEARE ULTIMATELYEXPENSIVE ANDSHOULDBEREPLACEDORREMOVED 4HESPECIlCNATUREOFTHEADVICEGIVENTOTHEOWNERWILLDEPENDINLARGEPARTONTHE CIRCUMSTANCESOFTHEINDIVIDUALBUSINESSINQUESTIONWHATISRIGHTFORONEMAYNOTBE APPROPRIATEFORANOTHER4HEACCOUNTANTSROLEISTOPROVIDEGUIDANCEANDASSISTANCESO THATDECISIONSAREMADEINANINFORMEDMANNER BUTULTIMATELYITISUPTOTHEOWNERTO DECIDEWHATCOURSEOFACTIONTOTAKE
REVIEW QUESTIONS 18.12
1 StateTHREESTRATEGIESTHATCOULDBEUSEDTOIMPROVEAlRMSABILITYTOEARN REVENUE 2 StateTHREESTRATEGIESTHATCOULDBEUSEDTOIMPROVEAlRMSABILITYTOCONTROL ITSEXPENSES
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
447
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
448
UNITS 3&4
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s !NALYSINGINVOLVESEXAMININGTHEREPORTSINDETAILTOIDENTIFYCHANGESORDIFFERENCES INPERFORMANCE s )NTERPRETING INVOLVES EXAMINING THE RELATIONSHIPS BETWEEN ITEMS IN THE REPORTS IN ORDERTOEXPLAINTHECAUSEANDEFFECTOFTHOSECHANGESORDIFFERENCES s 0ROlTABILITYISABOUTASSESSINGTHElRMSCAPACITYORABILITYTOEARNPROlT ASSUMING ALLOTHERFACTORSWEREEQUAL s 4HEREAREVARIOUSTOOLSAVAILABLETOASSESSPROlTABILITY INCLUDINGTRENDS VARIANCES BENCHMARKSANDPROlTABILITYINDICATORS s "ENCHMARKS FOR ASSESSING PROlTABILITY INCLUDE PERFORMANCE IN PREVIOUS PERIODS BUDGETEDPERFORMANCEANDTHEPERFORMANCEOFOTHERSIMILARlRMS s 0ROlTABILITYINDICATORSEXPRESSANELEMENTOFPROlTINRELATIONTOSOMEOTHERASPECT OFBUSINESSPERFORMANCE s 2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTASSESSESPROlTABILITYFROMANINVESTORSPOINTOFVIEW s 4HE $EBT 2ATIO HAS IMPLICATIONS FOR BOTH THE RISK LONG TERM STABILITY AND RETURN 2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENT s 2ETURNON!SSETSASSESSESPROlTABILITYFROMAMANAGERSPOINTOFVIEW s 4HE.ET0ROlT-ARGINAND'ROSS0ROlT-ARGINASSESSEXPENSECONTROL s 4HE2ETURNON!SSETSDEPENDSONTHE!SSET4URNOVERANDTHE.ET0ROlT-ARGIN s %VALUATINGPROlTABILITYISLIMITEDBYTHEUSEOFHISTORICALDATA THEUSEOFAVERAGES DIFFERENTACCOUNTINGMETHODSANDLIMITEDINFORMATION s ! BUSINESS MAY REQUIRE NON lNANCIAL INFORMATION ABOUT ITS RELATIONSHIP WITH ITS CUSTOMERS ITSSTOCK ITSRELATIONSHIPWITHITSEMPLOYEES ANDTHESTATEOFTHEECONOMY
EXERCISES
EXERCISE 18.1 PROFITABILITY
W B
page 402
6INCE)ACONISISTHEOWNEROF#HELTENHAM(I&I WHICHLASTYEAREARNEDPROlT (ISFRIEND-ARINDA2ENDLEISTHEOWNEROF-ENTONE3TEREO3TORE WHICHEARNED PROlTFORTHESAMEPERIOD6INCEHASSTATEDTHATBECAUSEHISlRMSPROlTISHIGHER HIS lRMMUSTBEMOREPROlTABLE Required a ExplainWHY6INCESSTATEMENTISINCORRECT b StateTWOBASESTHATPROlTCOULDBECOMPAREDAGAINSTINANASSESSMENTOF PROlTABILITY
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 18
E VA L U AT I N G P R O F I TA B I L I T Y
EXERCISE 18.2 RETURN ON OWNER’S INVESTMENT
W B
page 403
+ARLS +ITES IS A KITE SHOP OWNED AND RUN BY +ARL ,ARGERmAG +ARL HAS PROVIDED THE FOLLOWINGINFORMATIONRELATINGTOITSPERFORMANCEOVERTHELASTTWOYEARS
Net Profit Average Capital
2015
2016
15 000
14 400
150 000
120 000
+ARLISCONSIDERINGWHETHERTOCONTINUEASTHEOWNER ORSELLTHEBUSINESSANDINVEST INAPROPERTYTRUSTTHATISCURRENTLYEARNINGPERYEAR Required a CalculateTHE2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTFOR+ARLS+ITESFORAND b ExplainTHECAUSES OFTHECHANGEINTHE2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTFROM TO c StateTWOREASONSWHY+ARLSHOULDBEHAPPYWITHTHElRMSPROlTABILITYIN d State ONE REASON WHY +ARL SHOULD BE CONCERNED ABOUT THE lRMS PROlTABILITY IN
EXERCISE 18.3 RETURN ON OWNER’S INVESTMENT AND DEBT RATIO
W B
page 404
"ABBLING "ROOKE SELLS PONDS AND OTHER GARDEN ORNAMENTS AND HAS PROVIDED THE FOLLOWINGINFORMATIONRELATINGTOITSPERFORMANCEOVERTHELASTTWOYEARS 2015 Net Profit
2016
22 000
10 000
10%
12.5%
Total Liabilities
180 000
320 000
Total Assets
400 000
400 000
Return on Owner’s Investment
Required a StateWHETHERPROlTABILITYIMPROVEDORWORSENEDINJustifyYOURANSWER b CalculateTHE$EBT2ATIOFOR"ABBLING"ROOKEFORAND c Explain THE EFFECT OF THE CHANGE IN THE $EBT 2ATIO ON THE LONG TERM STABILITY OF "ABBLING"ROOKE d ExplainTHEEFFECTOFTHECHANGEINTHE$EBT2ATIOONTHEPROlTABILITYOF"ABBLING "ROOKE e Discuss WHETHER THE OWNER SHOULD BE PLEASED ABOUT THE CHANGE IN THE lRMS PERFORMANCEIN
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
449
450
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 18.4 RETURN ON OWNER’S INVESTMENT AND RETURN ON ASSETS
W B
page 405
,EGEND'UITARSAND!XEMANS(EAVENARECOMPETITORSINSELLINGMUSICALINSTRUMENTS 4HEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONRELATESTOTHEIRTRADINGPERFORMANCEFOR Legend Guitars
Axeman’s Heaven
Net Profit
12 000
12 000
Average Owner’s Equity
80 000
40 000
120 000
150 000
Return on Owner’s Investment
15%
30%
Debt Ratio
22 000
10 000
Average Total Assets
Required a StateWHATISMEASUREDBY2ETURNON!SSETS b CalculateTHE2ETURNON!SSETSFOREACHlRMFOR c ExplainWHYTHE2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTISHIGHERFOR!XEMANS(EAVENTHAN ,EGEND'UITARS d &ROM A MANAGERS POINT OF VIEW state WHICH lRM IS MORE PROlTABLE Justify YOUR ANSWER e ExplainWHYAlRMS2ETURNON/WNERS)NVESTMENTWILLALWAYSBEGREATERTHANITS 2ETURNON!SSETS f State ONE OTHER INDICATOR THE ACCOUNTANT WOULD NEED TO CONSIDER BEFORE GIVING ADVICETOIMPROVEPROlTABILITYExplainTHEROLEOFTHISINDICATOR
EXERCISE 18.5 RETURN ON ASSETS AND ASSET TURNOVER
W B
page 407
/NLY"IKESHASPRESENTEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONRELATINGTOITSPERFORMANCEFOR AND 2014 Sales Revenue Net Profit Average Total Assets Return on Assets
2015
300 000
448 000
15 000
16 800
200 000
280 000
7.5%
6%
4HEOWNEROF/NLY"IKESARGUESTHATEXPENSECONTROLMUSTHAVEIMPROVEDIN BECAUSE.ET0ROlTINCREASED Required a b c d
StateWHATISMEASUREDBY@!SSET4URNOVER Calculate!SSET4URNOVERFOR/NLY"IKESFORAND ExplainWHY!SSET4URNOVERHASCHANGEDFROMTO 2EFERRINGTO!SSET4URNOVERAND2ETURNON!SSETS explainWHYTHEOWNERSASSERTION ISINCORRECT e SuggestTWOSTRATEGIESTHEOWNERCOULDADOPTTOIMPROVE.ET0ROlTINWITHOUT CHANGING!SSET4URNOVER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 18
E VA L U AT I N G P R O F I TA B I L I T Y
EXERCISE 18.6 ASSET TURNOVER AND NET PROFIT MARGIN
W B
page 408
&ILMORE &ITTINGS SELLS HARDWARE AND HOMEWARES AND HAS PROVIDED THE FOLLOWING INFORMATIONRELATINGTOISPERFORMANCEFOR Filmore Fittings Return on Owner’s Investment Return on Assets Asset Turnover Net Profit Margin
Industry average
20%
12.5%
6%
8%
0.60 times
0.64 times
10%
12.5%
Required a StateTWOREASONSWHYTHE2ETURNON!SSETSOF&ILMORE&ITTINGSISLOWERTHANTHE INDUSTRYAVERAGE b StateTWOBENCHMARKSOTHERTHANTHEINDUSTRYAVERAGETHATCOULDBEUSEDTOASSESS THE2ETURNON!SSETSOF&ILMORE&ITTINGS c SuggestTWOSTRATEGIES&ILMORE&ITTINGSCOULDADOPTTOIMPROVEITS!SSET4URNOVER d Explain WHY AN IMPROVEMENT IN EXPENSE CONTROL COULD STILL SEE TOTAL EXPENSES INCREASE e !SSUMING IT HAD THE SAME TOTAL ASSETS AS THE INDUSTRY AVERAGE state WHETHERTHE$EBT2ATIOOF&ILMORE&ITTINGSWOULDBE s HIGHERTHANTHEINDUSTRYAVERAGE s LOWERTHANTHEINDUSTRYAVERAGE s THESAMEASTHEINDUSTRYAVERAGE s UNABLETOBEDETERMINED Justify YOURANSWER
EXERCISE 18.7 NET PROFIT MARGIN
W B
page 409
!LL4HE7EIGHTSSELLSGYMEQUIPMENT ANDHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONABOUT ITSPROlTPERFORMANCEFORAND
Sales Net Profit Asset Turnover Return on Assets
2015
2016
153 000
175 000
8 500
11 000
1.8 times
1.75 times
10%
11%
Required a 2EFERRINGTOTHEINFORMATIONABOVE identifyONEINDICATORTHATSUPPORTSTHECLAIM THATTHElRMSABILITYTOEARNREVENUEHASWORSENED b StateTHEREASONFORTHEDECREASEINTHElRMS!SSET4URNOVER c StateWHATISMEASUREDBYTHE.ET0ROlT-ARGIN d CalculateTHE.ET0ROlT-ARGINFORAND e ExplainWHYTHElRMS2ETURNON!SSETSHASINCREASEDIN
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
451
452
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 18.8 GROSS PROFIT MARGIN
W B
page 410
(OLLYS'OLF'EARHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONFOR $ Sales Revenue
120 000
Gross Profit
75 000
Adjusted Gross Profit
72 000
Net Profit
45 000
Gross Profit Margin – 2009
60%
Required a b c d
ExplainWHATISMEASUREDBYTHE'ROSS0ROlT-ARGIN Calculate'ROSS0ROlT-ARGINFOR StateTWOSTRATEGIESTHEOWNERCOULDADOPTTOIMPROVETHE'ROSS0ROlT-ARGIN ExplainHOWINCREASINGSELLINGPRICESCOULDLEADTOANINCREASEINTHE'ROSS0ROlT -ARGINBUTADECREASEIN'ROSS0ROlT e SuggestTWOSTRATEGIESTHATTHEOWNERCOULDADOPTTOIMPROVETHEADJUSTED'ROSS 0ROlTWITHOUTCHANGINGTHE'ROSS0ROlT-ARGIN
EXERCISE 18.9 GROSS PROFIT MARGIN
W B
page 411
4HE'ROSS0ROlT-ARGINOF#AMPBELL0AINTSFELLFROMINTOIN)N RESPONSE THEOWNERHASDECIDEDTOINCREASESPENDINGONADVERTISING Required a SuggestTWOPOSSIBLEREASONSFORTHECHANGEINTHE'ROSS0ROlT-ARGINFROM TO b ExplainWHYTHEOWNERSPLANOFACTIONWILLNOTLEADTOANIMPROVEMENTINTHE'ROSS 0ROlT-ARGIN c StateONEWAYOFIMPROVINGTHE'ROSS0ROlT-ARGINWITHOUTAFFECTING!SSET4URNOVER d ExplainHOWTHEOWNERSPLANOFACTIONCOULDLEADTO s ANIMPROVEMENTINTHE.ET0ROlT-ARGIN s AWORSENINGINTHE.ET0ROlT-ARGIN e StateTWOPIECESOFNON lNANCIALINFORMATIONTHEOWNERMAYWANTTOSEETOASSESS THEQUALITYOFHISSTOCK f State ONE LIMITATION OF RELYING ON THE 'ROSS 0ROlT -ARGIN TO ASSESS THE lRMS PROlTABILITY
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 18
E VA L U AT I N G P R O F I TA B I L I T Y
EXERCISE 18.10 VERTICAL ANALYSIS OF THE INCOME STATEMENT
W B
page 412
7OOLLY'OODISACLOTHINGSHOP ANDITHASPROVIDEDAVERTICALANALYSISOFITS)NCOME 3TATEMENTSFORTHEYEARENDING$ECEMBERAND WOOLLY GOOD Income Statement for the year ended 31 December 2015
2016
$
%
$
%
Sales Revenue
90 000
100
120 000
100
Less Cost of Goods Sold
37 800
42
54 000
45
Gross Profit
52 200
58
66 000
55
Less Stock Loss Adjusted Gross Profit
1 800
3
2 400
2
50 400
55
63 600
53
15 300
17
21 600
18
9 000
10
12 000
10
Advertising
11 700
13
13 200
11
Net Profit
13 500
15
16 800
14
Less Other Expenses Wages Rent
Required a ListTHREEPOSSIBLEREASONSFORTHEINCREASEIN3ALESREVENUE b StateWHETHEROVERALLEXPENSECONTROLHASIMPROVEDORWORSENEDINJustify YOURANSWER c ExplainHOWAREDUCTIONINTHE'ROSS0ROlT-ARGINHASBEENBENElCIALFORTHElRM IN d StateTWOREASONSWHYTHEOWNERSHOULDnotBECONCERNEDABOUTTHEDECREASEIN THE!DJUSTED'ROSS0ROlT-ARGIN e SuggestTWOSTRATEGIESTHElRMCOULDADOPTTOIMPROVEITSCONTROLOFWAGES f SuggestONEPOSSIBLEREASONWHYRENTHASINCREASED g DiscussWHETHERTHECHANGEINADVERTISINGHASBEENBENElCIALTOTHElRMSOVERALL PROlTABILITY h State TWO PIECES OF NON lNANCIAL INFORMATION THE OWNER COULD USE TO ASSESS THE lRMSRELATIONSHIPWITHITSSTAFF
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
453
454
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 18.11 GRAPHICAL REPRESENTATION OF VERTICAL ANALYSIS
W B
page 414
0ETER#OLE%NTERPRISESHASPRESENTEDTHEFOLLOWINGGRAPHSRELATINGTOITSPROlTABILITYFOR AND Cost of Goods Sold Wages
2015
Rent Stock loss Advertising Net Profit
Cost of Goods Sold Wages
2016
Rent Stock Loss Advertising Net Profit
Additional information: s 3ALESREVENUEWASINANDIN s 2ENTEXPENSEWASINEACHYEAR s 4OTALASSETSREMAINEDTHESAMEBUTTHE$EBT2ATIODECREASEDIN Required a 2EFERRING TO INFORMATION PROVIDED identify ONE REASON FOR THE INCREASE IN 3ALES REVENUEIN b 2EFERRINGTOTHEGRAPHS explainWHYTHERENTEXPENSESEGMENTTHEGREENSEGMENT ISSMALLERIN c SuggestTWOSTRATEGIES0ETERMAYHAVEUSEDTOCAUSETHECHANGEIN3TOCK,OSS d StateWHETHERWAGESEXPENSEINDOLLARTERMS WOULDBEHIGHER LOWERORTHESAME INJustifyYOURANSWER e ExplainWHYTHE'ROSS0ROlT-ARGINWOULDBELOWERIN f DiscussWHETHERPROlTABILITYIMPROVED WORSENEDORREMAINEDTHESAMEIN
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony Simmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
Where are we headed? After completing this chapter, you should be able to: s define@LIQUIDITY s analyseLIQUIDITYAND EFlCIENCYUSINGTRENDS VARIANCES BENCHMARKSAND LIQUIDITYINDICATORS s calculateANDexplainVARIOUS LIQUIDITYANDEFlCIENCY INDICATORS s explainTHERELATIONSHIP BETWEENTURNOVERINDICATORS s suggestSTRATEGIESTO IMPROVELIQUIDITYANDMANAGE STOCKANDDEBTORS
Course advice: advice: 4HE6#%!CCOUNTING3TUDY 4HE 6#% !CCOUNTING 3TUDY $ESIGNSTATESTHATSTUDENTS $ESIGN STATES THAT STUDENTS WILLNOTBEREQUIREDTO WILL NOT BE REQUIRED TO CALCULATElNANCIALINDICATORS CALCULATE lNANCIAL INDICATORS INTHEEXAMINATION(OWEVER IN THE EXAMINATION (OWEVER CALCULATIONSAREINCLUDED CALCULATIONS ARE INCLUDED INTHISTEXTASANESSENTIAL IN THIS TEXT AS AN ESSENTIAL MECHANISMFORUNDERSTANDING MECHANISM FOR UNDERSTANDING THEINFORMATIONTHESEINDICATORS THE INFORMATION THESE INDICATORS PRESENT
CHAPTER 19
EVALUATING LIQUIDITY KEY TERMS After completing this chapter, you should be familiar with the following terms: s s s s s s s s
LIQUIDITY 7ORKING#APITAL2ATIO7#2 1UICK!SSET2ATIO1!2 #ASH&LOW#OVER# 3TOCK4URNOVER34/ $EBTORS4URNOVER$4/ $EBTORS!GEING!NALYSIS #REDITORS4URNOVER#4/
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
456
UNITS 3&4
19.1 ASSESSING LIQUIDITY #HAPTER DISCUSSED THE TOOLS AND TECHNIQUES THAT CAN BE EMPLOYED TO EVALUATE PROlTABILITY WITH THE AIM OF PROVIDING BUSINESS OWNERS WITH ADVICE TO AID THEIR DECISION MAKING4HISCHAPTERTAKESASIMILARAPPROACH BUTCONCENTRATESINSTEADONAN ASSESSMENTOFLIQUIDITY
Liquidity refers to the ability of a business to meet its short-term debts as they fall due
liquidity the ability of a business to meet its short-term debts as they fall due
Liquidity REFERSTOTHEABILITYOFABUSINESSTOMEETITSSHORT TERMDEBTSASTHEYFALL DUE !NY ASSESSMENT OF LIQUIDITY SHOULD BEGIN BY ANALYSING THE level OF LIQUID FUNDS THAT IS AVAILABLE TO MEET SHORT TERM OBLIGATIONS 4HIS WILL OBVIOUSLY INCLUDE CASH THAT ISALREADYONHAND BUTITWILLALSOINCLUDECASHTHATCANBEGENERATEDFROMSTOCKAND DEBTORS (OWEVER IT SHOULD ALSO ANALYSE THE speed AT WHICH THOSE LIQUID RESOURCES BECOMEAVAILABLE SOTHATWECANASSESSWHETHERTHECASHWILLBEAVAILABLEINTIMETO MEETTHElRMSSHORT TERMOBLIGATIONS
Tools for assessing liquidity 4HE SAME TYPES OF TOOLS THAT WERE USED TO ASSESS PROlTABILITY CAN BE APPLIED TO AN ASSESSMENTOFLIQUIDITY s TRENDS s BENCHMARKS s VARIANCES s LIQUIDITYINDICATORS )NTERMSOFIDENTIFYINGtrendsANDvariances THEPRIMARYSOURCESOFINFORMATIONWILL BE THE #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT AND "UDGETED #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT WHICH DETAIL THE ACTUALANDEXPECTEDINmOWSANDOUTmOWSOFCASH4HISWASCOVEREDINDETAILIN#HAPTER )NFACT THE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTISESSENTIALTOANANALYSISOFLIQUIDITY AS ITDETAILSALLEXPECTEDCASHINmOWSANDCASHOUTmOWS ANDSTATESCATEGORICALLYWHETHER THEBUSINESSWILLBEABLETOMEETITSCASHOBLIGATIONSFORTHECOMINGYEAR )N#HAPTER WEASSESSEDPROlTABILITYAGAINSTTHREEKEYBENCHMARKS ANDTHESECAN BEAPPLIEDTOASSESSLIQUIDITY s LIQUIDITYIN previous periods s budgetedLIQUIDITY s LIQUIDITYOFsimilar businesses ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 19
E VA L U AT I N G L I Q U I D I T Y
457
)N ADDITION SOME OF THE LIQUIDITY INDICATORS HAVE THEIR OWN SPECIlC BENCHMARK AGAINSTWHICHLIQUIDITYCANBEMEASURED 7EWILLUSETHEFOLLOWINGINDICATORSTOASSESSTHElevelOFLIQUIDITY s 7ORKING#APITAL2ATIO7#2 s 1UICK!SSET2ATIO1!2 s #ASH&LOW#OVER# 7EWILLUSETHREEEFlCIENCYINDICATORSTOASSESSTHEspeedOFLIQUIDITY s 3TOCK4URNOVER34/ s $EBTORS4URNOVER$4/ s #REDITORS4URNOVER#4/
REVIEW QUESTIONS 19.1
1 2 3 4
DefineTHETERM@LIQUIDITY ExplainTHEROLEOFTHE"UDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTINEVALUATINGLIQUIDITY StateTHREEINDICATORSTHATAREUSEDTOASSESSTHELEVELOFLIQUIDITY State THREEINDICATORSTHATAREUSEDTOASSESSTHESPEEDOFLIQUIDITY
19.2 WORKING CAPITAL RATIO (WCR) 4HEWorking Capital Ratio (WCR)ASSESSESLIQUIDITYBYCOMPARINGCURRENTASSETSAND CURRENTLIABILITIES Working Capital Ratio: formula Working Capital Ratio (WCR)
Current assets
=
Current liabilities
Working Capital Ratio (WCR) a liquidity indicator that measures the ratio of current assets to current liabilities, to assess the firm’s ability to meet its short-term debts
3PECIlCALLY THE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOMEASURESHOWMANYDOLLARSOFCURRENTASSETS AREAVAILABLETOMEETEACHDOLLAROFCURRENTLIABILITIES!SARESULT ITINDICATESWHETHER THEBUSINESSWILLBEABLETOMEETITSSHORT TERMDEBTSITSCURRENTLIABILITIES USINGCASH GENERATEDFROMITSCURRENTASSETS
Grant’s Glasses has presented the following extract from its Balance Sheet as at 31 January 2015: Current Assets Bank Debtors Control Stock Control Prepaid Rent Expense Total Current Assets
EXAMPLE
Current Liabilities 3 500 12 500 34 000 1 000 $51 000
Creditors Control Loan – GV Bank Accrued Wages GST Clearing Total Current Liabilities
20 000 12 000 500 1 500 $34 000
4HE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOWOULDBECALCULATEDASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 19.1
Calculating Working Capital Ratio (WCR)
WCR
= =
51 000 34 000 1.5:1
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
458
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
4HE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOSHOWSTHAT'RANTS'LASSESHASOFCURRENTASSETSFOR EVERYOFCURRENTLIABILITIES
Assessing the Working Capital Ratio !SWASSTATEDEARLIER THE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOFORTHECURRENTPERIODCANBECOMPARED AGAINST previous periods OR THE budgeted lGURE TO ASSESS WHETHER IT HAS INCREASED OR DECREASED BUT THIS WILL NOT ALLOW US TO DETERMINE WHETHER IT IS SATISFACTORY OR UNSATISFACTORY 4HE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOISBASEDONTHEIDEATHATTHECASHTHATCANBEGENERATED FROMCURRENTASSETSINTHENEXTMONTHS SHOULDBEENOUGHTOMEETTHESHORT TERM DEBTSTHATFALLDUEINTHATTIME!SARESULT satisfactoryLIQUIDITYEXISTSIFTHE7ORKING #APITAL2ATIOISat least 1:1 ASTHISWOULDINDICATETHATTHEREISATLEASTOFCURRENT ASSETSAVAILABLETOMEETEVERYOFCURRENTLIABILITIES ANDTHElRMWOULDBEABLETO MEETALLITSSHORT TERMDEBTSASTHEYFALLDUE'RANTS'LASSESACTUALLYHASWORTHOF CURRENTASSETSFOREVERYDOLLAROFCURRENTLIABILITIES SOITSLEVELOFLIQUIDITYISSATISFACTORY !7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOOFless than 1:1 INDICATES unsatisfactory LIQUIDITYTHEBUSINESS MAYNOTBEABLETOMEETITSDEBTSASTHEYFALLDUEASITHASINSUFlCIENTCURRENTASSETSTO MEETITSCURRENTLIABILITIES)FTHESITUATIONISNOTADDRESSED ANDCREDITORSANDOTHERSARE UNABLETOBEPAID THEBUSINESSMAYBEFORCEDINTOLIQUIDATION WITHITSASSETSSOLDTO RAISEFUNDSTOPAYOFFITSDEBT !7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOOFexactly1:1WOULDLEAVENOMARGINFORERRORIFANYOFTHE CURRENT ASSETS COULD NOT BE CONVERTED INTO CASH THE BUSINESS WOULD HAVE INSUFlCIENT CASHTOMEETITSDEBTS ANDCOULDFACELIQUIDITYPROBLEMS Working Capital Ratio less than 1:1 )FTHE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOISless than 1:1 THElRMMAYEXPERIENCEDIFlCULTIESINMEETING ITSDEBTSASTHEYFALLDUE)NORDERTOAVOIDSUCHDIFlCULTIES THEOWNERMAYBEREQUIREDTO s MAKEACASH CAPITALCONTRIBUTION s SEEKADDITIONALlNANCEBYENTERINGINTO OREXTENDING ANOVERDRAFTFACILITY s TAKEOUTALOANTOPURCHASENON CURRENTASSETS )NTHELONGTERM BORROWINGMAYWORSENTHECASHSITUATION ASTHESERVICINGOFTHE DEBTWOULDREQUIRECASHTOREPAYBOTHTHEPRINCIPALANDINTEREST(OWEVER INTHESHORT TERM THESURVIVALOFTHEBUSINESSMAYDEPENDONTHEEXTRAlNANCEPROVIDEDBYALOAN Working Capital Ratio much greater than 1:1 !LTHOUGH IT IS BENElCIAL FOR THE 7ORKING #APITAL 2ATIO TO BE ABOVE A BUSINESS OWNERSHOULDALSOBEWARYOFHAVINGA7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOTHATIStoo high ASTHIS MAYINDICATETHATTHEBUSINESSHASEXCESSCURRENTASSETSTHATAREIDLE ANDNOTBEING EMPLOYEDEFFECTIVELY 4HISCANBEAPPARENTINANUMBEROFDIFFERENTCURRENTASSETS s Bank"USINESSBANKACCOUNTSPAYVERYSMALLAMOUNTSOFINTEREST THUSTHEREISLITTLE TOGAINFROMKEEPINGMORECASHINTHEBANKTHANISNECESSARYTOMEETOBLIGATIONS EXPECTEDANDUNEXPECTED !BUSINESSWOULDBEBETTEROFFUSINGEXCESSCASHTO RETIRE DEBT EXPAND /PERATIONS OR EVEN TO MAKE OTHER INVESTMENTS EG A TERM DEPOSIT WHEREITWILLBEABLETOEARNAGREATERRETURNONITSFUNDS s Stock Control. ! LARGE AMOUNT OF STOCK COULD INCUR ADDITIONAL STORAGE COSTS AND INCREASE THE POSSIBILITY OF STOCK LOSS DAMAGE AND TECHNICAL OBSOLESCENCE WHICH COULDREQUIREASTOCKWRITE DOWN s Debtors Control. ! LARGE DEBTORS lGURE MIGHT INDICATE AN INCREASING GROUP OF @AGEINGDEBTORS4HEOLDERADEBTBECOMESTHELESSLIKELYITISTOBERECEIVEDAND THEGREATERTHEPROBABILITYTHATTHEDEBTWILLGO@BADTHATIS BECOMEUNCOLLECTIBLE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 19
E VA L U AT I N G L I Q U I D I T Y
459
7HERETHE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOISTOOHIGHTHEOWNERMAY s USEEXCESSCASHBYREPAYINGDEBTS PURCHASINGNON CURRENTASSETSORTAKINGEXTRA DRAWINGS s ALLOWSTOCKLEVELSTORUNDOWNBEFOREREORDERING s CONTACTDEBTORSTOCOLLECTAMOUNTSOUTSTANDING
REVIEW QUESTIONS 19.2
1 2 3 4 5
State WHATISMEASUREDBYTHE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIO7#2 ShowTHEFORMULATOCALCULATETHE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIO Explain WHYTHE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOSHOULDBEATLEAST ExplainONEPROBLEMASSOCIATEDWITHANEXCESSIVE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIO State TWOACTIONSTHEOWNERMAYBEREQUIREDTOTAKEIF7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOIS s TOOLOW s TOOHIGH
19.3 QUICK ASSET RATIO (QAR) 5NDERLYINGTHEUSEOFTHE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOTOASSESSTHELEVELOFLIQUIDITYISTHE ASSUMPTIONTHATALLCURRENTASSETSCANBELIQUIDATEDIMMEDIATELYIFCASHISNEEDEDTOMEET SHORT TERMDEBTS(OWEVER THEREARESOMEPRACTICALDIFlCULTIESWITHTHISASSUMPTION #ONSIDERstock-OSTTRADINGBUSINESSESWOULDALREADYBETRYINGTOSELLTHEIRSTOCK ASFASTASTHEYCAN SOTHEREISNOGUARANTEETHATALLTHEIRSTOCKWILLSUDDENLYBESOLD JUSTBECAUSETHElRMISFACINGLIQUIDITYPROBLEMS!NDTHEREISVIRTUALLYNOCHANCEOF THIS HAPPENING IMMEDIATELY !S A RESULT IT IS QUESTIONABLE WHETHER THESE ASSETS CAN BE RELIED ON AS SOURCES OF LIQUID FUNDS !LSO prepaid expenses CANNOT NORMALLY BE CONVERTED BACK INTO CASH )F THE BUSINESS HAS ENTERED INTO A CONTRACT AND PAID FOR A MONTHLEASE ITISNOTLIKELYTOBEABLETOASKFORAREFUND !TTHESAMETIME ALTHOUGHAbank overdraftISACURRENTLIABILITY ITISUNLIKELYTHATIT WILLBECALLEDINFORREPAYMENT ASLONGASITREMAINSUNDERTHELIMIT4HISISANARGUMENT FOREXCLUDINGITASADEBTTHATWILLREQUIREPAYMENTINTHESHORTTERM)FTHEOVERDRAFTIS WELLBELOWTHELIMIT ITMAYREPRESENTASOURCEOFFUNDS Quick Asset Ratio (QAR) )NORDERTOOVERCOMETHESEDElCIENCIES THEQuick Asset Ratio (QAR)CANBEUSED a liquidity indicator that ASANALTERNATIVEINDICATOROFTHELEVELOFLIQUIDITY)TASSESSESTHElRMSABILITYTOMEETITS measures the ratio of quick immediateDEBTSUSINGITSimmediateASSETS
assets to quick liabilities, to assess the firm’s ability to meet its immediate debts
Quick Asset Ratio: formula Quick Asset Ratio = (QAR)
Current assets (excluding Stock and Prepaid Expenses) Current liabilities (excluding Bank Overdraft)
4HE 1UICK !SSET 2ATIO IS A MODIlCATION OF THE 7ORKING #APITAL 2ATIO IT EXCLUDES STOCKANDPREPAIDEXPENSESFROMCURRENTASSETSASTHEYMAYNOTBEEASILYCONVERTEDTO CASHINATIMEOFCRISIS ANDEXCLUDESANYBANKOVERDRAFTFROMCURRENTLIABILITIESASTHISIS UNLIKELYTOREQUIREREPAYMENT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
460
UNITS 3&4
Assessing the Quick Asset Ratio !LTHOUGHTHE1UICK!SSET2ATIOISASLIGHTLYDIFFERENTMEASUREOFLIQUIDITY THEBENCHMARKS FORASSESSINGITSADEQUACYREMAINTHESAMEASTHOSEUSEDTOASSESSTHE7ORKING#APITAL 2ATIO4HATIS THE1UICK!SSET2ATIOSHOULDBEATLEAST BUTCANALSOBECOMPARED TOTHE1UICK!SSET2ATIOFROMprevious periodsORTHEbudgetTOIDENTIFYINCREASESOR DECREASES
EXAMPLE
WILSON’S WHITE GOODS Balance Sheet (extract) as at 31 December 2015 Current Assets Debtors Control Stock Control Prepaid rent Total Current Assets
Current Liabilities 15 000 51 000 9 000 $75 000
Bank overdraft Creditors Control Accrued electricity GST Clearing
5 000 15 000 3 000 2 000
Total Current Liabilities
$25 000
!COMPARISONOFTHE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOAND1UICK!SSET2ATIOISSHOWNIN&IGURE STUDY TIP
Figure 19.2 !LTHOUGHPREPAID EXPENSESARE EXCLUDEDFROMQUICK ASSETS ACCRUED EXPENSESAREINCLUDED ASQUICKLIABILITIESAS THEYWILLSTILLHAVETO BEREPAID
Comparing Working Capital Ratio and Quick Asset Ratio
Working Capital Ratio WCR
= =
75 000 25 000 3:1
Quick Asset Ratio QAR
= =
15 000 20 000 0.75:1
4HE 7ORKING #APITAL 2ATIO INDICATES THAT THE BUSINESS HAS $3 OF CURRENT ASSETS FOR EVERYOFCURRENTLIABILITIESAND ASARESULT ITSLIQUIDITYISSATISFACTORYTHERESHOULD BESUFlCIENTCURRENTASSETSTOMEETITSCURRENTLIABILITIESASTHEYFALLDUE(OWEVER THE 1UICK !SSET 2ATIO SUGGESTS THAT LIQUIDITY IS UNSATISFACTORY BECAUSE THE lRM WILL HAVE ONLYCOFQUICKASSETSTOPAYQUICKLIABILITIES7HATDOESTHISMEANFORLIQUIDITY7ILL THEBUSINESSBEABLETOMEETITSSHORT TERMDEBTSORNOT 4HEFACTTHATTHE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOISSATISFACTORYBUTTHE1UICK!SSET2ATIOIS UNSATISFACTORYISADIRECTRESULTOFTHEFACTTHATTHEBUSINESSHASALARGEINVESTMENTINITS STOCKANDPREPAIDEXPENSES'IVENTHEDIFlCULTIESINLIQUIDATINGPREPAIDEXPENSES THE lRMSABILITYTOMEETITSDEBTSWILLDEPENDHEAVILYONITSABILITYTOSELLITSSTOCKONTIME IFTHESTOCKCANBESOLD THElRMWILLBEABLETOMEETITSDEBTSASTHEYFALLDUEIFNOT LIQUIDITYPROBLEMSMAYRESULT )NORDERTOADDRESSTHESITUATION THEBUSINESSWILLNEEDTOIMPROVETHELEVELOFQUICK ASSETSBYIMPROVINGDEBTORSORBYTRYINGTOMAINTAINAPOSITIVEBANKBALANCE)TCANALSO ATTEMPT TO REDUCE THE LEVEL OF QUICK LIABILITIES BY REDUCING THE LEVEL OF CREDITORS AND ACCRUEDEXPENSES
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 19
E VA L U AT I N G L I Q U I D I T Y
461
REVIEW QUESTIONS 19.3
1 StateWHATISMEASUREDBYTHE1UICK!SSET2ATIO1!2 2 ShowTHEFORMULATOCALCULATETHE1UICK!SSET2ATIO 3 Explain WHY THE FOLLOWING ITEMS ARE EXCLUDED FROM THE CALCULATION OF THE 1UICK!SSET2ATIO s STOCK s PREPAIDEXPENSES s BANKOVERDRAFT 4 ExplainWHATISINDICATEDIFTHE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOISSATISFACTORY BUTTHE 1UICK!SSET2ATIOISUNSATISFACTORY
19.4 CASH FLOW COVER (CFC) /NE OF THE KEY PROBLEMS WITH USING BOTH THE 7ORKING #APITAL 2ATIO AND THE 1UICK !SSET2ATIOISTHATTHEYRELYONstatic itemsTOMEASUREFUTURECASHmOWS4HATIS THE INFORMATIONUSEDINBOTHRATIOSCOMESFROMTHE"ALANCE3HEET SOITPROVIDESNOREAL INDICATIONOFTHECASHmOWSOFTHEBUSINESS )NCONTRAST THECash Flow Cover (CFC) ASSESSESLIQUIDITYBYIDENTIFYINGTHEACTUAL CASH THAT THE BUSINESS GENERATES FROM ITS /PERATING ACTIVITIES TO MEET ITS lNANCIAL OBLIGATIONS3PECIlCALLY ITMEASURESTHENUMBEROFTIMESAVERAGECURRENTLIABILITIESCAN BEMETUSINGTHE.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM/PERATIONS
Cash Flow Cover (CFC) a liquidity indicator that measures the number of times Net Cash Flows from Operations is able to cover average Current Liabilities
Cash Flow Cover: formula Cash Flow Cover (CFC)
=
Net Cash Flows from Operations Average Current Liabilities
)FABUSINESSCANNOTGENERATESUFlCIENTCASHFROMITSDAY TO DAYOPERATINGACTIVITIES IT WILL REQUIRE REGULAR CONTRIBUTIONS FROM THE OWNER OR EXTERNAL lNANCIERS IN ORDER TO MEETITSLOANREPAYMENTSANDPROVIDECASHFORTHEOWNERSDRAWINGS
EXAMPLE
Jenny’s Jumpers has provided the following information about its liquidity position as at 30 June: Net Cash Flows from Operations
2015
2016
$ 40 000
$ 36 000
Current liabilities at start
18 000
14 000
Current liabilities at end
14 000
10 000
#LEARLY THEREISLESSCASHAVAILABLEFROMOPERATINGACTIVITIESIN BUTHASLIQUIDITY IMPROVED OR WORSENED AS A RESULT 4HE #ASH &LOW #OVER FOR EACH YEAR WOULD BE CALCULATEDASISSHOWNIN&IGURE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
462
Figure 19.3
UNITS 3&4
Calculating Cash Flow Cover 2015
STUDY TIP
CFC
=
40 000
2016 CFC
=
(14 000 + 10 000)/2
(18 000 + 14 000)/2
!LTHOUGHITISCALLEDA @RATIO THECALCULATION ISACTUALLYEXPRESSEDIN TERMSOF@TIMES
=
40 000
36 000
=
12 000
16 000 =
2.5 times
36 000
=
3 times
)N .ET#ASH&LOWSFROM/PERATIONSWASABLETOPAYAVERAGECURRENTLIABILITIES TIMES4HISHASINCREASEDTOTIMESIN INDICATINGIMPROVEDLIQUIDITY7HYDID THISHAPPEN%VENTHOUGH.ET#ASH&LOWSFROM/PERATIONSDECREASEDFROM TO IN AVERAGE CURRENT LIABILITIES DECREASED BY PROPORTIONATELY MORE LEADINGTOANIMPROVEMENTINTHEABILITYOFTHElRMTOPAYITSSHORT TERMDEBTSUSINGITS OPERATINGCASHmOWS
Assessing the Cash Flow Cover 5NLIKE THE 7ORKING #APITAL 2ATIO AND 1UICK !SSET 2ATIO THERE IS NO SET BENCHMARK AT WHICH THE #ASH &LOW #OVER WOULD BE CONSIDERED SATISFACTORY (OWEVER IT CAN BE COMPAREDAGAINSTTHE#ASH&LOW#OVERFROMprevious periods ORTHEbudgeted#ASH &LOW#OVERTOASSESSWHETHERITHASIMPROVEDORWORSENED ORAGAINSTTHE#ASH&LOW #OVEROFsimilar businesses)NGENERAL THELONGERTHEPERIODBEINGEXAMINEDINTHE RATIO THE MORE TIMES THE BUSINESS WOULD EXPECT THE AVERAGE CURRENT LIABILITIES TO BE COVERED
REVIEW QUESTIONS 19.4
1 State WHATISMEASUREDBYTHE#ASH&LOW#OVER# 2 Show THEFORMULATOCALCULATETHE#ASH&LOW#OVER 3 State THREE BENCHMARKS THAT COULD BE USED TO ASSESS THE ADEQUACY OF THE #ASH&LOW#OVER
19.5 THE SPEED OF LIQUIDITY /URANALYSISOFLIQUIDITYSOFARHASBEENPREDICATEDONTHENOTIONTHATABUSINESSWILL STRUGGLE TO MEET ITS DEBTS AS THEY FALL DUE IF ITS CURRENTQUICK ASSETS ARE LESS THAN ITS CURRENTQUICK LIABILITIES 4HIS ASSESSMENT OF THE level OF LIQUIDITY USED THE 7ORKING #APITAL2ATIOANDTHE1UICK!SSET2ATIOTOASSESSHOWMUCHCASHTHEBUSINESSCOULD GENERATETOMEETITSSHORT TERMOBLIGATIONS (OWEVER BUSINESSESARENOTSTATICENTITIESTHEYARECONSTANTLYGENERATINGSALES WHICH WILLTHENTURNINTOCASH WHICHWILLTHENBEUSEDTOPURCHASEMORESTOCK TOGENERATE MORESALES ETC4HUS THELEVELOFLIQUIDITYIS ONITSOWN ANINADEQUATEMEASUREOFA lRMSABILITYTOMEETITSDEBTS)NFACT ABUSINESSCANSURVIVEINSPITEOFANUNSATISFACTORY LEVELOFLIQUIDITY IFTHEspeedOFITSTRADINGCYCLEISFASTENOUGH4HATIS IFABUSINESSCAN SELLITSSTOCKANDCOLLECTTHECASHFROMITSCUSTOMERS BEFORETHATCASHISNEEDED ITWILL BEABLETOSURVIVEEVENWITHAVERYLOW7ORKING#APITAL2ATIO "USINESSESSUCHASTHISMAYNEVERHAVEAHIGHLEVELOFCASHONHAND BUTCANSURVIVE BECAUSE THEIR turnover IS SO FAST 4HEREFORE OUR ASSESSMENT OF LIQUIDITY MUST ALSO CONSIDERTHESPEEDOFTHElRMS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 19
E VA L U AT I N G L I Q U I D I T Y
463
s 3TOCK4URNOVER34/ s $EBTORS4URNOVER$4/ s #REDITORS4URNOVER#4/ )NCOMMONWITH!SSET4URNOVERFROM#HAPTER THESEINDICATORSACTUALLYASSESS efficiencyTHEABILITYOFTHElRMTOMANAGEITSSTOCK DEBTORSANDCREDITORS(OWEVER BECAUSE THEY HAVE A DIRECT AND SIGNIlCANT EFFECT ON CASH mOWS NAMELY #ASH 3ALES 2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORSAND0AYMENTSTO#REDITORS THEYALSOHAVEASIGNIlCANTEFFECT ONLIQUIDITY
REVIEW QUESTIONS 19.5
1 Explain HOW A lRM WITH A HIGH TURNOVER CAN REMAIN SOLVENT DESPITE AN UNSATISFACTORYLEVELOFLIQUIDITY 2 Define THE TERM @EFlCIENCY AS IT RELATES TO THE ASSESSMENT OF BUSINESS PERFORMANCE
19.6 STOCK TURNOVER (STO) !STHEMAINSOURCEOFREVENUE STOCKISALSOTHEMAINSOURCEOFCASHINmOWS"UTBEFORE CASHCANBECOLLECTEDFROMCASHSALESORDEBTORS THESTOCKMUSTlRSTBESOLDStock Turnover (STO) ASSESSES HOW EFFECTIVELY THE lRM HAS MANAGED ITS STOCK HOLDINGS BY CALCULATINGTHEAVERAGENUMBEROFDAYSTAKENTOCONVERTSTOCKINTOSALES Stock Turnover: formula Stock Turnover (STO)
=
Stock Turnover (STO) the average number of days it takes for a business to convert its stock into sales
Average stock x 365 Cost of Goods Sold
!VERAGESTOCKISUSEDINANATTEMPTTOREmECTTHESTOCKONHANDCARRIEDTHROUGHOUT THEPERIOD WHILEMULTIPLYINGBYCONVERTSTHETURNOVERINTODAYS &AST3TOCK4URNOVER ASMEASUREDBYLOWDAYS MEANSTHAT ONAVERAGE STOCKISSOLD QUICKLY4HISWILLENHANCETHElRMSABILITYTOGENERATECASHFROMTHESALEOFSTOCK AND ASSISTITSLIQUIDITY
Markwell Mirrors has provided the following information relating to its trading Operations for the year ended 30 June: 2015 Cost of Goods Sold Average stock
$ 90 000 25 000
EXAMPLE
2016 $ 100 000 20 000
4HE3TOCK4URNOVERWOULDBECALCULATEDASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 19.4
Calculating Stock Turnover 2015
STO
2016
=
25 000 x 365
=
20 000 x 365
=
90 000
=
100 000
=
101 days*
=
73 days
2OUNDEDTONEARESTDAY
STO
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
464
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
4HElGURESINDICATETHATIN ITTOOKANAVERAGEOFDAYSTOSELLSTOCK4HE FOLLOWINGYEAR 3TOCK4URNOVERDECREASEDFAVOURABLYBYDAYSITONLYTOOKDAYSON AVERAGE TOTURNSTOCKINTOSALESIN )N -ARKWELL-IRRORSNOTONLYsold more stockASISSHOWNBYTHEINCREASEIN #OSTOF'OODS3OLD BUTITheld less stock on handIN DOWNTO IN "OTHFACTORSARERESPONSIBLEFORTHEIMPROVEMENTIN3TOCK4URNOVER
Assessing Stock Turnover )NTHEPRECEDINGEXAMPLE WEUSEDTHE3TOCK4URNOVERFROMA previous periodTOIDENTIFY ANIMPROVEMENT)NTERMSOFASSESSINGWHETHER3TOCK4URNOVERISSATISFACTORY ITCANBE COMPAREDAGAINSTTHEbudgetedlGURE ORTHE3TOCK4URNOVEROFsimilar firms !NASSESSMENTOF3TOCK4URNOVERMUSTALSOCONSIDERTHENATUREOFTHEGOODSSOLD 'OODS THAT ARE PERISHABLE SUCH AS FRESH PRODUCE OR SUSCEPTIBLE TO TECHNOLOGICAL OBSOLESCENCESHOULDHAVEAFAST3TOCK4URNOVERSOTHEYARENOTSUBJECTTOSTOCKLOSSOR STOCKWRITE DOWNISSUES2ELATIVELYCHEAPITEMSSHOULDALSOBESOLDMUCHFASTERTHAN MOREEXPENSIVEITEMS SUCHASLUXURYCARS Stock Turnover too slow )F3TOCK4URNOVERISTOOSLOWTHATIS AHIGHNUMBEROFDAYS THElRMWILLBELESSABLETO GENERATESALESAND THEREFORE LESSABLETOGENERATECASHINmOWSFROM#ASH3ALESAND 2ECEIPTSFROM$EBTORS INTIMETOMEETDEBTSASTHEYFALLDUE4HISCOULDBECAUSEDBY ADECREASEINTHELEVELOFSALESDUETOGENERALECONOMICCONDITIONS SEASONALFACTORS STOCKQUALITYORCOMPETITION ORANINCREASEINTHELEVELOFSTOCKONHANDDUETOORDERING MORESTOCKTHANISREQUIRED )NTHISCASE THEBUSINESSMAYNEEDTO s EMPLOYSTRATEGIESTOincrease sales SUCHASADVERTISING CHANGINGSELLINGPRICESOR CHANGINGTHESTOCKMIXSEE#HAPTERFORSTRATEGIESTOINCREASESALES s decrease the level of stock on hand BY ORDERING LESS ORDERING SMALLER AMOUNTS MOREFREQUENTLYJUST IN TIMEORDERING ORREPLACINGSLOW MOVINGSTOCKLINES Stock Turnover too fast )TISALSOPOSSIBLETHAT3TOCK4URNOVERCOULDBETOOFAST!LTHOUGHTHEBUSINESSWOULD BEGENERATINGHIGHSALES ITMAYBEBECAUSETHESELLINGPRICEISTOOLOW ANDTHISWOULD BEALOSSOFPOTENTIALREVENUE ANDPROlT!LTERNATIVELY ITMAYBEBECAUSETHElRMIS HOLDINGTOOLITTLESTOCK)FTHISISTHECASE COSTSSUCHASDELIVERYMAYBEHIGHERBECAUSE DELIVERIES ARE MORE FREQUENT AND THE BUSINESS COULD LOSE THE POSSIBILITY OF EARNING DISCOUNTSFORBUYINGINBULK "ECAUSE IT ONLY MEASURES THE average TIME TAKEN TO SELL STOCK DECISIONS SUCH AS THESESHOULDNOTBEMADEONANASSESSMENTOF3TOCK4URNOVERALONE)TISIMPORTANT THATTHEOWNERALSOANALYSESTHESTOCKCARDS SOTHATHEORSHEHASDETAILEDINFORMATION ABOUTTHESPEEDATWHICHspecific lines of stockARESELLING SOTHATAPPROPRIATEDECISIONS CANBEMADE
Stock management 4HEREARECERTAINSTRATEGIESABUSINESSOWNERCANEMPLOYTOENSURETHATSTOCKISMANAGED WISELYTOMAXIMISETHEPOTENTIALFORSALES
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 19
E VA L U AT I N G L I Q U I D I T Y
465
Review sales to maintain an appropriate stock mix 7HATIS@APPROPRIATEMAYCHANGEFROMSEASONTOSEASON ORASTASTESANDPREFERENCES CHANGE SOTHEOWNERMUSTPAYCLOSEATTENTIONTOWHICHSTOCKISSELLING3TOCKLINESTHAT ARE SELLING WELL SHOULD BE EXPANDED WHILE THOSE THAT ARE NOT SHOULD BE REDUCED OR EVENDISCONTINUED Promote the sale of complementary goods #OMPLEMENTARY GOODS ARE ADD ON SALES THAT ARE GENERATED TO SUPPORT THE ORIGINAL ITEMSOLD!SPARTOFITSASSESSMENTOFITSSTOCKMIX THEBUSINESSSHOULDCONSIDERWHAT @EXTRA SALES IT CAN GENERATE FROM STOCK THAT IS RELATED IN SOME WAY &OR EXAMPLE A BUSINESSSELLINGTENTSMAYALSOSELLSLEEPINGBAGS INmATABLEMATTRESSESANDGASLIGHTS TOENCOURAGEMORESALES Ensure stock is up to date 3ALESOFSOMESTOCKLINESWILLBEHEAVILYAFFECTEDBYCHANGESINFASHIONORTECHNOLOGY)N ORDERTOMAINTAINSALES STOCKOFTHESEITEMSMUSTBETHEMOSTCURRENTVERSIONAVAILABLE OLDERANDOUT OF DATEVERSIONSSHOULDBEDISCOUNTEDFORQUICKSALE Rotate stock 4HEPOSITIONINGOFSTOCKINTHESTORECANHAVEASIGNIlCANTIMPACTONWHETHERITSELLS ORSIMPLYSITSONTHESHELF0ARTICULARLYFORPERISHABLEITEMS OLDERPRODUCTSSHOULDBE MOVEDTOTHEFRONTSOTHEYARETAKENlRSTTHISWILLMINIMISESTOCKLOSSORWRITE DOWN ISSUES!TOTHERTIMES MOVINGANENTIRESTOCKLINETOANOTHERLOCATIONWITHINTHESTORE MAYBOOSTITSSALES Determine an appropriate level of stock on hand 3TOCK LEVELS SHOULD BE SUFlCIENT TO MEET DEMAND BUT NOT SO HIGH THAT ADDITIONAL STORAGECOSTSORSTOCKWRITE DOWNISSUESSUCHASDAMAGEORTECHNICALOBSOLESCENCE ENSUE3ETTINGATARGETLEVELFORSTOCKALSOASSISTSINIDENTIFYINGWHENTOREORDER Strong marketing 3TRATEGIESLIKEADVERTISINGWILLHOPEFULLYLEADTOINCREASEDSALESANDFASTER3TOCK4URNOVER FORALLLINESOFSTOCK ORFORAPARTICULARLINEWHICHMAYTHENATTRACTCUSTOMERSANDENTICE THEMTOBUYOTHERITEMSTOO
REVIEW QUESTIONS 19.6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
State WHATISMEASUREDBY3TOCK4URNOVER34/ Show THEFORMULATOCALCULATE3TOCK4URNOVER ExplainWHYFAST3TOCK4URNOVERISBENElCIALFORLIQUIDITY StateTWOACTIONSTHATANOWNERCOULDTAKETOIMPROVE3TOCK4URNOVER ExplainONEADVANTAGEANDONEDISADVANTAGEOFFAST3TOCK4URNOVER ExplainTHEROLEOFSTOCKCARDSINANANALYSISOF3TOCK4URNOVER ExplainFOURSTRATEGIESTHATBUSINESSESSHOULDUSETOMANAGETHEIRSTOCK
19.7 DEBTORS TURNOVER (DTO) )NBUSINESSESTHATSELLPREDOMINANTLYONACASHBASIS THETIMETAKENTOTURNSTOCKINTO SALES3TOCK4URNOVER ALSOMEASURESTHETIMETAKENTOGENERATECASHASSOONASTHE STOCKISSOLD THECASHISCOLLECTED"USINESSESTHATMAKECREDITSALESMUSTWAITALITTLE LONGERlRSTUNTILTHESTOCKISSOLD THENAGAINUNTILTHECASHISRECEIVEDFROMDEBTORS 4HUS Debtors Turnover (DTO) IS AN IMPORTANT FACTOR INmUENCING A lRMS ABILITY TO GENERATECASHTOMEETITSSHORT TERMDEBTSASTHEYFALLDUE ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Debtors Turnover (DTO) the average number of days it takes for a business to collect cash from its debtors
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
466
UNITS 3&4
Debtors Turnover: formula Debtors Turnover (DTO)
=
Average debtors x 365 Credit Sales
$EBTORS 4URNOVER ASSESSES HOW EFFECTIVELY THE lRM HAS MANAGED ITS DEBTORS BY CALCULATINGTHEAVERAGENUMBEROFDAYSITTAKESAlRMTOCOLLECTCASHFROMITSDEBTORS &AST$EBTORS4URNOVERMEANSITTAKESONAVERAGE AFEWDAYSTOCOLLECTCASHIFCASHIS COLLECTEDQUICKLY ITCANTHENBEUSEDTOMEETOTHERDEBTSASTHEYFALLDUE ,ETSRETURNTO-ARKWELL-IRRORS WITHSOMEINFORMATIONADDED
EXAMPLE
2015 Credit Sales Cash Sales Average debtors Stock Turnover Credit terms offered to customers
2016
$180 000 16 000 30 000 101 days 30 days
$200 000 17 000 35 000 73 days 30 days
4HE$EBTORS4URNOVERWOULDBECALCULATEDASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 19.5
Calculating Debtors Turnover 2015
DTO
2016 =
35 000 x 365
180 000
=
200 000
61 days*
=
64 days*
=
30 000 x 365
= =
DTO
2OUNDEDTONEARESTDAY
STUDY TIP
"ECAREFULWHEN EXPLAININGCHANGES IN34/AND$4/A DECREASEINDAYSISAN IMPROVEMENTINLIQUIDITY
4HElGURESINDICATETHATIN ITTOOKANAVERAGEOFDAYSTOCOLLECTCASHFROM DEBTORS BUT IN THIS INCREASED UNFAVOURABLY TO DAYS 4HIS MEANS THAT ON AVERAGE IT TOOK THREE DAYS LONGER TO GENERATE CASH FROM DEBTORS IN BECAUSE ALTHOUGH#REDIT3ALESINCREASED AVERAGEDEBTORSINCREASEDBYPROPORTIONATELYMORE
Turning stock into cash 'IVEN THAT -ARKWELL -IRRORS SELLS MOST OF IT STOCK ON CREDIT ITS ABILITY TO MEET ITS COMMITMENTSWILLDEPENDONTHETIMETAKENTOTURNTHESTOCKINTO3ALES34/ ANDTHEN THETIMETAKENTOTURNDEBTORSINTOCASH$4/ 4HUS IN ITWILLTAKETHEBUSINESS DAYSTOTURNSTOCKINTOCASH3TOCK4URNOVERDAYS$EBTORS4URNOVERDAYS
Assessing Debtors Turnover 4HETHREE DAYINCREASEINTHEPRECEDINGEXAMPLEMAYNOTBEASIGNIlCANTINCREASE BUT THEFACTTHATDEBTORSCONTINUETOTAKEMORETHANDAYSISOFGRAVECONCERN BECAUSE THElRMOFFERSONLYDAYSCREDITTOITSCUSTOMERS$EBTORS4URNOVERCANBEASSESSED AGAINSTAprevious periodTOIDENTIFYINCREASESORDECREASES BUTITISTHEcredit terms offered to customers AND PERHAPS THE budgeted $EBTORS 4URNOVER THAT SHOULD BE USEDTODETERMINEWHETHER$EBTORS4URNOVERISSATISFACTORY ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 19
E VA L U AT I N G L I Q U I D I T Y
%VENIF$EBTORS4URNOVERISWITHINTHECREDITTERMS ITSHOULDBENOTEDTHATITISAN average lGURE SOME DEBTORS MAY BE REPAYING WITHIN THE CREDIT TERMS WHILE OTHERS MAYBEPAYINGTHEIRSLATE)NCONJUNCTIONWITH$EBTORS4URNOVER THEOWNERWILLNEEDTO ANALYSETHEDEBTORSLEDGERSOTHATEACHINDIVIDUALDEBTORCANBEMANAGEDAPPROPRIATELY 4OTHISEND THEBUSINESSMAYPREPAREADebtors Ageing Analysis WHICHCALCULATESHOW MUCHISOWINGFROMDEBTORSBASEDONTHE@AGEOFTHEDEBT
Debtor management
467
Debtors Ageing Analysis a listing of the amount and proportion of debtors according to the length of time they are owing
)F$EBTORS4URNOVERISTOOSLOWTHATIS GREATERTHANTHECREDITTERMSOFFEREDTOCUSTOMERS THElRMWILLHAVETOWAITTOOLONGFORCASHFROMDEBTORSANDTHUSWILLBELESSABLETO MEETITSSHORT TERMDEBTSASTHEYFALLDUE)NORDERTOAVOID ORADDRESS THISSITUATION THEOWNERMAYCONSIDERIMPLEMENTINGTHEFOLLOWINGSTRATEGIES Discounts for quick settlement /FFERINGSETTLEMENTDISCOUNTSCANENCOURAGEDEBTORSTOPAYWELLWITHINTHECREDITTERMS $ISCOUNTSSHOULDNOTBEOFFEREDONOVERDUEDEBTS Prompt invoicing )NVOICESSHOULDBESENTWITHTHEGOODSSOTHATTHECUSTOMERISIMMEDIATELYAWAREOFTHE AMOUNTOWINGANDTHEREPAYMENTDATE5NTILTHEINVOICEISRECEIVED THEDEBTORWILLNOT BEGINTOEVENTHINKABOUTPAYING Extensive credit checks /NLYOFFERINGCREDITTOCUSTOMERSWHOHAVEAPROVENRECORDWILLINCREASETHECHANCES THATCASHWILLBERECEIVEDONTIME Reminder notices .OTICESSHOULDBESENTIMMEDIATELYTOREMINDDEBTORSTHATTHEIRPAYMENTISOVERDUE PROGRESSING FROM FRIENDLY REMINDERS TO THREATENING LEGAL ACTION 2EMINDERS MAY TAKE THEFORMOFACOPYOFTHEINVOICE ORASTATEMENTOFACCOUNTTHATHASTHEOUTSTANDING AMOUNTCLEARLYSHOWNASOVERDUE Threats of legal action 4HETHREATOFCOURTACTIONCANSOMETIMESPROMPTPAYMENT BUTLEGALACTIONCANBEA LONGANDCOSTLYPROCESS)TALSOSIGNALSTHEENDOFTHERELATIONSHIPWITHTHEDEBTOR BUT PERHAPSDEBTORSWHOPAYTHISLATEAREUNDESERVINGOFFURTHER#REDIT3ALES Debt collection agency $EBTCOLLECTIONAGENCIESCANEMPLOYPRACTICESRANGINGFROMANNOYINGALATEPAYERBY PERSISTENTTELEPHONECONTACTTOEMBARRASSMENTATTHEIRPLACEOFWORK Threats of not providing credit in the future $EBTORSWHOHAVENOTPAIDTHEIRCURRENTDEBTSSHOULDBEREFUSEDFURTHERCREDITUNTILTHE AMOUNTOUTSTANDINGISRECEIVED REVIEW QUESTIONS 19.7
1 2 3 4
StateWHATISMEASUREDBY$EBTORS4URNOVER$4/ ShowTHEFORMULATOCALCULATE$EBTORS4URNOVER ExplainWHY$EBTORS4URNOVERISCRUCIALTOANASSESSMENTOFLIQUIDITY Explain THE IMPORTANCE OF CREDIT TERMS OFFERED TO CUSTOMERS IN ASSESSING $EBTORS4URNOVER 5 ListTHESTRATEGIESABUSINESSCOULDUSETOIMPROVEITS$EBTORS4URNOVER INTHE ORDERINWHICHTHEYSHOULDBEIMPLEMENTED ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
468
UNITS 3&4
19.8 CREDITORS TURNOVER (CTO) /FALLTHEOBLIGATIONSATRADINGlRMMUSTMEET THEMOSTPERSISTENTISPAYINGFORSTOCK )FSTOCKISPURCHASEDFORCASH THEBUSINESSWILLLEAVEITSELFNOTIMETOSELLTHESTOCKAND COLLECTTHECASHBEFORETHEPAYMENTMUSTBEMADE/NTHEOTHERHAND CREDITPURCHASES ALLOWTHElRMSOMETIMETOSELLTHESTOCKANDCOLLECTTHECASHBEFORETHECREDITORMUST BEPAID(OWEVER ITISSTILLIMPORTANTTHATCREDITORSAREPAIDONTIME Creditors Turnover: formula Creditors Turnover (CTO)
Creditors Turnover (CTO) the average number of days it takes for a business to pay its creditors
=
Average creditors x 365 Credit purchases
Creditors Turnover (CTO)MEASURESTHEAVERAGENUMBEROFDAYSTAKENTOPAY CREDITORS INDICATINGTHEEFFECTIVENESSOFTHElRMINMANAGINGITSCREDITORS 2ETURNINGTO-ARKWELL-IRRORS
EXAMPLE Credit purchases Average creditors Stock Turnover Debtors turnover Credit terms offered to customers
2015
2016
$ 70 000 10 000 101 days 61 days 60 days
$ 90 000 12 000 73 days 64 days 60 days
4HE#REDITORS4URNOVERWOULDBECALCULATEDASISSHOWNIN&IGURE Figure 19.6
Calculating Creditors Turnover 2015
CTO
=
10 000 x 365
2016 CTO
=
12 000 x 365
=
70 000
=
90 000
=
52 days*
=
49 days*
2OUNDEDTONEARESTDAY 4HElGURESINDICATETHATIN CREDITORSWEREPAIDEVERYDAYSTHATIS EIGHT DAYSBEFORETHECREDITTERMSEXPIRED)N THISDECREASEDBYTHREEDAYSTODAYS THATIS DAYSSHORTERTHANTHECREDITTERMSALLOWED4HISWASBECAUSE ALTHOUGHCREDIT PURCHASES AND AVERAGE CREDITORS INCREASED AVERAGE CREDITORS INCREASED BY A SMALLER PROPORTION
Stock Turnover, Debtors Turnover and Creditors Turnover 4HElRMSABILITYTOPAYITSCREDITORSWILLRELYHEAVILYONITSABILITYTOGENERATECASHFROM ITSSTOCK4HISMEANS#REDITORS4URNOVERISRELIANTON3TOCK4URNOVERAND IFTHEBUSINESS DEALSMAINLYONCREDIT $EBTORS4URNOVER &IGURESHOWSTHISRELATIONSHIPBETWEEN3TOCK4URNOVER $EBTORS4URNOVERAND #REDITORS4URNOVER
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 19
Figure 19.7
E VA L U AT I N G L I Q U I D I T Y
Cash cycle
Sale of stock
Purchase of stock
Receipt from debtor
Payment to creditor
4HE DAYS BETWEEN THE PURCHASE OF STOCK AND SALE OF STOCK ARE MEASURED BY THE 3TOCK4URNOVERTHEDAYSBETWEENTHESALEOFSTOCKANDTHERECEIPTFROMTHEDEBTORARE MEASUREDBYTHE$EBTORS4URNOVERANDTHEDAYSBETWEENTHEPURCHASEOFTHESTOCK ANDTHEPAYMENTTOTHECREDITORAREMEASUREDBYTHE#REDITORS4URNOVER )NTHISEXAMPLE SLOWER$EBTORS4URNOVERWASMORETHANOFFSETBYMUCHFASTER3TOCK 4URNOVER LEADING TO A DECREASE IN THE NUMBER OF DAYS TAKEN TO TURN STOCK INTO CASH 7ITHADECREASEINTHENUMBERSOFDAYSTOTURNSTOCKINTOCASH CASHWASAVAILABLEMORE QUICKLY SO THE BUSINESS WAS ABLE TO PAY ITS CREDITORS MORE QUICKLY LEADING TO FASTER #REDITORS4URNOVERS
Assessing Creditors Turnover #REDITORS 4URNOVER CAN BE ASSESSED AGAINST A previous period TO IDENTIFY INCREASES OR DECREASES BUT IN COMMON WITH $EBTORS 4URNOVER IT IS THE credit terms offered by suppliers AND PERHAPS THE budgeted #REDITORS 4URNOVER THAT SHOULD BE USED TO DETERMINEWHETHER#REDITORS4URNOVERISSATISFACTORY )FDISCOUNTSAREOFFERED ANDTHECASHISAVAILABLE THENPAYINGEARLYMAYBEBENElCIAL (OWEVER IF DISCOUNTS ARE not AVAILABLE THERE IS NO INCENTIVE TO PAY EARLY #REDITORS 4URNOVERSHOULDBEASCLOSEASPOSSIBLETOTHECREDITTERMS4HISWILLMEANTHEBUSINESS RETAINSCASHLONGER ANDCANUSEITTOMEETOTHERPAYMENTSASTHEYFALLDUE !TTHESAMETIME #REDITORS4URNOVERSHOULDNOTEXCEEDTHECREDITTERMSOFFEREDBY THESUPPLIER ORPENALTIESMAYBEINCURRED SUCHASTHOSEOUTLINEDBELOW Interest charges on late accounts )NTERESTCHARGESWOULDDECREASEPROlTANDREQUIREANEVENGREATERCASHOUTmOW4HIS WOULDHAVETOBESTIPULATEDINTHECREDITCONTRACT Removal of credit facilities 7ITHCREDITFACILITIESWITHDRAWN THEBUSINESSWOULDHAVETOPAYCASHFORITSSTOCK ORMAY NOTBEABLETOPURCHASESTOCKATALL Reduction in credit rating 4HISMAYMAKEITDIFlCULTTOESTABLISHLINESOFCREDITINTHEFUTUREIFTHEBUSINESSHASA POORHISTORYOFREPAYINGITSDEBTS )NMOSTCASES AlRMWILLWANTITSCASHINmOWFROM34/AND$4/ TOBEASFASTAS POSSIBLETHATIS THELOWESTNUMBEROFDAYSPOSSIBLE WHEREASITWILLWANTTOPAYITS CREDITORS AS SLOWLY AS POSSIBLE THAT IS THE HIGHEST NUMBER OF DAYS POSSIBLE WITHOUT EXCEEDINGCREDITTERMS 4HEBESTCIRCUMSTANCEFORATRADINGBUSINESSISTOSELLSTOCKFOR CASHANDTOBUYSTOCKONCREDIT4HISAPPROACHPROVIDESTIMEFORTHEBUSINESSTOSELLITS STOCK COLLECTTHECASHANDREPAYITSCREDITORS ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
469
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
470
UNITS 3&4
REVIEW QUESTIONS 19.8
1 StateWHATISMEASUREDBY#REDITORS4URNOVER#4/ 2 ShowTHEFORMULATOCALCULATE#REDITORS4URNOVER 3 ExplainTHERELATIONSHIPBETWEEN3TOCKAND$EBTORS4URNOVER AND#REDITORS 4URNOVER 4 StateTHREENEGATIVECONSEQUENCESOFEXCEEDINGTHECREDITTERMSOFFEREDBY SUPPLIERS
WHERE HAVE WE BEEN? s ,IQUIDITYREFERSTOTHEABILITYOFABUSINESSTOMEETITSSHORT TERMDEBTSASTHEYFALL DUE s 4HE "UDGETED #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT IS ESSENTIAL TO AN ANALYSIS OF LIQUIDITY AS IT DETAILSALLEXPECTEDCASHINmOWSANDCASHOUTmOWS ANDSTATESCATEGORICALLYWHETHER THEBUSINESSWILLBEABLETOMEETITSCASHOBLIGATIONSFORTHECOMINGYEAR s 4HE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOAND1UICK!SSET2ATIOASSESSTHELEVELOFLIQUIDITY AND SHOULDBEATLEAST s 3TOCK 4URNOVER $EBTORS 4URNOVER AND #REDITORS 4URNOVER ASSESS EFlCIENCY THE ABILITYOFTHElRMTOMANAGEITSSTOCK DEBTORSANDCREDITORS s 3TOCK MANAGEMENT STRATEGIES ARE DETERMINING AN APPROPRIATE LEVEL OF STOCK ON HANDMAINTAININGANAPPROPRIATESTOCKMIXROTATINGSTOCKENSURINGSTOCKISUP TO DATEANDPROMOTINGTHESALEOFCOMPLEMENTARYGOODS s $EBTOR MANAGEMENT STRATEGIES ARE THE USE OF DISCOUNTS FOR QUICK SETTLEMENT PROMPTINVOICINGEXTENSIVECREDITCHECKSREMINDERNOTICESTHREATSOFLEGALACTION DEBTCOLLECTIONAGENCYANDTHREATSOFNOTPROVIDINGCREDITINTHEFUTURE s $EBTORS 4URNOVER AND #REDITORS 4URNOVER SHOULD BE ASSESSED AGAINST THE CREDIT TERMS s 0ENALTIES FOR EXCEEDING CREDIT TERMS ARE INTEREST REMOVAL OF CREDIT FACILITIES AND REDUCTIONINCREDITRATING
EXERCISES
EXERCISE 19.1 LIQUIDITY
W B
page 416
!TTHEENDOF (ILLTOP3PORTING'OODSHADCASHINTHEBANK BUTBYTHE ENDOF THATHADFALLENTO PROMPTINGITSOWNERTOSAYTHATITSLIQUIDITYHAD FALLEN Required a State TWO REASONS WHY THE OWNERS ASSERTION ABOUT THE lRMS LIQUIDITY MAY BE INCORRECT b StateTWOINDICATORSTHATCANBEUSEDTOASSESSTHELEVELOFLIQUIDITY c StateTWOINDICATORSTHATCANBEUSEDTOASSESSTHESPEEDOFLIQUIDITY
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 19
E VA L U AT I N G L I Q U I D I T Y
EXERCISE 19.2 WORKING CAPITAL RATIO
W B
page 417
7ELLINGTON"OOTSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONFROMITS"ALANCE3HEETASAT $ECEMBER Current assets
34 000
Current liabilities
42 500
Required a StateWHATISMEASUREDBYTHE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIO b CalculateTHE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOFOR7ELLINGTON"OOTSASAT$ECEMBER c 2EFERRING TO YOUR ANSWER TO PART @B state WHETHER THE 7ORKING #APITAL 2ATIO IS SATISFACTORYORUNSATISFACTORYJustifyYOURANSWER d SuggestTWOACTIONSTHEOWNEROF7ELLINGTON"OOTSMAYNEEDTOTAKETOENSURETHE BUSINESSISABLETOMEETITSSHORT TERMDEBTSASTHEYFALLDUE
EXERCISE 19.3 WORKING CAPITAL RATIO
W B
page 418
,IGHTSOF9OUR,IFEHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATION
Working Capital Ratio
2015
2016
1.65:1
1.21:1
Required a Explain ONE REASON WHY THE OWNER SHOULD BE CONCERNED ABOUT THE TREND IN THIS INDICATOR b ExplainONELIMITATIONOFRELYINGONTHE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOTOASSESSLIQUIDITY c ExplainHOWTHEBUDGETED#ASH&LOW3TATEMENTCOULDBEUSEDTOASSESSLIQUIDITY
EXERCISE 19.4 WORKING CAPITAL RATIO AND QUICK ASSET RATIO
W B
page 419
-ADDEN(OMEWARESHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGEXTRACTFROMITS"ALANCE3HEET MADDEN HOMEWARES Balance Sheet (extract) as at 30 June 2015 Current Assets
$
Current Liabilities
$
Accrued Interest Revenue
300
Bank Overdraft
12 000 20 100
Stock Control
47 200
Creditors Control
Debtors Control
34 100
Accrued Electricity
500
GST Clearing
900
Prepaid Rent Total Current Assets
2 150 $83 750
Total Current Liabilities
$33 500
4HE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOOF-ADDEN(OMEWARESASAT*UNEWAS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
471
472
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
Required a b c d
StateWHATISMEASUREDBYTHE1UICK!SSET2ATIO ExplainWHYSTOCKISEXCLUDEDFROMTHECALCULATIONOFQUICKASSETS CalculateTHE1UICK!SSET2ATIOOF-ADDEN(OMEWARESASAT*UNE 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@C stateWHETHERTHE1UICK!SSET2ATIOISSATISFACTORY ORUNSATISFACTORYJustifyYOURANSWER e ExplainHOWTHEEFlCIENCYOFTHISBUSINESSINMANAGINGITSCURRENTASSETSWILLAFFECT ITSLIQUIDITY
EXERCISE 19.5 WORKING CAPITAL RATIO AND QUICK ASSET RATIO
W B
page 420
*ORDANS2UGSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATION 2015
2016
7ORKING#APITAL2ATIO
1UICK!SSET2ATIO
Required a ExplainONEPOSSIBLEREASONFORTHECHANGEINTHE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOAND1UICK !SSET2ATIOFROMTO b ExplainONENEGATIVECONSEQUENCEIFTHE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOISTOOHIGH c ExplainTHECIRCUMSTANCESINWHICHTHISlRMISLIKELYTO s HAVENODIFlCULTIESMEETINGITSSHORT TERMDEBTS s HAVEDIFlCULTIESMEETINGITSSHORT TERMDEBTS
EXERCISE 19.6 CASH FLOW COVER (CFC)
W B
page 421
(AIR4ODAYHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATION 2015
2016
Net Cash Flows from Operations
39 000
35 000
Average current liabilities
13 000
10 000
Required a CalculateTHE#ASH&LOW#OVERFOR(AIR4ODAYFORAND b 2EFERRING TO YOUR ANSWER TO PART @A explain WHETHER LIQUIDITY HAS IMPROVED OR WORSENEDFROMTO c ExplainTHECAUSES OFTHECHANGEINTHE#ASH&LOW#OVERFROMTO d State TWO OTHER PIECES OF INFORMATION FROM THE #ASH &LOW 3TATEMENT THAT WOULD ASSISTINTHEASSESSMENTOFLIQUIDITY e Explain WHY IT IS IMPORTANT FOR LIQUIDITY THAT .ET #ASH &LOWS FROM /PERATIONS IS POSITIVE
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 19
E VA L U AT I N G L I Q U I D I T Y
EXERCISE 19.7 LEVEL OF LIQUIDITY
W B
page 422
E #OMMS AND 6IRTUAL 7ORLD BOTH SELL COMPUTER SYSTEMS AND HAVE PROVIDED THE FOLLOWINGINFORMATIONFOR e-Comms
Virtual World
Working Capital Ratio
1.2:1
5.3:1
Quick Asset Ratio
0.75:1
3.4:1
Cash Flow Cover
4.6 times
1.25 times
Required a Explain WHYTHE7ORKING#APITAL2ATIOOFEACHlRMISHIGHERTHANITS1UICK!SSET 2ATIO b Explain ONE REASON WHY 6IRTUAL 7ORLD SHOULD BE CONCERNED ABOUT ITS 7ORKING #APITAL2ATIO c Explain HOW THE "ALANCE 3HEET OF 6IRTUAL 7ORLD AS AT $ECEMBER COULD ASSISTINASSESSINGITSLIQUIDITY d DiscussWHETHERE #OMMSWILLBEABLETOMEETITSSHORT TERMDEBTSASTHEYFALLDUE e IdentifyONEOTHERPIECEOFINFORMATIONTHATWOULDASSISTINASSESSINGTHELIQUIDITYOF E #OMMSJustifyYOURANSWER
EXERCISE 19.8 STOCK TURNOVER
W B
page 423
/RLANDOS"LOOMSISAmOWERSHOPOPERATINGIN(ORSHAM)THASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWING INFORMATIONRELATINGTOITSSTOCKFOR Cost of Goods Sold
195 000
Average stock
8 000
Budgeted Stock Turnover
4 days
Required a StateWHATISMEASUREDBY3TOCK4URNOVER b Calculate3TOCK4URNOVERFOR/RLANDOS"LOOMSFOR c 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERTOPART@B stateTWOREASONSWHYTHEOWNERWOULDCONSIDER THIS3TOCK4URNOVERTOBEUNSATISFACTORY d ExplainHOWSLOW3TOCK4URNOVERCANHAVENEGATIVECONSEQUENCESFOR s Profitability s liqUIDITY e StateONEACTIONTHEOWNERCOULDTAKETOIMPROVE3TOCK4URNOVERWITHOUTAFFECTING 'ROSS0ROlT
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
473
474
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 19.9 STOCK TURNOVER
W B
page 424
4HE,IGHT(OUSESELLSAHUGEVARIETYOFLIGHTSANDLAMPSASWELLASCANDLES CANDLESTICKS ANDOTHERDECORATIVEITEMS4HEOWNERHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONRELATING TOITSSTOCKFORAND 2015
2016
Stock Turnover
42 days
33 days
Average stock
34 000
30 000
Required a b c d
ExplainWHYTHEOWNERWOULDBEPLEASEDWITHTHISTRENDIN3TOCK4URNOVER ExplainONENEGATIVECONSEQUENCEIF3TOCK4URNOVERISTOOFAST ExplainTHERELATIONSHIPBETWEENSELLINGPRICESAND3TOCK4URNOVER State ONE LIMITATION OF USING 3TOCK 4URNOVER TO ASSESS THE EFFECTIVENESS OF STOCK MANAGEMENT e Explain HOW STOCK CARDS CAN ASSIST AN ASSESSMENT OF THE EFFECTIVENESS OF STOCK MANAGEMENT
EXERCISE 19.10 DEBTORS TURNOVER
W B
page 425
&ERRANTE3UITSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONRELATINGTOITSACTIVITIESFOR Cash Sales Credit Sales Average debtors
200 000 45 000 6 000
Credit terms offered to customers
40 days
Stock Turnover
21 days
Required a StateWHATISMEASUREDBY$EBTORS4URNOVER b Calculate$EBTORS4URNOVERFOR&ERRANTE3UITSFOR c 2EFERRINGTOYOURANSWERFORPART@B stateWHETHER$EBTORS4URNOVERISSATISFACTORY ORUNSATISFACTORYJustifyYOURANSWER d SuggestTWOSTRATEGIESTHEOWNERCOULDIMPLEMENTTOIMPROVE$EBTORS4URNOVER e ExplainWHYTHISlRMS$EBTORS4URNOVERISUNLIKELYTOHAVEASIGNIlCANTIMPACTON ITSABILITYTOMEETITSSHORT TERMDEBTS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
CHAPTER 19
E VA L U AT I N G L I Q U I D I T Y
EXERCISE 19.11 DEBTORS TURNOVER AND STOCK TURNOVER
W B
page 426
,OWEN,IFEVESTSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONFOR Stock Turnover
46 days
Debtors Turnover
25 days
Credit terms offered to customers
30 days
Credit terms offered by suppliers
60 days
Stock Turnover (2014)
31 days
Required a ExplainWHYTHISlRMMAYHAVELIQUIDITYPROBLEMSIN b IdentifyTWOFACTSTHATSUPPORTTHECLAIMTHATSTOCKMANAGEMENTHASBEENWORSE THANDEBTORMANAGEMENTIN c ExplainTHEIMPORTANCEOFSTOCKMANAGEMENTINTERMSOFMEETINGSHORT TERMDEBTS ASTHEYFALLDUE d List THREE STOCK MANAGEMENT STRATEGIES THIS lRM COULD IMPLEMENT TO IMPROVE ITS 3TOCK4URNOVER e StateONEBENElTANDONECOSTOFOFFERINGDISCOUNTSTODEBTORS f ExplainHOWCREDITCHECKSCANLEADTOFASTER$EBTORS4URNOVER
EXERCISE 19.12 CREDITORS TURNOVER
W B
page 427
0RINGLE0UMPSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONFOR Credit purchases
91 250
Average creditors
10 000
Credit terms offered by suppliers
30 days
Budgeted Sales revenue
140 000
Sales revenue
100 000
)N #REDITORS4URNOVERWASDAYS Required a StateWHATISMEASUREDBY#REDITORS4URNOVER b Calculate#REDITORS4URNOVERFOR0RINGLE0UMPSFOR c StateTWOREASONSWHYTHEOWNERSHOULDBECONCERNEDABOUT#REDITORS4URNOVER IN d StateTWONEGATIVECONSEQUENCESOFEXCEEDINGTHECREDITTERMSOFFEREDBYSUPPLIERS
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
475
476
CAMBRIDGE VCE ACCOUNTING
UNITS 3&4
EXERCISE 19.13 STOCK TURNOVER, DEBTORS TURNOVER AND CREDITORS TURNOVER
W B
page 428
#LAIRES#LOCKSHASPROVIDEDTHEFOLLOWINGINFORMATIONRELATINGTOITSACTIVITIESFOR AND 2015
2016
Stock Turnover
36 days
33 days
Debtors Turnover
31 days
49 days
Creditors Turnover
51 days
64 days
Credit terms offered to customers
30 days
Credit terms offered by suppliers
45 days
Stock Turnover – industry average
11 days
Required a SuggestTWOREASONSTHATCOULDEXPLAINTHEIMPROVEMENTIN3TOCK4URNOVERIN b SuggestTWOSTRATEGIESTHEOWNERCOULDADOPTTOENCOURAGELATEDEBTORSTOPAY c Explain HOW THE CHANGE IN $EBTORS 4URNOVER HAS AFFECTED #REDITORS 4URNOVER IN d 2EFERRING TO ONE OTHER LIQUIDITY INDICATOR explain HOW THIS BUSINESS COULD AVOID LIQUIDITYPROBLEMSWITHOUTRAISINGFURTHEREXTERNALlNANCEIN
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richardy Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
477
GLOSSARY
accounting equation [p. 23] the rule that states that assets must always equal liabilities plus owner’s equity
bad debt [p. 152] an expense incurred when a debt is written off because it is deemed to be irrecoverable
accounting principles [p. 8] the generally accepted rules that govern the way accounting information is generated
balance day adjustment (BDA) [p. 218] a change made to a revenue or expense account on balance day so that revenue accounts show revenues earned and expense accounts show expenses incurred in a particular Reporting Period
accrual accounting [p. 10] calculating profit by comparing revenues earned against expenses incurred in a particular Reporting Period accrued expense [p. 223] an expense that has been incurred but not yet paid accrued revenue [p. 376] a revenue that has been earned but not yet received accumulated depreciation [p. 246] the value of a non-current asset that has been consumed/incurred over its life thus far advice [p. 7] the provision to the owners of a range of options appropriate to their aims/objectives, together with recommendations as to the suitability of those aims/objectives agreed value [p. 9] the accepted value of a non-cash asset at the time of its contribution by the owner analysing [p. 428] examining the financial reports in detail to identify changes or differences in performance Analysing Chart [p. 42] a tool used to identify the steps for recording transactions in the General Ledger asset [p. 13] a resource controlled by an entity, as a result of past events, from which future economic benefits are expected to flow to the entity Asset Turnover (ATO) [p. 438] an efficiency indicator that measures how productively a business has used its assets to earn revenue
Balance Sheet [p. 24] an accounting report that details the business’s assets, liabilities and owner’s equity at a particular point in time balancing [p. 51] ruling off an asset, liability or owner’s equity account to determine its balance at the end of the reporting period and transferring that balance to the next reporting period benchmark [p. 431] an acceptable standard against which the firm’s actual performance can be assessed budget [p. 388] an accounting report that predicts/estimates the financial consequences of future events Budgeted Balance Sheet [p. 403] an accounting report that predicts assets, liabilities and owner’s equity at some point in the future Budgeted Cash Flow Statement [p. 390] an accounting report that attempts to predict all future cash inflows and cash outflows, and thus the estimated cash balance at the end of the budget period Budgeted Income Statement [p. 400] an accounting report that shows expected future revenues and expenses budgeting [p. 388] the process of predicting/estimating the financial consequences of future events carrying value [p. 249] the value of a non-current asset that is yet to be consumed/allocated as an expense, plus any residual value
Cash Budget Variance Report [p. 410] an accounting report that compares actual and budgeted cash flows, highlighting variances cash deficit [p. 265] an excess of cash payments over Cash Receipts, leading to a decrease in the bank balance Cash Flow Cover (CFC) [p. 461] a liquidity indicator that measures the number of times Net Cash Flows from Operations is able to cover average Current Liabilities Cash Flow Statement [p. 266] an accounting report that details all cash inflows and outflows from Operating, Investing and Financing activities, and the overall change in the firm’s cash balance Cash Payments Journal [p. 109] an accounting record summarising all cash paid during a month cash receipt [p. 62] a source document used to verify cash received Cash Receipts Journal [p. 114] an accounting record that summarises all cash received during a month cash surplus [p. 265] an excess of cash receipts over cash payments, leading to an increase in the bank balance cheque butt [p. 67] a source document used to verify cash payments classification [p. 25] grouping together items that have some common characteristic closing the ledger [p. 197] transferring balances from revenue and expense ledger accounts to the Profit and Loss Summary account so that profit can be calculated
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
478
GLOSSARY
commencing entry [p. 145] a General Journal entry to establish doubleentry records by entering existing asset, liability and owner’s equity balances in the ledger accounts Comparability [p. 12] accounting reports should be able to be compared over time Conservatism [p. 10] losses should be recorded when probable but gains should only be recorded when certain, so that liabilities and expenses are not understated and assets and revenues are not overstated Consistency [p. 10] accounting methods should be applied in a consistent manner to ensure that reports are comparable between periods control account [p. 90] an account in the General Ledger summarising the transactions recorded in the subsidiary ledger accounts cost of a non-current asset [p. 251] all costs incurred in order to bring the asset into a location and condition ready for use, which will provide a benefit for the life of the asset. Cost of Goods Sold (COGS) [p. 182] all costs incurred in getting stock into a condition and location ready for sale cost of stock [p. 308] all costs incurred in order to bring stock into a condition and location ready for sale cost price [p. 167] the original purchase price of stock credit note [p. 293] a source document that verifies the return of stock either to a trade creditor or by a trade debtor Creditors Schedule [p. 91] a list of the name and balance of each individual account in the Creditors Ledger, added together to enable checking against the balance of the Creditors Control account Creditors Turnover (CTO) [p. 468] the average number of days it takes for a business to pay its creditors cross-reference [p. 39] the name of the other account affected by a transaction, so that both accounts affected by a particular transaction can be identified current asset [p. 25] a resource controlled by the entity as a result of past events, from which a future economic benefit is expected to flow to the entity in the next 12 months
current liability [p. 26] a present obligation of the Entity arising from past events, the settlement of which is expected to result in an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits in the next 12 months
expense [p. 15] an outflow or consumption of economic benefits (or reduction in inflows) in the form of a decrease in assets (or increase in liabilities) that reduces owner’s equity, except for drawings by the owner
Debt Ratio [p. 434] a stability indicator that measures the percentage of a firm’s assets that are financed by liabilities Debtors Ageing Analysis [p. 467] a listing of the amount and proportion of debtors according to the length of time they are owing
expense control [p. 440] the firm’s ability to manage its expenses so that they either decrease or, in the case of variable expenses, increase no faster than Sales revenue
Debtors Turnover (DTO) [p. 465] the average number of days it takes for a business to collect cash from its debtors
financial information [p. 5] financial data that has been sorted, classified and summarised into a more useable and understandable form
depreciable asset [p. 241] a non-current asset that has a finite life, and must be depreciated over its life depreciable value [p. 244] the total value of the asset that will be consumed by the current entity, and so must be allocated over its useful life depreciation [p. 242] the allocation of the cost of a non-current asset over its useful life depreciation expense [p. 242] that part of the cost of a non-current asset that has been consumed in the current Reporting Period
financial data [p. 5] raw facts and figures upon which financial information is based
Financing activities [p. 266] cash flows related to changes in the financial structure of the firm finite life [p. 241] the limited period of time (usually measured in years) for which a non-current asset will exist First In, First Out (FIFO) [p. 170] the assumption that the stock that is purchased first will be sold first footing [p. 49] an informal process used to determine the balance of a ledger account
discount expense [p. 126] an expense, in the form of a decrease in debtors, incurred when cash is received early from debtors
General Journal [p. 144] an accounting record used to record infrequent, non-cash transactions, which cannot be recorded in the special journals
discount revenue [p. 123] a revenue (in the form of a decrease in creditors) earned when creditors are paid early
General Ledger [p. 36] the collective name for the main group of ledger accounts
double-entry accounting [p. 28] a system that records two effects on the accounting equation as a result of each transaction
Going Concern [p. 9] the life of the business is assumed to be continuous, and its records are kept on that basis
efficiency [p. 428] the ability of the business to manage its assets and liabilities
Goods and Services Tax (GST) [p. 60] a 10% tax levied by the federal government on most purchases of goods (excluding fresh food) and services
Entity [p. 8] the business is assumed to be separate from the owner and other businesses, and its records should be kept on this basis
Gross Profit Margin (GPM) [p. 442] a profitability indicator that measures the average mark-up by calculating the percentage of Sales revenue that is retained as Gross Profit
equities [p. 23] claims on the assets of the business, consisting of both liabilities and owner’s equity
GST refund [p. 96] a cash receipt from the ATO to refund the excess that occurs when GST on sales is less than GST on purchases
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
GLOSSARY
GST settlement [p. 96] a cash payment made to the ATO to settle the liability that occurs when GST on sales is greater than GST on purchases
narration [p. 145] a brief description of a transaction recorded in the General Journal, including a reference to the relevant source document
Historical Cost [p. 10] the recording of a transaction at its original cost or value, as this value is verifiable by reference to the source document
Net Profit Margin (NPM) [p. 440] a profitability indicator that measures expense control by calculating the percentage of Sales revenue that is retained as Net Profit
horizontal analysis [p. 430] comparing reports from one period to the next, and identifying the increase or decrease in specific items in the report Income Statement [p. 203] an accounting report that details the revenues earned and expenses incurred during the current Reporting Period
Net Realisable Value (NRV) [p. 219] the estimated selling price of stock less any costs involved in its selling, marketing or distribution Net Sales [p. 301] sales revenue after the deduction of Sales Returns; that is, sales less Sales Returns
Income Statement Variance Report [p. 412] an accounting report that compares actual and budgeted revenues and expenses, and highlights variations
non-current asset [p. 25] a resource controlled by the Entity as a result of past events, from which a future economic benefit is expected to flow to the entity for more than the next 12 months
interpreting [p. 428] examining the relationships between the items in the financial reports in order to explain the cause and effect of changes or differences in performance
non-current liability [p. 26] a present obligation of the Entity arising from past events, the settlement of which is expected to result in an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits in more than 12 months
Investing activities [p. 266] cash flows related to the purchase and sale of non-current assets ledger accounts [p. 36] accounting records showing all the transactions that affect a particular item
non-financial information [p. 445] any information that cannot be found in the financial statements, and is not expressed in dollars and cents, or reliant on dollars and cents for its calculation
479
Post-adjustment Trial Balance [p. 228] a list of all General Ledger accounts and their balances after balance day adjustments have been made Pre-adjustment Trial Balance [p. 228] a list of all General Ledger accounts and their balances before balance day adjustments have been made prepaid expense [p. 220] an expense paid in advance but yet to be consumed prepaid revenue [p. 368] a revenue received but yet to be earned product cost [p. 307] a cost incurred in order to bring stock into a condition and location ready for sale, which can be allocated to individual units of stock on a logical basis profit on disposal of asset [p. 350] where the proceeds from the disposal of an asset are greater than its carrying value profitability [p. 428] the ability of the business to earn profit, as compared against a base, such as Sales, assets or owner’s equity profitability indicators [p. 431] measures that express an element of profit in relation to some other aspect of business performance purchase invoice [p. 72] a source document used to verify a credit purchase of stock or other items
liability [p. 14] a present obligation of the entity as a result of past events, the settlement of which is expected to result in an outflow from the entity of resources embodying economic benefits
Operating activities [p. 266] cash flows related to day-to-day trading activities
purchase return [p. 292] the return of stock by our firm to a trade creditor
order form [p. 76] a document requesting the supply of stock or other goods
liquidity [p. 428] the ability of a business to meet its shortterm debts as they fall due
over-depreciation [p. 346] occurs when excess depreciation has been allocated over the life of the asset, so that the carrying value of the asset is understated
Purchases Journal [p. 88] an accounting record that summarises all transactions involving the purchase of stock on credit during a month purpose of accounting [p. 4] to provide financial information to assist decision-making
owner’s equity [p. 14] the residual interest in the assets of the entity after the deduction of its liabilities
qualitative characteristics [p. 11] the qualities of the information in accounting reports
period cost [p. 313] a cost incurred in order to bring stock into a condition and location ready for sale that is not allocated to individual units of stock because there is no logical basis to do so
Quick Asset Ratio (QAR) [p. 459] a liquidity indicator that measures the ratio of quick assets to quick liabilities, to assess the firm’s ability to meet its immediate debts
loss on disposal of asset [p. 348] where the proceeds from the disposal of an asset is less than its carrying value materiality [p. 12] size or significance memo [p. 74] a source document used to verify an internal transaction Monetary Unit [p. 10] all items must be recorded and reported in a common unit of measurement; that is, Australian dollars
perpetual system of stock recording [p. 183] recording stock transactions in stock cards, then conducting a physical stocktake at the end of the Reporting Period to verify the balances of those stock cards
recording [p. 6] sorting, classifying and summarising the data contained in the source documents so that it is more useable
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
480
GLOSSARY
Relevance [p. 12] accounting reports should include all information that is useful for decisionmaking Reliability [p. 12] accounting reports should contain information that is accurate, and free from bias or error reporting [p. 7] the preparation of financial statements that communicate financial information to the owner Reporting Period [p. 9] the life of the business must be divided into periods of time to allow reports to be prepared; these accounting reports should reflect the Reporting Period in which a transaction occurs Return on Assets (ROA) [p. 436] a profitability indicator that measures how effectively a business has used its assets to earn profit Return on Owner’s Investment (ROI) [p. 432] a profitability indicator that measures how effectively a business has used the owner’s capital to earn profit revenue [p. 15] an inflow of economic benefits (or saving in outflows) in the form of an increase in assets (or decrease in liabilities) that increases owner’s equity, except for capital contributions by the owner
settlement discount [p. 121] a reduction in the amount repayable by a credit customer in return for early repayment source documents [p. 6] paper or electronic documents that provide both the evidence that a transaction has occurred and the details of the transaction itself
trading firm [p. 164] a firm that purchases goods in order to resell them at a profit
special journal [p. 87] an accounting record that summarises similar transactions
transaction [p. 6] an exchange of goods or services with another party
stability [p. 428] the ability of the business to meet its debts and continue its operations in the long term
trend [p. 429] the pattern formed by changes in an item over a number of periods
statement of account [p. 75] a summary of the transactions a firm has had with a particular debtor/creditor over a certain period of time (usually a month)
Trial Balance [p. 49] a list of all the accounts in the General Ledger, and their balances, to determine if total debits equal total credits
Statement of Receipts and Payments [p. 264] an accounting report that details cash received and paid during a Reporting Period, and the change in the firm’s bank balance over that period
under-depreciation [p. 356] occurs when insufficient depreciation has been allocated over the life of the asset, so that the carrying value of the asset is overstated
stock [p. 164] goods purchased by a trading firm for the purpose of resale at a profit stock card [p. 166] a subsidiary accounting record that records each individual transaction involving the movement in and out of the business of a particular line of stock
sales invoice [p. 70] a source document used to verify a credit sale of stock
stock gain [p. 176] a revenue earned when the stocktake shows a figure for stock on hand that is more than the balance shown in the stock card
Sales Journal [p. 92] an accounting record summarising all transactions involving the sale of stock on credit during a month
stock loss [p. 174] an expense incurred when the stocktake shows a figure for stock on hand that is less than the balance shown in the stock card
sales return [p. 292] the return of stock to our firm by a trade debtor
Stock Turnover (STO) [p. 463] the average number of days it takes for a business to convert its stock into sales
Schedule of Payments to Creditors [p. 400] a table used to calculate how much cash will be paid to creditors in the budget period as a consequence of credit purchases in the current and previous periods
Stock Write-down [p. 320] the expense incurred when the NRV of an item of stock falls below its original purchase price
Schedule of Receipts from Debtors [p. 397] a table used to calculate how much cash will be received from debtors in the budget period as a consequence of Credit Sales in the current and previous periods
trade-in [p. 351] when a firm uses the proceeds from the sale of a non-current asset to reduce the amount payable for the purchase of a new noncurrent asset
stocktake [p. 173] a physical count of the number of units of each line of stock on hand
Understandability [p. 12] accounting reports should be presented in a manner that makes it easy for them to be understood by the user unit cost [p. 309] the cost price of each individual item/unit of stock variance [p. 411] the difference between an actual figure and a budgeted figure, expressed as ‘favourable’ or ‘unfavourable’ variance report [p. 410] an accounting report that compares actual and budgeted figures, highlighting variances, so that problems can be identified and corrective action taken vertical analysis [p. 443] a report that expresses every item as a percentage of a base figure; in this case, Sales revenue Working Capital Ratio (WCR) [p. 457] a liquidity indicator that measures the ratio of current assets to current liabilities, to assess the firm’s ability to meet its shortterm debts
subsidiary ledger [p. 90] an additional set of ledger accounts kept outside the General Ledger, recording individual transactions for each individual debtor or creditor
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
481
SELECTED ANSWERS
CHAPTER 7
Chapter 2 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.6 2.7
c b a d b
Total Assets = $92 600 Total Assets = $83 190 Total Assets = $165 500 Total Assets = $103 100 Total Assets = $91 700
Chapter 3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 3.8
c e d c d g h
b
5.3 5.5 5.6 5.8
e/f b e/f a c/d
5.9
c/d
Purchases Journal: Total Creditors Control = $54 120 Creditors Control (balance) = $15 950 Sales Journal: Total Debtors Control = $6 402 Debtors Control (balance) = $9 130 Purchases Journal: Creditors Control = $2 970 Sales Journal: Debtors Control= $3 850 Creditors Control (balance) = $4 720 Debtors Control (balance) = $8 140 Creditors Control (balance) = $7 260 Debtors Control (balance) = $8 525
Chapter 6 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.4 6.5 6.6 6.7
6.10 6.11
b d/e b d/e c e a d/e c/d a d/e c/d b
6.12
c d/f
6.8 6.9
8.8
8.12
b f a d d e
Total assets = $51 250 Stock Control (Balance) = $8 855
Net profit = $15 500 Total assets = $174 500 Net profit = $300 Total assets = $64 600 Stock Control (balance) = $10 530 Debtors Control (balance) = $22 000 Net profit = $20 520
CHAPTER 9 9.3 9.4 9.5 9.6 9.7 9.8
e b d g c f c g d f
Total equities = $68 700 Net profit = $24 000 Net loss = ($880) Total assets = $44 570 Net profit = $2 600 Total assets = $165 300 Net profit = $920 Total assets = $40 320 Net profit = $24 910 Total assets = $238 300
CHAPTER 10 10.11
10.12 Cash Payments Journal: Bank = $8 660 Creditors Control (balance) = $9 590 Cash Payments Journal: Bank = $10 085 Debtors Control (balance) = $6 910 GST Clearing (balance) = $550 CCR GST Clearing (balance) = $600 CCR Cash Payments Journal: Bank = $50 162 Creditors Control (balance) = $18 150 Creditors Control (balance) = $13 940 Cash Payments Journal: Bank = $10 427 Debtors Control (balance) = $1 815 Debtors Control (balance) = $5 720 Bank (balance) = $4 580 CR GST Clearing (balance) = $560 CR Trial Balance = $242 050 Creditors Control (balance) = $6 380 Debtors Control (balance) = $11 440
d e
CHAPTER 8
8.9 Trial Balance = $183 900 Trial Balance = $37 470 Trial Balance = $245 130 Trial Balance = $14 000 Trial Balance = $272 380 Net profit = $5 240 Total assets = $263 240
Chapter 5 5.2
7.2 7.12
10.13
c e f c e g c f g
Trial Balance = $194 970 Net profit = $2180 Total assets = $96 650 Trial Balance = $480 530 Net profit = $52 550 Total assets = $311 500 Trial Balance = $172 120 Net profit = $26 260 Total assets = $113 670
CHAPTER 11 11.10
11.11
c e h b e g
Trial Balance = $288 150 Net loss = ($8250) Total assets = $84 450 Trial Balance = $204 220 Net profit = $19 880 Total assets = $79 100
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press
SELECTED ANSWERS
482
CHAPTER 16
CHAPTER 12 12.1 12.10 12.11 12.12 12.13 12.14
a/b b b b c a/b c d
Bank Balance at End = $2900 DR. Bank Balance at End= ($530) Bank Balance at End= ($7950) Bank Balance at End= $57 800 Net loss = ($1350) Bank Balance at End= ($560) Debtors Control (balance) = $56 000 Bank Balance at End= $10 860
16.9
16.10
c d f f
CHAPTER 17 17.1 17.2
b b
17.5
c
17.6
a b d
CHAPTER 13 13.2 13.4 13.5
e d e d
13.6
c
13.8
d b
Freezing Fridges (balance) = $5434 Mega World (balance) = $1355 Gross profit = $480 Stock Control (balance at Nov 1) = $46 000 Creditors Control (balance at Nov 1) = $28 500 GST Clearing (balance at Nov 1) = $2 400 Debtors Control (balance at Dec 1) = $30 120 Stock Control (balance at Dec 1) = $16 600 GST Clearing (balance at Dec 1) = $970 Gross profit = $18 800 Debtors Control (balance at Jul 1) = $4 290 Creditors Control (balance at Jul 1) = $4 268 Stock Control (balance at Jul 1) = $7 820 GST Clearing (balance at Jul 1) = $363 City of Hume (balance) = $924 Net loss = ($3 379)
d e
17.7
17.15
f c d f g e g
CHAPTER 14 14.5 14.8 14.12
c e f
Adjusted Gross Profit = $1 100 Adjusted Gross Profit = $1 900 Adjusted Gross Profit = $19 500
Trial Balance = $247 975 Net profit = $10 415 Total assets = $185 925 Current Assets = $109 180 Current Liabilities = $93 500
h 17.16
c e
Bank Balance at End = ($7330) Bank Balance at End: Jan. = $120 Feb. = ($15 160) Mar. = $4 910 Net Cash Flows from Operations: Jan. = $120 Feb. = ($15 160) Mar. = $4 910 Bank Balance at End= $42 480 Net profit = $5 250 Stock Control (balance) = $21 200 GST Clearing (balance) = $2 120 Total assets = $76 250 Bank Balance at End= $28 135 Net profit = $9 745 Stock Control (balance) = $18 700 GST Clearing (balance) = $1 880 Total assets = $110 755 Bank Balance at End = $25 108 Stock Control (balance) = $49 900 GST Clearing (balance) = $7 220 Current Assets = $98 358 Current Liabilities = $55 220 Net profit = $25 220 Total assets = $69 320
CHAPTER 15 15.14
b d f
Trial Balance = $131 440 Net profit = $9 440 Total assets = $72 950
ISBN 978-1-107-64070-2 © Anthony SImmons, Richard Hardy 2012 Photocopying is restricted under law and this material must not be transferred to another party.
Cambridge University Press